Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Ford
Model
Expedition 4wd
Engine and year
V8-5.4L (2007)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 8
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory
Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 10
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Antenna Control Module: Service and Repair
ANTENNA ISOLATOR MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH C-pillar trim panel. 2. Disconnect the antenna cable connector, the antenna
isolator module electrical connector, and the antenna isolator module-to-quarter glass
connector.
3. Remove the stud and the antenna isolator module.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Parking Assist Control Module: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 17
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 18
C4226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Parking
Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 19
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
PARKING AID MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking aid module sub-harness from the body harness. 2. Remove the rear
bumper cover. 3. Remove the 4 insulator-to-bumper cover nuts and the insulator from the bumper
cover. 4. Disconnect the parking aid module sub-harness from the parking aid module. 5. Remove
the 2 parking aid module bracket bolts. 6. Remove the parking aid module bracket assembly. 7.
Release the module tabs from the bracket and remove the module from the bracket. 8. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Remote
Control Module, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Center Console - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Remote
Control Module, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Page 23
C3077
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 28
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C341A
C341B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 29
C341C
C341D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 30
C341E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Seat Control Module: Description and Operation
DRIVER SEAT MODULE - MEMORY SEAT
The power driver seat, power outside rear view mirrors, power adjustable pedals and adjustable
steering column are controlled by the driver seat module (DSM) only when the vehicle is equipped
with the programmable/recall memory option. The DSM is located on the driver seat track.
This system allows automatic positioning of the driver seat to 2 programmable positions.
The memory seat system consists of the following components:
- DSM
- Driver memory seat control switch
- Memory set switch
- Adjustable pedal switch
- Power mirror switch
- Adjustable steering column switch
- Memory seat track assembly (with seat position sensors integral to motors) Horizontal motor (part of seat track)
- Front height motor (part of seat track)
- Rear height motor (part of seat track)
- Backrest power recliner motor (with integral position sensor) (part of backrest frame)
- LH memory power mirror
- RH memory power mirror
- Power adjustable memory pedals
- Power adjustable steering column
- Remote keyless entry transmitter
Two personalized seat positions may be programmed into the memory seat system. A memory
seat position may be set by first positioning the driver seat using the driver power seat switch and
depressing the memory set switch. Memory seat position 1 or 2 must be selected within 5 seconds
to set a personalized seat position. If position 1 or 2 is not selected within 5 seconds, the operation
is aborted. This operation also aborts if any input is received from the driver power seat switch, the
power mirror switch, the adjustable pedal switch, the power adjustable steering column switch or if
the memory set switch is depressed again during the 5-second limit. The personalized memory
seat positions are recalled using the memory switch positions 1 and 2 or with the remote keyless
entry transmitter.
A programmed seat position can only be recalled when the transmission selector is in PARK or
NEUTRAL with the ignition switch in the RUN position. A position may be programmed at any time.
For information on the DSM, refer to Body Control Systems (Multifunction Electronic Control
Module).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 38
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 41
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 43
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 44
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 45
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Customer Interest Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC
B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 54
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Power Liftgate
Inoperative/DTC B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 60
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 61
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Locations
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 62
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 63
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
C4174A
C4174B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 64
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair
POWER LIFTGATE MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the power liftgate module.
1 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2 Remove the bolt. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Service and Repair
RETRACTABLE RUNNING BOARD MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH B-pillar trim panel. 2. Disconnect the retractable running board module electrical
connectors. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the retractable running board module assembly. 4. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 07-21-6 > Oct
> 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
Seat Heater Control Module: Customer Interest A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
TSB 07-21-6
10/29/07
CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - NO COMMUNICATION - DCSM VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 8/31/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 KZ, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
built before 8/31/2007 and equipped with climate control seats may exhibit inoperative heating
and/or cooling. There are no diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) associated with this issue and
IDS/PDS will not communicate with the dual climate control seat module (DCSM).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn the ignition switch to key on engine off (KOEO) position.
2. Run self test on DCSM.
a. If DTCs are present do not continue with this TSB, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM)
diagnostics for the DTCs.
b. If no communication with the DCSM, proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove power to the DCSM and wait a minimum of 2 minutes. This will reset the DCSM.
^ Expedition/Navigator - remove Fuse 8 in the battery junction box (BJB).
^ Zephyr/MKZ - remove Fuse 11 and 12 in the BJB.
4. Reinstall the fuse(s) and recheck for communication.
a. If communication does not return, refer to WSM, Section 418-00.
b. If the communication is restored by resetting:
(1) Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ - reprogram the DCSM to the latest calibration using IDS
release 51.4 or later with patch 7. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
(2) 2006 Zephyr/2007 MKZ - replace the DCSM.
5. Recheck operation of the heated/cooled seat and for DTCs. If no DTCs return the vehicle to the
customer.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 07-21-6 > Oct
> 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative > Page 76
072106A 2007-2008 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ With Climate Control Seats Built Before 8/31/2007: Reprogram
The DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not Use
With 12650D 12651D, 12651D4)
072106A 2006 Zephyr, 2007 MKZ: 1.0 Hr.
Replace DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not
Use With 12650D, 12651D,
12651D4, 63100A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
Seat Heater Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Climate Control Seats
Inoperative
TSB 07-21-6
10/29/07
CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - NO COMMUNICATION - DCSM VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 8/31/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 KZ, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
built before 8/31/2007 and equipped with climate control seats may exhibit inoperative heating
and/or cooling. There are no diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) associated with this issue and
IDS/PDS will not communicate with the dual climate control seat module (DCSM).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn the ignition switch to key on engine off (KOEO) position.
2. Run self test on DCSM.
a. If DTCs are present do not continue with this TSB, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM)
diagnostics for the DTCs.
b. If no communication with the DCSM, proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove power to the DCSM and wait a minimum of 2 minutes. This will reset the DCSM.
^ Expedition/Navigator - remove Fuse 8 in the battery junction box (BJB).
^ Zephyr/MKZ - remove Fuse 11 and 12 in the BJB.
4. Reinstall the fuse(s) and recheck for communication.
a. If communication does not return, refer to WSM, Section 418-00.
b. If the communication is restored by resetting:
(1) Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ - reprogram the DCSM to the latest calibration using IDS
release 51.4 or later with patch 7. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
(2) 2006 Zephyr/2007 MKZ - replace the DCSM.
5. Recheck operation of the heated/cooled seat and for DTCs. If no DTCs return the vehicle to the
customer.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative > Page 82
072106A 2007-2008 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ With Climate Control Seats Built Before 8/31/2007: Reprogram
The DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not Use
With 12650D 12651D, 12651D4)
072106A 2006 Zephyr, 2007 MKZ: 1.0 Hr.
Replace DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not
Use With 12650D, 12651D,
12651D4, 63100A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 83
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 84
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams
C3265A
C3265B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 85
C3265C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 86
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair
CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), carry out the appropriate steps in
the programmable module installation (PMI)
procedure.
2. Position the front passenger seat fully upward and depower the supplemental restraint system
(SRS).
3. CAUTION: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield. Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
4. Release the 2 tabs and slide out the CCSM.
5. Remove the CCSM.
- Cut and remove the wiring harness tie strap.
- Release the 2 locking wedges.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the SRS. 8. If a new CCSM has been
installed, carry out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Locations
View 151-43 (Roof - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 90
View 151-45 (Roof - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 91
C921
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 96
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 97
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 100
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 102
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 103
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 104
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 105
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 106
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake Control
Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Electronic Brake Control Module: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC
C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake Control
Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 117
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake Control
Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 118
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Electronic Brake Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon
ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 124
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 125
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 126
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 127
C135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 128
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new module, it must be calibrated and configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. Disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air cleaner cover.
^ to install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.)
3. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 4. Release the retaining clips
and position the air cleaner cover aside. 5. Remove the 3 hydraulic control unit (HCU) bracket
bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
6. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical connector. 7. Remove the 4 bolts
and the ABS module.
^ To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.)
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ If installing a new ABS module, program the module. For additional information, refer to
Information Bus (Module Configuration).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 132
C2142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 138
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 139
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 140
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 143
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 144
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 145
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 146
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 147
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 148
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 149
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 151
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 152
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 153
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 157
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH RELAY (A/CCR)
NOTE: The PCM PIDs WAC and wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WACF) are used to
monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR is wired normally open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch
or electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module and the A/C clutch. The PCM receives
a signal indicating that A/C is requested. For some applications, this message is sent through the
communications network. When A/C is requested, the PCM checks other A/C related inputs that
are available, such as A/C pressure switch and A/C cycling switch. If these inputs indicate A/C
operation is OK, and the engine conditions are OK (coolant temperature, engine RPM, throttle
position), the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending voltage to
the A/CCR.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 158
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 159
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 165
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
C228A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 168
C228B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 169
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Manual Climate Control Module
C2357A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 170
C2357B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 171
C2357C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 176
Backup Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 177
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 178
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 183
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 186
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 187
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 188
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 190
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 195
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 198
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 199
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 200
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Reset Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 201
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 207
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 208
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 211
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 212
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 213
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 214
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 215
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 216
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 217
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 218
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 223
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 224
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 228
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 229
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB)
Removal
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new SJB after installation.
1. NOTE:
- The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) functionality is integral to the SJB.
- A new SJB is delivered in "manufacturing mode" with 7 pre-set DTCs. These 7 manufacturing
mode DTCs require that a successful configuration of the SJB occurs, then a successful TPMS
sensor training occurs, then a successful self-test occurs, including the clearing of all DTCs. All of
this is required in order to clear the 7 manufacturing mode DTCs. The 7 manufacturing mode DTCs
are as follows: B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured) This DTC is present
when the SJB is not configured, even on applications that are not equipped with initiators.
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-state)
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Remove the pin-type retainer and the RH A-pillar lower trim panel. 4.
Remove the glove compartment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 233
5. Disconnect the 7 electrical connectors. 6. Remove the 2 bolts and the SJB.
Installation
1. Position the SJB and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
2. Connect the 7 electrical connectors. 3. Position the RH A-pillar lower trim panel and install the
pin-type retainer. 4. Install the glove compartment. 5. Connect the battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and
clears DTCs B2477 and B106D. The clearing of
these DTCs indicate the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the SJB.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB on-demand self-test by clearing DTCs and then retrieving DTCs to confirm all
DTCs have been cleared.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 238
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 239
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 242
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 243
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 244
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 245
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 246
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 247
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 248
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 249
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 254
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 255
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 256
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 257
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 258
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 259
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 260
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 261
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 262
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 263
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 266
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
C2280B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 267
C2280C
C2280D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 268
C2280E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 269
C2280F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 270
C2280G
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 273
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 274
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 275
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 276
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 277
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 279
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 280
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 281
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 282
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programmable
Module Installation
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Programmable Module Installation
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation Using the Integrated Diagnostic System IDS) When the Original
Module is NOT Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure carried
out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal and
installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle normal. 3. From the Toolbox
icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable Module
Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the
ignition key to the OFF position, and press check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn
the ignition key to the ON position, and press check mark. 8. If the data is not available, the IDS
displays screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data from the technician
service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programmable
Module Installation > Page 290
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (Dsm)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new DSM after
installation.
1. Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the DSM forward to remove it from the bracket.
3. Disconnect the battery. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
5. NOTE: Once the module is installed it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the scan tool into the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position (TP) sensor, and mechanical throttle body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The TP sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant throttle position
signals are required for increased monitoring
reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and
the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal
operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of
throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 294
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is convened to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 295
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 296
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. The E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly monitor
selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of the IPC
and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it takes
appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 297
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 298
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 4% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 4% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key ON,
engine OFF.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 8% - Enable ice breaker mode. Used to clear potential
ice buildup in the throttle body.
- Greater than or equal to 8% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide open throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop > Page 307
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare >
Page 312
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To
Zero At A Stop
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To
Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To
Zero At A Stop > Page 318
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2
Shift Flare
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2
Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2
Shift Flare > Page 323
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
324
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 327
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 328
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 329
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 330
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 331
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 332
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 333
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 334
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 335
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 336
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 337
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 338
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 339
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 340
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 341
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 342
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 343
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 344
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175B (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 345
C175B (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 346
C175E (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 347
C175E (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain
Control Module (PCM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Removal
1. Retrieve the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration retrieval steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the 2 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the ground cable.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Remove the PCM. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Installation
1. Install the PCM. 2. Position the ground cable and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. Connect the 3 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Connect the battery ground cable.
5. NOTE:
- When a new PCM is installed, the air bag warning indicator will illuminate when the ignition switch
is ON. The warning indicator will remain on until PCM configuration is restored
- Clear all restraints control module (RCM) continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) after
Programmable Module Installation procedure has
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain
Control Module (PCM) > Page 350
been completed on the PCM.
Restore the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration restore steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain
Control Module (PCM) > Page 351
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module
(PCM). The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the
vehicle, and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTCs P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and needs programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old module is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 355
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 356
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 357
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 362
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 363
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 364
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 368
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 369
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 370
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 375
Ignition Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 376
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 377
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-22 (RH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 382
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 383
C310B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 384
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
WARNING:
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON.Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation.If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation.If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have
deployed.In addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original
condition.Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a
crash.
CAUTION: Prior to removal of the RCM module, it is necessary to upload module configuration
information to the scan tool.This information needs to be downloaded into the new RCM module
once installed.Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network).
NOTE:
- When a new PCM is installed, the air bag warning indicator will illuminate when the ignition switch
is ON.The warning indicator will remain on until PCM configuration is restored.Clear RCM DTCs.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM is
being installed.RCMs are not interchangeable between vehicles or vehicle lines.If an incorrect
RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs and incorrect diagnosis will result.
The restraints control module (RCM) carries out the following functions:
- deploys the air bag(s) in the event of a deployable crash.
- activates the safety belt buckle pretensioners to remove slack from the safety belt.
- monitors the SRS for faults.
- illuminates the air bag warning indicator if a fault is detected.
- communicates through the data link connector (DLC) the current or historical diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs).
The RCM monitors the SRS for possible faults.If a fault is detected while the ignition switch is in the
ON position, the RCM will request illumination of the air bag warning indicator located in the
instrument cluster.
When the ignition switch is cycled (turned OFF and then ON), the air bag warning indicator will
prove out by lighting for 6 seconds and then turn off.If a SRS fault exists, the air bag warning
indicator will illuminate and remain illuminated for the rest of the key cycle.The RCM will also
communicate the on-demand (current) and continuous (historical) DTCs through the DLC, to the
scan tool.If the RCM requests illumination of the air bag warning indicator and the air bag warning
indicator does not function, the instrument cluster module will automatically activate an audible
chime.The chime is a series of 5 sets of 5 tone bursts.If the chime is heard, the SRS and the air
bag warning indicator require repair.
The RCM includes a backup power supply.This feature provides sufficient backup power to deploy
the air bags in the event that the ignition circuit is lost or damaged during impact.The backup power
supply will deplete its stored energy approximately one minute after the battery ground cable is
disconnected.
A new RCM installed in a vehicle will flash lamp fault code (LFC) 54 until programmable module
installation (PMI) has been carried out on the RCM.If a LFC is present after completing PMI, a fault
is present in the SRS and on-demand DTCs must be retrieved and diagnosed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 385
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The RCM orientation is critical for proper air bag SRS operation. If a vehicle equipped with an
SRS system has been involved in a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 386
collision in which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have deployed.
In addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
can result.
- When installing a new RCM, it is necessary to carry out programmable module installation (PMI).
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- When installing a new RCM, always make sure the correct RCM is being installed. If an incorrect
RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All vehicles 1. If installing a new restraints control module (RCM), carry out the steps necessary to
prepare for programmable module installation (PMI). 2. Depower the system.
Vehicles with a center console 3. Remove the center console.
Vehicles with bucket seats and no center console 4. Remove the 3 RCM push-nut retainers and
the RCM cover.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
1 Push down to release the retaining tab.
2 While releasing the retaining tab, pull out and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
6. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1 Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever away from the RCM,
disengaging the lever.
2 Pull out and disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
7. Remove the 3 bolts and RCM.
Installation
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 387
1. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag RCM retaining bolts is critical for correct system
operation.
Install the RCM and 3 bolts. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
2. Make sure the connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before attempting
to connect the connector.
3. CAUTION: Putting the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM on an angle can cause bad
electrical connections and damage
components.
Position the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM.
- CAUTION: Do not push the connector on to where the lever pivots and seats itself. Light pressure
is needed to get the connector into position on the RCM before using the lever to fully seat the
connector.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 388
4. Connect the RCM electrical connector.
- Pivot the connector position assurance lever toward the RCM, drawing the connector in to the
RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with bucket seats and no center console 6. Install the 3 RCM push-nut retainers and the
RCM cover.
Vehicles with a center console 7. Install the center console.
All vehicles 8. Repower the SRS. Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 9. When installing a new
RCM, carry out the steps necessary to complete programmable module installation (PMI).
10. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 389
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous memory diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay > Page 395
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Run/Start Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 398
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 399
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 400
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 401
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 402
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 408
Compressor/Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 409
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 410
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 414
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
C2131A
C2131B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 415
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Module
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. NOTE: The air suspension control module is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 air suspension control module electrical connectors.
3. Remove the air suspension control module nuts and the air suspension control module.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. NOTE: The air suspension control module is calibrated with information from the ride height
sensors. A new or exchanged air suspension control
module requires that the LH and RH ride height sensors are calibrated and a pneumatic test is
carried out. For additional information, refer to Vehicle Dynamic Suspension Calibration Initialize
System - Clear C1990 and C1991 DTCs.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Control Module: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 426
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 431
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 436
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 437
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module:
> 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 438
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 444
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 449
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 454
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 455
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 456
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 461
Control Module: Diagrams
C281A
C281B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules
- Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 462
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH-side cowl side panel cover to gain access. 2. Remove the 2 screws. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 4WD control module. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 467
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 468
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 469
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 474
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 477
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 478
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 479
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 480
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 481
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
C2090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 >
Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
Pedal Positioning Switch: Customer Interest Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 >
Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 495
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-18-5 >
Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
Pedal Positioning Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Battery Drain/No
Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-18-5 >
Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 501
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Pedal
Positioning Switch: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Speedometer Head: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero
At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Pedal
Positioning Switch: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 507
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Pedal
Positioning Switch: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 513
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 514
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 515
C2089
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 516
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 517
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal
Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 518
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Console Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Console Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams
C2090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 07-18-5 > Sep >
07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
Pedal Positioning Switch: Customer Interest Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 07-18-5 > Sep >
07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 534
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Pedal Positioning Switch: >
07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
Pedal Positioning Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Battery Drain/No
Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Pedal Positioning Switch: >
07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 540
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 541
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 542
C2089
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 543
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 544
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 545
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 550
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
C505
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side > Page 553
C605
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 554
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 555
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 556
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door trim panel. 2. Release the tabs and remove the door lock control switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 560
C527
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 561
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 562
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 563
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 564
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driver front door trim panel.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
1 Depress the locking tabs.
2 Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor > Page 569
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor > Page 570
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Locations Height Sensor, Left/Right Rear
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor > Page 571
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor
C372
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 574
C373
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 575
C383
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 576
C4092
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 577
C4093
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Power Seat Switch, Left
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 582
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 583
Power Seat Switch: Locations Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left/Right
View 151-26 (Right Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 584
View 151-30 (Right Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Switch, Left
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Power Seat Switch, Left
C352
C3016
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 587
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Power Seat Switch, Right
C355
C3026
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 588
C4179
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 589
C4180
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 592
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 593
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 594
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 595
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 10-Way Power Seat - Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 596
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 597
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 10-Way Power Seat - Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 598
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 599
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 600
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 601
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 603
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 604
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 605
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 606
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 607
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 608
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 609
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 610
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 611
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair
MEMORY SET SWITCH
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 612
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 613
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 614
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 615
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat shown, passenger similar.
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Detach and position aside the driver seat
cushion side shield cover. 3. Release the clips and remove the memory set switch.
- Disconnect the seat control switch.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate
Hazard Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard Sensor: Service and Repair
PINCH STRIP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove brake light.
- Remove the screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate
Hazard Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 619
2. Disconnect the pinch strip electrical connector.
3. Remove the pinch strip.
1 Remove the pin-type retainers.
2 Remove the grommet and route the harness out of the vehicle.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-41 (Liftgate - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch
C4340
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch > Page 625
C4039
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Belt Tower Position
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the outboard side of the driver
seat track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver
seat position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Front
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - FRONT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 633
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 634
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 635
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 636
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat shown, passenger similar.
All seats
1. Position the seat forward and upward to aid in seat control switch removal. 2. Depower the
supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Pull and remove the seat control switch button(s).
- If equipped, remove the power recliner switch button.
Power seat with manual recliner
4. CAUTION: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield. Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 637
5. Remove the cushion side shield cover forward screw.
6. CAUTION: Do not damage the manual recliner lever when removing the cushion side shield
cover.
Remove the cushion side shield cover. Partially remove the cover to gain access to the seat control switch.
- Release the retainers and detach the seat control switch from the side shield cover.
- Remove the cushion side shield cover.
All seats
7. Detach and remove the cushion side shield cover.
- Disconnect the seat control switch.
- If equipped, disconnect the memory set switch electrical connector.
8. Release the clips and remove the seat control switch. 9. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
10. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 638
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Third Row
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - THIRD ROW
Removal and Installation
1. Release and remove the tray from the RH rear quarter trim panel.
2. NOTE: The LH and RH switch wiring harness electrical connectors are not interchangeable.
Remove the affected seat control switch. Reach a hand behind the RH rear quarter trim panel and squeeze together the 2 tabs on the
affected seat control switch to release.
- Pull the seat control switch through the opening and disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 642
C3246
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations Liftgate Rear Control Switch
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 647
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 648
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
C4333
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 651
C2361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations
ABS Sensor Block: Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 656
View 151-22 (RH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 657
C3073
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 658
ABS Sensor Block: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the bracket.
^ To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Sensor
Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 659
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Booster
Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Booster
Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 663
C149
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 667
C124
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the bracket.
^ To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 671
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (LH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 675
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Angle
Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set
TSB 08-20-8
10/13/08
STEERING WHEEL ANGLE CIRCUIT AND/OR SIGNAL FAILURE - C1277-C1278 - BUILT
ON/OR BEFORE 4/10/2008
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 08-10-3 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 4/10/2008 may
exhibit a traction control light (TCL) on with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1277 and/or C1278
(steering wheel angle 1 and 2 circuit failure and/or signal faulted).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check to see if the steering wheel rotation (SWR) sensor wiring near the connector has come in
contact with or is touching the brake pedal bracket. Vibration of the harness may cause interruption
in the SWR signal.
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, do not continue with this procedure. Refer to normal diagnosis in the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09.
2. Repair any chafing that may have occurred.
3. Move the harness towards the driver's side of the vehicle and tuck in front of the 14401 harness
above the steering column. Use a tie strap to secure in place.
4. Replace the SWR sensor following WSM, Section 206-09.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082008A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor, Includes Time To Reposition Harness,
Check DTCs, Repair Wires If Required, And Calibrate New Sensor. (Do Not Use With 12650D,
14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Angle
Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set > Page 684
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14401 12
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Angle
Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996
Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Angle
Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 689
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Angle
Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 690
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC
C1277/C1278 Set
TSB 08-20-8
10/13/08
STEERING WHEEL ANGLE CIRCUIT AND/OR SIGNAL FAILURE - C1277-C1278 - BUILT
ON/OR BEFORE 4/10/2008
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 08-10-3 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 4/10/2008 may
exhibit a traction control light (TCL) on with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1277 and/or C1278
(steering wheel angle 1 and 2 circuit failure and/or signal faulted).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check to see if the steering wheel rotation (SWR) sensor wiring near the connector has come in
contact with or is touching the brake pedal bracket. Vibration of the harness may cause interruption
in the SWR signal.
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, do not continue with this procedure. Refer to normal diagnosis in the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09.
2. Repair any chafing that may have occurred.
3. Move the harness towards the driver's side of the vehicle and tuck in front of the 14401 harness
above the steering column. Use a tie strap to secure in place.
4. Replace the SWR sensor following WSM, Section 206-09.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082008A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor, Includes Time To Reposition Harness,
Check DTCs, Repair Wires If Required, And Calibrate New Sensor. (Do Not Use With 12650D,
14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set > Page 696
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14401 12
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon
ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 701
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 702
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 703
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and
the steering wheel rotation sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.)
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 707
C2361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 708
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair
Stability/Traction Control Switch - Expedition
Stability/Traction Control Switch - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower instrument cluster center finish panel. 2. Remove the upper instrument cluster
center finish panel.
^ Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. Depress the 4 tabs and remove the traction control switch assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 709
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 08-14-2 >
Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 08-14-2 >
Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 718
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 08-14-2 >
Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 719
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 07-25-6 >
Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation
TSB 07-25-6
12/24/07
ABS LIGHT ON - VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 2/15/2007
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 02/15/2007 may experience an
ABS light on and the base brake system continuing to function normally. This may be due to
corrosion in the connector of the rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition as it may be necessary to
replace the rear wheel speed sensor and the female side of the connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics. If the diagnostics lead to replacement of the
rear wheel speed sensor, follow these steps to prevent water leaking into the connector.
1. Disconnect the rear wheel speed sensor connector.
2. Inspect the female terminals, on the harness side of the connector (C440 and C426).
3. If corrosion or evidence of water damage is present, replace the connector with wiring pigtail kit
and follow the instruction sheet which is included.
4. Replace rear wheel speed sensor. Refer to WSM, Section 206-09.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072506A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: One Side (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
072506B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 2.4 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: Both Sides (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 07-25-6 >
Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation > Page 724
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C204 95
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon
ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 730
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 731
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-25-6 > Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake
Operation
TSB 07-25-6
12/24/07
ABS LIGHT ON - VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 2/15/2007
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 02/15/2007 may experience an
ABS light on and the base brake system continuing to function normally. This may be due to
corrosion in the connector of the rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition as it may be necessary to
replace the rear wheel speed sensor and the female side of the connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics. If the diagnostics lead to replacement of the
rear wheel speed sensor, follow these steps to prevent water leaking into the connector.
1. Disconnect the rear wheel speed sensor connector.
2. Inspect the female terminals, on the harness side of the connector (C440 and C426).
3. If corrosion or evidence of water damage is present, replace the connector with wiring pigtail kit
and follow the instruction sheet which is included.
4. Replace rear wheel speed sensor. Refer to WSM, Section 206-09.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072506A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: One Side (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
072506B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 2.4 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: Both Sides (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-25-6 > Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation > Page 736
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C204 95
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left/Right Front
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left/Right Front > Page 739
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Left/Right Rear
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left/Right Front > Page 740
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 743
C440
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 744
C160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 745
C426
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the wheel speed sensor
harness retainer bolt and detach the retainers.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the 2 caliper anchor bolts and position the caliper, pads and anchor plate aside. ^
Support the caliper with mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.)
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 748
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake shoes. 2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the
retaining clips. 3. Remove the rear wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul >
08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Yaw Rate Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul >
08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 757
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul >
08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 758
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Yaw Rate Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Yaw Rate Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC
C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Yaw Rate Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 764
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Yaw Rate Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 765
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 766
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the bracket.
^ To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 767
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
FAN SPEED SENSOR (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch With (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The powertrain control
module (PCM) uses the frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop
control of the cooling fan clutch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 776
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 777
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 778
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Locations > Page 783
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control)
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 786
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS) Brake
Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS) BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 793
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the driver air bag module during this procedure.
- Be careful not to allow the speed control switch electrical connector to fall back into the steering
wheel.
1. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the driver air bag module. 3. Remove the 2 screws and the steering wheel controls
bezel. 4. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 798
C103
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 799
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) switch electrical
connector.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
3. Remove the EOP switch.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch,
Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 807
C132
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 808
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the upper radiator sight shield. 2. Detach and disconnect the ambient temperature
sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the ambient air temperature sensor. 4. To install, reverse
the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Blower Motor Switch: Description and Operation
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
The blower motor switch controls blower motor speed by adding or bypassing resistors in the
blower motor resistor in all function selector positions except OFF. The blower motor switch is
mounted to the climate control assembly and can be separately installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 812
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair
BLOWER MOTOR SPEED CONTROL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped). 2. Disconnect the blower motor
speed control electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 blower motor speed control screws. 4. Remove
the blower motor speed control. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
C233
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor > Page 818
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity Sensor
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity
Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 3 lower steering column cover screws and the lower steering column cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the 4 steering column reinforcement bolts and position the steering column
reinforcement aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Remove the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor.
1 Detach the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor from the instrument panel finish panel.
2 Disconnect the aspirator hose.
3 Disconnect the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity Sensor > Page 821
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor. 3. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
View 151-46 (Climate Control System - Manual A/C)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 825
View 151-47 (Climate Control System - EATC)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 826
C2323
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Discharge Air Temperature Sensor
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Evaporator Discharge Air
Temperature Sensor
EVAPORATOR DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The evaporator discharge air temperature sensor communicates the evaporator discharge air
temperature to the electronic manual temperature control (EMTC) module (if equipped) or
electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped).
The PCM maintains evaporator core temperature and prevents icing of the evaporator core, by
disengaging the A/C compressor clutch when the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor
reading falls below acceptable levels, and by engaging the A/C compressor clutch when the
discharge air temperature rises above acceptable levels.
The evaporator discharge air temperature sensor is located on the heater core and evaporator core
housing in the air-stream leaving the evaporator core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Discharge Air Temperature Sensor > Page 829
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Evaporator
Temperature (ACET) Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE (ACET) SENSOR
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance changes the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling, improve defrost/demist
performance, and reduce A/C clutch cycling.
NOTE: These values can vary 15% due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 830
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) EVAPORATOR DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Detach the glove compartment dampener and lower the glove compartment. 2. Disconnect the
evaporator discharge air temperature sensor electrical connector. 3. Carefully pry the evaporator
discharge air temperature sensor probe out of the heater core and evaporator core housing. 4. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Humidity Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 837
C1260
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation A/C Pressure Transducer
A/C PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
The A/C pressure transducer communicates the compressor discharge pressure to the PCM. The
PCM will interrupt A/C compressor operation in the event that the A/C pressure transducer
indicates excessively high system discharge pressures. It is also used to sense low charge
conditions. If the pressure is below a predetermined value for a given ambient temperature, the
PCM will not allow the clutch to engage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 840
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling
Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CYCLING SWITCH
The A/C cycling switch may be wired to either the ACCS or ACPSW PCM input. When the A/C
cycling switch opens, the PCM turns off the A/C clutch. For information on the specific function of
the A/C cycling switch, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning, Climate Control System. Also, refer to
the applicable Vehicle/Diagrams for vehicle specific wiring.
If the ACCS signal is not received by the PCM, the PCM circuit will not allow the A/C to operate.
Some applications do not have a dedicated (separate) input to the PCM indicating that A/C is
requested. This information is received by the PCM through the communication link.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 841
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) High
Pressure Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH
The A/C high pressure switch is used for additional A/C system pressure control. The A/C high
pressure switch is either dual function for multiple speed, relay controlled electric fan applications,
or single function for all others.
For refrigerant containment control, the normally closed high pressure contacts open at a
predetermined A/C pressure. This results in the A/C turning off, preventing the A/C pressure from
rising to a level that would open the A/C high pressure relief valve.
For fan control, the normally open medium pressure contacts close at a predetermined A/C
pressure. This grounds the ACPSW circuit input to the PCM. The PCM then turns on the high
speed fan to help reduce the pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch,
HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 842
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP)
Transducer Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING PRESSURE (ACP) TRANSDUCER SENSOR
A/C Pressure Transducer Sensor Output Voltage
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
The ACP transducer sensor is located in the high pressure (discharge) side of the A/C system. The
ACP transducer sensor provides a voltage signal to the PCM that is proportional to the A/C
pressure. The PCM uses this information for A/C clutch control, fan control and idle speed control.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 846
Solar Sensor: Diagrams
C286
C2360
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel
dimmer switch. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch > Page 852
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch > Page 853
Vehicles with power tilt
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
View 151-39 (LH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 858
View 151-40 (RH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 859
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 860
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 863
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 864
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 865
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 874
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 >
Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 >
Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 879
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 >
Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill
Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 >
Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 885
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 >
Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4
& 7/8 Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 >
Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 890
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 891
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 892
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 893
C433
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 894
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 895
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE AND RESERVOIR
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the key has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 896
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All fuel tanks
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 897
1. Remove the fuel tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the nuts and the fuel pump module cover.
All fuel tanks
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect coupling, the fuel tank
pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump
module quick connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
4. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
5. CAUTION:
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (LH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 901
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
LIGHT SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Using a suitable tool, remove the light sensor from the instrument panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 909
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 910
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 911
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
STOPLAMP SWITCH
Removal
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to
depress the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 N [1-3 lb]), pull rearward on the brake pedal, rotate the
stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the stoplamp switch.
Installation
CAUTION: It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the
installation of the stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the stoplamp
switch.
1. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise. 2. Connect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Console Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Console Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
View 151-39 (LH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 919
View 151-40 (RH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 920
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 921
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 924
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 925
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 926
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 930
C2361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch > Page 936
C2065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Illumination Dimmer Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 939
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 940
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 941
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 945
C205
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 946
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 947
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 948
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP SWITCH
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 949
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Remove the screw and the LH lower instrument panel finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the 3 screws and the steering column finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
All vehicles
3. NOTE: The headlamp switch is removed by releasing the tabs and pushing from behind.
Remove the headlamp switch. Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-17 (Steering Wheel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 953
C217
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 957
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 958
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 959
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 960
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Vehicles with power tilt
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 961
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 967
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 968
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 972
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 973
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 974
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 975
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and the
MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349 > Page 984
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page 990
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 991
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1 > Page 994
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 995
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 996
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
LH camshaft position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the CMP sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1003
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1004
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1005
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the accessory drive belt. 3.
Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C
compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1009
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1010
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1011
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 1015
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All fuel tanks
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 1016
1. Remove the fuel tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the nuts and the fuel pump module cover.
All fuel tanks
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect coupling, the fuel tank
pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump
module quick connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
4. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
5. CAUTION:
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1020
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1021
C435
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1022
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1023
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
106L (28 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1024
106L (28 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 2)
125L (33 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1025
125L (33 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 2)
Removal and Installation
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank.
106 L (28 gal.) fuel tank
2. Disconnect the supply and return fuel tubes quick connect couplings from the fuel filter.
All fuel tanks
3. Remove the fuel tank heat shield retainer(s) and remove the fuel tank heat shield. 4. Disconnect
the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel vapor/grade vent valves quick
connect couplings. 5. Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel
pump module quick connect coupling.
6. NOTE: For the 106 L (28 gal.) fuel tank the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly
and fresh air tube are serviced as an assembly.
Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly with the fresh air tube from the
fuel tank.
125 L (33 gal.) fuel tank
7. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly from the fuel tank.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1026
- Leak test the system. See: Powertrain Management/Emission Control Systems/Evaporative
Emissions System/Testing and Inspection/Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle. See: Powertrain
Management/Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1030
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1031
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1032
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard OBD/cold
weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the intake
manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature information to
the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 >
Page 1038
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1039
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1040
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 1051
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #12
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6R75 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 1052
View 151-10 (Transmission - 6HP26 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 1053
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 1054
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6R75 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 1055
View 151-10 (Transmission - 6HP26 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22
C141
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 1058
C142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 1059
C171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 1060
C172
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1061
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 1064
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the HO2S with penetrating and lock lubricant to aid in removal.
Using the special tool, remove the HO2S. To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply a light coat of nickel anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the HO2S.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 1065
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 1066
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the HO2S with penetrating and lock lubricant to aid in removal.
Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor. To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply a light coat of nickel anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the HO2S.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 1071
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 1075
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1079
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 1082
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1083
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Remove the throttle body (TB).
2. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1088
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1089
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1090
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1091
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1092
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1093
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1094
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1095
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1096
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1097
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1098
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1099
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1100
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1101
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1102
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1103
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1104
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 1109
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low velocity,
the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 1114
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1119
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1120
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1124
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1125
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1126
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1127
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and the
MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 1132
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Locations
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1139
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1140
C4168
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1141
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1142
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the LH rear interior quarter trim panel. 3.
Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the
IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1146
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 1149
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 1150
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Remove the throttle body (TB).
2. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page
1160
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349 > Page 1166
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
1167
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
1 > Page 1170
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1171
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1172
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
LH camshaft position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the CMP sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1176
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1177
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1178
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the accessory drive belt. 3.
Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C
compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - FUNCTIONAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional > Page 1184
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - NON FUNCTIONAL
Removal
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the ignition
lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer. 4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering
column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage. 2. Install
a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 1190
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1191
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1192
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1198
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1199
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1200
Impact Sensor: Locations Safety Canopy Sensor, Driver 2
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1201
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1202
Impact Sensor: Locations Safety Canopy Sensor, Passenger 2
View 151-26 (Right Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1203
View 151-30 (Right Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor
C177
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1206
C539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1207
C631
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1208
C3314
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1209
C3315
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1210
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation
SENSORS
WARNING:
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have deployed.
In addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition. Failure to
follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install a new and correctly position the sensor or any
other damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is
deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a
crash.
For these vehicles, the SRS uses 5 satellite sensors in addition to the RCM. The RCM is mounted
to the center tunnel beneath the console. All vehicles will have one front impact severity sensor
located in the front-center area of the vehicle, behind the grille mounted on the lower radiator
support. The first row impact sensors are located in each of the front doors behind the trim panel,
the second row sensors are located on each C-pillar. The side impact sensors are not
interchangeable between the first and second row. Mounting orientation is critical for correct
operation of all impact sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
FRONT IMPACT SEVERITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system SRS is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged SRS components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the lower radiator support.
1. Depower the system. 2. Disconnect the front impact severity sensor electrical connector.
3. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag front impact severity sensor retaining bolt is
critical for correct system operation.
NOTE:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1213
- Make sure the radiator support and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are clean and
free of foreign material.
- Note position of the locator tab on the front impact severity sensor for installation.
Remove the bolt and front impact severity sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1214
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - C-PILLAR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag SRS is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting bracket and wiring pigtail for
deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other damaged SRS components
whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1215
procedure again.
- RH side shown, LH similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the rear door scuff plate. 3. Detach the rear door weatherstrip.
4. NOTE: Make sure the second row safety belt retractor belt webbing is not twisted prior to
installation.
Remove the bolt and second row safety belt retractor anchor. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Position aside the quarter trim panel.
- Pull out on the quarter trim panel at the C-pillar to release the retaining clips to access the C-pillar
side impact sensor.
6. WARNING: The tightening torque of the side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for correct
system operation.
NOTE: Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tab for installation.
- Make sure the C-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
Remove the side impact sensor bolt. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
7. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the side impact sensor. 8. To install, reverse the
removal procedure. 9. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1216
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag SRS is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting bracket and wiring pigtail for
deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other damaged SRS components
whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- Avoid applying corrosion protection to any safety, mechanical and electrical parts, electric motors,
speakers, door locks and drain holes.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Driver side shown, passenger similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the front interior door trim panel on the side with the affected
side impact sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 1217
3. Separate the weathershield from the door enough to access the side impact sensor. 4.
Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
5. WARNING: The tightening torque of the side impact sensor retaining screws is critical for correct
system operation.
NOTE: Make sure the side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign material.
- Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tab for installation.
Remove the 2 screws and side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger > Page 1222
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver
C3065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver > Page 1225
C3066
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1226
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE SWITCHES
As part of the supplemental restraint system (SRS), the driver and front outboard passenger safety
belt buckles are equipped with safety belt buckle switches.The safety belt buckle switches indicate
to the restraints control module (RCM) Whether the safety belts are connected or
disconnected.The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver and passenger air bag modules.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Tower Position
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the outboard side of the driver
seat track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver
seat position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Power seat track seat position sensor shown, manual seat track position sensor similar.
1. Raise the driver seat and then position it to the rear of the track. 2. Depower the system. 3.
Remove the seat position sensor and bracket bolt. 4. Unhook the seat position sensor and bracket
from the seat track cross brace. 5. Disconnect the seat position sensor electrical connector and
remove the seat position sensor and bracket. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7.
Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1236
C356
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - FUNCTIONAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional > Page
1243
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - NON FUNCTIONAL
Removal
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the ignition
lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer. 4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering
column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage. 2. Install
a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 1250
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1254
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Telescoping Wheel Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
C2250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Tilt Wheel Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
C2250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
LH Side
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
1265
RH Side
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the senor harness from the
sensor bracket. 3. Disconnect the sensor electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the sensor arm from
the ball stud on the lower control arm. 5. Remove and discard the 2 sensor bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensor assemblies cannot be used on opposite sides of the
vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the LH and RH height sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1269
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1274
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1277
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1278
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1279
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1280
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in the following sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 in) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1281
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear. ^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1282
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1289
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1290
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1291
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1292
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1293
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1294
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1295
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1296
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1297
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1298
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1299
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1300
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1301
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1302
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1303
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1304
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
1305
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1306
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1311
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1312
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1313
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1314
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1315
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1316
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1317
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1318
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1319
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1320
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1321
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1322
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1323
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1324
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1325
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1326
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 1327
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1332
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1333
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1334
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1335
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1336
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1337
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1338
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1339
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1340
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1341
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1342
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1343
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1344
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1345
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1346
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1347
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1348
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1354
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1355
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1356
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1357
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1358
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1359
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1360
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1361
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1362
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1363
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1364
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1365
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1366
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1367
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1368
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1369
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1370
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1371
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1372
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Control
(TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (TC) switch is not replaceable. If a new TC switch is required,
install a new transmission selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Control
(TC) Switch - Column Shift > Page 1375
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (+/-) switch is not serviced. If a new switch is required, install a
new selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1380
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1381
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1382
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1383
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1384
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1385
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1386
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1387
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1388
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1389
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1390
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1391
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1392
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1393
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1394
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1395
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 1396
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1401
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1402
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1403
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1404
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1405
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1406
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1407
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1408
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1409
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1410
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1411
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1412
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1413
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1414
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1415
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1416
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 1417
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1422
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1423
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1424
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1425
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1426
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1427
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1428
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1429
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1430
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1431
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1432
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1433
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1434
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1435
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1436
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1437
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1438
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1443
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Diagrams
C284
C2071
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1449
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1450
View 151-39 (LH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1451
View 151-40 (RH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
C504A
C504B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1454
C535A
C535B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1455
C701
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1456
C801
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1457
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
C624
C648
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1460
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1461
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1462
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1463
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switches - Left Rear and Right Rear
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 1464
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1465
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
WINDOW CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LF shown, all others similar.
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. Unlock the tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel. 3. To install,
reverse removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1470
C138
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1474
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 1477
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 1478
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 1479
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 1480
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1481
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Vehicles with power tilt
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1482
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1486
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 1489
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 1490
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 1491
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 1492
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1493
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Vehicles with power tilt
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1494
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications
Part 1 Of 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1500
Part 2 Of 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1501
Alignment: Specifications Ride Height
Part 1 Of 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1502
Part 2 Of 3
Part 3 Of 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1503
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1504
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1505
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1506
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1507
Alignment: Specifications
Part 1 Of 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1508
Part 2 Of 2
Part 1 Of 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1509
Part 2 Of 3
Part 3 Of 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1510
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1511
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1512
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
General Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1513
General Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment Specifications >
Page 1514
General Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1515
Alignment: Description and Operation
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Camber
Negative and Positive Camber
Camber is the vertical tilt of the wheel when viewed from the front. Camber can be positive or
negative and has a direct affect on tire wear.
Caster
Caster
Caster is the deviation from vertical of an imaginary line drawn through the ball joints when viewed
from the side. The caster specifications will give the vehicle the best directional stability
characteristics when loaded and driven. The caster setting does not affect tire wear.
Toe
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1516
Positive Toe (Toe In)
Negative Toe (Toe Out)
The vehicle toe setting: ^
affects tire wear and directional stability.
^ must be checked after adding aftermarket equipment, such as a snowplow.
Ride Height
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim height prior to measuring the vehicle ride height.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1517
Front Ride Height Measurement
Rear Ride Height Measurement
Wander
Wander is the tendency of the vehicle to require frequent, random left and right steering wheel
corrections to maintain a straight path down a level road.
Shimmy
Shimmy, as observed by the driver, is large, consistent, rotational oscillations of the steering wheel
resulting from large, side-to-side (lateral) tire/wheel movements.
Shimmy is usually experienced near 64 km/h (40 mph), and can begin or be amplified when the tire
contacts pot holes or irregularities in the road surface.
Nibble
Sometimes confused with shimmy, nibble is a condition resulting from tire interaction with various
road surfaces or tire imbalance. This condition is observed by the driver as small rotational
oscillations of the steering wheel.
Poor Returnability/Sticky Steering
Poor returnability and sticky steering is used to describe the poor return of the steering wheel to
center after a turn or when the steering correction is completed.
Drift/Pull
Pull is a tugging sensation, felt by the hands on the steering wheel, that must be overcome to keep
the vehicle going straight.
Drift describes what a vehicle with this condition does with hands off the steering wheel. ^
A vehicle-related drift/pull, on a flat road, will cause a consistent deviation from the straight-ahead
path and require constant steering input in the opposite direction to counteract the effect.
^ Drift/pull may be induced by conditions external to the vehicle (such as wind or road camber).
Poor Groove Feel
Poor groove feel is characterized by little or no buildup of turning effort felt in the steering wheel as
the wheel is rocked slowly left and right within very small turns around center or straight-ahead
(under 20 degrees of steering wheel turn). Efforts may be said to be "flat on center." ^
Under 20 degrees of turn, most of the turning effort that builds up comes from the mesh of gear
teeth in the steering gear. In this range, the steering wheel is not yet turned enough to feel the
effort from the self-aligning forces at the road wheel or tire patch.
^ In the diagnosis of a steering or alignment concern, it is important to understand the difference
between wander and poor groove feel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment-Front
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber and Caster Adjustment-Front
Camber and Caster Adjustment-Front
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the front caster and
camber.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the caster and camber values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Remove and discard the lower arm front and rear nuts and bolts.
3. NOTE: New lower arm front and rear bolts must be installed with cam bolt kit (3B236 for the front
and rear bushing), to allow for adjustment of
the arm in the frame slot. The vehicle should be supported by the frame to ease movement of the
lower arm in the slot.
Install the cam bolt kit and loosely install the nut.
4. To adjust the caster and camber, refer to the following chart.
^ Adjustments that require moving the front and the rear of the lower arm should be made equally.
5. NOTE: The lower arm front and rear bolts must be tightened with the weight of the vehicle
resting on the wheel and tire assembles.
While holding the cam bolt, tighten the nut to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the front toe.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment-Front > Page 1520
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Front
Toe Adjustment - Front
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the front toe.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the front toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Start the engine and center the steering wheel. 3. Turn the engine off and, using a suitable
steering wheel holding device, lock the steering wheel in the straight-ahead position. 4. Remove
the steering gear bellows clamp(s).
5. Loosen the tie-rod end jam nut(s).
6. NOTE: Do not allow the steering gear bellows to twist while rotating the tie rod.
Rotate the tie rod(s) to achieve the desired toe setting.!
7. CAUTION: Make sure to hold the tie-rod end stationary while tightening the jam nut or damage
to the boot can occur.
NOTE: Make sure that the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the jam nuts.
Tighten the tie-rod end jam nut(s) to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment-Front > Page 1521
8. Install the steering gear bellows clamp(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment-Front > Page 1522
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Rear
Toe Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
toe.
NOTE: Before carrying out a toe adjustment, check the tires for the correct pressure. Inspect the
tires for incorrect wear or damage. Inspect the suspension for wear or damage.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear toe.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the rear toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Loosen the toe link cam bolt nut(s).
3. Rotate the toe link cam bolt(s) until the toe setting is within specification.
4. NOTE: Make sure the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the cam nut(s).
Tighten the toe link cam bolt nut(s) to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
5. Recheck the rear toe setting, adjust as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment-Front > Page 1523
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment - Rear
Camber Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
camber or toe.
NOTE: Before carrying out a camber adjustment, check the tires for the correct pressure. Inspect
the tires for incorrect wear or damage. Inspect the suspension for wear or damage.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear camber.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the rear camber value is not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Remove the upper arm-to-frame bolt and the camber set shim.
^ Discard the camber set shim.
^ Install and snug the upper arm-to frame bolt.
3. Position the upper arm-to-frame bolt in the upper arm-to-frame slot until the camber setting is
within specification.
4. NOTE: Do not allow the upper arm to move and change the camber adjustment setting when
tightening the bolt.
Tighten the upper arm-to-frame bolt to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
5. Recheck the camber setting, adjust as necessary. 6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear
toe.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and Caster
Adjustment-Front > Page 1524
Alignment: Service and Repair Ride Height Adjustments (Vehicle Dynamic Suspension)
Ride Height Adjustments
Special Tool(s)
CAUTION: The suspension height D dimensions are for reference only. The vehicle attitude must
be controlled by the correct dimensions to prevent vehicle damage.
NOTE: If one or both height sensors are installed new, both height sensors must be calibrated.
NOTE: Incorrect air suspension ride height D dimension can be caused by an air suspension
system that is incorrectly set.
NOTE: The air suspension module has a preprogrammed trim height.
1. NOTE: The vehicle must be on a level surface, such as a drive on alignment hoist.
Position the vehicle on a level surface.
2. Using the vehicle message center, verify that the air suspension is in the ON mode. 3. Using the
scan tool, run the accurate trim test. 4. Measure the ride height D dimension. 5. If ride height
dimension D is not within specification, use the scan tool to vent or fill the air suspension to the
correct dimension.
6. NOTE: The air suspension height sensor sends a signal to the air suspension module. The
output ranges from approximately 4.5 volts at minimum
height (when the vehicle is low or in full jounce) to 0.5 volt at maximum height (when the vehicle is
in high or in full rebound).
Using the scan tool, monitor the 2 suspension height sensors voltage parameter identifications
(PIDs).
7. Using the scan tool, save the vehicle's trim height for both sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
Key on, engine off.................................................................................................................................
.............................................240-310 kPa (35-45 psi) Engine running.................................................
..................................................................................................................................193-310 kPa
(28-45 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information >
Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 695 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air
cleaner cover.
- To install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 4. Release the retaining clips
and position the air cleaner cover aside. 5. Remove the air cleaner element.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1536
Installation
1. CAUTION: The air cleaner element must be fully seated into the air cleaner housing. Failure to
do so will result in unusual engine noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing a fire hazard. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the Schrader valve cap and attach the pressure gauge.
3. NOTE: Open manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from the
fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the pressure gauge and relieve the fuel pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1544
Firing Order: Locations
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Number One
Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on
Steady Cruise
Spark Plug: Customer Interest Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
TSB 07-24-8
12/10/07
ENGINE MISFIRE DURING CRUISE WITH OR WITHOUT DTCS (MEXICO ONLY)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition, F-150, F-250
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LI, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Mark LT, F-150 and F-250 vehicles equipped with
a 5.4 3V engines may exhibit engine misfire during cruise, rough run, hesitation, buck jerk, with or
without diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner to clean engine combustion system.
a. Disconnect canister purge line from the intake manifold.
b. Attach a vacuum line to the purge port.
c. At hot engine idle, allow the engine to ingest about a 1/2 to 2/3 of a can of Motorcraft(R)
Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Use caution not to ingest too quickly due to potential hydro-lock
issues. Read the entire label on the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Shake the can well
before using and make sure to use at room temperature.
d. Shut the engine off and allow it to soak for one hour.
e. Start engine, allow the engine to ingest the remainder of the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up
Cleaner.
f. Reconnect canister purge vacuum line.
g. Cycle engine between idle and 2500 RPM for about 5 minutes.
2. Inspect the spark plugs for abnormal fouling.
3. Replace fouled spark plugs.
4. Re-gap the spark plug to .035" (0.9 mm).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072408A 2007-2008 1.9 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator/F-150/F-250/Mark LT 5.4L 3V: Check DTCs,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on
Steady Cruise > Page 1557
Clean Combustion System, Remove Spark Plugs Inspect And, Replace As Necessary (Do Not Use
With 12650D, 12405A, 1 2650D64)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1563
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1564
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1565
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1566
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1567
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1568
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1569
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1570
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1571
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1572
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition
System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1573
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 >
Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
TSB 07-24-8
12/10/07
ENGINE MISFIRE DURING CRUISE WITH OR WITHOUT DTCS (MEXICO ONLY)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition, F-150, F-250
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LI, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Mark LT, F-150 and F-250 vehicles equipped with
a 5.4 3V engines may exhibit engine misfire during cruise, rough run, hesitation, buck jerk, with or
without diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner to clean engine combustion system.
a. Disconnect canister purge line from the intake manifold.
b. Attach a vacuum line to the purge port.
c. At hot engine idle, allow the engine to ingest about a 1/2 to 2/3 of a can of Motorcraft(R)
Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Use caution not to ingest too quickly due to potential hydro-lock
issues. Read the entire label on the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Shake the can well
before using and make sure to use at room temperature.
d. Shut the engine off and allow it to soak for one hour.
e. Start engine, allow the engine to ingest the remainder of the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up
Cleaner.
f. Reconnect canister purge vacuum line.
g. Cycle engine between idle and 2500 RPM for about 5 minutes.
2. Inspect the spark plugs for abnormal fouling.
3. Replace fouled spark plugs.
4. Re-gap the spark plug to .035" (0.9 mm).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072408A 2007-2008 1.9 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator/F-150/F-250/Mark LT 5.4L 3V: Check DTCs,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 >
Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise > Page 1578
Clean Combustion System, Remove Spark Plugs Inspect And, Replace As Necessary (Do Not Use
With 12650D, 12405A, 1 2650D64)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1584
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1585
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1586
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1587
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1588
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1589
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1590
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1591
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1592
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1593
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System
- Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 1594
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1595
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1596
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark plug ...........................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... PZT-2F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1597
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
^ Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
^ Clean the spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
^ Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
^ Correct the oil leak concern.
^ Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
^
Clean the spark plug.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
^ Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1598
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a Heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. ^
Install a new spark plug.
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by a white or light gray spots and with bluish-burnt appearance
of electrodes. This is caused by engine
overheating, wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low
fuel pump pressure or incorrect ignition timing. ^
Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
^ Clean the spark plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1599
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Engine Ignition - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1600
Engine Ignition - LH
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug.
2. CAUTION:
- Do not remove the spark plugs when the engine is hot or cold soaked. Spark plug thread or
cylinder head damage can occur. Make sure the engine is warm (hand touch after cooling down)
prior to spark plug removal.
- Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur to the
cylinder head or spark plug.
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before removing the
spark plugs.
- If an original spark plug is used, make sure it is installed in the same cylinder from which it was
taken. New spark plugs can be used in any cylinder.
Remove the spark plugs. To install, tighten to 34 Nm (25 lb-ft).
3. Inspect the spark plugs. Install new spark plugs as necessary. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1604
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test - Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty. 2. If compression does not
improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly. 3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low
compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does not increase compression, the head
gasket may be
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1605
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
This engine is equipped with hydraulic lash adjusters. No adjustment is required.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Drive Belt: > 09-9-7 > May > 09 > Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
Drive Belt: Customer Interest Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
TSB 09-9-7
05/18/09
COLD START FEAD HOOT - WHISTLE NOISE
FORD: 2007-2008 Mustang, Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-150
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LT, Navigator
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 8-4-2 to remove the production build date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 F-150, Mustang vehicles equipped with a 4.6L and 5.4L engine;
2007-2008 Mark LT, Expedition, Navigator vehicles equipped with a 5.4L engine; Explorer,
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac vehicles with 4.6L engine may exhibit a front end accessory drive
(FEAD) related high-pitched metallic whistle/hoot noise after a cold soak in ambient temperatures
below 40 °F (4.4 °C). This noise may be caused by the grooved nylon FEAD idler pulley.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
FEAD IDLER PULLEY NOISE MAY BE MOST APPARENT AT OR NEAR COLD ENGINE IDLE
SPEEDS (APPROXIMATELY 1200 RPM). NOISE DURATION IS LESS THAN 10 MINUTES
AFTER STARTUP AND WILL BE ELIMINATED WITH FEAD BELT REMOVED.
1. Replace the nylon FEAD idler pulley, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 303-05.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
090907A 2007-2008 F-150/Mark LT 0.3 Hr.
4.6L/5.4L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do
Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine
Belt (Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Explorer/Mountaineer/
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Drive Belt: > 09-9-7 > May > 09 > Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start > Page 1617
Sport Trac 4.6L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt
(Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 Mustang 4.6L: 0.3 Hr.
Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do Not Use With
8678A, 8620F)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6C348 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 09-9-7 > May > 09 > Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
Drive Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
TSB 09-9-7
05/18/09
COLD START FEAD HOOT - WHISTLE NOISE
FORD: 2007-2008 Mustang, Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-150
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LT, Navigator
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 8-4-2 to remove the production build date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 F-150, Mustang vehicles equipped with a 4.6L and 5.4L engine;
2007-2008 Mark LT, Expedition, Navigator vehicles equipped with a 5.4L engine; Explorer,
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac vehicles with 4.6L engine may exhibit a front end accessory drive
(FEAD) related high-pitched metallic whistle/hoot noise after a cold soak in ambient temperatures
below 40 °F (4.4 °C). This noise may be caused by the grooved nylon FEAD idler pulley.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
FEAD IDLER PULLEY NOISE MAY BE MOST APPARENT AT OR NEAR COLD ENGINE IDLE
SPEEDS (APPROXIMATELY 1200 RPM). NOISE DURATION IS LESS THAN 10 MINUTES
AFTER STARTUP AND WILL BE ELIMINATED WITH FEAD BELT REMOVED.
1. Replace the nylon FEAD idler pulley, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 303-05.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
090907A 2007-2008 F-150/Mark LT 0.3 Hr.
4.6L/5.4L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do
Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine
Belt (Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Explorer/Mountaineer/
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 09-9-7 > May > 09 > Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start > Page 1623
Sport Trac 4.6L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt
(Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 Mustang 4.6L: 0.3 Hr.
Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do Not Use With
8678A, 8620F)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6C348 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1624
Drive Belt: Locations
Accessory Drive
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1625
Drive Belt: Diagrams
Accessory Drive
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1626
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
Accessory Drive
The accessory drive system:
- has a single serpentine drive belt (6 ribs). - has 3 idler pulleys. - has an automatic belt tensioner. is not adjustable.
The accessory drive system provides power to operate components which power other systems.
These could include components such as the generator, power steering pump, and A/C
compressor. Each of these components is equipped with a pulley which is driven by the accessory
drive belt. The accessory drive belt is driven by the engine crankshaft pulley. One or more idler
pulleys may be provided to facilitate belt routing and alignment. The automatic belt tensioner
maintains correct belt tension and compensates for component wear and changes in system load.
System load changes can be caused by the A/C compressor clutch engaging and disengaging, or
demand changes on other systems powered by the accessory drive belt. To maintain correct
operation of this stem, it is critical that the correct length drive belt be installed. The pulleys must
also be correctly aligned and kept clean.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview
Drive Belt: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys be
lubricated as potential damage to the belt material and tensioner damping mechanism will occur.
Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
1. Verify the customer concern by operating the system. 2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of
mechanical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
Visual Inspection Chart
3. Eliminate all other non-belt related noises that could cause belt misdiagnosis, such as A/C
compressor engagement chirp, power steering
cavitations at low temperatures, variable camshaft timing (VCT) tick or generator whine.
4. If a concern is found, correct the condition before proceeding to the next step.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Drive Belt With Cracks Across Ribs
5. NOTE: Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be considered
acceptable. If damage exceeds the acceptable limit or
any chunks are found to be missing from the ribs, a new belt must be installed.
Check the belt for cracks. Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be
considered acceptable. If cracks exceed this standard, install a new belt.
6. The condition of the V-ribbed drive belt should be compared against the illustration and
appropriate action taken.
1 Small scattered deposits of rubber material. This is not a concern, therefore, installation of a new
belt is not required.
2 Longer deposit areas building up to 50% of the rib height. This is not considered a concern but it
can result in excessive noise. If noise is apparent, install a new belt.
3 Heavy deposits building up along the grooves resulting in a possible noise and belt stability
concern. If heavy deposits are apparent, install a new belt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1629
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Piling
7. There should be no chunks missing from the belt ribs. If the belt shows any evidence of this,
install a new accessory drive belt.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Chunks of Rib Missing
8. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom and GO to Symptom Chart. See:
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1630
Drive Belt: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1631
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1632
Drive Belt: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
Drive belt chirp occurs due to pulley misalignment or excessive pulley runout. It can be the result of
a damaged or incorrectly aligned grooved pulley.
To correct, determine the area where the noise comes from. Check each of the pulleys in that area
with a straightedge to the crankshaft pulley. Look for accessory pulleys out of position in the fore/aft
direction or at an angle to the straightedge.
CAUTION: Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
Drive belt squeal may be an intermittent or constant noise that occurs when the drive belt slips on
an accessory pulley under certain conditions.
A short intermittent squeal may occur during engine start-up and shut down or during very rapid
engine acceleration and decelerations, such as: ^
wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts or 2-3 and 3-4 back out shifts on automatic transmissions.
^ wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts and any combination of rapid downshifting on manual
transmissions.
These special short-term transient events are expected, and are due to the higher system inertias
required to meet the electrical and cooling demands on today's vehicle systems. Constant or
reoccurring drive belt squeal can occur: ^
if the A/C discharge pressure goes above specifications: the A/C system is overcharged.
- the A/C condenser core airflow is blocked.
^ if the A/C off equalized pressure (the common discharged and suction pressure that occurs after
several minutes) exceeds specifications.
^ if any of the accessories are damaged or have a worn or damaged bearing. All accessories
should be rotatable by hand in the unloaded condition. If not, inspect the accessory.
^ if there is evidence of fluid contamination on the accessory drive belt. When the drive belt has
been exposed to fluid contamination during vehicle operation, such as leaks from the power
steering system, A/C system or cooling system, clean all pulleys with soap and water, rinse with
clean water and install a new accessory drive belt. If the drive belt has been exposed to fluids in a
localized area during routine vehicle service, such as replacement of hoses or fluids, the drive belt
and pulleys should be washed with soap and water immediately (prior to starting the engine), and
rinsed with clean water.
^ if the accessory drive belt is too long. A drive belt that is too long will allow the accessory drive
belt tensioner arm to go all the way to the arm travel stop under certain load conditions, which will
release tension to the drive belt. If the accessory drive belt tensioner indicator is outside the normal
installation wear range window, install a new accessory drive belt.
^ NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner arm should rotate freely without binding.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if the drive belt tensioner is worn or damaged.
Drive Belt - Incorrect Installation
Drive Belt - Incorrect Installation
CAUTION: Incorrect accessory drive belt installation will cause excessive drive belt wear and can
cause the drive belt to come off the pulleys.
Non-standard accessory drive belts can track differently or incorrectly. If an accessory drive belt
tracks incorrectly, install a new accessory drive belt to avoid performance failure or loss of the drive
belt.
Incorrect Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection
and Diagnostic Overview > Page 1633
Correct Installation
With the engine running, check accessory drive belt tracking on all pulleys. If the edge of the
accessory drive belt rides beyond the edge of the pulleys, noise and premature wear will occur.
Make sure the accessory drive belt rides correctly on the pulley. If an accessory drive belt tracking
condition exists: ^
Visually check the accessory drive belt tensioner for damage, especially the mounting pad surface.
If the accessory drive belt tensioner is not installed correctly, the mounting surface pad will be out
of position. This will result in chirp and squeal noises.
^ With the engine running, visually observe the grooves in the pulleys (not the pulley flanges or the
pulley forward faces) for excessive wobble. Install new components as necessary.
^ Check all accessories, mounting brackets and the accessory drive belt tensioner for any
interference that would prevent the component from mounting correctly. Correct any interference
condition and recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
^ Tighten all accessories, mounting brackets and accessory drive belt tensioner retaining hardware
to specification. Recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
The only mechanical check that needs to be made is a check for tensioner stick, grab or bind. 1.
With the engine off, check routing of the accessory drive belt.
2. NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner spring is very strong and requires substantial force to
release.
Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, release the tension
on the belt and detach the accessory drive belt in the area of the tensioner.
3. Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, move the
tensioner from its relaxed position, through its full stroke
and back to the relaxed position to make sure there is no stick, grab or bind, and to make sure that
there is tension on the tensioner spring.
4. Rotate the tensioner pulley by hand and check for a binding, contaminated or seized condition.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if
necessary.
5. Inspect the area surrounding the accessory drive belt tensioner for oil leaks or contamination
and repair any leaks. Install a new accessory drive
belt tensioner as necessary.
6. If the accessory drive belt tensioner meets the above criteria, proceed to testing the tensioner
dynamically. If the accessory drive belt tensioner
does not meet the above criteria, install a new tensioner.
Belt Tensioner - Dynamics
Belt Tensioner - Dynamics
The accessory drive belt tensioner can be checked dynamically as follows: 1. With the engine
running, observe the accessory drive belt tensioner movement. The accessory drive tensioner
should move (respond) when the air
conditioning clutch cycles (if equipped), or when the engine is accelerated rapidly. If the accessory
drive belt tensioner movement is excessive without air conditioning clutch cycling or engine
acceleration, check belt rideout. Excessive belt rideout (uneven depth of grooves in the belt) can
cause excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement. Check rideout condition by installing a
new belt. If excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement still exists, install a new accessory
drive belt tensioner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1634
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
Accessory Drive
Removal
1. Rotate the drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the drive belt.
Installation
1. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air
cleaner cover.
- To install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 4. Release the retaining clips
and position the air cleaner cover aside. 5. Remove the air cleaner element.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 1640
Installation
1. CAUTION: The air cleaner element must be fully seated into the air cleaner housing. Failure to
do so will result in unusual engine noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cabin Air Filter: Service and Repair
NOTE: The air distribution system of this vehicle cannot be equipped with a cabin air filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair
DUST SEPARATOR
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 1647
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 1648
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: The evaporative emission canister vent solenoid and dust separator are an assembly.
This assembly is removed with the evaporative
emission canister vent solenoid.
Refer to Evaporative Emission Canister Vent Solenoid. See: Powertrain Management/Emission
Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Leak Detection Valve/Service and Repair
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair
Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
Material
Removal
CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified, can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the fluid fill plug fluid level
indicator assembly located on the passenger side front portion of the transmission case. Removal
of the plug
will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in the transmission. This will aid in allowing the
fluid pan to be easily removed when the bolts are removed.
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the fluid to drain.
4. Remove the fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
1652
5. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
6. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan and magnet.
Installation
NOTE: If the transmission is being repaired for a contamination-related failure, install a new
transmission fluid filter and seal assembly. The fluid filter may be reused if no excessive
contamination is indicated.
1. Inspect the transmission case for the transmission fluid filter seal. If the seal is in the case,
carefully remove the seal without scratching the case.
2. Make sure that the seal is on the transmission fluid filter and lubricate the seal with clean
automatic transmission fluid.
3. NOTE: The fluid filter may be reused if no excessive contamination is indicated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
1653
Install a new transmission fluid filter.
4. Position the magnet in the transmission fluid pan.
5. NOTE: The fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install a new transmission fluid pan gasket if required.
6. Install the fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 lb-ft).
7. Using the refill procedure, fill and check the transmission fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and
Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing a fire hazard. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the Schrader valve cap and attach the pressure gauge.
3. NOTE: Open manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from the
fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the pressure gauge and relieve the fuel pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Refrigerant Filter: Customer Interest A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 1666
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 1667
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 1668
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Refrigerant Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 1674
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 1675
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 1676
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: Customer Interest A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 1686
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 1687
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
1693
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
1694
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Heater Hose: Procedures
HEATER HOSE COUPLING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect
1. WARNING: The engine must be off, fully cool and the cooling system fully depressurized before
attempting to disconnect any heater
water hoses. Failure to comply with this warning can result in serious injury or burns from hot liquid
escaping out of the engine cooling system.
Depressurize the engine cooling system.
2. Push the heater water hose toward the tube to fully expose the locking tabs.
3. NOTE: When compressing the white coupling retainer, the Heater Hose Disconnect Tool must
be perpendicular to and on the highest point of the
coupling.
Push the special tool over the coupling retainer windows to compress the retainer locking tabs.
4. NOTE: A slight twisting motion while pulling on the heater water hose may be necessary to
assist in the removal.
Pull the heater water hose away from the heater core tube.
5. Plug the heater water hose. 6. Remove the white coupling retainer from the tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1697
7. Spread the retainer tabs apart and slide the retainer off the tube. 8. Discard the retainer.
Connect
1. Clean the tubes and lubricate with MERPOL meeting Ford specification ESE-M99B144-B or
plain water.
2. Install a new coupling retainer, spacer, and lubricated O-ring seals into the quick disconnect
coupling housing.
3. Push the heater water hose with a quick disconnect coupling onto the tube. 4. Make sure the
coupling is fully engaged by lightly pulling on the heater water hose.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1698
Heater Hose: Removal and Replacement
AUXILIARY HEATER OUTLET AND INLET LINE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1699
Part 2
Removal
NOTE:
- The auxiliary heater inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly. The auxiliary
heater inlet line and outlet line are each installed from the factory as one-piece assemblies. The
replacement parts are supplied as separate kits containing multiple-piece lines for ease of
installation.
- The following procedure can be used to remove and install one or both the auxiliary evaporator
inlet and auxiliary evaporator outlet lines. If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed and
installed, cut or disconnect only the desired line at the specified points within the procedure.
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain the engine coolant. 3. Remove the
spare tire. 4. Remove the RH fender splash shield.
5. NOTE: If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the auxiliary heater outlet and/or inlet line front quick disconnect fitting(s).
6. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the front auxiliary line bracket nut and the
front auxiliary line bracket.
7. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
8. Remove the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1700
9. NOTE: If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line rear quick disconnect fitting(s).
10. Remove the muffler. 11. Remove the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts and the spare tire
carrier splash shield. 12. Remove the 3 muffler heat shield bolts and the muffler heat shield. 13.
Remove the 2 exhaust hanger bolts and the exhaust hanger. 14. Remove the RH catalyst
monitoring sensor. 15. Remove the 3 remaining RH catalytic converter heat shield bolts and the
heat shield.
16. Remove the 3 remaining auxiliary line bracket nuts and the line brackets.
17. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary heater line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new line(s).
18. Remove the auxiliary heater line(s) in 3 separate pieces.
Installation
Expedition or Navigator only
1. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line(s) and connect the quick
disconnect fittings.
All vehicles
2. Install the front auxiliary heater line(s) and connect the quick disconnect fittings.
3. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the middle auxiliary heater line(s).
4. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 auxiliary line brackets and nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
5. Tighten the middle auxiliary heater line fittings. 6. Inspect the auxiliary heater lines for correct
installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as needed. 7. Install the RH catalytic converter heat
shield and the 3 catalytic converter heat shield rear bolts. 8. Install the RH catalyst monitoring
sensor. 9. Install the exhaust hanger and the 2 exhaust hanger bolts.
10. Install the muffler heat shield and the 3 muffler heat shield bolts. 11. Install the muffler. 12.
Install the spare tire carrier splash shield and the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts. 13.
Working through the RH fender well opening, Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt. 14. Install the front auxiliary line bracket and the front auxiliary line bracket and nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
15. Install the RH front fender splash shield. 16. Install the RH front wheel.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
17. Install the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 1701
All vehicles
18. Install the spare tire. 19. Fill the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Hose/Line HVAC: Customer Interest A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 1710
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 1711
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 1712
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Hose/Line HVAC: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
1718
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
1719
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
1720
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1721
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation
AUXILIARY A/C - HEATER LINES
The auxiliary lines are secured to the underbody of the vehicle. Each auxiliary line is only available
as a multiple-piece kit for ease of installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
AUXILIARY EVAPORATOR OUTLET AND INLET LINE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1724
Part 2
Removal
NOTE:
- The auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly for
Expedition or Navigator vehicles. The auxiliary evaporator inlet line and outlet line are each
installed from the factory as one-piece assemblies. The replacement parts are supplied as
separate kits containing multiple-piece lines for ease of installation.
- The auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet lines for Expedition EL or Navigator L vehicles are
installed from the factory as a single one-piece assembly including both lines. The replacement
part is supplied as a multiple-piece kit for ease of installation.
- For Expedition or Navigator vehicles, the following procedure can be used to remove and install
one or both the auxiliary evaporator inlet and auxiliary evaporator outlet lines. If only one auxiliary
evaporator line is to be removed and installed, cut or disconnect only the desired line at the
specified points within the procedure. For Expedition EL or Navigator L vehicles, both lines must be
removed.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air conditioning
system except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
All vehicles 1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Recover the refrigerant.
3. NOTE: If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line front fitting nut(s) and disconnect the fitting(s).
Discard the O-ring seals and gasket seals.
4. Remove the spare tire. 5. Remove the RH fender splash shield. 6. Working through the RH
fender well opening, remove the front auxiliary line bracket nut and the front auxiliary line bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1725
7. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
Expedition or Navigator only
8. NOTE: Both A/C fittings must be disconnected even if only one line is to be removed.
Disconnect the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fittings. Discard the O-ring seals.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only 9. Remove the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
10. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the gasket seals.
All vehicles 11. Remove the muffler. 12. Remove the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts and the
spare tire carrier splash shield. 13. Remove the 3 muffler heat shield bolts and the heat shield. 14.
Remove the 2 exhaust hanger bolts and the exhaust hanger. 15. Remove the RH catalyst
monitoring sensor. 16. Remove the 3 remaining RH catalytic converter heat shield bolts and the
heat shield.
17. Remove the 3 remaining auxiliary line bracket nuts and the auxiliary line brackets.
18. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary evaporator line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary evaporator line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new
line(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1726
19. NOTE:
- Expedition EL shown.
- For Expedition EL or Navigator L vehicles, the middle portion of the auxiliary evaporator outlet
and inlet lines can be removed through the RH rear wheel well opening between the body and the
frame.
Remove the auxiliary evaporator line(s) in 3 separate pieces.
Installation
Expedition or Navigator only 1. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) and
connect the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fittings.
- Install new O-ring seals.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only 2. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary evaporator outlet and
inlet line. 3. Connect the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting and install the nut.
- Install new gasket seals.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
All vehicles 4. Install the front portion of the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line(s). 5. Connect
the evaporator outlet and inlet line front fitting(s) and install the nut(s).
- Install new O-ring seals and gasket seals.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the middle auxiliary evaporator line(s).
7. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 auxiliary line brackets and nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1727
8. NOTE: Expedition/Navigator shown, Expedition EL or Navigator L similar.
Tighten the middle auxiliary evaporator line fittings.
9. Inspect the auxiliary evaporator lines for correct installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as
needed.
10. Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield and the 3 rear catalytic converter heat shield bolts.
11. Install the exhaust hanger and the 2 exhaust hanger bolts. 12. Install the muffler heat shield
and the 3 muffler heat shield bolts. 13. Install the RH catalyst monitoring sensor. 14. Install the
muffler. 15. Working through the RH fender well opening, Install the RH catalytic converter heat
shield front bolt. 16. Install the front auxiliary line bracket and the front auxiliary line bracket nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
17. Install the spare tire carrier splash shield and the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts. 18.
Install the RH front fender splash shield. 19. Install the RH front wheel.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only 20. Install the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
All vehicles 21. Install the spare tire. 22. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of
clean PAG oil. 23. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1728
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line
COMPRESSOR TO CONDENSER DISCHARGE LINE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the compressor discharge fitting nut and disconnect the
fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
3. Remove the condenser inlet jumper line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. Remove the compressor-to-condenser discharge line. 5. If removing the condenser inlet jumper
line, remove the RH headlamp assembly. 6. If removing the condenser inlet jumper line, disconnect
the A/C pressure transducer electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 1729
7. If removing the condenser inlet jumper line, remove the condenser inlet fitting bolt and
disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring and gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
8. Remove the condenser inlet jumper line. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals and O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the upper air deflector.
1 Remove the 10 upper air deflector pushpin-type retainers.
2 Remove the air deflector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1734
3. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe. 4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering
return hose from the power steering fluid cooler. 5. Release the power steering return hose from
the cooling fan shroud clips. 6. Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab and rotate the shroud
upward.
7. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt, rotate the clamp plate and disconnect the power
steering return line from the power steering gear. ^
To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
^ Discard the steering line O-ring seals.
9. NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1735
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure
Line
Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1736
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1737
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
NOTE: A new Teflon O-ring seal must be installed any time the power steering line is disconnected
from the power steering pump.
1. Remove the power steering pump pulley. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: A new Teflon O-ring seal must be installed any time the power steering line is
disconnected from the power steering pump.
Disconnect the power steering pressure line-to-power steering pump fitting. ^
Discard the Teflon O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 lb-ft).
4. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-crossmember bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
5. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-engine nut.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 1738
6. NOTE: A new O-ring seal must be installed any time the power steering line is disconnected
from the power steering gear.
Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt, rotate the clamp plate and disconnect the power
steering line. ^
Discard the O-ring seals. ^
To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
7. NOTE: A new O-ring seal must be installed any time the power steering line is disconnected
from the power steering gear.
NOTE: A new Teflon O-ring seal must be installed any time the power steering line is disconnected
from the power steering pump.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Using the special tool, install a new Teflon O-ring on the pressure line-to-pump fitting and pressure
line-to-steering gear.
8. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Motorcraft High Performance DOT 3 Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. PM-1-C Ford Specification ...............................................
.....................................................................................................................................
WSS-M6C62-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
COOLING SYSTEM
BASE RADIATOR
Without aux rear heat ..........................................................................................................................
........................................ 20.6 quarts (19.5 liters) With aux rear heat ................................................
....................................................................................................................... 23.2 quarts (22.0 liters)
HEAVY DUTY TRAILER TOW RADIATOR
Without aux rear heat ..........................................................................................................................
........................................ 21.1 quarts (20.0 liters) With aux rear heat ................................................
....................................................................................................................... 23.8 quarts (22.5 liters)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1747
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE COOLANT
Motorcraft Premium Gold Engine Coolant (yellow-colored)
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. VC-7-B Ford Specification ................................................
................................................................................................................................ WSS-M97B51-A1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid (6R75) ..................................................................................................................
............................................. 11.0 quarts (10.5 liters)
NOTE: Indicates only approximate dry fill capacity. Some applications may vary based on cooler
size and if equipped with an in-tank cooler.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1752
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid Type
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... MERCON SP XT-6-QSP
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Check Fluid Level and Condition
Fluid Level Check
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
NOTE: The transmission fluid temperature must not be allowed to exceed 50°C (122°F) when
checking the fluid level. The fluid temperature should be between 30°C-50°C (86°F-122°F) closer
to 50°C (122°F) when checking the fluid level.
This vehicle is not equipped with a fluid level indicator. An incorrect level may affect the
transmission operation and can result in transmission failure.
Under normal circumstances, the fluid level should not be checked during normal maintenance. If
the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level should be
checked. 1. With the transmission in PARK, the engine at idle (550-750 rpm) and foot pressed on
the brake, move the range selector lever through each gear
and allow engagement of each gear. Place the transmission range selector lever in the PARK
position.
2. With the engine idling (550-750 rpm) in PARK, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the fluid fill plug
located on the side of the transmission case. 4. Partially add fluid until fluid starts to come out. Wait
until the fluid stops or just drips from the hole. 5. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
High Fluid Level
CAUTION: A fluid level that is too high can cause the fluid to become aerated due to the churning
action of the rotating internal parts. This will cause erratic control pressure, foaming, loss of fluid
from the vent tube and possible transmission failure.
If an overfill reading is indicated, drain and refill the transmission.
Low Fluid Level
A low fluid level can result in poor transmission engagement, slipping or failure. This may also
indicate a leak in one of the transmission seals or gaskets.
Adding Fluid
CAUTION: The use of any other type of transmission fluid than specified can result in transmission
failure.
If fluid must be added, add fluid in 0.5 liter (1/2 quart) increments through the fluid fill plug. Do not
overfill the fluid. For fluid type, refer to the specification chart.
Fluid Condition Check
1. Check the fluid level. 2. Remove the fluid fill plug and allow the fluid to drip onto a facial tissue
and examine the stain.
3. NOTE: The transmission fluid could be 2 different colors. The factory fill fluid is amber. The
replacement fluid is red.
Observe the color and the odor. The color under normal circumstances should be dark reddish or
clear, not black or have a burnt odor.
4. If evidence of solid material is found, the transmission fluid pan should be removed for further
inspection. 5. If the stain is a foamy pink color, this may indicate coolant in the transmission. The
engine cooling system should also be inspected at this time. 6. If fluid contamination or
transmission failure is confirmed by the sediment in the bottom of the fluid pan, the transmission
must be disassembled
and completely cleaned. This includes the torque converter and fluid cooler tubes. A new oil-to-air
cooler must be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > 6HP26
Automatic Transmission > Page 1755
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection 6R75 Automatic Transmission
Check Fluid Level and Condition
Fluid Level Check
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be extremely hot
during this procedure.
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period at high highway speeds, in city
traffic, during hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the fluid must cool down to obtain an accurate
reading.
NOTE: If the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level
should be checked.
This transmission is equipped with an internal thermal bypass located in the case. This internal
thermal bypass valve will shut off fluid flowing to the fluid cooler if the fluid temperature falls below
normal operating temperature.
High Fluid Level
CAUTION: fluid level that is too high can cause the fluid to become aerated due to the churning
action of the rotating internal parts. This will cause erratic control pressure, foaming, loss of fluid
from the vent tube and possible transmission failure.
If an overfill reading is indicated, remove any excessive fluid.
Low Fluid Level
A low fluid level can result in poor transmission engagement, slipping or failure. This may also
indicate a leak in one of the transmission seals or gaskets.
Adding Fluid
CAUTION: The use of any other type of transmission fluid than specified can result in transmission
failure.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be extremely hot
during this procedure.
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period at high highway speeds, in city
traffic, during hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the fluid must cool down to obtain an accurate
reading.
Add fluid using the refill procedure.
Fluid Condition Check
1. Check the fluid level. 2. Remove the fluid fill plug and fluid level indicator and allow the fluid to
drip onto a facial tissue and examine the stain. 3. Observe the color and the odor. The color under
normal circumstances should be dark reddish, not black or have a burnt odor. 4. If evidence of solid
material is found, the transmission fluid pan should be removed for further inspection. 5. If the stain
is a foamy pink color, this may indicate coolant in the transmission. The engine cooling system
should also be inspected at this time. 6. If fluid contamination or transmission failure is confirmed
by the sediment in the bottom of the fluid pan, the transmission must be disassembled
and completely cleaned. This includes the torque converter and fluid cooler tubes. new oil-to-air
(OTA) cooler must be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Special Tool(s)
Material
Drain
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the transmission fluid pan and
allow the fluid to drain.
3. Remove the fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1758
4. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan and magnet.
Refill
1. Install the fluid pan gasket.
2. Install the fluid pan and bolts.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
3. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during
this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Remove the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case, near the transmission electrical
connector.
4. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or
transmission failure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1759
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add 4.7 liters (5 quarts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid
fill hole. Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
5. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 6. With the special tool connected, the engine idling (550-750 rpm) in
PARK and the transmission temperature at 30°C-50°C (86°F-122°F), check
and adjust the transmission fluid level.
7. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during
this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid until the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
8. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
6R75 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1760
Special Tool(s)
Material
Drain
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Some fluid leakage may occur when removing the fluid fill plug.
Remove the fluid fill plug fluid level indicator assembly located on the passenger side front portion
of the transmission case. Removal of the plug will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in
the transmission. This will aid in allowing the fluid pan to be easily removed when the bolts are
removed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1761
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the fluid to drain.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 lb-ft).
Transmission Fluid Refill
CAUTION: This procedure contains the air purge steps required to purge air from the cooling
system. This procedure is NOT intended for use with the Transmission Fluid Level Check.
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be extremely hot
during this procedure.
CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified, can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
NOTE: If the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level
should be checked.
NOTE: Here is an overview of the Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill procedure.
^ Adding 3.3L (3.5 qt) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission is an initial fill
enabling you to start the engine.
^ The cold level range shown in the procedure allows the vehicle to be driven.
^ The vehicle should be driven to allow the transmission fluid temperature to reach 85°C-88°C
(185°F-190°F) in order to purge the air from the transmission cooling system.
^ Fill the transmission fluid to the fill range on the fluid level indicator at the normal operating range
80°C-85°C (175°F-185°F).
1. NOTE: The transmission will need 3.3L (3.5 qt) of clean automatic transmission fluid added to
the transmission as an initial fill if:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1762
^ the transmission has been overhauled.
^ a new mechatronic assembly has been installed.
^ the transmission fluid pan or fluid filter have been removed.
Using the special tool, add 3.3L (3.5 qt) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission
through the fluid fill hole.
2. Check the transmission fluid level cold.
1 The vehicle is safe to drive if the transmission fluid is in the cold level range 32°C-43°C
(90°F-110°F).
^ Using the scan tool and the engine running, place the transmission selector lever in each gear
position and hold approximately 5 seconds. Place the transmission selector lever in PARK, with the
engine at idle (600-750 rpm).
3. Separate the fluid level indicator from the fill plug.
4. Wipe the fluid level indicator clean. Reinstall the fluid level indicator only back into the fill plug
hole to check the fluid level. Repeat this until a
consistent reading is established.
5. Add clean transmission fluid to the cold level location as shown in the illustration.
6. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1763
7. While driving the vehicle, use the scan tool to verify that the transmission fluid temperature has
reached a temperature of 88°C (190°F). This will
circulate the transmission fluid through the torque converter and the cooling system, eliminating
any trapped air in the cooling system. ^
With the engine idling (600-750 rpm) in PARK, verify that the transmission fluid temperature is
between 80°C-85°C (175°F-185°F).
8. Remove the fluid fill plug fluid level indicator assembly located on the passenger side front
portion of the transmission case.
9. Separate the fluid level indicator from the fill plug.
10. Wipe the fluid level indicator clean. Reinstall the fluid level indicator only back into the fill plug
hole to check the fluid level. Repeat this until a
consistent reading is established.
11. Using the scan tool verify that the transmission fluid temperature is between 80°C-85°C
(175°F-185°F). The fluid level must be at the upper level
of the crosshatch mark.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1764
12. NOTE: If the transmission fluid is not at the correct level, follow the steps for Adding Additional
Transmission Fluid or Removing Transmission
Fluid in this procedure.
Install the fluid fill plug. ^
Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Adding Additional Transmission Fluid
NOTE: To get an accurate fluid level reading the engine should be idling (600-750 rpm) in PARK.
1. Install the special tool into the fluid fill hole.
2. Fill the special tool with approximately 0.47L (1 pt) of clean automatic transmission fluid.
3. Hang the special tool under the vehicle, upright and close to the transmission.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1765
4. Connect the special tools.
^ Connect the open end of the fluid hose from the special tool onto the special tool from the
transmission case.
5. Apply a maximum of 206.85 kPa (30 psi) to the open end of the vacuum/pressure hose from the
special tool. Fluid will immediately start flowing
out of the special tool into the transmission.
6. NOTE: Do not overfill the transmission. The fluid level must be at the upper level of the
crosshatch mark.
Reinstall the fluid level indicator only back into the fill plug hole to check the fluid level. Repeat this
until a consistent reading is established.
7. Using the scan tool verify that the transmission fluid temperature is between 80°C-85°C
(175°F-185°F). The fluid level must be at the upper level
of the crosshatch mark.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1766
8. NOTE: If the transmission fluid is over full, follow the steps for Removing Transmission Fluid in
this procedure.
Install the fluid fill plug. ^
Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Removing Transmission Fluid
NOTE: To get an accurate fluid level reading the engine should be idling (600-750 rpm) in PARK.
1. If the transmission is overfilled, fluid must be removed to the correct level. Use the special tools
to extract any excessive fluid.
2. Using the scan tool, verify that the transmission fluid temperature is between 80°C-85°C
(175°F-185°F). The fluid level must be at the upper level
of the crosshatch mark. Reinstall the fluid level indicator only back into the fill plug hole to check
the fluid level. Repeat this until a consistent reading is established.
3. Install the fluid fill plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1767
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1768
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Level Check
Transmission Fluid Level Check
Special Tool(s)
Material
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be extremely hot
during this procedure.
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period at high highway speeds, in city
traffic, during hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the fluid must cool down to obtain an accurate
reading.
NOTE: If the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level
should be checked.
NOTE: Do not overfill the transmission. The fluid level must be at the upper level of the crosshatch
mark.
NOTE: If the installation of a new transmission fluid cooler, cooler lines have been carried out the
vehicle must be driven to get the transmission fluid to a temperature of 88°C (190°F) in order to
purge the air from the cooling system.
1. With the engine running, place the transmission selector lever in each gear position and hold
approximately 5 seconds. Place the transmission
selector lever in PARK.
2. With the engine idling (600-750 rpm) in PARK, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the fluid fill plug
fluid level indicator assembly, located on the passenger side front portion of the transmission case.
4. Separate the fluid level indicator from the fill plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1769
5. Wipe the fluid level indicator clean. Reinstall the fluid level indicator only back into the fill plug
hole to check the fluid level.
6. Using the scan tool, verify that the transmission fluid temperature is between 80°C-85°C
(175°F-185°F). Do not overfill the transmission. The
fluid level must be at the upper level of the crosshatch mark.
7. NOTE: If the transmission fluid is not at the correct level, follow the steps for Adding Additional
Transmission Fluid or Removing Transmission
Fluid.
Install the fluid fill plug. ^
Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1770
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Cooler - Backflushing and Cleaning
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler - Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
CAUTION: When internal damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch plate
material can travel into the torque converter and the transmission fluid cooler. These contaminates
are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent further concerns, remove these
contaminates from the cooler lines and install a new cooler before placing the transmission in use.
1. Install a new transmission fluid cooler if any fluid leaks are indicated or a major metallic failure is
indicated. 2. Using a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner, flush the fluid cooler and lines.
3. NOTE: Rubber hoses must be attached to the ends of the fluid cooler tubes, to aid in connecting
them to the fluid cooler cleaner.
Connect the cleaner pressure and return lines appropriately. 1
Connect the pressure line to the fluid cooler inlet tube.
2 Connect the return line to the fluid cooler outlet tube.
3 Place the outlet end of the return line in the fluid tank reservoir.
4. NOTE: Cycling the fluid pump on and off will help dislodge contaminants in the cooler system.
Switch the fluid pumps on. Allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes.
5. Switch the fluid pump off. 6. Disconnect the cleaner pressure line at the fluid cooler tube. 7.
Using compressed air, blow through the fluid cooler inlet tube until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove
the rubber hoses from the fluid cooler tubes.
6R75 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler - Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
CAUTION: When internal damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch plate
material can travel into the torque converter and the transmission fluid cooler. These contaminates
are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent further concerns, remove these
contaminates from the cooler lines and install a new cooler before placing the transmission in use.
1. Install a new transmission fluid cooler if any fluid leaks are indicated or a major metallic failure is
indicated. 2. Using a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner, flush the fluid cooler and lines.
3. NOTE: Rubber hoses must be attached to the ends of the fluid cooler tubes, to aid in connecting
them to the cleaner.
Connect the cleaner pressure and return lines appropriately. 1
Connect the pressure line to the fluid cooler inlet tube.
2 Connect the return line to the fluid cooler outlet tube.
3 Place the outlet end of the return line in the fluid tank reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 1771
4. NOTE: Cycling the fluid pump ON and OFF will help dislodge contaminants in the cooler system.
Switch the fluid pumps ON. Allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes.
5. Switch the fluid pump OFF. 6. Disconnect the cleaner pressure line at the fluid cooler tube. 7.
Using compressed air, blow through the fluid cooler inlet tube until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove
the rubber hoses from the fluid cooler tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Differential Oil Capacity
FRONT AXLE ......................................................................................................................................
................................. 3.5 - 3.7 pints (1.8 - 2.0 liters)
REAR AXLE Conventional differential .................................................................................................
..................................................................... 4.5 pints (2.13 liters) Limited-slip differential .................
..................................................................................................................................................... 4.25
pints (2.01 liters)
NOTE: Your vehicles rear axle is filled with a synthetic rear axle lubricant and is considered
lubricated for life. These lubricants are not to be checked or changed unless a leak is suspected,
service is required or the axle has been submerged in water. The axle lubricant should be changed
any time the axle has been submerged in water.
NOTE: Add 4 oz. (118 ml) of Additive Friction Modifier XL-3 (or equivalent) for complete refill of
Ford Limited Slip axles.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Differential > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1776
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Differential Fluid Type
REAR AXLE Motorcraft SAE 75W-140 Synthetic Rear Axle Lube Ford P/N ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
. XY-75W140-QL Ford Specification ...................................................................................................
................................................................................... WSL-M2C192-A
FRONT AXLE Motorcraft SAE 80W-90 Premium Rear Axle Lube Ford P/N ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... XY-80W90-QL Ford Specification ...................................................................................................
................................................................................... WSP-M2C197-A
NOTE: Add 4.0 oz. (118 ml) of Additive Friction Modifier XL-3 or equivalent for complete refill of
Ford Limited Slip rear axles.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Transfer Case: Capacity Specifications
Transfer Case Capacity .......................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 2.0 Quarts
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 1781
Fluid - Transfer Case: Fluid Type Specifications
Transfer Case Fluid
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................. Mercon ATF
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1782
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair
Transfer Case Draining and Filling
Special Tool(s)
Material
1. Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid. Clean the drain plug and the drain plug area. Apply
thread sealant to the drain plug threads. Reinstall
the drain plug. ^
To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
2. Clean the area around the fill plug. Remove the fill plug.
3. CAUTION: Incorrect fluid fill can result in transfer case failure.
Using the special tool, fill the transfer case to specification. ^
The fluid must be just below the fill plug hole. Fill the case until the fluid slowly flows over the fill
plug threads. Clean the fluid from the fill plug area.
4. Apply thread sealant to the fill plug threads, then install the fill plug.
^ Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
With Filter ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 6.6L (7.0 Qt)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1787
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
U.S.A. ...................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Premium Synthetic Blend Motor Oil Canada
..................................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Super Premium Motor Oil
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................... XO-5W20-QSP (U.S.A) Ford P/N ............................................................
...................................................................................................................... CXO-5W20-LSP12
(Canada) Ford Specification
.........................................................................................................................................
WSS-M2C930-A with API Certification Mark
NOTE: Use of synthetic or synthetic blend motor oil is not mandatory. Engine oil need only meet
the requirements of Ford specification WSS-M2C930-A and the API Certification mark.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage
Power Steering Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage
TSB 07-1-7
01/22/07
MERCON(R) ATF REPLACED BY MERCON(R) V AS A SERVICE FLUID FOR SOME POWER
STEERING SYSTEMS
FORD: 1996-1997 Thunderbird 1996-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 1998-2003 Escort
2000-2007 Focus 2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2006 Ford GT 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle
2006-2007 Fusion 1996-1997 Aerostar 1996-2007 E-Series, Explorer, Ranger 1997-2004 F-53
Motorhome Chassis 1997-2007 Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty 1998-2003 Windstar 2000-2005
Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2005 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2007 Escape 2004-2007
Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1996-1997 Cargo 1996-1998 L-Series 1996-1999 F- B-Series
2000-2007 F-650, F-750 2006-2007 Low Cab Forward
LINCOLN: 1996-1998 Mark VIII 1996-1999 Continental 1996-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln
LS 2006 Zephyr 2007 MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator
2006-2007 Mark LT 2007 MKX
MERCURY: 1996-1997 Cougar 1996-2005 Sable 1996-2007 Grand Marquis 1999-2002 Cougar
2003-2004 Marauder 2005-2007 Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2007 Mountaineer 1998-2002
Villager 2004-2007 Monterey 2005-2007 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission Fluid is being replaced by MERCON(R) V as a
service fluid for power steering systems originally requiring MERCON(R).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage > Page 1792
ACTION Beginning immediately all power steering applications requiring MERCON(R) can now be
serviced using MERCON(R) V or MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission Fluid or dual usage fluids
labeled MERCON(R) / MERCON(R) V. After July 1, 2007, MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission
Fluid will no longer be manufactured, therefore, availability of this fluid will continue until remaining
inventory has been depleted.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Service power steering Systems requiring MERCON(R) with MERCON(R) V or MERCON(R)
Automatic Transmission Fluid or dual usage fluids labeled MERCON(R) / MERCON(R) V.
CAUTION
APPLICATIONS RECOMMENDING TYPE F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION AND POWER
STEERING FLUID MUST CONTINUE TO USE THAT PARTICULAR FLUID. USE OF ANY
OTHER FLUID MAY CAUSE REDUCED FUNCTIONALITY OR DAMAGE
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1793
Power Steering Fluid: Testing and Inspection
Power Steering Fluid Leak Test
NOTE: This test should only be carried out if a leak in the system has not been detected during a
thorough visual inspection.
1. Check the power steering fluid level. If necessary, add the specified power steering fluid. 2.
Remove the power steering pump reservoir cap and tightly install the evacuation cap to the power
steering pump reservoir. 3. Install the hose from the fill adapter manifold tee to the evacuation cap
on the power steering pump reservoir. 4. Install the vacuum pump to the evacuation cap. 5. Using
the vacuum pump, apply 68-85 kPa (20-25 in-Hg) of vacuum to the power steering system. 6.
Observe the vacuum gauge for 30 seconds. If the vacuum gauge reading drops more than 3 kPa
(0.88 in-Hg) a leak is present. 7. Remove the vacuum pump.
8. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel at the stops for more than 3-5 seconds. Damage to
the power steering pump can occur.
Start the engine. With the engine at idle, raise the power steering fluid temperature to 74-80°C
(165-176°F) by rotating the steering wheel fully to the left and right several times.
9. Visually inspect the system for leaks. If a leak is evident, repair as necessary. If a leak is not
evident, add the specified UV fluorescent tracer dye
to the power steering fluid. Use 14.78 mL (1/2 oz) of dye solution for every 1.89L (2 qt) of power
steering fluid. For steering system fluid capacity, refer to Specifications.
10. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel at the stops for more than 3-5 seconds. Damage to
the power steering pump can occur.
Start the engine. With the engine at idle, raise the power steering fluid temperature to 74-80°C
(165-176°F) by rotating the steering wheel fully to the left and right several times.
11. NOTE: On vehicles with rack and pinion steering gear, it may be necessary to remove the
bellows boot clamp from the steering gear bellows
boots to inspect for internal steering gear leaks.
Using the special tool (UV lamp), inspect the system for traces of UV dye. Repair as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1798
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
REFRIGERANT TYPE
R134a Refrigerant Ford P/N ................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. YN-19 Ford Specification ..................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. WSH-M17B19-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1799
Refrigerant: Description and Operation
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM DYE
Fluorescent refrigerant system dye is added to the refrigerant system at the factory to assist in
refrigerant system leak diagnosis using a Rotunda-approved ultraviolet blacklight. It is not
necessary to add additional dye to the refrigerant system before diagnosing leaks, even if a
significant amount of refrigerant has been removed from the system. Additional refrigerant system
dye should only be added if more than 50% of the refrigerant system lubricant capacity has been
lost due to a fitting separation, hose rupture or other damage. Refer to Heating and Air
Conditioning.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1804
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL TYPE
(R-134a Systems) PAG Refrigerant Compressor Oil Ford P/N ...........................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
YN-12-D Ford Specification .................................................................................................................
................................................................. WSH-M1C231-B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1809
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tube fittings.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1810
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the anti-lock brake (ABS) hydraulic control unit (HCU)
has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the ABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in a
container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1811
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the scan tool.
Connect the scan tool to the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the dash and follow the scan
tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the scan tool service bleed procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1812
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Gravity
Gravity
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid. 2. Bleed the rear disc
brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH rear disc brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1813
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1814
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Manual
Manual
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the clean, specified brake fluid.
Never reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1815
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper. 6. Place a box-end wrench on the
RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1816
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1817
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tube fittings.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1818
with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the anti-lock brake (ABS) hydraulic control unit (HCU)
has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the ABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in a
container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the scan tool.
Connect the scan tool to the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the dash and follow the scan
tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the scan tool service bleed procedure.
Gravity
Gravity
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1819
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid. 2. Bleed the rear disc
brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH rear disc brake caliper.
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
Manual
Manual
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1820
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the clean, specified brake fluid.
Never reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper. 6. Place a box-end wrench on the
RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1821
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Pressure
Pressure
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1822
NOTE: Bleed the longest line first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough clean, specified brake
fluid to complete the bleeding operation.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 5. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then tighten rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
6. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
7. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter. 8. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid and install the
brake master cylinder filler cap.
Master Cylinder, Bench
Master Cylinder, Bench
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1823
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Support the brake master cylinder body in a vise and fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with
clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In
Vehicle > Page 1824
3. Slowly depress the primary piston until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module.Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped). Failure to
follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable (14301) and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all supplemental restraint system (SRS) components are connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install restraints control module (RCM) fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1829
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off.If an air bag SRS fault
is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1830
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body.This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down.This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin.Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module.Doing so can result in safety canopy
deployment, which can result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device.Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner.Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector.Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON.This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and
the restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors are located in the first row doors, behind the door trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1831
auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).Failure to follow these instructions may
increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position. 8. Center the tilt steering column.
9. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock
position).
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws and pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
11. Remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
All vehicles 12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws. 13. Release the clips and
remove the steering column upper shroud. 14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1832
15. CAUTION: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each
of the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel.Failure to do so will damage the driver
air bag module and steering wheel.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity.The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
- Use a mirror to look at the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
- Note the position of the 2 driver air bag module locator pins to the steering wheel for installation.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
16. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors, then disconnect the horn switch
electrical connector and remove the driver air bag
module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight ahead position (the 12
o'clock position). 18. Open and lower the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1833
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat.The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector.
21. Release the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
22. Remove the bolt and the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1834
23. Remove the cover and the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1835
27. Remove the bolt and the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
28. Remove the cover and the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1836
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat.The driver seat side air bag module
electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SPDJB. 33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1837
5. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1838
9. Connect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
10. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1839
13. Attach the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector. 16. Close the glove compartment
door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag
module.Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module.Do not force
the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the horn switch electrical connector, then connect the 2 driver air bag module electrical
connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1840
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE:
- Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated correctly to the
steering wheel.
- Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks. -
Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud. 22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
23. Install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. Install the lower steering column opening cover and the 3 screws.
All vehicles 25. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 26. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and install the cover.
27. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
28. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair >
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 1841
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position.This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps.If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1847
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1848
Fuse: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1849
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1850
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1851
Fuse: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1852
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1853
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1854
Fuse: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1855
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1856
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1859
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1860
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1861
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1862
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1863
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1864
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1865
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1866
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1867
Fuse: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1868
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1869
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1870
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1871
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1872
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1873
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1874
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1875
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1878
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1879
Fuse: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1880
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1881
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1882
Fuse: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1883
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1884
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1885
Fuse: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1886
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Application and
ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1887
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1892
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1893
Fuse Block: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1894
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1895
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1896
Fuse Block: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1897
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1898
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1899
Fuse Block: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1900
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1901
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1904
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1905
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1906
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1907
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1908
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1909
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1910
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1911
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1912
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1913
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1914
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1915
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1916
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1917
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1918
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1919
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1920
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1921
Fuse Block: Connector Views
C1035
C2280A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1922
C2280B
C2280C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1923
C2280D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1924
C2280E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1925
C2280F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1926
C2280G
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1929
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1930
Fuse Block: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1931
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1932
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1933
Fuse Block: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1934
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1935
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1936
Fuse Block: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1937
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application
and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1938
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1943
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1944
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1945
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1946
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1947
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1948
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1949
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1950
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1951
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 1952
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1955
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
C2280B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1956
C2280C
C2280D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1957
C2280E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1958
C2280F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams >
Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 1959
C2280G
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 1962
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 1963
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 1964
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 1965
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 1966
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 1967
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 1968
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 1969
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 1970
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Relay Box > Component Information > Application
and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 1971
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Low Tire Pressure Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPMS Indicator and Message Center Messages
The TPMS indicator and vehicle message center (if equipped) sometimes displays faults that
cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these messages as TPMS faults that must be serviced.
TPMS Indicator Illuminates Continuously
NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPMS functionality before carrying out any diagnosis.
1. The TPMS indicator remains on continuously for the following condition:
^ Low Tire Pressure - The TPMS indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low.
When this condition exists, the tire pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold pressure
as indicated on the vehicle certification label.
2. NOTE: The TPMS sensors do not transmit when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle has been
stationary for more than 30 minutes, it will be
necessary to wake up the sensors so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information to the
SJB.
If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, carry out the following procedure to
wake up the TPMS sensors. 1
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2 Adjust the air pressure in the LF tire (as necessary).
3 Activate the LF TPMS sensor, at least 2 times, using the tire pressure monitor activation tool.
4 Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5 If the TPMS indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and activating each sensor, GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
TPMS Indicator Flashes
The TPMS indicator flashes for 70 seconds, then remains ON solid when the ignition switch is
turned to the ON position, for the following conditions: 1. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped,
the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
2. No communication with the SJB (TPMS is integral to the SJB) - The TPMS indicator is
illuminated when the instrument cluster has received no
signals from the SJB for more than 5 seconds. If equipped, the message center displays TIRE
PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring
System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
3. Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT when the tire pressure
monitoring system is malfunctioning or communication with the instrument cluster has been lost.
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Wheels and Tires/Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Service and Repair
This vehicle is not equipped with a maintenance required lamp/indicator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (MIL)
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, Or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately 4 seconds.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if: an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the hardware limited operation strategy (HLOS).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if an indicator or instrument cluster
concern is present.
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the scan tool must be sent, or 3
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
- The MIL flashes after a period of time with the key in the RUN position (engine not running) if
DTC P1000 is set.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
CHANGE OIL SOON/OIL CHANGE REQUIRED
Displayed when the engine oil life remaining is 5 percent or less. When oil life left is between 5%
and 0%, the CHANGE OIL SOON message will be displayed. When oil life left reaches 0%, the OIL
CHANGE REQUIRED message will be displayed.
An oil change is required whenever indicated by the message center and according to the
recommended maintenance schedule. USE ONLY RECOMMENDED ENGINE OILS.
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change [approximately 5,000 miles (8,000
km) or 180 days] perform the following:
1. Press and release the SETUP control to display "OIL LIFE=XXX% HOLD RESET=NEW ".
2. Press and hold the RESET control for 2 seconds and release. Oil life is set to 100% and "OIL
LIFE SET TO 100%" is displayed. 3. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
instrument cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press and release the reset button to exit the
procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by10% increments down to 10%.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET NEW. 2.
Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 100% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Press the RESET button once for each 10% reduction below the default 100% until the message
center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
4. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE:All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
instrument cluster (IC).
NOTE:The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press the RESET button to lower 10% from
the default 100% until the message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%. 6. NOTE:The oil life
start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the value starts again at
100%. Repeat steps 2-5 for each
desired 10% reduction.
7. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
JACKING
WARNING:
- The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting or jacking an
air suspension equipped vehicle. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of
the air springs which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not run the engine when jacking the vehicle. The wheels contacting the ground could cause
the vehicle to move.
- Support the vehicle prior to carrying out any procedure requiring the vehicle to be jacked off the
ground.
- Make sure the jack and jack stands are correctly located to prevent the vehicle from falling.
- Wheel chocks should be used to prevent the vehicle from rolling and falling off the jack.
CAUTION:
- Never use a halfshaft as a lifting point.
- If equipped with retractable running board, disable the system through the instrument cluster
controls.
Disable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level Control.
Jacking Points - Front
The front jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located behind the front tire and
wheel assembly.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
Jacking Points - Rear
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1989
CAUTION: Do not use the differential housing as a lift point. Leaks or damage to the rear axle
cover and adjoining differential housing surface can occur if a floor jack or any lifting device is
allowed to contact the cover at any point where the cover joins the housing.
CAUTION: Do not use the rear control arms as a lifting point.
The rear jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located in front of the rear tire
and wheel assembly.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
LIFTING
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting or
jacking an air suspension equipped vehicle. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or
deflation of the air springs which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Damage to suspension, exhaust and steering linkage components can occur if care is
not exercised when positioning the hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
Disable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level Control.
Lifting Points - Twin Post Hoist
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 1990
Locate the front hoist adapters and rear hoist adapters (top of frame arc) as indicated.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
Lifting Points - Drive On Hoist
The vehicle is supported by tires and suspension components.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1995
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1998
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 1999
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 2000
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 2001
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in the following sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 in) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 2002
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear. ^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 2003
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure Indicator >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPMS Indicator and Message Center Messages
The TPMS indicator and vehicle message center (if equipped) sometimes displays faults that
cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these messages as TPMS faults that must be serviced.
TPMS Indicator Illuminates Continuously
NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPMS functionality before carrying out any diagnosis.
1. The TPMS indicator remains on continuously for the following condition:
^ Low Tire Pressure - The TPMS indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low.
When this condition exists, the tire pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold pressure
as indicated on the vehicle certification label.
2. NOTE: The TPMS sensors do not transmit when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle has been
stationary for more than 30 minutes, it will be
necessary to wake up the sensors so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information to the
SJB.
If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, carry out the following procedure to
wake up the TPMS sensors. 1
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2 Adjust the air pressure in the LF tire (as necessary).
3 Activate the LF TPMS sensor, at least 2 times, using the tire pressure monitor activation tool.
4 Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5 If the TPMS indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and activating each sensor, GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
TPMS Indicator Flashes
The TPMS indicator flashes for 70 seconds, then remains ON solid when the ignition switch is
turned to the ON position, for the following conditions: 1. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped,
the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
2. No communication with the SJB (TPMS is integral to the SJB) - The TPMS indicator is
illuminated when the instrument cluster has received no
signals from the SJB for more than 5 seconds. If equipped, the message center displays TIRE
PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
3. Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT when the tire pressure
monitoring system is malfunctioning or communication with the instrument cluster has been lost.
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2011
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 2014
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 2015
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 2016
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 2017
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in the following sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 in) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 2018
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear. ^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 2019
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns
Tires: Customer Interest 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns
TSB 08-21-11
10/27/08
4 WHEEL DRIVE/ALL WHEEL DRIVE - WITH CONTROL TRAC - SHUDDER ON
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION OR BINDING ON SLOW TURNS
FORD: 1997-2008 Expedition, Explorer 2006-2008 F-150 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac 2008
F-150
LINCOLN: 1998-2008 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2005 Mountaineer 2006-2008 Mountaineer
ISSUE Various 1997-2008 vehicles equipped with either 4 wheel drive or all wheel drive and
equipped with control trac may exhibit a shudder on acceleration/deceleration, binding in slow
speed turns or noise from the front driveline and/or transfer case. The shudder/binding will occur
with the vehicle being operated in the awd/auto 4x4 mode. The shudder/binding may be due to
incorrect tire circumference or improper tire inflation pressures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS DOES NOT APPLY TO 2006-2008 MOUNTAINEER WITH A 4.0L ENGINE OR 2007-2008
EXPLORER AND SPORT TRAC WITH 20 INCH WHEELS.
NOTE
VEHICLES ON THE LIST MAY REQUIRE REPLACEMENT OF TIRE/S IF THE TIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AVERAGE BETWEEN THE FRONT AND REAR AXLES ARE OUTSIDE OF
THE 1/2 INCH SPECIFICATION OR IF THE TIRE CIRCUMFERENCE FROM SIDE TO SIDE ON
EITHER AXLE EXCEEDS 1/2 INCH DIFFERENCE, THE SMALLER TIRE(S) MUST BE
REPLACED.
NOTE
REVIEW THE WARRANTY AND POLICY MANUAL FOR FORD MOTOR COMPANY TIRE
REPLACEMENT WARRANTY BEFORE PERFORMING THE SERVICE PROCEDURE.
NOTE
ONLY USE REPLACEMENT TIRE AND WHEEL THAT ARE THE SAME SIZE, LOAD INDEX,
SPEED RATING AND TYPE (SUCH AS P-METRIC VERSUS LT-METRIC OR ALL-SEASON
VERSUS ALL-TERRAIN) AS THOSE ORIGINALLY PROVIDED BY FORD. THE
RECOMMENDED TIRE AND WHEEL SIZE MAY BE FOUND ON EITHER THE SAFETY
COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION LABEL OR THE TIRE LABEL WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE
B-PILLAR OR EDGE OF THE DRIVER'S DOOR.
NOTE
ON SOME 4WD MODELS, THE INITIAL SHIFT FROM 2WD TO 4WD WHILE THE VEHICLE IS
MOVING CAN CAUSE A MOMENTARY CLUNK AND/OR BRIEF RATCHETING SOUND. THESE
SOUNDS ARE NORMAL AS THE FRONT DRIVETRAIN COMES UP TO SPEED AND IS NOT
CAUSE FOR CONCERN.
1. Review the tire label for correct tire size and tire inflation pressures located at the B-Pillar of the
driver's door.
2. If the tire size does not match the label, this procedure does not apply, follow normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
3. If the tire size is correct, ensure tire pressures are within specifications.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns >
Page 2028
4. Raise the vehicle on the hoist, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 100-02.
5. Disconnect all wiring going to the transfer case and road test.
6. Is the shudder/binding present?
a. If the shudder/binding is still present, do not continue with this procedure, continue with WSM
normal diagnostic for 4X4.
b. If the shudder/binding is gone, proceed to Step 7.
7. Raise the vehicle on the hoist and reconnect all the wiring previously disconnected.
8. Using a tailor's tape or flexible measuring tape and measure the circumference of all four (4)
tires and record the measurements. (Figure 1)
9. Calculate the average of the circumference of the two (2) front tires and calculate the average of
the circumference of the two (2) rear tires. (Figure 2)
10. If the difference between these two averages is greater than 1/2" (12.7 mm), front to back or
side to side, replace the smallest circumference tire(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns >
Page 2029
and remeasure the tire averages. Refer to WSM, Section 204-04 for tire replacement.
NOTE
WARRANTY COVERAGE ELIGIBILITY STARTS WITH 2007 NEW VEHICLE LIMITED
WARRANTY COVERAGE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082111A 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111A 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace TWO Tires. (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace Two (2) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns >
Page 2030
Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150
Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do
Not Use With 1007A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A195 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns
TSB 08-21-11
10/27/08
4 WHEEL DRIVE/ALL WHEEL DRIVE - WITH CONTROL TRAC - SHUDDER ON
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION OR BINDING ON SLOW TURNS
FORD: 1997-2008 Expedition, Explorer 2006-2008 F-150 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac 2008
F-150
LINCOLN: 1998-2008 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2005 Mountaineer 2006-2008 Mountaineer
ISSUE Various 1997-2008 vehicles equipped with either 4 wheel drive or all wheel drive and
equipped with control trac may exhibit a shudder on acceleration/deceleration, binding in slow
speed turns or noise from the front driveline and/or transfer case. The shudder/binding will occur
with the vehicle being operated in the awd/auto 4x4 mode. The shudder/binding may be due to
incorrect tire circumference or improper tire inflation pressures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS DOES NOT APPLY TO 2006-2008 MOUNTAINEER WITH A 4.0L ENGINE OR 2007-2008
EXPLORER AND SPORT TRAC WITH 20 INCH WHEELS.
NOTE
VEHICLES ON THE LIST MAY REQUIRE REPLACEMENT OF TIRE/S IF THE TIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AVERAGE BETWEEN THE FRONT AND REAR AXLES ARE OUTSIDE OF
THE 1/2 INCH SPECIFICATION OR IF THE TIRE CIRCUMFERENCE FROM SIDE TO SIDE ON
EITHER AXLE EXCEEDS 1/2 INCH DIFFERENCE, THE SMALLER TIRE(S) MUST BE
REPLACED.
NOTE
REVIEW THE WARRANTY AND POLICY MANUAL FOR FORD MOTOR COMPANY TIRE
REPLACEMENT WARRANTY BEFORE PERFORMING THE SERVICE PROCEDURE.
NOTE
ONLY USE REPLACEMENT TIRE AND WHEEL THAT ARE THE SAME SIZE, LOAD INDEX,
SPEED RATING AND TYPE (SUCH AS P-METRIC VERSUS LT-METRIC OR ALL-SEASON
VERSUS ALL-TERRAIN) AS THOSE ORIGINALLY PROVIDED BY FORD. THE
RECOMMENDED TIRE AND WHEEL SIZE MAY BE FOUND ON EITHER THE SAFETY
COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION LABEL OR THE TIRE LABEL WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE
B-PILLAR OR EDGE OF THE DRIVER'S DOOR.
NOTE
ON SOME 4WD MODELS, THE INITIAL SHIFT FROM 2WD TO 4WD WHILE THE VEHICLE IS
MOVING CAN CAUSE A MOMENTARY CLUNK AND/OR BRIEF RATCHETING SOUND. THESE
SOUNDS ARE NORMAL AS THE FRONT DRIVETRAIN COMES UP TO SPEED AND IS NOT
CAUSE FOR CONCERN.
1. Review the tire label for correct tire size and tire inflation pressures located at the B-Pillar of the
driver's door.
2. If the tire size does not match the label, this procedure does not apply, follow normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
3. If the tire size is correct, ensure tire pressures are within specifications.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 2036
4. Raise the vehicle on the hoist, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 100-02.
5. Disconnect all wiring going to the transfer case and road test.
6. Is the shudder/binding present?
a. If the shudder/binding is still present, do not continue with this procedure, continue with WSM
normal diagnostic for 4X4.
b. If the shudder/binding is gone, proceed to Step 7.
7. Raise the vehicle on the hoist and reconnect all the wiring previously disconnected.
8. Using a tailor's tape or flexible measuring tape and measure the circumference of all four (4)
tires and record the measurements. (Figure 1)
9. Calculate the average of the circumference of the two (2) front tires and calculate the average of
the circumference of the two (2) rear tires. (Figure 2)
10. If the difference between these two averages is greater than 1/2" (12.7 mm), front to back or
side to side, replace the smallest circumference tire(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 2037
and remeasure the tire averages. Refer to WSM, Section 204-04 for tire replacement.
NOTE
WARRANTY COVERAGE ELIGIBILITY STARTS WITH 2007 NEW VEHICLE LIMITED
WARRANTY COVERAGE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082111A 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111A 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace TWO Tires. (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace Two (2) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns > Page 2038
Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150
Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do
Not Use With 1007A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A195 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 2043
major service expense. A new part with the same part number must be installed if installation
becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque
values must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these
parts.
1. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness
bolt and detach the harness from the retainers.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Remove the halfshaft nut dust cap. 7. Remove and discard the
halfshaft nut.
^ To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
8. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and wheel hub bolts and the wheel hub.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 lb-ft).
9. If installing a new wheel bearing and wheel hub, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the
wheel speed sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
10. CAUTION: If the original wheel bearing and wheel hub is being installed, install a new wheel
hub O-ring seal.
CAUTION: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the halfshaft
nut.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 2044
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the halfshaft nut. ^
To install, tighten to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
3. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV joint from the wheel hub.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 2045
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose can result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Detach the wheel speed sensor harness from the retainers and
disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
7. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and wheel hub bolts, the wheel bearing assembly and the wheel
speed sensor as an assembly.
^ Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
^ Discard the bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 lb-ft).
8. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and wheel hub.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications > Front
Axle Nut: Specifications Front
Front Axle nut.......................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 27 Nm (20 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications > Front > Page 2051
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear
Rear axle Nut .......................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 300 Nm (221 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2055
C1157
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Wheel Hub (Locking): Service and Repair
Integrated Wheel End (IWE)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the front wheel and tire.
3. Remove the dust cap.
4. Remove and discard the axle nut.
5. Disconnect the vacuum tubes from the Integrated Wheel End (IWE).
6. Remove the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
7. Remove the tie-rod nut and separate the tie rod from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the tie-rod nut.
8. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
9. Remove the front brake flexible hose bracket bolt and position the brake hose aside.
10. Remove the upper ball joint nut and separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the upper ball joint nut.
11. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, remove the halfshaft outboard end from the wheel knuckle hub
bearing.
12. Remove the IWE from the halfshaft outboard end.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 2059
1. Compress the IWE and install a vacuum cap on the vacuum port.
2. NOTICE: Do not dislodge the Integrated Wheel End (IWE) seal spring when installing the IWE
on halfshaft outboard end or component
damage may occur.
Install the IWE onto the halfshaft outboard end.
3. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, install the halfshaft outboard end into the wheel knuckle hub bearing.
4. Connect the upper ball joint and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
5. Connect the tie rod and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
6. Position the front brake flexible hose bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Position the wheel speed sensor harness bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
8. Install the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
9. Remove the IWE vacuum cap and connect the vacuum tubes.
10. NOTICE: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the axle nut
or component damage may occur.
Install the new axle nut.
- Tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
11. Install the dust cap.
12. Install the front wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel nuts............................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 204 Nm (150 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2063
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair
Wheel Studs
Special Tool(s)
Removal
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
2. CAUTION: Never use a hammer to remove a wheel stud. Damage to the wheel hub can result.
Place the wheel hub in a soft-jawed vice and, using the special tool, remove the wheel stud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2064
Installation
1. Position the new wheel stud in the wheel bearing and hub assembly, aligning the serrations in
the wheel hub flange made by the original wheel
stud.
2. CAUTION: Do not use power tools to install the wheel stud. The serrations on the flange can be
stripped.
NOTE: Do not use the wheel nut that came with the vehicle.
Install 4 washers and a wheel nut on the wheel stud and tighten the wheel nut until the stud seats
against the flange.
3. Remove the wheel nut and washers.
^ Discard the wheel nut.
4. Install the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
JACKING
WARNING:
- The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting or jacking an
air suspension equipped vehicle. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of
the air springs which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not run the engine when jacking the vehicle. The wheels contacting the ground could cause
the vehicle to move.
- Support the vehicle prior to carrying out any procedure requiring the vehicle to be jacked off the
ground.
- Make sure the jack and jack stands are correctly located to prevent the vehicle from falling.
- Wheel chocks should be used to prevent the vehicle from rolling and falling off the jack.
CAUTION:
- Never use a halfshaft as a lifting point.
- If equipped with retractable running board, disable the system through the instrument cluster
controls.
Disable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level Control.
Jacking Points - Front
The front jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located behind the front tire and
wheel assembly.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
Jacking Points - Rear
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
2068
CAUTION: Do not use the differential housing as a lift point. Leaks or damage to the rear axle
cover and adjoining differential housing surface can occur if a floor jack or any lifting device is
allowed to contact the cover at any point where the cover joins the housing.
CAUTION: Do not use the rear control arms as a lifting point.
The rear jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located in front of the rear tire
and wheel assembly.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
LIFTING
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting or
jacking an air suspension equipped vehicle. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or
deflation of the air springs which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Damage to suspension, exhaust and steering linkage components can occur if care is
not exercised when positioning the hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
Disable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level Control.
Lifting Points - Twin Post Hoist
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
2069
Locate the front hoist adapters and rear hoist adapters (top of frame arc) as indicated.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
Lifting Points - Drive On Hoist
The vehicle is supported by tires and suspension components.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page 2077
C1452
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2078
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
VCT System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is achieved. A difference between the desired and
actual camshaft position represents a position error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM
disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a default position if a concern is detected. A related
DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2079
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Actuators and Solenoids - Engine > Variable Valve
Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) OIL CONTROL SOLENOID
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the valve cover.
2. Remove the bolt and the variable camshaft timing (VCT) oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 2086
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test - Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty. 2. If compression does not
improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly. 3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low
compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does not increase compression, the head
gasket may be
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications > Page 2087
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft Bearing
> Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Bearing: Specifications
Camshaft bearing cap bolts .................................................................................................................
.................................................. 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See:
Camshaft/Service and Repair
2. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See:
Camshaft/Service and Repair
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the special
tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must
be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing
Components
Remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket from the timing chain.
4. Inspect the front of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for missing or damaged roll pins.
- If the roll pins are missing or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be installed.
5. Inspect the rear of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for a deformed or damaged location pin.
- If the location pin is deformed or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be
installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft
Gear/Sprocket > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2095
6. Visually inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for squareness (A). If the trigger wheel or
spring is deformed or damaged (B), install a new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
If installing a new camshaft phaser and sprocket, transfer the original scribe mark to the new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
2. NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to
valves and pistons will result.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Align the scribe marks and position the camshaft phaser and sprocket into the timing chain.
3. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See:
Camshaft/Service and Repair
4. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See:
Camshaft/Service and Repair
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures
Camshaft: Service and Repair General Procedures
Camshaft Bearing Journal Diameter
1. Measure each camshaft journal diameter in 2 directions.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Camshaft Journal to Bearing Clearance
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: The camshaft journals must meet specifications before checking camshaft journal
clearance.
1. Remove the camshaft bearing cap and lay Plastigage(R) across the surface.
2. NOTE: Do not turn the camshaft while carrying out this procedure.
Position the camshaft bearing cap and install the bolts.
3. Use Plastigage(R) to verify the camshaft journal clearance.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Camshaft End Play
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2100
Special Tool(s)
1. Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure camshaft end play. 2. Position the
camshaft to the rear of the cylinder head. 3. Zero the indicator. 4. Move the camshaft to the front of
the cylinder head. Note and record the camshaft end play.
^ If camshaft end play exceeds specifications, install new camshaft and recheck end play.
^ If camshaft end play exceeds specification after camshaft installation, install a new cylinder head.
Camshaft Surface Inspection
1. Inspect camshaft lobes for pitting or damage in the contact area. Minor pitting is acceptable
outside the contact area.
^ If excessive pitting or damage is present, install new components as necessary.
Camshaft Lobe Lift
Special Tool(s)
1. Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure camshaft intake/exhaust lobe lift.
^ Rotate the camshaft and subtract the lowest indicator reading from the highest indicator reading
to figure the camshaft lobe lift.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2101
Camshaft Runout
Special Tool(s)
1. NOTE: Camshaft journals must be within specifications before checking runout.
Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure the camshaft runout. ^
Rotate the camshaft and subtract the lowest indicator reading from the highest indicator reading.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2102
Camshaft: Service and Repair Camshaft - LH
Camshaft - LH
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2103
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
CAUTION: The camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the valves and pistons
will result.
1. Position the crankshaft damper spoke at the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation
at the 1 o'clock position.
2. Remove the LH valve cover.
3. CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
Loosen and back off the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt one full turn.
4. Disconnect the LH camshaft position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2104
5. Remove the LH CMP sensor and the bolt.
6. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft keyway will
require one full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
The No. 5 cylinder camshaft lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by noting the
position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the No. 5 cylinder.
7. Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2105
8. CAUTION: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder.
NOTE: The camshaft roller followers must be installed in their original locations. Record camshaft
roller follower locations.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the special tool, remove only the 3 designated camshaft roller followers from the previous
step.
9. CAUTION: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set.
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise, as viewed from the front, positioning the crankshaft damper spoke
at the 6 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation at the 7 o'clock position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2106
10. CAUTION: Engine is not freewheeling. Camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or
damage to valves and pistons will result.
CAUTION: The Timing Chain Wedge tool must be installed square to the timing chain and the
engine block.
NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Install the special tool in the LH timing chain as shown.
11. CAUTION: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement,
the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed.
CAUTION: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Scribe a location mark on the timing chain and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2107
12. CAUTION: When removing the front thrust camshaft bearing cap, use care as the cap may be
damaged from side loading when
removing the cam unequally in height from the bearing towers.
NOTE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record camshaft
bearing cap locations.
Remove the bolts in the sequence shown and remove the front camshaft bearing cap and then the
remaining bearing caps.
13. Clean and inspect the LH camshaft bearing caps.
^ The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
14. CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
CAUTION: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2108
CAUTION: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the special
tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must
be retimed.
Remove the bolt and withdraw the camshaft from the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly,
leaving the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly in place. ^
Discard the bolt and washer.
15. Inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for damage.
Installation
1. Lubricate the camshaft and camshaft journals with clean engine oil. 2. CAUTION: Do not remove
the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the special tool is removed or out of
placement,
the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed.
CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
CAUTION: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Install the camshaft into the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly and onto the head. Install a
new camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt finger tight.
3. CAUTION: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement,
the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed.
CAUTION: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Verify the camshaft phaser and sprocket and timing chain scribe marks are still in alignment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2109
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Install the camshaft bearing caps in their original locations. ^
Lubricate the camshaft bearing caps with clean engine oil.
^ Position the front camshaft bearing cap.
^ Position the remaining camshaft bearing caps.
^ Install the bolts loosely.
5. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
6. NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Remove the special tools.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2110
7. Rotate the crankshaft a half turn counterclockwise and position the crankshaft damper spoke at
the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark
indentation at the 1 o'clock position.
8. Verify correct camshaft position by noting the position of the No. 5 cylinder intake and exhaust
camshaft lobes.
9. Using the special tool, install the 3 originally removed camshaft roller followers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2111
10. Install the CMP sensor and the bolt.
11. Connect the CMP electrical connector.
12. CAUTION: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or
damage may occur to the camshaft or camshaft
phaser and sprocket.
CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
Tighten the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt in 2 stages: ^
Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
^ Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2112
13. Install the LH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2113
Camshaft: Service and Repair Camshaft - RH
Camshaft - RH
Valve Train Components - Exploded View
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2114
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
CAUTION: The camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or damage to the valves and pistons
will result.
1. Position the crankshaft damper spoke at the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation
at the 1 o'clock position.
2. Remove the RH valve cover.
3. CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
Loosen and backoff the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt one full turn.
4. Disconnect the RH camshaft position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2115
5. Remove the bolt and the RH CMP sensor.
6. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft will require one
full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
The No. 1 cylinder camshaft exhaust lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by
noting the position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the No. 1 cylinder.
7. Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2116
8. CAUTION: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder.
NOTE: The camshaft roller followers must be installed in their original locations. Record camshaft
roller follower locations.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the special tool, remove only the 3 designated camshaft roller followers from the previous
step.
9. CAUTION: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set.
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise, as viewed from the front, positioning the crankshaft damper spoke
at the 6 o'clock position and the timing mark indentation at the 7 o'clock position.
10. CAUTION: Engine is not freewheeling. Camshaft procedure must be followed exactly or
damage to valves and pistons will result.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2117
CAUTION: The Timing Chain Wedge tool must be installed square to the timing chain and the
engine block.
NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity.
Install the special tool in the RH timing chain as shown.
11. CAUTION: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement,
the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed.
CAUTION: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
Scribe a location mark on the timing chain and the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly.
12. CAUTION: When removing the front thrust camshaft bearing cap, use care as the cap may be
damaged from sideloading when
removing the cam unequally in height from the bearing towers.
NOTE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record camshaft
bearing cap locations.
Remove the bolts in the sequence shown and remove the front camshaft bearing cap and then the
remaining bearing caps.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2118
13. Clean and inspect the RH camshaft bearing caps.
^ The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
14. CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
CAUTION: Only use hand tools to remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt or damage may
occur to the camshaft or camshaft phaser and sprocket.
CAUTION: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the special
tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must
be retimed.
Remove the bolt and withdraw the camshaft from the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly,
leaving the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly in place. ^
Discard the bolt and washer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2119
15. Inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for damage.
Installation
1. Lubricate the camshaft and camshaft journals with clean engine oil.
2. CAUTION: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement,
the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed.
CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
CAUTION: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Install the camshaft into the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly and onto the head. Install a
new camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt finger tight.
3. CAUTION: Do not remove the Timing Chain Wedge tool at any time during assembly. If the
special tool is removed or out of placement,
the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must be retimed.
CAUTION: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to valves and pistons will result.
Verify the camshaft phaser and sprocket and timing chain scribe marks are still in alignment.
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the camshaft roller followers to move out of position when installing the
camshaft.
Install the camshaft bearing caps in their original locations. ^
Lubricate the camshaft bearing caps with clean engine oil.
^ Position the front camshaft bearing cap.
^ Position the remaining camshaft bearing caps.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2120
^ Install the bolts loosely.
5. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
6. NOTE: Engine front cover removed for clarity. Remove the special tool.
7. Rotate the crankshaft a half turn counterclockwise and position the crankshaft damper spoke at
the 12 o'clock position and the timing mark
indentation at the 1 o'clock position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2121
8. Verify correct camshaft position by noting the position of the No. 1 cylinder intake and exhaust
camshaft lobes.
9. Using the special tool, install the 3 originally removed camshaft roller followers.
10. Install the CMP sensor and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
11. Connect the CMP electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2122
12. CAUTION: Only use hand tools to install the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly or
damage may occur to the camshaft or camshaft
phaser and sprocket.
CAUTION: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
Tighten the new camshaft phaser and sprocket bolt in 2 stages: ^
Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
^ Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
13. Install the RH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2123
Camshaft: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Repair
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See:
2. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See:
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the special
tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must
be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components. See: Timing
Components
Remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket from the timing chain.
4. Inspect the front of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for missing or damaged roll pins.
- If the roll pins are missing or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be installed.
5. Inspect the rear of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for a deformed or damaged location pin.
- If the location pin is deformed or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be
installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft, Engine
> Component Information > Service and Repair > General Procedures > Page 2124
6. Visually inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for squareness (A). If the trigger wheel or
spring is deformed or damaged (B), install a new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
If installing a new camshaft phaser and sprocket, transfer the original scribe mark to the new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
2. NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to
valves and pistons will result.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Align the scribe marks and position the camshaft phaser and sprocket into the timing chain.
3. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See:
4. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Testing and Inspection
Hydraulic Lash Adjuster Inspection
1. Inspect the hydraulic lash adjuster and roller follower for damage. If any damage is found,
inspect the camshaft lobes and valves for damage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2128
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Lash Adjuster
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the camshafts. 2. Remove the remaining camshaft roller followers from the cylinder
head being serviced.
3. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation
into the original locations.
Remove the hydraulic lash adjusters that are being serviced.
4. Inspect the hydraulic lash adjusters.
5. NOTE: Lubricate each of the hydraulic lash adjusters with clean engine oil prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Rocker Arm Assembly: Testing and Inspection
Roller Follower Inspection
1. Inspect the roller follower for flat spots or scoring. If any damage is found, inspect the camshaft
lobes and hydraulic lash adjuster for damage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2132
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair
Camshaft Roller Follower
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. Depending on the camshaft roller follower being serviced, remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2.
Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with the
intake valve and the exhaust valves closed.
3. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same position.
Mark the components for installation
into the original location.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller follower.
4. Repeat the previous 2 steps for each camshaft roller follower being serviced. 5. Inspect the
camshaft roller follower.
Installation
1. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same position.
Mark the components for installation
into the original locations.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller follower.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2133
2. Repeat the previous step for each camshaft roller follower being serviced. 3. Depending on the
camshaft roller follower being serviced, install the LH or RH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page 2138
C1452
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2139
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
VCT System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is achieved. A difference between the desired and
actual camshaft position represents a position error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM
disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a default position if a concern is detected. A related
DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Variable Valve
Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2140
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing: Specifications
Connecting Rod Bearing
Bore diameter (with assembled
liners)............................................................................................................... 53.049-53.027
mm)(2.0885-2.0877 inch) Bearing-to-crankshaft
clearance.............................................................................................................................
0.064-0.026 mm (0.0025-0.0010 inch) Rod side clearance.................................................................
................................................................................. 0.475-0.125 mm (0.0187-0.0049 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2145
Connecting Rod Bearing: Testing and Inspection
Bearing Inspection
1. Inspect bearings for these defects. Possible causes are shown:
1 Cratering - fatigue failure.
2 Spot polishing - incorrect seating.
3 Imbedded dirt engine oil.
4 Scratching - dirty engine oil.
5 Base exposed - poor lubrication.
6 Both edges worn - journal damaged.
7 One edge worn - journal tapered or bearing not seated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod: Specifications
Connecting Rod
Rod-to-pin
clearance.............................................................................................................................................
0.009-0.0235 mm (0.0004-0.0093 inch) Pin bore
diameter................................................................................................................................................
22.012-22.024 mm (0.8666-0.8671 inch) Length (center-to-center)....................................................
.......................................................................................................... 169.1 mm (6.6575 inch)
Maximum allowed bend........................................................................................................................
.................................... ± 0.038 mm (0.0015 inch) Maximum allowed twist(a).....................................
..................................................................................................................... ± 0.05 mm (0.0020 inch)
Rod bearing
Bore diameter (with assembled
liners)......................................................................................................... 53.049-53.027
mm)(2.0885-2.0877 inch) Bearing-to-crankshaft
clearance....................................................................................................................... 0.064-0.026
mm (0.0025-0.0010 inch)
Rod side clearance...............................................................................................................................
................... 0.475-0.125 mm (0.0187-0.0049 inch)
(a) The pin bore and crank bearing bore must be parallel and in the same vertical plane within the
specified total difference when measured at the ends of a 203 mm bar, 105.5 mm on each side of
rod centerline.
Connecting Rod Bolts
Discard the bolts.
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
................................................. 43 Nm (32 ft. lbs.) Final pass .............................................................
.......................................................................................................................................... Tighten
105°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2149
Connecting Rod: Service and Repair
Connecting Rod Cleaning
CAUTION: Do not use a caustic cleaning solution or damage to connecting rods can occur.
1. NOTE: The connecting rod large end is a matched set. The connecting rod cap must be installed
on the original connecting rod in the original
position. Do not reverse the cap. Parts are not interchangeable.
Mark and separate the parts and clean with solvent. Clean the oil passages.
Connecting Rod Large End Bore
1. Tighten the bolts to specification, then measure the bore in 2 directions. The difference is the
connecting rod bore out-of-round. Verify the
out-of-round is within specification. ^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Connecting Rod Bushing Diameter
1. Use a telescoping gauge to determine the inner diameter of the connecting rod bushing, if
equipped.
2. Measure the telescoping gauge with a micrometer. Verify the diameter is within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2150
Connecting Rod Bend
1. Measure the connecting rod bend on a suitable alignment fixture. Follow the instructions of the
fixture manufacturer. Verify the bend measurement
is within specification. ^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Connecting Rod Twist
1. Measure the connecting rod twist on a suitable alignment fixture. Follow the instructions of the
fixture manufacturer. Verify the measurement is
within specification. ^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Connecting Rod-to-Piston Clearance
1. Measure the clearance between the connecting rod and the piston. Verify the measurement is
within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Connecting Rod Bearing Journal-to-Bearing Clearance
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2151
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: The crankshaft connecting rod journals must be within specifications to check the
connecting rod bearing journal clearance.
1. Remove the connecting rod bearing cap. 2. Position a piece of Plastigage(R) across the bearing
surface.
3. NOTE: Do not turn the crankshaft during this step.
Install and tighten to specifications, then remove the connecting rod bearing cap.
4. Measure the Plastigage(R) to get the connecting rod bearing journal clearance. The
Plastigage(R) should be smooth and flat. A changing width
indicates a tapered or damaged connecting rod or connecting rod bearing. ^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Connecting Rod Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round
1. Measure the crankshaft connecting rod journal diameters in 2 directions perpendicular to one
another at each end of the connecting rod journal.
The difference in the measurements from one end to the other is the taper. Verify measurement is
within the wear limit. ^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2152
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Crankshaft Pulley Bolt
Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.) Second pass .......................................................
............................................................................................................................................. Loosen
360° Third pass ...................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.) Final pass ....................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
Tighten 90°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Specifications
Cylinder Block
Main bearing bore inside
diameter..........................................................................................................................
72.400-72.424 mm (2.850-2.851 inch)
Crankshaft
Main bearing journal
Diameter...............................................................................................................................................
......... 67.481-67.505 mm (2.6567-2.6576 inch) Maximum taper.........................................................
.............................................................................................................. 0.004 mm (0.0002 inch)
Maximum out-of-round.....................................................................................................................
0.0075 mm (0.0003 inch) between cross sections Journal-to-cylinder block
clearance................................................................................................................. 0.048-0.024 mm
(0.0019-0.0009 inch)
Connecting rod journal
Diameter...............................................................................................................................................
......... 53.003-52.983 mm (2.0867-2.0859 inch) Maximum taper.........................................................
.............................................................................................................. 0.004 mm (0.0002 inch)
Maximum out-of-round.....................................................................................................................
0.0075 mm (0.0003 inch) between cross sections
Crankshaft maximum end
play................................................................................................................................ 0.075-0.377
mm (0.0030-0.0148 inch)
Main Bearing Size Codes
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2159
Vertical Main Bearing Cap Fasteners
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2160
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
................................................. 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs). Final pass .............................................................
............................................................................................................................................ Tighten
90°
Side Bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
................................................. 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs). Final pass .............................................................
............................................................................................................................................ Tighten
90°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2161
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Testing and Inspection
Bearing Inspection
1. Inspect bearings for these defects. Possible causes are shown:
1 Cratering - fatigue failure.
2 Spot polishing - incorrect seating.
3 Imbedded dirt engine oil.
4 Scratching - dirty engine oil.
5 Base exposed - poor lubrication.
6 Both edges worn - journal damaged.
7 One edge worn - journal tapered or bearing not seated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications
Crankshaft
Main bearing journal
Diameter...............................................................................................................................................
......... 67.481-67.505 mm (2.6567-2.6576 inch) Maximum taper.........................................................
.............................................................................................................. 0.004 mm (0.0002 inch)
Maximum out-of-round.....................................................................................................................
0.0075 mm (0.0003 inch) between cross sections Journal-to-cylinder block
clearance................................................................................................................. 0.048-0.024 mm
(0.0019-0.0009 inch)
Connecting rod journal
Diameter...............................................................................................................................................
......... 53.003-52.983 mm (2.0867-2.0859 inch) Maximum taper.........................................................
.............................................................................................................. 0.004 mm (0.0002 inch)
Maximum out-of-round.....................................................................................................................
0.0075 mm (0.0003 inch) between cross sections
Crankshaft maximum end
play................................................................................................................................ 0.075-0.377
mm (0.0030-0.0148 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2165
Crankshaft: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal Diameter
1. Measure each of the crankshaft main bearing journal diameters in at least 2 directions.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal Taper and Out-of-Round
1. Measure each of the crankshaft main bearing journal diameters in at least 2 directions at each
end of the main bearing journal.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Crankshaft Main Bearing Journal-to-Bearing Clearance
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: Crankshaft main bearing journals must be within specifications before checking journal
clearance.
1. Remove the crankshaft main bearing caps and crankshaft main bearing. 2. Lay a piece of
Plastigage(R) across the face of each crankshaft main bearing surface.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2166
3. NOTE: Do not turn the crankshaft while carrying out this procedure.
Install and remove the crankshaft main bearing cap.
4. Verify the crankshaft journal clearance.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Crankshaft End Play
Special Tool(s)
1. Measure the crankshaft end play. Use a Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure
crankshaft end play. 2. Position the crankshaft to the rear of the cylinder block. 3. Zero the
indicator. 4. Move the crankshaft to the front of the cylinder block. Note and record the crankshaft
end play.
^ If crankshaft end play exceeds specifications, install a new crankshaft thrust washer or crankshaft
thrust main bearing.
Crankshaft Runout
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2167
Special Tool(s)
1. NOTE: Crankshaft main bearing journals must be within specifications before checking runout.
Use the Dial Indicator Gauge with Holding Fixture to measure the crankshaft runout. ^
Rotate the crankshaft and subtract the lowest dial indicator reading from the highest dial indicator
reading to figure the crankshaft runout. If it is out of specification, install new components as
necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Engine Block Heater >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Engine Block Heater: Service and Repair
Block Heater
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system.
2. CAUTION: Do not loosen the block heater retaining screw more than necessary for removal.
Loosen the block heater retaining screw and remove the block heater. ^
To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.)
3. NOTE: Route the block heater power cable away from hot or rotating components, or damage to
the cable can occur.
NOTE: Lubricate the block heater O-ring seal with clean engine coolant prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Specifications
Crankshaft Pulley Bolt
Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.) Second pass .......................................................
............................................................................................................................................. Loosen
360° Third pass ...................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.) Final pass ....................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
Tighten 90°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2174
Harmonic Balancer - Crankshaft Pulley: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Pulley
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2175
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Release the cooling fan shroud position tab and rotate the
shroud upward until the lower tab locks into position.
3. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from the crankshaft pulley.
4. Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt and washer.
^ Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
5. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2176
Installation
1. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with metal surface prep and silicone gasket
remover. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4
minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant to the Woodruff key slot in the crankshaft pulley.
2. Lubricate the crankshaft pulley sealing area with clean engine oil prior to installation.
3. Using the special tool, install the crankshaft pulley.
4. Using a new crankshaft pulley bolt, install the bolt and washer and tighten the bolt in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.)
^ Stage 2: Loosen 360 degrees.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Harmonic Balancer Crankshaft Pulley > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2177
^ Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
5. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt onto the crankshaft pulley.
6. Release the cooling fan shroud position tab and rotate the shroud downward until the tab locks
into position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
Piston
Diameter (at right angle to pin bore)
Grade
1.........................................................................................................................................................
90.175-90.165 mm (3.5502-3.5498 inch) Grade
2.........................................................................................................................................................
90.185-90.175 mm (3.5506-3.5502 inch) Grade
3.........................................................................................................................................................
90.195-90.185 mm (3.5510-3.5506 inch)
Piston-to-cylinder bore clearance (at grade
size).................................................................................................... 0.025-0.045 mm
(0.0010-0.0018 inch) Ring end gap
Top ......................................................................................................................................................
.................... 0.15-0.30 mm (0.006-0.012 inch) Intermediate...............................................................
........................................................................................... 0.25-0.50 mm (0.0098-0.0197 inch) Oil c
ontrol.....................................................................................................................................................
........ 0.15-0.65 mm (0.0059-0.0256 inch)
Ring groove width
Top.......................................................................................................................................................
................. 1.52-1.55 mm (0.0598-0.0610 inch) Intermediate..............................................................
............................................................................................ 1.52-1.54 mm (0.0598-0.0606 inch) Oil c
ontrol.....................................................................................................................................................
.... 3.030-3.050 mm (0.1193-0.1201 inch)
Ring width - top and
intermediate...............................................................................................................................
1.50-1.47 mm (0.0590-0.0578 inch) Ring-to-groove clearance
Top ......................................................................................................................................................
............ 0.020-0.080 mm (0.0008-0.0031 inch) Intermediate...............................................................
....................................................................................... 0.030-0.070 mm (0.0012-0.0028 inch)
Pin
Bore
diameter................................................................................................................................................
22.008-22.014 mm (0.8665-0.8667 inch) Pin
diameter..............................................................................................................................................
22.0010-22.0030 mm (0.8662-0.8663 inch) Length.............................................................................
............................................................................................................. 61.8 mm (2.433 inch)
Pin-to-piston
fit.................................................................................................................................................
0.005-0.013 mm (0.0002-0.0005 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Piston: Procedures
Piston Inspection
Special Tool(s)
CAUTION: Do not use a caustic cleaning solution or a wire brush to clean the pistons or damage
can occur.
1. Clean and inspect the (1) ring lands, (2) skirts, (3) pin bosses and the (4) tops of the pistons. If
wear marks, scores or glazing is found on the piston
skirt, check for a bent or twisted connecting rod.
2. Use the Piston Ring Groove Scraper to clean the piston ring grooves.
^ Make sure the oil ring holes are clean.
Piston Pin to Bore Diameter
1. WARNING: Cover the end of the pin bore with a hand or shop rag when removing the retainer
ring, since it has a tendency to spring
out. Wear eye protection.
NOTE: Piston and piston pins are a matched set and should not be interchanged.
Measure the piston pin bore diameter in 2 directions on each side. Verify the diameter is within
specification. ^
If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2183
Piston Diameter
1. Measure the piston diameter 90 degrees from the piston pin and 42 mm down from the top of the
piston at the point indicated.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Piston To Cylinder Bore Clearance
1. Subtract the piston diameter from the cylinder bore diameter to find the piston-to-cylinder bore
clearance.
Piston Selection
NOTE: The cylinder bore must be within the specifications for taper and out-of-round before fitting
a piston.
1. Select a piston size based on the cylinder bore.
2. NOTE: For precision fit, new pistons are divided into 3 categories within each size range based
on their relative position within the range. A paint
spot on the new pistons indicates the position within the size range.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2184
Choose the piston with the correct paint color.
Piston Ring End Gap
CAUTION: Use care when fitting piston rings to avoid possible damage to the piston ring or the
cylinder bore.
CAUTION: Piston rings should not be transferred from one piston to another.
NOTE: Cylinder bore must be within specification for taper and out-of-round.
1. Use a piston without rings to push a piston ring in a cylinder to the bottom of ring travel.
2. Use a feeler gauge to measure the top piston ring end gap and the second piston ring end gap.
Piston Ring-to-Groove Clearance
1. Inspect the piston for ring land damage or accelerated wear.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2185
2. Measure the piston ring-to-groove clearance.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Piston Pin Diameter
1. Measure the piston pin diameter in 2 directions at the points shown. Verify the diameter is within
specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2186
Piston: Overhaul
Piston
Material
Disassembly
1. Remove the piston rings from the piston. - Discard the piston rings. 2. Remove the piston pin
retainers and the piston pin. 3. Separate the piston from the connecting rod. 4. Clean and inspect
the piston and connecting rod.
Assembly
1. NOTE: The connecting rod must be installed into the piston with identification markings toward
the front.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2187
Position the connecting rod in the piston.
2. Lubricate the piston pin and pin bore with clean engine oil. 3. Install the piston pin in the piston
and connecting rod assembly. 4. Install the piston pin retaining clips in the piston. 5. Lubricate the
piston and the new piston rings with clean engine oil. 6. Install the piston rings onto the piston.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston Ring: Specifications
Piston Ring
End gap
Top ......................................................................................................................................................
.................... 0.15-0.30 mm (0.006-0.012 inch) Intermediate...............................................................
........................................................................................... 0.25-0.50 mm (0.0098-0.0197 inch) Oil c
ontrol.....................................................................................................................................................
........ 0.15-0.65 mm (0.0059-0.0256 inch)
Groove width
Top.......................................................................................................................................................
................. 1.52-1.55 mm (0.0598-0.0610 inch) Intermediate..............................................................
............................................................................................ 1.52-1.54 mm (0.0598-0.0606 inch) Oil c
ontrol.....................................................................................................................................................
.... 3.030-3.050 mm (0.1193-0.1201 inch)
Ring width - top and
intermediate...............................................................................................................................
1.50-1.47 mm (0.0590-0.0578 inch) Ring-to-groove clearance
Top ......................................................................................................................................................
............ 0.020-0.080 mm (0.0008-0.0031 inch) Intermediate...............................................................
....................................................................................... 0.030-0.070 mm (0.0012-0.0028 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
This engine is equipped with hydraulic lash adjusters. No adjustment is required.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing a fire hazard. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the Schrader valve cap and attach the pressure gauge.
3. NOTE: Open manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from the
fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the pressure gauge and relieve the fuel pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Rocker Arm Assembly: Testing and Inspection
Roller Follower Inspection
1. Inspect the roller follower for flat spots or scoring. If any damage is found, inspect the camshaft
lobes and hydraulic lash adjuster for damage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2201
Rocker Arm Assembly: Service and Repair
Camshaft Roller Follower
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. Depending on the camshaft roller follower being serviced, remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2.
Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with the
intake valve and the exhaust valves closed.
3. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same position.
Mark the components for installation
into the original location.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller follower.
4. Repeat the previous 2 steps for each camshaft roller follower being serviced. 5. Inspect the
camshaft roller follower.
Installation
1. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same position.
Mark the components for installation
into the original locations.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller follower.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2202
2. Repeat the previous step for each camshaft roller follower being serviced. 3. Depending on the
camshaft roller follower being serviced, install the LH or RH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Cover - LH
Valve Cover - LH
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2207
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2208
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2209
Removal
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction. 2. Remove the degas bottle. For additional information, refer to Cooling System. 3.
Remove the LH ignition coils. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 4. Disconnect the
quick connect couplings and remove the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) tube. For additional
information, refer to Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction.
5. Remove the bolt and position the oil level indicator tube aside. 6. Disconnect the LH radio
ignition interference capacitor electrical connector. 7. Disconnect the LH variable camshaft timing
(VCT) solenoid electrical connector and the wiring harness retainers. 8. Disconnect the intake
manifold vacuum tube hose from the brake booster. 9. Disconnect the intake manifold vacuum tube
assembly from the support bracket and the valve cover stud and position aside.
10. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
tools cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
CAUTION: When removing the valve cover, make sure to avoid damaging the VCT solenoid.
NOTE: The fasteners are part of the valve cover and should not be removed.
Fully loosen the 15 fasteners and remove the LH valve cover and gasket. ^
Clean the valve cover mating surface of the cylinder head with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
^ Discard the valve cover gasket. Clean the valve cover gasket groove with soap and water or a
suitable solvent.
Installation
1. NOTE: If the valve cover is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the
sealing area cleaned with metal surface prep
and silicone gasket remover. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no
sign of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future
oil leakage.
Apply a bead of silicone gasket and sealant in 2 places where the engine front cover meets the
cylinder head.
2. CAUTION: When installing the valve cover, make sure to avoid damaging the VCT solenoid.
Position the LH valve cover and new gasket on the cylinder head and tighten the fasteners in the
sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2210
3. Position the intake manifold vacuum tube assembly onto the support bracket and the valve cover
stud. 4. Connect the intake manifold vacuum tube hose to the brake booster. 5. Connect the VCT
solenoid electrical connector and the wiring harness retainers. 6. Connect the radio ignition
interference capacitor electrical connector. 7. Position the oil level indicator tube and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
8. Position the PCV tube and connect the quick connect couplings. For additional information, refer
to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 9. Install the LH ignition coils. For additional information, refer to
Ignition System.
10. Install the degas bottle. 11. Install the air cleaner outlet pipe. For additional information, refer to
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2211
Valve Cover: Service and Repair Valve Cover - RH
Valve Cover - RH
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2212
Removal
All vehicles
1. Recover the refrigerant. For additional information, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning.
Vehicles with auxiliary heat
2. Drain the cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System. 3. Disconnect the
2 auxiliary heat coolant hoses.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2213
4. Disconnect the coolant hose from the intake manifold and position the coolant hose assembly
aside.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the crankcase vent tube. For additional
information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 6. Remove the nut and the ground cable and
disconnect the wiring harness retainer.
7. Disconnect the powertrain control module (PCM) electrical connector.
8. Disconnect the 2 electrical connectors and the wiring harness retainer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2214
9. Disconnect the evaporator outlet and inlet fittings.
^ Discard the O-ring seals.
10. Disconnect the RH radio ignition interference capacitor and engine cooling fan clutch electrical
connectors.
11. Remove the RH ignition coils. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 12.
Disconnect the RH variable camshaft timing (VCT) solenoid electrical connector. 13. Disconnect
the RH camshaft position (CMP) sensor electrical connector.
14. Disconnect the 2 engine wiring harness retainers from the RH valve cover studs.
15. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
tools cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
CAUTION: When removing the valve cover, make sure to avoid damaging the VCT solenoid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2215
NOTE: The fasteners are part of the valve cover and should not be removed.
Fully loosen the 15 fasteners and remove the RH valve cover and gasket. ^
Clean the valve cover mating surface of the cylinder head with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
^ Discard the valve cover gasket. Clean the valve cover gasket groove with soap and water or a
suitable solvent.
Installation
All vehicles
1. NOTE: If the valve cover is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the
sealing area cleaned with metal surface prep
and silicone gasket remover. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no
sign of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future
oil leakage.
Apply a bead of silicone gasket and sealant in 2 places where the engine front cover meets the
cylinder head.
2. CAUTION: When installing the valve cover, make sure to avoid damaging the VCT solenoid.
Position the LH valve cover and new gasket on the cylinder head and tighten the fasteners in the
sequence shown. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
3. Install the RH ignition coils. For additional information, refer to Ignition System.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2216
4. Using new O-ring seals, connect the evaporator outlet and inlet fittings.
^ Lubricate the O-ring seals with PAG oil prior to installation.
5. Connect the 2 electrical connectors and the wiring harness retainer.
6. Connect the PCM electrical connector.
7. Connect the wiring harness retainer and ground cable and install the nut.
^ tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
8. Connect the RH radio ignition interference capacitor and engine cooling fan clutch electrical
connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Cover - LH > Page 2217
9. Connect the RH VCT solenoid electrical connector.
10. Connect the wiring harness retainers to the valve cover. 11. Position the crankcase vent tube
and connect the quick connect couplings. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction.
Vehicles with auxiliary heat
12. Position the coolant hose assembly and connect the coolant hose to the intake manifold.
13. Connect the 2 auxiliary heat coolant hoses.
14. Fill and bleed the coolant system.
All vehicles
15. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system. For additional information, refer to
Heating and Air Conditioning.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Valve Guide: Service and Repair
Valve Guide Inner Diameter
1. NOTE: Valve guides tend to wear in an hourglass pattern. The ball gauge can be inserted into
the combustion chamber side of the valve guide if
necessary.
Use a ball gauge to determine the inner diameter of the valve guides in 2 directions at the top,
middle and bottom of the valve guide.
2. Measure the ball gauge with a micrometer.
3. If the valve guide is not within specifications, ream the valve guide and install a valve with an
oversize stem or remove the valve guide and install
a new valve guide.
Valve Guide Reaming
1. Use a hand-reaming kit to ream the valve guide. 2. Reface the valve seat. 3. Clean the sharp
edges left by reaming.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Seat > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Valve Seat: Service and Repair
Valve Seat Inspection
Valve and Seat Refacing Measurements
CAUTION: After grinding valves or valve seats, check valve clearance.
1. Check the valve head and seat.
^ Check valve angles.
^ Check margin width.
^ Be sure margin width is within specification.
2. Inspect for abnormalities on the valve face and seat.
Valve Seat Width
1. Measure the valve seat width. If necessary, grind the valve seat to specification.
^ Measure the intake valve seat width.
^ Measure the exhaust valve seat width.
^ Recheck the valve spring installed length after the seats have been ground, and shim the valve
springs as necessary to achieve the correct installed spring length.
Valve Seat Runout
1. Use the Valve Seat Runout Gauge to check valve seat runout.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Spring Inspection
Valve Spring: Service and Repair Valve Spring Inspection
Valve Spring Installed Length
1. Measure the installed length of each valve spring.
^ If out of specification, install new components.
Valve Spring Free Length
1. Measure the free length of each valve spring.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Valve Spring Squareness
1. NOTE: This procedure only applies to cylindrical valve springs.
Measure the out-of-square on each valve spring. ^
Turn the valve spring and observe the space between the top of the valve spring and the square.
Install a new valve spring if out of square.
Valve Spring Strength
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Spring Inspection > Page 2228
Special Tool(s)
1. Use a Valve/Clutch Spring Pressure Gauge to check the valve spring for correct strength at the
specified valve spring length.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Spring Inspection > Page 2229
Valve Spring: Service and Repair Valve Springs
Valve Springs
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. Depending on the valve spring being serviced, remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2. Remove the
spark plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 3. Rotate the crankshaft until the
piston for the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with the intake valve and the exhaust
valves closed.
4. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation
into the original locations.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller follower.
5. Use compressed air in the cylinder to hold both valves in position.
^ Apply a minimum of 965 kPa (140 psi) of compressed air into the cylinder.
6. CAUTION: If air pressure has forced the piston to the bottom of the cylinder, any loss of air
pressure will allow the valve to fall into the
cylinder. If air pressure must be removed, support the valve prior to removal.
CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same position.
Mark the components for location.
NOTE: If a valve drops into the cylinder, remove the cylinder head.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the valve spring retainer keys.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Valve Spring Inspection > Page 2230
7. Remove the valve spring retainer and the valve spring. 8. Inspect the valve spring.
Installation
1. Using the special tool, install the valve spring, the valve spring retainer and the valve spring
retainer keys.
2. Relieve the air pressure from the cylinder.
3. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation
into the original locations.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller follower with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller follower.
4. Install the spark plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 5. Depending on the
valve spring being serviced, install the LH or RH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Valve: Testing and Inspection
Valve Inspection
1. Inspect these valve areas:
1 the end of the stem for grooves or scoring
2 the valve face and the edge for pits, grooves or scores
3 the valve head for signs of burning, erosion, warpage and cracking
4 the valve margin for wear
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2234
Valve: Service and Repair
Valve Stem Diameter
1. Measure the diameter of each intake and exhaust valve stem at the points shown. Verify the
diameter is within specification.
^ If out of specification, install new components as necessary.
Valve Stem to Valve Guide Clearance
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: Valve stem diameter must be within specifications before checking valve stem to valve
guide clearance.
1. NOTE: If necessary, use a magnetic base.
Install a Valve Stem Clearance Tool on the valve stem and install a Dial Indicator with Bracketry.
Lower the valve until the Valve Stem Clearance Tool contacts the upper surface of the valve guide.
2. Move the Valve Stem Clearance Tool toward the indicator and zero the indicator. Move the
Valve Stem Clearance Tool away from the indicator
and note the reading. The reading will be DOUBLE the valve stem-to-valve guide clearance.
Valves with oversize stems will need to be installed if out of specification.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Drive Belt: > 09-9-7 > May > 09 >
Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
Drive Belt: Customer Interest Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
TSB 09-9-7
05/18/09
COLD START FEAD HOOT - WHISTLE NOISE
FORD: 2007-2008 Mustang, Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-150
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LT, Navigator
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 8-4-2 to remove the production build date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 F-150, Mustang vehicles equipped with a 4.6L and 5.4L engine;
2007-2008 Mark LT, Expedition, Navigator vehicles equipped with a 5.4L engine; Explorer,
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac vehicles with 4.6L engine may exhibit a front end accessory drive
(FEAD) related high-pitched metallic whistle/hoot noise after a cold soak in ambient temperatures
below 40 °F (4.4 °C). This noise may be caused by the grooved nylon FEAD idler pulley.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
FEAD IDLER PULLEY NOISE MAY BE MOST APPARENT AT OR NEAR COLD ENGINE IDLE
SPEEDS (APPROXIMATELY 1200 RPM). NOISE DURATION IS LESS THAN 10 MINUTES
AFTER STARTUP AND WILL BE ELIMINATED WITH FEAD BELT REMOVED.
1. Replace the nylon FEAD idler pulley, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 303-05.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
090907A 2007-2008 F-150/Mark LT 0.3 Hr.
4.6L/5.4L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do
Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine
Belt (Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Explorer/Mountaineer/
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Drive Belt: > 09-9-7 > May > 09 >
Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start > Page 2244
Sport Trac 4.6L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt
(Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 Mustang 4.6L: 0.3 Hr.
Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do Not Use With
8678A, 8620F)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6C348 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 09-9-7 > May
> 09 > Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
Drive Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
TSB 09-9-7
05/18/09
COLD START FEAD HOOT - WHISTLE NOISE
FORD: 2007-2008 Mustang, Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-150
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LT, Navigator
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 8-4-2 to remove the production build date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 F-150, Mustang vehicles equipped with a 4.6L and 5.4L engine;
2007-2008 Mark LT, Expedition, Navigator vehicles equipped with a 5.4L engine; Explorer,
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac vehicles with 4.6L engine may exhibit a front end accessory drive
(FEAD) related high-pitched metallic whistle/hoot noise after a cold soak in ambient temperatures
below 40 °F (4.4 °C). This noise may be caused by the grooved nylon FEAD idler pulley.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
FEAD IDLER PULLEY NOISE MAY BE MOST APPARENT AT OR NEAR COLD ENGINE IDLE
SPEEDS (APPROXIMATELY 1200 RPM). NOISE DURATION IS LESS THAN 10 MINUTES
AFTER STARTUP AND WILL BE ELIMINATED WITH FEAD BELT REMOVED.
1. Replace the nylon FEAD idler pulley, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 303-05.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
090907A 2007-2008 F-150/Mark LT 0.3 Hr.
4.6L/5.4L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do
Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine
Belt (Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Explorer/Mountaineer/
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 09-9-7 > May
> 09 > Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start > Page 2250
Sport Trac 4.6L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt
(Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 Mustang 4.6L: 0.3 Hr.
Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do Not Use With
8678A, 8620F)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6C348 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2251
Drive Belt: Locations
Accessory Drive
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2252
Drive Belt: Diagrams
Accessory Drive
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2253
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
Accessory Drive
The accessory drive system:
- has a single serpentine drive belt (6 ribs). - has 3 idler pulleys. - has an automatic belt tensioner. is not adjustable.
The accessory drive system provides power to operate components which power other systems.
These could include components such as the generator, power steering pump, and A/C
compressor. Each of these components is equipped with a pulley which is driven by the accessory
drive belt. The accessory drive belt is driven by the engine crankshaft pulley. One or more idler
pulleys may be provided to facilitate belt routing and alignment. The automatic belt tensioner
maintains correct belt tension and compensates for component wear and changes in system load.
System load changes can be caused by the A/C compressor clutch engaging and disengaging, or
demand changes on other systems powered by the accessory drive belt. To maintain correct
operation of this stem, it is critical that the correct length drive belt be installed. The pulleys must
also be correctly aligned and kept clean.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Drive Belt: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
CAUTION: Under no circumstances should the accessory drive belt, tensioner or pulleys be
lubricated as potential damage to the belt material and tensioner damping mechanism will occur.
Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
1. Verify the customer concern by operating the system. 2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of
mechanical damage.
Visual Inspection Chart
Visual Inspection Chart
3. Eliminate all other non-belt related noises that could cause belt misdiagnosis, such as A/C
compressor engagement chirp, power steering
cavitations at low temperatures, variable camshaft timing (VCT) tick or generator whine.
4. If a concern is found, correct the condition before proceeding to the next step.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Drive Belt With Cracks Across Ribs
5. NOTE: Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be considered
acceptable. If damage exceeds the acceptable limit or
any chunks are found to be missing from the ribs, a new belt must be installed.
Check the belt for cracks. Up to 15 cracks in a rib over a distance of 100 mm (4.0 inch) can be
considered acceptable. If cracks exceed this standard, install a new belt.
6. The condition of the V-ribbed drive belt should be compared against the illustration and
appropriate action taken.
1 Small scattered deposits of rubber material. This is not a concern, therefore, installation of a new
belt is not required.
2 Longer deposit areas building up to 50% of the rib height. This is not considered a concern but it
can result in excessive noise. If noise is apparent, install a new belt.
3 Heavy deposits building up along the grooves resulting in a possible noise and belt stability
concern. If heavy deposits are apparent, install a new belt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2256
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Piling
7. There should be no chunks missing from the belt ribs. If the belt shows any evidence of this,
install a new accessory drive belt.
V-Ribbed Serpentine Belt With Chunks of Rib Missing
8. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom and GO to Symptom Chart. See:
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2257
Drive Belt: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2258
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2259
Drive Belt: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
Drive Belt - Noise/Flutter
Drive belt chirp occurs due to pulley misalignment or excessive pulley runout. It can be the result of
a damaged or incorrectly aligned grooved pulley.
To correct, determine the area where the noise comes from. Check each of the pulleys in that area
with a straightedge to the crankshaft pulley. Look for accessory pulleys out of position in the fore/aft
direction or at an angle to the straightedge.
CAUTION: Do not apply any fluids or belt dressing to the accessory drive belt or pulleys.
Drive belt squeal may be an intermittent or constant noise that occurs when the drive belt slips on
an accessory pulley under certain conditions.
A short intermittent squeal may occur during engine start-up and shut down or during very rapid
engine acceleration and decelerations, such as: ^
wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts or 2-3 and 3-4 back out shifts on automatic transmissions.
^ wide open throttle 1-2 and 2-3 shifts and any combination of rapid downshifting on manual
transmissions.
These special short-term transient events are expected, and are due to the higher system inertias
required to meet the electrical and cooling demands on today's vehicle systems. Constant or
reoccurring drive belt squeal can occur: ^
if the A/C discharge pressure goes above specifications: the A/C system is overcharged.
- the A/C condenser core airflow is blocked.
^ if the A/C off equalized pressure (the common discharged and suction pressure that occurs after
several minutes) exceeds specifications.
^ if any of the accessories are damaged or have a worn or damaged bearing. All accessories
should be rotatable by hand in the unloaded condition. If not, inspect the accessory.
^ if there is evidence of fluid contamination on the accessory drive belt. When the drive belt has
been exposed to fluid contamination during vehicle operation, such as leaks from the power
steering system, A/C system or cooling system, clean all pulleys with soap and water, rinse with
clean water and install a new accessory drive belt. If the drive belt has been exposed to fluids in a
localized area during routine vehicle service, such as replacement of hoses or fluids, the drive belt
and pulleys should be washed with soap and water immediately (prior to starting the engine), and
rinsed with clean water.
^ if the accessory drive belt is too long. A drive belt that is too long will allow the accessory drive
belt tensioner arm to go all the way to the arm travel stop under certain load conditions, which will
release tension to the drive belt. If the accessory drive belt tensioner indicator is outside the normal
installation wear range window, install a new accessory drive belt.
^ NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner arm should rotate freely without binding.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if the drive belt tensioner is worn or damaged.
Drive Belt - Incorrect Installation
Drive Belt - Incorrect Installation
CAUTION: Incorrect accessory drive belt installation will cause excessive drive belt wear and can
cause the drive belt to come off the pulleys.
Non-standard accessory drive belts can track differently or incorrectly. If an accessory drive belt
tracks incorrectly, install a new accessory drive belt to avoid performance failure or loss of the drive
belt.
Incorrect Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 2260
Correct Installation
With the engine running, check accessory drive belt tracking on all pulleys. If the edge of the
accessory drive belt rides beyond the edge of the pulleys, noise and premature wear will occur.
Make sure the accessory drive belt rides correctly on the pulley. If an accessory drive belt tracking
condition exists: ^
Visually check the accessory drive belt tensioner for damage, especially the mounting pad surface.
If the accessory drive belt tensioner is not installed correctly, the mounting surface pad will be out
of position. This will result in chirp and squeal noises.
^ With the engine running, visually observe the grooves in the pulleys (not the pulley flanges or the
pulley forward faces) for excessive wobble. Install new components as necessary.
^ Check all accessories, mounting brackets and the accessory drive belt tensioner for any
interference that would prevent the component from mounting correctly. Correct any interference
condition and recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
^ Tighten all accessories, mounting brackets and accessory drive belt tensioner retaining hardware
to specification. Recheck the accessory drive belt tracking.
Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
Belt Tensioner - Mechanical
The only mechanical check that needs to be made is a check for tensioner stick, grab or bind. 1.
With the engine off, check routing of the accessory drive belt.
2. NOTE: The accessory drive belt tensioner spring is very strong and requires substantial force to
release.
Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, release the tension
on the belt and detach the accessory drive belt in the area of the tensioner.
3. Using a suitable, commercially available serpentine belt tensioner release tool, move the
tensioner from its relaxed position, through its full stroke
and back to the relaxed position to make sure there is no stick, grab or bind, and to make sure that
there is tension on the tensioner spring.
4. Rotate the tensioner pulley by hand and check for a binding, contaminated or seized condition.
Install a new accessory drive belt tensioner if
necessary.
5. Inspect the area surrounding the accessory drive belt tensioner for oil leaks or contamination
and repair any leaks. Install a new accessory drive
belt tensioner as necessary.
6. If the accessory drive belt tensioner meets the above criteria, proceed to testing the tensioner
dynamically. If the accessory drive belt tensioner
does not meet the above criteria, install a new tensioner.
Belt Tensioner - Dynamics
Belt Tensioner - Dynamics
The accessory drive belt tensioner can be checked dynamically as follows: 1. With the engine
running, observe the accessory drive belt tensioner movement. The accessory drive tensioner
should move (respond) when the air
conditioning clutch cycles (if equipped), or when the engine is accelerated rapidly. If the accessory
drive belt tensioner movement is excessive without air conditioning clutch cycling or engine
acceleration, check belt rideout. Excessive belt rideout (uneven depth of grooves in the belt) can
cause excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement. Check rideout condition by installing a
new belt. If excessive accessory drive belt tensioner movement still exists, install a new accessory
drive belt tensioner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2261
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
Accessory Drive
Removal
1. Rotate the drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the drive belt.
Installation
1. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Drive
Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Service and Repair
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair
Accessory Drive Belt Tensioner
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the cooling fan. For additional information, refer to Cooling System. 2. Rotate the
accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from the A/C
compressor pulley.
3. Remove the 3 bolts and the accessory drive belt tensioner.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair
Engine Mount: Service and Repair
Engine Support Insulators
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2268
LH Engine Support Insulator
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2269
RH Engine Support Insulator
Removal
All engine support insulators
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional
information, refer to Battery. 3. Remove the throttle body (TB). For additional information, refer to
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 4. Remove the cooling fan. For additional information, refer to
Cooling System. 5. Remove the generator. For additional information, refer to Alternator. 6.
Remove the starter. For additional information, refer to Starting System.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2270
7. If servicing the engine support insulators on a four wheel drive (4WD) vehicle, remove the front
drive shaft. 8. Install the special tools.
9. Remove the 4 exhaust manifold-to-catalytic converter nuts.
10. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts
or damage to the transmission mount can
occur.
Loosen the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts.
RH engine support insulator
11. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when loosening the engine support insulator through bolts or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-cylinder block bracket can occur.
Loosen the LH engine support insulator through bolt.
12. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the engine support insulator through bolts or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-cylinder block bracket can occur.
Remove the RH engine support insulator through bolt.
13. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the engine support insulator nuts or damage to
the engine support insulator can occur.
NOTE: If during nut removal the stud bolt is extracted from the engine support insulator, separate
the nut from the stud bolt prior to stud bolt installation.
Remove the 2 RH engine support insulator nuts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2271
14. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the engine support insulator stud bolts or
damage to the engine support insulator can
occur.
Remove the 2 RH engine support insulator stud bolts.
15. Using the special tools, raise the engine.
16. Remove the 3 bolts and the RH engine support insulator-to-cylinder block bracket. 17. Remove
the RH engine support insulator. LH engine support insulator
18. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when loosening the engine support insulator through bolts or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-cylinder block bracket can occur.
Loosen the RH engine support insulator through bolt.
19. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the engine support insulator through bolts or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-cylinder block bracket can occur.
Remove the LH engine support insulator through bolt.
20. Using the special tools, raise the engine.
21. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the engine support insulator-to-frame bolts or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-frame nut plate can occur.
Remove the 3 engine support insulator-to-frame bolts. ^
Discard the 3 bolts.
22. Remove the 3 bolts and the LH engine support insulator-to-cylinder block bracket. 23. Remove
the LH engine support insulator. 24. Inspect the engine support insulator-to-frame nut plate for
thread damage. If the nut plate is damaged, bend 2 tabs back and remove the nut plate.
Replace the nut plate with service part number 56190 and bend the 2 tabs back to the original
position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2272
Installation
RH engine support insulator
1. Clean the engine support insulator-to-cylinder block and engine support insulator-to-frame
mating surfaces of any dirt or foreign material prior to
installation.
2. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when installing the engine support insulator stud bolts or
damage to the engine support insulator can
occur.
Position the RH engine support insulator into the vehicle and install the 2 stud bolts. ^
Tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
3. Position the RH engine support insulator-to-cylinder block bracket and install the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs.)
4. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when installing the RH engine support insulator nuts or damage
to the engine support insulator can
occur.
Install the 2 RH engine support insulator nuts. ^
Tighten to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs.)
LH engine support insulator
5. Clean the engine support insulator-to-cylinder block and engine support insulator-to-frame
mating surfaces of any dirt or foreign material prior to
installation.
6. Position the LH engine support insulator and hand start the 3 new engine support
insulator-to-frame bolts.
^ Tighten to 175 Nm (129 ft. lbs.)
7. Position the LH engine support insulator-to-cylinder block bracket and install the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 63 Nm (46 ft. lbs.)
All engine support insulator
8. Using the special tools, lower the engine into position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2273
9. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when installing the engine support insulator through bolt or
damage to the engine support
insulator-to-cylinder block bracket can occur.
Install the LH and RH engine support insulator bolts. ^
Apply Threadlock 262 to the bolt threads prior to installation.
^ Tighten to 350 Nm (258 ft. lbs.)
10. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when installing the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts or
damage to the transmission mount can
occur.
Install the transmission mount-to-crossmember nuts. ^
Tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.)
11. Position the Y-pipe and install the 4 nuts.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
12. Remove the special tools.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2274
13. Install the starter. For additional information, refer to Starting System. 14. If servicing the engine
support insulator on a 4WD vehicle, install the front driveshaft. 15. Install the generator. For
additional information, refer to Alternator. 16. Install the cooling fan. 17. Install the TB. For
additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 18. Connect the battery ground
cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-9-7 > May > 09 > Engine - FEAD
Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
Idler Pulley: Customer Interest Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
TSB 09-9-7
05/18/09
COLD START FEAD HOOT - WHISTLE NOISE
FORD: 2007-2008 Mustang, Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-150
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LT, Navigator
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 8-4-2 to remove the production build date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 F-150, Mustang vehicles equipped with a 4.6L and 5.4L engine;
2007-2008 Mark LT, Expedition, Navigator vehicles equipped with a 5.4L engine; Explorer,
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac vehicles with 4.6L engine may exhibit a front end accessory drive
(FEAD) related high-pitched metallic whistle/hoot noise after a cold soak in ambient temperatures
below 40 °F (4.4 °C). This noise may be caused by the grooved nylon FEAD idler pulley.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
FEAD IDLER PULLEY NOISE MAY BE MOST APPARENT AT OR NEAR COLD ENGINE IDLE
SPEEDS (APPROXIMATELY 1200 RPM). NOISE DURATION IS LESS THAN 10 MINUTES
AFTER STARTUP AND WILL BE ELIMINATED WITH FEAD BELT REMOVED.
1. Replace the nylon FEAD idler pulley, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 303-05.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
090907A 2007-2008 F-150/Mark LT 0.3 Hr.
4.6L/5.4L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do
Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine
Belt (Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Explorer/Mountaineer/
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-9-7 > May > 09 > Engine - FEAD
Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start > Page 2283
Sport Trac 4.6L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt
(Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 Mustang 4.6L: 0.3 Hr.
Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do Not Use With
8678A, 8620F)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6C348 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-9-7 > May > 09 >
Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
Idler Pulley: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start
TSB 09-9-7
05/18/09
COLD START FEAD HOOT - WHISTLE NOISE
FORD: 2007-2008 Mustang, Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, Explorer, F-150, F-150
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LT, Navigator
MERCURY: 2007-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 8-4-2 to remove the production build date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 F-150, Mustang vehicles equipped with a 4.6L and 5.4L engine;
2007-2008 Mark LT, Expedition, Navigator vehicles equipped with a 5.4L engine; Explorer,
Mountaineer, Explorer Sport Trac vehicles with 4.6L engine may exhibit a front end accessory drive
(FEAD) related high-pitched metallic whistle/hoot noise after a cold soak in ambient temperatures
below 40 °F (4.4 °C). This noise may be caused by the grooved nylon FEAD idler pulley.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
FEAD IDLER PULLEY NOISE MAY BE MOST APPARENT AT OR NEAR COLD ENGINE IDLE
SPEEDS (APPROXIMATELY 1200 RPM). NOISE DURATION IS LESS THAN 10 MINUTES
AFTER STARTUP AND WILL BE ELIMINATED WITH FEAD BELT REMOVED.
1. Replace the nylon FEAD idler pulley, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 303-05.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
090907A 2007-2008 F-150/Mark LT 0.3 Hr.
4.6L/5.4L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do
Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine
Belt (Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 0.4 Hr.
Explorer/Mountaineer/
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-9-7 > May > 09 >
Engine - FEAD Idler Pulley Noise During Cold Start > Page 2289
Sport Trac 4.6L: Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt
(Do Not Use With 8678A, 8620F)
090907A 2007-2008 Mustang 4.6L: 0.3 Hr.
Replace FEAD Idler Pulley Includes Time To Remove And Install Serpentine Belt (Do Not Use With
8678A, 8620F)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
6C348 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: > 08-20-8 > Oct
> 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC
C1277/C1278 Set
TSB 08-20-8
10/13/08
STEERING WHEEL ANGLE CIRCUIT AND/OR SIGNAL FAILURE - C1277-C1278 - BUILT
ON/OR BEFORE 4/10/2008
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 08-10-3 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 4/10/2008 may
exhibit a traction control light (TCL) on with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1277 and/or C1278
(steering wheel angle 1 and 2 circuit failure and/or signal faulted).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check to see if the steering wheel rotation (SWR) sensor wiring near the connector has come in
contact with or is touching the brake pedal bracket. Vibration of the harness may cause interruption
in the SWR signal.
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, do not continue with this procedure. Refer to normal diagnosis in the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09.
2. Repair any chafing that may have occurred.
3. Move the harness towards the driver's side of the vehicle and tuck in front of the 14401 harness
above the steering column. Use a tie strap to secure in place.
4. Replace the SWR sensor following WSM, Section 206-09.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082008A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor, Includes Time To Reposition Harness,
Check DTCs, Repair Wires If Required, And Calibrate New Sensor. (Do Not Use With 12650D,
14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: > 08-20-8 > Oct
> 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set > Page 2295
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14401 12
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: > 08-14-2 > Jul
> 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon
ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: > 08-14-2 > Jul
> 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 2300
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: > 08-14-2 > Jul
> 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 2301
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: > 08-20-8 > Oct
> 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set > Page 2307
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14401 12
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: > 08-14-2 > Jul
> 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 2312
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Idler Pulley: > 08-14-2 > Jul
> 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 2313
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories > Idler
Pulley > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2314
Idler Pulley: Service and Repair
Accessory Drive Belt Idler Pulley
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the cooling fan. For additional information, refer to Cooling System. 2. Rotate the
accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from the A/C
compressor pulley.
3. Remove the bolt and the accessory drive belt idler pulley.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
4. Repeat the previous step for each accessory drive belt idler pulley being serviced. 5. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Oil pressure minimum @ 2,000 rpm (engine at normal operating
temperature)............................................................................................ 517 kPa (75 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2319
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Test
1. Disconnect and remove the oil pressure sensor from the engine. 2. Connect the Oil Pressure
Gauge to the oil pressure sender oil galley port. 3. Run the engine until normal operating
temperature is reached. 4. Run the engine at the specified rpm and record the gauge reading. 5.
The oil pressure should be within specifications. 6. If the pressure is not within specification, check
these possible sources:
^ Insufficient oil
^ Oil leakage
^ Worn or damaged oil pump
^ Oil pump screen cover and tube
^ Excessive main bearing clearance
^ Excessive connecting rod bearing clearance
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick
Tube > Component Information > Service and Repair
Engine Oil Dip Stick - Dip Stick Tube: Service and Repair
Oil Level Indicator and Tube
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH exhaust manifold. 2. Remove the oil level indicator and tube bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
3. Remove the oil level indicator and tube from the cylinder block.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
4. NOTE: Lubricate the new oil level indicator tube O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to
installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Install a new O-ring seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil
With Filter ............................................................................................................................................
............................................................. 6.6L (7.0 Qt)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2327
Engine Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
Engine Oil
U.S.A. ...................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Premium Synthetic Blend Motor Oil Canada
..................................................................................................................................................
Motorcraft SAE 5W-20 Super Premium Motor Oil
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................... XO-5W20-QSP (U.S.A) Ford P/N ............................................................
...................................................................................................................... CXO-5W20-LSP12
(Canada) Ford Specification
.........................................................................................................................................
WSS-M2C930-A with API Certification Mark
NOTE: Use of synthetic or synthetic blend motor oil is not mandatory. Engine oil need only meet
the requirements of Ford specification WSS-M2C930-A and the API Certification mark.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Filter Adapter: Service and Repair
Oil Filter Adapter
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter Adapter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2331
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the engine cooling system. For additional information,
refer to Cooling System. 3. Disconnect the lower radiator hose from the oil filter adapter and
position it aside. 4. Disconnect the degas bottle coolant hose from the oil filter adapter and position
it aside. 5. Remove and discard the engine oil filter.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
6. Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) switch electrical connector. 7. Remove the EOP
switch.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
8. Remove the 4 bolts and the oil filter adapter.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
9. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
may cause scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths. Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing
surfaces.
Remove and discard the oil filter adapter gasket. Clean the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket
remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Inspect the mating
surfaces.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Install a new oil filter.
^ Check the engine oil level and fill as necessary with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Pan: Specifications
Oil Pan Bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
............................................... 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.) Second pass .........................................................
................................................................................................................................. 20 Nm (15 ft.
lbs.) Final pass ....................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... Tighten 60°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2335
Oil Pan: Service and Repair
Oil Pan
Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2336
Material
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the engine oil. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the frame
crossmember.
4. Remove the nut and remove the starter wiring harness and transmission fluid cooler tube
support brackets from the stud bolt.
5. Disconnect the starter wiring harness retainer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2337
Four wheel drive (4WD) vehicles
6. Support the front axle housing with a jack stand.
7. NOTE: Mark the bolt and bracket so that alignment can be maintained on installation.
Remove the front axle housing RH mounting bolt.
8. NOTE: Mark the bolt and bracket so that alignment can be maintained on installation.
Remove the front axle housing LH front mounting bolt.
9. NOTE: Mark the bolt and bracket so that alignment can be maintained on installation.
Remove the front axle housing LH rear mounting bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2338
10. CAUTION: Use care when lowering the front axle housing, or the vacuum lines to the axle
solenoid may become disconnected or
damaged.
Lower the axle to allow clearance for the oil pan to be removed.
All vehicles
11. NOTE: Be careful when removing the oil pan gasket. It is reusable.
Remove the 16 bolts, the oil pan and the gaskets. ^
Inspect the oil pan gasket for damage.
^ If damaged, discard the oil pan gasket and the oil pan-to-oil pump gaskets.
Installation
All vehicles
1. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
tools cause scratches and gouges, which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove
all traces of old sealant.
Inspect the oil pan. Clean the mating surface for the oil pan with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
2. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness,
or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2339
Apply silicone gasket and sealant at the crankshaft rear seal retainer plate-to-cylinder block sealing
surface.
3. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness,
or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant at the engine front cover-to-cylinder block sealing surface.
4. Install the oil pan gasket and the oil pan and loosely install the 16 bolts.
5. Tighten the bolts in 3 stages, in the sequence shown.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.)
^ Stage 2: Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
^ Stage 3: Tighten an additional 60 degrees.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2340
4WD vehicles
6. CAUTION: Use care when positioning the front axle housing, or the vacuum lines to the axle
solenoid may become disconnected or
damaged.
Position the front axle housing and loosely install the 3 bolts, aligning the bolt location marks made
during removal.
7. Install the front axle housing RH mounting bolt.
^ Tighten to 89 Nm (66 ft. lbs.)
8. Install the front axle housing LH front mounting bolt.
^ Tighten to 89 Nm (66 ft. lbs.)
9. Install the front axle housing LH rear mounting bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2341
^ Tighten to 89 Nm (66 ft. lbs.)
All vehicles
10. Position the frame crossmember and the 4 bolts.
^ Tighten to 102 Nm (75 ft. lbs.)
11. Position the starter wiring harness and transmission fluid cooler tube support brackets and
install the nut.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
12. Connect the starter wiring harness retainer to the cylinder block.
13. Fill the crankcase with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2345
C103
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Sender >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2346
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) switch electrical
connector.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
3. Remove the EOP switch.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pick Up/Strainer > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pick Up/Strainer: Service and Repair
Oil Pump Screen and Pickup Tube
Engine Lubrication Components - Exploded View
Material
Removal
1. Remove the oil pan. 2. Remove the 3 bolts and the oil pump screen and pickup tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pick Up/Strainer > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 2350
Installation
1. CAUTION: Make sure the O-ring is in place and not damaged. A missing or damaged O-ring can
cause foam in the lubrication system,
low oil pressure and severe engine damage.
NOTE: Clean and inspect the mating surfaces and install a new O-ring. Lubricate the O-ring with
clean engine oil prior to installation.
Position the oil pump screen and pickup tube and install the bolts. ^
Tighten the oil pump screen and pickup tube-to-oil pump bolts to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
^ Tighten the oil pump screen and pickup tube-to-spacer bolt to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
2. Install the oil pan.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications
Oil pressure minimum @ 2,000 rpm (engine at normal operating
temperature)............................................................................................ 517 kPa (75 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine Oil
Pressure > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2355
Engine Oil Pressure: Testing and Inspection
Oil Pressure Test
1. Disconnect and remove the oil pressure sensor from the engine. 2. Connect the Oil Pressure
Gauge to the oil pressure sender oil galley port. 3. Run the engine until normal operating
temperature is reached. 4. Run the engine at the specified rpm and record the gauge reading. 5.
The oil pressure should be within specifications. 6. If the pressure is not within specification, check
these possible sources:
^ Insufficient oil
^ Oil leakage
^ Worn or damaged oil pump
^ Oil pump screen cover and tube
^ Excessive main bearing clearance
^ Excessive connecting rod bearing clearance
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch,
Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications
Intake Manifold: Specifications
Intake Manifold Bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
................................................ 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.) Final pass ............................................................
............................................................................................................................... 10 Nm (89 inch
lbs.)
TB Bolts
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
................................................ 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.) Final pass ............................................................
............................................................................................................................................. Tighten
90°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures
Intake Manifold: Procedures
Intake Manifold
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2364
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2365
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2367
Removal
WARNING: Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not
running. Before servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel
system pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Drain the cooling system. For additional information, refer to Cooling System. 2. Disconnect the
battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 3. Disconnect the fuel supply hose
spring lock coupling from the fuel rail. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction. 4. Remove the generator. For additional information, refer to Alternator. 5. Remove the
air cleaner outlet pipe. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 6.
Disconnect the crankcase ventilation tube quick connect coupling from the intake manifold. For
additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and
Air Induction.
7. Disconnect the quick connect coupling and remove the evaporative emissions system (EVAP)
hose from the intake manifold. For additional
information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction.
8. Disconnect the EVAP hose position retainer from the intake manifold.
9. Remove the 4 bolts and the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-TB adapter.
10. Disconnect the heater coolant hose from the coolant bypass tube. 11. Disconnect the quick
connect couplings and remove the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) tube. For additional
information, refer to Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction.
12. Disconnect the 8 fuel injector electrical connectors. 13. Disconnect the 8 ignition coil electrical
connectors. 14. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor and electronic acceleration control
electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2368
15. Disconnect the heated PCV intake fitting electrical connector. 16. Remove the intake manifold
vacuum tube support bracket bolt and disconnect the intake manifold vacuum tube-to-intake
manifold hose. 17. Disconnect the brake booster vacuum hose from the intake manifold vacuum
tube. 18. Disconnect the intake manifold vacuum tube support retainer from the valve cover and
position the intake manifold vacuum tube aside. 19. Remove the 10 intake manifold bolts. 20.
Disconnect the charge motion control valve (CMCV) electrical connector. 21. Disconnect the
cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper harness electrical connector.
22. Disconnect the LH and RH knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors.
23. Remove the nut and disconnect the engine wiring harness retainer from the CMCV stud.
24. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
tools cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Remove the intake manifold and discard the gaskets. ^
Inspect and clean the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow
the directions on the packaging.
Installation
1. NOTE: Electrical and vacuum harnesses must not restrict movement of the CMCV control rods
at rear of the intake manifold. Use extreme care
on installation of the intake manifold to prevent any pinching of electrical and vacuum harnesses.
Using new intake manifold gaskets, position the intake manifold.
2. Connect the engine wiring harness retainer to the CMCV stud and install the nut.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
3. Connect the CMCV electrical connector. 4. Connect the CHT sensor jumper harness electrical
connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2369
5. Connect the LH and RH KS electrical connectors.
6. Install the intake manifold bolts and tighten in 2 stages, in the sequence shown.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.)
^ Stage 2: Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
7. Install the intake manifold vacuum tube support bracket bolt and connect the intake manifold
vacuum tube-to-intake manifold hose.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
8. Connect the intake manifold vacuum tube support retainer to the valve cover and position the
intake manifold vacuum tube aside. 9. Connect the brake booster vacuum hose to the intake
manifold vacuum tube.
10. Connect the heated PCV intake fitting electrical connector. 11. Connect the TP sensor and
electronic acceleration control electrical connectors. 12. Connect the 8 fuel injector electrical
connectors. 13. Connect the 8 ignition coil electrical connectors. 14. Position the air cleaner outlet
pipe-to-TB adapter and install the 4 bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2370
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
15. Connect the crankcase ventilation tube quick connect coupling to the intake manifold. For
additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction.
16. Position the EVAP hose and connect the quick connect coupling to the intake manifold. For
additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air
Induction.
17. Connect the EVAP hose position retainer to the intake manifold.
18. Position the PCV tube and connect the quick connect couplings. For additional information,
refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 19. Connect the heater coolant hose to the coolant bypass.
20. Connect the fuel supply spring lock coupling to the fuel rail. For additional information, refer to
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 21. Install the generator. For additional information, refer to
Alternator. 22. Install the air cleaner outlet pipe. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction. 23. Connect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
24. Fill and bleed the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2371
Intake Manifold: Overhaul
Intake Manifold Assembly
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2372
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2373
Disassembly
1. Remove the 4 bolts, the vibration damper and the throttle body (TB). 2. Remove the 4 bolts and
the fuel rail. 3. Remove the fuel injector-to-fuel rail locking clips and separate the fuel injectors from
the fuel rail.
^ Discard the 2 O-ring seals from each fuel injector.
4. Remove the charge motion control valve (CMCV) rod locking clips. 5. Remove the stud bolt, the
2 bolts and the CMCV. 6. Remove the 2 bolts and the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV) heater
element.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
7. Remove the engine noise shield insulator from the intake manifold.
Assembly
1. Install the engine noise shield insulator onto the intake manifold.
2. NOTE: Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using a new O-ring seal, install the PCV heater element and the 2 bolts. ^
Tighten to 6 Nm (53 inch lbs.)
3. Position the CMCV and install the stud bolt and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
4. Install the CMCV rod locking clips.
5. NOTE: Lubricate the new O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install new O-ring seals on each of the fuel injectors.
6. Assemble the fuel injectors onto the fuel rail and install the locking clips. 7. Install the fuel rail
and fuel injector assembly onto the intake manifold. 8. Install the 4 fuel rail bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
9. NOTE: Lubricate the TB-to-intake manifold gasket with clean engine coolant prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Procedures > Page 2374
Install the TB, the vibration damper and tighten the bolts in 2 stages. ^
Stage 1: Tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
^ Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Seal
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Seal
Crankshaft Rear Seal
Flexplate or Flywheel and Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Seal > Page 2380
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Seal > Page 2381
1. Remove the transmission. 2. Remove the 8 bolts and the flexplate. 3. Using the special tools,
remove the crankshaft oil slinger.
^ Discard the crankshaft oil slinger.
4. Using the special tools, remove the crankshaft rear seal.
^ Discard the crankshaft rear seal.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the inner lip of the crankshaft rear seal with clean engine oil.
Using the special tools, install a new crankshaft rear seal.
2. Using the special tools, install a new crankshaft rear oil slinger.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Seal > Page 2382
3. Install the flexplate and tighten the 8 bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.)
4. Install the transmission.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Seal > Page 2383
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair Crankshaft Rear Seal With Retainer Plate
Crankshaft Rear Seal with Retainer Plate
Flexplate or Flywheel and Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Seal > Page 2384
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Seal > Page 2385
Material
Removal
1. Remove the transmission. 2. Remove the oil pan. 3. Remove the 8 bolts and the flexplate. 4.
Using the special tools, remove the crankshaft oil slinger.
^ Discard the crankshaft oil slinger.
5. Using the special tools, remove the crankshaft rear seal.
^ Discard the crankshaft rear seal.
6. Remove the 6 bolts and the crankshaft rear seal retainer plate.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
tools cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
NOTE: Clean the sealing surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging. Failure to follow
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Seal > Page 2386
this procedure can cause future oil leakage. Clean and inspect the mating surface.
2. NOTE: If the rear crankshaft seal retaining plate is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant
must be removed and the sealing area cleaned
with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow
to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this
procedure can cause future oil leaks.
NOTE: The silicone must be applied on the groove along the retainer plate.
Apply a 4.06 mm (0.16 inch) bead of silicone gasket and sealant around the crankshaft rear seal
retainer plate sealing surface.
3. Install the crankshaft rear seal retainer plate and the 6 bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
4. NOTE: Lubricate the inner lip of the crankshaft rear seal with clean engine oil.
Using the special tools, install a new crankshaft rear seal.
5. Using the special tools, install a new crankshaft rear oil slinger.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main Bearing
Seal > Component Information > Service and Repair > Crankshaft Rear Seal > Page 2387
6. Install the flexplate and tighten the 8 bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.)
7. Install the oil pan. 8. Install the transmission.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Front Seal
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2391
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Release the cooling fan shroud position tab and rotate the
shroud upward until the lower tab locks into position.
3. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from the crankshaft pulley.
4. Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt and washer.
^ Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2392
5. Using the special tool, remove the crankshaft pulley.
6. Using the special tool, remove and discard the crankshaft front seal.
Installation
1. Lubricate the engine front cover and the new crankshaft front seal inner lip with clean engine oil.
2. Using the special tools, install the new crankshaft front seal.
3. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with metal surface prep and silicone gasket
remover. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4
minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant to the Woodruff key slot in the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2393
4. Using the special tool, install the crankshaft pulley.
5. Using a new crankshaft pulley bolt, install the bolt and washer and tighten the bolt in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.)
^ Stage 2: Loosen 360 degrees.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.)
^ Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
6. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt onto the crankshaft pulley.
7. Release the cooling fan shroud position tab and rotate the shroud downward until the tab locks
into position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2394
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair
Valve Seals
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. Depending on the valve being serviced, remove the LH or RH valve cover. 2. Remove the spark
plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 3. Rotate the crankshaft until the piston for
the valve being serviced is at the top of its stroke with the intake valve and the exhaust valves
closed.
4. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation
into the original locations.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the camshaft roller follower.
5. Use compressed air in the cylinder to hold both valves in position.
^ Apply a minimum of 965 kPa (140 psi) of compressed air into the cylinder.
6. CAUTION: If air pressure has forced the piston to the bottom of the cylinder, any loss of air
pressure will allow the valve to fall into the
cylinder. If air pressure must be removed, support the valve prior to removal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2398
CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for locations.
NOTE: If a valve drops into the cylinder, remove the cylinder head.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and remove the valve spring retainer keys.
7. Remove the valve spring retainer, the valve spring and the valve seal.
^ Discard the valve seal.
8. Inspect the components.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the valve seal and valve stem with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Position a new valve seal onto the valve stem.
2. Using the special tool, install the new valve seal.
3. Using the special tool, install the valve spring, the valve spring retainer and the valve spring
retainer keys.
4. Relieve the air pressure from the cylinder.
5. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation
into the original locations.
NOTE: Lubricate the camshaft roller follower with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Using the special tool, compress the valve spring and install the camshaft roller follower.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2399
6. Install the spark plug. For additional information, refer to Ignition System. 7. Depending on the
valve being serviced, install the LH or RH valve cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2404
C103
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender
> Component Information > Locations > Page 2405
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) switch electrical
connector.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
3. Remove the EOP switch.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Temperature
Sensor/Switch, Engine > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Camshaft Gear/Sprocket: Service and Repair
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See: Camshaft,
Lifters and Push Rods/Camshaft/Service and Repair
2. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, remove the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See: Camshaft,
Lifters and Push Rods/Camshaft/Service and Repair
3. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: Do not remove the Timing Chain Locking Tool at any time during assembly. If the special
tool is removed or out of placement, the engine front cover must be removed and the engine must
be retimed. For additional information, refer to Timing Drive Components. See:
Remove the camshaft phaser and sprocket from the timing chain.
4. Inspect the front of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for missing or damaged roll pins.
- If the roll pins are missing or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be installed.
5. Inspect the rear of the camshaft phaser and sprocket for a deformed or damaged location pin.
- If the location pin is deformed or damaged, a new camshaft phaser and sprocket must be
installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Camshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2413
6. Visually inspect the camshaft phaser and sprocket for squareness (A). If the trigger wheel or
spring is deformed or damaged (B), install a new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
Installation
1. NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or
used as a lifting or leveraging device.
If installing a new camshaft phaser and sprocket, transfer the original scribe mark to the new
camshaft phaser and sprocket.
2. NOTICE: The timing chain must be installed in its original position onto the camshaft phaser and
sprocket using the scribed marks, or damage to
valves and pistons will result.
NOTICE: Damage to the camshaft phaser and sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used
as a lifting or leveraging device.
Align the scribe marks and position the camshaft phaser and sprocket into the timing chain.
3. If servicing the RH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the RH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - RH. See: Camshaft,
Lifters and Push Rods/Camshaft/Service and Repair
4. If servicing the LH camshaft phaser and sprocket, install the LH camshaft. For additional
information, refer to Camshaft - LH. See: Camshaft,
Lifters and Push Rods/Camshaft/Service and Repair
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket >
Component Information > Specifications
Crankshaft Gear/Sprocket: Specifications
Crankshaft Pulley Bolt
Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt.
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.) Second pass .......................................................
............................................................................................................................................. Loosen
360° Third pass ...................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.) Final pass ....................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
Tighten 90°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications
Timing Chain Tensioner: Specifications
Timing chain hydraulic tensioner bolts.................................................................................................
...................................................... 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2420
Timing Chain Tensioner: Service and Repair
Timing Drive Components
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. Remove the engine front cover. 2. Remove the crankshaft sensor ring from the crankshaft.
3. Position the crankshaft keyway at the 12 o'clock position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2421
4. NOTE: If the camshaft lobes are not exactly positioned as shown, the crankshaft will require one
full additional rotation to 12 o'clock.
The No. 1 cylinder camshaft exhaust lobe must be coming up on the exhaust stroke. Verify by
noting the position of the 2 intake camshaft lobes and the exhaust lobe on the No. 1 cylinder.
5. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation
into the original locations.
Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration from the RH cylinder head.
6. CAUTION: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2422
Using the special tool, remove the 3 designated camshaft roller followers in the previous step from
the RH cylinder head.
7. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation
into the original locations.
Remove only the 3 camshaft roller followers shown in the illustration from the LH cylinder head.
8. CAUTION: Do not allow the valve keepers to fall off the valve or the valve may drop into the
cylinder.
NOTE: It may be necessary to push the valve down while compressing the spring.
Using the special tool, remove the 3 designated camshaft roller followers in the previous step from
the LH cylinder head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2423
9. CAUTION: The crankshaft cannot be moved past the 6 o'clock position once set.
Rotate the crankshaft clockwise and position the crankshaft keyway at the 6 o'clock position.
10. CAUTION: If one or both of the tensioner mounting bolts are loosened or removed, the
tensioner-sealing bead must be inspected for seal
integrity. If cracks, tears, separation from the tensioner body or permanent compression of the seal
bead is observed, install a new tensioner.
Remove the bolts, the LH timing chain tensioner and tensioner arm.
11. CAUTION: If one or both of the tensioner mounting bolts are loosened or removed, the
tensioner-sealing bead must be inspected for seal
integrity. If cracks, tears, separation from the tensioner body or permanent compression of the seal
bead is observed, install a new tensioner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2424
Remove the bolts, the RH timing chain tensioner and tensioner arm.
12. Remove the RH and LH timing chains and the crankshaft sprocket.
^ Remove the RH timing chain from the camshaft sprocket.
^ Remove the RH timing chain from the crankshaft sprocket.
^ Remove the LH timing chain from the camshaft sprocket.
^ Remove the LH timing chain and crankshaft sprocket.
13. NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
Remove the LH and RH timing chain guides. ^
Remove the bolts.
^ Remove both timing chain guides.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2425
14. CAUTION: Damage to the variable camshaft timing (VCT) phaser sprocket assembly will occur
if mishandled or used as a lifting or
leveraging device.
CAUTION: Only use hand tools to remove the VCT phaser sprocket assembly or damage may
occur to the camshaft or VCT phaser sprocket.
Using the special tool, remove the bolt and the RH VCT phaser sprocket assembly. ^
Discard the VCT phaser sprocket bolt.
15. CAUTION: Damage to the VCT phaser sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used as a
lifting or leveraging device.
CAUTION: Only use hand tools to remove the VCT phaser sprocket assembly or damage may
occur to the camshaft or VCT phaser sprocket.
Using the special tool, remove the bolt and the LH VCT phaser sprocket assembly. ^
Discard the VCT phaser sprocket bolt.
16. CAUTION: When removing the front thrust camshaft bearing cap, use care as the cap may be
damaged from sideloading when
removing the cam unequally in height from the bearing towers.
NOTE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record camshaft
bearing cap locations.
Remove the bolts in the sequence shown and remove the RH cylinder head front camshaft bearing
cap and then the remaining bearing caps.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2426
17. Clean and inspect the RH camshaft bearing caps.
^ The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
18. Remove the RH camshaft.
19. CAUTION: When removing the front thrust camshaft bearing cap, use care as the cap may be
damaged from sideloading when
removing the cam unequally in height from the bearing towers.
NOTE: The camshaft bearing caps must be installed in their original locations. Record camshaft
bearing cap locations.
Remove the bolts in the sequence shown and remove the LH cylinder head front camshaft bearing
cap and then the remaining bearing caps.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2427
20. Clean and inspect the LH camshaft bearing caps.
^ The camshaft front thrust bearing cap contains an oil metering groove. Make sure the groove is
free of foreign material.
21. Remove the LH camshaft.
22. CAUTION: If the components are to be reinstalled, they must be installed in the same positions.
Mark the components for installation
into the original locations.
Remove all of the remaining camshaft roller followers from the cylinder heads.
Installation
1. Install the LH and RH camshafts.
^ Lubricate the camshaft and camshaft journals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
2. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the LH and RH camshaft bearing caps in their original locations. ^
Lubricate the camshaft bearing caps with clean engine oil.
^ Position the front camshaft bearing cap.
^ Position the remaining camshaft bearing caps.
^ Install the bolts loosely.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.) in the sequence shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2428
3. CAUTION: Damage to the VCT phaser sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used as a
lifting or leveraging device.
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Install the VCT phaser sprockets and new VCT phaser sprocket bolts finger tight.
4. CAUTION: Damage to the VCT phaser sprocket assembly will occur if mishandled or used as a
lifting or leveraging device.
CAUTION: Only use hand tools to remove the VCT phaser sprocket assembly or damage may
occur to the camshaft or VCT phaser sprocket.
NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Using the special tool, tighten the LH and RH VCT phaser sprocket bolts in 2 stages. ^
Stage 1: Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
^ Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2429
5. Position the crankshaft keyway at the 11 o'clock position.
6. CAUTION: Timing chain procedures must be followed exactly or damage to valves and pistons
will result.
CAUTION: Prior to installation, inspect the tensioner-sealing bead for seal integrity. If cracks, tears,
separation from the tensioner body or permanent compression of the seal bead is observed, install
a new tensioner.
Compress the tensioner plunger, using a vise.
7. Install a retaining clip on the tensioner to hold the plunger in during installation.
8. Remove the tensioner from the vise. 9. If the copper links are not visible, mark 2 links on one
end and 1 link on the other end, and use as timing marks.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2430
10. Install the crankshaft sprocket, making sure the flange faces forward.
11. Install the 4 bolts and the LH and RH timing chain guides.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
12. Position the lower end of the LH (inner) timing chain on the crankshaft sprocket, aligning the
timing mark on the outer flange of the crankshaft
sprocket with the single copper (marked) link on the chain.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2431
13. NOTE: Make sure the upper half of the timing chain is below the tensioner arm dowel.
Position the timing chain on the VCT phaser sprocket with the timing mark positioned between the
2 copper (marked) chain links.
14. NOTE: The LH timing chain tensioner arm has a bump near the dowel hole for identification.
Position the LH timing chain tensioner arm on the dowel pin and install the LH timing chain
tensioner and bolts. ^
Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
15. Remove the retaining clip from the LH timing chain tensioner.
16. Position the lower end of the RH (outer) timing chain on the crankshaft sprocket, aligning the
timing mark on the sprocket with the single copper
(marked) chain link.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2432
17. NOTE: The camshaft phaser and sprocket will be stamped with one of the illustrated timing
marks for the RH camshaft.
Position the RH timing chain on the VCT phaser sprocket with the timing mark positioned between
the 2 copper (marked) chain links.
18. Position the RH timing chain tensioner arm on the dowel pin and install the RH timing chain
tensioner and bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
19. Remove the retaining clip from the RH timing chain tensioner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2433
20. As a post-check, verify correct alignment of all timing marks.
21. Install the crankshaft sensor ring on the crankshaft.
22. Using the special tool, install all of the camshaft roller followers.
^ Lubricate the camshaft roller followers with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain Tensioner >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2434
23. Install the engine front cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications
Timing Cover: Specifications
Engine Front Cover Front Fasteners
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2438
First pass: fasteners 1-15 ....................................................................................................................
.................................................. 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs). Final pass: fasteners 6 & 7 .................................
................................................................................................................................... 48 Nm (35 ft.
lbs).
Engine Front Cover Lower Fasteners
First pass .............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs). Final pass ............................................................
............................................................................................................................................. Tighten
60°
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2439
Timing Cover: Service and Repair
Engine Front Cover
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2440
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2441
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2442
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2443
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2444
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the engine oil. 3. Remove the engine cooling fan. For
additional information, refer to Cooling System. 4. Remove the cooling fan shroud. For additional
information, refer to Cooling System. 5. Remove the RH valve cover. 6. Remove the LH valve
cover. 7. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt.
8. Remove the nut and the power steering pressure hose support bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2445
9. Remove the nut and the battery wiring harness and transmission cooler tube support brackets.
10. Remove the crankshaft pulley bolt and washer. - Discard the crankshaft pulley bolt. 11. Using
the special tool, remove the crankshaft pulley.
12. Using the special tool, remove and discard the crankshaft front seal.
13. Remove the 3 bolts and the 3 accessory drive idler pulleys. 14. Remove the 4 bolts and the
coolant pump pulley. 15. Remove the 3 bolts and the accessory drive belt tensioner. 16.
Disconnect the RH camshaft position (CMP) sensor wiring harness retainer from the cylinder head.
17. Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 18. Disconnect the crankshaft position
(CKP) sensor electrical connector. 19. Remove the bolt and the RH CMP sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2446
20. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Disconnect the radio ignition interference capacitor electrical connectors.
21. Remove the nut and the RH radio ignition interference capacitor. 22. Remove the nut and the
LH radio ignition interference capacitor. 23. Remove the bolt and the LH CMP sensor.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
24. Disconnect the wiring harness position retainer from the power steering pump stud bolt.
25. Disconnect the wiring harness position retainer and the engine oil pressure (EOP) switch
electrical connector and position the wiring harness aside.
26. Remove the 2 bolts, the stud bolt and position the power steering pump assembly aside. 27.
Remove the 4 front oil pan bolts. 28. Remove the bolts and the studs.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2447
29. Remove the engine front cover from the front cover to cylinder block dowel.
30. Remove the bolt and the CKP sensor.
^ Discard the O-ring seal.
31. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
tools cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
Remove and discard the engine front cover gaskets. ^
Clean the mating surfaces with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
^ Inspect the mating surfaces.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install the CKP sensor and the bolt.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
2. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
tools cause scratches and gouges which make leak paths. Use a plastic scraping tool to remove all
traces of old sealant.
NOTE: If the engine front cover is not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and
the sealing area cleaned with silicone gasket remover and metal surface prep. Follow the directions
on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness, or 4 minutes, whichever is longer.
Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
NOTE: Make sure that the engine front cover gasket is in place on the engine front cover before
installation.
Apply a bead of silicone gasket and sealant along the cylinder head-to-cylinder block surface and
the oil pan-to-cylinder block surface, at the locations shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2448
3. Install new engine front cover gaskets on the engine front cover. Position the engine front cover
onto the dowels. Install the fasteners finger tight.
4. Tighten the engine front cover fasteners in 2 stages, in the sequence shown.
Stage 1: Tighten fasteners 1 through 15 to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) Stage 2: Tighten fasteners 6 and 7 to
48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2449
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2450
5. Loosely install the bolts, then tighten the bolts in 2 stages, in the sequence shown.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
^ Stage 2: Tighten an additional 60 degrees.
6. Position the power steering pump assembly and install the bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
7. Position the power steering pressure hose support bracket and install the nut.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
8. Position the transmission cooler tube support bracket and install the nut.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2451
9. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install the RH CMP sensor and the bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
10. Connect the RH CMP sensor electrical connector. 11. Connect the wiring harness retainer from
the cylinder head. 12. Connect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 13. Connect the CKP
sensor electrical connector. 14. Install the LH radio ignition interference capacitor and the nut.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
15. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Install the LH CMP sensor and the bolt. ^
Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
16. Connect the LH CMP sensor electrical connector. 17. Install the RH radio ignition interference
capacitor and the nut.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
18. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Connect the radio ignition interference capacitor electrical connectors.
19. Connect the wiring harness position retainer to the power steering pump stud bolt.
20. Connect the wiring harness position retainer and the EOP switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2452
21. Install the accessory drive belt tensioner and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
22. Install the coolant pump pulley and the 4 bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
23. Install the 3 accessory drive idler pulleys and the 3 bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
24. Lubricate the engine front cover and the crankshaft front seal inner lip with clean engine oil.
25. Using the special tools, install the crankshaft front seal into the engine front cover.
26. NOTE: If not secured within 4 minutes, the sealant must be removed and the sealing area
cleaned with silicone gasket remover and metal
surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging. Allow to dry until there is no sign of wetness,
or 4 minutes, whichever is longer. Failure to follow this procedure can cause future oil leakage.
Apply silicone gasket and sealant to the Woodruff key slot on the crankshaft pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2453
27. Use the special tool to install the crankshaft pulley.
28. Tighten the new crankshaft pulley bolt in 4 stages.
^ Stage 1: Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.)
^ Stage 2: Loosen 360 degrees.
^ Stage 3: Tighten to 50 Nm (37 ft. lbs.)
^ Stage 4: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
29. Rotate the tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt.
30. Install the RH valve cover. 31. Install the LH valve cover. 32. Install the cooling fan shroud. 33.
Install the engine cooling fan. 34. Fill the crankcase with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page
2459
C1452
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2460
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
VCT System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is achieved. A difference between the desired and
actual camshaft position represents a position error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM
disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a default position if a concern is detected. A related
DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2461
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Variable Valve Timing >
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) OIL CONTROL SOLENOID
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the valve cover.
2. Remove the bolt and the variable camshaft timing (VCT) oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
Key on, engine off.................................................................................................................................
.............................................240-310 kPa (35-45 psi) Engine running.................................................
..................................................................................................................................193-310 kPa
(28-45 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 695 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air
cleaner cover.
- To install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 4. Release the retaining clips
and position the air cleaner cover aside. 5. Remove the air cleaner element.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2476
Installation
1. CAUTION: The air cleaner element must be fully seated into the air cleaner housing. Failure to
do so will result in unusual engine noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter
> Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing a fire hazard. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the Schrader valve cap and attach the pressure gauge.
3. NOTE: Open manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from the
fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the pressure gauge and relieve the fuel pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2484
Firing Order: Locations
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition
Timing > Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel
Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
Spark Plug: Customer Interest Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
TSB 07-24-8
12/10/07
ENGINE MISFIRE DURING CRUISE WITH OR WITHOUT DTCS (MEXICO ONLY)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition, F-150, F-250
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LI, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Mark LT, F-150 and F-250 vehicles equipped with
a 5.4 3V engines may exhibit engine misfire during cruise, rough run, hesitation, buck jerk, with or
without diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner to clean engine combustion system.
a. Disconnect canister purge line from the intake manifold.
b. Attach a vacuum line to the purge port.
c. At hot engine idle, allow the engine to ingest about a 1/2 to 2/3 of a can of Motorcraft(R)
Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Use caution not to ingest too quickly due to potential hydro-lock
issues. Read the entire label on the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Shake the can well
before using and make sure to use at room temperature.
d. Shut the engine off and allow it to soak for one hour.
e. Start engine, allow the engine to ingest the remainder of the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up
Cleaner.
f. Reconnect canister purge vacuum line.
g. Cycle engine between idle and 2500 RPM for about 5 minutes.
2. Inspect the spark plugs for abnormal fouling.
3. Replace fouled spark plugs.
4. Re-gap the spark plug to .035" (0.9 mm).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072408A 2007-2008 1.9 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator/F-150/F-250/Mark LT 5.4L 3V: Check DTCs,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel
Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise > Page 2497
Clean Combustion System, Remove Spark Plugs Inspect And, Replace As Necessary (Do Not Use
With 12650D, 12405A, 1 2650D64)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2503
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2504
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2505
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2506
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2507
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2508
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2509
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2510
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2511
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2512
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr
> 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2513
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 07-24-8 >
Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
TSB 07-24-8
12/10/07
ENGINE MISFIRE DURING CRUISE WITH OR WITHOUT DTCS (MEXICO ONLY)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition, F-150, F-250
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LI, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Mark LT, F-150 and F-250 vehicles equipped with
a 5.4 3V engines may exhibit engine misfire during cruise, rough run, hesitation, buck jerk, with or
without diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner to clean engine combustion system.
a. Disconnect canister purge line from the intake manifold.
b. Attach a vacuum line to the purge port.
c. At hot engine idle, allow the engine to ingest about a 1/2 to 2/3 of a can of Motorcraft(R)
Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Use caution not to ingest too quickly due to potential hydro-lock
issues. Read the entire label on the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Shake the can well
before using and make sure to use at room temperature.
d. Shut the engine off and allow it to soak for one hour.
e. Start engine, allow the engine to ingest the remainder of the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up
Cleaner.
f. Reconnect canister purge vacuum line.
g. Cycle engine between idle and 2500 RPM for about 5 minutes.
2. Inspect the spark plugs for abnormal fouling.
3. Replace fouled spark plugs.
4. Re-gap the spark plug to .035" (0.9 mm).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072408A 2007-2008 1.9 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator/F-150/F-250/Mark LT 5.4L 3V: Check DTCs,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 07-24-8 >
Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise > Page 2518
Clean Combustion System, Remove Spark Plugs Inspect And, Replace As Necessary (Do Not Use
With 12650D, 12405A, 1 2650D64)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2524
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2525
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2526
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2527
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2528
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2529
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2530
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2531
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2532
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2533
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr >
08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 2534
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2535
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2536
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark plug ...........................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... PZT-2F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2537
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
^ Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
^ Clean the spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
^ Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
^ Correct the oil leak concern.
^ Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
^
Clean the spark plug.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
^ Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2538
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a Heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. ^
Install a new spark plug.
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by a white or light gray spots and with bluish-burnt appearance
of electrodes. This is caused by engine
overheating, wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low
fuel pump pressure or incorrect ignition timing. ^
Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
^ Clean the spark plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2539
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Engine Ignition - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2540
Engine Ignition - LH
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug.
2. CAUTION:
- Do not remove the spark plugs when the engine is hot or cold soaked. Spark plug thread or
cylinder head damage can occur. Make sure the engine is warm (hand touch after cooling down)
prior to spark plug removal.
- Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur to the
cylinder head or spark plug.
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before removing the
spark plugs.
- If an original spark plug is used, make sure it is installed in the same cylinder from which it was
taken. New spark plugs can be used in any cylinder.
Remove the spark plugs. To install, tighten to 34 Nm (25 lb-ft).
3. Inspect the spark plugs. Install new spark plugs as necessary. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 2544
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test - Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty. 2. If compression does not
improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly. 3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low
compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does not increase compression, the head
gasket may be
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications > Page 2545
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
This engine is equipped with hydraulic lash adjusters. No adjustment is required.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Coolant pump bolts ..............................................................................................................................
..................................................... 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2552
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Coolant Pump
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. Remove the cooling fan. 3. Loosen the 4 coolant pump
pulley bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
4. Rotate the belt tensioner clockwise and disconnect the accessory drive belt from the coolant
pump pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 2553
5. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump pulley. 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump.
Discard the O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect the mating surfaces. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
^ Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine coolant prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Bypass Hose > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Thermostat Bypass Hose: Service and Repair
Bypass Tube
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. Remove the intake manifold. 3. Remove the 3 bolts, the
bypass tube, and discard the bypass tube gaskets.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect the mating surfaces and clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep and silicone
gasket remover. Follow the directions on the packaging.
^ Install new bypass tube gaskets.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
COOLING SYSTEM
BASE RADIATOR
Without aux rear heat ..........................................................................................................................
........................................ 20.6 quarts (19.5 liters) With aux rear heat ................................................
....................................................................................................................... 23.2 quarts (22.0 liters)
HEAVY DUTY TRAILER TOW RADIATOR
Without aux rear heat ..........................................................................................................................
........................................ 21.1 quarts (20.0 liters) With aux rear heat ................................................
....................................................................................................................... 23.8 quarts (22.5 liters)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 2562
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
ENGINE COOLANT
Motorcraft Premium Gold Engine Coolant (yellow-colored)
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. VC-7-B Ford Specification ................................................
................................................................................................................................ WSS-M97B51-A1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Coolant Reservoir: Service and Repair
Degas Bottle
Material
Removal and Installation
1. WARNING: To avoid personal injury, do not unscrew the coolant pressure relief cap while the
engine is operating or hot. The cooling
system is under pressure; steam and hot liquid can come out forcefully when the cap is loosened
slightly. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Release the pressure in the cooling system by slowly turning the pressure relief cap one half turn
counterclockwise. When the pressure is released, remove the pressure relief cap.
2. Using hose clamp pliers, clamp the coolant return hose. 3. Using a suitable suction device,
siphon the coolant from the degas bottle. 4. Remove the air cleaner element. For additional
information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 5. Disconnect the degas bottle inlet coolant
hose from the radiator. 6. Remove the clip and disconnect the coolant return hose quick connect
coupling from the degas bottle. 7. Remove the 2 bolts and the degas bottle/lower air cleaner
housing assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2566
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Fill the degas bottle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2572
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2573
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2574
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2575
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2576
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2577
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2578
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2579
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2580
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2581
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2582
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2583
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2584
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2585
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2586
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2587
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2588
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2589
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Description and Operation
FAN CONTROL
The PCM monitors certain parameters (such as engine coolant temperature, vehicle speed, A/C
on/off status, A/C pressure) to determine engine cooling fan needs.
For variable speed electric fan(s):
Edge/MKX, Five Hundred/Freestyle/Montego, Fusion/Milan/MKZ, Crown Victoria/Grand Marquis,
Town Car: FCV Duty Cycle Output From PCM (Negative Duty Cycle)
The PCM controls the fan speed and operation using a duty cycle output on the fan control variable
(FCV) circuit. The fan controller (located at or integral to the engine cooling fan assembly) receives
the FCV command and operates the cooling fan at the speed requested (by varying the power
applied to the fan motor).
For relay controlled fans:
2.0L Focus (with A/C) And Taurus: PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
2.3L Escape: PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2590
Freestar, Monterey: PCM FC Output State For Cooling Fan Speeds
The PCM controls the fan operation through the fan control (FC) (single speed fan applications),
low fan control (LFC), medium fan control (MFC), and/or high fan control (HFC) outputs. Some
applications will have the xFC circuit wired to 2 separate relays.
For 3-speed fans, although the PCM output circuits are called low, medium, and high fan control
(FC), cooling fan speed is controlled by a combination of these outputs. Refer to the table.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling Fan
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
FAN SPEED SENSOR (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch With (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The powertrain control
module (PCM) uses the frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop
control of the cooling fan clutch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fan Blade: Service and Repair
Cooling Fan
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Blade >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2597
2. Disconnect the cooling fan electronic clutch electrical connector. 3. Remove the nut and the
cooling fan electronic clutch harness support bracket from the stud bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 13 Nm (10 ft. lbs.)
4. Release the cooling fan shroud position tab and rotate the shroud upwards until the lower tab
locks into position.
5. Using the special tools, remove the cooling fan and clutch assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.)
^ If servicing the cooling fan or cooling fan clutch, refer to Cooling Fan and Cooling Fan Clutch.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Diagrams
C1158
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2601
Fan Clutch: Description and Operation
COOLING FAN CLUTCH
Cooling Fan Clutch With Fan Speed Sensor (FSS)
The cooling fan clutch is an electrically actuated viscous clutch that consists of 3 main elements:
- a working chamber
- a reservoir chamber
- a cooling fan clutch actuator valve and a fan speed sensor (FSS)
The cooling fan clutch actuator valve controls the fluid flow from the reservoir into the working
chamber. Once viscous fluid is in the working chamber, shearing of the fluid results in fan rotation.
The cooling fan clutch actuator valve is activated with a pulse width modulated (PWM) output
signal from the PCM. By opening and closing the fluid port valve, the PCM can control the cooling
fan clutch speed. The cooling fan clutch speed is measured by a Hall-effect sensor and is
monitored by the PCM during closed loop operation.
The PCM optimizes fan speed based on engine coolant temperature (ECT), engine oil temperature
(EOT), transmission fluid temperature (TFT), intake air temperature (IAT), or air conditioning
requirements. When an increased demand for fan speed is requested for vehicle cooling, the PCM
monitors the fan speed through the Hall-effect sensor. If a fan speed increase is required, the PCM
outputs the PWM signal to the fluid port, providing the required fan speed increase.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2602
Fan Clutch: Tools and Equipment
Fan Clutch Holding Tool AST tool# 8005
Allows the technician to hold the water pump pulleuy in place while loosening the radiator fan.
2009 Suggested user price: $41.20
Assenmacher Specialty Tools 1 800 525 2943
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2607
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2608
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch
> Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2609
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Fan Shroud: Service and Repair
Cooling Fan Shroud
Cooling Fan Shroud (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2613
Cooling Fan Shroud (Part 2)
Cooling Fan Shroud (Part 3)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional
information, refer to Battery. 3. Drain the engine cooling system. 4. Remove the air cleaner outlet
pipe. For additional information, refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 5. Remove the nut and
disconnect the electrical cables.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
6. Disconnect the wiring harness retainer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2614
7. Disconnect the upper radiator hose from the radiator. 8. Disconnect the upper radiator hose
position retainer from the cooling fan shroud. 9. Disconnect the electrical connector and the wiring
harness position retainer.
10. If equipped, disconnect the wiring harness position retainer from the vacuum reservoir.
11. If equipped, disconnect the vacuum connectors and the electrical connector on the LH side of
the cooling fan shroud and remove the vacuum
canister.
12. Disconnect the wiring harness retainer from the RH side of the radiator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2615
13. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the 2 cooling fan shroud bolts and the wiring harness retainers. ^
To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
14. Remove the 4 bolts and position the power distribution box (PDB) and support bracket aside.
^ NOTE: Hand start the 4 PDB support bracket bolts or damage to the radiator support can result.
To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
15. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical harness position retainer.
16. Disconnect the power steering fluid hose position retainers from the cooling shroud and radiator
support. 17. Remove the bolt and position the power steering reservoir aside.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
18. Disconnect the degas bottle coolant inlet hose from the radiator. 19. Release the lower cooling
fan shroud position tab and rotate the lower cooling fan shroud upwards until the lower tab locks
into position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Fan Shroud > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2616
20. Remove the clip and disconnect the lower radiator hose quick connect coupling from the
radiator.
21. Remove the cooling fan shroud. 22. To install reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Core: Customer Interest A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
2625
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
2626
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 2632
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 2633
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2639
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2640
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2641
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2642
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2643
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2644
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2645
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2646
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2647
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2648
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2649
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems Misfire on Steady Cruise
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
TSB 07-24-8
12/10/07
ENGINE MISFIRE DURING CRUISE WITH OR WITHOUT DTCS (MEXICO ONLY)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition, F-150, F-250
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LI, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Mark LT, F-150 and F-250 vehicles equipped with
a 5.4 3V engines may exhibit engine misfire during cruise, rough run, hesitation, buck jerk, with or
without diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner to clean engine combustion system.
a. Disconnect canister purge line from the intake manifold.
b. Attach a vacuum line to the purge port.
c. At hot engine idle, allow the engine to ingest about a 1/2 to 2/3 of a can of Motorcraft(R)
Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Use caution not to ingest too quickly due to potential hydro-lock
issues. Read the entire label on the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Shake the can well
before using and make sure to use at room temperature.
d. Shut the engine off and allow it to soak for one hour.
e. Start engine, allow the engine to ingest the remainder of the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up
Cleaner.
f. Reconnect canister purge vacuum line.
g. Cycle engine between idle and 2500 RPM for about 5 minutes.
2. Inspect the spark plugs for abnormal fouling.
3. Replace fouled spark plugs.
4. Re-gap the spark plug to .035" (0.9 mm).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072408A 2007-2008 1.9 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator/F-150/F-250/Mark LT 5.4L 3V: Check DTCs,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems Misfire on Steady Cruise > Page 2654
Clean Combustion System, Remove Spark Plugs Inspect And, Replace As Necessary (Do Not Use
With 12650D, 12405A, 1 2650D64)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2660
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2661
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2662
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2663
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2664
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2665
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2666
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2667
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2668
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2669
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 2670
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems Misfire on Steady Cruise > Page 2675
Clean Combustion System, Remove Spark Plugs Inspect And, Replace As Necessary (Do Not Use
With 12650D, 12405A, 1 2650D64)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2676
Heater Core: Description and Operation
HEATER CORE
The heater core consists of fins and tubes arranged to extract heat from the engine coolant and
transfer the heat to air passing through the auxiliary climate control housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core
HEATER CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be leak tested before it is removed
from the vehicle.
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the 8 plenum chamber
screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core > Page 2679
3. Release the plenum chamber clip and position the plenum chamber aside. 4. Remove 2 heater
core fitting clips and the dash panel seal. 5. Remove the heater core tube bracket screw and the
heater core tube bracket. 6. Remove the heater core bracket screw and the heater core bracket. 7.
Remove the heater core. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core > Page 2680
Heater Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core
AUXILIARY HEATER CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be pressure leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing.
2. Release the clip and open the floorpan bracket. 3. Remove the heater core tube bracket screw
and the heater core tube bracket. 4. Remove the 12 evaporator/heater core access cover screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core > Page 2681
5. Remove the evaporator/heater core access cover. 6. Remove the heater core. 7. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core > Page 2682
Heater Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition EL, Navigator L
AUXILIARY HEATER CORE - EXPEDITION EL, NAVIGATOR L
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be pressure leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
- It is not necessary to install the new heater core tubes contained in the heater core service kit
unless there is evidence of damage to the heater core tubes. New O-ring seals must be installed
any time the heater core tubes are detached from the heater core.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain the engine coolant. 3. Remove the
RH quarter trim panel. 4. Position a suitable drain pan and disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater outlet
and inlet line quick disconnect fittings at the floorpan connections to
allow any residual coolant to drain from the auxiliary heater core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Heater Core > Page 2683
5. Remove the heater core door screw.
6. Remove the 2 auxiliary heater core tube fitting clips.
7. Disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater core tubes.
1 Position the auxiliary heater core partially out of the housing.
2 Disconnect the auxiliary heater core inlet tube.
3 Disconnect the auxiliary heater core outlet tube. Discard the O-ring seals.
8. Remove the auxiliary heater core.
9. NOTE:
- Use only the O-ring seals contained in the auxiliary heater core service kit.
- Verify that the heater core tube fittings are completely seated in the heater core before installing
the heater core tube fitting clips.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
10. Fill the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: Customer Interest A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 2692
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 2693
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 2699
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core
Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 2700
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures
Heater Hose: Procedures
HEATER HOSE COUPLING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect
1. WARNING: The engine must be off, fully cool and the cooling system fully depressurized before
attempting to disconnect any heater
water hoses. Failure to comply with this warning can result in serious injury or burns from hot liquid
escaping out of the engine cooling system.
Depressurize the engine cooling system.
2. Push the heater water hose toward the tube to fully expose the locking tabs.
3. NOTE: When compressing the white coupling retainer, the Heater Hose Disconnect Tool must
be perpendicular to and on the highest point of the
coupling.
Push the special tool over the coupling retainer windows to compress the retainer locking tabs.
4. NOTE: A slight twisting motion while pulling on the heater water hose may be necessary to
assist in the removal.
Pull the heater water hose away from the heater core tube.
5. Plug the heater water hose. 6. Remove the white coupling retainer from the tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2703
7. Spread the retainer tabs apart and slide the retainer off the tube. 8. Discard the retainer.
Connect
1. Clean the tubes and lubricate with MERPOL meeting Ford specification ESE-M99B144-B or
plain water.
2. Install a new coupling retainer, spacer, and lubricated O-ring seals into the quick disconnect
coupling housing.
3. Push the heater water hose with a quick disconnect coupling onto the tube. 4. Make sure the
coupling is fully engaged by lightly pulling on the heater water hose.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2704
Heater Hose: Removal and Replacement
AUXILIARY HEATER OUTLET AND INLET LINE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2705
Part 2
Removal
NOTE:
- The auxiliary heater inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly. The auxiliary
heater inlet line and outlet line are each installed from the factory as one-piece assemblies. The
replacement parts are supplied as separate kits containing multiple-piece lines for ease of
installation.
- The following procedure can be used to remove and install one or both the auxiliary evaporator
inlet and auxiliary evaporator outlet lines. If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed and
installed, cut or disconnect only the desired line at the specified points within the procedure.
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain the engine coolant. 3. Remove the
spare tire. 4. Remove the RH fender splash shield.
5. NOTE: If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the auxiliary heater outlet and/or inlet line front quick disconnect fitting(s).
6. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the front auxiliary line bracket nut and the
front auxiliary line bracket.
7. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
8. Remove the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2706
9. NOTE: If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line rear quick disconnect fitting(s).
10. Remove the muffler. 11. Remove the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts and the spare tire
carrier splash shield. 12. Remove the 3 muffler heat shield bolts and the muffler heat shield. 13.
Remove the 2 exhaust hanger bolts and the exhaust hanger. 14. Remove the RH catalyst
monitoring sensor. 15. Remove the 3 remaining RH catalytic converter heat shield bolts and the
heat shield.
16. Remove the 3 remaining auxiliary line bracket nuts and the line brackets.
17. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary heater line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new line(s).
18. Remove the auxiliary heater line(s) in 3 separate pieces.
Installation
Expedition or Navigator only
1. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line(s) and connect the quick
disconnect fittings.
All vehicles
2. Install the front auxiliary heater line(s) and connect the quick disconnect fittings.
3. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the middle auxiliary heater line(s).
4. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 auxiliary line brackets and nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
5. Tighten the middle auxiliary heater line fittings. 6. Inspect the auxiliary heater lines for correct
installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as needed. 7. Install the RH catalytic converter heat
shield and the 3 catalytic converter heat shield rear bolts. 8. Install the RH catalyst monitoring
sensor. 9. Install the exhaust hanger and the 2 exhaust hanger bolts.
10. Install the muffler heat shield and the 3 muffler heat shield bolts. 11. Install the muffler. 12.
Install the spare tire carrier splash shield and the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts. 13.
Working through the RH fender well opening, Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt. 14. Install the front auxiliary line bracket and the front auxiliary line bracket and nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
15. Install the RH front fender splash shield. 16. Install the RH front wheel.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
17. Install the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Hose > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 2707
All vehicles
18. Install the spare tire. 19. Fill the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module
Radiator: Service and Repair Cooling Module
Cooling Module
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2712
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Drain the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2713
3. Recover the A/C system refrigerant. For additional information, refer to Heating and Air
Conditioning. 4. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 5.
Remove the RH and LH headlamp assemblies. 6. Remove the front fascia. 7. Remove the cooling
fan shroud. 8. Remove the 2 hood latch assembly bolts. 9. Disconnect the cable position retainers
and position the hood latch assembly aside.
10. Remove the pushpin and move the air deflector aside.
11. Remove the transmission cooler tube secondary latches. 12. Using the special tool, disconnect
the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the transmission fluid cooler hoses.
13. Remove the 2 condenser inlet fitting nuts and disconnect the 2 fittings.
^ Discard the O-ring seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2714
Expedition vehicles
14. Disconnect the horn electrical connector.
Navigator vehicles
15. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the bolt and the horn assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2715
All vehicles
16. Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector.
17. Remove the 6 radiator support bolts and remove the cooling module from the vehicle.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Position the cooling module in the vehicle. 2. Install the 6 radiator support bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
3. Connect the ambient temperature sensor electrical connector.
Navigator vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2716
4. Position the horn assembly and install the bolt and connect the electrical connector.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
Expedition vehicles
5. Connect the horn electrical connector.
All vehicles
6. NOTE: Lubricate the new O-ring seals with PAG Refrigerant Compressor Oil prior to installation.
Using new O-ring seals, connect the A/C fittings and install the 2 nuts. ^
Tighten to 8 Nm (71 inch lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2717
7. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tubes and install the secondary latches. 8. Position the air
deflector and install the pushpin.
9. Position the hood latch assembly and install the 2 hood latch assembly bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
10. Connect the hood latch cable position retainers.
11. Install the cooling fan shroud. 12. Install the front fascia. 13. Install the RH and LH headlamp
assemblies. 14. Connect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 15.
Fill and bleed the engine cooling system. 16. Fill the transmission with fluid and verify correct
operation. 17. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system. For additional information,
refer to Heating and Air Conditioning.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2718
Radiator: Service and Repair Radiator
Radiator
Radiator
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2719
2. Remove the RH and LH headlamp assemblies. 3. Remove the cooling fan shroud. 4. Remove
the 2 radiator-to-radiator support bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
5. Remove the 2 bolts and position the degas bottle aside.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 ft. lbs.)
Navigator vehicles
6. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the bolt and the horn assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
All vehicles
7. NOTE: LH shown, RH similar.
Remove the 6 LH and RH air deflector-to-condenser core pin-type retainers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Cooling Module > Page 2720
8. Disconnect the 2 transmission fluid cooler-to-radiator hoses.
9. NOTE: The cooling module must be positioned rearward to raise and detach the 4 condenser
mounts from the radiator.
Depress the retaining tabs on the 2 lower condenser mounting brackets and raise the condenser
assembly until the 4 condenser mounting brackets detach from the radiator.
10. Remove the radiator. 11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Fill the transmission fluid level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radiator Cooling Fan Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
FAN SPEED SENSOR (FSS)
Cooling Fan Clutch With (FSS)
The FSS is a Hall-effect sensor that measures the cooling fan clutch speed by generating a
waveform with a frequency proportional to the fan speed. If the cooling fan clutch is moving at a
relatively low speed, the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the cooling fan clutch
speed increases, the sensor generates a signal with a higher frequency. The powertrain control
module (PCM) uses the frequency signal generated by the FSS as a feedback for closed loop
control of the cooling fan clutch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2729
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2730
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System >
Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2731
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications
Thermostat: Specifications
Thermostat Opening Temperatures
Starts to open.......................................................................................................................................
........................................ 86.7-90.6°C (188-195°F) Fully open...........................................................
....................................................................................................................... 97.8-101.7°C
(208-215°F)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2735
Thermostat: Service and Repair
Thermostat and Thermostat Housing
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. If servicing the thermostat housing, disconnect the upper
radiator hose from the thermostat housing. 3. Remove the 2 bolts, the thermostat housing and the
thermostat. Discard the O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect the mating surfaces. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
^ Install a new O-ring seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat Housing, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Thermostat Housing: Service and Repair
Thermostat and Thermostat Housing
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. If servicing the thermostat housing, disconnect the upper
radiator hose from the thermostat housing. 3. Remove the 2 bolts, the thermostat housing and the
thermostat. Discard the O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect the mating surfaces. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
^ Install a new O-ring seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications
Water Pump: Specifications
Coolant pump bolts ..............................................................................................................................
..................................................... 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2742
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Coolant Pump
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Drain the engine cooling system. 2. Remove the cooling fan. 3. Loosen the 4 coolant pump
pulley bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
4. Rotate the belt tensioner clockwise and disconnect the accessory drive belt from the coolant
pump pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2743
5. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump pulley. 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the coolant pump.
Discard the O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Inspect the mating surfaces. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the
directions on the packaging.
^ Install a new O-ring seal. Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine coolant prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
CATALYST AND EXHAUST SYSTEMS
Overview
V-Engines
In-Line Engines
The catalytic converter and exhaust Systems work together to control the release of harmful engine
exhaust emissions into the atmosphere. The engine exhaust gas consists mainly of nitrogen (N),
carbon dioxide (CO2) and water vapor (H2O) However, it also contains carbon monoxide (CO),
oxides of nitrogen (NOx), hydrogen (H), and various unburned hydrocarbons (HCs). The major air
pollutants of CO, NOx, and HCs, and their emission into the atmosphere must be controlled.
The exhaust system generally consists of an exhaust manifold, front exhaust pipe, front heated
oxygen sensor (HO2S), rear exhaust pipe, catalyst HO2S, a muffler, and an exhaust tailpipe. The
catalytic converter is typically installed between the front and rear exhaust pipes. On some vehicle
applications, more than one catalyst is used between the front and rear exhaust pipes. Catalytic
converter efficiency is monitored by the on board diagnostic (OBD) system strategy in the PCM.
For information on the OBD catalyst monitor, refer to the description for the Catalyst Efficiency
Monitor. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive Cycles and Readiness Codes/Monitors/Catalyst Efficiency Monitor
The number of HO2Ss used in the exhaust stream and the location of these sensors depend on the
vehicle emission certification level (LEV, LEV-II, ULEV, PZEV). On most vehicles only 2 HO2Ss are
used in an exhaust stream. The front sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control while the ones after the catalyst (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor
catalyst efficiency. However, some partial zero emission vehicles (PZEV) use 3 HO2Ss for each
engine bank. The stream 1 sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) located before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control, the stream 2 sensors (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor the light-off
catalyst, and the stream 3 sensors (HO2S13/HO2S23) located after the catalyst are used for long
term fuel trim control to optimize catalyst efficiency (fore aft oxygen sensor control). Current PZEV
vehicles use only a 4-cylinder engine, so only the bank 1 HO2Ss are used.
Catalytic Converter
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 2748
A catalyst is a material that remains unchanged when it initiates and increases the speed of a
chemical reaction. A catalyst also enables a chemical reaction to occur at a lower temperature. The
concentration of exhaust gas products released to the atmosphere must be controlled. The
catalytic converter assists in this task. It contains a catalyst in the form of a specially treated
ceramic honeycomb structure saturated with catalytically active precious metals. As the exhaust
gases come in contact with the catalyst, they are changed into mostly harmless products. The
catalyst initiates and speeds up heat producing chemical reactions of the exhaust gas components
so they are used up as much as possible.
Light Off Catalyst
As the catalyst heats up, converter efficiency rises rapidly. The point at which conversion efficiency
exceeds 50% is called catalyst light off. For most catalysts this point occurs at 246°C to 302°C
(475°F to 575°F). A fast light catalyst is a 3-way catalyst (TWC) that is located as close to the
exhaust manifold as possible. Because the light off catalyst is located close to the exhaust manifold
it lights off faster and reduces emissions more quickly than the catalyst located under the body.
Once the catalyst lights off, the catalyst quickly reaches the maximum conversion efficiency for that
catalyst.
Three-Way Catalyst (TWC) Conversion Efficiency
TWC Conversion Efficiency Chart
A TWC requires a stoichiometric fuel ratio, 14.7 pounds of air to 1 pound of fuel (14.7:1), for high
conversion efficiency. In order to achieve these high efficiencies, the air/fuel ratio must be tightly
controlled with a narrow window of stoichiometry. Deviations outside of this window greatly
decrease the conversion efficiency. For example a rich mixture decreases the HC and CO
conversion efficiency while a lean mixture decreases the NOx conversion efficiency.
Exhaust System
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 2 HO2S Configuration
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Page 2749
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 3 HO2S Configuration
The purpose of the exhaust system is to convey engine emissions from the exhaust manifold to the
atmosphere. Engine exhaust emissions are directed from the engine exhaust manifold to the
catalytic converter through the front exhaust pipe. A HO2S is mounted on the front exhaust pipe
before the catalyst. The catalytic converter reduces the concentration of CO, unburned HCs, and
NOx in the exhaust emissions to an acceptable level. The reduced exhaust emissions are directed
from the catalytic converter past another HO2S mounted in the rear exhaust pipe and then on into
the muffler. Finally, the exhaust emissions are directed to the atmosphere through an exhaust
tailpipe.
On some PZEV, there is a total of 3 HO2S in the exhaust stream. One near the exhaust manifold
(stream 1), one in the middle of the light-off catalyst (stream 2), and the third (stream 3) is mounted
after the light-off catalyst.
Underbody Catalyst
The underbody catalyst is located after the light off catalyst. The underbody catalyst may be in line
with the light off catalyst, or the underbody catalyst may be common to 2 light off catalysts, forming
a Y pipe configuration. For an exact configuration of the catalyst and exhaust system for a specific
vehicle, refer to Catalytic Converter, Exhaust System.
Three-Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
The TWC converter contains either platinum (Pt) and rhodium (Rh) or palladium (Pd) and rhodium
(Rh). The TWC converter catalyzes the oxidation reactions of unburned HCs and CO and the
reduction reaction of NOx. The 3-way conversion can be best accomplished by always operating
the engine air fuel/ratio at or close to stoichiometry.
Exhaust Manifold Runners
The exhaust manifold runners collect exhaust gases from engine cylinders. The number of exhaust
manifolds and exhaust manifold runners depends on the engine configuration and number of
cylinders.
Exhaust Pipes
Exhaust pipes are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to
increase the life of the product. The pipes serve as guides for the flow of exhaust gases from the
engine exhaust manifold through the catalytic converter and the muffler.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2Ss provide the powertrain control module (PCM) with voltage and frequency information
related to the oxygen content of the exhaust gas.
Muffler
Mufflers are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to increase.
the life of the product. The muffler reduces the level of noise produced by the engine, and also
reduces the noise produced by exhaust gases as they travel from the catalytic converter to the
atmosphere.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
Exhaust Manifold Nuts
Discard the exhaust manifold nuts and studs.
Studs ...................................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs). Nuts .....................................................................
................................................................................................................................. 25 Nm (18 ft.
lbs).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2753
Exhaust Manifold: Testing and Inspection
Exhaust Manifold Cleaning and Inspection
Special Tool(s)
1. Clean the exhaust manifold using a suitable solvent. Use a plastic scraping tool to clean the
gasket sealing surfaces.
2. NOTE: New exhaust manifold gaskets, studs, nuts and/or bolts must be installed when an
exhaust manifold is serviced.
Using the special tool (or a precision straight edge) and a feeler gauge, check the exhaust manifold
sealing surface for warpage. If the warpage is greater than 0.76 mm (0.0299 inch), install a new
exhaust manifold.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold - LH
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold - LH
Exhaust Manifold - LH
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold - LH > Page 2756
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the air cleaner outlet tube. For additional information,
refer to Fuel Delivery and Air Induction. 3. Remove the degas bottle. For additional information,
refer to Cooling System.
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while the intermediate shaft is
disconnected or damage to the clockspring
can result. If there is evidence that the shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be removed and
recentered. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Remove the bolt and disconnect the steering shaft and position aside.
5. Remove the 4 (2 LH and 2 RH) exhaust manifold-to-catalytic converter nuts.
6. Remove the 3 bolts and the exhaust manifold heat shield.
Four wheel drive (4WD) vehicles
7. Remove the front driveshaft.
All vehicles
8. Remove the 8 exhaust manifold nuts, studs and the exhaust manifold.
^ Discard the exhaust manifold nuts and studs.
9. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold - LH > Page 2757
may cause scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths. Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing
surfaces.
NOTE: Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Remove and discard the exhaust manifold gaskets. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface
prep.
10. Inspect the exhaust manifold.
Installation
All vehicles
1. Using new exhaust manifold gaskets and studs, position the 2 gaskets and exhaust manifold and
install the 8 studs.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
2. Using new exhaust manifold nuts, install the 8 nuts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) in the sequence shown.
4WD vehicles
3. Install the front driveshaft.
All vehicles
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while the intermediate shaft is
disconnected or damage to the clockspring
can result. If there is evidence that the shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be removed and
recentered. For additional information, refer to Air Bag Systems.
Connect the steering shaft and install the bolt. ^
To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 ft. lbs.)
5. Install the 4 exhaust manifold-to-catalytic converter nuts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold - LH > Page 2758
6. Position the exhaust manifold heat shield and install the 3 bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
7. Install the degas bottle. 8. Install the air cleaner outlet tube. For additional information, refer to
Fuel Delivery and Air Induction.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold - LH > Page 2759
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair Exhaust Manifold - RH
Exhaust Manifold - RH
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Exhaust Manifold - LH > Page 2760
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the RH inner fenderwell. 3. Remove the RH engine
support insulator. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the exhaust manifold heat shield. 5. Remove the 8
exhaust manifold nuts, studs and the exhaust manifold.
^ Discard the exhaust manifold nuts and studs.
6. CAUTION: Do not use metal scrapers, wire brushes, power abrasive discs or other abrasive
means to clean the sealing surfaces. These
may cause scratches and gouges resulting in leak paths. Use a plastic scraper to clean the sealing
surfaces.
NOTE: Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface prep. Follow the directions on the packaging.
Remove and discard the exhaust manifold gaskets. Clean the sealing surfaces with metal surface
prep.
7. Inspect the exhaust manifold.
Installation
1. Using new exhaust manifold gaskets and studs, position the 2 gaskets and exhaust manifold and
install the 8 studs.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
2. Using new exhaust manifold nuts, install the 8 nuts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) in the sequence shown.
3. Position the exhaust manifold heat shield and install the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 inch lbs.)
4. Install the RH engine support insulator. For additional information, refer to Engine Support
Insulators. 5. Install the RH inner fenderwell.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Exhaust Pipe: Service and Repair
Exhaust Y-Pipe - Dual Catalytic Converter
Exhaust System - Exploded View (Expedition and Navigator Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2764
Exhaust System - Exploded View (Expedition and Navigator Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2765
Exhaust System - Exploded View (Expedition EL and Navigator L Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2766
Exhaust System - Exploded View (Expedition EL and Navigator L Part 2)
Material
Removal
CAUTION: Do not use oil or grease-based lubricants on isolators as they deteriorate the rubber.
NOTE: The exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter is a 2-piece assembly. The RH and LH
converters can be serviced separately as needed.
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
Four wheel drive (4WD) vehicles
2. NOTE: LH side shown, RH side similar.
If equipped, remove the transfer case skid plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2767
All vehicles
3. Disconnect the heated oxygen and catalyst monitor sensors electrical connectors. 4. Using a
suitable jack, support the transmission. 5. Remove the LH heat shield bolt and LH heat shield and
evaporative emissions (EVAP) canister assembly bolt.
6. Remove the RH heat shield bolt.
7. Remove the transmission mount nuts.
8. Remove the 4 crossmember bolts and the crossmember.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2768
9. Loosen the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket cap bolt.
Rear wheel drive (RWD) vehicles
10. Remove the 3 bolts and then slide off the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket from the
exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter.
4WD vehicles
11. NOTE: On 4WD vehicles, the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket will not slide off the
exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter until the
exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter is removed from the vehicle.
NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Remove the 4 bolts from the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket.
All vehicles
12. Remove the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2769
13. NOTE: LH catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nuts shown, RH similar.
Remove and discard the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nuts.
14. NOTE: Use caution removing the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter. Make sure not to
damage the manifold outlet flare, the converter inlet
flare or the studs.
Remove the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter from the vehicle.
4WD vehicles
15. If necessary, remove the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket from the exhaust Y-pipe
dual catalytic converter.
All vehicles
16. NOTE: A new RH catalytic converter-to-LH catalytic converter clamp must be installed
whenever the clamp is loosened.
If necessary, loosen the RH catalytic converter-to-LH catalytic converter clamp.
17. If necessary, separate the RH catalytic converter from the LH catalytic converter. 18. If the RH
catalytic converter-to-LH catalytic converter clamp is loosened, grind the spot weld and remove the
RH catalytic converter-to-LH
catalytic converter clamp. Clean the uneven surface area.
Installation
All vehicles
CAUTION: Do not tighten the fasteners until all components are assembled and aligned, making
sure to tighten all fasteners beginning at the front of the vehicle. For additional information, refer to
Exhaust System Alignment.
NOTE: Clean the mating surfaces of the exhaust manifold outlet flare and the exhaust Y-pipe dual
catalytic converter inlet flares.
Also clean the mating surfaces of the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly.
Make sure not to damage the exhaust manifold outlet flares, the exhaust Y-pipe-dual catalytic
converter inlet flares or the studs.
NOTE: Always install new fasteners and RH catalytic converter-to-LH catalytic converter clamp.
1. NOTE: Make sure to apply anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the sensors before installation.
If removed, install the heated oxygen and the catalyst monitor sensors. ^
Tighten to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
2. If necessary, position a new RH catalytic converter-to-LH catalytic converter clamp with the
clamp bolt facing the front of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2770
3. If separated, install RH catalytic converter to the LH catalytic converter.
4WD vehicles
4. If removed, install the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket to the exhaust Y-pipe dual
catalytic converter.
All vehicles
5. NOTE: Use caution installing the Y-pipe dual catalytic converter. Make sure not to damage the
manifold outlet flare, the converter inlet flare or
the studs.
Position the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter into the vehicle.
6. NOTE: LH catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nuts shown, RH similar.
Loosely install the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-exhaust manifold nuts.
4WD vehicles
7. NOTE: RH side shown, LH side similar.
Install the 4 exhaust and transmission mounting bracket-to-transmission bolts. ^
Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.)
RWD vehicles
8. Slide on the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket to the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic
converter and install the 3 exhaust and transmission
mounting bracket-to-transmission bolts. ^
Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2771
All vehicles
9. Install the 4 crossmember bolts and the crossmember.
^ Tighten to 90 Nm (66 ft. lbs.)
10. Install the exhaust and transmission mounting bracket nuts.
^ Tighten to 103 Nm (76 ft. lbs.)
11. Install the RH heat shield bolt.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
12. Install the LH heat shield bolt and LH heat shield and evaporative emissions (EVAP) canister
assembly bolt.
^ Tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 2772
13. Loosely install the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolts. 14.
Connect the heated oxygen and catalyst monitor sensor electrical connectors.
15. Align the exhaust system.
4WD vehicles
16. NOTE: LH side shown, RH side similar.
If equipped, install the transfer case skid plate. ^
Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Muffler: Service and Repair
Muffler and Tailpipe
Exhaust System - Exploded View (Expedition and Navigator Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 2776
Exhaust System - Exploded View (Expedition and Navigator Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 2777
Exhaust System - Exploded View (Expedition EL and Navigator L Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 2778
Exhaust System - Exploded View (Expedition EL and Navigator L Part 2)
Removal
CAUTION: Do not use oil or grease-based lubricants on isolators as they deteriorate the rubber.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. NOTE: LH side shown, RH side similar.
If equipped, remove the transfer case skid plate.
3. Loosen the tailpipe or resonator-to-muffler assembly clamp.
4. Remove the isolator and bracket assembly bolts and remove:
^ the tailpipe for Expedition models.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 2779
^ the resonator for Navigator models.
5. Using a suitable jack stand, support the muffler. 6. Remove and discard the exhaust Y-pipe dual
catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolts and flag nuts.
7. CAUTION: Make sure not to make contact with the axle boots while routing the muffler assembly
outlet over the rear axle or damage to
the boots may result.
Detach the isolators from the muffler assembly and remove from the vehicle
Installation
1. NOTE: Clean the mating surfaces of the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler
assembly.
NOTE: Check the exhaust hanger isolators for wear or damage, install new isolators, if necessary.
Install the muffler assembly into the vehicle and attach the isolators.
2. NOTE: Always install new fasteners.
Loosely install the exhaust Y-pipe dual catalytic converter-to-muffler assembly bolts and flag nuts.
3. Install the tailpipe for Expedition models or the resonator for Navigator models and install the
isolator and bracket assembly bolts.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
4. Tighten the tailpipe or resonator-to-muffler assembly clamp.
^ Tighten to 48 Nm (35 ft. lbs.)
5. Align the exhaust system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 2780
6. NOTE: LH side shown, RH side similar. If equipped, install the transfer case skid plate.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Programmable Module Installation
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Programmable Module Installation
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation Using the Integrated Diagnostic System IDS) When the Original
Module is NOT Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure carried
out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal and
installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle normal. 3. From the Toolbox
icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable Module
Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the
ignition key to the OFF position, and press check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn
the ignition key to the ON position, and press check mark. 8. If the data is not available, the IDS
displays screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data from the technician
service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Programmable Module Installation > Page 2789
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (Dsm)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new DSM after
installation.
1. Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the DSM forward to remove it from the bracket.
3. Disconnect the battery. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
5. NOTE: Once the module is installed it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the scan tool into the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position (TP) sensor, and mechanical throttle body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The TP sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant throttle position
signals are required for increased monitoring
reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and
the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal
operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of
throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2793
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is convened to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2794
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2795
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. The E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly monitor
selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of the IPC
and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it takes
appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2796
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 2797
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 4% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 4% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key ON,
engine OFF.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 8% - Enable ice breaker mode. Used to clear potential
ice buildup in the throttle body.
- Greater than or equal to 8% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide open throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To
Zero At A Stop
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To
Zero At A Stop > Page 2806
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2
Shift Flare
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2
Shift Flare > Page 2811
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't
Return To Zero At A Stop
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To
Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't
Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 2817
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1
Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2
Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1
Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 2822
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2823
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2826
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2827
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2828
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2829
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2830
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2831
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2832
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2833
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2834
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2835
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2836
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2837
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2838
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2839
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2840
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2841
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2842
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2843
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175B (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2844
C175B (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2845
C175E (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2846
C175E (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Removal
1. Retrieve the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration retrieval steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the 2 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the ground cable.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Remove the PCM. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Installation
1. Install the PCM. 2. Position the ground cable and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. Connect the 3 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Connect the battery ground cable.
5. NOTE:
- When a new PCM is installed, the air bag warning indicator will illuminate when the ignition switch
is ON. The warning indicator will remain on until PCM configuration is restored
- Clear all restraints control module (RCM) continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) after
Programmable Module Installation procedure has
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) > Page 2849
been completed on the PCM.
Restore the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration restore steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) > Page 2850
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module
(PCM). The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the
vehicle, and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTCs P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and needs programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old module is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2854
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2855
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2856
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2861
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2862
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2863
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2867
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2868
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2869
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2874
Ignition Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2875
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2876
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2882
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2883
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2887
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2888
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2889
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2890
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and the
MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349 > Page 2899
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page 2905
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 2906
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft
Position Sensor 1 > Page 2909
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2910
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2911
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
LH camshaft position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the CMP sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2918
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2919
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2920
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the accessory drive belt. 3.
Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C
compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2924
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2925
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2926
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 2930
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All fuel tanks
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 2931
1. Remove the fuel tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the nuts and the fuel pump module cover.
All fuel tanks
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect coupling, the fuel tank
pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump
module quick connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
4. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
5. CAUTION:
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2935
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2936
C435
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2937
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2938
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
106L (28 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2939
106L (28 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 2)
125L (33 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2940
125L (33 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 2)
Removal and Installation
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank.
106 L (28 gal.) fuel tank
2. Disconnect the supply and return fuel tubes quick connect couplings from the fuel filter.
All fuel tanks
3. Remove the fuel tank heat shield retainer(s) and remove the fuel tank heat shield. 4. Disconnect
the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel vapor/grade vent valves quick
connect couplings. 5. Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel
pump module quick connect coupling.
6. NOTE: For the 106 L (28 gal.) fuel tank the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly
and fresh air tube are serviced as an assembly.
Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly with the fresh air tube from the
fuel tank.
125 L (33 gal.) fuel tank
7. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly from the fuel tank.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2941
- Leak test the system. See: Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and
Inspection/Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle. See: Emission Control
Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair
Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2945
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2946
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2947
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard OBD/cold
weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the intake
manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature information to
the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 >
Page 2953
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2954
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2955
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2966
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #12
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6R75 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2967
View 151-10 (Transmission - 6HP26 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2968
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2969
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6R75 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 2970
View 151-10 (Transmission - 6HP26 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22
C141
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2973
C142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2974
C171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 2975
C172
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2976
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2979
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the HO2S with penetrating and lock lubricant to aid in removal.
Using the special tool, remove the HO2S. To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply a light coat of nickel anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the HO2S.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2980
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated
Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 2981
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the HO2S with penetrating and lock lubricant to aid in removal.
Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor. To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply a light coat of nickel anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the HO2S.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 2986
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 2990
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2994
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 2997
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 2998
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Remove the throttle body (TB).
2. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3003
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3004
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3005
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3006
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3007
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3008
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3009
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3010
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3011
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3012
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3013
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3014
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3015
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3016
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3017
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3018
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3019
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 3024
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low velocity,
the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Emission Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 3029
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3034
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3035
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3039
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3040
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3041
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3042
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and the
MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 3047
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Locations
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3054
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3055
C4168
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3056
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3057
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the LH rear interior quarter trim panel. 3.
Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the
IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3061
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 3064
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Page 3065
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Remove the throttle body (TB).
2. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page
3075
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349 > Page 3081
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
3082
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor
1 > Page 3085
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3086
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3087
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
LH camshaft position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the CMP sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3091
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3092
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3093
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the accessory drive belt. 3.
Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C
compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - FUNCTIONAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional > Page 3099
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - NON FUNCTIONAL
Removal
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the ignition
lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer. 4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering
column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage. 2. Install
a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3105
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3106
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3107
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
Key on, engine off.................................................................................................................................
.............................................240-310 kPa (35-45 psi) Engine running.................................................
..................................................................................................................................193-310 kPa
(28-45 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 695 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air
cleaner cover.
- To install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 4. Release the retaining clips
and position the air cleaner cover aside. 5. Remove the air cleaner element.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing >
Air Filter Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3119
Installation
1. CAUTION: The air cleaner element must be fully seated into the air cleaner housing. Failure to
do so will result in unusual engine noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing a fire hazard. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the Schrader valve cap and attach the pressure gauge.
3. NOTE: Open manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from the
fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the pressure gauge and relieve the fuel pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3127
Firing Order: Locations
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems Misfire on Steady Cruise
Spark Plug: Customer Interest Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
TSB 07-24-8
12/10/07
ENGINE MISFIRE DURING CRUISE WITH OR WITHOUT DTCS (MEXICO ONLY)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition, F-150, F-250
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LI, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Mark LT, F-150 and F-250 vehicles equipped with
a 5.4 3V engines may exhibit engine misfire during cruise, rough run, hesitation, buck jerk, with or
without diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner to clean engine combustion system.
a. Disconnect canister purge line from the intake manifold.
b. Attach a vacuum line to the purge port.
c. At hot engine idle, allow the engine to ingest about a 1/2 to 2/3 of a can of Motorcraft(R)
Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Use caution not to ingest too quickly due to potential hydro-lock
issues. Read the entire label on the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Shake the can well
before using and make sure to use at room temperature.
d. Shut the engine off and allow it to soak for one hour.
e. Start engine, allow the engine to ingest the remainder of the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up
Cleaner.
f. Reconnect canister purge vacuum line.
g. Cycle engine between idle and 2500 RPM for about 5 minutes.
2. Inspect the spark plugs for abnormal fouling.
3. Replace fouled spark plugs.
4. Re-gap the spark plug to .035" (0.9 mm).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072408A 2007-2008 1.9 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator/F-150/F-250/Mark LT 5.4L 3V: Check DTCs,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems Misfire on Steady Cruise > Page 3140
Clean Combustion System, Remove Spark Plugs Inspect And, Replace As Necessary (Do Not Use
With 12650D, 12405A, 1 2650D64)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3146
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3147
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3148
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3149
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3150
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3151
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3152
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3153
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3154
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3155
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3156
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07
> Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
TSB 07-24-8
12/10/07
ENGINE MISFIRE DURING CRUISE WITH OR WITHOUT DTCS (MEXICO ONLY)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition, F-150, F-250
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LI, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Mark LT, F-150 and F-250 vehicles equipped with
a 5.4 3V engines may exhibit engine misfire during cruise, rough run, hesitation, buck jerk, with or
without diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner to clean engine combustion system.
a. Disconnect canister purge line from the intake manifold.
b. Attach a vacuum line to the purge port.
c. At hot engine idle, allow the engine to ingest about a 1/2 to 2/3 of a can of Motorcraft(R)
Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Use caution not to ingest too quickly due to potential hydro-lock
issues. Read the entire label on the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Shake the can well
before using and make sure to use at room temperature.
d. Shut the engine off and allow it to soak for one hour.
e. Start engine, allow the engine to ingest the remainder of the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up
Cleaner.
f. Reconnect canister purge vacuum line.
g. Cycle engine between idle and 2500 RPM for about 5 minutes.
2. Inspect the spark plugs for abnormal fouling.
3. Replace fouled spark plugs.
4. Re-gap the spark plug to .035" (0.9 mm).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072408A 2007-2008 1.9 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator/F-150/F-250/Mark LT 5.4L 3V: Check DTCs,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07
> Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise > Page 3161
Clean Combustion System, Remove Spark Plugs Inspect And, Replace As Necessary (Do Not Use
With 12650D, 12405A, 1 2650D64)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3167
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3168
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3169
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3170
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3171
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3172
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3173
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3174
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3175
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3176
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 >
Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions > Page 3177
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3178
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3179
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark plug ...........................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... PZT-2F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3180
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
^ Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
^ Clean the spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
^ Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
^ Correct the oil leak concern.
^ Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
^
Clean the spark plug.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
^ Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3181
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a Heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. ^
Install a new spark plug.
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by a white or light gray spots and with bluish-burnt appearance
of electrodes. This is caused by engine
overheating, wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low
fuel pump pressure or incorrect ignition timing. ^
Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
^ Clean the spark plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3182
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Engine Ignition - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3183
Engine Ignition - LH
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug.
2. CAUTION:
- Do not remove the spark plugs when the engine is hot or cold soaked. Spark plug thread or
cylinder head damage can occur. Make sure the engine is warm (hand touch after cooling down)
prior to spark plug removal.
- Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur to the
cylinder head or spark plug.
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before removing the
spark plugs.
- If an original spark plug is used, make sure it is installed in the same cylinder from which it was
taken. New spark plugs can be used in any cylinder.
Remove the spark plugs. To install, tighten to 34 Nm (25 lb-ft).
3. Inspect the spark plugs. Install new spark plugs as necessary. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3187
Compression Check: Testing and Inspection
Compression Test - Compression Gauge Check
1. Make sure the oil in the crankcase is of the correct viscosity and at the correct level and that the
battery is correctly charged. Operate the vehicle
until the engine is at normal operating temperature. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position,
then remove all the spark plugs.
2. Set the throttle plates in the wide-open position. 3. Install a compression gauge such as the
Compression Tester in the No. 1 cylinder. 4. Install an auxiliary starter switch in the starting circuit.
With the ignition switch in the OFF position, and using the auxiliary starter switch, crank
the engine a minimum of 5 compression strokes and record the highest reading. Note the
approximate number of compression strokes required to obtain the highest reading.
5. Repeat the test on each cylinder, cranking the engine approximately the same number of
compression strokes.
Compression Test - Test Results
The indicated compression pressures are considered within specification if the lowest reading
cylinder is at least 75% of the highest reading. Refer to the Compression Pressure Limit Chart.
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
Compression Pressure Limit Chart
If one or more cylinders reads low, squirt approximately one tablespoon of engine oil on top of the
pistons in the low-reading cylinders. Repeat the compression pressure check on these cylinders.
Compression Test - Interpreting Compression Readings
1. If compression improves considerably, piston rings are faulty. 2. If compression does not
improve, valves are sticking or seating incorrectly. 3. If 2 adjacent cylinders indicate low
compression pressures and squirting oil on each piston does not increase compression, the head
gasket may be
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check >
System Information > Specifications > Page 3188
leaking between cylinders. Engine oil or coolant in cylinders could result from this condition.
Use the Compression Pressure Limit Chart when checking cylinder compression so that the lowest
reading is within 75% of the highest reading.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
This engine is equipped with hydraulic lash adjusters. No adjustment is required.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3196
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3197
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3201
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3202
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3203
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3204
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and the
MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3208
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3209
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3210
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard OBD/cold
weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the intake
manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature information to
the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Programmable Module Installation
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Programmable Module Installation
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation Using the Integrated Diagnostic System IDS) When the Original
Module is NOT Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure carried
out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal and
installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle normal. 3. From the Toolbox
icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable Module
Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the
ignition key to the OFF position, and press check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn
the ignition key to the ON position, and press check mark. 8. If the data is not available, the IDS
displays screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data from the technician
service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Body Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Programmable Module Installation > Page 3216
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (Dsm)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new DSM after
installation.
1. Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the DSM forward to remove it from the bracket.
3. Disconnect the battery. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
5. NOTE: Once the module is installed it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the scan tool into the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3220
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Signal: Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Brake Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 3223
Brake Signal: Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS) Brake Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS) BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug
> 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug
> 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page 3232
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: >
08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: >
08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page 3238
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3239
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1 > Page 3242
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3243
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3244
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
LH camshaft position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the CMP sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3251
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3252
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3253
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the accessory drive belt. 3.
Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C
compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Data Link Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3259
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3260
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3261
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3262
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3263
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3264
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3265
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3266
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3267
Data Link Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3268
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3269
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3270
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3271
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3272
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3273
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3274
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3275
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3276
C251
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3280
C1368
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Actuator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3281
Electronic Throttle Actuator: Description and Operation
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE ACTUATOR CONTROL (TAC)
The electronic TAC is a DC motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2 wires). The gear ratio from the
motor to the throttle plate shaft is 17:1. There are 2 designs for the TAC, parallel and in-series. The
parallel design has the motor under the bore parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing. Two springs
are used; one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger assembly that
results in a default angle when no power is applied. The force of the plunger spring is 2 times
stronger than the main spring. The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48
km/h (30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degree from the hard stop angle. The closed
throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~ 0.75 degree). This
hard stop setting is not adjustable and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine
airflow required at idle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position (TP) sensor, and mechanical throttle body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The TP sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant throttle position
signals are required for increased monitoring
reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and
the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal
operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of
throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3285
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is convened to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3286
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3287
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. The E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly monitor
selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of the IPC
and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it takes
appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3288
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3289
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 4% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 4% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key ON,
engine OFF.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 8% - Enable ice breaker mode. Used to clear potential
ice buildup in the throttle body.
- Greater than or equal to 8% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide open throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 >
Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 >
Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 3298
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07
> Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07
> Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 3303
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2
> Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To
Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2
> Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 3309
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11
> Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2
Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11
> Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 3314
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3315
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3318
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3319
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3320
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3321
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3322
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3323
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3324
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3325
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3326
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3327
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3328
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3329
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3330
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3331
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3332
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3333
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3334
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3335
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175B (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3336
C175B (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3337
C175E (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3338
C175E (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Removal
1. Retrieve the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration retrieval steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the 2 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the ground cable.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Remove the PCM. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Installation
1. Install the PCM. 2. Position the ground cable and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. Connect the 3 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Connect the battery ground cable.
5. NOTE:
- When a new PCM is installed, the air bag warning indicator will illuminate when the ignition switch
is ON. The warning indicator will remain on until PCM configuration is restored
- Clear all restraints control module (RCM) continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) after
Programmable Module Installation procedure has
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) > Page 3341
been completed on the PCM.
Restore the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration restore steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) > Page 3342
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module
(PCM). The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the
vehicle, and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTCs P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and needs programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old module is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3346
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3347
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3348
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3352
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All fuel tanks
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3353
1. Remove the fuel tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the nuts and the fuel pump module cover.
All fuel tanks
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect coupling, the fuel tank
pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump
module quick connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
4. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
5. CAUTION:
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3357
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3358
C435
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3359
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3360
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
106L (28 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3361
106L (28 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 2)
125L (33 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3362
125L (33 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 2)
Removal and Installation
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank.
106 L (28 gal.) fuel tank
2. Disconnect the supply and return fuel tubes quick connect couplings from the fuel filter.
All fuel tanks
3. Remove the fuel tank heat shield retainer(s) and remove the fuel tank heat shield. 4. Disconnect
the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel vapor/grade vent valves quick
connect couplings. 5. Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel
pump module quick connect coupling.
6. NOTE: For the 106 L (28 gal.) fuel tank the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly
and fresh air tube are serviced as an assembly.
Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly with the fresh air tube from the
fuel tank.
125 L (33 gal.) fuel tank
7. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly from the fuel tank.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3363
- Leak test the system. See: Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and
Inspection/Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle. See: Emission Control
Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair
Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Description and Operation
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
NOTE: The IAC valve assembly is not adjustable and cannot be cleaned, also some IAC valves are
normally open and others are normally closed. Some IAC valves require engine vacuum to
operate.
The IAC valve assembly controls the engine idle speed and provides a dashpot function. The IAC
valve assembly meters intake air around the throttle plate through a bypass within the IAC valve
assembly and throttle body. The PCM determines the desired idle speed or bypass air and signals
the IAC valve assembly through a specified duty cycle. The IAC valve responds by positioning the
IAC valve to control the amount of bypassed air. The PCM monitors engine RPM and increases or
decreases the IAC duty cycle in order to achieve the desired RPM.
The PCM uses the IAC valve assembly to control:
- no touch start
- cold engine fast idle for rapid warm-up
- idle (corrects for engine load)
- stumble or stalling on deceleration (provides a dashpot function)
- over-temperature idle boost
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Information Bus: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3371
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3372
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3373
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3374
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3375
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3376
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3377
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3378
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3379
Information Bus: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3380
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3381
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3382
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3383
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3384
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3385
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3386
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3387
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3388
Information Bus: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
14-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3389
14-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3390
14-3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3391
14-4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3392
14-5
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3393
Information Bus: Description and Operation
COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK
Vehicle communication utilizes both medium and high speed controller area network (CAN)
communications. CAN is used for many modules to communicate with each other on a common
network. CAN in-vehicle networking, is a method for transferring data among distributed electronic
modules via a serial data bus. Without serial networking, intermodule communication requires
dedicated, point to point wiring resulting in bulky, expensive, complex, and difficult to install wiring
harnesses. Applying a serial data network reduces the number of wires combining the signals on a
single network. Information is sent to the individual control modules that control each function.
The vehicle has 2 module communication networks:
- Medium speed (MS) CAN
- High speed (HS) CAN
Both networks are connected to the data link connector (DLC). This makes diagnosis and testing of
these systems easier by allowing one scan tool to be able to diagnose and control any module on
both networks from one connector. The DLC can be found under the instrument panel between the
steering column and the audio unit.
MS-CAN Network Operation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3394
Network Topology
The MS-CAN network communicates using bussed messages. The MS-CAN has an unshielded
twisted pair cable, data bus (+) and data bus (-) circuits. In addition to scan tool communication,
this network allows sharing of information between all modules on the network.
The MS-CAN is a medium speed communication network used for the following modules:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3395
- SJB
- Audio unit
- Instrument cluster
- DSM (if equipped)
- DVD player (if equipped)
- Electronic manual temperature control module (if equipped)
- EATC module (if equipped)
- SDARS module (if equipped)
- Parking aid module (if equipped)
- Power liftgate module (if equipped)
- Auxiliary audio module (if equipped)
- THX(R) amplifier (if equipped)
- Power running board module (if equipped)
- Climate controlled seat module (if equipped)
HS-CAN Network Operation
The HS-CAN network communicates using bussed messages. The HS-CAN network uses an
unshielded twisted pair cable, data bus (+) and data bus (-) circuits. In addition to scan tool
communication, this network allows sharing of information between all modules on the network.
The HS-CAN is a high speed communication network used for the following modules: PCM
- RCM
- ABS module
- Instrument cluster
- TCM (if equipped)
- 4WD control module (if equipped)
- Air suspension module (if equipped)
Network Termination
The CAN network uses a network termination circuit to improve communication reliability. The
network termination of the CAN bus takes place inside the termination modules by termination
resistors. Termination modules are located at either end of the bus network. As network messages
are broadcast in the form of voltage signals, the network voltage signals are stabilized by the
termination resistors. Each termination module has a 120 ohm resistor across the positive and
negative bus connection in the termination module. With 2 termination modules on each network,
and the 120 ohm resistors located in a parallel circuit configuration, the total network impedance, or
total resistance is 60 ohms.
Network termination improves bus message reliability by: stabilizing bus voltage.
- eliminating electrical interference.
Gateway Module
The instrument cluster is the gateway module, translating HS-CAN to MS-CAN and vice versa. This
information allows a message to be distributed throughout both networks. The instrument cluster is
the only module on this vehicle that has this ability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Information Bus: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Visually inspect the following for obvious signs of electrical
damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Battery junction box (BJB) fuse(s): 7 (40A) (no communication with power running board module)
- 8 (40A) (no communication with climate controlled seat module)
- 35 (20A) (no communication with 4WD control module)
- 36 (10A) (no communication with PCM)
- 37 (15A) (no communication with TCM)
- 43 (20A) (no communication with 4WD control module)
- 45 (30A) (no communication with DSM)
- 47 (30A) (no communication with air suspension module)
- 65 (10A) (no communication with air suspension module)
- 73 (5A) (no communication with TCM)
- 76 (20A) (no communication with PCM)
- 77 (10A) (no communication with ABS module)
- Smart junction box (SJB) fuse(s): 2 (15A) (no communication with DSM)
- 3 (15A) (no communication with satellite radio receiver, auxiliary audio module, DVD)
- 5 (10A) (no communication with SJB)
- 14 (10A) (no communication with power liftgate module)
- 15 (10A) (no communication with electronic manual temperature control module, EATC module)
- 20 (15A) (no power to scan tool)
- 26 (20A) (no communication with SJB)
- 28 (5A) (no communication with audio unit)
- 29 (5A) (no communication with instrument cluster)
- 32 (10A) (no communication with RCM)
- 35 (10A) (no communication with parking aid module)
- 37 (10A) (no communication with Electronic manual temperature control module, EATC module)
- 38 (20A) (no communication with THX(R) amplifier)
- 39 (20A) (no communication with audio unit)
- 40 (20A) (no communication with THX(R) amplifier)
- Data link connector (DLC)
- Wiring harness
- Circuitry
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the DLC.
NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground from
the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- GO to Pinpoint Test W, to diagnose no power to the scan tool. See: Pinpoint Tests/Test W: No
Power To The Scan Tool
5. NOTE: During the network test, the scan tool will first attempt to communicate with the PCM,
after establishing communication with the PCM,
the scan tool will then attempt to communicate with all other modules on the vehicle.
Carry out the network test. If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs and proceed to Step
6.
- If the network test fails, GO to Symptom Chart to identify the module not communicating. See:
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3398
6. If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, go to the Communication Network Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) Chart. For all other DTCs,
refer to Body Control Systems (Multifunction Electronic Control Module). See: Diagnostic Trouble
Code Descriptions
7. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
Vehicle communication utilizes both medium and high speed controller area network (CAN)
communications. CAN is a method for transferring data among distributed electronic modules via a
serial data bus.
The vehicle is equipped with 2 module communication networks:
- Medium speed (MS) CAN
- High speed (HS) CAN
MS-CAN
The MS-CAN is a medium speed communication network that uses an unshielded twisted pair
cable of data (+) and data (-) circuits. The data (+) and the data (-) circuits are each regulated to
approximately 2.5 volts during neutral or rested network traffic. As bus messages are sent on the
data (+) circuit, voltage is increased by approximately 1.0 volt. Inversely, the data (-) circuit is
reduced by approximately 1.0 volt when a bus message is sent. Multiple bus messages can be
sent over the network CAN circuits allowing multiple modules to communicate with each other. The
MS-CAN network will not communicate while certain faults are present, but will operate with
diminished performance with other faults present. The MS-CAN network may remain operational
when 1 of the 2 termination resistors are not present.
The MS-CAN network operates at a maximum data transfer speed of 125 Kbps for bus messages
and designed for general information transfer. The network will remain operational, but at a
degraded level when certain circuit faults are present. The HS-CAN network may remain
operational with only one termination resistor present.
The following modules are on the MS-CAN network: Smart junction box (SJB)
- Instrument cluster
- Audio unit
- THX(R) amplifier (if equipped)
- Satellite radio receiver (if equipped)
- Power running board module (if equipped)
- Parking aid module (if equipped)
- Power liftgate module (if equipped)
- Electronic manual temperature control module (if equipped)
- Electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped)
- Driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped)
- Climate controlled seat module (if equipped)
- Auxiliary audio module (if equipped)
- Digital versatile disc (DVD) player (if equipped)
MS-CAN Network Communication Fault Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3399
The fault chart describes the specific MS-CAN network failures and their resulting symptom:
HS-CAN
The HS-CAN is a high speed communication network that uses an unshielded twisted pair cable of
data (+) and data (-) circuits. The data (+) and the data (-) circuits are each regulated to
approximately 2.5 volts during neutral or rested network traffic. As bus messages are sent on the
data (+) circuit, voltage is increased by approximately 1.0 volt. Inversely, the data (-) circuit is
reduced by approximately 1.0 volt when a bus message is sent. Multiple bus messages can be
sent over the network CAN circuits allowing multiple modules to communicate with each other. The
HS-CAN network will not communicate while certain faults are present, but will operate with
diminished performance with other faults present. The HS-CAN bus may remain operational when
1 of the 2 termination resistors are not present.
The HS-CAN network operates at a maximum data transfer speed of 500 Kbps and is designed for
real time information transfer and control. The network will remain operational, but at a degraded
level when certain circuit faults are present. The HS-CAN network may remain operational with
only one termination resistor present.
The following modules are on the HS-CAN network: Powertrain control module (PCM)
- Anti-lock brake system (ABS) module
- Restraints control module (RCM)
- Instrument cluster
- Transmission control module (TCM)
- Four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped)
- Air suspension module (if equipped)
HS-CAN Network Communication Fault Chart
The fault chart describes the specific HS-CAN network failures and their resulting symptom:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3400
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3401
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3402
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3403
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3404
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3405
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 6)
The chart describes the specific CAN network messages broadcast by each module, and the
module(s) that receive the message:
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
This provides step-by-step module configuration procedures. Carry out the programmable module
installation (PMI) procedure when another Vehicle System directs to carry out configuration or
when DTCs from the list are present. See: Body Control Module/Service and Repair
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
Configurable modules accommodate a variety of vehicle options, eliminating the need for many
unique modules for one vehicle line. These modules must be configured when replaced as part of a
repair procedure.
Configurable modules should not be exchanged between vehicles since the settings are unique to
each vehicle. Failure to configure a new module may result in improper operation and/or any of the
following DTCs setting:
- B2477 and/or B2141 - sets when a body/chassis module is not configured.
- B2900 - sets when there is a VIN mismatch between the module with the B2900 and the PCM.
Either the PCM or the body module stored VIN may be incorrect.
- P0602, P0605 and/or P1639 - sets when the powertrain control module (PCM) vehicle
identification (VID) block is not configured or is configured incorrectly.
- U0300 and/or U0301 - sets when the configuration between 2 or more modules do not match.
- U2050 and/or U2051 - sets when a valid strategy/calibration is not present.
The following are the 3 different methods of configuration:
- Programmable module installation (PMI)
- Module reprogramming (flashing)
- Programmable parameters
Some modules do not support all 3 methods.
Definition of Terms
The following are definitions of configuration terms:
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) PMI is a scan tool process which configures settings in a
new module. Data used for the PMI process is automatically downloaded from the original module
and stored when a scan tool session is started. If this data cannot be retrieved from the module
being replaced, the scan tool may prompt for As-Built data entry or display a list of parameter
values that need to be manually selected. Some modules are reprogrammed during PMI when a
strategy/calibration update is available.
NOTE: A module must be able to communicate with the scan tool in order to carry out PMI. It is
important that the scan tool identifies the vehicle and obtains configuration data prior to removing
any modules.
To carry out PMI, refer to Programmable Module Installation. See: Body Control Module/Service
and Repair
Module Reprogramming Module reprogramming (also referred to as "flashing") is a scan tool
process which updates the strategy/calibration in a module. Module reprogramming is
automatically carried out during PMI when a later strategy/calibration is available. Reprogramming
a module with the same level of software will not improve module operation or repair a hardware
failure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3406
NOTE: Module reprogramming should be limited to circumstances where a published Technical Service
Bulletin (TSB) procedure recommends doing so.
- A module cannot communicate with other modules on the communication network while being
reprogrammed. Clear any network communication DTCs which may have been set in other
modules during reprogramming.
Programmable Parameters Programmable parameters are customer preference items that may be
modified by the dealer via scan tool or in some cases modified by the customer following a
procedure listed in the vehicle Owner's Literature. While many configuration options may exist for a
module, only a few of these options are programmable parameters.
Adaptive Learning and Calibration
Some modules require a separate learning procedure be carried out if replaced as part of a repair
procedure. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
Vehicle Identification (VID) Block
Some PCMs contain a memory area called a vehicle identification (VID) block. The PCM VID block
commonly stores powertrain configuration items such as VIN, tire size, axle ratio, and whether or
not the vehicle is equipped with speed control.
As-Built Data
As-Built data is a VIN specific module configuration record. During vehicle build, the configuration
from all modules is downloaded and stored in the As-Built database. As Built data will not reflect
customer preference items that have been changed from the default state. These items will need to
be changed using programmable parameters after the module is configured.
NOTE: It is not necessary to obtain As-Built data unless directed to do so by the scan tool. This
data may be accessed from the technician service publication website.
Body/Chassis Module Addresses For As-Built Entry
The chart lists body/chassis module As-Built data addresses:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3407
Module Configuration And Parameter Index (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3408
Module Configuration And Parameter Index (Part 2)
Module Configuration And Parameter Index (Part 3)
The chart describes specific module programming information:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3409
Information Bus: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
U0001-U0114
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3410
U0121-U0155
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3411
U0155-U0208
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3412
U0230-U2023
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3413
U2023-U2473
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3414
Information Bus: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
B2477-B2900
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3415
P0602-P1639 / U0300-U2050
U2051
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3416
Information Bus: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3417
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3418
Information Bus: Testing and Inspection
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Visually inspect the following for obvious signs of electrical
damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Battery junction box (BJB) fuse(s): 7 (40A) (no communication with power running board module)
- 8 (40A) (no communication with climate controlled seat module)
- 35 (20A) (no communication with 4WD control module)
- 36 (10A) (no communication with PCM)
- 37 (15A) (no communication with TCM)
- 43 (20A) (no communication with 4WD control module)
- 45 (30A) (no communication with DSM)
- 47 (30A) (no communication with air suspension module)
- 65 (10A) (no communication with air suspension module)
- 73 (5A) (no communication with TCM)
- 76 (20A) (no communication with PCM)
- 77 (10A) (no communication with ABS module)
- Smart junction box (SJB) fuse(s): 2 (15A) (no communication with DSM)
- 3 (15A) (no communication with satellite radio receiver, auxiliary audio module, DVD)
- 5 (10A) (no communication with SJB)
- 14 (10A) (no communication with power liftgate module)
- 15 (10A) (no communication with electronic manual temperature control module, EATC module)
- 20 (15A) (no power to scan tool)
- 26 (20A) (no communication with SJB)
- 28 (5A) (no communication with audio unit)
- 29 (5A) (no communication with instrument cluster)
- 32 (10A) (no communication with RCM)
- 35 (10A) (no communication with parking aid module)
- 37 (10A) (no communication with Electronic manual temperature control module, EATC module)
- 38 (20A) (no communication with THX(R) amplifier)
- 39 (20A) (no communication with audio unit)
- 40 (20A) (no communication with THX(R) amplifier)
- Data link connector (DLC)
- Wiring harness
- Circuitry
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the DLC.
NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground from
the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- GO to Pinpoint Test W, to diagnose no power to the scan tool. See: Pinpoint Tests/Test W: No
Power To The Scan Tool
5. NOTE: During the network test, the scan tool will first attempt to communicate with the PCM,
after establishing communication with the PCM,
the scan tool will then attempt to communicate with all other modules on the vehicle.
Carry out the network test. If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs and proceed to Step
6.
- If the network test fails, GO to Symptom Chart to identify the module not communicating. See:
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3419
6. If the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, go to the Communication Network Diagnostic
Trouble Code (DTC) Chart. For all other DTCs,
refer to Body Control Systems (Multifunction Electronic Control Module). See: Diagnostic Trouble
Code Descriptions
7. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
Vehicle communication utilizes both medium and high speed controller area network (CAN)
communications. CAN is a method for transferring data among distributed electronic modules via a
serial data bus.
The vehicle is equipped with 2 module communication networks:
- Medium speed (MS) CAN
- High speed (HS) CAN
MS-CAN
The MS-CAN is a medium speed communication network that uses an unshielded twisted pair
cable of data (+) and data (-) circuits. The data (+) and the data (-) circuits are each regulated to
approximately 2.5 volts during neutral or rested network traffic. As bus messages are sent on the
data (+) circuit, voltage is increased by approximately 1.0 volt. Inversely, the data (-) circuit is
reduced by approximately 1.0 volt when a bus message is sent. Multiple bus messages can be
sent over the network CAN circuits allowing multiple modules to communicate with each other. The
MS-CAN network will not communicate while certain faults are present, but will operate with
diminished performance with other faults present. The MS-CAN network may remain operational
when 1 of the 2 termination resistors are not present.
The MS-CAN network operates at a maximum data transfer speed of 125 Kbps for bus messages
and designed for general information transfer. The network will remain operational, but at a
degraded level when certain circuit faults are present. The HS-CAN network may remain
operational with only one termination resistor present.
The following modules are on the MS-CAN network: Smart junction box (SJB)
- Instrument cluster
- Audio unit
- THX(R) amplifier (if equipped)
- Satellite radio receiver (if equipped)
- Power running board module (if equipped)
- Parking aid module (if equipped)
- Power liftgate module (if equipped)
- Electronic manual temperature control module (if equipped)
- Electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped)
- Driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped)
- Climate controlled seat module (if equipped)
- Auxiliary audio module (if equipped)
- Digital versatile disc (DVD) player (if equipped)
MS-CAN Network Communication Fault Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3420
The fault chart describes the specific MS-CAN network failures and their resulting symptom:
HS-CAN
The HS-CAN is a high speed communication network that uses an unshielded twisted pair cable of
data (+) and data (-) circuits. The data (+) and the data (-) circuits are each regulated to
approximately 2.5 volts during neutral or rested network traffic. As bus messages are sent on the
data (+) circuit, voltage is increased by approximately 1.0 volt. Inversely, the data (-) circuit is
reduced by approximately 1.0 volt when a bus message is sent. Multiple bus messages can be
sent over the network CAN circuits allowing multiple modules to communicate with each other. The
HS-CAN network will not communicate while certain faults are present, but will operate with
diminished performance with other faults present. The HS-CAN bus may remain operational when
1 of the 2 termination resistors are not present.
The HS-CAN network operates at a maximum data transfer speed of 500 Kbps and is designed for
real time information transfer and control. The network will remain operational, but at a degraded
level when certain circuit faults are present. The HS-CAN network may remain operational with
only one termination resistor present.
The following modules are on the HS-CAN network: Powertrain control module (PCM)
- Anti-lock brake system (ABS) module
- Restraints control module (RCM)
- Instrument cluster
- Transmission control module (TCM)
- Four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped)
- Air suspension module (if equipped)
HS-CAN Network Communication Fault Chart
The fault chart describes the specific HS-CAN network failures and their resulting symptom:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3421
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3422
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3423
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3424
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3425
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3426
CAN Network Module Communication Message Chart (Part 6)
The chart describes the specific CAN network messages broadcast by each module, and the
module(s) that receive the message:
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
This provides step-by-step module configuration procedures. Carry out the programmable module
installation (PMI) procedure when another Vehicle System directs to carry out configuration or
when DTCs from the list are present. See: Body Control Module/Service and Repair
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
Configurable modules accommodate a variety of vehicle options, eliminating the need for many
unique modules for one vehicle line. These modules must be configured when replaced as part of a
repair procedure.
Configurable modules should not be exchanged between vehicles since the settings are unique to
each vehicle. Failure to configure a new module may result in improper operation and/or any of the
following DTCs setting:
- B2477 and/or B2141 - sets when a body/chassis module is not configured.
- B2900 - sets when there is a VIN mismatch between the module with the B2900 and the PCM.
Either the PCM or the body module stored VIN may be incorrect.
- P0602, P0605 and/or P1639 - sets when the powertrain control module (PCM) vehicle
identification (VID) block is not configured or is configured incorrectly.
- U0300 and/or U0301 - sets when the configuration between 2 or more modules do not match.
- U2050 and/or U2051 - sets when a valid strategy/calibration is not present.
The following are the 3 different methods of configuration:
- Programmable module installation (PMI)
- Module reprogramming (flashing)
- Programmable parameters
Some modules do not support all 3 methods.
Definition of Terms
The following are definitions of configuration terms:
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) PMI is a scan tool process which configures settings in a
new module. Data used for the PMI process is automatically downloaded from the original module
and stored when a scan tool session is started. If this data cannot be retrieved from the module
being replaced, the scan tool may prompt for As-Built data entry or display a list of parameter
values that need to be manually selected. Some modules are reprogrammed during PMI when a
strategy/calibration update is available.
NOTE: A module must be able to communicate with the scan tool in order to carry out PMI. It is
important that the scan tool identifies the vehicle and obtains configuration data prior to removing
any modules.
To carry out PMI, refer to Programmable Module Installation. See: Body Control Module/Service
and Repair
Module Reprogramming Module reprogramming (also referred to as "flashing") is a scan tool
process which updates the strategy/calibration in a module. Module reprogramming is
automatically carried out during PMI when a later strategy/calibration is available. Reprogramming
a module with the same level of software will not improve module operation or repair a hardware
failure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3427
NOTE: Module reprogramming should be limited to circumstances where a published Technical Service
Bulletin (TSB) procedure recommends doing so.
- A module cannot communicate with other modules on the communication network while being
reprogrammed. Clear any network communication DTCs which may have been set in other
modules during reprogramming.
Programmable Parameters Programmable parameters are customer preference items that may be
modified by the dealer via scan tool or in some cases modified by the customer following a
procedure listed in the vehicle Owner's Literature. While many configuration options may exist for a
module, only a few of these options are programmable parameters.
Adaptive Learning and Calibration
Some modules require a separate learning procedure be carried out if replaced as part of a repair
procedure. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
Vehicle Identification (VID) Block
Some PCMs contain a memory area called a vehicle identification (VID) block. The PCM VID block
commonly stores powertrain configuration items such as VIN, tire size, axle ratio, and whether or
not the vehicle is equipped with speed control.
As-Built Data
As-Built data is a VIN specific module configuration record. During vehicle build, the configuration
from all modules is downloaded and stored in the As-Built database. As Built data will not reflect
customer preference items that have been changed from the default state. These items will need to
be changed using programmable parameters after the module is configured.
NOTE: It is not necessary to obtain As-Built data unless directed to do so by the scan tool. This
data may be accessed from the technician service publication website.
Body/Chassis Module Addresses For As-Built Entry
The chart lists body/chassis module As-Built data addresses:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3428
Module Configuration And Parameter Index (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3429
Module Configuration And Parameter Index (Part 2)
Module Configuration And Parameter Index (Part 3)
The chart describes specific module programming information:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3430
U0001-U0114
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3431
U0121-U0155
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3432
U0155-U0208
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3433
U0230-U2023
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3434
U2023-U2473
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3435
B2477-B2900
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3436
P0602-P1639 / U0300-U2050
U2051
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3437
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3438
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Test A: The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST A: THE POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3439
A1-A2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3440
A2-A3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3441
A4
Normal Operation
The PCM communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area network
(HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the PCM. The PCM shares the HS-CAN network with the transmission
control module (TCM), the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, the restraints control module
(RCM), the four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped), the air suspension module (if
equipped) and the instrument cluster.
DTC U0100 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the PCM and failed.
Possible Causes
- Circuit VDB04 (WH/BU) open (HS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB05 (WH) open (HS-CAN -)
- PCM
Test B: The Transmission Control Module (TCM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST B: THE TRANSMISSION CONTROL MODULE (TCM) DOES NOT RESPOND
TO THE SCAN TOOL
B1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3442
B1-B3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3443
B3-B4
Normal Operation
The TCM communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area network
(HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the TCM. The TCM shares the HS-CAN network with the powertrain control
module (PCM), the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, the restraints control module (RCM), the
four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped), the air suspension module (if equipped) and
the instrument cluster. Voltage for the TCM is provided by circuits CBB73 (WH/BN) and SBB37
(GY/RD). Circuit GD113 (BK/YE) provides ground.
DTC U0101 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the TCM and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBB73 (WH/BN) open
- Circuit GD113 (BK/YE) open
- Circuit SBB37 (GY/RD) open
- Circuit VDB04 (WH/BU) open (HS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB05 (WH) open (HS-CAN -)
- TCM
Test C: The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST C: THE ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM (ABS) MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND
TO THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3444
C1-C2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3445
C3-C4
Normal Operation
The ABS module communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area network
(HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the ABS module. The ABS module shares the HS-CAN network with the
powertrain control module (PCM), the transmission control module (TCM), the restraints control
module (RCM), the four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped), the air suspension module
(if equipped) and the instrument cluster. Voltage for the ABS module is provided by circuit CBB77
(WH), and ground is provided by circuit GD120 (BK/GN).
DTC U0121 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the ABS control module
and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBB77 (WH) open
- Circuit GD120 (BK/GN) open
- Circuit VDB04 (WH/BU) open (HS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB05 (WH) open (HS-CAN -)
- ABS module
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3446
Test D: The Restraints Control Module (RCM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST D: THE RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM) DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE SCAN TOOL
D1-D2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3447
D2-D4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3448
D4-D5
Normal Operation
The RCM communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area network
(HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the RCM. The RCM shares the HS-CAN network with the powertrain control
module (PCM), the transmission control module (TCM), the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module,
the four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped), the air suspension module (if equipped)
and the instrument cluster. Voltage for the RCM is provided by circuit CBP32 (GN/VT), and the
RCM is case grounded.
DTC U0151 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the RCM and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBP32 (GN/VT) open
- Circuit VDB04 (WH/BU) open (HS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB05 (WH) open (HS-CAN -)
- Case ground open
- RCM
Test E: The Four Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST E: THE FOUR WHEEL DRIVE 4WD) CONTROL MODULE DOES NOT
RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3449
E1-E2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3450
E3-E4
Normal Operation
The 4WD control module communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area
network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the 4WD control module. The 4WD control module shares the HS-CAN with
powertrain control module (PCM), the transmission control module (TCM), the anti-lock brake
system (ABS) module, the restraints control module (RCM), the air suspension module if equipped)
and the instrument cluster. Voltage is supplied by circuits CBP35 (YE/GY), SBB35 BU/RD) and
SBB43 (BU/RD). Ground is supplied by circuits GD123 (BK/GY) and GD133 (BK).
DTC U0102 or DTC U0114 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the 4WD
control module and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBP35 (YE/GY) open
- Circuit GD123 (BK/GY) open
- Circuit GD133 (BK) open
- Circuit SBB35 (BU/RD) open
- Circuit SBB43 (BU/RD) open
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3451
- Circuit VDB04 (WH/BU) open (HS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB05 (WH) open (HS-CAN -)
- 4WD control module
Test F: The Air Suspension Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST F: THE AIR SUSPENSION MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN
TOOL
F1-F2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3452
F3-F4
Normal Operation
The air suspension module communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area
network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide
the network connection to the air suspension module. The air suspension module shares the
HS-CAN with powertrain control module (PCM), the transmission control module (TCM), the
anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, the restraints control module (RCM), the four wheel drive
(4WD) control module (if equipped) and the instrument cluster. Voltage for the air suspension
module is provided by circuits CBB65 (WH/OG) and SBB47 (WH/RD). Circuits GD120 (BK/GN)
and GD133 (BK) provide ground.
DTC U0122 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the air suspension
module and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBB65 (WH/OG) open
- Circuit SBB47 (WH/RD) open
- Circuit GD120 (BK/GN) open
- Circuit GD133 (BK) open
- Circuit VDB04 (WH/BU) open (HS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB05 (WH) open (HS-CAN -)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3453
- Air suspension module
Test G: The Instrument Cluster Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST G: THE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
G1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3454
G1-G3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3455
G4-G5
Normal Operation
The instrument cluster communicates with the scan tool through the high speed controller area
network (HS-CAN). Circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) provide
the HS-CAN network connection to the instrument cluster and circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN
+) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the MS-CAN network connection to the instrument
cluster. The instrument cluster shares the HS-CAN network with the powertrain control module
(PCM), the transmission control module (TCM), the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, the
restraints control module (RCM), the four wheel drive (4WD) control module (if equipped) and the
air suspension module (if equipped). The instrument cluster shares the MS-CAN network with the
smart junction box (SJB), the electronic manual temperature control module (if equipped), the
electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R)
amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the driver seat module (DSM) (if
equipped), the climate controlled seat module (if equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped),
the parking aid module (if equipped), the power running board module (if equipped), the auxiliary
audio module and the digital versatile disc (DVD) player. Voltage for the instrument cluster is
provided by circuits CBP29 (WH/VT) and SBP26 (YE/RD). Circuit GD133 (BK) provides ground.
DTC U0155 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the instrument cluster
and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBP29 (WH/VT) open
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3456
- Circuit GD133 (BK) open
- Circuit SBP26 (YE/RD) open
- Circuit VDB04 (WH/BU) open (HS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB05 (WH) open (HS-CAN -)
- Instrument cluster
Test H: The Smart Junction Box (SJB) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST H: THE SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB) DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN
TOOL
H1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3457
H1-H3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3458
H3-H4
Normal Operation
The SJB communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area network
(MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the SJB. The SJB shares the MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster,
the electronic manual temperature control module (if equipped), the electronic automatic
temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if
equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the
climate controlled seat module (if equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped), the parking
aid module (if equipped), the power running board module (if equipped), the auxiliary audio module
(if equipped) and the digital versatile disc (DVD) player (if equipped). Voltage for the SJB is
provided by circuit CDC33 (VT/GN). Circuit GD133 (BK) provides ground.
DTC U0140 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the SJB and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CDC33 (VT/GN) open
- Circuit GD133 (BK) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- SJB
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3459
Test I: The Electronic Manual Temperature Control Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST I: THE ELECTRONIC MANUAL TEMPERATURE CONTROL MODULE DOES
NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
I1-I2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3460
I2-I3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3461
I3-I4
Normal Operation
The electronic manual temperature control module communicates with the scan tool through the
medium speed controller area network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and
VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the electronic manual temperature
control module. The electronic manual temperature control module shares the MS-CAN network
with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if
equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the auxiliary audio module, the digital versatile
disc (DVD) player, the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the power running board module,
the parking aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate module and the climate controlled seat
module (if equipped). Voltage for the electronic manual temperature control module is provided by
circuits CBP37 (WH) and SBP15 (WH/RD). Circuit GD133 (BK) provides ground.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBP37 (WH) open
- Circuit GD133 (BK) open
- Circuit SBP15 (WH/RD) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- Electronic manual temperature control module
Test J: The Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module Does Not Respond To The
Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST J: THE ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL (EATC)
MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3462
J1-J2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3463
J3-J4
Normal Operation
The EATC module communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area
network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the EATC module. The EATC module shares the MS-CAN
network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the audio unit, the THX(R)
amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the auxiliary audio module, the
digital versatile disc (DVD) player, the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the power running
board module, the parking aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate module and the climate
controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the EATC module is provided by circuits CBP37
(WH) and SBP15 (WH/RD). Circuit GD133 (BK) provides ground.
DTC U0164 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the EATC module and
failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBP37 (WH) open
- Circuit GD133 (BK) open
- Circuit SBP15 (WH/RD) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3464
- EATC module
Test K: The Audio Unit Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST K: THE AUDIO UNIT DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
K1-K2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3465
K2-K3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3466
K4
Normal Operation
There are 2 types of audio units used on this vehicle, the base audio unit (Audiophile) and the
THX(R) audio unit (if equipped). Both audio units communicate with the scan tool through the
medium speed controller area network (CAN), circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) and VDB07 (VT/OG).
Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the network
connection to the audio unit. The audio unit shares the MS-CAN network with the instrument
cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic manual temperature control module (if
equipped), the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio
unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the auxiliary audio
module, the digital versatile disc (DVD) player, the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the
power running board module, the parking aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate module and
the climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the audio unit is provided by circuit
SBP39 (WH/RD). Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) provides ground.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) open
- Circuit SBP39 (WH/RD) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- THX(R) amplifier
Test L: The THX(R) Amplifier Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST L: THE THX(R) AMPLIFIER DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
L1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3467
L1-L3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3468
L3-L4
Normal Operation
The THX(R) amplifier communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area
network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the THX(R) amplifier. The THX(R) amplifier shares the MS-CAN
network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic manual
temperature control module (if equipped), the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC)
module (if equipped), the audio unit, the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the auxiliary audio
module, the digital versatile disc (DVD) player, the driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the
power running board module (if equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate
module (if equipped) and the climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the THX(R)
amplifier is provided by circuits SBP38 (BN/RD) and SBP40 (VT/RD). Three circuits GD114
(BK/BU) provide ground.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) open
- Circuit SBP38 (BN/RD) open
- Circuit SBP40 (VT/RD) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- Audio unit
Test M: The Satellite Radio Receiver Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST M: THE SATELLITE RADIO RECEIVER DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN
TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3469
M1-M2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3470
M3-M4
Normal Operation
The satellite radio receiver communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller
area network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the satellite radio receiver. The satellite radio receiver shares the
MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic manual
temperature control module (if equipped), the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC)
module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the auxiliary audio module
(if equipped), the digital versatile disc (DVD) player (if equipped), the driver seat module (DSM) (if
equipped), the power running board module (if equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the
power liftgate module (if equipped) and the climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage
for the satellite radio receiver is provided by circuit SBP03 (BU/RD). Circuit GD114 (BK/BU)
provides ground.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) open
- Circuit SBP03 (BU/RD) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- Satellite radio receiver
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3471
Test N: The Auxiliary Audio Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST N: THE AUXILIARY AUDIO MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN
TOOL
N1-N2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3472
N2-N3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3473
N4
Normal Operation
Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the network
connection to the auxiliary audio module. The auxiliary audio module shares the MS-CAN network
with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic manual temperature control
module (if equipped), the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped),
the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the
driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped), the power running board module (if equipped), the parking
aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped) and the climate controlled seat
module (if equipped). Voltage for the auxiliary audio module is provided by circuit SBP03 (BU/RD).
Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) provides ground.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) open
- Circuit SBP03 (BU/RD) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- Auxiliary audio module
Test O: The Digital Versatile Disc (DVD) Player Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST O: THE DIGITAL VERSATILE DISC (DVD) PLAYER DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE SCAN TOOL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3474
O1-O2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3475
O3-O4
Normal Operation
The DVD player communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area
network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the DVD player. The DVD player is only on vehicles equipped
with rear seat entertainment. The DVD player shares the MS-CAN network with the instrument
cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic manual temperature control module (if
equipped), the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio
unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the driver seat
module (DSM) (if equipped), the power running board module (if equipped), the parking aid module
(if equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped) and the climate controlled seat module (if
equipped). Voltage for the DVD player is provided by circuit SBP03 (BU/RD). Circuit GD114
(BK/BU) provides ground.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit GD114 (BK/BU) open
- Circuit SBP03 (BU/RD) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- DVD player
Test P: The Driver Seat Module (DSM) Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3476
PINPOINT TEST P: THE DRIVER SEAT MODULE DSM) DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN
TOOL
P1-P2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3477
P2-P3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3478
P4
Normal Operation
The DSM communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller area network
(MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) provide the
network connection to the DSM. The DSM shares the MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster,
the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic manual temperature control module (if equipped), the
electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R)
amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the power running board module (if
equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped) and the
climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the DSM is provided by circuit SBB45
(GY/RD). Circuit GD143 (BK/VT) provides ground.
DTC U0208 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the DSM and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit GD143 (BK/VT) open
- Circuit SBB45 (GY/RD) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- DSM
Test Q: The Climate Controlled Seat Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST Q: THE CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO
THE SCAN TOOL
Q1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3479
Q2-Q4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3480
Q4-Q5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3481
Q6
Normal Operation
The climate controlled seat module communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed
controller area network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG)
(MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the climate controlled seat module. The climate
controlled seat module shares the MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction
box (SJB), the electronic manual temperature control module (if equipped), the electronic automatic
temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if
equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the power running board module (if equipped),
the parking aid module (if equipped) and the power liftgate module (if equipped). Voltage for the
climate controlled seat module is provided by circuit SBB08 (VT/RD).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit GD138 (BK/WH) open
- Circuit SBB08 (VT/RD) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- Climate controlled seat module
Test R: The Power Running Board Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST R: THE POWER RUNNING BOARD MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE
SCAN TOOL
R1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3482
R1-R2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3483
R3-R4
Normal Operation
The power running board module communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed
controller area network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG)
(MS-CAN -) provide the network connection to the power running board module. The power
running board module shares the MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction
box (SJB), the electronic manual temperature control module (if equipped), the electronic automatic
temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if
equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the power
liftgate module (if equipped) and the climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the
power running board module is provided by circuit SBB07 (WH/RD). Circuit GD143 (BK/VT)
provides ground.
DTC U0244 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the power running board
module and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit GD143 (BK/VT) open
- Circuit SBB07 (WH/RD) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3484
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- Power running board module
Test S: The Parking Aid Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST S: THE PARKING AID MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN TOOL
S1-S2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3485
S2-S3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3486
S4
Normal Operation
The parking aid module communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller
area network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the parking aid module. The parking aid module shares the
MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic manual
temperature control module (if equipped), the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC)
module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver
(if equipped), the power running board module (if equipped), the power liftgate module (if equipped)
and the climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the parking aid module is provided
by circuit CBP35 (YE/GY). Circuit GD133 (BK) provides ground.
DTC U0159 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the parking aid module
and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBP35 (YE/GY) open
- Circuit GD133 (BK) open
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- Parking aid module
Test T: The Power Liftgate Module Does Not Respond To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST T: THE POWER LIFTGATE MODULE DOES NOT RESPOND TO THE SCAN
TOOL
T1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3487
T1-T3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3488
T3-T4
Normal Operation
The power liftgate module communicates with the scan tool through the medium speed controller
area network (MS-CAN). Circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -)
provide the network connection to the power liftgate module. The power liftgate module shares the
MS-CAN network with the instrument cluster, the smart junction box (SJB), the electronic manual
temperature control module (if equipped), the electronic automatic temperature control (EATC)
module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R) amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver
(if equipped), the power running board module (if equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped)
and the climate controlled seat module (if equipped). Voltage for the power liftgate module is
provided by circuits SBP14 (BN/RD) and SBB27 (BU/RD). Circuit GD149 (BK/GY) provides
ground.
DTC U0230 - sets in a module which had attempted to communicate with the power liftgate module
and failed.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit GD149 (BK/GY) open
- Circuit SBP14 (BN/RD) open
- Circuit SBB27 (BU/RD) open
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3489
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open (MS-CAN -)
- Power liftgate module
Test U: No Medium Speed Controller Area Network (MS-CAN) Communication, All Modules Are
Not Responding
PINPOINT TEST U: NO MEDIUM SPEED CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (MS-CAN)
COMMUNICATION, ALL MODULES ARE NOT RESPONDING
U1-U2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3490
U2-U3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3491
U4-U6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3492
U6-U7
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3493
U8-U10
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3494
U10-U14
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3495
U14-U17
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3496
U18-U22
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3497
U22-U26
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3498
U26-U30
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3499
U30-U33
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3500
U33-U35
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3501
U35-U39
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3502
U39-U42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3503
U43-U47
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3504
U47-U51
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3505
U51-U55
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3506
U55-U57
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3507
U58-U61
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3508
U62-U66
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3509
U67-U70
U71
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3510
Normal Operation
The MS-CAN network uses an unshielded twisted pair cable, circuits VDB06 (GY/OG) and VDB07
(VT/OG) provide the network connection to all modules on the network. The smart junction box
(SJB), the instrument cluster, the electronic manual temperature control module (if equipped), the
electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped), the audio unit, the THX(R)
amplifier (if equipped), the satellite radio receiver (if equipped), the auxiliary audio module (if
equipped), the digital versatile disc (DVD) (if equipped), the power running board module (if
equipped), the parking aid module (if equipped), the power liftgate module, the driver seat module,
and the climate controlled seat module (if equipped) all communicate with the scan tool using the
MS-CAN network.
Possible Causes
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) open, short to ground or voltage (MS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) open, short to ground or voltage (MS-CAN -)
- Circuit VDB06 (GY/OG) (MS-CAN +) and circuit VDB07 (VT/OG) (MS-CAN -) shorted together
- SJB
- Instrument cluster
- Audio unit
- THX(R) amplifier (if equipped)
- EATC module (if equipped)
- Electronic manual temperature control module (if equipped)
- Auxiliary audio module (if equipped)
- DVD player (if equipped)
- Driver seat module (DSM) (if equipped)
- Climate controlled seat module (if equipped)
- Satellite radio receiver (if equipped)
- Power running board module (if equipped)
- Parking aid module (if equipped)
- Power liftgate module (if equipped)
Test V: No High Speed Controller Area Network (HS-CAN) Communication, All Modules Are Not
Responding
PINPOINT TEST V: NO HIGH SPEED CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (HS-CAN)
COMMUNICATION, ALL MODULES ARE NOT RESPONDING
V1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3511
V1-V2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3512
V3-V4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3513
V5-V6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3514
V7-V8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3515
V8-V9
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3516
V10-V11
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3517
V12-V15
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3518
V15-V18
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3519
V18-V20
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3520
V20-V22
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3521
V22-V26
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3522
V26-V28
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3523
V28-V30
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3524
V31-V34
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3525
V35
Normal Operation
The HS-CAN uses an unshielded twisted pair cable, circuits VDB04 (WH/BU) and VDB05 (WH).
The powertrain control module (PCM), the transmission control module (TCM), the anti-lock brake
system (ABS) module, the restraints control module (RCM), the four wheel drive (4WD) control
module (if equipped), the air suspension module (if equipped) and the instrument cluster all
communicate with the scan tool using the HS-CAN.
Possible Causes
- Circuit VDB04 (WH/BU) open, short to ground or voltage (HS-CAN +)
- Circuit VDB05 (WH) open, short to ground or voltage (HS-CAN -)
- Circuit VDB04 (WH/BU) (HS-CAN +) and circuit VDB05 (WH) (HS-CAN -) shorted together
- PCM
- RCM
- TCM
- ABS module
- Instrument cluster
- 4WD control module (if equipped)
- Air suspension module (if equipped)
Test W: No Power To The Scan Tool
PINPOINT TEST W: NO POWER TO THE SCAN TOOL
W1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3526
W2-W3
Normal Operation
The scan tool is connected to the data link connector (DLC) to communicate with the high speed
controller area network (HS-CAN) and the medium speed controller area network (MS-CAN)
communications network. Voltage for the scan tool is provided by circuit SBP20 (GN/RD). Ground
is provided by circuits GD113 (BK/YE) and GD138 (BK/WH).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit SBP20 (GN/RD) open
- Circuit GD113 (BK/YE) open
- Circuit GD138 (BK/WH) open
- Scan tool
Programming and Relearning
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 3527
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For instructions, refer to the specific module removal and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Not Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 3528
Information Bus: Service and Repair
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For instructions, refer to the specific module removal and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using The Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When The
Original Module Is Not Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 3. From the
Toolbox icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable
Module Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions,
turn the ignition key to the OFF position, and press the check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen
instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8. If the data is not
available, the IDS displays a screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data
from the technician service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Tools and Equipment > Module Communications Network
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Information Bus > Component
Information > Tools and Equipment > Module Communications Network > Page 3531
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3537
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3538
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3539
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3543
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3544
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3545
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (MIL)
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, Or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately 4 seconds.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if: an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the hardware limited operation strategy (HLOS).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if an indicator or instrument cluster
concern is present.
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the scan tool must be sent, or 3
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
- The MIL flashes after a period of time with the key in the RUN position (engine not running) if
DTC P1000 is set.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3559
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #12
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6R75 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3560
View 151-10 (Transmission - 6HP26 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3561
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3562
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6R75 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #11 > Page 3563
View 151-10 (Transmission - 6HP26 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
C141
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3566
C142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3567
C171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22 > Page 3568
C172
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 3569
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3572
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the HO2S with penetrating and lock lubricant to aid in removal.
Using the special tool, remove the HO2S. To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply a light coat of nickel anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the HO2S.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3573
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3574
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the HO2S with penetrating and lock lubricant to aid in removal.
Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor. To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply a light coat of nickel anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the HO2S.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 3579
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust
Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust
Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3583
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programmable Module
Installation
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Programmable Module Installation
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation Using the Integrated Diagnostic System IDS) When the Original
Module is NOT Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure carried
out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal and
installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle normal. 3. From the Toolbox
icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable Module
Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the
ignition key to the OFF position, and press check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn
the ignition key to the ON position, and press check mark. 8. If the data is not available, the IDS
displays screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data from the technician
service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Programmable Module
Installation > Page 3590
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (Dsm)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new DSM after
installation.
1. Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the DSM forward to remove it from the bracket.
3. Disconnect the battery. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
5. NOTE: Once the module is installed it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the scan tool into the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation
Electronic Throttle Control Module: Description and Operation
TORQUE BASED ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC)
Overview
The torque based ETC is a hardware and software strategy that delivers an engine output torque
(via throttle angle) based on driver demand (pedal position). It uses an electronic throttle body, the
powertrain control module (PCM), and an accelerator pedal assembly to control the throttle
opening and engine torque. The ETC system replaces the standard cable operated accelerator
pedal, idle air control (IAC) valve, 3-wire throttle position (TP) sensor, and mechanical throttle body.
Torque based ETC enables aggressive automatic transmission shift schedules (earlier upshifts and
later downshifts). This is possible by adjusting the throttle angle to achieve the same wheel torque
during shifts, and by calculating this desired torque, the system prevents engine lugging (low RPM
and low manifold vacuum) while still delivering the performance and torque requested by the driver.
It also enables many fuel economy/emission improvement technologies such as variable camshaft
timing (VCT) (deliver same torque during transitions).
Torque based ETC also results in less intrusive vehicle and engine speed limiting, along with
smoother traction control.
Other benefits of ETC are: eliminate cruise control actuators
- eliminate idle air control (IAC) valve
- better airflow range
- packaging (no cable)
- more responsive powertrain at altitude and improved shift quality
It should be noted that the ETC system illuminates a powertrain malfunction indicator (wrench) on
the instrument cluster when a concern is present. Concerns are accompanied by diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs) and may also illuminate the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL).
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB)
The ETB has the following characteristics: 1. The throttle actuator control (TAC) motor is a DC
motor controlled by the PCM (requires 2-wires). The gear ratio from the motor to the throttle
plate shaft is 17:1.
2. There are 2 designs: parallel and in-series. The parallel design has the motor under the bore
parallel to the plate shaft. The motor housing is
integrated into the main housing. The in-series design has a separate motor housing.
3. Two springs are used: one is used to close the throttle (main spring) and the other is in a plunger
assembly that results in a default angle when no
power is applied. This is for limp home reasons (the force of the plunger spring is 2 times stronger
than the main spring). The default angle is usually set to result in a top vehicle speed of 48 km/h
(30 mph). Typically this throttle angle is 7 to 8 degrees from the hard-stop angle.
4. The closed throttle plate hard stop is used to prevent the throttle from binding in the bore (~0.75
degree). This hard stop setting is not adjustable
and is set to result in less airflow than the minimum engine airflow required at idle.
5. Unlike cable operated throttle bodies, the intent for the ETB is not to have a hole in the throttle
plate or to use plate sealant. The hole is not
required in the ETB because the required idle airflow is provided by the plate angle in the throttle
body assembly. This plate angle controls idle, idle quality, and eliminates the need for an IAC
valve.
6. The TP sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant throttle position
signals are required for increased monitoring
reasons. The first TP signal (TP1) has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and
the second signal (TP2) has a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal
operation the negative slope TP signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of
throttle position. The TP sensor assembly requires 4 circuits. 5-volt reference voltage
- Signal return (ground)
- TP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- TP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensors
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3594
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) And Accelerator Pedal Assembly
The ETC strategy uses pedal position sensors as an input to determine the driver demand. 1.
There are 3 pedal position signals required for system monitoring. APP1 has a negative slope
(increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and APP2 and
APP3 both have a positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation
APP1 is used as the indication of pedal position by the strategy.
2. There are 2 VREF circuits, 2 signal return circuits, and 3 signal circuits (a total of 7 circuits and
pins) between the PCM and the APP sensor
assembly. 2 reference voltage circuits (5 volts)
- 2 signal return (ground) circuits
- APP1 voltage with negative voltage slope (5-0 volts)
- APP2 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
- APP3 voltage with positive voltage slope (0-5 volts)
3. The pedal position signal is convened to pedal travel degrees (rotary angle) by the PCM. The
software then converts these degrees to counts,
which is the input to the torque based strategy.
4. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a
concern. The PCM determines if a signal is
incorrect by calculating where it should be, inferred from the other signals. A value is substituted for
an incorrect signal if 2 of the 3 signals are incorrect.
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) System Strategy
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3595
ETC System
The torque based ETC strategy was developed to improve fuel economy and to accommodate
variable camshaft timing (VCT). This is possible by not coupling the throttle angle to the driver
pedal position. Uncoupling the throttle angle (produce engine torque) from the pedal position (driver
demand) allows the powertrain control strategy to optimize fuel control and transmission shift
schedules while delivering the requested wheel torque.
The ETC monitor system is distributed across 2 processors within the PCM: the main powertrain
control processor unit (CPU) and a monitoring processor called an enhanced-quizzer (E-Quizzer)
processor. The primary monitoring function is carried out by the independent plausibility check
(IPC) software, which resides on the main processor. It is responsible for determining the
driver-demanded torque and comparing it to an estimate of the actual torque delivered. If the
generated torque exceeds driver demand by a specified amount, the IPC takes appropriate
corrective action.
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3596
ETC System Failure Mode And Effects Management (Part 2)
Since the IPC and the main controller share the same processor, they are subject to a number of
potential common failure modes. The E-Quizzer processor was added to redundantly monitor
selected PCM inputs and to act as an intelligent watchdog and monitor the performance of the IPC
and the main processor. If it determines that the IPC function is impaired in any way, it takes
appropriate failure mode and effects management (FMEM) actions.
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation:
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3597
Electronic Throttle Monitor Operation (Part 2)
Accelerator and Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Inputs
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check:
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) Sensor Check
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check:
Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Check
Throttle Plate Position Controller (TPPC) Outputs
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Electronic Throttle Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3598
Throttle Plate Controller Check Operation
The purpose of the TPPC is to maintain the throttle position at the desired throttle angle. It is a
separate chip embedded in the PCM. The desired angle is communicated from the main CPU via a
312.5 Hz duty cycle (DC) signal. The TPPC interprets the duty cycle signal as follows: Less than 4% - Out of range, limp home default position.
- Greater than or equal to 4% but less than 6% - Commanded default position, closed.
- Greater than or equal to 6% but less than 7% - Commanded default position. Used for key ON,
engine OFF.
- Greater than or equal to 7% but less than 8% - Enable ice breaker mode. Used to clear potential
ice buildup in the throttle body.
- Greater than or equal to 8% but less than 10% - Closed against hard-stop. Used to learn zero
throttle angle position (hard stop) after key-up.
- Greater than or equal to 10% but less than or equal to 92% - Normal operation, between 0
degrees (hard stop) and 82 degrees, 10% duty cycle equals 0 degrees throttle angle, 92% duty
cycle equals 82 degrees throttle angle.
- Greater than 92% but less than or equal to 96% - Wide open throttle, 82 to 86 degrees throttle
angle.
- Greater than 96% but less than or equal to 100% - Out of range, limp home default position.
The desired angle is relative to the hard-stop angle. The hard stop angle is learned during each
key-up process before the main CPU requests the throttle plate be closed against the hard stop.
The output of the TPPC is a voltage request to the H driver (also in PCM). The H driver is capable
of positive or negative voltage to the electronic throttle body motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 3607
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Engine Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 3612
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To
Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
> Page 3618
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Engine Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2
Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Engine Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare >
Page 3623
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3624
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Engine Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3627
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3628
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3629
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3630
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3631
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3632
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3633
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3634
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3635
Engine Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3636
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3637
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3638
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3639
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3640
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3641
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3642
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3643
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3644
Engine Control Module: Connector Views
C175B (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3645
C175B (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3646
C175E (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3647
C175E (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module
(PCM)
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM)
Removal
1. Retrieve the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration retrieval steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the 2 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the ground cable.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
5. Remove the PCM. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Installation
1. Install the PCM. 2. Position the ground cable and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. Connect the 3 PCM electrical connectors. 4. Connect the battery ground cable.
5. NOTE:
- When a new PCM is installed, the air bag warning indicator will illuminate when the ignition switch
is ON. The warning indicator will remain on until PCM configuration is restored
- Clear all restraints control module (RCM) continuous diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) after
Programmable Module Installation procedure has
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) > Page 3650
been completed on the PCM.
Restore the module configuration. Carry out the module configuration restore steps of the
Programmable Module Installation procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module
(PCM) > Page 3651
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory (EEPROM)
FLASH ELECTRICALLY ERASABLE PROGRAMMABLE READ ONLY MEMORY (EEPROM)
Description
The EEPROM is contained in an integrated circuit (IC) internal to the powertrain control module
(PCM). The EEPROM contains the vehicle strategy including calibration information specific to the
vehicle, and is capable of being programmed or flashed repeatedly.
As part of the calibration there is an area referred to as the vehicle identification (VID) block. The
VID block is programmed when installing a new PCM as described under Programming the VID
Block for a Replacement PCM. Failure to carry out this procedure may generate DTCs P1635 or
P1639. The VID block in an existing PCM can also be tailored to accommodate various hardware
or parameter changes made to the vehicle since production. Failure to carry out this procedure
properly may generate DTC P1635, Tire/Axle Ratio out of Acceptable Range. An incorrect tire/axle
ratio is one of the main causes for DTC P1639. This is described under Making Changes to the VID
Block and also under Making Changes to the PCM Calibration. The VID block contains many items
used by the strategy for a variety of functions. Some of these items include the vehicle identification
number (VIN), octane adjust, fuel octane, fuel type, vehicle speed limit, tire size, axle ratio, the
presence of speed control, and 4-wheel drive electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF) versus manual
shift-on-the-fly (MSOF). Only items applicable to the vehicle hardware and supported by the VID
block is displayed on the scan tool.
When changing items in the VID block, the strategy places range limits on certain items such as
tire and axle ratio. The number of times the VID block may be reconfigured is limited. When this
limit is reached, the scan tool displays a message indicating the need to flash the PCM again to
reset the VID block.
Programming can be carried out by a local Ford dealer or any non-Ford facility. Refer to the scan
tool manufacturer's instruction manual for details.
Programming the VID Block for a Replacement PCM
A new PCM contains the latest strategy and calibration level for a particular vehicle. However, the
VID block is blank and needs programming. There are 2 procedures available. The first is an
automatic data transfer from the old PCM to the new PCM, and the second is manual data entry
into the new PCM.
Automatic data transfer is carried out if the old PCM is capable of communicating. This is done by
using a scan tool to retrieve data from the old PCM before removing it from the vehicle. The stored
data can then be downloaded to the new PCM after it has been installed.
Carry out manual data entry if the old module is damaged or incapable of communicating. Remove
and install a new PCM. Using a compatible scan tool, select and carry out the module/parameter
programming, referring to the scan tool manufacturer's instruction manual. Make certain that all
parameters are included. Failure to properly program tire size in revolutions per mile, (rev/mile
equals 63,360 divided by the tire circumference in inches), axle ratio, 4x4/4x2, and/or MSOF/ESOF
may result in DTCs P1635 and P1639. You may be instructed to contact the As-Built Data Center
for the information needed to manually update the VID block with the scan tool. Contact the center
only if the old PCM cannot be used or the data is corrupt. For Ford and Lincoln Mercury
technicians, contact your National Hotline or the Professional Technician Society (PTS) website for
As-Built data listed under the Service Publications Index. Non-Ford technicians use the
Motorcraft(R) website at www.motorcraft.com. From the Motorcraft(R) homepage, use the search
function to find the Module Programming or As-Built Data.
For Ford and Lincoln Mercury technicians, check the Programmable Module Installation link on the
PTS website for quick Programmable Module data information by vehicle.
Making Changes to the VID Block
A PCM which is programmed may require changes to be made to certain VID information to
accommodate the vehicle hardware. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Making Changes to the PCM Calibration
At certain times, the entire EEPROM needs to be completely reprogrammed. This is due to
changes made to the strategy or calibration after production, or the need to reset the VID block
because it has reached its limit. Refer to Module Reprogramming on the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3655
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3656
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Computers
and Control Systems > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3657
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3662
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3663
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3667
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3668
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3669
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3670
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and the
MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page 3679
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page 3685
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-22-7 > Nov > 08 > Engine, A/T Controls - Driveline Bump When
Braking
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls Driveline Bump When Braking
TSB 08-22-7
11/10/08
DRIVELINE BUMP WHILE BRAKING - BELOW 10 MPH (16 KM/H)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 08-4-13 to update the Issue, Service Procedure and remove the
production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a bump feeling while braking to a stop
below 10 MPH (16 Km/h). This procedure will improve the bump felt while braking to a stop.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION
APPLYING THIS PROCEDURE TO UNITS THAT DO NOT EXHIBIT THE COASTDOWN BUMP
MAY RESULT IN WORSE SHIFT QUALITY.
NOTE
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REPLACE THE MECHATRONIC UNIT. MECHATRONIC
REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System/Portable Diagnostic Software (IDS/PDS) or equivalent and
ID the vehicle.
2. Update the Power Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration using
IDS release 57.8 and higher or 58.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM
2008.9 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website. Since the TCM cannot be
independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine and transmission
calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
a. Verify that the TCM shows 8L1P-7J104-AC (8L1P-7J104-BC for 2008 vehicles built after
12/3/2007) part number after reprogramming is complete.
b. Select the following from IDS, Tool Box, Powertrain, OBD Test Modes, Mode Level 9 Vehicle
info, TCM Cal Part Number.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Then Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-22-7 > Nov > 08 > Engine, A/T Controls - Driveline Bump When
Braking > Page 3691
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn:
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h), remove foot from accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat Steps (a-b) a total of five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1300-1800 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for at least 10 seconds.
g. Repeat steps (e-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
THE HARSH BUMP FELT WHILE BRAKING TO A STOP WILL BE IMPROVED. HOWEVER,
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082207A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Test. Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 07-10-6 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2107/P2110 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P2107/P2110 Set
TSB 07-10-6
05/28/07
MIL ON - DTCS P2107/P2110 - NO DRIVEABILITY CONCERN
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator light
(MIL) on with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P2107 and P2110 with no driveability concerns.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 48.13 and higher or 49.2 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM
2007.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071006A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Check DTCs And Reprogram The PCM (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift
Flare
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh
1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift
Flare > Page 3700
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-22-7 > Nov > 08 > Engine, A/T Controls - Driveline Bump When
Braking > Page 3706
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn:
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h), remove foot from accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat Steps (a-b) a total of five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1300-1800 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for at least 10 seconds.
g. Repeat steps (e-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
THE HARSH BUMP FELT WHILE BRAKING TO A STOP WILL BE IMPROVED. HOWEVER,
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082207A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Test. Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift
Flare > Page 3715
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 3716
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position
Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position
Sensor 1 > Page 3719
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3720
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3721
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
LH camshaft position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the CMP sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Clutch Switch, ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3728
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3729
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3730
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the accessory drive belt. 3.
Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C
compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3734
C107
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3735
Engine Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Typical CHT Sensor
The CHT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with the temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as temperature increases., and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
The CHT sensor is installed in the cylinder head and measures the metal temperature. The CHT
sensor can provide complete engine temperature information and can be used to infer coolant
temperature. If the CHT sensor conveys an overheating condition to the PCM, the PCM initiates a
fail-safe cooling strategy based on information from the CHT sensor. A cooling system concern
such as low coolant or coolant loss could cause an overheating condition. As a result, damage to
major engine components could occur. Using both the CHT sensor and fail-safe cooling strategy,
the PCM prevents damage by allowing air cooling of the engine and limp home capability.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Engine Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3736
Engine Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
CYLINDER HEAD TEMPERATURE (CHT) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the cylinder head temperature (CHT) sensor jumper
harness electrical connector. 3. Remove and discard the CHT sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Coat the CHT sensor threads with high temperature nickel anti-seize lubricant prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Level Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL LEVEL INPUT (FLI)
The FLI is a communications network message. Most vehicle applications use a potentiometer type
FLI sensor connected to a float in the FP module to determine fuel level.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3740
Fuel Level Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All fuel tanks
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Level Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3741
1. Remove the fuel tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the nuts and the fuel pump module cover.
All fuel tanks
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect coupling, the fuel tank
pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump
module quick connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
4. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
5. CAUTION:
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3745
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3746
C435
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3747
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL TANK PRESSURE (FTP) SENSOR
Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
In-Line Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP) Sensor
The FTP sensor or in-line FTP sensor is used to measure the fuel tank pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3748
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
106L (28 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3749
106L (28 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 2)
125L (33 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3750
125L (33 Gallon) Fuel Tank (Part 2)
Removal and Installation
All fuel tanks
1. Remove the fuel tank.
106 L (28 gal.) fuel tank
2. Disconnect the supply and return fuel tubes quick connect couplings from the fuel filter.
All fuel tanks
3. Remove the fuel tank heat shield retainer(s) and remove the fuel tank heat shield. 4. Disconnect
the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel vapor/grade vent valves quick
connect couplings. 5. Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel
pump module quick connect coupling.
6. NOTE: For the 106 L (28 gal.) fuel tank the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly
and fresh air tube are serviced as an assembly.
Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly with the fresh air tube from the
fuel tank.
125 L (33 gal.) fuel tank
7. Remove the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly from the fuel tank.
All fuel tanks
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3751
- Leak test the system. See: Emission Control Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and
Inspection/Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emission repair verification drive cycle. See: Emission Control
Systems/Evaporative Emissions System/Testing and Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair
Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3755
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3756
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR
Typical Stand-Alone/Non-Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensors
Typical Integrated Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Incorporated Into A Drop-in Or Flange-type
MAF Sensor
The IAT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical
resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases
as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the sensor
terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The IAT provides air temperature information to the PCM. The PCM uses the air temperature
information as a correction factor in the calculation of fuel, spark, and air flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3757
The IAT sensor provides a quicker temperature change response time than the ECT or CHT
sensor.
Currently there are 2 design types of IAT sensors used, a stand-alone/non-integrated type and a
integrated type. Both types function the same, however the integrated type is incorporated into the
mass air flow (MAF) sensor instead of being a stand alone sensor.
Supercharged vehicles use 2 IAT sensors. Both sensors are thermistor type devices and operate
as described. One is located before the supercharger at the air cleaner for standard OBD/cold
weather input, while a second sensor (IAT2) is located after the supercharger in the intake
manifold. The IAT2 sensor located after the supercharger provides air temperature information to
the PCM to control spark and to help determine charge air cooler (CAC) efficiency.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 3763
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3764
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3765
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR
Typical Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
The MAP sensor measures intake manifold absolute pressure. The PCM uses information from the
MAP sensor to measure how much exhaust gas is introduced into the intake manifold.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Temperature Sensor For ECM: Description and Operation
ENGINE OIL TEMPERATURE (EOT) SENSOR
Typical EOT Sensor
The EOT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The
electrical resistance of a thermistor decreases as the temperature increases and the resistance
increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance changes the voltage drop across
the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to temperature.
Thermistor-type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in a series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The EOT sensor measures the temperature of the engine oil. The sensor is typically threaded into
the engine oil lubrication system. The PCM can use the EOT sensor input to determine the
following:
- On variable camshaft timing (VCT) applications the EOT input is used to adjust the VCT control
gains and logic for camshaft timing.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input in conjunction with other PCM inputs to determine oil
degradation.
- The PCM can use EOT sensor input to initiate a soft engine shutdown. To prevent engine
damage from occurring as a result of high oil temperatures, the PCM has the ability to initiate a soft
engine shutdown. Whenever engine RPM exceeds a calibrated level for a certain period of time,
the PCM begins reducing power by disabling engine cylinders.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3776
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #12
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6R75 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3777
View 151-10 (Transmission - 6HP26 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3778
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3779
Oxygen Sensor: Locations Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S) #22
View 151-8 (Transmission - 6R75 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#11 > Page 3780
View 151-10 (Transmission - 6HP26 4x4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22
C141
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 3783
C142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 3784
C171
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
#22 > Page 3785
C172
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3786
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2S detects the presence of oxygen in the exhaust and produces a variable voltage
according to the amount of oxygen detected. A high concentration of oxygen (lean air/fuel ratio) in
the exhaust produces a voltage signal less than 0.4 volt. A low concentration of oxygen (rich
air/fuel ratio) produces a voltage signal greater than 0.6 volt. The HO2S provides feedback to the
PCM indicating air/fuel ratio in order to achieve a near stoichiometric air/fuel ratio of 14.7:1 during
closed loop engine operation. The HO2S generates a voltage between 0.0 and 1.1 volts.
Embedded with the sensing element is the HO2S heater. The heating element heats the sensor to
a temperature of 800°C (1,472°F). At approximately 300°C (572°F) the engine can enter closed
loop operation. The VPWR circuit supplies voltage to the heater. The PCM turns the heater on by
providing the ground when the correct conditions occur. The heater allows the engine to enter
closed loop operation sooner. The use of this heater requires the HO2S heater control to be duty
cycled, to prevent damage to the heater.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S)
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HO2S)
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor
(HO2S) electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3789
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the HO2S with penetrating and lock lubricant to aid in removal.
Using the special tool, remove the HO2S. To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply a light coat of nickel anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the HO2S.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3790
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair Catalyst Monitor Sensor
CATALYST MONITOR SENSOR
Exploded View
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the catalyst monitor sensor
electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Heated Oxygen
Sensor (HO2S) > Page 3791
3. NOTE: If necessary, lubricate the HO2S with penetrating and lock lubricant to aid in removal.
Using the special tool, remove the catalyst monitor sensor. To install, tighten to 46 Nm (34 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Apply a light coat of nickel anti-seize lubricant to the threads of the HO2S.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
> Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 3796
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 3800
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3804
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 3807
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page
3808
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Remove the throttle body (TB).
2. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3813
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3814
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3815
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3816
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3817
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3818
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3819
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3820
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3821
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3822
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3823
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3824
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3825
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3826
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3827
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3828
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3829
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Output
Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 3834
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low velocity,
the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3838
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 3841
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3842
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Remove the throttle body (TB).
2. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3847
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3848
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3849
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3850
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3851
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3852
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3853
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3854
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3855
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3856
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3857
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3858
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3859
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3860
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3861
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3862
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3863
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1
C1451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) Valve 1 > Page 3868
C1452
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3869
Variable Valve Timing Actuator: Description and Operation
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) SYSTEM
Overview
The VCT enables rotation of the camshaft(s) relative to the crankshaft rotation as a function of
engine operating conditions. There are 4 types of VCT systems. Exhaust phase shifting (EPS) system - the exhaust cam is the active cam being retarded.
- Intake phase shifting (IPS) system - the intake cam is the active cam being advanced.
- Dual equal phase shifting (DEPS) system - both intake and exhaust cams are phase shifted and
equally advanced or retarded.
- Dual independent phase shifting (DIPS) system - where both the intake and exhaust cams are
shifted independently.
All systems have 4 operational modes: idle, part throttle, wide open throttle (WOT), and default
mode. At idle and low engine speeds with closed throttle, the powertrain control module (PCM)
determines the phase angle based on air flow, engine oil temperature and engine coolant
temperature. At part and wide open throttle the PCM determines the phase angle based on engine
RPM, load, and throttle position. VCT systems provide reduced emissions and enhanced engine
power, fuel economy and idle quality. IPS systems also have the added benefit of improved torque.
In addition, some VCT system applications can eliminate the need for an external exhaust gas
recirculation (EGR) system. The elimination of the EGR system is accomplished by controlling the
overlap time between the intake valve opening and exhaust valve closing. Currently, both the IPS
and DEPS systems are used.
Variable Camshaft Timing (VCT) System
VCT System
The VCT system consists of an electric hydraulic positioning control solenoid, a camshaft position
(CMP) sensor, and a trigger wheel. The CMP trigger wheel has a number of equally spaced teeth
equal to the number (n) of cylinders on a bank plus one extra tooth (n+1). Four cylinder and V8
engines use a CMP 4+1 tooth trigger wheel. V6 engines use a CMP 3+1 tooth trigger wheel. The
extra tooth placed between the equally spaced teeth represents the CMP signal for that bank. A
crankshaft position sensor (CKP) provides the PCM with crankshaft positioning information in 10
degree increments. 1. The PCM receives input signals from the intake air temperature (IAT)
sensor, engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor, engine oil temperature
(EOT) sensor, CMP, throttle position (TP) sensor, mass air flow (MAF) sensor, and CKP to
determine the operating conditions of the engine. At idle and low engine speeds with closed
throttle, the PCM controls the camshaft position based on ECT, EOT, IAT, and MAF. During part
and wide open throttle, the camshaft position is determined by engine RPM, load and throttle
position. The VCT system does not operate until the engine is at normal operating temperature.
2. The VCT system is enabled by the PCM when the correct conditions are met. 3. The CKP signal
is used as a reference for CMP positioning. 4. The VCT solenoid valve is an integral part of the
VCT system. The solenoid valve controls the flow of engine oil in the VCT actuator assembly.
As the PCM controls the duty cycle of the solenoid valve, oil pressure/flow advances or retards the
cam timing. Duty cycles near 0% or 100% represent rapid movement of the camshaft. Retaining a
fixed camshaft position is accomplished by dithering (oscillating) the solenoid valve duty cycle.
The PCM calculates and determines the desired camshaft position. It continually updates the VCT
solenoid duty cycle until the desired position is achieved. A difference between the desired and
actual camshaft position represents a position error in the PCM VCT control loop. The PCM
disables the VCT and places the camshaft in a default position if a concern is detected. A related
DTC is also set when the concern is detected.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Actuator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3870
5. When the VCT solenoid is energized, engine oil is allowed to flow to the VCT actuator assembly
which advances or retards the camshaft timing.
One half of the VCT actuator is coupled to the camshaft and the other half is connected to the
timing chain. Oil chambers between the 2 halves couple the camshaft to the timing chain. When
the flow of oil is shifted from one side of the chamber to the other, the differential change in oil
pressure forces the camshaft to rotate in either an advance or retard position depending on the oil
flow.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Variable Valve Timing Solenoid >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Variable Valve Timing Solenoid: Service and Repair
VARIABLE CAMSHAFT TIMING (VCT) OIL CONTROL SOLENOID
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the valve cover.
2. Remove the bolt and the variable camshaft timing (VCT) oil control solenoid.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor
OUTPUT SHAFT SPEED (OSS) SENSOR
The OSS sensor provides the PCM with information about the rotational speed of an output shaft.
The PCM uses the information to control and diagnose powertrain behavior. In some applications,
the sensor is also used as the source of vehicle speed. The sensor may be physically located in
different places on the vehicle, depending upon the specific application. The design of each speed
sensor is unique and depends on which powertrain control feature uses the information that is
generated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Output Shaft Speed (OSS) Sensor > Page 3878
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
VEHICLE SPEED SENSOR (VSS)
Typical Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
The VSS is a variable reluctance or hall-effect sensor that generates a waveform with a frequency
that is proportional to the speed of the vehicle. If the vehicle is moving at a relatively low velocity,
the sensor produces a signal with a low frequency. As the vehicle velocity increases, the sensor
generates a signal with a higher frequency. The PCM uses the frequency signal generated by the
VSS (and other inputs) to control such parameters as fuel injection, ignition control,
transmission/transaxle shift scheduling, and torque converter clutch scheduling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Diverter Solenoid >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Diverter Solenoid: Description and Operation
SECONDARY AIR INJECTION (AIR) BYPASS SOLENOID
Secondary AIR Bypass Solenoid
The secondary AIR bypass solenoid is used by the PCM to control vacuum to the secondary air
injection diverter (AIR diverter) valve. The secondary AIR bypass solenoid is a normally closed
solenoid. The secondary AIR bypass solenoid also has a filtered vent feature to permit vacuum
release.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Diverter Valve >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Diverter Valve: Description and Operation
SECONDARY AIR DIVERTER VALVE
Secondary AIR Diverter Valve
The secondary AIR diverter valve is used with the secondary AIR pump to provide on/off control of
air to the exhaust manifold and catalytic converter. When the secondary AIR pump is on and
vacuum is supplied to the AIR diverter valve, air passes the integral check valve disk. When the
secondary AIR pump is off, and vacuum is removed from the AIR diverter valve, the integral check
valve disk is held on the seat and stops air from being drawn into the exhaust system and prevents
the back flow of the exhaust into the secondary AIR system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Air Injection > Air Injection Pump >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Injection Pump: Description and Operation
SECONDARY AIR PUMP
Secondary Air Pump
The secondary AIR pump provides pressurized air to the secondary AIR system. The secondary
AIR pump functions independently of RPM and is controlled by the PCM. The secondary AIR pump
is only used for short periods of time. Delivery of air is dependent on the amount of system
backpressure and system voltage. The secondary AIR pump draws dry filtered air from the intake
air system downstream of the MAF/IAT sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
CATALYST AND EXHAUST SYSTEMS
Overview
V-Engines
In-Line Engines
The catalytic converter and exhaust Systems work together to control the release of harmful engine
exhaust emissions into the atmosphere. The engine exhaust gas consists mainly of nitrogen (N),
carbon dioxide (CO2) and water vapor (H2O) However, it also contains carbon monoxide (CO),
oxides of nitrogen (NOx), hydrogen (H), and various unburned hydrocarbons (HCs). The major air
pollutants of CO, NOx, and HCs, and their emission into the atmosphere must be controlled.
The exhaust system generally consists of an exhaust manifold, front exhaust pipe, front heated
oxygen sensor (HO2S), rear exhaust pipe, catalyst HO2S, a muffler, and an exhaust tailpipe. The
catalytic converter is typically installed between the front and rear exhaust pipes. On some vehicle
applications, more than one catalyst is used between the front and rear exhaust pipes. Catalytic
converter efficiency is monitored by the on board diagnostic (OBD) system strategy in the PCM.
For information on the OBD catalyst monitor, refer to the description for the Catalyst Efficiency
Monitor. See: Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Monitors, Trips, Drive
Cycles and Readiness Codes/Monitors/Catalyst Efficiency Monitor
The number of HO2Ss used in the exhaust stream and the location of these sensors depend on the
vehicle emission certification level (LEV, LEV-II, ULEV, PZEV). On most vehicles only 2 HO2Ss are
used in an exhaust stream. The front sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control while the ones after the catalyst (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor
catalyst efficiency. However, some partial zero emission vehicles (PZEV) use 3 HO2Ss for each
engine bank. The stream 1 sensors (HO2S11/HO2S21) located before the catalyst are used for
primary fuel control, the stream 2 sensors (HO2S12/HO2S22) are used to monitor the light-off
catalyst, and the stream 3 sensors (HO2S13/HO2S23) located after the catalyst are used for long
term fuel trim control to optimize catalyst efficiency (fore aft oxygen sensor control). Current PZEV
vehicles use only a 4-cylinder engine, so only the bank 1 HO2Ss are used.
Catalytic Converter
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3893
A catalyst is a material that remains unchanged when it initiates and increases the speed of a
chemical reaction. A catalyst also enables a chemical reaction to occur at a lower temperature. The
concentration of exhaust gas products released to the atmosphere must be controlled. The
catalytic converter assists in this task. It contains a catalyst in the form of a specially treated
ceramic honeycomb structure saturated with catalytically active precious metals. As the exhaust
gases come in contact with the catalyst, they are changed into mostly harmless products. The
catalyst initiates and speeds up heat producing chemical reactions of the exhaust gas components
so they are used up as much as possible.
Light Off Catalyst
As the catalyst heats up, converter efficiency rises rapidly. The point at which conversion efficiency
exceeds 50% is called catalyst light off. For most catalysts this point occurs at 246°C to 302°C
(475°F to 575°F). A fast light catalyst is a 3-way catalyst (TWC) that is located as close to the
exhaust manifold as possible. Because the light off catalyst is located close to the exhaust manifold
it lights off faster and reduces emissions more quickly than the catalyst located under the body.
Once the catalyst lights off, the catalyst quickly reaches the maximum conversion efficiency for that
catalyst.
Three-Way Catalyst (TWC) Conversion Efficiency
TWC Conversion Efficiency Chart
A TWC requires a stoichiometric fuel ratio, 14.7 pounds of air to 1 pound of fuel (14.7:1), for high
conversion efficiency. In order to achieve these high efficiencies, the air/fuel ratio must be tightly
controlled with a narrow window of stoichiometry. Deviations outside of this window greatly
decrease the conversion efficiency. For example a rich mixture decreases the HC and CO
conversion efficiency while a lean mixture decreases the NOx conversion efficiency.
Exhaust System
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 2 HO2S Configuration
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3894
Typical Bank 1 Catalyst 3 HO2S Configuration
The purpose of the exhaust system is to convey engine emissions from the exhaust manifold to the
atmosphere. Engine exhaust emissions are directed from the engine exhaust manifold to the
catalytic converter through the front exhaust pipe. A HO2S is mounted on the front exhaust pipe
before the catalyst. The catalytic converter reduces the concentration of CO, unburned HCs, and
NOx in the exhaust emissions to an acceptable level. The reduced exhaust emissions are directed
from the catalytic converter past another HO2S mounted in the rear exhaust pipe and then on into
the muffler. Finally, the exhaust emissions are directed to the atmosphere through an exhaust
tailpipe.
On some PZEV, there is a total of 3 HO2S in the exhaust stream. One near the exhaust manifold
(stream 1), one in the middle of the light-off catalyst (stream 2), and the third (stream 3) is mounted
after the light-off catalyst.
Underbody Catalyst
The underbody catalyst is located after the light off catalyst. The underbody catalyst may be in line
with the light off catalyst, or the underbody catalyst may be common to 2 light off catalysts, forming
a Y pipe configuration. For an exact configuration of the catalyst and exhaust system for a specific
vehicle, refer to Catalytic Converter, Exhaust System.
Three-Way Catalytic (TWC) Converter
The TWC converter contains either platinum (Pt) and rhodium (Rh) or palladium (Pd) and rhodium
(Rh). The TWC converter catalyzes the oxidation reactions of unburned HCs and CO and the
reduction reaction of NOx. The 3-way conversion can be best accomplished by always operating
the engine air fuel/ratio at or close to stoichiometry.
Exhaust Manifold Runners
The exhaust manifold runners collect exhaust gases from engine cylinders. The number of exhaust
manifolds and exhaust manifold runners depends on the engine configuration and number of
cylinders.
Exhaust Pipes
Exhaust pipes are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to
increase the life of the product. The pipes serve as guides for the flow of exhaust gases from the
engine exhaust manifold through the catalytic converter and the muffler.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
The HO2Ss provide the powertrain control module (PCM) with voltage and frequency information
related to the oxygen content of the exhaust gas.
Muffler
Mufflers are usually treated during manufacturing with an anti-corrosive coating agent to increase.
the life of the product. The muffler reduces the level of noise produced by the engine, and also
reduces the noise produced by exhaust gases as they travel from the catalytic converter to the
atmosphere.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams
C1195
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3899
Canister Purge Control Valve: Description and Operation
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION (EVAP) CANISTER PURGE VALVE
Typical EVAP Canister Purge Valve
NOTE: The EVAP canister purge valve may also be referred to as a vapor management valve
(VMV).
The EVAP canister purge valve is part of the enhanced EVAP system that is controlled by the
PCM. This valve controls the flow of vapors (purging) from the EVAP canister to the intake manifold
during various engine operating modes. The EVAP canister purge valve is a normally closed valve.
The EVAP canister purge valve controls the flow of vapors by way of a solenoid, eliminating the
need for an electronic vacuum regulator and vacuum diaphragm. The PCM outputs a signal
between 0 mA and 1,000 mA to control the EVAP canister purge valve.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3900
Canister Purge Control Valve: Service and Repair
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER PURGE VALVE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3901
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3902
Exploded View
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3903
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The evaporative emissions system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquid fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions can result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the evaporative emissions (EVAP) canister
purge valve electrical connector. 3. Disconnect the intake manifold-to-EVAP canister purge valve
vapor tube quick connect coupling. 4. Disconnect the EVAP canister-to-EVAP canister purge valve
vapor tube quick connect coupling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3904
5. Pull the EVAP canister purge valve release tab and slide the EVAP canister purge valve off the
bracket. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Leak test the system. See: Testing and Inspection/Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emissions repair verification drive cycle. See: Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair
DUST SEPARATOR
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3908
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3909
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: The evaporative emission canister vent solenoid and dust separator are an assembly.
This assembly is removed with the evaporative
emission canister vent solenoid.
Refer to Evaporative Emission Canister Vent Solenoid. See: Leak Detection Valve/Service and
Repair
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair
Evaporative Emission Control Canister: Service and Repair
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3913
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3914
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The evaporative emissions system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquid fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions can result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Emission Control Canister > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3915
NOTE: The evaporative emission canister vent solenoid and dust separator are an assembly.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical jumper from the wiring harness. 4.
Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-EVAP canister quick connect
coupling. 5. Disconnect the EVAP canister purge valve vapor tube-to-EVAP canister quick connect
coupling. 6. Disconnect the fresh air tube-to-canister vent solenoid and dust separator assembly
quick connect coupling. 7. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket-to-frame rail bolt in the
rear.
- Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
8. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket-to-frame rail bolt in the front.
- Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
9. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket and exhaust Y-pipe-dual catalytic converter heat
shield-to-transmission crossmember bolt and
remove the EVAP canister assembly from the vehicle. Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
10. NOTE: Lowering the corner of the EVAP canister assembly bracket will aid in disconnecting the
EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical
connector.
Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical connector.
11. Remove the EVAP canister-to-EVAP canister assembly bracket bolts.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
12. Remove the EVAP canister assembly from the EVAP canister assembly bracket. 13. Remove
the canister vent solenoid and dust separator assembly from the EVAP canister. 14. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
- Leak test the system. See: Testing and Inspection/Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emissions repair verification drive cycle. See: Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (LH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3919
C4116
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3920
Leak Detection Valve: Description and Operation
CANISTER VENT (CV) SOLENOID
Typical Canister Vent (CV) Solenoid
During the evaporative emissions (EVAP) leak check monitor, the CV solenoid seals the EVAP
canister from the atmospheric pressure. This allows the EVAP canister purge valve to obtain the
target vacuum in the fuel tank during the EVAP leak check monitor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3921
Leak Detection Valve: Service and Repair
EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CANISTER VENT SOLENOID
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3922
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3923
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The evaporative emissions system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquid fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions can result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System > Leak
Detection Valve, Evaporative System > Component Information > Locations > Page 3924
NOTE: The evaporative emission canister vent solenoid and dust separator are an assembly.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3.
Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical jumper from the wiring harness. 4.
Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-EVAP canister quick connect
coupling. 5. Disconnect the EVAP canister purge valve vapor tube-to-EVAP canister quick connect
coupling. 6. Disconnect the fresh air tube-to-canister vent solenoid and dust separator assembly
quick connect coupling. 7. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket-to-frame rail bolt in the
rear.
- Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
8. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket-to-frame rail bolt in the front.
- Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
9. Remove the EVAP canister assembly bracket and exhaust Y-pipe-dual catalytic converter heat
shield-to-transmission crossmember bolt and
remove the EVAP canister assembly from the vehicle. Tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
10. NOTE: Lowering the corner of the EVAP canister assembly bracket will aid in disconnecting the
EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical
connector.
Disconnect the EVAP canister vent solenoid electrical connector.
11. Remove the EVAP canister-to-EVAP canister assembly bracket bolts in the front of the
canister.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
12. Remove the canister vent solenoid and dust separator assembly from the EVAP canister. 13.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Leak test the system. See: Testing and Inspection/Emission System Leak Test
- Carry out the evaporative emissions repair verification drive cycle. See: Testing and
Inspection/Evaporative Emission Repair Verification Drive Cycle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid > Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Electronic Vacuum Regulator Solenoid: Description and Operation
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) VACUUM REGULATOR SOLENOID
EGR Vacuum Regulator Solenoid
Vacuum Output (IN-HG)
EGR Vacuum Regulator Solenoid Data
The EGR vacuum regulator solenoid is an electromagnetic device used to regulate the vacuum
supply to the EGR valve. The solenoid contains a coil which magnetically controls the position of a
disc to regulate the vacuum. As the duty cycle to the coil increases, the vacuum signal passed
through the solenoid to the EGR valve also increases. Vacuum not directed to the EGR valve is
vented through the solenoid vent to atmosphere. Note that at 0% duty cycle (no electrical signal
applied), the EGR vacuum regulator solenoid allows some vacuum to pass, but not enough to open
the EGR valve.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Tube
> Component Information > Description and Operation
EGR Tube: Description and Operation
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) ORIFICE TUBE ASSEMBLY
EGR Orifice Tube Assembly
The orifice tube assembly is a section of tubing connecting the exhaust system to the intake
manifold. The assembly provides the flow path for the EGR to the intake manifold and also
contains the metering orifice and 2 pressure pick-up tubes. The internal metering orifice creates a
measurable pressure drop across it as the EGR valve opens and closes. This pressure differential
across the orifice is picked up by the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor which provides
feedback to the PCM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve
ELECTRIC EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EEGR) VALVE
EEGR Motor/Valve Assembly
Depending on the application, the EEGR valve is a water cooled or an air cooled motor/valve
assembly. The motor is commanded to move in 52 discrete steps as it acts directly on the EEGR
valve. The position of the valve determines the rate of EGR. The built-in spring works to close the
valve (against the motor opening force).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve > Page 3936
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) System Module (ESM)
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM MODULE (ESM)
ESM
The ESM is an integrated differential pressure feedback EGR system that functions in the same
manner as a conventional differential pressure feedback EGR system. The various system
components have been integrated into a single component called the ESM. The flange of the valve
portion of the ESM bolts directly to the intake manifold with a metal gasket that forms the metering
orifice. This arrangement increases system reliability, response time, and system precision. By
relocating the EGR orifice from the exhaust to the intake side of the EGR valve, the downstream
pressure signal measures manifold absolute pressure (MAP). This MAP signal is used for EGR
correction and inferred barometric pressure (BARO) at key on. The system provides the powertrain
control module (PCM) with a differential pressure feedback EGR signal, identical to a traditional
differential pressure feedback EGR system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR Valve
> Component Information > Description and Operation > Electric Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EEGR) Valve > Page 3937
EGR Valve: Description and Operation Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Valve
EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) VALVE
Typical EGR Valve
EGR Flowrate
The EGR valve in the differential pressure feedback EGR system is a conventional,
vacuum-actuated. The valve increases or decreases the flow of EGR. As vacuum applied to the
EGR valve diaphragm overcomes the spring force, the valve begins to open. As the vacuum signal
weakens, at 5.4 kPa (1.6 in-Hg) or less, the spring force closes the valve. The EGR valve is fully
open at about 15 kPa (4.5 in-Hg).
Since EGR flow requirement varies greatly, providing repair specifications on flow rate is
impractical. The on board diagnostic (OBD) system monitors the EGR valve function and triggers a
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) if the test criteria is not met. The EGR valve flow rate is not
measured directly as part of the diagnostic procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Pressure
Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > Pressure
Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3941
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation > PCV
Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair
PCV Heater: Service and Repair
POSITIVE CRANKCASE VENTILATION (PCV) HEATER ELEMENT
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV)
heater element electrical connector. 3. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the
PCV tube. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the PCV heater element.
- Discard the O-ring seal.
Installation
1. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to Installation.
Using a new O-ring seal, install the PCV heater element and the 2 bolts. Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
2. Position the PCV tube and connect the quick connect couplings. 3. Connect the PCV heater
element electrical connector. 4. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Diagrams
C190
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation
Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor: Description and Operation
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is a ceramic, capacitive-type pressure transducer
that monitors the differential pressure across a metering orifice located in the orifice tube assembly.
The differential pressure feedback EGR sensor receives this signal through 2 hoses referred to as
the downstream pressure hose (REF SIGNAL) and upstream pressure hose (HI SIGNAL). The HI
and REF hose connections are marked on the differential pressure feedback EGR sensor housing
for identification (note that the HI signal uses a larger diameter hose). The differential pressure
feedback EGR sensor outputs a voltage proportional to the pressure drop across the metering
orifice and supplies it to the PCM as EGR flow rate feedback.
DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE FEEDBACK EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SENSOR TUBE MOUNTED
Differential Pressure Feedback Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Sensor - Tube Mounted
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches - Emission
Control Systems > Pressure Feedback Exhaust Sensor, EGR > Component Information > Description and Operation >
Page 3953
The tube mounted differential pressure feedback EGR sensor is identical in operation as the large
plastic differential pressure feedback EGR sensors and uses a 1.0 volt offset. The HI and REF
hose connections are marked on the side of the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > System Information
> Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
Key on, engine off.................................................................................................................................
.............................................240-310 kPa (35-45 psi) Engine running.................................................
..................................................................................................................................193-310 kPa
(28-45 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release > System
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing a fire hazard. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the Schrader valve cap and attach the pressure gauge.
3. NOTE: Open manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from the
fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the pressure gauge and relieve the fuel pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System Information >
Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
Typical Diagnostic Reference Value
Measured/PID Values 695 RPM ..........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... Hot Idle
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Accelerator Pedal - Fixed
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal - Fixed
ACCELERATOR PEDAL - FIXED
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the accelerator pedal position sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the 3 bolts and the accelerator pedal assembly.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Accelerator Pedal - Fixed > Page 3969
Accelerator Pedal: Service and Repair Accelerator Pedal - Adjustable
ACCELERATOR PEDAL - ADJUSTABLE
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: The brake pedal and the accelerator pedal must be in the same position when installing
a new cable or a new pedal. The pedals must be in the all the way forward or the all the way
rearward position.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the accelerator pedal position sensor
electrical connector. 3. Remove the 3 bolts and the accelerator pedal assembly.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3973
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3974
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER ELEMENT
Exploded View
Removal
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air
cleaner cover.
- To install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 4. Release the retaining clips
and position the air cleaner cover aside. 5. Remove the air cleaner element.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3979
Installation
1. CAUTION: The air cleaner element must be fully seated into the air cleaner housing. Failure to
do so will result in unusual engine noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3983
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3984
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3985
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3986
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and the
MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
CHECK FUEL CAP INDICATOR
The check fuel cap indicator is a communications network message sent by the PCM. The PCM
sends the message to illuminate the lamp when the strategy determines that there is a failure in the
vapor management system due to the fuel filler cap not being sealed correctly. This would be
detected by the inability to pull vacuum in the fuel tank, after a fueling event.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELEASE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing a fire hazard. Failure to
follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Remove the Schrader valve cap and attach the pressure gauge.
3. NOTE: Open manual valve slowly to relieve the system pressure. This may drain fuel from the
fuel system. Place fuel in a suitable container.
Open the manual valve on the pressure gauge and relieve the fuel pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector: Electrical Specifications
Fuel Injector Resistance ......................................................................................................................
............................................................. 11 - 18 Ohms
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1
C181
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4000
C182
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4001
C183
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4002
C184
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4003
Fuel Injector: Diagrams
C181
C182
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4004
C183
C184
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4005
C185
C186
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Fuel Injector 1 > Page 4006
C187
C188
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4007
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation
FUEL INJECTORS
Typical Fuel Injector
CAUTION: Do not apply battery positive voltage (B+) directly to the fuel injector electrical connector
terminals. The solenoids may be damaged internally in a matter of seconds.
The fuel injector is a solenoid-operated valve that meters fuel flow to the engine. The fuel injector is
opened and closed a constant number of times per crankshaft revolution. The amount of fuel is
controlled by the length of time the fuel injector is held open.
The fuel injector is normally closed, and is operated by a 12-volt source from either the electronic
engine control (EEC) power relay or fuel pump relay. The ground signal is controlled by the PCM.
The injector is the deposit resistant injector (DRI) type and does not have to be cleaned. However,
it can be flow checked and, if found outside of specification, a new fuel injector should be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4008
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4009
Exploded View
Removal
WARNING: Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4010
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the fuel supply tube spring lock coupling. 3.
Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe. 4. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the
crankcase vent tube.
5. Disconnect the generator wiring harness retainer from the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-throttle body
(TB) adapter. 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-TB adapter.
- Lubricate the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-TB adapter seal with clean engine coolant prior to
installation.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV)
tube.
8. Disconnect the electronic throttle control electrical connector.
9. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4011
10. Disconnect the heated PCV intake fitting electrical connector. 11. Disconnect the 8 fuel injector
electrical connectors. 12. Remove the 4 fuel rail bolts.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
13. Remove the fuel rail and fuel injectors as an assembly. 14. Remove the 8 fuel injector-to-fuel
rail locking clips.
15. CAUTION: Use O-ring seals that are made of special fuel-resistant material. Use of ordinary
O-ring can cause the fuel system to leak. Do
not reuse the O-ring seals. Lubricate the O-ring seals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Separate the fuel injectors from the fuel rail. Discard the O-ring seals.
16. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the new fuel injector O-ring seals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Spring Lock Couplings
SPRING LOCK COUPLINGS
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect
WARNING:
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
2. Remove the fuel tube safety clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4016
3. Install the special tool.
4. Close and push the special tool into the open side of the cage.
5. Separate the spring lock coupling.
Connect
CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
1. Inspect and clean both spring lock coupling ends. Install new O-ring seals and garter springs if
necessary.
- Lubricate the O-ring seals with clean engine oil.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4017
2. Fit the male fitting into the female end and push until the garter spring snaps over the flared end
of the female end.
3. Make sure the spring lock coupling is engaged by pulling on the lines.
4. Install the fuel tube safety clip.
Disconnect - Type II
WARNING:
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, which can cause a fire hazard.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always cap off any open orifices or tubes.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
1. Release the fuel system pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4018
2. Disconnect the safety clip from the male hose.
3. Install the special tool and press it into the spring lock coupling.
4. Separate the spring lock coupling.
Connect - Type II
1. Inspect and clean both spring lock coupling ends.
2. CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that
the fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the
tube.
NOTE: Lubricate the tube end with clean engine oil to ease assembly.
Align the fuel tubes spring lock coupling and push together until a click is heard.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4019
3. Pull on the spring lock coupling to make sure it is fully engaged, then install the safety clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4020
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Vapor Tube Fittings
VAPOR TUBE FITTINGS
Disconnect
WARNING:
- The evaporative emission system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or fuel liquid is present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect the vapor tube fitting.
- Push the connector toward the tube or fitting to release pressure.
- Press the quick connect fitting button and pull the fuel tube to disconnect.
Connect
CAUTION: Make sure the quick connect fitting clicks into place when installing the tube. To make
sure that the quick connect fitting is fully seated, pull on the tube.
1. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube or fitting before connecting.
Connect the vapor tube fitting.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4021
Fuel Line Coupler: Service and Repair Quick Connect Coupling
QUICK CONNECT COUPLING
Disconnect - Type I
WARNING:
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
1. Disconnect the quick connect coupling.
- Push the connector toward the tube to release pressure.
- Push the release tab clockwise.
- Disconnect the quick connect coupling.
Connect - Type I
CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
1. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube or fitting before connecting.
Connect the quick connect coupling.
Disconnect - Type II
WARNING:
- The evaporative emissions system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquid fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4022
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or have open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- If the liquid or vapor tube is damaged (torn, holes or delaminated), a new tube assembly must be
installed. Do not use aftermarket sleeving. Do not re-adhere loose sleeving material.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components which may
cause fuel leaks.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube, release the fuel system pressure.
2. Press the tab corners to release the locking tab.
3. Pull the locking tab to the release position.
4. Disconnect the quick connect coupling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4023
- Push the fitting toward the tube to release pressure.
- Press the tab corners to release the fitting.
- Disconnect the quick connect fitting.
Connect - Type II
CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that the
fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the tube.
1. NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to the end of the tube or fitting before connecting.
Connect the tube into the quick connect coupling.
2. CAUTION: Make sure the quick connect fitting clicks into place when installing the tube. To
make sure that the quick connect fitting is
fully seated, pull on the fitting.
Press the locking tab down into the locked position.
Disconnect - Type III
WARNING:
- The evaporative emissions system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquid fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or have an open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as a cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- If the liquid or vapor tube is damaged (torn, holes or delaminated), a new tube assembly must be
installed. Do not use aftermarket sleeving. Do not re-adhere loose sleeving material.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4024
connector.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is,
therefore, essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components which may
cause fuel leaks.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube, release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable.
3. Disconnect the fuel tube quick connect coupling.
- Press the fuel tube quick connect coupling button and pull the fuel tube to disconnect.
Connect - Type III
1. CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that
the fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the
tube.
NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to O-ring seals.
Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube until it is fully seated.
Disconnect - Type IV
WARNING:
- The evaporative emissions system contains fuel vapor and condensed fuel vapor. Although not
present in large quantities, it still presents the danger of explosion or fire. Disconnect the battery
ground cable from the battery to minimize the possibility of an electrical spark occurring, possibly
causing a fire or explosion if fuel vapor or liquid fuel are present in the area. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not smoke, or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not carry personal electronic devices such as cell phones, pagers or audio equipment of any
type when working on or near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always
present and can be ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
repairing or disconnecting any of the fuel lines or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel, causing personal injury or a fire
hazard. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- This procedure involves fuel handling. Be prepared for fuel spillage at all times and always
observe fuel handling precautions. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- If the liquid or vapor tube is damaged (torn, holes or delaminated), a new tube assembly must be
installed. Do not use aftermarket sleeving. Do not re-adhere loose sleeving material.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Line Coupler > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Spring Lock Couplings > Page 4025
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube. Apply clean
engine oil to the end of the tube before inserting the tube into the connector.
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- Do not use any tools. The use of tools may cause a deformity in the clip components which may
cause fuel leaks.
1. If servicing a liquid fuel tube, release the fuel system pressure. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable.
3. Disconnect the fuel tube quick connect coupling.
- Press the 2 fuel tube quick connect coupling buttons and pull the fuel tube to disconnect.
Connect - Type IV
1. CAUTION: Make sure the fuel tube clicks into place when installing the tube. To make sure that
the fuel tube is fully seated, pull on the
tube.
NOTE: Apply clean engine oil to O-ring seals.
Install the quick connect coupling onto the tube until it is fully seated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 4030
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Pulsation Damper >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Pressure Pulsation Damper: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PULSE DAMPER
Typical Fuel Rail Pulse Damper
The fuel rail pulse damper is located on the fuel rail and reduces the fuel system noise caused by
the pulsing of the fuel injectors. The vacuum port located on the damper is connected to manifold
vacuum to avoid fuel spillage if the pulse damper diaphragm ruptures. The fuel rail pulse damper
should not be confused with a fuel pressure regulator; it does not regulate the fuel rail pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
System Information > Specifications
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Fuel Pressure
Key on, engine off.................................................................................................................................
.............................................240-310 kPa (35-45 psi) Engine running.................................................
..................................................................................................................................193-310 kPa
(28-45 psi)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4041
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4042
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4043
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail Assembly Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 08S02 Date: 080206
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated by February 6, 2008.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail Assembly Replacement >
Page 4052
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, available through the website by February 6, 2008. Owner names and addresses will be
available by March 7, 2008.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company is offering a refund for owner-paid repairs covered by this recall if the repair
was performed prior to the date indicated in the reimbursement plan, which is posted with this
bulletin. This plan is also available to owners through the Customer Relationship Center (CRC).
The CRC will direct owners to seek reimbursement through authorized dealers or, at their option,
directly through Ford Motor Company at P.O. Box 6251 Dearborn, MI 48121-6251.
^ Dealers are also authorized to refund owner-paid emergency repairs that were performed away
from an authorized servicing dealer after the end date specified in the reimbursement plan.
Non-covered repairs, or those judged by Ford to be excessive, will not be accepted for
reimbursement.
^ Refunds will only be provided for the cost associated with the replacement of the fuel rail.
^ This safety recall must still be performed, even if the customer has paid for a previous repair.
Claiming a refund will not close the recall on the vehicle.
^ Refund Claiming Information (Submit on separate repair line.)
- Program Code: 08S02 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN
- Misc. Expense: REFUND - Misc. Expense: 0.2 Hrs.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail Assembly Replacement >
Page 4053
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from Special Service Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts will not be direct shipped for this program. Order your parts requirements through normal
order processing channels.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures.
EXCESS STOCK RETURN
Excess stock returned for credit must have been purchased from Ford Customer Service Division
in accordance with Policy Procedure Bulletin 4000.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves replacing the Fuel Rail Assembly and injector 0-rings.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Refer to SECTION 303-04: Fuel Charging and Controls on the online version of the appropriate
workshop manual for the latest service procedure for removing and installing the fuel rail. Be sure
to review all removal notes, cautions, and warnings.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail Assembly Replacement >
Page 4054
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail Assembly Replacement >
Page 4055
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail Assembly Replacement >
Page 4056
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Fuel Rail: > NHTSA08V057000 > Feb > 08 > Recall 08V057000: Fuel Rail
Replacement
Fuel Rail: Recalls Recall 08V057000: Fuel Rail Replacement
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/E-150 2006-2007 Ford/E-250 2006-2007
Ford/E-350 2006-2007 Ford/Expedition 2007 Lincoln/Navigator 2007 MANUFACTURER: Ford
Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: February 04, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V057000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Fuel System, Gasoline: Fuel Injection System:
Fuel Rail
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 57199
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 57,199 M/Y 2006-2007 E-150, E-250, E-350, and M/Y 2007
Expedition and Lincoln Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L engines. The fuel rail cross-over
hose may contain weak areas. As a result, the hose may crack, which could cause a fuel odor
and/or fuel leak.
CONSEQUENCE: Fuel leakage in the presence of an ignition source could result in a fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the fuel rail assembly. The recall is expected to begin during March
2008. Owners may contact Ford at 1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 08S02. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail
Assembly Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 08S02 Date: 080206
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated by February 6, 2008.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail
Assembly Replacement > Page 4066
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, available through the website by February 6, 2008. Owner names and addresses will be
available by March 7, 2008.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
^ Ford Motor Company is offering a refund for owner-paid repairs covered by this recall if the repair
was performed prior to the date indicated in the reimbursement plan, which is posted with this
bulletin. This plan is also available to owners through the Customer Relationship Center (CRC).
The CRC will direct owners to seek reimbursement through authorized dealers or, at their option,
directly through Ford Motor Company at P.O. Box 6251 Dearborn, MI 48121-6251.
^ Dealers are also authorized to refund owner-paid emergency repairs that were performed away
from an authorized servicing dealer after the end date specified in the reimbursement plan.
Non-covered repairs, or those judged by Ford to be excessive, will not be accepted for
reimbursement.
^ Refunds will only be provided for the cost associated with the replacement of the fuel rail.
^ This safety recall must still be performed, even if the customer has paid for a previous repair.
Claiming a refund will not close the recall on the vehicle.
^ Refund Claiming Information (Submit on separate repair line.)
- Program Code: 08S02 - Misc. Expense: ADMIN
- Misc. Expense: REFUND - Misc. Expense: 0.2 Hrs.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail
Assembly Replacement > Page 4067
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line on which
the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from Special Service Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
LABOR ALLOWANCES
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts will not be direct shipped for this program. Order your parts requirements through normal
order processing channels.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures.
EXCESS STOCK RETURN
Excess stock returned for credit must have been purchased from Ford Customer Service Division
in accordance with Policy Procedure Bulletin 4000.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves replacing the Fuel Rail Assembly and injector 0-rings.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Refer to SECTION 303-04: Fuel Charging and Controls on the online version of the appropriate
workshop manual for the latest service procedure for removing and installing the fuel rail. Be sure
to review all removal notes, cautions, and warnings.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail
Assembly Replacement > Page 4068
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail
Assembly Replacement > Page 4069
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Rail: > 08S02 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Fuel Rail
Assembly Replacement > Page 4070
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Rail: > NHTSA08V057000 > Feb > 08 > Recall
08V057000: Fuel Rail Replacement
Fuel Rail: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V057000: Fuel Rail Replacement
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/E-150 2006-2007 Ford/E-250 2006-2007
Ford/E-350 2006-2007 Ford/Expedition 2007 Lincoln/Navigator 2007 MANUFACTURER: Ford
Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: February 04, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V057000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Fuel System, Gasoline: Fuel Injection System:
Fuel Rail
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 57199
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 57,199 M/Y 2006-2007 E-150, E-250, E-350, and M/Y 2007
Expedition and Lincoln Navigator vehicles equipped with 5.4L engines. The fuel rail cross-over
hose may contain weak areas. As a result, the hose may crack, which could cause a fuel odor
and/or fuel leak.
CONSEQUENCE: Fuel leakage in the presence of an ignition source could result in a fire.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the fuel rail assembly. The recall is expected to begin during March
2008. Owners may contact Ford at 1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 08S02. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4075
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair
FUEL RAIL
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4076
Exploded View
Removal
WARNING: Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and may be ignited.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
working on or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4077
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the fuel supply tube spring lock coupling. 3.
Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe. 4. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the
crankcase vent tube.
5. Disconnect the generator wiring harness retainer from the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-throttle body
(TB) adapter. 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-TB adapter.
- Lubricate the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-TB adapter seal with clean engine coolant prior to
installation.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Disconnect the quick connect couplings and remove the positive crankcase ventilation (PCV)
tube.
8. Disconnect the electronic throttle control electrical connector.
9. Disconnect the throttle position (TP) sensor electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4078
10. Disconnect the heated PCV intake fitting electrical connector. 11. Disconnect the 8 fuel injector
electrical connectors. 12. Remove the 4 fuel rail bolts.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
13. Remove the fuel rail and fuel injectors as an assembly. 14. Remove the 8 fuel injector-to-fuel
rail locking clips.
15. CAUTION: Use O-ring seals that are made of special fuel-resistant material. Use of ordinary
O-ring can cause the fuel system to leak. Do
not reuse the O-ring seals. Lubricate the O-ring seals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Separate the fuel injectors from the fuel rail. Discard the O-ring seals.
16. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the new fuel injector O-ring seals with clean engine oil prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair
FUEL LINES
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4082
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel which can cause a fire hazard.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Release the fuel system pressure. 3.
Disconnect the fuel tube-to-fuel rail spring lock coupling. 4. Disconnect the evaporative emissions
(EVAP) canister-to-EVAP canister purge valve vapor tube quick connect coupling. 5. Remove the
transmission. 6. Disconnect the fuel tube-to-fuel filter outlet tube spring lock coupling. 7. Disconnect
the EVAP canister purge valve vapor tube-to-EVAP canister quick connect coupling. 8. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Filler Hose: Service and Repair
FUEL TANK FILLER PIPE
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4087
106L (28 Gal) Fuel Tank (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4088
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4089
127L (33.5 Gal) Fuel Tank (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or near any
fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be ignited. Failure
to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Fuel in the fuel system remains under high pressure even when the engine is not running. Before
servicing or disconnecting any of the fuel tubes or fuel system components, the fuel system
pressure must be relieved to prevent accidental spraying of fuel which can cause a fire hazard.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- Fuel injection equipment is manufactured to very precise tolerances and fine clearances. It is
therefore essential that absolute cleanliness is observed when working with these components.
Always install blanking plugs to any open orifices or tubes.
- When reusing liquid or vapor tube connectors, make sure to use compressed air to remove any
foreign material from the connector retaining clip area before separating from the tube.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery ground cable.
3. Remove the fuel tank filler cap.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Filler Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4090
4. Remove the 3 fuel tank filler pipe-to-body screws. 5. Disconnect the fuel tank filler pipe vent
tube-to-fuel tank pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly quick connect coupling. 6. Disconnect
the fuel tank filler pipe vapor tube from the evaporative emissions (EVAP) canister fresh air tube. 7.
Loosen the hose clamp and disconnect the fuel tank filler pipe hose-to-fuel tank. 8. Remove the 2
fuel tank filler pipe support brackets-to-frame bolts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
9. Remove the fuel tank filler pipe assembly.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 4099
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 >
Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 >
Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 4104
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 >
Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill
Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 >
Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 4110
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 >
Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4
& 7/8 Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 >
Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 4115
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4116
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4117
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4118
C433
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4119
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4120
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE AND RESERVOIR
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the key has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4121
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All fuel tanks
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4122
1. Remove the fuel tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the nuts and the fuel pump module cover.
All fuel tanks
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect coupling, the fuel tank
pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump
module quick connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
4. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
5. CAUTION:
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations
Fuel Tank Unit: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4126
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4127
C433
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4128
Fuel Tank Unit: Description and Operation
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank Unit > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4129
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE AND RESERVOIR
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the key has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Description and Operation
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE
NOTE: The IAC valve assembly is not adjustable and cannot be cleaned, also some IAC valves are
normally open and others are normally closed. Some IAC valves require engine vacuum to
operate.
The IAC valve assembly controls the engine idle speed and provides a dashpot function. The IAC
valve assembly meters intake air around the throttle plate through a bypass within the IAC valve
assembly and throttle body. The PCM determines the desired idle speed or bypass air and signals
the IAC valve assembly through a specified duty cycle. The IAC valve responds by positioning the
IAC valve to control the amount of bypassed air. The PCM monitors engine RPM and increases or
decreases the IAC duty cycle in order to achieve the desired RPM.
The PCM uses the IAC valve assembly to control:
- no touch start
- cold engine fast idle for rapid warm-up
- idle (corrects for engine load)
- stumble or stalling on deceleration (provides a dashpot function)
- over-temperature idle boost
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Locations
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4139
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4140
C4168
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4141
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4142
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the LH rear interior quarter trim panel. 3.
Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the
IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Duct > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Intake Air Duct: Service and Repair
AIR CLEANER OUTLET PIPE
Exploded View
Removal
1. Remove the 2 bolts and the engine appearance cover. 2. Loosen the 2 air cleaner outlet pipe
clamps. 3. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Duct > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4146
1. CAUTION: The air cleaner intake pipe should be securely sealed to prevent unusual engine
noise.
Position the air cleaner outlet pipe with the alignment indicator positioned as shown and tighten the
2 clamps. Tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
2. Position the engine appearance cover and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4150
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel
System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4152
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 4157
Fuel Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 4158
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 4159
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4163
Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System): Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4164
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel Delivery
and Air Induction > Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System) > Component Information > Locations > Page 4165
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4170
C2040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4171
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION (APP) SENSOR
The APP sensor is an input to the powertrain control module (PCM) and is used to determine the
torque demand. There are 3 pedal position signals in the sensor. Signal 1, APPS1, has a negative
slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and signals 2 and 3, APPS2 and APPS3, both have a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation APPS1 is used as
the indication of pedal position by the strategy. The 3 pedal position signals make sure the PCM
receives a correct input even if 1 signal has a concern. There are 2 reference voltage circuits and 2
signal return circuits for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4175
C1454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4176
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Description and Operation
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Diagram Of Air Flow Through Throttle Body Contacting MAF Sensor Hot And Cold Wire (and IAT
Sensor Wire Where Applicable) Terminals
Typical Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4177
Typical Drop-in Mass Air Flow (MAF) Sensor
The MAF sensor uses a hot wire sensing element to measure the amount of air entering the
engine. Air passing over the hot wire causes it to cool. This hot wire is maintained at 200°C (392°F)
above the ambient temperature as measured by a constant cold wire. The current required to
maintain the temperature of the hot wire is proportional to the mass air flow. The MAF sensor then
outputs an analog voltage signal to the PCM proportional to the intake air mass. The PCM
calculates the required fuel injector pulse width in order to provide the desired air/fuel ratio. This
input is also used in determining transmission electronic pressure control (EPC), shift and torque
converter clutch scheduling.
The MAF sensor is located between the air cleaner and the throttle body or inside the air cleaner
assembly. Most MAF sensors have integrated bypass technology with an integrated intake air
temperature (IAT) sensor. The hot wire electronic sensing element must be replaced as an
assembly. Replacing only the element may change the air flow calibration.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Air Flow Meter/Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4178
Air Flow Meter/Sensor: Service and Repair
MASS AIR FLOW (MAF) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and the
MAF sensor.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail
Pressure (FRP) Sensor
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE (FRP) SENSOR
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) Sensor
The FRP sensor is a diaphragm strain gauge device in which resistance changes with pressure.
The electrical resistance of a strain gauge increases as pressure increases, and the resistance
decreases as the pressure decreases. The varying resistance affects the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM corresponding to pressure.
Strain gauge type sensors are considered passive sensors. A passive sensor is connected to a
voltage divider network so that varying the resistance of the passive sensor causes a variation in
total current flow. Voltage that is dropped across a fixed resistor in series with the sensor resistor
determines the voltage signal at the PCM. This voltage signal is equal to the reference voltage
minus the voltage drop across the fixed resistor.
The FRP sensor measures the pressure of the fuel near the fuel injectors. This signal is used by
the PCM to adjust the fuel injector pulse width and meter fuel to each engine combustion cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Fuel Rail
Pressure (FRP) Sensor > Page 4183
Fuel Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT)
Sensor
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
FUEL RAIL PRESSURE TEMPERATURE (FRPT) SENSOR
Typical Fuel Rail Pressure Temperature (FRPT) Sensor
The FRPT sensor measures the pressure and temperature of the fuel in the fuel rail and sends
these signals to the PCM. The sensor uses the intake manifold vacuum as a reference to
determine the pressure difference between the fuel rail and the intake manifold. The relationship
between fuel pressure and fuel temperature is used to determine the possible presence of fuel
vapor in the fuel rail.
The temperature sensing portion of the FRPT sensor is a thermistor device in which resistance
changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of the thermistor decreases as the temperature
increases, and the resistance increases as the temperature decreases. The varying resistance
changes the voltage drop across the sensor terminals and provides electrical signals to the PCM
corresponding to temperature.
Both the pressure and temperature signals are used to control the speed of the fuel pump. The
speed of the fuel pump sustains fuel rail pressure which preserves fuel in its liquid state. The
dynamic range of the fuel injectors increase because of the higher rail pressure, which allows the
injector pulse width to decrease.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Locations
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4190
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4191
C4168
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4192
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Description and Operation
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Typical Inertia Fuel Shutoff (IFS) Switch
The IFS switch is used in conjunction with the electric fuel pump. The purpose of the IFS switch is
to shutoff the fuel pump if a collision occurs. It consists of a steel ball held in place by a magnet.
When a sharp impact occurs, the ball breaks loose from the magnet, rolls up a conical ramp and
strikes a target plate which opens the electrical contacts of the switch and shuts off the electric fuel
pump. Once the switch is open, it must be manually reset before restarting the vehicle. Refer to the
Owner's Literature for the location of the IFS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4193
Inertia Fuel Shutoff Switch: Service and Repair
INERTIA FUEL SHUTOFF (IFS) SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the LH rear interior quarter trim panel. 3.
Disconnect the inertia fuel shutoff (IFS) switch electrical connector. 4. Remove the 2 bolts and the
IFS switch.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4197
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic
Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 4200
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4201
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Remove the throttle body (TB).
2. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Throttle Body: Service and Repair
THROTTLE BODY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4205
Removal
WARNING: Do not smoke or carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related components. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: The throttle body must be removed from the vehicle to be cleaned. Do not hold the
throttle plate open with any object that could scratch the bore or plate while servicing or cleaning
the throttle body.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe. 3. Disconnect the
quick connect couplings and remove the crankcase vent tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 4206
4. Disconnect the generator wiring harness retainer from the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-throttle body
(TB) adapter. 5. Remove the 4 bolts and position aside the air cleaner outlet tube-to-TB adapter. 6.
Disconnect the electronic throttle control electrical connector. 7. Disconnect the throttle position
(TP) sensor electrical connector. 8. Remove the 4 bolts and the vibration damper. 9. Remove the
TB assembly.
- Discard the TB O-ring seal.
Installation
1. Using a new O-ring seal, position the TB and vibration damper and tighten the 4 bolts in 2
stages.
- Stage 1: Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Stage 2: Tighten an additional 90 degrees.
2. Connect the TP sensor electrical connector. 3. Connect the electronic throttle control electrical
connector.
4. Lubricate the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-TB adapter seal with clean engine coolant prior to
installation. 5. Position the air cleaner outlet pipe-to-TB adapter and install the 4 bolts.
- Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. Connect the generator wiring harness retainer to the air cleaner outlet tube-to-TB adapter. 7.
Position the crankcase vent tube and connect the quick connect couplings. 8. Install the air cleaner
outlet pipe. 9. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4210
C189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE BODY (ETB) POSITION SENSOR
The ETB position sensor has 2 signal circuits in the sensor for redundancy. The redundant ETB
position signals are required for increased monitoring. The first ETB position sensor signal (TP1)
has a negative slope (increasing angle, decreasing voltage) and the second signal (TP2) has a
positive slope (increasing angle, increasing voltage). During normal operation the negative slope
ETB position sensor signal (TP1) is used by the control strategy as the indication of throttle
position. The 2 ETB position sensor signals make sure the PCM receives a correct input even if 1
signal has a concern. There is 1 reference voltage circuit and 1 signal return circuit for the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Electronic Throttle Body (ETB) Position Sensor > Page 4213
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation Throttle Position (TP) Sensor
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Typical TP Sensor
The TP sensor is a rotary potentiometer sensor that provides a signal to the PCM that is linearly
proportional to the throttle plate/shaft position. The sensor housing has a 3-blade electrical
connector that may be gold plated. The gold plating increases the corrosion resistance on the
terminals and increases the connector durability. The TP sensor is mounted on the throttle body.
As the TP sensor is rotated by the throttle shaft, 4 operating conditions are determined by the PCM
from the TP. The operating conditions are:
- closed throttle (includes idle or deceleration)
- part throttle (includes cruise or moderate acceleration)
- wide open throttle (includes maximum acceleration or de-choke on crank)
- throttle angle rate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4214
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
THROTTLE POSITION (TP) SENSOR
Removal
1. Remove the throttle body (TB).
2. CAUTION: Failure to remove the TP sensor screws in the following manner will result in damage
to the screws. First loosen the screws
1-2 full turns using a hand tool and then use a suitable high speed driver to complete the removal.
Remove and discard the 2 screws and the TP sensor.
Installation
1. CAUTION:
- Do not reuse the TP sensor and screws. A new TP sensor and screws must be installed.
- Do not use a high speed driver to install the new screws or damage to the TP sensor can occur.
NOTE: When installing the new TP sensor, make sure that the radial locator tab on the TP sensor
is aligned with the radial locator hole on the throttle body.
Position the new TP sensor and install the 2 new screws. Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
2. Install the TB.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams
C1442
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4219
Variable Induction Control Actuator: Description and Operation
INTAKE MANIFOLD TUNING VALVE (IMTV)
WARNING: Substantial opening and closing torque is applied by this system. To prevent injury, be
careful to keep fingers away from lever mechanisms when actuated.
The IMTV is a motorized actuated unit mounted directly to the intake manifold. The IMTV actuator
controls a shutter device attached to the actuator shaft. There is no monitor input to the PCM with
this system to indicate shutter position.
The motorized IMTV unit is not energized below approximately 2,600 RPM. The shutter is in the
closed position not allowing airflow blend to occur in the intake manifold. The motorized unit is
energized above approximately 2,600 RPM. The motorized unit is commanded on by the PCM
initially at a 100 percent duty cycle to move the shutter to the open position, and then falling to
approximately 50 percent to continue to hold the shutter open.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Variable Induction System >
Variable Induction Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4220
Variable Induction Control Actuator: Service and Repair
CHARGE MOTION CONTROL VALVE (CMCV)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the charge motion control valve (CMCV) RH and LH
rods from the intake manifold. 3. Remove the stud bolt, the 2 bolts and the CMCV.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 4225
Firing Order: Locations
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Number One Cylinder >
Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing order...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349 > Page 4238
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page 4244
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill
Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 4250
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 >
Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4
& 7/8 Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 >
Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 4255
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 4261
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 >
Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 4266
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4267
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1 > Page 4270
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4271
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 4272
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
LH camshaft position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the CMP sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4276
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4277
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4278
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the accessory drive belt. 3.
Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C
compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1
C111
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 4284
C112
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 4285
C113
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 4286
C114
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 4287
Ignition Coil: Diagrams
C111
C112
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 4288
C113
C114
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 4289
C115
C116
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 4290
C117
C118
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Coil On Plug (COP) 1 > Page 4291
C174
C194
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 4292
Ignition Coil: Description and Operation
COIL ON PLUG (COP)
Typical Coil On Plug (COP)
The COP ignition operates similar to a standard coil pack ignition except each plug has one coil per
plug. The COP has 3 different modes of operation: engine crank, engine running, and CMP failure
mode effects management (FMEM).
COIL PACK
Typical Four-Tower Coil Pack
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 4293
Typical Six-Tower Coil Pack
The PCM provides a grounding switch for the coil primary circuit. When the switch is closed,
voltage is applied to the coil primary circuit. This creates a magnetic field around the primary coil.
The PCM opens the switch, causing the magnetic field to collapse, inducing the high voltage in the
secondary coil windings and firing the spark plug. The spark plugs are paired so that as one spark
plug fires on the compression stroke, the other spark plug fires on the exhaust stroke. The next
time the coil is fired the order is reversed. The next pair of spark plugs fire according to the engine
firing order.
Coil packs come in 4-tower, 6-tower horizontal and series 5 6-tower models. Two adjacent coil
towers share a common coil and are called a matched pair. For 6-tower coil pack (6 cylinder)
applications, the matched pairs are 1 and 5, 2 and 6, and 3 and 4. For 4-tower coil pack (4 cylinder)
applications, the matched pairs are 1 and 4, and 2 and 3.
When the coil is fired by the PCM, spark is delivered through the matched pair towers to their
respective spark plugs. The spark plugs are fired simultaneously and are paired so that as one fires
on the compression stroke, the other spark plug fires on the exhaust stroke. The next time the coil
is fired, the situation is reversed. The next pair of spark plugs fire according to the engine firing
order.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 4294
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair
IGNITION COIL-ON-PLUG
Engine Ignition - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 4295
Engine Ignition - LH
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect the ignition coil electrical connector. 3.
Remove the bolt and the ignition coil.
- Remove the ignition coil, using a twisting motion while pulling up on the ignition coil.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
4. NOTE: Verify that the ignition coil spring is correctly located inside the ignition coil boot and that
there is no damage to the tip of the boot.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. Apply a light coat of dielectric compound to the inside of the ignition coil boots.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information >
Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4299
Ignition Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4300
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4301
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 4307
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4308
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4309
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 4314
Ignition Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 4315
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System > Ignition
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 4316
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft
Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Camshaft
Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page 4326
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349
Camshaft Position Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P0345/P0349
TSB 08-16-14
08/18/08
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTCS) P0345 AND/OR P0349 - NO DRIVEABILITY
SYMPTOMS, MIL LIGHT ON
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit the malfunction indicator
light (MIL) on with DTC P0345 and/or P0349 without any driveability symptoms.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IT MAY BE NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE BANK 2 CAM POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
CONNECTOR AND RE-ROUTE THE CMP HARNESS AWAY FROM THE POWER STEERING
(PS) HOSE. THE PS HOSE MAY VIBRATE AGAINST THE HARNESS AND CAUSE
INTERFERENCE WITH THE CMP SIGNAL.
1. Visually inspect the Bank 2 cam sensor wiring for evidence of interference with the PS hose.
a. If interference, proceed to Step 2.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to Powertrain Controls/Emissions
Diagnosis (PC/ED) pinpoint test DR.
2. With vehicle in park, start the engine and turn the steering wheel to the full lock position.
Observe the PS pressure hose movement at full lock position. Repeat the full lock position several
times to determine if hose movement under pressure is touching the CMP harness.
a. If yes, turn off the engine and proceed to Step 3.
b. If no interference, this procedure does not apply. Refer to PC/ED pinpoint test DR.
3. Remove air cleaner housing cover.
NOTE
DO NOT TRANSFER THE RIGHT ANGLE ELBOW (ON THE EXISTING CONNECTOR) TO THE
NEW CONNECTOR.
4. Replace the CMP sensor connector C1367 with Pigtail Kit. Refer to included instruction sheet.
5. Using a tie strap, route the harness away from the PS hose by attaching it to the hole in the
valve cover, located on the front left corner.
6. Install air cleaner housing cover.
7. Start engine and place in park. Check PS hose to CMP wire harness inter[ace.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081614A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The CMP Sensor Connector, Includes Time To Remove
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Camshaft Position Sensor: > 08-16-14 > Aug > 08 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P0345/P0349 > Page 4332
And Install Air Cleaner Housing Cover. (Do Not Use With 12650D, 9601A, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14474 X2
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4333
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1
C1366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Camshaft Position Sensor 1 > Page 4336
C1367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4337
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Typical Synchronizer Hall-Effect CMP Sensor
Typical Variable Reluctance CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor detects the position of the camshaft. The CMP sensor identifies when piston
number 1 is on its compression stroke. A signal is then sent to the PCM and used for synchronizing
the sequential firing of the fuel injectors. Coil-on-plug (COP) ignition applications use the CMP
signal to select the correct ignition coil to fire.
Vehicles with 2 CMP sensors are equipped with variable camshaft timing (VCT). They use the
second sensor to identify the position of the camshaft on bank 2 as an input to the PCM.
There are 2 types of CMP sensors: the 3-pin connector Hall-effect type sensor and the 2-pin
connector variable reluctance type sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4338
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CAMSHAFT POSITION (CMP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
LH camshaft position (CMP) sensor
1. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe.
All CMP sensors
2. Disconnect the CMP sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the bolt and the CMP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4342
C101
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4343
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Typical Crankshaft Position (CKP) Sensor
The CKP sensor is a magnetic transducer mounted on the engine block adjacent to a pulse wheel
located on the crankshaft. By monitoring the crankshaft mounted pulse wheel, the CKP is the
primary sensor for ignition information to the PCM. The pulse wheel has a total of 35 teeth spaced
10 degrees apart with one empty space for a missing tooth. The 6.8L 10-cylinder pulse wheel has
39 teeth spaced 9 degrees apart and one 9 degree empty space for a missing tooth. By monitoring
the pulse wheel, the CKP sensor signal indicates crankshaft position and speed information to the
PCM. By monitoring the missing tooth, the CKP sensor is also able to identify piston travel in order
to synchronize the ignition system and provide a way of tracking the angular position of the
crankshaft relative to a fixed reference for the CKP sensor configuration. The PCM also uses the
CKP signal to determine if a misfire has occurred by measuring rapid deceleration between teeth.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4344
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
CRANKSHAFT POSITION (CKP) SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the accessory drive belt. 3.
Disconnect the A/C compressor electrical connector. 4. Remove the 3 bolts and position the A/C
compressor aside.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
5. Disconnect the crankshaft position (CKP) sensor electrical connector. 6. Remove the bolt and
the CKP sensor.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
- Lubricate the O-ring seal with clean engine oil prior to installation.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - FUNCTIONAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Ignition
Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
> Page 4350
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - NON FUNCTIONAL
Removal
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the ignition
lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer. 4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering
column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage. 2. Install
a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-6 (Engine, Rear)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1
C109
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Knock Sensor 1 > Page 4356
C108
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4357
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Two Types Of Knock Sensor (KS)
The KS is a tuned accelerometer on the engine which converts engine vibration to an electrical
signal. The PCM uses this signal to determine the presence of engine knock and to retard spark
timing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System > Knock
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4358
Knock Sensor: Service and Repair
KNOCK SENSOR (KS)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the intake manifold. 2. Disconnect the knock sensor (KS) electrical connectors. 3.
Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 knock sensors.
- To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
Spark Plug: Customer Interest Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
TSB 07-24-8
12/10/07
ENGINE MISFIRE DURING CRUISE WITH OR WITHOUT DTCS (MEXICO ONLY)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition, F-150, F-250
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LI, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Mark LT, F-150 and F-250 vehicles equipped with
a 5.4 3V engines may exhibit engine misfire during cruise, rough run, hesitation, buck jerk, with or
without diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner to clean engine combustion system.
a. Disconnect canister purge line from the intake manifold.
b. Attach a vacuum line to the purge port.
c. At hot engine idle, allow the engine to ingest about a 1/2 to 2/3 of a can of Motorcraft(R)
Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Use caution not to ingest too quickly due to potential hydro-lock
issues. Read the entire label on the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Shake the can well
before using and make sure to use at room temperature.
d. Shut the engine off and allow it to soak for one hour.
e. Start engine, allow the engine to ingest the remainder of the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up
Cleaner.
f. Reconnect canister purge vacuum line.
g. Cycle engine between idle and 2500 RPM for about 5 minutes.
2. Inspect the spark plugs for abnormal fouling.
3. Replace fouled spark plugs.
4. Re-gap the spark plug to .035" (0.9 mm).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072408A 2007-2008 1.9 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator/F-150/F-250/Mark LT 5.4L 3V: Check DTCs,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise > Page
4367
Clean Combustion System, Remove Spark Plugs Inspect And, Replace As Necessary (Do Not Use
With 12650D, 12405A, 1 2650D64)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4373
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4374
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4375
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4376
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4377
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4378
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4379
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4380
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4381
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4382
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug
Removal Instructions > Page 4383
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on
Steady Cruise
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on Steady Cruise
TSB 07-24-8
12/10/07
ENGINE MISFIRE DURING CRUISE WITH OR WITHOUT DTCS (MEXICO ONLY)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition, F-150, F-250
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Mark LI, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Mark LT, F-150 and F-250 vehicles equipped with
a 5.4 3V engines may exhibit engine misfire during cruise, rough run, hesitation, buck jerk, with or
without diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner to clean engine combustion system.
a. Disconnect canister purge line from the intake manifold.
b. Attach a vacuum line to the purge port.
c. At hot engine idle, allow the engine to ingest about a 1/2 to 2/3 of a can of Motorcraft(R)
Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Use caution not to ingest too quickly due to potential hydro-lock
issues. Read the entire label on the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner. Shake the can well
before using and make sure to use at room temperature.
d. Shut the engine off and allow it to soak for one hour.
e. Start engine, allow the engine to ingest the remainder of the Motorcraft(R) Carburetor Tune-Up
Cleaner.
f. Reconnect canister purge vacuum line.
g. Cycle engine between idle and 2500 RPM for about 5 minutes.
2. Inspect the spark plugs for abnormal fouling.
3. Replace fouled spark plugs.
4. Re-gap the spark plug to .035" (0.9 mm).
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072408A 2007-2008 1.9 Hrs.
Expedition/Navigator/F-150/F-250/Mark LT 5.4L 3V: Check DTCs,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 07-24-8 > Dec > 07 > Ignition/Fuel Systems - Misfire on
Steady Cruise > Page 4388
Clean Combustion System, Remove Spark Plugs Inspect And, Replace As Necessary (Do Not Use
With 12650D, 12405A, 1 2650D64)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions
Spark Plug: All Technical Service Bulletins Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal Instructions
TSB 08-7-6
04/14/08
SPARK PLUG REMOVAL INSTRUCTIONS - 4.6L 3V/5.4L 3V16.8L 3V
FORD: 2005-2008 Mustang 2004-2008 F-150 2005-2008 Expedition, F-Super Duty 2006-2008
Explorer, F-53 Motorhome Chassis 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2005-2008 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
MERCURY: 2006-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-9 to update Vehicle Applications, Service Procedure and Part
List.
ISSUE Some 2004-2008 F-150, 2006-2008 Mark LT, 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, Expedition, and
Navigator, with 5.4L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 Mustang, 2006-2008 Explorer, Mountaineer, and
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac with 4.6L 3-V engine; 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2006-2008 and
F-Stripped Chassis, with 6.8L 3-V engine may experience difficulty with spark plug removal. This
may cause damage to the spark plug and leave part of the spark plug in the cylinder head. Affected
engine build dates are as follows: 5.4L 3-V and 6.8L 3-V before 10/9/07, 4.6L 3-V before 11/30/07.
ACTION Refer to the following Service Procedure for techniques to remove the spark plugs and
extract broken spark plugs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
The engine build date can be read on the left hand cam cover information sticker.
To remove spark plugs without damage, it is necessary to adhere exactly to this procedure before
removal is attempted.
CAUTION
DO NOT REMOVE PLUGS WHEN THE ENGINE IS WARM OR HOT. THE ENGINE MUST BE AT
ROOM TEMPERATURE WHEN PERFORMING SPARK PLUG SERVICE. REMOVING THE
SPARK PLUGS FROM A WARM/HOT ENGINE INCREASES THE CHANCE THE THREADS
COULD BE DAMAGED.
Spark Plug Removal Procedure
1. Remove the coil-on-plug assemblies and thoroughly blow out the spark plug wells and
surrounding valve cover area with compressed air.
2. Back out the spark plugs no more than 1/8 to 1/4 of a turn. Using Motorcraft(R) Carburetor
Tune-Up Cleaner, fill the spark plug well just above where the jamb nut hex sits (1/2 - 3/4
teaspoon). A minimum period of 15 minutes of soak time is required. The cleaner will wick down to
the ground electrode shield and soften the carbon deposits in this time. DO NOT WORK the spark
plug back and forth at this point.
NOTE
COMPLETELY REVIEW THE PRODUCT LABEL FOR THE MOTORCRAFT CARBURETOR
TUNE-UP CLEANER PRODUCT - USE AT ROOM TEMPERATURE AND SHAKE WELL.
CAUTION
EXCESSIVE MOTORCRAFT(R) CARBURETOR TUNE-UP CLEANER, OR REPEATING THE
PROCESS SEVERAL TIMES WITH TOO MUCH CLEANER FLUID, COULD INTRODUCE
ENOUGH LIQUID VOLUME TO HYDRO-LOCK THE ENGINE.
CAUTION
DO NOT USE AIR OR POWER TOOLS FOR SPARK PLUG REMOVAL. SPARK PLUGS MUST
ONLY BE REMOVED WITH HAND TOOLS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4394
3. Tighten, and then loosen the spark plug, working the plug back and forth. Some screeching and
high effort may be noticed. The expected removal torque is about 33 lb-ft (45 N.m). Repeat the
back and forth turning as needed until turning effort is reduced, and remove the spark plugs.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (Figure 1)
Separated/Broken Spark Plug Removal
If the spark plug separates after following the Spark Plug Removal Procedure, it will fail in one of
three modes. Refer to the appropriate removal procedure as required.
a. Mode 1: The ground electrode shield is left behind as an empty shell. (Figure 2)
b. Mode 2: The entire porcelain insulator and ground electrode shield remains in the cylinder head.
(Figure 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4395
c. Mode 3: The upper section of porcelain broke off with remaining porcelain left inside the ground
shield. (Figure 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4396
Flowchart of procedure. (Figure 5)
Mode 1 Procedure:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4397
Use Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 to remove an empty ground electrode shield from the
cylinder head. (Figure 6)
NOTE
THIS TOOL IS ONLY DESIGNED TO WORK WITH AN EMPTY GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
IF PORCELAIN REMAINS, PROCEED TO MODE 2 OR 3 REMOVAL.
1. Modify vacuum cap to a 3/8" (10 mm) length for each ground electrode shield that needs to be
removed. (Figure 7)
2. Use the installation rod (J) provided with service tool 303-1203 update to install the modified
vacuum cap. Push the cap into the ground shield down to the electrode strap. This will plug and
protect the combustion chamber from contamination. (Figure 7)
3. Thread-tap the ground electrode shield using a 9.0 x 1.0 mm plug tap (tap profile is about 3-4
reduced diameter threads on the tip end).
a. Coat the end of the tap with general purpose grease. (Figure 8)
b. Turn the tap about 3 to 4 turns into the ground electrode shield. Back the tap up frequently to
break chips and avoid cut material from coiling-up in the spark plug well. A tap socket adaptor (K)
is provided with service tool 303-1203 update to connect the tap to a 3/8" socket
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4398
drive.
CAUTION
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD WITH THE TAP AND
WRENCH. THE TAP MAY BREAK IF THIS IS ATTEMPTED.
4. Thread Rotunda special service tool 303-1203 into the ground electrode shield. (Figure 9)
a. Install the stepped end of the tool pilot bushing into the spark plug well ensuring it bottoms out.
b. Screw the center shank into the ground electrode shield. Do not over tighten the shank, to
prevent thread stripping.
c. Install the nylon washer and jack nut until finger tight.
d. Turn the jack nut until the ground electrode is freed from the cavity and withdraw the tool
assembly.
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP.
Mode 2 Procedure:
1. Add an additional 1/2 teaspoon Motorcraft® Carburetor Tune-Up Cleaner fluid into spark plug
well and allow 15 minutes of soak time.
2. Using long-reach nose pliers grasp and remove the porcelain with an up and down motion taking
care not to fracture the porcelain.
3. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Mode 3 Procedure:
CAUTION
DO NOT DRIVE PORCELAIN DOWN INTO THE GROUND SHIELD WITH A PUNCH AS
FRAGMENTS MAY ENTER THE COMBUSTION CHAMBER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4399
Use Rotunda special service tool kit 303-1398 to remove porcelain broken inside the ground
electrode shield. (FIGURE 10)
Porcelain Removal - Preparation
CAUTION
THE ENGINE AND THE BONDING ADHESIVE MUST BE ROOM TEMPERATURE OF 70 °F (21
°C) OR HIGHER FOR PROPER CURE AND BOND STRENGTH. VERIFY EXPIRATION DATE OF
ADHESIVE.
CAUTION
DO NOT REUSE PINS. THIS ENSURES THE CORRECT SURFACE CHARACTERISTICS FOR
BONDING.
1. Remove any remaining electrode material from broken porcelain with long nose reach pliers.
2. Spray Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner into the porcelain hole for 2-4 seconds using the
straw nozzle supplied with the brake cleaner can.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4400
3. Insert a pin (A) into the collet (B). Screw the collet onto the threaded rod (C). Install the
assembled collet, pin, and threaded rod into the steel tool pilot (F). (Figures 11 and 12)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4401
4. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot, protecting the pin. (Figures 13 and 14)
NOTE
PIN TIP DAMAGE OR BENT PINS WILL PREVENT INSERTION INTO THE PORCELAIN.
5. Insert the completed assembly into the spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the
porcelain. (Figure 15)
6. Spray Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner 2-4 seconds between the spark plug well and
steel tool pilot. The steel tool pilot must be lifted up approximately 1/2" to allow brake cleaner to
flood the porcelain and pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4402
7. Scrub the porcelain inside diameter by moving the threaded rod up and down vigorously. Take
care making sure the pin does not disengage the porcelain. (Figure 16).
8. Repeat Steps 6 and 7.
9. Remove the tool assembly. Again flood the porcelain with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts
Cleaner for 2-4 seconds, then blow out the entire spark plug well and porcelain with dry
compressed air.
NOTE
CLEAN AND DRY COMPONENTS ARE KEY TO BONDING THE PIN TO THE PORCELAIN.
10. Repeat Steps 1-9 to prepare remaining porcelain fragments as needed.
11. Disassemble the collet and pin from the threaded rod. Dry the tools thoroughly with dry
compressed air.
Porcelain Removal - Bonding Process
CAUTION
USE CARE TO PREVENT BONDING AGENT FROM CONTACTING THREADS IN CYLINDER
HEAD.
NOTE
WORKING TIME LIMIT OF LOCTITE(R) 638(TM) RETAINING COMPOUND IS 5 MINUTES.
1. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to opposite sides of a clean and dry
applicator (H). Excessive amounts of Loctite(R) 638(TM) are being used if it drips off the applicator.
(Figure 17)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4403
2. Insert applicator into the porcelain and move applicator up and down 1/2" (13 mm) while turning
to spread the Loctite® 638TM on the inside of the porcelain. (Figure 18).
3. Add additional Loctite(R) 638(TM), repeating Steps 1 and 2.
4. Clean the applicator with Motorcraft(R) Metal Brake Parts Cleaner before the bonding agent
starts to cure.
5. Reassemble a dry and clean collet and pin assembly.
6. Apply two 3/4" (19 mm) long stripes of Loctite(R) 638(TM) to the pin. Excessive amounts of
Loctite® 638TMare being used if it drips off the pin.
7. Retract the collet and pin into the steel tool pilot to protect the Loctite(R) 638(TM) coated pin.
8. Insert the completed assembly into spark plug well and fully engage the pin into the porcelain
with a twisting motion to spread the bonding agent.
9. Add additional Loctite® 638TM, repeating Steps 6-8.
10. Leave the pin fully inserted in the porcelain while the adhesive cures. Replace the steel tool
pilot with the aluminum alignment sleeve (G), Figure 9, to support the threaded rod while the
adhesive cures if additional porcelain fragments are present in other cylinders. (Figure 19).
CAUTION
A MINIMUM 1 HOUR CURING TIME AT 70 °F (21 °C) DEGREES IS REQUIRED BEFORE
EXTRACTION IS ATTEMPTED.
11. Allow the Loctite(R) 638(TM) to cure for a minimum of one hour at 70 °F (21 °C).
12. Repeat the bonding process for remaining cylinders as needed.
Porcelain Removal - Extraction
1. After a minimum of one hour curing at 70 °F (21 °C), install the steel pilot tool over the threaded
rod.
2. Install the washer and jack nut until finger tight against the tool pilot bushing.
CAUTION
ONLY THE STEEL PILOT TOOL IS ACCEPTABLE FOR USE IN PORCELAIN REMOVAL.
3. While holding the end of the threaded rod with a wrench, tighten the jack nut until the porcelain is
free of the ground electrode.
4. Refer to Mode 1 Procedure to remove the remaining ground electrode shield from the cylinder
head.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spark Plug: > 08-7-6 > Apr > 08 > Ignition System - Spark Plug Removal
Instructions > Page 4404
NOTE
NEW PLUGS SHOULD BE INSTALLED USING A FILM COATING OF MOTORCRAFT® HIGH
TEMPERATURE NICKEL ANTI-SEIZE LUBRICANT ON THE GROUND ELECTRODE SHIELD.
DO NOT COAT THE ELECTRODE STRAP. (FIGURE 7)
Porcelain Removal - Pin Slipped Out
In the unlikely event that the pin does not remove the broken porcelain, this process can be
repeated.
Key elements to success are:
^ Clean and dry porcelain
^ Sufficient Loctite® 638TM Retaining Compound spread uniformly
^ Loctite(R) 638(TM) cure time and temperature
^ Preventing the threaded rod from rotating while removing the porcelain
Replacement Supplies
Replacement kit components and additional kit consumables (Loctite(R) 638TM Retaining
Compound and pins) can be obtained by calling 1-800-ROTUNDA, Option 5.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT080706 Claim Labor As Actual Actual
Time Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
12405 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4405
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4406
Spark Plug: Application and ID
Spark plug ...........................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... PZT-2F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4407
Spark Plug: Testing and Inspection
Spark Plug Inspection
1. Inspect the spark plug for a bridged gap.
^ Check for deposit build-up closing the gap between the electrodes. Deposits are caused by oil or
carbon fouling.
^ Clean the spark plug.
2. Check for oil fouling.
^ Check for wet, black deposits on the insulator shell bore electrodes, caused by excessive oil
entering the combustion chamber through worn rings and pistons, excessive valve-to-guide
clearance or worn or loose bearings.
^ Correct the oil leak concern.
^ Install a new spark plug.
3. Inspect for carbon fouling. Look for black, dry, fluffy carbon deposits on the insulator tips,
exposed shell surfaces and electrodes, caused by a
spark plug with an incorrect heat range, dirty air cleaner, too rich a fuel mixture or excessive idling.
^
Clean the spark plug.
4. Inspect for normal burning.
^ Check for light tan or gray deposits on the firing tip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4408
5. Inspect for pre-ignition, identified by melted electrodes and a possibly damaged insulator.
Metallic deposits on the insulator indicate engine
damage. This may be caused by incorrect ignition timing, wrong type of fuel or the unauthorized
installation of a Heli-coil insert in place of the spark plug threads. ^
Install a new spark plug.
6. Inspect for overheating, identified by a white or light gray spots and with bluish-burnt appearance
of electrodes. This is caused by engine
overheating, wrong type of fuel, loose spark plugs, spark plugs with an incorrect heat range, low
fuel pump pressure or incorrect ignition timing. ^
Install a new spark plug.
7. Inspect for fused deposits, identified by melted or spotty deposits resembling bubbles or blisters.
These are caused by sudden acceleration.
^ Clean the spark plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4409
Spark Plug: Service and Repair
SPARK PLUGS
Engine Ignition - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 4410
Engine Ignition - LH
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the ignition coil-on-plug.
2. CAUTION:
- Do not remove the spark plugs when the engine is hot or cold soaked. Spark plug thread or
cylinder head damage can occur. Make sure the engine is warm (hand touch after cooling down)
prior to spark plug removal.
- Only use hand tools when removing or installing the spark plugs or damage can occur to the
cylinder head or spark plug.
NOTE: Use compressed air to remove any foreign material from the spark plug well before removing the
spark plugs.
- If an original spark plug is used, make sure it is installed in the same cylinder from which it was
taken. New spark plugs can be used in any cylinder.
Remove the spark plugs. To install, tighten to 34 Nm (25 lb-ft).
3. Inspect the spark plugs. Install new spark plugs as necessary. 4. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4418
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4419
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4420
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4421
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4422
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4423
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4424
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4425
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4426
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4427
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4428
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4429
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4430
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4431
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4432
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4433
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4434
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4438
C2139
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake shift interlock actuator is not serviced individually. If replacement is required,
install a new floor shift selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift > Page 4441
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Set the parking brake. 2. Remove the steering column shrouds. 3. Turn the ignition to the
accessory position and apply the brake or actuate the brake shift interlock actuator (BSIA) override.
4. Put the selector lever into the NEUTRAL position. 5. Disconnect the BSIA electrical connector. 6.
Remove the BSIA screw. 7. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift > Page 4442
8. NOTE: During installation, verify that the BSIA override has been activated and the slider is fully
rearward. Before rotating the selector lever
from NEUTRAL into PARK, align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4447
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4448
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4449
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4450
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4451
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4452
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4453
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4454
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4455
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4456
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4457
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4458
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4459
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4460
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4461
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4462
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4463
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4468
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4469
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4470
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4471
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4472
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4473
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4474
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4475
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4476
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4477
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4478
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4479
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4480
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4481
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4482
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4483
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4484
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Control Module: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop >
Page 4500
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page
4505
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page
4510
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page
4511
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page
4512
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At
A Stop
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At
A Stop > Page 4518
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift
Flare
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift
Flare > Page 4523
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In
TCM
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In
TCM > Page 4528
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In
TCM > Page 4529
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In
TCM > Page 4530
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4535
Control Module: Diagrams
C281A
C281B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules - Transmission
and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4536
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH-side cowl side panel cover to gain access. 2. Remove the 2 screws. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 4WD control module. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4543
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4544
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4545
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4546
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4547
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4548
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4549
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4550
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4551
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4552
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4553
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4554
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4555
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4556
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4557
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4558
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4559
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 4560
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4565
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4566
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4567
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4568
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4569
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4570
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4571
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4572
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4573
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4574
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4575
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4576
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4577
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4578
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4579
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4580
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4581
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4586
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4587
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4588
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4589
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4590
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4591
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4592
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4593
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4594
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4595
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4596
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4597
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4598
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4599
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4600
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4601
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4602
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4608
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4609
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4610
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4611
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4612
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4613
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4614
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4615
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4616
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4617
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4618
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4619
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4620
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4621
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4622
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4623
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4624
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4625
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 4626
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (TC) switch is not replaceable. If a new TC switch is required,
install a new transmission selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift > Page 4629
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (+/-) switch is not serviced. If a new switch is required, install a
new selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4634
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4635
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4636
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4637
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4638
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4639
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4640
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4641
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4642
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4643
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4644
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4645
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4646
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4647
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4648
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4649
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4650
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4655
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4656
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4657
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4658
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4659
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4660
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4661
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4662
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4663
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4664
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4665
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4666
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4667
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4668
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4669
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4670
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4671
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4676
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4677
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4678
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4679
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4680
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4681
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4682
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4683
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4684
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4685
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4686
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4687
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4688
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4689
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4690
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4691
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4692
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4697
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Diagrams
C284
C2071
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 08-22-7 >
Nov > 08 > Engine, A/T Controls - Driveline Bump When Braking
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine, A/T Controls - Driveline
Bump When Braking
TSB 08-22-7
11/10/08
DRIVELINE BUMP WHILE BRAKING - BELOW 10 MPH (16 KM/H)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 08-4-13 to update the Issue, Service Procedure and remove the
production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a bump feeling while braking to a stop
below 10 MPH (16 Km/h). This procedure will improve the bump felt while braking to a stop.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION
APPLYING THIS PROCEDURE TO UNITS THAT DO NOT EXHIBIT THE COASTDOWN BUMP
MAY RESULT IN WORSE SHIFT QUALITY.
NOTE
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REPLACE THE MECHATRONIC UNIT. MECHATRONIC
REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System/Portable Diagnostic Software (IDS/PDS) or equivalent and
ID the vehicle.
2. Update the Power Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration using
IDS release 57.8 and higher or 58.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM
2008.9 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website. Since the TCM cannot be
independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine and transmission
calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
a. Verify that the TCM shows 8L1P-7J104-AC (8L1P-7J104-BC for 2008 vehicles built after
12/3/2007) part number after reprogramming is complete.
b. Select the following from IDS, Tool Box, Powertrain, OBD Test Modes, Mode Level 9 Vehicle
info, TCM Cal Part Number.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Then Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 08-22-7 >
Nov > 08 > Engine, A/T Controls - Driveline Bump When Braking > Page 4706
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn:
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h), remove foot from accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat Steps (a-b) a total of five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1300-1800 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for at least 10 seconds.
g. Repeat steps (e-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
THE HARSH BUMP FELT WHILE BRAKING TO A STOP WILL BE IMPROVED. HOWEVER,
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082207A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Test. Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 07-10-6 >
May > 07 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2107/P2110 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's
P2107/P2110 Set
TSB 07-10-6
05/28/07
MIL ON - DTCS P2107/P2110 - NO DRIVEABILITY CONCERN
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator light
(MIL) on with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P2107 and P2110 with no driveability concerns.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 48.13 and higher or 49.2 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM
2007.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071006A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Check DTCs And Reprogram The PCM (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 07-8-11 >
Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1
Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: > 07-8-11 >
Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 4715
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-22-7 > Nov > 08 > Engine, A/T Controls - Driveline Bump When Braking
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Controls Driveline Bump When Braking
TSB 08-22-7
11/10/08
DRIVELINE BUMP WHILE BRAKING - BELOW 10 MPH (16 KM/H)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 08-4-13 to update the Issue, Service Procedure and remove the
production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a bump feeling while braking to a stop
below 10 MPH (16 Km/h). This procedure will improve the bump felt while braking to a stop.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
CAUTION
APPLYING THIS PROCEDURE TO UNITS THAT DO NOT EXHIBIT THE COASTDOWN BUMP
MAY RESULT IN WORSE SHIFT QUALITY.
NOTE
DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REPLACE THE MECHATRONIC UNIT. MECHATRONIC
REPAIR/REPLACEMENT IS NOT AUTHORIZED FOR THIS ISSUE.
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System/Portable Diagnostic Software (IDS/PDS) or equivalent and
ID the vehicle.
2. Update the Power Control Module/Transmission Control Module (PCM/TCM) calibration using
IDS release 57.8 and higher or 58.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM
2008.9 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website. Since the TCM cannot be
independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine and transmission
calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
a. Verify that the TCM shows 8L1P-7J104-AC (8L1P-7J104-BC for 2008 vehicles built after
12/3/2007) part number after reprogramming is complete.
b. Select the following from IDS, Tool Box, Powertrain, OBD Test Modes, Mode Level 9 Vehicle
info, TCM Cal Part Number.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Then Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM.
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
08-22-7 > Nov > 08 > Engine, A/T Controls - Driveline Bump When Braking > Page 4721
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn:
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h), remove foot from accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat Steps (a-b) a total of five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1300-1800 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for at least 10 seconds.
g. Repeat steps (e-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
THE HARSH BUMP FELT WHILE BRAKING TO A STOP WILL BE IMPROVED. HOWEVER,
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082207A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Check DTCs, Reprogram The PCM And TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM And Perform Road
Test. Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
07-10-6 > May > 07 > Engine Controls - MIL ON/DTC's P2107/P2110 Set
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - MIL
ON/DTC's P2107/P2110 Set
TSB 07-10-6
05/28/07
MIL ON - DTCS P2107/P2110 - NO DRIVEABILITY CONCERN
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a malfunction indicator light
(MIL) on with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P2107 and P2110 with no driveability concerns.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) to the latest calibration using IDS
release 48.13 and higher or 49.2 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM
2007.5 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071006A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Check DTCs And Reprogram The PCM (Do Not Use With 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECALEM 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh
1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: >
07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 4730
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4738
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4739
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4740
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4741
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4742
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4743
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4744
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4745
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4746
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4747
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4748
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4749
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4750
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4751
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4752
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4753
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4754
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4758
C2139
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake shift interlock actuator is not serviced individually. If replacement is required,
install a new floor shift selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift > Page 4761
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Set the parking brake. 2. Remove the steering column shrouds. 3. Turn the ignition to the
accessory position and apply the brake or actuate the brake shift interlock actuator (BSIA) override.
4. Put the selector lever into the NEUTRAL position. 5. Disconnect the BSIA electrical connector. 6.
Remove the BSIA screw. 7. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift
Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift > Page 4762
8. NOTE: During installation, verify that the BSIA override has been activated and the slider is fully
rearward. Before rotating the selector lever
from NEUTRAL into PARK, align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4767
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4768
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4769
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4770
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4771
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4772
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4773
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4774
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4775
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4776
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4777
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4778
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4779
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4780
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4781
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4782
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 4783
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4788
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4789
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4790
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4791
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4792
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4793
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4794
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4795
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4796
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4797
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4798
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4799
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4800
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4801
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4802
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4803
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 4804
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4811
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4812
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4813
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4814
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4815
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4816
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4817
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4818
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4819
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4820
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4821
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4822
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4823
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4824
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4825
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4826
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 4827
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 4831
C2139
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake shift interlock actuator is not serviced individually. If replacement is required,
install a new floor shift selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift >
Page 4834
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Set the parking brake. 2. Remove the steering column shrouds. 3. Turn the ignition to the
accessory position and apply the brake or actuate the brake shift interlock actuator (BSIA) override.
4. Put the selector lever into the NEUTRAL position. 5. Disconnect the BSIA electrical connector. 6.
Remove the BSIA screw. 7. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift >
Page 4835
8. NOTE: During installation, verify that the BSIA override has been activated and the slider is fully
rearward. Before rotating the selector lever
from NEUTRAL into PARK, align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4840
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4841
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4842
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4843
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4844
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4845
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4846
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4847
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4848
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4849
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4850
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4851
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4852
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4853
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4854
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4855
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4856
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4861
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4862
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4863
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4864
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4865
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4866
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4867
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4868
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4869
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4870
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4871
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4872
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4873
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4874
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4875
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4876
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and Solenoids A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
> Page 4877
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4882
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4883
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4884
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4885
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4886
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4887
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4888
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4889
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4890
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4891
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4892
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4893
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4894
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4895
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4896
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4897
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4898
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4899
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 09-6-1 > Apr > 09 > A/T - 6R75 Squawk Noise
On Hard Downshifts
Clutch: Customer Interest A/T - 6R75 Squawk Noise On Hard Downshifts
TSB 09-6-1
04/06/09
6R75 TRANSMISSION - SQUAWK NOISE DURING POWER/FORCED DOWNSHIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 08-19-8 to update the vehicle model years and remove the production
fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles equipped with a 6R75 transmission may exhibit a
squawk type noise during hard acceleration down shifts (4-3), (5-3) and (6-3) downshifts. The noise
is produced during the release of the overdrive clutch.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01B to replace the overdrive friction plates.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
090601A 2007-2008 Expedition 10.9
6R75 Transmission 4X2: Hrs.
Replace The Overdrive Friction Plates, Includes Time To Remove And Install Transmission. (Do
Not Use With 7000A, 7000A2, 7000AXQ, 7000AZT)
090601A 2007-2008 Expedition 11.6
6R75 Transmission 4X4: Hrs.
Replace The Overdrive Friction Plates, Includes Time To Remove And Install Transmission And,
Transfer Case. (Do Not Use With 7000A, 7000A2, 7OOOAXQ, 7000AZT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7B164 D4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 09-6-1 > Apr > 09 > A/T - 6R75 Squawk Noise
On Hard Downshifts > Page 4908
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 07-5-5 > Mar > 07 > A/T - 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL
ON/DTC's P07782/P0784
Clutch: Customer Interest A/T - 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784
TSB 07-5-5
03/19/07
6R75 TRANSMISSION 2-3 AND/OR 4-5 SHIFT FLARE, POSSIBLE WRENCH LAMP
ILLUMINATED WITH DTC P0782 AND/OR P0784
FORD: 2007 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-7 to remove the production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition vehicles exhibit a 2-3 shift flare and/or a 4-5 shift flare. The wrench
light may be illuminated and diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0782 and/or P0784 may be
present in the transmission control module (TCM) memory. This condition may be caused by
damaged direct clutch (B Clutch) seals.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
THIS CONCERN IS FOR VEHICLES WITH LESS THAN 1000 MILES ONLY.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the two (2) direct clutch seals on the direct clutch cylinder and shaft assembly only. It is
NOT necessary to completely overhaul the transmission.
Follow the disassembly procedures as shown in the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01 B
through the removal of the Forward Clutch (A Clutch), the front planetary gear set, the Overdrive
Clutch (E Clutch) and the Direct Clutch (B Clutch).
NOTE
DISASSEMBLY OF THE CLUTCH PACKS AND THE SEPARATION OF THE FRICTION AND
STEELS IS NOT REQUIRED FOR THIS REPAIR. THERE IS NO NEED TO PERFORM CLUTCH
PACK END CLEARANCE CHECKS. IT IS ONLY NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE DIRECT
CLUTCH SEALING RINGS. IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO DISASSEMBLE THE ENTIRE
TRANSMISSION TO REPLACE THESE SEALS.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCARD CENTER SUPPORT RUBBER FEED TUBES.
NOTE
DO NOT REMOVE FRONT PUMP SEAL.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE FLUID FILTER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 07-5-5 > Mar > 07 > A/T - 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL
ON/DTC's P07782/P0784 > Page 4913
1. Remove the two (2) seal rings from the direct (B Clutch) cylinder. Discard the seal rings and
replace with new ones. See Figure 1 for proper direct (B Clutch) seal locations and alignment of the
scarf cut seals.
2. Reassemble in reverse order following the WSM, Section 307-01B.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X4: 8.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
Time To Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F,
4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X2: 7.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
time to Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F,
4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A098 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 09-6-1 > Apr > 09 > A/T - 6R75
Squawk Noise On Hard Downshifts
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 6R75 Squawk Noise On Hard Downshifts
TSB 09-6-1
04/06/09
6R75 TRANSMISSION - SQUAWK NOISE DURING POWER/FORCED DOWNSHIFT
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 08-19-8 to update the vehicle model years and remove the production
fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles equipped with a 6R75 transmission may exhibit a
squawk type noise during hard acceleration down shifts (4-3), (5-3) and (6-3) downshifts. The noise
is produced during the release of the overdrive clutch.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01B to replace the overdrive friction plates.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
090601A 2007-2008 Expedition 10.9
6R75 Transmission 4X2: Hrs.
Replace The Overdrive Friction Plates, Includes Time To Remove And Install Transmission. (Do
Not Use With 7000A, 7000A2, 7000AXQ, 7000AZT)
090601A 2007-2008 Expedition 11.6
6R75 Transmission 4X4: Hrs.
Replace The Overdrive Friction Plates, Includes Time To Remove And Install Transmission And,
Transfer Case. (Do Not Use With 7000A, 7000A2, 7OOOAXQ, 7000AZT)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7B164 D4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 09-6-1 > Apr > 09 > A/T - 6R75
Squawk Noise On Hard Downshifts > Page 4919
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 07-5-5 > Mar > 07 > A/T - 2-3/4-5
Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784
TSB 07-5-5
03/19/07
6R75 TRANSMISSION 2-3 AND/OR 4-5 SHIFT FLARE, POSSIBLE WRENCH LAMP
ILLUMINATED WITH DTC P0782 AND/OR P0784
FORD: 2007 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-7 to remove the production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition vehicles exhibit a 2-3 shift flare and/or a 4-5 shift flare. The wrench
light may be illuminated and diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0782 and/or P0784 may be
present in the transmission control module (TCM) memory. This condition may be caused by
damaged direct clutch (B Clutch) seals.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
THIS CONCERN IS FOR VEHICLES WITH LESS THAN 1000 MILES ONLY.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the two (2) direct clutch seals on the direct clutch cylinder and shaft assembly only. It is
NOT necessary to completely overhaul the transmission.
Follow the disassembly procedures as shown in the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01 B
through the removal of the Forward Clutch (A Clutch), the front planetary gear set, the Overdrive
Clutch (E Clutch) and the Direct Clutch (B Clutch).
NOTE
DISASSEMBLY OF THE CLUTCH PACKS AND THE SEPARATION OF THE FRICTION AND
STEELS IS NOT REQUIRED FOR THIS REPAIR. THERE IS NO NEED TO PERFORM CLUTCH
PACK END CLEARANCE CHECKS. IT IS ONLY NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE DIRECT
CLUTCH SEALING RINGS. IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO DISASSEMBLE THE ENTIRE
TRANSMISSION TO REPLACE THESE SEALS.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCARD CENTER SUPPORT RUBBER FEED TUBES.
NOTE
DO NOT REMOVE FRONT PUMP SEAL.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE FLUID FILTER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 07-5-5 > Mar > 07 > A/T - 2-3/4-5
Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784 > Page 4924
1. Remove the two (2) seal rings from the direct (B Clutch) cylinder. Discard the seal rings and
replace with new ones. See Figure 1 for proper direct (B Clutch) seal locations and alignment of the
scarf cut seals.
2. Reassemble in reverse order following the WSM, Section 307-01B.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X4: 8.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
Time To Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F,
4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X2: 7.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
time to Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F,
4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A098 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4925
Clutch: Service and Repair
Clutch Application Chart
General Specifications
Clutch Application Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 >
Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Control Module: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 >
Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 4934
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 >
Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 >
Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 4939
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 4944
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 4945
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 4946
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar >
10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar >
10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 4952
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr
> 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr
> 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 4957
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr >
07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr >
07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 4962
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr >
07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 4963
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Control Module, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr >
07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 4964
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
Transmission Fluid (6R75) ..................................................................................................................
............................................. 11.0 quarts (10.5 liters)
NOTE: Indicates only approximate dry fill capacity. Some applications may vary based on cooler
size and if equipped with an in-tank cooler.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4969
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Transmission Fluid Type
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
.......................................... MERCON SP XT-6-QSP
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Check Fluid Level and Condition
Fluid Level Check
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
NOTE: The transmission fluid temperature must not be allowed to exceed 50°C (122°F) when
checking the fluid level. The fluid temperature should be between 30°C-50°C (86°F-122°F) closer
to 50°C (122°F) when checking the fluid level.
This vehicle is not equipped with a fluid level indicator. An incorrect level may affect the
transmission operation and can result in transmission failure.
Under normal circumstances, the fluid level should not be checked during normal maintenance. If
the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level should be
checked. 1. With the transmission in PARK, the engine at idle (550-750 rpm) and foot pressed on
the brake, move the range selector lever through each gear
and allow engagement of each gear. Place the transmission range selector lever in the PARK
position.
2. With the engine idling (550-750 rpm) in PARK, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the fluid fill plug
located on the side of the transmission case. 4. Partially add fluid until fluid starts to come out. Wait
until the fluid stops or just drips from the hole. 5. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
High Fluid Level
CAUTION: A fluid level that is too high can cause the fluid to become aerated due to the churning
action of the rotating internal parts. This will cause erratic control pressure, foaming, loss of fluid
from the vent tube and possible transmission failure.
If an overfill reading is indicated, drain and refill the transmission.
Low Fluid Level
A low fluid level can result in poor transmission engagement, slipping or failure. This may also
indicate a leak in one of the transmission seals or gaskets.
Adding Fluid
CAUTION: The use of any other type of transmission fluid than specified can result in transmission
failure.
If fluid must be added, add fluid in 0.5 liter (1/2 quart) increments through the fluid fill plug. Do not
overfill the fluid. For fluid type, refer to the specification chart.
Fluid Condition Check
1. Check the fluid level. 2. Remove the fluid fill plug and allow the fluid to drip onto a facial tissue
and examine the stain.
3. NOTE: The transmission fluid could be 2 different colors. The factory fill fluid is amber. The
replacement fluid is red.
Observe the color and the odor. The color under normal circumstances should be dark reddish or
clear, not black or have a burnt odor.
4. If evidence of solid material is found, the transmission fluid pan should be removed for further
inspection. 5. If the stain is a foamy pink color, this may indicate coolant in the transmission. The
engine cooling system should also be inspected at this time. 6. If fluid contamination or
transmission failure is confirmed by the sediment in the bottom of the fluid pan, the transmission
must be disassembled
and completely cleaned. This includes the torque converter and fluid cooler tubes. A new oil-to-air
cooler must be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 4972
Fluid - A/T: Testing and Inspection 6R75 Automatic Transmission
Check Fluid Level and Condition
Fluid Level Check
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be extremely hot
during this procedure.
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period at high highway speeds, in city
traffic, during hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the fluid must cool down to obtain an accurate
reading.
NOTE: If the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level
should be checked.
This transmission is equipped with an internal thermal bypass located in the case. This internal
thermal bypass valve will shut off fluid flowing to the fluid cooler if the fluid temperature falls below
normal operating temperature.
High Fluid Level
CAUTION: fluid level that is too high can cause the fluid to become aerated due to the churning
action of the rotating internal parts. This will cause erratic control pressure, foaming, loss of fluid
from the vent tube and possible transmission failure.
If an overfill reading is indicated, remove any excessive fluid.
Low Fluid Level
A low fluid level can result in poor transmission engagement, slipping or failure. This may also
indicate a leak in one of the transmission seals or gaskets.
Adding Fluid
CAUTION: The use of any other type of transmission fluid than specified can result in transmission
failure.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be extremely hot
during this procedure.
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period at high highway speeds, in city
traffic, during hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the fluid must cool down to obtain an accurate
reading.
Add fluid using the refill procedure.
Fluid Condition Check
1. Check the fluid level. 2. Remove the fluid fill plug and fluid level indicator and allow the fluid to
drip onto a facial tissue and examine the stain. 3. Observe the color and the odor. The color under
normal circumstances should be dark reddish, not black or have a burnt odor. 4. If evidence of solid
material is found, the transmission fluid pan should be removed for further inspection. 5. If the stain
is a foamy pink color, this may indicate coolant in the transmission. The engine cooling system
should also be inspected at this time. 6. If fluid contamination or transmission failure is confirmed
by the sediment in the bottom of the fluid pan, the transmission must be disassembled
and completely cleaned. This includes the torque converter and fluid cooler tubes. new oil-to-air
(OTA) cooler must be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Special Tool(s)
Material
Drain
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the transmission fluid pan and
allow the fluid to drain.
3. Remove the fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4975
4. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan and magnet.
Refill
1. Install the fluid pan gasket.
2. Install the fluid pan and bolts.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
3. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during
this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Remove the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case, near the transmission electrical
connector.
4. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or
transmission failure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4976
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add 4.7 liters (5 quarts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid
fill hole. Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
5. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 6. With the special tool connected, the engine idling (550-750 rpm) in
PARK and the transmission temperature at 30°C-50°C (86°F-122°F), check
and adjust the transmission fluid level.
7. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during
this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid until the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
8. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
6R75 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4977
Special Tool(s)
Material
Drain
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Some fluid leakage may occur when removing the fluid fill plug.
Remove the fluid fill plug fluid level indicator assembly located on the passenger side front portion
of the transmission case. Removal of the plug will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in
the transmission. This will aid in allowing the fluid pan to be easily removed when the bolts are
removed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4978
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the fluid to drain.
4. Install the transmission fluid pan.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 lb-ft).
Transmission Fluid Refill
CAUTION: This procedure contains the air purge steps required to purge air from the cooling
system. This procedure is NOT intended for use with the Transmission Fluid Level Check.
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be extremely hot
during this procedure.
CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified, can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
NOTE: If the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level
should be checked.
NOTE: Here is an overview of the Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill procedure.
^ Adding 3.3L (3.5 qt) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission is an initial fill
enabling you to start the engine.
^ The cold level range shown in the procedure allows the vehicle to be driven.
^ The vehicle should be driven to allow the transmission fluid temperature to reach 85°C-88°C
(185°F-190°F) in order to purge the air from the transmission cooling system.
^ Fill the transmission fluid to the fill range on the fluid level indicator at the normal operating range
80°C-85°C (175°F-185°F).
1. NOTE: The transmission will need 3.3L (3.5 qt) of clean automatic transmission fluid added to
the transmission as an initial fill if:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4979
^ the transmission has been overhauled.
^ a new mechatronic assembly has been installed.
^ the transmission fluid pan or fluid filter have been removed.
Using the special tool, add 3.3L (3.5 qt) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission
through the fluid fill hole.
2. Check the transmission fluid level cold.
1 The vehicle is safe to drive if the transmission fluid is in the cold level range 32°C-43°C
(90°F-110°F).
^ Using the scan tool and the engine running, place the transmission selector lever in each gear
position and hold approximately 5 seconds. Place the transmission selector lever in PARK, with the
engine at idle (600-750 rpm).
3. Separate the fluid level indicator from the fill plug.
4. Wipe the fluid level indicator clean. Reinstall the fluid level indicator only back into the fill plug
hole to check the fluid level. Repeat this until a
consistent reading is established.
5. Add clean transmission fluid to the cold level location as shown in the illustration.
6. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4980
7. While driving the vehicle, use the scan tool to verify that the transmission fluid temperature has
reached a temperature of 88°C (190°F). This will
circulate the transmission fluid through the torque converter and the cooling system, eliminating
any trapped air in the cooling system. ^
With the engine idling (600-750 rpm) in PARK, verify that the transmission fluid temperature is
between 80°C-85°C (175°F-185°F).
8. Remove the fluid fill plug fluid level indicator assembly located on the passenger side front
portion of the transmission case.
9. Separate the fluid level indicator from the fill plug.
10. Wipe the fluid level indicator clean. Reinstall the fluid level indicator only back into the fill plug
hole to check the fluid level. Repeat this until a
consistent reading is established.
11. Using the scan tool verify that the transmission fluid temperature is between 80°C-85°C
(175°F-185°F). The fluid level must be at the upper level
of the crosshatch mark.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4981
12. NOTE: If the transmission fluid is not at the correct level, follow the steps for Adding Additional
Transmission Fluid or Removing Transmission
Fluid in this procedure.
Install the fluid fill plug. ^
Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Adding Additional Transmission Fluid
NOTE: To get an accurate fluid level reading the engine should be idling (600-750 rpm) in PARK.
1. Install the special tool into the fluid fill hole.
2. Fill the special tool with approximately 0.47L (1 pt) of clean automatic transmission fluid.
3. Hang the special tool under the vehicle, upright and close to the transmission.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4982
4. Connect the special tools.
^ Connect the open end of the fluid hose from the special tool onto the special tool from the
transmission case.
5. Apply a maximum of 206.85 kPa (30 psi) to the open end of the vacuum/pressure hose from the
special tool. Fluid will immediately start flowing
out of the special tool into the transmission.
6. NOTE: Do not overfill the transmission. The fluid level must be at the upper level of the
crosshatch mark.
Reinstall the fluid level indicator only back into the fill plug hole to check the fluid level. Repeat this
until a consistent reading is established.
7. Using the scan tool verify that the transmission fluid temperature is between 80°C-85°C
(175°F-185°F). The fluid level must be at the upper level
of the crosshatch mark.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4983
8. NOTE: If the transmission fluid is over full, follow the steps for Removing Transmission Fluid in
this procedure.
Install the fluid fill plug. ^
Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Removing Transmission Fluid
NOTE: To get an accurate fluid level reading the engine should be idling (600-750 rpm) in PARK.
1. If the transmission is overfilled, fluid must be removed to the correct level. Use the special tools
to extract any excessive fluid.
2. Using the scan tool, verify that the transmission fluid temperature is between 80°C-85°C
(175°F-185°F). The fluid level must be at the upper level
of the crosshatch mark. Reinstall the fluid level indicator only back into the fill plug hole to check
the fluid level. Repeat this until a consistent reading is established.
3. Install the fluid fill plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4984
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4985
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Level Check
Transmission Fluid Level Check
Special Tool(s)
Material
CAUTION: The vehicle should not be driven if the fluid level is low as internal failure could result.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug is located near the exhaust system. The exhaust will be extremely hot
during this procedure.
NOTE: If the vehicle has been operated for an extended period at high highway speeds, in city
traffic, during hot weather or while pulling a trailer, the fluid must cool down to obtain an accurate
reading.
NOTE: If the transmission starts to slip, shifts slowly or shows signs of fluid leaking, the fluid level
should be checked.
NOTE: Do not overfill the transmission. The fluid level must be at the upper level of the crosshatch
mark.
NOTE: If the installation of a new transmission fluid cooler, cooler lines have been carried out the
vehicle must be driven to get the transmission fluid to a temperature of 88°C (190°F) in order to
purge the air from the cooling system.
1. With the engine running, place the transmission selector lever in each gear position and hold
approximately 5 seconds. Place the transmission
selector lever in PARK.
2. With the engine idling (600-750 rpm) in PARK, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the fluid fill plug
fluid level indicator assembly, located on the passenger side front portion of the transmission case.
4. Separate the fluid level indicator from the fill plug.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4986
5. Wipe the fluid level indicator clean. Reinstall the fluid level indicator only back into the fill plug
hole to check the fluid level.
6. Using the scan tool, verify that the transmission fluid temperature is between 80°C-85°C
(175°F-185°F). Do not overfill the transmission. The
fluid level must be at the upper level of the crosshatch mark.
7. NOTE: If the transmission fluid is not at the correct level, follow the steps for Adding Additional
Transmission Fluid or Removing Transmission
Fluid.
Install the fluid fill plug. ^
Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4987
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Cooler - Backflushing and Cleaning
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler - Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
CAUTION: When internal damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch plate
material can travel into the torque converter and the transmission fluid cooler. These contaminates
are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent further concerns, remove these
contaminates from the cooler lines and install a new cooler before placing the transmission in use.
1. Install a new transmission fluid cooler if any fluid leaks are indicated or a major metallic failure is
indicated. 2. Using a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner, flush the fluid cooler and lines.
3. NOTE: Rubber hoses must be attached to the ends of the fluid cooler tubes, to aid in connecting
them to the fluid cooler cleaner.
Connect the cleaner pressure and return lines appropriately. 1
Connect the pressure line to the fluid cooler inlet tube.
2 Connect the return line to the fluid cooler outlet tube.
3 Place the outlet end of the return line in the fluid tank reservoir.
4. NOTE: Cycling the fluid pump on and off will help dislodge contaminants in the cooler system.
Switch the fluid pumps on. Allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes.
5. Switch the fluid pump off. 6. Disconnect the cleaner pressure line at the fluid cooler tube. 7.
Using compressed air, blow through the fluid cooler inlet tube until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove
the rubber hoses from the fluid cooler tubes.
6R75 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler - Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
CAUTION: When internal damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch plate
material can travel into the torque converter and the transmission fluid cooler. These contaminates
are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent further concerns, remove these
contaminates from the cooler lines and install a new cooler before placing the transmission in use.
1. Install a new transmission fluid cooler if any fluid leaks are indicated or a major metallic failure is
indicated. 2. Using a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner, flush the fluid cooler and lines.
3. NOTE: Rubber hoses must be attached to the ends of the fluid cooler tubes, to aid in connecting
them to the cleaner.
Connect the cleaner pressure and return lines appropriately. 1
Connect the pressure line to the fluid cooler inlet tube.
2 Connect the return line to the fluid cooler outlet tube.
3 Place the outlet end of the return line in the fluid tank reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Drain and Refill > Page 4988
4. NOTE: Cycling the fluid pump ON and OFF will help dislodge contaminants in the cooler system.
Switch the fluid pumps ON. Allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes.
5. Switch the fluid pump OFF. 6. Disconnect the cleaner pressure line at the fluid cooler tube. 7.
Using compressed air, blow through the fluid cooler inlet tube until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove
the rubber hoses from the fluid cooler tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair
Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
Material
Removal
CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified, can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the fluid fill plug fluid level
indicator assembly located on the passenger side front portion of the transmission case. Removal
of the plug
will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in the transmission. This will aid in allowing the
fluid pan to be easily removed when the bolts are removed.
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the fluid to drain.
4. Remove the fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4992
5. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
6. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan and magnet.
Installation
NOTE: If the transmission is being repaired for a contamination-related failure, install a new
transmission fluid filter and seal assembly. The fluid filter may be reused if no excessive
contamination is indicated.
1. Inspect the transmission case for the transmission fluid filter seal. If the seal is in the case,
carefully remove the seal without scratching the case.
2. Make sure that the seal is on the transmission fluid filter and lubricate the seal with clean
automatic transmission fluid.
3. NOTE: The fluid filter may be reused if no excessive contamination is indicated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4993
Install a new transmission fluid filter.
4. Position the magnet in the transmission fluid pan.
5. NOTE: The fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install a new transmission fluid pan gasket if required.
6. Install the fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 lb-ft).
7. Using the refill procedure, fill and check the transmission fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes
Fluid Line/Hose: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes
Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes > Page 4998
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the pushpin and move the air
deflector aside.
3. Remove the transmission cooler tube secondary latches.
4. Using the special tool, disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the transmission fluid
cooler hoses.
5. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bracket nut from the front of the engine.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes > Page 4999
6. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tube bracket from the side of the transmission.
7. NOTE: The transmission fluid cooler tube O-rings may remain in the transmission case.
Carefully remove them from the case if retained.
Remove the bolt and disconnect the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the transmission.
8. Disconnect the electrical harness from the transmission cooler tubes.
9. Remove the 4 nuts and lower the front sway bar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes > Page 5000
10. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when removing the engine mount nuts or damage to the engine
mount may occur.
For four wheel drive (4WD), remove the LH engine mount nuts and lift the engine to gain clearance
for the trans cooler tubes.
11. Remove the transmission fluid cooler tubes from the vehicle.
Installation
1. Position the transmission fluid cooler tubes in the vehicle. 2. Install the bolt and transmission
fluid cooler tube bracket to the side of the transmission.
^ Tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
3. Install the nut and transmission fluid cooler tube bracket to the front of the engine.
^ Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Connect the transmission fluid cooler tubes to the transmission fluid cooler hoses.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes > Page 5001
5. Install the transmission cooler tube secondary latches.
6. Reposition the air deflector and install the pushpin.
7. Position the sway bar in place and install the 4 nuts.
^ Tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
8. CAUTION: Only use hand tools when installing the engine mount nuts or damage to the engine
mount may occur.
For 4WD, lower the engine and install the LH engine mount nuts. ^
Tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes > Page 5002
9. Connect the electrical harness to the transmission cooler tubes.
10. NOTE: Inspect the case to make sure that the old O-rings are not stuck in the case.
NOTE: Install new O-rings on the ends of the cooler lines prior to installing.
Install new O-rings on the transmission fluid cooler tubes.
11. NOTE: Inspect the case to make sure that the old O-rings are not stuck in the case.
NOTE: Install new O-rings on the ends of the cooler lines prior to installing.
Position the transmission fluid cooler tubes into the transmission, then install the bolt. ^
Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes > Page 5003
12. Fill the transmission with fluid and verify correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes > Page 5004
Fluid Line/Hose: Service and Repair Transmission Fluid Cooler Hoses
Transmission Fluid Cooler Hoses
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes > Page 5005
Removal
1. Remove the upper radiator cover.
1 Remove the fasteners.
2. Remove and discard the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose clamps. 3. Disconnect the
auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose from the coolers. 4. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist. 5. Move the flexible air deflector aside, then remove and discard the
transmission fluid cooler tube secondary latches. 6. Using the special tool, disconnect the
transmission fluid cooler hoses from the transmission fluid cooler tubes.
7. Remove and discard the transmission fluid cooler hose clamps. 8. Disconnect the transmission
fluid cooler hoses from the coolers.
Installation
1. Connect the transmission fluid cooler hoses to the coolers. 2. Install new transmission fluid
cooler hose clamps. 3. Connect the transmission fluid cooler hoses to the transmission fluid cooler
tubes. 4. Install new transmission fluid cooler tube secondary latches, then move the flexible air
deflector back into place. 5. Connect the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose to the coolers.
6. Install new auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose clamps. 7. Install the upper radiator
cover.
1 Install the fasteners.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Fluid Cooler Tubes > Page 5006
8. Fill the transmission with fluid and verify correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Fluid Pan: Specifications 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission fluid pan bolts.................................................................................................................
........................................................... 12 Nm (9 lb-ft) Tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5011
Fluid Pan: Specifications 6R75 Automatic Transmission
Transmission fluid pan bolts.................................................................................................................
......................................................... 14 Nm (10 lb-ft) Tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5012
Fluid Pan: Service and Repair
Fluid Pan, Gasket and Filter
Material
Removal
CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified, can result in the transmission
failing to operate in a normal manner or transmission failure.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the fluid fill plug fluid level
indicator assembly located on the passenger side front portion of the transmission case. Removal
of the plug
will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in the transmission. This will aid in allowing the
fluid pan to be easily removed when the bolts are removed.
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the fluid to drain.
4. Remove the fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5013
5. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
6. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan and magnet.
Installation
NOTE: If the transmission is being repaired for a contamination-related failure, install a new
transmission fluid filter and seal assembly. The fluid filter may be reused if no excessive
contamination is indicated.
1. Inspect the transmission case for the transmission fluid filter seal. If the seal is in the case,
carefully remove the seal without scratching the case.
2. Make sure that the seal is on the transmission fluid filter and lubricate the seal with clean
automatic transmission fluid.
3. NOTE: The fluid filter may be reused if no excessive contamination is indicated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5014
Install a new transmission fluid filter.
4. Position the magnet in the transmission fluid pan.
5. NOTE: The fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install a new transmission fluid pan gasket if required.
6. Install the fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 lb-ft).
7. Using the refill procedure, fill and check the transmission fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fluid Pump: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Fluid Pump: Customer Interest A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fluid Pump: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 5023
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fluid Pump: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10
> A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Fluid Pump: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fluid Pump: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10
> A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 5029
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators - A/T
> Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5038
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5039
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5040
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5041
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5042
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5043
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5044
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5045
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5046
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5047
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5048
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5049
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5050
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5051
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5052
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5053
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Overdrive Switch, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5054
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5059
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5060
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5061
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5062
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5063
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5064
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5065
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5066
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5067
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5068
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5069
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5070
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5071
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5072
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5073
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5074
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Pressure Regulating
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5075
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Control Module: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 5085
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 5090
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5095
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5096
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: >
07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5097
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 5103
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 5108
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5113
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5114
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Relays and Modules - A/T >
Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control
Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5115
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Seals and Gaskets: Customer Interest A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 5124
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 07-5-5 > Mar > 07 > A/T 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784
Seals and Gaskets: Customer Interest A/T - 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784
TSB 07-5-5
03/19/07
6R75 TRANSMISSION 2-3 AND/OR 4-5 SHIFT FLARE, POSSIBLE WRENCH LAMP
ILLUMINATED WITH DTC P0782 AND/OR P0784
FORD: 2007 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-7 to remove the production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition vehicles exhibit a 2-3 shift flare and/or a 4-5 shift flare. The wrench
light may be illuminated and diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0782 and/or P0784 may be
present in the transmission control module (TCM) memory. This condition may be caused by
damaged direct clutch (B Clutch) seals.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
THIS CONCERN IS FOR VEHICLES WITH LESS THAN 1000 MILES ONLY.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the two (2) direct clutch seals on the direct clutch cylinder and shaft assembly only. It is
NOT necessary to completely overhaul the transmission.
Follow the disassembly procedures as shown in the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01 B
through the removal of the Forward Clutch (A Clutch), the front planetary gear set, the Overdrive
Clutch (E Clutch) and the Direct Clutch (B Clutch).
NOTE
DISASSEMBLY OF THE CLUTCH PACKS AND THE SEPARATION OF THE FRICTION AND
STEELS IS NOT REQUIRED FOR THIS REPAIR. THERE IS NO NEED TO PERFORM CLUTCH
PACK END CLEARANCE CHECKS. IT IS ONLY NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE DIRECT
CLUTCH SEALING RINGS. IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO DISASSEMBLE THE ENTIRE
TRANSMISSION TO REPLACE THESE SEALS.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCARD CENTER SUPPORT RUBBER FEED TUBES.
NOTE
DO NOT REMOVE FRONT PUMP SEAL.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE FLUID FILTER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 07-5-5 > Mar > 07 > A/T 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784 > Page 5129
1. Remove the two (2) seal rings from the direct (B Clutch) cylinder. Discard the seal rings and
replace with new ones. See Figure 1 for proper direct (B Clutch) seal locations and alignment of the
scarf cut seals.
2. Reassemble in reverse order following the WSM, Section 307-01B.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X4: 8.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
Time To Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F,
4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X2: 7.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
time to Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F,
4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A098 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 10-18-1 > Sep
> 10 > A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's
P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 10-18-1 > Sep
> 10 > A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 5135
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 07-5-5 > Mar >
07 > A/T - 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's
P07782/P0784
TSB 07-5-5
03/19/07
6R75 TRANSMISSION 2-3 AND/OR 4-5 SHIFT FLARE, POSSIBLE WRENCH LAMP
ILLUMINATED WITH DTC P0782 AND/OR P0784
FORD: 2007 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-7 to remove the production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition vehicles exhibit a 2-3 shift flare and/or a 4-5 shift flare. The wrench
light may be illuminated and diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0782 and/or P0784 may be
present in the transmission control module (TCM) memory. This condition may be caused by
damaged direct clutch (B Clutch) seals.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
THIS CONCERN IS FOR VEHICLES WITH LESS THAN 1000 MILES ONLY.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the two (2) direct clutch seals on the direct clutch cylinder and shaft assembly only. It is
NOT necessary to completely overhaul the transmission.
Follow the disassembly procedures as shown in the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01 B
through the removal of the Forward Clutch (A Clutch), the front planetary gear set, the Overdrive
Clutch (E Clutch) and the Direct Clutch (B Clutch).
NOTE
DISASSEMBLY OF THE CLUTCH PACKS AND THE SEPARATION OF THE FRICTION AND
STEELS IS NOT REQUIRED FOR THIS REPAIR. THERE IS NO NEED TO PERFORM CLUTCH
PACK END CLEARANCE CHECKS. IT IS ONLY NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE DIRECT
CLUTCH SEALING RINGS. IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO DISASSEMBLE THE ENTIRE
TRANSMISSION TO REPLACE THESE SEALS.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCARD CENTER SUPPORT RUBBER FEED TUBES.
NOTE
DO NOT REMOVE FRONT PUMP SEAL.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE FLUID FILTER.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 07-5-5 > Mar >
07 > A/T - 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784 > Page 5140
1. Remove the two (2) seal rings from the direct (B Clutch) cylinder. Discard the seal rings and
replace with new ones. See Figure 1 for proper direct (B Clutch) seal locations and alignment of the
scarf cut seals.
2. Reassemble in reverse order following the WSM, Section 307-01B.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X4: 8.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
Time To Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F,
4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X2: 7.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
time to Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F,
4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A098 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 5141
Seals and Gaskets: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 10-18-1 Date: 100927
A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 5142
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150, Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To
Remove And Install The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor
Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 07-5-5 Date: 070319
A/T - 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784
TSB 07-5-5
03/19/07
6R75 TRANSMISSION 2-3 AND/OR 4-5 SHIFT FLARE, POSSIBLE WRENCH LAMP
ILLUMINATED WITH DTC P0782 AND/OR P0784
FORD: 2007 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-7 to remove the production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition vehicles exhibit a 2-3 shift flare and/or a 4-5 shift flare. The wrench
light may be illuminated and diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0782 and/or P0784 may be
present in the transmission control module (TCM) memory. This condition may be caused by
damaged direct clutch (B Clutch) seals.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
THIS CONCERN IS FOR VEHICLES WITH LESS THAN 1000 MILES ONLY.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the two (2) direct clutch seals on the direct clutch cylinder and shaft assembly only. It is
NOT necessary to completely overhaul the transmission.
Follow the disassembly procedures as shown in the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01 B
through the removal of the Forward Clutch (A Clutch), the front planetary gear set, the Overdrive
Clutch (E Clutch) and the Direct Clutch (B Clutch).
NOTE
DISASSEMBLY OF THE CLUTCH PACKS AND THE SEPARATION OF THE FRICTION AND
STEELS IS NOT REQUIRED FOR THIS REPAIR. THERE IS NO NEED TO PERFORM CLUTCH
PACK END CLEARANCE CHECKS. IT IS ONLY NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE DIRECT
CLUTCH SEALING RINGS. IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO DISASSEMBLE THE ENTIRE
TRANSMISSION TO REPLACE THESE SEALS.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCARD CENTER SUPPORT RUBBER FEED TUBES.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 5143
NOTE
DO NOT REMOVE FRONT PUMP SEAL.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE FLUID FILTER.
1. Remove the two (2) seal rings from the direct (B Clutch) cylinder. Discard the seal rings and
replace with new ones. See Figure 1 for proper direct (B Clutch) seal locations and alignment of the
scarf cut seals.
2. Reassemble in reverse order following the WSM, Section 307-01B.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X4: 8.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
Time To Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F,
4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X2: 7.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
time to Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 5144
Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A,
700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F, 4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A098 30
Disclaimer Technical Service Bulletin # 07-5-5 Date: 070319
A/T - 2-3/4-5 Shift Flare/MIL ON/DTC's P07782/P0784
TSB 07-5-5
03/19/07
6R75 TRANSMISSION 2-3 AND/OR 4-5 SHIFT FLARE, POSSIBLE WRENCH LAMP
ILLUMINATED WITH DTC P0782 AND/OR P0784
FORD: 2007 Expedition
This article supersedes TSB 07-3-7 to remove the production fix date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition vehicles exhibit a 2-3 shift flare and/or a 4-5 shift flare. The wrench
light may be illuminated and diagnostic trouble code(s) (DTCs) P0782 and/or P0784 may be
present in the transmission control module (TCM) memory. This condition may be caused by
damaged direct clutch (B Clutch) seals.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
THIS CONCERN IS FOR VEHICLES WITH LESS THAN 1000 MILES ONLY.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Replace the two (2) direct clutch seals on the direct clutch cylinder and shaft assembly only. It is
NOT necessary to completely overhaul the transmission.
Follow the disassembly procedures as shown in the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01 B
through the removal of the Forward Clutch (A Clutch), the front planetary gear set, the Overdrive
Clutch (E Clutch) and the Direct Clutch (B Clutch).
NOTE
DISASSEMBLY OF THE CLUTCH PACKS AND THE SEPARATION OF THE FRICTION AND
STEELS IS NOT REQUIRED FOR THIS REPAIR. THERE IS NO NEED TO PERFORM CLUTCH
PACK END CLEARANCE CHECKS. IT IS ONLY NECESSARY TO REPLACE THE DIRECT
CLUTCH SEALING RINGS. IT IS NOT NECESSARY TO DISASSEMBLE THE ENTIRE
TRANSMISSION TO REPLACE THESE SEALS.
NOTE
DO NOT DISCARD CENTER SUPPORT RUBBER FEED TUBES.
NOTE
DO NOT REMOVE FRONT PUMP SEAL.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 5145
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE FLUID FILTER.
1. Remove the two (2) seal rings from the direct (B Clutch) cylinder. Discard the seal rings and
replace with new ones. See Figure 1 for proper direct (B Clutch) seal locations and alignment of the
scarf cut seals.
2. Reassemble in reverse order following the WSM, Section 307-01B.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X4: 8.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
Time To Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F,
4602A, 7191A, 7191A1, 7326C, 12650D)
070505A 2007 Expedition 4X2: 7.0 Hrs.
Replace The Two Direct Clutch Seals On The Direct Clutch Cylinder And Shaft Assembly. Includes
time to Check DTCs, R And I Transmission, Also Includes Shift Cable Adjustment After
Re-assembly (Do Not Use
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page 5146
With 5200A, 5200B, 7000A, 700A2, 7000A6, 7000A7, 7000A12, 7000F, 4602A, 7191A, 7191A1,
7326C, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A098 30
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Output Shaft Seal
Output Shaft Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
NOTE: Rear wheel drive (RWD) shown, four wheel drive (4WD) similar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5149
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
RWD vehicles
2. Remove the rear driveshaft. 3. Remove and discard the output shaft flange nut.
4. Remove the output shaft flange.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5150
5. Using the special tools, remove the output shaft seal.
4WD vehicles
6. Remove the transfer case. 7. Using the special tools, remove the output shaft seal.
Installation
RWD vehicles
1. Position a new output shaft seal.
2. Using the special tool, install the output shaft seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5151
3. Install the output shaft flange.
4. Install a new output shaft flange nut.
^ Tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
5. Install the rear driveshaft.
4WD vehicles
6. Position the output shaft seal.
7. Using the special tool, install a new output shaft seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5152
8. Install the transfer case.
All vehicles
9. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during
this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Remove the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case near the transmission electrical
connector.
10. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate correctly or
transmission failure.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add 4.7 liters (5 quarts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid
fill hole. Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
11. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 12. With the special tool connected, the engine idling (550-750 rpm) in
PARK and the transmission temperature at 30°C-50°C (86°F-122°F), check
and adjust the transmission fluid level.
13. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during
this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid until the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5153
14. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Manual Control Lever Shaft and Seal
Manual Control Lever Shaft and Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. If equipped, remove the heat shield.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5154
3. Move the locking tab up and disconnect the selector lever cable from the manual lever ball stud.
4. CAUTION: Do not pull on the wire harness to disconnect the connector or damage to the
connector will occur.
Disconnect the main transmission electrical harness by twisting the outer shell and pulling back on
the connector.
5. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the fluid to drain.
6. Remove the fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5155
7. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
8. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan and magnet.
9. Press the release tab and pull down on the bulkhead connector retainer.
10. With the release tab down, pull the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5156
11. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins. Electrostatic charge may occur and will
cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Pull the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector out of the transmission.
12. NOTE: During removal of the mechatronic assembly, the thermal bypass valve, pump adapter
seal and one or more center support seals may
become dislodged. Save these components for reuse during assembly.
Remove the 10 bolts from the mechatronic assembly and remove the mechatronic assembly.
13. Remove the park rod actuating plate.
14. Remove the manual control lever.
1 Remove the roll pin.
2 Slide the manual control lever shaft out of the case.
3 Hold the spacer to keep it from falling out of the case.
4 Remove the manual valve inner lever and the park rod as an assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5157
15. Remove and discard the manual control lever seal.
Installation
1. Position a new manual control lever seal in place.
2. Using the special tool, install a new manual control lever shaft seal.
3. Install the manual lever in the case.
1 Slide the manual lever in the case.
2 Position the spacer in place while sliding the manual lever into the spacer.
3 Position the manual valve inner lever while sliding the manual lever and lining up the roll pin hole.
4 Install the roll pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5158
4. Position the park rod in place. Push down on the park pawl and position the park rod in place. 5.
While holding the park rod down, install the park rod actuating plate.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
6. NOTE: Before installing the mechatronic assembly into the transmission case, verify presence
and correct orientation of the thermal bypass valve,
pump adapter seal and center support seals. Also note that one or more of the center support seals
may have remained in the mechatronic assembly during removal and should be installed into the
transmission case at this time.
Verify the 4 rubber feed tubes for the center support are in place.
7. Verify the thermal bypass valve is in the case.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5159
8. Verify the rubber adapter is in place.
9. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the
transmission control module (TCM).
Electrostatic discharge may occur and may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Position the mechatronic assembly in place and loosely install the 10 bolts. 1
Align the manual valve and control lever linkage.
10. Tighten the mechatronic bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
11. Install new O-rings on the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5160
12. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins. Electrostatic charge may occur and will
cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down, push the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector into the
transmission.
13. Press up on the tab and lock the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector in place.
14. Install a new transmission fluid filter.
15. Install the fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5161
16. Install the fluid pan and bolts.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
17. Connect the main transmission electrical harness by pushing it in and twisting the outer shell to
lock it in place.
18. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the ball stud and move the locking tab down. ^
Listen for the audible click.
^ Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
19. If equipped, install the heat shield.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5162
20. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during
this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Remove the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case near the transmission electrical
connector.
21. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate correctly or
transmission failure.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add 4.7 liters (5 quarts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid
fill hole. Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
22. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 23. With the special tool connected, the engine idling (550-750 rpm) in
PARK and the transmission temperature at 30°C-50°C (86°F-122°F), check
and adjust the transmission fluid level.
24. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during
this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid until the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5163
25. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5164
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair 6R75 Automatic Transmission
Output Shaft Seal
Output Shaft Seal
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5165
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Rear wheel drive (RWD) vehicles
2. Remove the rear driveshaft.
3. NOTE: The output shaft flange nut has been staked to prevent it from coming loose. Prior to
removing the nut, remove the stake to prevent
damage to the output shaft.
Remove and discard the output shaft flange nut.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5166
4. Remove the output shaft flange.
5. Using the special tools, remove the output shaft seal.
Four wheel drive (4WD) vehicles
6. Remove the transfer case. 7. Using the special tools, remove the output shaft seal.
Installation
RWD vehicles
1. Position a new output shaft seal.
2. Using the special tool, install the output shaft seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5167
3. Install the output shaft flange.
4. Install a new output shaft flange nut.
^ Tighten to 60 Nm (44 lb-ft).
^ After installing the new nut, it must be staked at the slots to prevent it from coming loose.
5. Install the rear driveshaft.
4WD vehicles
6. Position the output shaft seal.
7. Using the special tool, install a new output shaft seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5168
8. Install the transfer case.
All vehicles
9. Fill and check the transmission fluid.
Manual Control Lever Shaft and Seal
Manual Control Lever Shaft and Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. If equipped, remove the heat shield.
3. Move the locking tab up and disconnect the selector lever cable from the manual lever ball stud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5169
4. Remove the fluid fill plug fluid level indicator assembly located on the passenger side front
portion of the transmission case. Removal of the plug
will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in the transmission. This will aid in allowing the
fluid pan to be easily removed when the bolts are removed.
5. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the fluid to drain.
6. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
7. Remove the fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5170
8. CAUTION: Do not pull on the wire harness to disconnect the connector or damage to the
connector will occur.
Disconnect the main transmission electrical harness by twisting the outer shell and pulling back on
the connector.
9. Pull the release tab and pull down on the bulkhead connector retainer.
10. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the TCM.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and
may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down, pull the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector out of the
transmission control module (TCM).
11. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the TCM.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and
may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Pull the bulkhead electrical connector out of the transmission.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5171
12. Remove the 11 bolts from the mechatronic assembly and remove the mechatronic assembly.
13. Remove the park rod actuating plate.
14. Remove the manual control lever.
1 Remove the roll pin.
2 Slide the manual control lever shaft out of the case.
3 Hold the spacer to keep it from falling out of the case.
4 Remove the manual valve inner lever and the park rod as an assembly.
15. Remove and discard the manual control lever seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5172
Installation
1. Position a new manual control lever seal in place.
2. Using the special tool, install a new manual control lever shaft seal.
3. Install the manual lever in the case.
1 Slide the manual lever in the case.
2 Position the spacer in place while sliding the manual lever into the spacer.
3 Position the manual valve inner lever while sliding the manual lever and lining up the roll pin hole.
4 Install the roll pin.
4. Position the park rod in place. Push down on the park pawl and position the park rod in place. 5.
While holding the park rod down, install the park rod actuating plate.
^ Tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5173
6. NOTE: Before installing the mechatronic assembly into the transmission case, verify presence
and correct orientation of the thermal bypass valve,
pump adapter seal and center support seals. Also note that one or more of the center support seals
may have remained in the mechatronic assembly during removal and should be installed into the
transmission case at this time.
Verify the 4 rubber feed tubes for the center support are in place. 1
Black feed tube.
2 Green feed tube.
3 Blue feed tube.
7. Verify the rubber adapter is in place.
8. Verify the thermal bypass valve is in the case.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5174
9. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the TCM.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and
may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Position the mechatronic assembly in place and loosely install the 11 bolts. 1
Align the manual valve and control lever linkage.
10. Tighten the mechatronic bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
11. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins. Electrostatic discharge may occur and
will cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down and unlocked, push the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector
into the transmission. Make sure that the bulkhead connector is fully seated into the TCM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5175
12. Press up on the tab and lock the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector in place.
13. Install a new transmission fluid filter.
14. NOTE: The fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install the transmission fluid pan gasket if necessary.
15. Install the fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 lb-ft).
16. Connect the main transmission electrical harness by pushing it in and twisting the outer shell to
lock it in place.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Seals and Gaskets, A/T >
System Information > Service and Repair > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5176
17. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the ball stud and move the locking tab down. ^
Listen for the audible click.
^ Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
18. If equipped, install the heat shield.
19. Using the refill procedure, fill and check the transmission fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5182
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5183
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5184
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5185
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5186
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5187
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5188
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5189
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5190
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5191
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5192
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5193
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5194
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5195
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5196
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5197
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5198
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5199
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5204
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5205
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5206
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5207
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5208
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5209
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5210
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5211
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5212
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5213
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5214
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5215
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5216
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5217
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5218
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5219
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5220
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5225
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5226
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5227
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5228
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5229
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5230
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5231
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5232
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5233
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5234
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5235
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5236
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5237
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5238
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5239
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5240
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5241
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5247
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5248
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5249
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5250
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5251
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5252
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5253
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5254
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5255
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5256
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5257
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5258
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5259
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5260
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5261
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5262
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5263
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5264
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5265
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch Column Shift
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (TC) switch is not replaceable. If a new TC switch is required,
install a new transmission selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch Column Shift > Page 5268
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (+/-) switch is not serviced. If a new switch is required, install a
new selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5273
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5274
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5275
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5276
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5277
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5278
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5279
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5280
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5281
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5282
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5283
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5284
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5285
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5286
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5287
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5288
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5289
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5294
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5295
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5296
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5297
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5298
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5299
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5300
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5301
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5302
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5303
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5304
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5305
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5306
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5307
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5308
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5309
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page
5310
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5315
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5316
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5317
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5318
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5319
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5320
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5321
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5322
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5323
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5324
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5325
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5326
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5327
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5328
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5329
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5330
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches - A/T
> Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5331
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 5336
C2139
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake shift interlock actuator is not serviced individually. If replacement is required,
install a new floor shift selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift > Page 5339
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Set the parking brake. 2. Remove the steering column shrouds. 3. Turn the ignition to the
accessory position and apply the brake or actuate the brake shift interlock actuator (BSIA) override.
4. Put the selector lever into the NEUTRAL position. 5. Disconnect the BSIA electrical connector. 6.
Remove the BSIA screw. 7. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T > Shift
Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift > Page 5340
8. NOTE: During installation, verify that the BSIA override has been activated and the slider is fully
rearward. Before rotating the selector lever
from NEUTRAL into PARK, align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5345
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5346
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5347
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5348
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5349
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5350
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5351
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5352
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5353
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5354
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5355
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5356
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5357
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5358
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5359
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5360
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5361
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams
C2096
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever Mechanism
Selector Lever Mechanism
Removal
1. Remove the instrument panel lower finish panel.
2. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
1 Remove the screws and the lower shroud.
3. Remove the steering column upper shroud. 4. Remove the instrument panel (IP)
cluster-to-shroud trim.
5. Remove the RH IP cluster trim screw.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5367
6. Remove the LH IP cluster trim screw and pull the IP cluster trim from the IP.
7. If equipped, disconnect the in-vehicle temperature sensor connector.
8. Disconnect the dimmer switch electrical connector and remove the IP cluster trim.
9. Remove the upper IP cluster screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5368
10. Remove the RH lower IP cluster screw.
11. Remove the LH lower IP cluster screw and position the IP cluster aside.
12. Disconnect the selector lever cable.
13. Remove the locking pin and the park lock cable (PLC).
1 Remove and discard the locking pin.
2 Disconnect the PLC.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5369
14. Disconnect the transmission control (TC) switch electrical connector and the harness from the
retaining clips.
15. Remove the selector lever bolt.
16. Remove the selector lever.
17. Remove the selector lever mechanism lower bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5370
18. Disconnect the brake shift interlock actuator (BSIA) electrical connector and remove the
selector lever mechanism upper bolts and the selector
lever mechanism from the vehicle.
19. Remove the BSIA from the selector lever mechanism.
1 Pull the BSIA override button.
2 Remove the BSIA screw.
3 Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
Installation
1. Install the BSIA onto the selector lever mechanism.
1 Pull the BSIA override button.
2 Align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
3 Position and secure the BSIA with the clip.
4 Install the screw.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5371
2. Install the selector lever mechanism into the vehicle, install the upper bolts and connect the BSIA
electrical connector.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
3. Install the selector lever mechanism lower bolt.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
4. Install the selector lever.
^ Tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
5. Connect the TC switch electrical connector and the harness into the retaining clips.
6. Install the locking pin and the PLC.
1 Connect the PLC.
2 Install a new locking pin.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5372
7. Connect the selector lever cable.
8. Position the IP cluster and install the LH lower IP cluster screw.
9. Install the RH lower IP cluster screw.
10. Install the upper IP cluster screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5373
11. Position the IP cluster trim and connect the dimmer switch electrical connector.
12. If equipped, connect the in-vehicle temperature sensor connector.
13. Install the LH IP cluster trim screw.
14. Install the RH IP cluster trim screw.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5374
15. Install the IP cluster-to-shroud trim.
16. Install the steering column upper shroud. 17. Install the steering column lower shroud.
18. Install the instrument panel lower finish panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5375
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever Knob
Selector Lever Knob
Vehicles Equipped With a 6R75 Transmission
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5376
Vehicles Equipped With a 6HP26 Transmission
Removal
1. NOTE: 6R75 transmission selector lever shown, 6HP26 similar.
Remove the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5377
2. Remove the screw and the console upper trim.
3. Remove and discard the RH selector lever knob cover.
1 Start at the bottom rear only.
2 Work towards the top.
4. Remove and discard the LH selector lever knob cover.
1 Start at the bottom rear only.
2 Work towards the top.
5. Remove and discard the RH selector lever knob screw.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5378
6. Remove and discard the LH selector lever knob screw.
7. Disconnect the transmission control (TC) switch electrical connector and remove the selector
lever knob.
Installation
1. Connect the transmission control (TC) switch electrical connector and install the selector lever
knob.
2. Install a new LH selector lever knob screw.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5379
3. Install a new RH selector lever knob screw.
4. NOTE: Wood trimmed vehicles have a rubber damper not found on other trim levels.
Install a new LH selector lever knob cover.
5. NOTE: Wood trimmed vehicles have a rubber damper not found on other trim levels.
Install a new RH selector lever knob cover.
6. Install the console upper trim and the screw.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5380
7. Install the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5381
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever Bezel
Selector Lever Bezel
Vehicles Equipped With a 6R75 Transmission
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5382
Vehicles Equipped With a 6HP26 Transmission
Removal
All vehicles
1. NOTE: 6R75 transmission selector lever shown, 6HP26 similar.
Remove the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5383
2. Remove the screw and the console upper trim.
3. Remove and discard the RH selector lever knob cover.
1 Start at the bottom rear only.
2 Work towards the top.
4. Remove and discard the LH selector lever knob cover.
1 Start at the bottom rear only.
2 Work towards the top.
5. Remove and discard the RH selector lever knob screw.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5384
6. Remove and discard the LH selector lever knob screw.
7. Disconnect the transmission control (TC) switch electrical connector and remove the selector
lever knob.
8. Lift the tabs on the selector lever bezel and lift the bezel for access to the electrical harness.
9. Disconnect the electrical harness from the selector lever housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5385
Vehicles equipped with a 6R75 transmission
10. Disconnect the electrical harness from the bezel.
Installation
Vehicles equipped with a 6R75 transmission
1. Connect the electrical harness onto the bezel.
All vehicles
2. Connect the electrical harness onto the selector lever housing.
3. Align the brake shift interlock override tab into its guide.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5386
4. Install the selector lever bezel onto the selector lever housing.
5. Connect the transmission control (TC) switch electrical connector and install the selector lever
knob.
6. Install a new LH selector lever knob screw.
^ tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
7. Install a new RH selector lever knob screw.
^ Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5387
8. NOTE: Wood trimmed vehicles have a rubber damper not found on other trim levels.
Install a new LH selector lever knob cover.
9. NOTE: Wood trimmed vehicles have a rubber damper not found on other trim levels.
Install a new RH selector lever knob cover.
10. Install the console upper trim and the screw.
11. Install the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5388
12. Verify brake shift interlock function.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5389
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever - Column Shift
Selector Lever - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower steering column shroud.
1 Remove the screws and the lower steering column shroud.
2. Remove the upper steering column shroud. 3. Disconnect the electrical connector and the
harness from the retaining clips.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5390
4. Remove the selector lever bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
5. Remove the selector lever.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5391
Shifter A/T: Service and Repair Selector Lever - Floor Shift
Selector Lever - Floor Shift
Vehicles Equipped With a 6R75 Transmission
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5392
Vehicles Equipped With a 6HP26 Transmission
Removal
Vehicles equipped with a 6R75 transmission
1. Remove the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5393
2. Remove the screw and the console upper trim.
3. NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever. 1
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever arm ball stud.
2 Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever housing.
4. Disconnect the selector lever electrical connector.
5. NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Remove the bolts and lift the selector lever out of the console.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5394
Vehicles equipped with a 6HP26 transmission
6. Remove the selector lever trim plate.
7. NOTE: Using a suitable tool, lift and remove the floor console upper panel from the rear.
Remove the floor console upper panel.
8. NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever arm ball stud.
9. Remove the center console LH kick panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5395
10. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever housing.
11. Disconnect the selector lever electrical connector.
12. NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Remove the bolts and lift the selector lever out of the console.
Installation
Vehicles equipped with a 6R75 transmission
1. NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Install the sector lever into the console.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5396
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2. Connect the selector lever electrical connector.
3. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever. 1
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever housing.
2 Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever arm ball stud. ^
Listen for the audible click.
^ Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
4. Install the console upper trim and the screw.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5397
5. Install the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Vehicles equipped with a 6HP26 transmission
6. NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Install the selector lever into the console. ^
Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
7. Connect the selector lever electrical connector.
8. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5398
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever housing.
9. Install the center console LH kick panel.
10. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever arm ball stud. ^
Listen for the audible click.
^ Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
11. Install the floor console upper panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Mechanism > Page 5399
12. Install the selector lever trim plate.
All vehicles
13. Adjust the selector lever cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments
Shift Cable: Adjustments
Selector Lever Cable Adjustment
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Place the selector lever in the
DRIVE position. 3. If equipped, remove the heat shield.
4. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the manual control lever.
5. NOTE: Make sure the cable moves freely.
Unlock the lock tab on the selector lever cable.
6. Place the manual control lever in the DRIVE position.
^ Place the manual control lever in the 1st gear position.
^ Move the manual control lever 3 detents to the DRIVE position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 5404
7. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
NOTE: Apply pressure to the selector lever cable end while connecting it to the manual lever to
make sure the selector lever has not moved out of the DRIVE position.
Connect the selector lever cable to the manual control lever. ^
Listen for the audible click.
^ Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure it is correctly installed.
8. Lock the selector lever cable lock tab.
9. If equipped, install the heat shield.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 5405
10. Carefully move the manual control lever from detent to detent and compare with transmission
settings. Verify that the vehicle will start in PARK
or NEUTRAL and backup lamps illuminate in REVERSE. If not, Steps 1 through 9 must be
repeated. ^
Readjust if necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift
Shift Cable: Service and Repair Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift
Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5408
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the instrument panel lower finish
panel.
3. Remove the hood release cable lever.
4. Remove the instrument panel lower reinforcement panel.
5. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
1 Remove the screws and the lower shroud.
6. NOTE: To prevent cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable assembly
between the steering column selector lever arm and the
steering column bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5409
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the steering column. 1
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever arm ball stud.
2 Carefully lift the locking tab and disconnect the selector lever cable from the steering column
bracket.
3 Disconnect the selector lever cable retainer.
7. Push the rubber grommet and selector lever cable down through the floor panel.
8. If equipped, remove the heat shield.
9. NOTE: To prevent selector lever cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable
between the manual control lever and the selector
lever cable bracket.
Move the locking tab up and disconnect the selector lever cable from the manual control lever.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5410
10. Remove the selector lever cable clip to release the selector lever cable from the bracket.
11. Remove the bolts and the selector lever cable bracket from the transmission.
Installation
1. Install the selector lever cable bracket and bolts onto the transmission.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
2. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
NOTE: To prevent selector lever cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable
between the manual control lever and the selector lever cable bracket.
Install the selector lever cable into the bracket and install the clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5411
3. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the manual control lever and move the locking tab down. ^
Listen for the audible click.
^ Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
4. If equipped, install the heat shield.
5. Push the selector lever cable and rubber grommet up through the floor panel.
6. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5412
cable to make sure that it is locked into the bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable
end is correctly installed onto the ball stud. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that
the cable end is correctly installed.
NOTE: To prevent cable damage, do not apply force to the selector lever cable assembly between
the steering column selector lever arm and the steering column bracket.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the steering column. 1
Connect the selector lever cable retainer.
2 Connect the selector lever cable onto the steering column bracket.
3 Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever arm ball stud.
^ Listen for the audible click.
^ Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
7. Install the steering column lower shroud.
1 Install the lower shroud.
8. Install the instrument panel lower reinforcement panel.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
9. Install the hood release cable lever.
^ Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5413
10. Install the instrument panel lower finish panel.
11. Adjust the selector lever cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5414
Shift Cable: Service and Repair Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Floor Shift
Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Floor Shift
Removal
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Vehicles equipped with a 6R75 transmission
2. Remove the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5415
3. Remove the screw and the console upper trim.
4. NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever. 1
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever arm ball stud.
2 Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever housing.
Vehicles equipped with a 6HP26 transmission
5. Remove the selector lever trim plate.
6. NOTE: Using a suitable tool, lift and remove the floor console upper panel from the rear.
Remove the floor console upper panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5416
7. NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever arm ball stud.
8. Remove the center console LH kick panel.
9. Disconnect the selector lever cable from the selector lever housing.
All vehicles
10. Remove the selector lever cable and grommet.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5417
11. If equipped, remove the heat shield.
12. Move the locking tab up and disconnect the selector lever cable from the manual control lever
ball stud.
13. Remove the selector lever cable clip to release the selector lever cable from the bracket.
14. Remove the bolts and the selector lever cable bracket from the transmission.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5418
Installation
All vehicles
1. Install the selector lever cable bracket and bolts onto the transmission.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
2. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
Install the selector lever cable into the bracket and install the clip.
3. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the manual control lever ball stud and move the locking tab
down. ^
Listen for the audible click.
^ Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5419
4. If equipped, install the heat shield.
5. Install the selector lever cable and grommet.
Vehicles equipped with a 6R75 transmission
6. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever. 1
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever housing.
2 Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever arm ball stud. ^
Listen for the audible click.
^ Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5420
7. Install the console upper trim and the screw.
8. Install the PRNDL trim, console tray and cup holder insert.
Vehicles equipped with a 6HP26 transmission
9. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever housing.
10. Install the center console LH kick panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5421
11. NOTE: When installing the selector lever cable, make sure that the selector lever cable locking
tabs are locked in place and the cable end is
snapped onto the ball stud. Press the selector lever cable into the bracket and listen for the cable
to click into place. Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is locked into the
bracket. Also, make sure that the selector lever cable end is correctly installed onto the ball stud.
Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that the cable end is correctly installed.
NOTE: Selector lever bezel removed for clarity.
Connect the selector lever cable onto the selector lever arm ball stud. ^
Listen for the audible click.
^ Pull back on the selector lever cable to make sure that it is correctly installed.
12. Install the floor console upper panel.
13. Install the selector lever trim plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T > Shift
Cable, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Selector Lever Cable and Bracket - Column Shift > Page 5422
All vehicles
14. Adjust the selector lever cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5427
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5428
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5429
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5430
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5431
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5432
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5433
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5434
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5435
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5436
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5437
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5438
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5439
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5440
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5441
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5442
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Position
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5443
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter: Description and Operation 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter
The torque converter is a 3-element unit containing a dual-plate clutch. The clutch can be
controlled and engaged in any gear 1st to 6th. Calibration parameters may be set to allow lock-up
in a higher gear only. The clutch is applied by removing fluid pressure from one side of the plate.
The torque converter transmits and multiplies torque. The torque converter includes the following 3
elements: ^
Impeller assembly
^ Turbine assembly
^ Reactor assembly
The standard torque converter components operate as follows: ^
Rotation of the converter housing and impeller set the fluid in motion.
^ The turbine reacts to the fluid motion from the impeller, transferring rotation to the geartrain
through the input shaft.
^ The reactor redirects fluid going back into the impeller, allowing for torque multiplication.
^ Power is transmitted from the torque converter to the planetary gearsets and other components
through the input shaft.
Torque Converter Clutch
The torque converter clutch is a device that reduces slip in the torque converter and, therefore,
helps to keep fuel consumption to a minimum.
The torque converter clutch is engaged and released by the control system.
Pressure at the torque converter clutch piston is determined by an electronic pressure control
valve.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Description and Operation > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5448
Torque Converter: Description and Operation 6R75 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter
The torque converter is a 3-element unit containing a 3-plate clutch. The clutch can be controlled
and engaged in any gear 2 to 6. Calibration parameters may be set to allow lockup in a higher gear
only. The clutch is applied by removing fluid pressure from one side of the plate. The torque
converter transmits and multiplies torque. The torque converter includes the following 3 elements: ^
Impeller assembly
^ Turbine assembly
^ Reactor assembly
The standard torque converter components operate as follows: ^
Rotation of the converter housing and impeller set the fluid in motion.
^ The turbine reacts to the fluid motion from the impeller, transferring rotation to the geartrain
through the input shaft.
^ The reactor redirects fluid going back into the impeller, allowing for torque multiplication.
^ Power is transmitted from the torque converter to the planetary gearsets and other components
through the input shaft.
Torque Converter Clutch
The torque converter clutch is a device that reduces slip in the torque converter and, therefore,
helps to keep fuel consumption to a minimum.
The torque converter clutch is engaged and released by the control system.
Pressure at the torque converter clutch piston is determined by an electronic pressure control
valve.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection Torque Converter Diagnosis
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter Diagnosis
Prior to torque converter installation, all diagnostic procedures must be followed. This is to prevent
the unnecessary installation of good torque converters. Only after a complete diagnostic evaluation
can the decision be made to install a new torque converter.
Begin with the normal diagnostic procedures as follows: 1. Preliminary inspection. 2. Know and
understand the customer's concern. 3. Verify the condition - carry out the torque converter
operation test. 4. Carry out diagnostic procedures.
^ Carry out On-Board Diagnostics. Repair all non-transmission related diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) first.
- Repair all transmission DTCs.
- Rerun on-board diagnostic to verify repair.
^ Carry out Stall Speed Test.
^ Carry out Diagnostic Routines. Use the Diagnosis by Symptom to locate the appropriate routine that best describes the
symptom(s). The routine will list all possible components that may cause or contribute to the
symptom. Check each component listed; diagnose and repair as required before changing the
torque converter.
Torque Converter Operation Test
This test verifies that the torque converter clutch control system and the torque converter are
operating correctly. 1. Carry out Quick Test with scan tool. Check for DTCs. 2. Connect a
tachometer to the engine. 3. Bring the engine to normal operating temperature by driving the
vehicle at highway speeds for approximately 15 minutes in DRIVE position. 4. After normal
operating temperature is reached, maintain a constant speed of about 80 km/h (50 mph) and tap
the brake pedal with the left foot. 5. Engine rpm should increase when the brake pedal is tapped
and decrease about 5 seconds after the pedal is released. If this does not occur, see
Torque Converter Operation Concerns. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Diagnostic Routines/Torque Converter Clutch
Operation Concerns 240-242
6. If the vehicle stalls in DRIVE or at idle with the vehicle at a stop, move the transmission range
selector lever to the manual 1 position. If the
vehicle stalls, see Torque Converter Operation Concerns. See: Transmission Control
Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Diagnostic
Routines/Torque Converter Clutch Operation Concerns 240-242 If the vehicle does not stall in
DRIVE, refer to Diagnosis By Symptom. See: Transmission Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Diagnosis By Symptom
NOTE: The following is a list of common vehicle concerns that have been misdiagnosed as torque
converter clutch shudder.
^ Spark plugs - check for cracks, high resistance or broken insulators
^ Plug wires
^ Fuel injector - filter may be plugged
^ Fuel contamination - engine driveability concerns
^ Exhaust gas recirculation (EGR) valve - valve may let in too much exhaust gas and cause engine
to run lean
^ Vacuum leak - engine will not get correct air/fuel mixture
^ Manifold absolute pressure (MAP)/mass air flow (MAF) sensor - incorrect air/fuel mixture
^ Heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) - too rich/lean air/fuel mixture
^ Fuel pressure - may be too low
^ Engine mounts - loose/damaged mounts can cause vibration concerns
^ Axle joints - check for vibration
6R75 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter Diagnosis
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis > Page 5451
Special Tool(s)
Prior to torque converter installation, all diagnostic procedures must be followed. This is to prevent
the unnecessary installation of good torque converters. Only after a complete diagnostic evaluation
can the decision be made to install a new torque converter.
Begin with the normal diagnostic procedures as follows: 1. Preliminary inspection. 2. Know and
understand the customer's concern. 3. Verify the condition - carry out the torque converter
operation test. 4. Carry out diagnostic procedures.
^ Carry out On-Board Diagnostics. Repair all non-transmission related DTCs first.
- Repair all transmission-related DTCs.
- Rerun on-board diagnostics to verify repair.
^ Carry out Stall Speed Test.
^ Carry out Diagnostic Routines. Use the Diagnosis by Symptom to locate the appropriate routine that best describes the
symptom(s). The routine will list all possible components that may cause or contribute to the
symptom. Check each component listed; diagnose and repair as required before changing the
torque converter.
Torque Converter Operation Test
The Torque Converter Operation Test verifies that the torque converter clutch (TCC) control
system and the torque converter are operating correctly. 1. Carry out Quick Test with the scan tool.
Refer to Computers and Control Systems. Check for DTCs. 2. Connect a scan tool to the vehicle.
3. Bring the engine to normal operating temperature by driving the vehicle at highway speeds for
approximately 15 minutes in D position. 4. After normal operating temperature is reached, maintain
a constant speed of about 56 km/h (35 mph) in 5th gear for 10 seconds. 5. Release the accelerator
pedal and monitor the scan tool TP voltage to approximately 1.25 volts or 25 percent throttle. 6.
Monitor the TCC and engine speed PID. The TCC should release and engine rpms should increase
before the 5-4 shift occurs.
NOTE: The following is a list of common vehicle concerns that have been misdiagnosed as TCC
shudder.
^ Spark plugs - check for cracks, high resistance or broken insulators
^ Plug wires
^ Fuel injector - filter may be plugged
^ Fuel contamination - engine driveability concerns
^ Exhaust gas recirculation (EGR) valve - valve may let in too much exhaust gas and cause engine
to run lean
^ Vacuum leak - engine will not get correct air/fuel mixture
^ Manifold absolute pressure (MAP)/mass air flow (MAF) sensor - incorrect air/fuel mixture
^ Heated oxygen sensor (HO2S) - too rich/lean air/fuel mixture
^ Fuel pressure - may be too low
^ Engine mounts - loose/damaged mounts can cause vibration concerns
^ Axle joints - check for vibration
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis > Page 5452
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection Torque Converter
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter
1. A new or remanufactured torque converter must be installed if one or more of the following
statements is true:
^ A torque converter malfunction has been determined based on complete diagnostic procedures.
^ Converter stud or studs, impeller hub or bushing are damaged.
^ Discoloration (due to overheating).
^ Evidence of transmission assembly or fluid contamination due to the following transmission or
converter failure modes: Major metallic failure.
- Multiple clutches or clutch plate failures.
- Sufficient component wear which results in metallic contamination.
- Internal torque converter contamination present.
6R75 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter
1. A new or remanufactured torque converter must be installed if one or more of the following
statements is true:
^ A torque converter malfunction has been determined based on complete diagnostic procedures.
^ Converter rivets, impeller hub or bushing are damaged.
^ Discoloration (due to overheating).
^ Evidence of transmission assembly or fluid contamination due to the following transmission or
converter failure modes: Major metallic failure.
- Multiple clutches or clutch plate failures.
- Sufficient component wear which results in metallic contamination.
- Internal torque converter contamination present.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis > Page 5453
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection Stall Speed
Stall Speed
Stall Speed
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Torque Converter Diagnosis > Page 5454
Torque Converter: Testing and Inspection Torque Converter Contamination Inspection
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter Contamination Inspection
Material
CAUTION: Do not use water-based cleaners or mineral spirits to clean or flush the torque converter
or transmission, damage will occur. Use only clean automatic transmission fluid designated for the
transmission and converter being serviced.
1. If a new or remanufactured torque converter is not being installed, the following steps must be
completed. 2. With the torque converter on a bench, pour a small amount of transmission fluid from
the torque converter onto an absorbent white tissue or
through a paper filter and examine the fluid.
3. NOTE: The factory fill fluid is clear, the exchange fluid will be red.
Observe the color and odor of the fluid. The fluid should be clear or red, not brown or black. Odor
may indicate an overheating condition such as clutch disc or band failure.
4. Examine the stain on the tissue for evidence of particles (specks of any kind). Examine the fluid
level indicator for signs of antifreeze (gum or
varnish). If particles are present in the fluid, a new torque converter must be installed.
5. If there are no particles or contamination present, drain the remainder of the transmission fluid
from the torque converter. 6. Add 1.9 liter (2 quarts) of clean automatic transmission fluid into the
converter and agitate by hand. 7. Thoroughly drain the fluid.
6R75 Automatic Transmission
Torque Converter Contamination Inspection
Material
CAUTION: Do not use water-based cleaners or mineral spirits to clean or flush the torque converter
or transmission, damage will occur. Use only clean automatic transmission fluid designated for the
transmission and converter being serviced.
1. If a new or remanufactured torque converter is not being installed, the following steps must be
completed. 2. With the torque converter on a bench, pour a small amount of transmission fluid from
the torque converter onto an absorbent white tissue or
through a paper filter and examine the fluid.
3. Observe the color and odor of the fluid. The fluid should be red, not brown or black. Odor may
indicate an overheating condition such as clutch
disc or band failure.
4. Examine the stain on the tissue for evidence of particles (specks of any kind). Examine the fluid
level indicator for signs of antifreeze (gum or
varnish). If particles are present in the fluid, a new torque converter must be installed.
5. If there are no particles or contamination present, drain the remainder of the transmission fluid
from the torque converter. 6. Add 1.9L (2 qt) of clean automatic transmission fluid into the converter
and agitate by hand. 7. Thoroughly drain the fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5459
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5460
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5461
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5462
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5463
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5464
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5465
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5466
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5467
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5468
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5469
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5470
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5471
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5472
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5473
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5474
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter Clutch
Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5475
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications
General Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > General Specifications > Page 5480
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Transmission Cooler: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
CAUTION: When internal wear or damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles, clutch plate
material and band material can travel into the torque converter, the fluid cooler tubes, the in-tank
transmission fluid cooler and the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler, if so equipped. These
contaminants are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent future concerns,
remove these contaminants from the cooling system before placing the transmission back into use.
1. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical damage, incorrect component installation and
system leaks. Repair as necessary.
^ Install a new or remanufactured radiator when fluid is found leaking from the in-tank transmission
fluid cooler.
^ Install a new O-ring when transmission fluid is found leaking between the radiator transmission oil
cooler and the transmission oil cooler fitting (not the cooler line into the fitting).
^ Install a new auxiliary transmission fluid cooler if there is leakage from the fluid cooler.
2. If the fault is not visually evident, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 5483
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 5484
Transmission Cooler: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler
CAUTION: Whenever a transmission has been disassembled to install new parts, the transmission
fluid cooler and transmission fluid cooler tubes must be cleaned and backflushed. Use a torque
converter/oil cooler cleaner.
NOTE: Cleaning and backflushing the transmission fluid cooling system, along with following all the
normal cleaning and inspection procedures during disassembly and reassembly, will keep
contaminants from entering the transmission, causing a repeat repair.
When internal wear or damage has occurred in the transmission, metal particles, clutch plate
material or band material may have been carried into the torque converter and transmission fluid
cooler. These contaminants are a major cause of recurring transmission troubles and must be
removed from the system before the transmission is put back into use.
6R75 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler
CAUTION: Whenever a transmission has been disassembled to install new parts, the transmission
fluid cooler and transmission fluid cooler tubes must be cleaned and backflushed. Use a torque
converter/oil cooler cleaner.
NOTE: Cleaning and backflushing the transmission fluid cooling system, along with following all the
normal cleaning and inspection procedures during disassembly and reassembly, will keep
contaminants from entering the transmission, causing a repeat repair.
When internal wear or damage has occurred in the transmission, metal particles, clutch plate
material or band material may have been carried into the torque converter and transmission fluid
cooler. These contaminants are a major cause of recurring transmission troubles and must be
removed from the system before the transmission is put back into use.
Transmission Fluid Cooler Leaks at Radiator
Transmission Fluid Cooler Leaks at Radiator
Transmission fluid may leak between the radiator transmission fluid cooler and the transmission
fluid cooler fitting (not the cooler line into the fitting), which may result in a residue of transmission
fluid on the radiator tank around the fluid cooler fitting. The in-tank transmission fluid cooler is not
serviceable. If installation of a new transmission fluid cooler is required, refer to Cooling System.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Transmission Cooler: Procedures
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler - Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
CAUTION: When internal damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch plate
material can travel into the torque converter and the transmission fluid cooler. These contaminates
are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent further concerns, remove these
contaminates from the cooler lines and install a new cooler before placing the transmission in use.
1. Install a new transmission fluid cooler if any fluid leaks are indicated or a major metallic failure is
indicated. 2. Using a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner, flush the fluid cooler and lines.
3. NOTE: Rubber hoses must be attached to the ends of the fluid cooler tubes, to aid in connecting
them to the fluid cooler cleaner.
Connect the cleaner pressure and return lines appropriately. 1
Connect the pressure line to the fluid cooler inlet tube.
2 Connect the return line to the fluid cooler outlet tube.
3 Place the outlet end of the return line in the fluid tank reservoir.
4. NOTE: Cycling the fluid pump on and off will help dislodge contaminants in the cooler system.
Switch the fluid pumps on. Allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes.
5. Switch the fluid pump off. 6. Disconnect the cleaner pressure line at the fluid cooler tube. 7.
Using compressed air, blow through the fluid cooler inlet tube until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove
the rubber hoses from the fluid cooler tubes.
6R75 Automatic Transmission
Transmission Fluid Cooler - Backflushing and Cleaning
Material
CAUTION: When internal damage occurs in the transmission, metal particles and clutch plate
material can travel into the torque converter and the transmission fluid cooler. These contaminates
are a major cause of recurring transmission concerns. To prevent further concerns, remove these
contaminates from the cooler lines and install a new cooler before placing the transmission in use.
1. Install a new transmission fluid cooler if any fluid leaks are indicated or a major metallic failure is
indicated. 2. Using a suitable torque converter/fluid cooler cleaner, flush the fluid cooler and lines.
3. NOTE: Rubber hoses must be attached to the ends of the fluid cooler tubes, to aid in connecting
them to the cleaner.
Connect the cleaner pressure and return lines appropriately. 1
Connect the pressure line to the fluid cooler inlet tube.
2 Connect the return line to the fluid cooler outlet tube.
3 Place the outlet end of the return line in the fluid tank reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5487
4. NOTE: Cycling the fluid pump ON and OFF will help dislodge contaminants in the cooler system.
Switch the fluid pumps ON. Allow the fluid to circulate a minimum of 5 minutes.
5. Switch the fluid pump OFF. 6. Disconnect the cleaner pressure line at the fluid cooler tube. 7.
Using compressed air, blow through the fluid cooler inlet tube until all fluid is removed. 8. Remove
the rubber hoses from the fluid cooler tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5488
Transmission Cooler: Removal and Replacement
Auxiliary Transmission Fluid Cooler
Removal
1. Remove the upper radiator cover.
1 Remove the fasteners.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 5489
2. Remove and discard the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose clamp. 3. Disconnect the
auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose from the cooler. 4. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL,
position it on a hoist. 5. Move the flexible air deflector aside, then remove and discard the auxiliary
transmission fluid cooler outlet hose clamp. 6. Disconnect the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler
outlet hose from the cooler. 7. Remove the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler.
Installation
1. Install the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler. 2. Connect the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler
outlet hose to the cooler. 3. Install a new auxiliary transmission fluid cooler outlet hose clamp, then
move the flexible air deflector back into place. 4. Connect the auxiliary transmission fluid cooler
inlet hose to the cooler. 5. Install a new auxiliary transmission fluid cooler inlet hose clamp. 6.
Install the upper radiator cover.
1 Install the fasteners.
7. Fill the transmission with fluid and verify correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode
Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5498
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5499
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5500
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5501
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5502
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5503
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5504
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5505
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5506
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5507
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5508
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5509
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5510
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5511
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5512
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5513
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5514
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5515
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5516
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (TC) switch is not replaceable. If a new TC switch is required,
install a new transmission selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mode Switch,
A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift > Page 5519
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (+/-) switch is not serviced. If a new switch is required, install a
new selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5524
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5525
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5526
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5527
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5528
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5529
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5530
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5531
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5532
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5533
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5534
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5535
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5536
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5537
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5538
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5540
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Pressure Test
Port, A/T > Component Information > Locations > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Air Pressure Test
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Pressure Test
Port, A/T > Component Information > Locations > 6HP26 Automatic Transmission > Page 5545
Air Pressure Test
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5550
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5551
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5552
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5553
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5554
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5555
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5556
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5557
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5558
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5559
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5560
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5561
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5562
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5563
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5564
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5565
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Speed
Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5566
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5571
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5572
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5573
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5574
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5575
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5576
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5577
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5578
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5579
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5580
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5581
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5582
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5583
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5584
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5585
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5586
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Temperature
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5587
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Body: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Valve Body: Customer Interest A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Body: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10 > A/T Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 5596
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Body: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Valve Body: Customer Interest A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Body: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5601
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Body: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5602
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Valve Body: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5603
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10
> A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735
TSB 10-18-1
09/27/10
5.4L WITH 6R75/6R80 - DELAYED FORWARD/REVERSE ENGAGEMENT - DTCS P0741,
P0731, AND/OR P0735 - AFTER COLD START
FORD: 2007-2010 Expedition 2009-2010 F-150
LINCOLN: 2009-2010 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2010 Expedition, 2009-2010 Navigator and F-150 vehicles equipped with a
5.4L engine and a 6R75/6R80 transmission may exhibit delayed forward/reverse engagement.
Diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) P0741, P0731, and/or P0735 for torque converter and/or gear
ratio concerns may be stored in the powertrain control module (PCM). This concern typically occurs
after cold start and in colder climates.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the mechatronic assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Inspect the fluid pump adapter seal molded frame for evidence of cracks, which are most often
found in the corner(s) of the molded frame.
a. If evidence of cracks are present, proceed to Step 3.
b. If evidence of cracks are not present, do not continue with this article. Refer to WSM Section
307-01 for further diagnostics.
3. Partially disassemble the mechatronic assembly to access only the main oil pressure regulator
valve located in the lower half. Refer to WSM, Section
307-01.
4. Inspect the main oil pressure regulator valve for free movement in its bore.
a. If the valve moves easily in the bore, proceed to Step 5.
b. If the valve does not move or sticks, remove the valve and clean both the valve and bore,
reinstall the valve. Proceed to Step 5.
5. Reassemble the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
6. Install a new front pump adapter seal.
7. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly. Refer to WSM, Section 307-01.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
101801A 2007-2010 Expedition, 2.7 Hrs.
2009-2010 F-150,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 10-18-1 > Sep > 10
> A/T - Delayed Engagement/DTC's P0741/P0731/P0735 > Page 5609
Navigator: Follow Service Procedure To Repair Mechatronic Includes Time To Remove And Install
The Mechatronic And Reprogram (Do Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7F401 01
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07
> A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Valve Body: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07
> A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5614
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07
> A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5615
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Valve Body: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07
> A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5616
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5617
Check Ball Location
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5618
Valve Body: Diagrams
Mechatronic Assembly Exploded Views
Mechatronic
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5619
Mechatronic Upper Half
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5620
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5621
Mechatronic Lower Half
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5622
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5623
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Valve Body: Removal and Replacement
6HP26 Automatic Transmission
Main Control Valve Body
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pull on the wire harness to disconnect the connector or damage to the
connector will occur.
Disconnect the main transmission electrical harness by twisting the outer shell and pulling back on
the connector.
3. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the fluid to drain.
4. Remove the fluid pan gasket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5626
5. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
6. Clean and inspect the transmission fluid pan and magnet.
7. Press the release tab and pull down on the bulkhead connector retainer.
8. With the release tab down, pull the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5627
9. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins. Electrostatic charge may occur and will
cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Pull the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector out of the transmission.
10. NOTE: During removal of the mechatronic assembly, the thermal bypass valve, pump adapter
seal and one or more center support seals may
become dislodged. Save these components for reuse during assembly.
Remove the 10 bolts from the mechatronic assembly and remove the mechatronic assembly.
Installation
1. NOTE: Before installing the mechatronic assembly into the transmission case, verify presence
and correct orientation of the thermal bypass valve,
pump adapter seal and center support seals. Also note that one or more of the center support seals
may have remained in the mechatronic assembly during removal and should be installed into the
transmission case at this time.
Verify the 4 rubber feed tubes for the center support are in place.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5628
2. Verify the thermal bypass valve is in the case.
3. Verify the rubber adapter is in place.
4. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the
transmission control module (TCM).
Electrostatic discharge may occur and may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Position the mechatronic assembly in place and loosely install the 10 bolts. 1
Align the manual valve and control lever linkage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5629
5. Tighten the mechatronic bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
6. Install new O-rings seals on the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector.!
7. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins. Electrostatic charge may occur and will
cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down, push the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector into the
transmission.
8. Press up on the tab and lock the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector in place.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5630
9. Install a new transmission fluid filter.
10. Install the fluid pan gasket.
11. Install the fluid pan and bolts.
^ Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
12. Connect the main transmission electrical harness by pushing it in and twisting the outer shell to
lock it in place.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5631
13. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during
this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Remove the fluid fill plug located on the RH rear side of the case near the transmission electrical
connector.
14. CAUTION: The use of any other transmission fluid than specified can result in the transmission
failing to operate correctly or
transmission failure.
CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust
and the heat shields.
Fill the transmission. ^
Add 4.7 liters (5 quarts) of clean automatic transmission fluid to the transmission through the fluid
fill hole. Stop when the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
15. Start the engine. Move the transmission range selector lever through all the gear ranges,
checking for engagements. 16. With the special tool connected, the engine idling (550-750 rpm) in
PARK and the transmission temperature at 30°C-50°C (86°F-122°F), check
and adjust the transmission fluid level.
17. CAUTION: The fluid fill plug located on the side of the transmission is near the exhaust system.
The exhaust will be extremely hot during
this procedure. Use care when working near the exhaust and the heat shields.
Fill with clean automatic transmission fluid until the fluid runs out of the bottom of the hole.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5632
18. Install the fluid fill plug.
^ Tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
6R75 Automatic Transmission
Mechatronic Assembly
Removal
NOTE: If a new or the existing mechatronic assembly is installed, the transmission control module
(TCM) will need to be reflashed to the latest level calibration available.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not pull on the wire harness to disconnect the connector or damage to the
connector will occur.
Disconnect the main transmission electrical harness by twisting the outer shell and pulling back on
the connector.
3. Remove the fluid fill plug fluid level indicator assembly located on the passenger side front
portion of the transmission case. Removal of the plug
will relieve any vacuum that might have built up in the transmission. This will aid in allowing the
fluid pan to be easily removed when the bolts are removed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5633
4. Remove the transmission fluid pan and allow the fluid to drain.
5. Remove the fluid pan gasket.
6. Remove and discard the transmission fluid filter.
7. Pull the release tab and pull down on the bulkhead connector retainer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5634
8. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the TCM.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and
may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down, pull the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector out of the TCM.
9. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the TCM.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and
may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Pull the bulkhead electrical connector out of the transmission.
10. Remove the 11 bolts from the mechatronic assembly and remove the mechatronic assembly.
Installation
1. NOTE: Before installing the mechatronic assembly into the transmission case, verify presence
and correct orientation of the thermal bypass valve,
pump adapter seal and center support seals. Also note that one or more of the center support seals
may have remained in the mechatronic assembly
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5635
during removal and should be installed into the transmission case at this time.
Verify the 4 rubber feed tubes for the center support are in place. 1
Black feed tube.
2 Green feed tube.
3 Blue feed tube.
2. Verify the rubber adapter is in place.
3. Verify the thermal bypass valve is in the case.
4. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the TCM.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and
may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
Position the mechatronic assembly in place and loosely install the 11 bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5636
1 Align the manual valve and control lever linkage.
5. Tighten the mechatronic bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the TCM.
Electrostatic discharge may occur and
may cause damage to the mechatronic unit.
With the release tab down and unlocked, push the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector
into the transmission. Make sure that the bulkhead connector is fully seated into the TCM.
7. Press up on the tab and lock the outer shell of the bulkhead electrical connector in place. Make
sure that the locking tab is securely locked.
8. Install a new transmission fluid filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5637
9. NOTE: The fluid pan gasket can be reused if not damaged.
Install the transmission fluid pan gasket if required.
10. Install the fluid pan and tighten the bolts in a crisscross pattern.
^ Tighten to 14 Nm (10 lb-ft).
11. Connect the main transmission electrical harness by pushing it in and twisting the outer shell to
lock it in place.
12. Using the refill procedure, fill and check the transmission fluid. 13. If a new or the existing
mechatronic assembly is installed, the TCM will need to be reflashed to the latest level calibration
available.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5638
Valve Body: Overhaul
Mechatronic Assembly
Mechatronic
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5639
Mechatronic Upper Half
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5640
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5641
Mechatronic Lower Half
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5642
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5643
Check Ball Location
Disassembly
CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the
transmission control module (TCM). An electrostatic discharge may occur and may cause damage
to the TCM/Mechatronic assembly.
NOTE: Make an identifying mark on each solenoid and the corresponding bore for correct
assembly.
NOTE: Solenoids may visually appear the same but their designs/functions are different. Caution
must be taken not to assemble the mechatronics assembly incorrectly. Incorrect solenoid
installation will result in poor transmission shift quality.
NOTE: Note where the 8 check balls, 6 solenoid dampers, 2 internal valves and springs and 2
internal filters are located for reassembly.
Mechatronic assembly upper half
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5644
1. Make an identifying mark on each solenoid and the corresponding bore for correct assembly.
2. Remove the 6 long bolts from the TCM unit.
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. 4. Remove 19 short bolts from the
mechatronic assembly.
5. Separate the lower half of the mechatronic assembly from the upper half of the mechatronic
assembly. 6. Remove and discard the separator plate.
7. Remove from the mechatronic assembly the clips, caps, valves and spring from each bore. Note
the location and order for reassembly. Refer to the
preceding exploded views.
8. Remove from the mechatronic assembly the transmission control valves, check balls and filter
screens. Note the location and order for reassembly.
Refer to the preceding exploded views.
9. Using clean mineral spirits, clean the upper half of the mechatronic assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5645
Mechatronic assembly lower half
10. Remove the 8 solenoid bracket bolts and the solenoid bracket.
11. Remove the solenoids.
12. Remove from the mechatronic assembly the clips, caps, valves and spring from each bore.
Note the location and order for reassembly. Refer to the
preceding exploded views.
13. Using clean mineral spirits, clean the lower half of the mechatronic assembly.
Assembly
CAUTION: Do not touch the electrical connector pins or the exposed solenoid tabs on the TCM. An
electrostatic discharge may occur and may cause damage to the TCM/Mechatronic assembly.
Mechatronic assembly upper half
1. NOTE: Many components and surfaces in the mechatronic valve body are precision machined.
Careful handling during disassembly, cleaning,
inspection and assembly will prevent unnecessary damage to machined surfaces.
Install the clips, caps, valves and spring into each bore. Refer to the preceding exploded views.
Mechatronic assembly lower half
2. NOTE: Many components and surfaces in the mechatronic valve body are precision machined.
Careful handling during disassembly, cleaning,
inspection and assembly will prevent unnecessary damage to machined surfaces.
Install the clips, caps, valves and spring into each bore.
3. NOTE: Lubricate the O-ring seals of the solenoids with clean automatic transmission fluid when
installing them into the valve body.
Install the solenoids into their correct bores as indicated during disassembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5646
4. Install the solenoid bracket and the 8 bolts.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
5. Install into the mechatronic assembly the transmission control valves, check balls and filter
screens. Refer to the preceding exploded views. 6. Install a new separator plate.
7. Assemble the lower half and the upper half of the mechatronic assembly. 8. Install the 19 short
bolts into the mechatronic assembly. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
9. Carefully install the TCM onto the mechatronic assembly.
10. Install the 6 long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten the bolts in the sequence shown.
^ Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5647
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Differential: Capacity Specifications
Differential Oil Capacity
FRONT AXLE ......................................................................................................................................
................................. 3.5 - 3.7 pints (1.8 - 2.0 liters)
REAR AXLE Conventional differential .................................................................................................
..................................................................... 4.5 pints (2.13 liters) Limited-slip differential .................
..................................................................................................................................................... 4.25
pints (2.01 liters)
NOTE: Your vehicles rear axle is filled with a synthetic rear axle lubricant and is considered
lubricated for life. These lubricants are not to be checked or changed unless a leak is suspected,
service is required or the axle has been submerged in water. The axle lubricant should be changed
any time the axle has been submerged in water.
NOTE: Add 4 oz. (118 ml) of Additive Friction Modifier XL-3 (or equivalent) for complete refill of
Ford Limited Slip axles.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Fluid - Differential > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 5653
Fluid - Differential: Fluid Type Specifications
Differential Fluid Type
REAR AXLE Motorcraft SAE 75W-140 Synthetic Rear Axle Lube Ford P/N ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
. XY-75W140-QL Ford Specification ...................................................................................................
................................................................................... WSL-M2C192-A
FRONT AXLE Motorcraft SAE 80W-90 Premium Rear Axle Lube Ford P/N ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... XY-80W90-QL Ford Specification ...................................................................................................
................................................................................... WSP-M2C197-A
NOTE: Add 4.0 oz. (118 ml) of Additive Friction Modifier XL-3 or equivalent for complete refill of
Ford Limited Slip rear axles.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Differential Output Shaft Bearing: Service and Repair Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
NOTE: The stub shaft seals must be replaced whenever the halfshafts are removed.
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly.
2. NOTE: If removing the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal only, engage the tangs of the special tool
on the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
Using the special tools, remove and discard the stub shaft pilot bearing and the stub shaft pilot
bearing oil seal. 1
Firmly engage the tangs of the special tool on the stub shaft pilot bearing.
2 Remove and discard the bearing and the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5659
3. Inspect the seal journal for rust, nicks and scratches. Polish the seal journal surface with fine
crocus cloth, if necessary. 4. Lubricate the new stub shaft pilot bearing with axle lubricant.
5. CAUTION: Installation of the stub shaft pilot bearing or stub shaft oil seal without the correct
tools can result in early bearing or seal
failure. If the stub shaft pilot bearing becomes cocked in the bore during installation, remove it and
install a new one.
Place the stub shaft pilot bearing onto the special tools.
6. Install the stub shaft pilot bearing into the rear axle housing bore.
7. NOTE: Do not disassemble the new oil seal.
NOTE: Use a tool like the Lisle LIS 17850 to avoid interference with the suspension components.
Install the new seal onto a suitable installer.
8. Carefully align the stub shaft pilot bearing seal with the housing bore and install the stub shaft
pilot bearing seal flush in the differential housing.
^ Strike only the handle. Directly striking the installer tool will damage the seal.
9. NOTE: If a feeler gauge of the specification shown in the illustration can be inserted between the
stub shaft oil seal and the differential housing,
the stub shaft seal is not seated correctly. Remove the stub shaft oil seal and install a new stub
shaft oil seal.
Make sure the stub shaft oil seal is correctly seated in the differential housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5660
10. CAUTION: Inspect the stub shaft seal journal for rust, nicks or scratches prior to installing the
halfshaft. Polish the seal journal with fine
crocus cloth, if required.
Install the halfshaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5661
Differential Output Shaft Bearing: Service and Repair Front Drive Axle and Differential
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Special Tool(s)
Removal
NOTE: Install a new stub shaft seal whenever a halfshaft is removed.
1. Remove the front drive halfshafts. 2. Using the special tools, remove the intermediate shaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5662
3. Remove and discard the intermediate shaft circlip and O-ring.
4. Using a suitable seal remover, remove and discard the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal. 5. Using
the special tools, remove and discard the stub shaft pilot bearing.
Installation
1. Position the stub shaft pilot bearing in the axle tube or differential housing bore and using the
special tool, install the bearing.
2. Carefully align the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal with the housing bore and install the stub shaft
bearing oil seal flush in the housing using the
special tools.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Output Shaft, Differential > Differential
Output Shaft Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5663
3. Install a new O-ring and new circlips on the intermediate shaft ends.
4. Insert the intermediate shaft and engage the circlip with the differential side gear. 5. Install the
front drive halfshafts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Pinion Flange: Service and Repair Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Drive Pinion Flange and Drive Pinion Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
CAUTION: Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies, brake calipers and brake discs to prevent
brake drag during the drive pinion bearing preload adjustment.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH rear
quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5668
result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the
vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury
and vehicle damage.
NOTE: If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies.
3. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose. Provide a suitable
support.
Remove the rear brake calipers and the brake discs. Position the brake calipers aside.
4. Remove the rear driveshaft assembly. 5. Install a Nm (lb-in) torque wrench on the nut and record
the torque necessary to maintain rotation of the drive pinion gear through several
revolutions.
6. CAUTION: After removing the pinion nut, discard it. Use a new nut for installation.
Use the special tool to hold the pinion flange while removing the pinion nut.
7. Index-mark the drive pinion flange and the drive pinion gear stem to maintain initial balance
during installation.
8. Using the special tool, remove the drive pinion flange.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5669
9. Force up on the metal flange of the drive pinion seal. Install gripping pliers and strike with a
hammer until the pinion seal is removed.
Installation
1. Lubricate the lips of the new drive pinion seal with grease.
2. CAUTION: If the drive pinion seal becomes misaligned during installation, remove it and install a
new seal.
Using the special tool, install the drive pinion seal.
3. Lubricate the drive pinion flange splines with rear axle lubricant.
4. NOTE: Disregard the index marks if installing a new drive pinion flange.
Position the drive pinion flange.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5670
5. Using the special tool, install the drive pinion flange.
6. Position the new drive pinion nut.
7. CAUTION: Do not under any circumstance loosen the nut to reduce preload. If it is necessary to
reduce preload, install a new drive
pinion collapsible spacer and nut.
CAUTION: Remove the special tool while taking preload readings with the Nm (inch-pound) torque
wrench.
Use the special tool to hold the pinion flange while tightening the nut. ^
Rotate the pinion occasionally to make sure the pinion bearings seat correctly. Take frequent
pinion bearing torque preload readings by rotating the drive pinion gear with a Nm (lb-in) torque
wrench.
^ If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is lower than the specification for used bearings,
tighten the nut to specification. If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is higher than the
specification for used bearings, tighten the nut to the original reading as recorded.
^ Refer to the torque specification for used pinion bearings.
8. CAUTION: Install the driveshaft with new bolts. If new bolts are not available, apply sealer to the
threads of the original bolts.
CAUTION: Align the index marks.
CAUTION: The driveshaft flange yoke fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. To make sure that the
yoke seats squarely on the flange, tighten the bolts evenly in a cross pattern as shown.
Install the rear driveshaft.
9. Install the rear brake discs and the brake calipers.
10. Install the rear wheel and tire assemblies. 11. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5671
12. If equipped with air suspension, reactivate the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5672
Pinion Flange: Service and Repair Front Drive Axle and Differential
Drive Pinion Seal
Drive Pinion Seal
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. Remove the front axle universal joint flange.
2. CAUTION: Do not damage the front axle housing.
Force up on the metal flange of the rear axle drive pinion seal. Install gripping pliers and strike with
a hammer to remove the pinion seal.
Installation
1. Clean the pinion seal bore and use the Drive Pinion Oil Seal Installer to install the pinion seal.
2. Install the front axle universal joint flange.
Universal Joint Flange
Universal Joint Flange
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5673
Special Tool(s)
Material
Removal
CAUTION: This operation disturbs the pinion bearing preload. Carefully reset the preload during
assembly.
1. Position the vehicle on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Remove the front brake caliper to prevent drag during the drive pinion bearing
preload adjustment.
CAUTION: Do not allow the calipers to hang from the brake hoses.
Remove the front brake calipers. Wire the caliper aside.
3. Index-mark the front driveshaft to the axle universal joint flange.
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the driveshaft to hang unsupported.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5674
Disconnect and support the front driveshaft. ^
Remove and discard the 6 bolts and 3 washers.
^ Carefully disconnect and support the front driveshaft.
5. Using a Nm (inch/pound) torque wrench, measure the torque necessary to maintain pinion
rotation. Record the measurement for reference during
installation.
6. CAUTION: After removing the pinion nut, discard it. Use a new pinion nut for installation.
Install the special tool and remove the pinion nut.
7. Index-mark the axle universal joint flange to the pinion stem.
8. Using the special tool, separate the axle universal joint flange from the pinion gear.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5675
9. Remove the flange.
10. Inspect the axle universal joint flange for burrs, the nut counterbore and the seal contact
surface for nicks, and the bearing cone contact area for
damage. Install a new flange if necessary.
11. Check the pinion stem splines for burrs. If burrs are evident, remove them with a fine crocus
cloth.
Installation
1. Lubricate the axle universal joint flange splines and the pinion seal.
^ Use front axle lubricant.
2. CAUTION: Never install the axle universal joint flange with a hammer or power tools.
NOTE: Disregard the scribe marks if installing a new flange.
Align the index marks and position the axle universal joint flange on the pinion shaft.
3. NOTE: Rotate the pinion gear occasionally to make sure the pinion bearings seat correctly.
Using the special tool, install the axle universal joint flange.
4. CAUTION: Do not loosen the pinion nut to reduce preload under any circumstance. If it is
necessary to reduce preload, install a new
drive pinion collapsible spacer and pinion nut.
Install the special tool and tighten the pinion nut. Refer to the torque specifications for used
bearings. ^
Rotate the pinion gear occasionally to make sure the pinion bearings are seating correctly. Take
frequent pinion bearing torque preload readings by rotating the pinion gear with a Nm (inch/pound)
torque wrench.
^ If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is lower than the specification for used bearings, then
tighten the pinion nut to the specification. If
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Pinion Flange, Differential > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5676
the preload recorded prior to disassembly is higher than the specification for used bearings, then
tighten the pinion nut to the original reading as recorded.
5. Align the index marks then attach the front driveshaft.
6. Inspect and, if necessary, fill the differential.
^ Use rear axle lubricant.
7. Lower the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Rear Drive Axle/Differential
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Special Tool(s)
Material
NOTE: The stub shaft seals must be replaced whenever the halfshafts are removed.
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly.
2. NOTE: If removing the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal only, engage the tangs of the special tool
on the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
Using the special tools, remove and discard the stub shaft pilot bearing and the stub shaft pilot
bearing oil seal. 1
Firmly engage the tangs of the special tool on the stub shaft pilot bearing.
2 Remove and discard the bearing and the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5681
3. Inspect the seal journal for rust, nicks and scratches. Polish the seal journal surface with fine
crocus cloth, if necessary. 4. Lubricate the new stub shaft pilot bearing with axle lubricant.
5. CAUTION: Installation of the stub shaft pilot bearing or stub shaft oil seal without the correct
tools can result in early bearing or seal
failure. If the stub shaft pilot bearing becomes cocked in the bore during installation, remove it and
install a new one.
Place the stub shaft pilot bearing onto the special tools.
6. Install the stub shaft pilot bearing into the rear axle housing bore.
7. NOTE: Do not disassemble the new oil seal.
NOTE: Use a tool like the Lisle LIS 17850 to avoid interference with the suspension components.
Install the new seal onto a suitable installer.
8. Carefully align the stub shaft pilot bearing seal with the housing bore and install the stub shaft
pilot bearing seal flush in the differential housing.
^ Strike only the handle. Directly striking the installer tool will damage the seal.
9. NOTE: If a feeler gauge of the specification shown in the illustration can be inserted between the
stub shaft oil seal and the differential housing,
the stub shaft seal is not seated correctly. Remove the stub shaft oil seal and install a new stub
shaft oil seal.
Make sure the stub shaft oil seal is correctly seated in the differential housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5682
10. CAUTION: Inspect the stub shaft seal journal for rust, nicks or scratches prior to installing the
halfshaft. Polish the seal journal with fine
crocus cloth, if required.
Install the halfshaft.
Drive Pinion Flange and Drive Pinion Seal
Drive Pinion Flange and Drive Pinion Seal
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5683
Material
Removal
CAUTION: Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies, brake calipers and brake discs to prevent
brake drag during the drive pinion bearing preload adjustment.
1. WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension
vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air suspension switch located in the LH rear
quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs,
which can result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury and vehicle damage.
NOTE: If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist.
2. Remove the rear wheel and tire assemblies.
3. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang from the brake hose. Provide a suitable
support.
Remove the rear brake calipers and the brake discs. Position the brake calipers aside.
4. Remove the rear driveshaft assembly. 5. Install a Nm (lb-in) torque wrench on the nut and record
the torque necessary to maintain rotation of the drive pinion gear through several
revolutions.
6. CAUTION: After removing the pinion nut, discard it. Use a new nut for installation.
Use the special tool to hold the pinion flange while removing the pinion nut.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5684
7. Index-mark the drive pinion flange and the drive pinion gear stem to maintain initial balance
during installation.
8. Using the special tool, remove the drive pinion flange.
9. Force up on the metal flange of the drive pinion seal. Install gripping pliers and strike with a
hammer until the pinion seal is removed.
Installation
1. Lubricate the lips of the new drive pinion seal with grease.
2. CAUTION: If the drive pinion seal becomes misaligned during installation, remove it and install a
new seal.
Using the special tool, install the drive pinion seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5685
3. Lubricate the drive pinion flange splines with rear axle lubricant.
4. NOTE: Disregard the index marks if installing a new drive pinion flange.
Position the drive pinion flange.
5. Using the special tool, install the drive pinion flange.
6. Position the new drive pinion nut.
7. CAUTION: Do not under any circumstance loosen the nut to reduce preload. If it is necessary to
reduce preload, install a new drive
pinion collapsible spacer and nut.
CAUTION: Remove the special tool while taking preload readings with the Nm (inch-pound) torque
wrench.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5686
Use the special tool to hold the pinion flange while tightening the nut. ^
Rotate the pinion occasionally to make sure the pinion bearings seat correctly. Take frequent
pinion bearing torque preload readings by rotating the drive pinion gear with a Nm (lb-in) torque
wrench.
^ If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is lower than the specification for used bearings,
tighten the nut to specification. If the preload recorded prior to disassembly is higher than the
specification for used bearings, tighten the nut to the original reading as recorded.
^ Refer to the torque specification for used pinion bearings.
8. CAUTION: Install the driveshaft with new bolts. If new bolts are not available, apply sealer to the
threads of the original bolts.
CAUTION: Align the index marks.
CAUTION: The driveshaft flange yoke fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. To make sure that the
yoke seats squarely on the flange, tighten the bolts evenly in a cross pattern as shown.
Install the rear driveshaft.
9. Install the rear brake discs and the brake calipers.
10. Install the rear wheel and tire assemblies. 11. Lower the vehicle. 12. If equipped with air
suspension, reactivate the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5687
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair Front Drive Axle and Differential
Drive Pinion Seal
Drive Pinion Seal
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. Remove the front axle universal joint flange.
2. CAUTION: Do not damage the front axle housing.
Force up on the metal flange of the rear axle drive pinion seal. Install gripping pliers and strike with
a hammer to remove the pinion seal.
Installation
1. Clean the pinion seal bore and use the Drive Pinion Oil Seal Installer to install the pinion seal.
2. Install the front axle universal joint flange.
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Stub Shaft Pilot Bearing and Seal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5688
Special Tool(s)
Removal
NOTE: Install a new stub shaft seal whenever a halfshaft is removed.
1. Remove the front drive halfshafts. 2. Using the special tools, remove the intermediate shaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5689
3. Remove and discard the intermediate shaft circlip and O-ring.
4. Using a suitable seal remover, remove and discard the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal. 5. Using
the special tools, remove and discard the stub shaft pilot bearing.
Installation
1. Position the stub shaft pilot bearing in the axle tube or differential housing bore and using the
special tool, install the bearing.
2. Carefully align the stub shaft pilot bearing oil seal with the housing bore and install the stub shaft
bearing oil seal flush in the housing using the
special tools.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Differential Assembly > Seals and Gaskets, Differential > System
Information > Service and Repair > Rear Drive Axle/Differential > Page 5690
3. Install a new O-ring and new circlips on the intermediate shaft ends.
4. Insert the intermediate shaft and engage the circlip with the differential side gear. 5. Install the
front drive halfshafts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications
Axle Shaft Assembly: Mechanical Specifications
General Specifications
Torque Specifications
General Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 5696
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Specifications > Mechanical Specifications > Page 5697
Materials
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Drive Halfshafts
Axle Shaft Assembly: Description and Operation Front Drive Halfshafts
Front Drive Halfshafts
Front Wheel Halfshaft and Joint, Disassembled View
New halfshaft components are available as follows: ^
A repair kit includes the boots, clamps, snap ring, retaining ring and grease.
^ A new inboard constant velocity (CV) joint (plunge-type).
^ A new outboard CV joint and interconnecting shaft assembly includes the outboard front wheel
halfshaft joint (fixed-type), boot and clamps.
^ A new integrated wheel end disconnect assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Front Drive Halfshafts > Page 5700
Axle Shaft Assembly: Description and Operation Rear Drive Halfshafts
Rear Drive Halfshafts
^ The RH and LH halfshafts are different lengths, with the LH halfshaft being the longer of the 2.
^ Inboard and outboard CV joints connect to a splined shaft.
^ An axle circlip retains the splined inboard CV joint to the differential side gear. Install a new axle
circlip every time the halfshaft is removed from the vehicle.
^ A rear axle wheel hub retainer secures the side shaft assembly (interconnecting shaft and
outboard CV joint) to the rear hub. Install a new rear axle wheel hub retainer every time you
remove the halfshaft from the vehicle.
Halfshaft Handling
CAUTION: Never pick up or hold the halfshaft by the inboard or outboard CV joint only.
NOTE: Only the inner CV joints are removable for installation of new CV boots and clamps. The
boots and clamps are the only serviced parts of the halfshaft assembly.
Handle all halfshaft components carefully during removal and installation procedures. ^
The halfshaft assemblies are not repairable. Install new assemblies if worn/damaged.
^ To separate the halfshaft from the rear hub, press the outboard CV joint from the rear hub.
^ To separate the halfshaft from the differential, apply a load to the back face of the inboard CV
joint assembly to overcome the axle circlip.
^ Do not over-angle the CV joints.
^ Install new differential stub shaft seals whenever the halfshafts are removed.
^ Damage will occur to an assembled inboard CV joint if it is over-plunged outward from the joint
housing.
^ Never use a hammer to remove or install the halfshafts.
^ Never use the halfshaft assembly as a lever to position other components. Always support the
free end of the halfshaft.
^ Do not allow the boots to contact sharp edges or hot exhaust components.
^ Handle the halfshaft by the interconnecting shaft only to avoid pull-apart and potential damage to
the CV joints.
^ Do not drop assembled halfshafts. The impact can cut the boots from the inside without evidence
of external damage.
Wheel and Tire Balancing, Rear
WARNING: Do not balance the rear wheels and tires while mounted on the vehicle.
Hoisting
CAUTION: Use a frame-contact hoist only. Vehicle or component damage can result if other types
of hoists are used.
Never raise the vehicle using the halfshafts as lift points.
Undercoating and Rustproofing
During undercoating and rustproofing procedures, protect the boots from the coating materials.
Foreign materials on the rubber boots will cause extreme advanced wear.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Axle Shaft Assembly: Removal and Replacement
Front Drive Halfshafts
Halfshaft
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Whenever a halfshaft is removed, a new circlip and stub shaft pilot bearing seal must
be installed.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disable the air suspension system. 3.
Remove the dust cap.
4. Remove and discard the axle nut.
^ To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
5. Remove the vacuum/vent line at the vacuum/vent port of the integrated wheel end (IWE)
disconnect.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5703
6. Remove the 3 IWE retaining bolts to the steering knuckle.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
7. Remove the tie-rod end nut.
^ Disconnect the tie-rod end from the steering knuckle.
^ Discard the tie-rod end nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
8. Remove the upper ball joint nut.
^ Disconnect the upper ball joint from the steering knuckle.
^ Discard the upper ball joint nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
9. CAUTION: Do not damage the hub seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5704
NOTE: Allow the steering knuckle to swing outboard while keeping the constant velocity (CV) shaft
pushed inboard.
Once clearance is available, remove the CV shaft joint outboard end and IWE disconnect from the
steering knuckle hub bearing.
10. Remove the IWE disconnect from the outboard CV joint housing.
11. Using the special tools, remove the halfshaft from the differential and the intermediate shaft.
12. Remove and discard the circlip and the stub shaft seal.
13. CAUTION: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the
halfshaft nut.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Install a new axle nut, tie-rod end nut and an upper ball joint nut.
Rear Drive Halfshafts
Halfshaft
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5705
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5706
NOTE: This procedure applies to both rear halfshaft assemblies.
1. CAUTION: Do not loosen the rear axle wheel hub retainer until after the wheel and tire assembly
is removed from the vehicle. Wheel
bearing damage will occur if the wheel bearing is unloaded with the weight of the vehicle applied.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the rear axle wheel hub retainer and the washer. ^
To install, tighten to 345 Nm (254 lb-ft).
3. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the halfshaft from the knuckle.
4. Remove the brake disc rotor. 5. Remove the upper trailing arm bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 250 Nm (184 lb-ft).
6. Remove the upper trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle nut.
^ To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
7. Using the special tool, separate the upper arm from the wheel knuckle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5707
8. Remove the stabilizer bar link nut.
^ To install, tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
9. Remove the toe link-to-knuckle bolt.
^ To install, tighten 225 Nm (166 lb-ft).
10. Disconnect the anti-lock brake sensor at the connector and open the wire retaining clips.
11. Compress the spring, depress the retaining tabs and detach the parking brake cable from the
wheel knuckle.
12. Remove the 2 lower trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
13. Remove the lower ball joint nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
14. Using the special tool, separate the lower ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
15. Rotating the top of the knuckle assembly outboard, remove the knuckle assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5708
16. CAUTION: Do not damage the axle shaft oil seal or the machined sealing surface on the
inboard CV joint housing.
CAUTION: Do not allow the splines on inboard CV joint housing to touch the axle shaft oil seal.
NOTE: A circlip retains the inboard CV joint housing to the differential side gear in the axle.
Using the special tool, disengage the inboard CV joint housing from the differential side gear.
17. Remove the halfshaft assembly from the vehicle. 18. Remove and discard the halfshaft retainer
circlip.
19. CAUTION: Always install a new differential stub shaft seal.
CAUTION: Always install the halfshaft with a new retainer circlip and a new rear axle wheel hub
retainer.
CAUTION: Never use power tools to tighten the rear axle wheel hub retainer.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5709
Axle Shaft Assembly: Overhaul
Front Drive Halfshafts
Halfshaft
Special Tool(s)
Material
Disassembly
1. Remove the halfshaft from the vehicle.
2. CAUTION: Do not damage the boot.
Remove the boot clamps.
3. Separate the boot from the inboard constant velocity (CV) joint housing.
4. Remove the retaining ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5710
5. Remove the inboard CV joint housing.
6. Index-mark the inner race and ball cage.
7. Remove the 6 balls.
8. Remove the snap ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5711
9. Remove the inner race and the ball cage.
10. Remove the inboard boot.
11. Remove the boot clamps.
12. Remove the outboard boot.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5712
13. NOTE: If the grease is contaminated, clean and inspect the joint for wear. Install a new
outboard CV joint and interconnecting shaft assembly if
worn/damaged.
Check the grease for contamination.
Assembly
1. Position the outboard boot on the shaft.
2. Pack the outboard CV joint with 165 grams (5.82 ounces) of grease.
1 Use CV joint grease or equivalent provided in the boot kit.
2 Spread any remaining grease from the kit evenly inside the boot.
3. Install the outboard boot.
1 Clean the boot mounting surface.
2 Seat the boot in the joint boot groove.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5713
4. Position the boot clamps.
5. NOTE: Tighten the through-bolt until the tool is in the closed position.
Using the special tool, install the 2 boot clamps.
6. Position the boot clamp on the shaft.
7. Position the inboard boot on the shaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5714
8. Position the ball cage on the shaft with the tapered end facing the boot.
9. NOTE: Align the index marks.
Position the inner race on the shaft with the counterbored end facing the boot.
10. Install the snap ring.
11. Lubricate and position the 6 balls.
^ Use CV joint grease or equivalent provided in the boot kit.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5715
12. Fill the inboard CV joint housing with 235 grams (8.29 ounces) of grease.
^ Use CV joint grease or equivalent provided in the boot kit.
13. Position the boot clamp on the inboard CV joint housing.
14. Position the inboard CV joint housing on the ball and race assembly.
15. Install the retaining ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5716
16. Remove any excess grease from the mating surface. Seat the boot in the joint boot groove.
17. Set the halfshaft assembled length to specification.
18. CAUTION: Do not damage the boot.
Insert a dull screwdriver blade under the boot to release the pressure.
19. NOTE: Tighten the through-bolt until the tool is in the closed position.
Using the special tool, install the 2 boot clamps.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5717
20. NOTE: Maintain a clean work surface.
Compress the integrated wheel end (IWE) disconnect on the bench to collapse the vacuum
chamber.
21. While the IWE disconnect is collapsed, install a vacuum cap on the vacuum port.
22. CAUTION: Do not install the integrated wheel end disconnect in the knuckle. It must be
installed on the outer constant velocity joint
housing.
Install the IWE disconnect on the outer CV joint housing.
23. CAUTION: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the
halfshaft nut.
Install the halfshaft in the vehicle.
Rear Drive Halfshafts
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5718
Halfshaft Joint
Special Tool(s)
Material
Disassembly
1. Remove the halfshaft assembly from the vehicle. 2. For the inboard CV joint, carry out the
following:
1 Remove and discard the boot clamps. ^
Use diagonal cutters to cut the clamp.
2 Remove the inboard CV joint housing.
3. NOTE: Install the halfshaft in a soft-jaw vise.
For the inboard CV joint, carry out the following: 1
Remove and discard the retainer circlip.
2 Slide the boot away from the CV joint.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5719
4. Using a suitable 3-jaw puller, remove the CV joint.
5. Remove and discard the tri-lobe insert and the boot.
6. NOTE: The outboard CV joint is not removable from the halfshaft. The boot must be removed or
installed from the inboard CV joint side of the
shaft.
For the outboard CV joint, carry out the following: 1
Remove and discard the boot clamps.
2 Remove and discard the boot.
7. Inspect the grease, packed in the inboard CV joint and the outboard CV joint, for contamination.
Rub some of the grease from each joint between
2 fingers. Any gritty feeling indicates contamination. Wash all of the grease from the inboard CV
joint, the inboard CV joint housing, the outboard CV joint and the interconnecting shaft. Thoroughly
dry all of the components and inspect them for wear or damage. Discard the assembly, if
necessary. Only proceed as follows if not discarding the assembly.
8. On the inboard end, remove and discard the retainer circlip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5720
Assembly
1. NOTE: Clean any excess grease from the boot mounting surfaces before installing the boot.
For the outboard CV joint, carry out the following: 1
Slide the boot on the interconnecting shaft.
2 Pack the outboard CV joint with 275 grams (9.7 ounces) of grease.
3 Spread any remaining grease evenly inside the boot.
4 Install the boot by seating it in the groove in the CV joint housing.
2. NOTE: Tighten the through-bolt until the special tool is in the closed position.
Using the special tool, install both boot clamps.
3. NOTE: Install the halfshaft in a soft-jaw vise.
NOTE: The lip on the end of the tri-lobe insert must seat against the end of the boot.
For the inboard CV joint, carry out the following: 1
Position the clamp on the interconnecting shaft.
2 Position the boot on the interconnecting shaft.
3 Install the tri-lobe insert.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5721
4. NOTE: One side of the inboard CV joint has a chamfer cut in the edge of joint at the inner
diameter near the splines. Install the inboard CV joint
so that the chamfer faces the outboard end of the halfshaft.
Install the CV joint.
5. Install the retainer circlip.
6. NOTE: Clean any excess grease from the boot mounting surfaces before installing the boot.
For the inboard CV joint, carry out the following: 1
Pack the inboard CV joint housing with 325 grams (11.5 ounces) of grease.
2 Spread any remaining grease evenly inside the boot and on the CV joint.
3 Install the inboard CV joint housing, seating the boot in the groove in the housing.
7. Set the halfshaft assembled length to specification.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 5722
1 Measure the entire assembly length.
2 Push in or pull out on the inner joint as necessary to adjust the halfshaft assembled length to
specification.
3 Hold the inner joint to prevent the assembled length from changing, and insert a small flat-blade
screwdriver between the boot and the joint to equalize the pressure.
8. NOTE: Tighten the through-bolt until the special tool is in the closed position.
Using the special tool, install both boot clamps.
9. CAUTION: Do not overexpand or twist the circlip during installation.
Install a new retainer circlip.
10. Install the halfshaft assembly in the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3 > Sep > 08
> Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
Seals and Gaskets: Customer Interest Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
TSB 08-19-3
09/29/08
UNITIZED SEAL DIAGNOSIS - LEAK / GREASE OIL SEPARATION - AXLE BEARING SEAL 8.8
IFS, 8.8 IRS, AND 9.75 IRS AXLES
FORD: 2002-2008 Explorer 2003-2008 Expedition 2006-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2003-2005 Aviator 2003-2008 Navigator
MERCURY: 2002-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-05 to update the model years, Part List and Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Explorer, Explorer Sport Track, and Mountaineer
vehicles equipped with rear axle unitized cartridge seal, 2007-2008 Expedition-Navigator AWD
equipped with front and rear axle unitized cartridge seal.
2003-2005 Expedition-Navigator, 2002-2005, Explorer-Mountaineer, 2003-2005 Aviator equipped
with unitized cartridge rear axle seal, may exhibit oil separation from the internal lube found in the
unitized cartridge seal. This oil separation appears to be, and is often misdiagnosed, as an axle
lube leak. The majority of the vehicles with this condition will be located in northern Canada and
Alaska due to the extreme cold weather.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL UNTIL YOU COMPLETE THIS
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE. FAILURE TO PROPERLY DIAGNOSE THE ISSUE MAY
RESULT IN UNNECESSARILY REPLACING THE SEAL, RESULTING IN A REPEAT CONCERN.
NOTE
THIS DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE IS ONLY NECESSARY ON VEHICLES WITH THE NEW
UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL. THIS SEAL HAS BEEN USED IN PRODUCTION FROM 2006
MODEL YEAR TO PRESENT, HOWEVER, SOME VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 2006 MODEL
YEAR MAY HAVE THIS NEW UPDATED UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL INSTALLED AS A
SERVICE
REPAIR.
1. Raise vehicle, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-02.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3 > Sep > 08
> Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 5731
NOTE
IF SEAL IS OLD DESIGN RADIAL LIP SEAL STYLE, (SEE FIGURES 1 AND 2 TO IDENTIFY
RADIAL LIP SEAL) THERE IS NO INTERNAL GREASE PRESENT IN SEAL TO SEPARATE.
THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTIC.
2. Check axle half shaft seal to ensure that it is unitized cartridge design.
3. Clean axle housing around the seal area using Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner or
equivalent cleaner. Wipe lube or oil with rag and let the housing dry.
4. Add 0.5 to 1 ounce (14.8 to 29.6 ml) Rotunda Dye-Lite® Leak Detection Dye for Gasoline Engine
Oil 164-R3700, also contained in 164-R0756 to the axle following the appropriate Workshop
Manual.
NOTE
ADDING THE DYE ON SOME VEHICLES WILL REQUIRE THE REAR WHEEL ABS SPEED
SENSOR TO BE REMOVED. REFER TO THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL DRAIN
AND FILL PROCEDURE.
5. Road test vehicle a minimum distance 15 miles (24 km) at a minimum speed of 25 MPH (40
Km/h).
NOTE
A BRIGHT ORANGE AREA WILL IDENTIFY AXLE LUBE LEAK. FOR EXTREMELY SMALL OIL
SEPARATION, ADDITIONAL AXLE OPERATION TIME MAY BE REQUIRED FOR THE LEAK TO
APPEAR.
6. Raise vehicle to check for signs of leak.
a. Use Rotunda 12V Master UV Leak Detector Kit 164-R0756 or equivalent to look for signs of
leak.
7. If there is not a verifiable lube leak, clean axle near seal area and return the vehicle to the
customer.
NOTE
IF THERE IS NO SIGNS OF LUBE LEAK, THIS MEANS THAT THE SUBSTANCE WHICH WAS
PRESENT PRIOR TO THE PROCEDURE WAS OIL WHICH HAD SEPARATED FROM THE
GREASE INTERNAL TO THE SEAL. THIS OIL IS A PRE-LUBE, AND IS NOT NECESSARY
ONCE THE AXLE SEAL IS BROKEN IN. ONCE THE OIL SEPARATION HAS OCCURRED,
THERE SHOULD BE NO
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3 > Sep > 08
> Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 5732
FURTHER OIL SEPARATION FROM THE SEAL. REMOVING THE SEAL AND INSTALLING A
NEW SEAL MIGHT CREATE A SITUATION WHERE THE OIL WILL SEPARATE, RESULTING IN
THE SAME CONCERN.
8. If there is a verifiable axle lube leak, replace seal following the Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 205, or look at instruction sheet included in Axle Shaft Seal Kit.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081903A 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks. Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With
4139A, 4139A2)
081903A 2002-2008 Explorer, 0.7 Hr.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, 2002-2005 Aviator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks.
Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of
The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903B 2003-2008 Expedition 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903C 2003-2008 Expedition 2.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903D 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3 > Sep > 08
> Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 5733
Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed
With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2006-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac :Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time
To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2002-2005 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Mountaineer:Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2003-2005 Aviator:Replace 0.8 Hr.
Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903E 2006-2008 Explorer, 2.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To
Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2002-2005 Explorer, 1.5 Hrs.
Mountaineer: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3 > Sep > 08
> Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 5734
4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2005 Aviator: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides.
This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4A109 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3
> Sep > 08 > Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
TSB 08-19-3
09/29/08
UNITIZED SEAL DIAGNOSIS - LEAK / GREASE OIL SEPARATION - AXLE BEARING SEAL 8.8
IFS, 8.8 IRS, AND 9.75 IRS AXLES
FORD: 2002-2008 Explorer 2003-2008 Expedition 2006-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2003-2005 Aviator 2003-2008 Navigator
MERCURY: 2002-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-05 to update the model years, Part List and Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Explorer, Explorer Sport Track, and Mountaineer
vehicles equipped with rear axle unitized cartridge seal, 2007-2008 Expedition-Navigator AWD
equipped with front and rear axle unitized cartridge seal.
2003-2005 Expedition-Navigator, 2002-2005, Explorer-Mountaineer, 2003-2005 Aviator equipped
with unitized cartridge rear axle seal, may exhibit oil separation from the internal lube found in the
unitized cartridge seal. This oil separation appears to be, and is often misdiagnosed, as an axle
lube leak. The majority of the vehicles with this condition will be located in northern Canada and
Alaska due to the extreme cold weather.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL UNTIL YOU COMPLETE THIS
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE. FAILURE TO PROPERLY DIAGNOSE THE ISSUE MAY
RESULT IN UNNECESSARILY REPLACING THE SEAL, RESULTING IN A REPEAT CONCERN.
NOTE
THIS DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE IS ONLY NECESSARY ON VEHICLES WITH THE NEW
UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL. THIS SEAL HAS BEEN USED IN PRODUCTION FROM 2006
MODEL YEAR TO PRESENT, HOWEVER, SOME VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 2006 MODEL
YEAR MAY HAVE THIS NEW UPDATED UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL INSTALLED AS A
SERVICE
REPAIR.
1. Raise vehicle, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-02.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3
> Sep > 08 > Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 5740
NOTE
IF SEAL IS OLD DESIGN RADIAL LIP SEAL STYLE, (SEE FIGURES 1 AND 2 TO IDENTIFY
RADIAL LIP SEAL) THERE IS NO INTERNAL GREASE PRESENT IN SEAL TO SEPARATE.
THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTIC.
2. Check axle half shaft seal to ensure that it is unitized cartridge design.
3. Clean axle housing around the seal area using Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner or
equivalent cleaner. Wipe lube or oil with rag and let the housing dry.
4. Add 0.5 to 1 ounce (14.8 to 29.6 ml) Rotunda Dye-Lite® Leak Detection Dye for Gasoline Engine
Oil 164-R3700, also contained in 164-R0756 to the axle following the appropriate Workshop
Manual.
NOTE
ADDING THE DYE ON SOME VEHICLES WILL REQUIRE THE REAR WHEEL ABS SPEED
SENSOR TO BE REMOVED. REFER TO THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL DRAIN
AND FILL PROCEDURE.
5. Road test vehicle a minimum distance 15 miles (24 km) at a minimum speed of 25 MPH (40
Km/h).
NOTE
A BRIGHT ORANGE AREA WILL IDENTIFY AXLE LUBE LEAK. FOR EXTREMELY SMALL OIL
SEPARATION, ADDITIONAL AXLE OPERATION TIME MAY BE REQUIRED FOR THE LEAK TO
APPEAR.
6. Raise vehicle to check for signs of leak.
a. Use Rotunda 12V Master UV Leak Detector Kit 164-R0756 or equivalent to look for signs of
leak.
7. If there is not a verifiable lube leak, clean axle near seal area and return the vehicle to the
customer.
NOTE
IF THERE IS NO SIGNS OF LUBE LEAK, THIS MEANS THAT THE SUBSTANCE WHICH WAS
PRESENT PRIOR TO THE PROCEDURE WAS OIL WHICH HAD SEPARATED FROM THE
GREASE INTERNAL TO THE SEAL. THIS OIL IS A PRE-LUBE, AND IS NOT NECESSARY
ONCE THE AXLE SEAL IS BROKEN IN. ONCE THE OIL SEPARATION HAS OCCURRED,
THERE SHOULD BE NO
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3
> Sep > 08 > Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 5741
FURTHER OIL SEPARATION FROM THE SEAL. REMOVING THE SEAL AND INSTALLING A
NEW SEAL MIGHT CREATE A SITUATION WHERE THE OIL WILL SEPARATE, RESULTING IN
THE SAME CONCERN.
8. If there is a verifiable axle lube leak, replace seal following the Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 205, or look at instruction sheet included in Axle Shaft Seal Kit.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081903A 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks. Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With
4139A, 4139A2)
081903A 2002-2008 Explorer, 0.7 Hr.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, 2002-2005 Aviator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks.
Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of
The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903B 2003-2008 Expedition 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903C 2003-2008 Expedition 2.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903D 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3
> Sep > 08 > Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 5742
Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed
With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2006-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac :Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time
To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2002-2005 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Mountaineer:Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2003-2005 Aviator:Replace 0.8 Hr.
Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903E 2006-2008 Explorer, 2.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To
Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2002-2005 Explorer, 1.5 Hrs.
Mountaineer: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 08-19-3
> Sep > 08 > Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking > Page 5743
4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2005 Aviator: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides.
This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4A109 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5744
Seals and Gaskets: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-19-3 Date: 080929
Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
TSB 08-19-3
09/29/08
UNITIZED SEAL DIAGNOSIS - LEAK / GREASE OIL SEPARATION - AXLE BEARING SEAL 8.8
IFS, 8.8 IRS, AND 9.75 IRS AXLES
FORD: 2002-2008 Explorer 2003-2008 Expedition 2006-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2003-2005 Aviator 2003-2008 Navigator
MERCURY: 2002-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-05 to update the model years, Part List and Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Explorer, Explorer Sport Track, and Mountaineer
vehicles equipped with rear axle unitized cartridge seal, 2007-2008 Expedition-Navigator AWD
equipped with front and rear axle unitized cartridge seal.
2003-2005 Expedition-Navigator, 2002-2005, Explorer-Mountaineer, 2003-2005 Aviator equipped
with unitized cartridge rear axle seal, may exhibit oil separation from the internal lube found in the
unitized cartridge seal. This oil separation appears to be, and is often misdiagnosed, as an axle
lube leak. The majority of the vehicles with this condition will be located in northern Canada and
Alaska due to the extreme cold weather.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL UNTIL YOU COMPLETE THIS
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE. FAILURE TO PROPERLY DIAGNOSE THE ISSUE MAY
RESULT IN UNNECESSARILY REPLACING THE SEAL, RESULTING IN A REPEAT CONCERN.
NOTE
THIS DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE IS ONLY NECESSARY ON VEHICLES WITH THE NEW
UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL. THIS SEAL HAS BEEN USED IN PRODUCTION FROM 2006
MODEL YEAR TO PRESENT, HOWEVER, SOME VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 2006 MODEL
YEAR MAY HAVE THIS NEW UPDATED UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL INSTALLED AS A
SERVICE
REPAIR.
1. Raise vehicle, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-02.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5745
NOTE
IF SEAL IS OLD DESIGN RADIAL LIP SEAL STYLE, (SEE FIGURES 1 AND 2 TO IDENTIFY
RADIAL LIP SEAL) THERE IS NO INTERNAL GREASE PRESENT IN SEAL TO SEPARATE.
THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTIC.
2. Check axle half shaft seal to ensure that it is unitized cartridge design.
3. Clean axle housing around the seal area using Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner or
equivalent cleaner. Wipe lube or oil with rag and let the housing dry.
4. Add 0.5 to 1 ounce (14.8 to 29.6 ml) Rotunda Dye-Lite® Leak Detection Dye for Gasoline Engine
Oil 164-R3700, also contained in 164-R0756 to the axle following the appropriate Workshop
Manual.
NOTE
ADDING THE DYE ON SOME VEHICLES WILL REQUIRE THE REAR WHEEL ABS SPEED
SENSOR TO BE REMOVED. REFER TO THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL DRAIN
AND FILL PROCEDURE.
5. Road test vehicle a minimum distance 15 miles (24 km) at a minimum speed of 25 MPH (40
Km/h).
NOTE
A BRIGHT ORANGE AREA WILL IDENTIFY AXLE LUBE LEAK. FOR EXTREMELY SMALL OIL
SEPARATION, ADDITIONAL AXLE OPERATION TIME MAY BE REQUIRED FOR THE LEAK TO
APPEAR.
6. Raise vehicle to check for signs of leak.
a. Use Rotunda 12V Master UV Leak Detector Kit 164-R0756 or equivalent to look for signs of
leak.
7. If there is not a verifiable lube leak, clean axle near seal area and return the vehicle to the
customer.
NOTE
IF THERE IS NO SIGNS OF LUBE LEAK, THIS MEANS THAT THE SUBSTANCE WHICH WAS
PRESENT PRIOR TO THE PROCEDURE WAS OIL WHICH HAD SEPARATED FROM THE
GREASE INTERNAL TO THE SEAL. THIS OIL IS A PRE-LUBE, AND IS NOT NECESSARY
ONCE THE AXLE SEAL IS BROKEN IN. ONCE THE OIL SEPARATION HAS OCCURRED,
THERE SHOULD BE NO
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5746
FURTHER OIL SEPARATION FROM THE SEAL. REMOVING THE SEAL AND INSTALLING A
NEW SEAL MIGHT CREATE A SITUATION WHERE THE OIL WILL SEPARATE, RESULTING IN
THE SAME CONCERN.
8. If there is a verifiable axle lube leak, replace seal following the Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 205, or look at instruction sheet included in Axle Shaft Seal Kit.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081903A 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks. Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With
4139A, 4139A2)
081903A 2002-2008 Explorer, 0.7 Hr.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, 2002-2005 Aviator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks.
Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of
The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903B 2003-2008 Expedition 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903C 2003-2008 Expedition 2.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903D 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5747
Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed
With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2006-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac :Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time
To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2002-2005 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Mountaineer:Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2003-2005 Aviator:Replace 0.8 Hr.
Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903E 2006-2008 Explorer, 2.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To
Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2002-2005 Explorer, 1.5 Hrs.
Mountaineer: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5748
4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2005 Aviator: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides.
This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4A109 42
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-19-3 Date: 080929
Drivetrain - Rear Axle Seal(s) Leaking
TSB 08-19-3
09/29/08
UNITIZED SEAL DIAGNOSIS - LEAK / GREASE OIL SEPARATION - AXLE BEARING SEAL 8.8
IFS, 8.8 IRS, AND 9.75 IRS AXLES
FORD: 2002-2008 Explorer 2003-2008 Expedition 2006-2008 Explorer Sport Trac
LINCOLN: 2003-2005 Aviator 2003-2008 Navigator
MERCURY: 2002-2008 Mountaineer
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-05 to update the model years, Part List and Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2006-2008 Expedition, Navigator, Explorer, Explorer Sport Track, and Mountaineer
vehicles equipped with rear axle unitized cartridge seal, 2007-2008 Expedition-Navigator AWD
equipped with front and rear axle unitized cartridge seal.
2003-2005 Expedition-Navigator, 2002-2005, Explorer-Mountaineer, 2003-2005 Aviator equipped
with unitized cartridge rear axle seal, may exhibit oil separation from the internal lube found in the
unitized cartridge seal. This oil separation appears to be, and is often misdiagnosed, as an axle
lube leak. The majority of the vehicles with this condition will be located in northern Canada and
Alaska due to the extreme cold weather.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE THE UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL UNTIL YOU COMPLETE THIS
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE. FAILURE TO PROPERLY DIAGNOSE THE ISSUE MAY
RESULT IN UNNECESSARILY REPLACING THE SEAL, RESULTING IN A REPEAT CONCERN.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5749
NOTE
THIS DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURE IS ONLY NECESSARY ON VEHICLES WITH THE NEW
UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL. THIS SEAL HAS BEEN USED IN PRODUCTION FROM 2006
MODEL YEAR TO PRESENT, HOWEVER, SOME VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 2006 MODEL
YEAR MAY HAVE THIS NEW UPDATED UNITIZED CARTRIDGE SEAL INSTALLED AS A
SERVICE
REPAIR.
1. Raise vehicle, refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 100-02.
NOTE
IF SEAL IS OLD DESIGN RADIAL LIP SEAL STYLE, (SEE FIGURES 1 AND 2 TO IDENTIFY
RADIAL LIP SEAL) THERE IS NO INTERNAL GREASE PRESENT IN SEAL TO SEPARATE.
THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTIC.
2. Check axle half shaft seal to ensure that it is unitized cartridge design.
3. Clean axle housing around the seal area using Motorcraft® Metal Brake Parts Cleaner or
equivalent cleaner. Wipe lube or oil with rag and let the housing dry.
4. Add 0.5 to 1 ounce (14.8 to 29.6 ml) Rotunda Dye-Lite® Leak Detection Dye for Gasoline Engine
Oil 164-R3700, also contained in 164-R0756 to the axle following the appropriate Workshop
Manual.
NOTE
ADDING THE DYE ON SOME VEHICLES WILL REQUIRE THE REAR WHEEL ABS SPEED
SENSOR TO BE REMOVED. REFER TO THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL DRAIN
AND FILL PROCEDURE.
5. Road test vehicle a minimum distance 15 miles (24 km) at a minimum speed of 25 MPH (40
Km/h).
NOTE
A BRIGHT ORANGE AREA WILL IDENTIFY AXLE LUBE LEAK. FOR EXTREMELY SMALL OIL
SEPARATION, ADDITIONAL AXLE OPERATION TIME MAY BE REQUIRED FOR THE LEAK TO
APPEAR.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5750
6. Raise vehicle to check for signs of leak.
a. Use Rotunda 12V Master UV Leak Detector Kit 164-R0756 or equivalent to look for signs of
leak.
7. If there is not a verifiable lube leak, clean axle near seal area and return the vehicle to the
customer.
NOTE
IF THERE IS NO SIGNS OF LUBE LEAK, THIS MEANS THAT THE SUBSTANCE WHICH WAS
PRESENT PRIOR TO THE PROCEDURE WAS OIL WHICH HAD SEPARATED FROM THE
GREASE INTERNAL TO THE SEAL. THIS OIL IS A PRE-LUBE, AND IS NOT NECESSARY
ONCE THE AXLE SEAL IS BROKEN IN. ONCE THE OIL SEPARATION HAS OCCURRED,
THERE SHOULD BE NO FURTHER OIL SEPARATION FROM THE SEAL. REMOVING THE
SEAL AND INSTALLING A NEW SEAL MIGHT CREATE A SITUATION WHERE THE OIL WILL
SEPARATE, RESULTING IN THE SAME CONCERN.
8. If there is a verifiable axle lube leak, replace seal following the Workshop Manual (WSM),
Section 205, or look at instruction sheet included in Axle Shaft Seal Kit.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081903A 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks. Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With
4139A, 4139A2)
081903A 2002-2008 Explorer, 0.7 Hr.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, 2002-2005 Aviator: INSPECT Axle Seal Leaks.
Includes Time to Add Oil Dye and Road Test. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Any Of
The Labor Operations In This Article. (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903B 2003-2008 Expedition 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903C 2003-2008 Expedition 2.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5751
Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With A, D, Or E (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2003-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903D 2006-2008 Explorer, 1.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac :Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time
To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not
Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2002-2005 Explorer, 0.9 Hr.
Mountaineer:Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
One Side. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903D 2003-2005 Aviator:Replace 0.8 Hr.
Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. One Side. This Labor
Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A, B, Or C (Do Not Use With 4139A,
4139A2)
081903E 2006-2008 Explorer, 2.1 Hrs.
Mountaineer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To
Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > Page
5752
Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2002-2005 Explorer, 1.5 Hrs.
Mountaineer: Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft.
Both Sides. This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
081903E 2003-2005 Aviator: 1.6 Hrs.
Replace Rear Axle Stub Shaft Seal. Includes Time To Remove and Install Halfshaft. Both Sides.
This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With A (Do Not Use With 4139A, 4139A2)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
4A109 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5757
major service expense. A new part with the same part number must be installed if installation
becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque
values must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these
parts.
1. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness
bolt and detach the harness from the retainers.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Remove the halfshaft nut dust cap. 7. Remove and discard the
halfshaft nut.
^ To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
8. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and wheel hub bolts and the wheel hub.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 lb-ft).
9. If installing a new wheel bearing and wheel hub, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the
wheel speed sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
10. CAUTION: If the original wheel bearing and wheel hub is being installed, install a new wheel
hub O-ring seal.
CAUTION: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the halfshaft
nut.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5758
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the halfshaft nut. ^
To install, tighten to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
3. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV joint from the wheel hub.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 5759
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose can result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Detach the wheel speed sensor harness from the retainers and
disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
7. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and wheel hub bolts, the wheel bearing assembly and the wheel
speed sensor as an assembly.
^ Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
^ Discard the bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 lb-ft).
8. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and wheel hub.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications > Front
Axle Nut: Specifications Front
Front Axle nut.......................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 27 Nm (20 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications > Front > Page 5765
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear
Rear axle Nut .......................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 300 Nm (221 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock
Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 5769
C1157
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub (Locking) >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Wheel Hub (Locking): Service and Repair
Integrated Wheel End (IWE)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the front wheel and tire.
3. Remove the dust cap.
4. Remove and discard the axle nut.
5. Disconnect the vacuum tubes from the Integrated Wheel End (IWE).
6. Remove the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
7. Remove the tie-rod nut and separate the tie rod from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the tie-rod nut.
8. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
9. Remove the front brake flexible hose bracket bolt and position the brake hose aside.
10. Remove the upper ball joint nut and separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the upper ball joint nut.
11. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, remove the halfshaft outboard end from the wheel knuckle hub
bearing.
12. Remove the IWE from the halfshaft outboard end.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub (Locking) >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 5773
1. Compress the IWE and install a vacuum cap on the vacuum port.
2. NOTICE: Do not dislodge the Integrated Wheel End (IWE) seal spring when installing the IWE
on halfshaft outboard end or component
damage may occur.
Install the IWE onto the halfshaft outboard end.
3. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, install the halfshaft outboard end into the wheel knuckle hub bearing.
4. Connect the upper ball joint and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
5. Connect the tie rod and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
6. Position the front brake flexible hose bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Position the wheel speed sensor harness bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
8. Install the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
9. Remove the IWE vacuum cap and connect the vacuum tubes.
10. NOTICE: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the axle nut
or component damage may occur.
Install the new axle nut.
- Tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
11. Install the dust cap.
12. Install the front wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Diagrams
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Diagrams
Front, Expedition and Navigator
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5778
Rear - Navigator Four Wheel Drive (4WD), Expedition 4WD and Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5779
Rear, Navigator RWD
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Driveshaft - Front
Driveshaft - Front
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Disable the air suspension system. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a
hoist. 3. Index-mark the front flange to the pinion flange.
4. Index-mark the rear flange to the transfer case flange.
5. Remove and discard the 6 rear flange-to-transfer case flange bolts. Retain the 3 washers.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
6. Remove and discard the 6 front flange-to-pinion flange bolts. Retain the 2 washers.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 5782
7. Remove and discard the 4 stabilizer bracket nuts and allow the stabilizer bar to swing downward.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
8. Remove the front driveshaft from the vehicle. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 5783
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Driveshaft - Rear, Expedition
Driveshaft - Rear, Expedition
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Disable the air suspension system. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a
hoist. 3. Index-mark the driveshaft flange to the rear axle pinion flange.
4. Remove the 4 driveshaft flange bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
5. CAUTION: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the rear axle pinion flange pilot. Never hammer on
the driveshaft or any of its
components to disconnect the driveshaft from the pinion flange. Pry only in the area shown, with a
suitable tool, to disconnect the driveshaft flange from the pinion flange.
Using a suitable tool, disconnect the driveshaft flange from the rear axle pinion flange.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 5784
6. NOTE: Do not rotate the driveshaft when removing the slip yoke from the transmission output
shaft.
Index-mark the driveshaft slip yoke and the transmission extension housing. ^
Mark the transmission output shaft to the transmission extension housing after removing the
driveshaft.
7. CAUTION: Coat the threads of the original bolts with sealer.
CAUTION: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the rear axle pinion flange pilot. To make sure that
the driveshaft flange seats squarely on the pinion flange, tighten the bolts evenly in a cross pattern
as shown.
CAUTION: Make sure all index marks are aligned.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Tighten the driveshaft flange bolts to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 5785
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Driveshaft - Rear, Navigator
Driveshaft - Rear, Navigator
Material
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Disable the air suspension system. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Four wheel drive (4WD) vehicles
3. Index-mark the driveshaft flange to the pinion flange.
4. Index-mark the driveshaft slip yoke to the transmission extension housing.
5. Remove and discard the 4 driveshaft flange bolts.
6. CAUTION: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. Never hammer on the
driveshaft or any of its components to
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 5786
disconnect the driveshaft from the pinion flange. Pry only in the area shown, with a suitable tool, to
disconnect the driveshaft flange from the pinion flange.
Using a suitable tool, disconnect the driveshaft flange from the pinion flange.
7. NOTE: Do not rotate the driveshaft when removing the slip yoke from the transmission output
shaft.
Remove the driveshaft. ^
Mark the transmission output shaft to the transmission extension housing after removing the
driveshaft.
Rear wheel drive (RWD) vehicles
8. Index-mark the driveshaft for correct alignment during installation.
9. Remove and discard the 3 flex-coupler-to-flange nuts and the 3 flex-coupler-to-flange bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 5787
10. Remove and discard the 4 driveshaft flange bolts.
11. CAUTION: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. Never hammer on the
driveshaft or any of its components to
disconnect the driveshaft from the pinion flange. Pry only in the area shown, with a suitable tool, to
disconnect the driveshaft flange from the pinion flange.
Using a suitable tool, disconnect the driveshaft flange from the pinion flange.
12. Remove the 2 driveshaft center bearing bolts, then remove the driveshaft.
^ Discard the driveshaft center bearing bolts.
Installation
4WD vehicles
1. Align all the index marks and install the driveshaft slip yoke into the transmission extension
housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 5788
2. CAUTION: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. To make sure that the
driveshaft flange seat squarely on the
pinion flange pilot, tighten the driveshaft flange bolts evenly in a cross pattern.
Align the index marks and install the driveshaft flange and the driveshaft flange bolts. ^
Tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
RWD vehicles
3. CAUTION: If new driveshaft center bearing bolts are not available, coat the threads of the
original driveshaft center bearing bolts with
Threadlock and Sealer.
Position the driveshaft center bearing and hand-tighten the 2 new driveshaft center bearing bolts
until the driveshaft is mounted to the flanges. ^
Tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. CAUTION: If new flex-coupler-to-flange bolts and flex-coupler-to-flange nuts are not available,
coat the threads of the original
flex-coupler-to-flange bolts with Threadlock and Sealer.
Install the 3 new flex-coupler-to-flange bolts and the 3 new flex-coupler-to-flange nuts. ^
Tighten the nuts to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 5789
5. CAUTION: The driveshaft flange fits tightly on the pinion flange pilot. To make sure that the
driveshaft flange seat squarely on the
pinion flange pilot, tighten the driveshaft flange bolts evenly in a cross pattern.
Install the 4 new driveshaft flange bolts. ^
Tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 5790
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair Driveshaft Slip Yoke Boot
Driveshaft Slip Yoke Boot
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driveshaft. 2. Index-mark the driveshaft to the center bearing for correct alignment
during installation.
3. Disconnect the slip yoke boot.
4. Separate the driveshaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Driveshaft - Front > Page 5791
5. Remove the slip yoke boot.
6. NOTE: Lubricate the slip yoke splines with premium long-life grease.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Align the index marks for correct alignment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation
Universal Joint: Description and Operation
Universal Joints
The universal joint (U-joint) connects to the drive axle of the driveshaft and allows for up and down
movement of the axle. The U-joint is lubricated for the life of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5795
Universal Joint: Service and Repair
Driveshaft Universal Joint - Single Cardan
Special Tool(s)
Disassembly
1. Remove the driveshaft.
2. CAUTION: Do not clamp the driveshaft in the jaws of a vise or a similar holding fixture.
Carefully place the driveshaft on a suitable workbench.
3. NOTE: Index-mark the driveshaft components relative to the driveshaft tube. Make sure all
components are reassembled in the same relationship
to maintain correct balance.
Index the driveshaft and driveshaft components.
4. Position the special tool in a vise.
5. Remove the snap rings from the universal joint.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5796
6. NOTE: If necessary, use a pair of pliers to remove a bearing cup if it cannot be pressed out all
the way.
Remove the driveshaft flange yoke. 1
Position the driveshaft flange in the special tool.
2 Press out the bearing cup.
3 Rotate the driveshaft flange yoke.
4 Press on the spider to remove the remaining bearing cup.
5 Remove the driveshaft flange yoke.
7. Repeat the previous step to remove the remaining bearing cups and spider from the driveshaft.
8. Clean the yoke area at the end of the driveshaft and flange yoke.
Assembly
NOTE: Universal joint service kits are to be installed as complete assemblies only. Do not use
components from other universal joints.
1. Clamp the special tool in a vise.
2. Install a new bearing cup.
1 Start a new bearing cup into the driveshaft yoke.
2 Position a new spider in the driveshaft yoke.
3 Install the driveshaft into the special tool.
4 Press the bearing cup below the yoke surface.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Universal Joint,
Drive/Propeller Shaft > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 5797
3. Remove the driveshaft from the special tool and install the snap ring.
4. Repeat the previous steps to install the remaining bearing cups.
5. NOTE: Do not strike the bearings. If binding, strike the yoke with a brass or plastic hammer.
Check the universal joint for freedom of movement.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications
Flex Plate: Specifications
Flexplate bolts .....................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5801
Flex Plate: Service and Repair
Flexplate
Flexplate or Flywheel and Crankshaft Rear Seal - Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the transmission. 2. Remove the 8 bolts and the flexplate.
^ To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 ft. lbs.) in the sequence shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications > Page
5802
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and
Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Power Take-Off > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Power Take-Off: Description and Operation
POWER TAKE-OFF (PTO) SWITCH AND CIRCUITS
The PTO circuit is used by the PCM to disable some of the on board diagnostics (OBD) monitors
during PTO operation. The PTO switch is normally open. When the PTO unit is activated, the PTO
switch is closed and battery voltage is supplied to the PTO input circuit. This indicates to the PCM
that an additional load is being applied to the engine. The PTO indicator lamp illuminates when the
PTO system is functioning correctly and flashes when the PTO system is damaged
When the PTO unit is activated, the PCM disables some OBD monitors, which may not function
reliably during PTO operation. Without the PTO circuit information to the PCM, false DTCs may be
set during PTO operation. Prior to an Inspection/Maintenance test, operate the vehicle with the
PTO disengaged long enough to successfully complete the OBD Monitors.
PTO Circuits Description
The 3 PTO input circuits are PTO mode, PTO engage, and PTO RPM.
The PTO engage circuit is used when the operator is requesting the PCM to check the needed
inputs required to initiate the PTO engagement.
The PTO RPM circuit is used for the operator to request additional engine RPM for PTO operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Control Module: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 5821
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 5826
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5831
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5832
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5833
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 5839
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 5844
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5849
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5850
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 5851
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 5856
Control Module: Diagrams
C281A
C281B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 5857
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH-side cowl side panel cover to gain access. 2. Remove the 2 screws. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 4WD control module. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5864
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5865
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5866
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5867
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5868
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5869
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5870
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5871
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5872
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5873
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5874
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5875
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5876
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5877
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5878
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5879
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5880
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5881
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5886
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5887
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5888
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5889
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5890
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5891
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5892
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5893
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5894
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5895
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5896
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5897
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5898
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5899
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5900
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5901
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions >
Page 5902
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5907
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5908
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5909
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5910
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5911
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5912
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5913
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5914
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5915
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5916
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5917
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5918
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5919
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5920
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5921
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5922
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5923
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5929
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5930
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5931
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5932
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5933
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5934
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5935
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5936
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5937
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5938
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5939
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5940
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5941
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5942
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5943
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5944
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5945
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5946
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 5947
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (TC) switch is not replaceable. If a new TC switch is required,
install a new transmission selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Transmission
Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift > Page 5950
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (+/-) switch is not serviced. If a new switch is required, install a
new selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5955
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5956
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5957
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5958
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5959
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5960
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5961
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5962
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5963
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5964
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5965
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5966
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5967
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5968
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5969
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5970
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5971
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5976
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5977
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5978
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5979
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5980
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5981
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5982
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5983
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5984
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5985
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5986
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5987
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5988
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5989
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5990
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5991
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 5992
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5997
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5998
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 5999
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6000
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6001
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6002
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6003
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6004
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6005
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6006
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6007
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6008
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6009
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6010
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6011
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6012
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 6013
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6018
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Diagrams
C284
C2071
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6023
Control Module: Diagrams
C281A
C281B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6024
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH-side cowl side panel cover to gain access. 2. Remove the 2 screws. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 4WD control module. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information
> Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - Transfer Case: Capacity Specifications
Transfer Case Capacity .......................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 2.0 Quarts
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information
> Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 6029
Fluid - Transfer Case: Fluid Type Specifications
Transfer Case Fluid
Type .....................................................................................................................................................
............................................................. Mercon ATF
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Fluid - Transfer Case > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 6030
Fluid - Transfer Case: Service and Repair
Transfer Case Draining and Filling
Special Tool(s)
Material
1. Remove the drain plug and drain the fluid. Clean the drain plug and the drain plug area. Apply
thread sealant to the drain plug threads. Reinstall
the drain plug. ^
To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
2. Clean the area around the fill plug. Remove the fill plug.
3. CAUTION: Incorrect fluid fill can result in transfer case failure.
Using the special tool, fill the transfer case to specification. ^
The fluid must be just below the fill plug hole. Fill the case until the fluid slowly flows over the fill
plug threads. Clean the fluid from the fill plug area.
4. Apply thread sealant to the fill plug threads, then install the fill plug.
^ Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6034
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Diagrams
C284
C2071
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 6039
Control Module: Diagrams
C281A
C281B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control
Module, Transfer Case > Component Information > Locations > Page 6040
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH-side cowl side panel cover to gain access. 2. Remove the 2 screws. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 4WD control module. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Seals and Gaskets, Transfer Case > System
Information > Service and Repair
Seals and Gaskets: Service and Repair
Transfer Case Rear Output Shaft Seal
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Index-mark the rear driveshaft yoke and pinion flange to maintain initial driveshaft
balance during installation.
Remove the rear driveshaft.
3. Using a suitable tool, remove the oil seal.
Installation
1. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Using the special tool, install the oil seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transfer Case > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four
Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6048
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Diagrams
C284
C2071
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6056
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6057
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6058
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6059
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6060
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6061
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6062
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6063
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6064
Pressure Regulating Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6065
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6066
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6067
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6068
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6069
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6070
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6071
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Pressure Regulating Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6072
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6076
C2139
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The brake shift interlock actuator is not serviced individually. If replacement is required,
install a new floor shift selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift > Page 6079
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Service and Repair Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
1. Set the parking brake. 2. Remove the steering column shrouds. 3. Turn the ignition to the
accessory position and apply the brake or actuate the brake shift interlock actuator (BSIA) override.
4. Put the selector lever into the NEUTRAL position. 5. Disconnect the BSIA electrical connector. 6.
Remove the BSIA screw. 7. Gently pry the clip up and remove the BSIA.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Brake Shift Interlock Actuator - Floor Shift > Page 6080
8. NOTE: During installation, verify that the BSIA override has been activated and the slider is fully
rearward. Before rotating the selector lever
from NEUTRAL into PARK, align the selector lever tab into the BSIA.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Shift Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6085
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6086
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6087
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6088
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6089
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6090
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6091
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6092
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6093
Shift Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6094
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6095
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6096
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6097
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6098
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6099
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6100
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6101
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6106
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6107
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6108
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6109
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6110
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6111
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6112
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6113
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6114
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6115
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6116
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6117
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6118
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6119
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6120
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6121
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6122
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To
Zero At A Stop
Control Module: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To
Zero At A Stop > Page 6138
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2
Shift Flare
Control Module: Customer Interest Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2
Shift Flare > Page 6143
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set
In TCM
Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set
In TCM > Page 6148
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set
In TCM > Page 6149
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set
In TCM > Page 6150
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't
Return To Zero At A Stop
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A
Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't
Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 6156
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh
1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Control - Harsh 1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare
TSB 07-8-11
04/30/07
HARSH 1-2 AND/OR 2-1 SHIFTS, TIP-IN HESITATION OR SURGE, AND/OR LONG
ENGAGEMENT TIME
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-4-8 to update the vehicle application.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a harsh tip-in from low speeds
below 7 MPH (11 Km/h), typically when still in 1st gear such as when in a traffic jam. Additionally
some 2007 Expedition vehicles may exhibit a harsh 1-2 shift and/or 2-1 downshift, 1-2 shift flare,
and/or long engagement time.
ACTION Reprogram the powertrain control module (PCM) and transmission control module (TCM)
to the latest calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher. This new calibration
is not included in the VCM 2007.3 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Navigator Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Expedition Procedure
1. Install IDS/PDS or equivalent and ID vehicle.
2. Update the PCM and 1CM calibration using IDS release 47.6 or higher and 48.1 and higher.
Since the 1CM cannot be independently reprogrammed, reprogram the PCM to ensure that engine
and transmission calibrations are updated to the latest level simultaneously.
3. Clear TCM keep alive memory (KAM) and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose reset KAM.
(4) Then choose TCM.
b. Using PDS
(1) Choose "All Tests and Calibrations".
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose "Reset TCM KAM"
NOTE
NOTE:
FOR PDS, RESET TCM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-8-11 > Apr > 07 > Engine Control - Harsh
1-2/2-1 Shifts/1-2 Shift Flare > Page 6161
UNHOOKING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
4. Verify that the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at
175 °F (80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km) to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
5. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from rest with light throttle. The 1-2, 2-3, and 3-4 shifts must occur at engine speeds
between 1300-1800 RPM.
b. Continue to accelerate gently to 50 MPH (80 Km/h) so that the transmission shifts into 6th gear.
c. Brake gently to a COMPLETE STOP and hold foot on brake for at least 15 seconds.
d. Repeat Steps (a-d) a total of five (5) times
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070811A 2007 Navigator: Check 0.4 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM. (Do Not Use With 12650D)
070811B 2007 Expedition: Check 0.9 Hr.
DTCs And Reprogram The PCM and TCM, Includes Time To Clear KAM, Check Fluid Level, And
Update Transmission Adaptive Strategy (Do Not Use with 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp'
ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 'Wrench Lamp' ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM
TSB 07-6-3
04/02/07
6R60/75 - DTC-MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY / POSSIBLE WRENCH LIGHT ON
FORD: 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 Explorer and Mountaineer, 2007 Sport Trac, and 2007 Expedition
vehicles may exhibit the following diagnostic trouble codes in the transmission control module
(1CM) memory with or without the wrench light on. The codes include the following; P0658, P0657,
P0972, P0973, P0974, P0975, P0976, P0977, P0978, P0979, P0980, P0981, P0982, P0083,
P0961, P0962, P0963, P2763, P2764, P0985, P0986, P0711, P0712. The cause is contamination
at the mechatronic assembly.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
IF THE MECHATRONIC ASSEMBLY WAS BUILT WITH A FOAM BARRIER STRIP, REMOVE
AND DISCARD, REMOVE ANY SOURCES OF CONTAMINATION, AND INSTALL A NEW FOAM
BARRIER STRIP.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Remove the source of contamination from the transmission control unit (TCU)/solenoid connections
and/or at the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) window. Install the foam barrier strip to prevent
recurrence.
1. Remove mechatronic assembly using the Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 307-01.
2. Remove the six (6) long fasteners from the TCM unit. (Figure 1)
3. Carefully separate the TCM from the mechatronic assembly. Do not separate the two halves of
the main control during this procedure.
NOTE
IF THE WRENCH LIGHT IS NOT ILLUMINATED THE CONTAMINATION MAY BE DISLODGED
FROM THE TCU/SOLENOID CONNECTORS AND FLOATING WITHIN THE HYDRAULICS
SYSTEM.
4. Inspect the TCM at the following locations for metal chips or other metallic contamination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp'
ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 6166
a. Closely inspect both sides of the TCU blades for machining chips or metallic contamination.
(Figure 2)
b. Closely inspect all solenoid terminals for machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
3 and 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp'
ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 6167
c. Closely inspect the TFT window for any machining chips and or metallic contamination. (Figure
5)
5. Prior to installation of the protective strip, remove all machining chips and or other metallic
contamination from these areas with a clean, lint free cloth.
6. Install the new foam barrier strip over the blades of the TCU, no special barrier strip is required
for the TFT. (Figure 2 shows before foam barrier strip is installed, Figure 6 shows after the foam
barrier strip is installed).
7. Reinstall the TCU on to the main control. Install the six (6) long bolts into the TCM unit. Tighten
to 53 lb-in (6 N.m). (Figure 7) Reinstall/verify the cooler bypass valve (spring end into the case first,
"point" down), reinstall pump seal adaptor, and four (4) center support seals following WSM,
Section 307-01.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Control Module: > 07-6-3 > Apr > 07 > A/T - 'Wrench Lamp'
ON/Multiple DTC's Set In TCM > Page 6168
8. Reinstall the mechatronic assembly following the WSM, Section 307-01.
9. Install a new fluid filter, and reusable gasket following WSM, Section 307-01.
10. Set the transmission fluid level following the WSM, Section 307-01.
11. Clear all DTC(s) from the TCM.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
070603A 2006-2007 2.6 Hrs.
Explorer/Mountaineer, 2007 Explorer Sport Trac 6R60 Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New
Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission
Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With 7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
070603A 2007 Expedition 6R75 2.7 Hrs.
Transmission: Check DTCs, Install New Barrier Protective Strip, Includes Time To Remove And
Install Mechatronic/TCM, Set Transmission Fluid, And Reprogram The TCM (Do Not Use With
7191A, 7191A1, 12650D, 12650D84)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14B167 49
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6173
Control Module: Diagrams
C281A
C281B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Relays and Modules Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and Modules - Transfer Case > Control Module, Transfer Case > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6174
Control Module: Service and Repair
Four Wheel Drive (4WD) Control Module
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH-side cowl side panel cover to gain access. 2. Remove the 2 screws. 3.
Disconnect the electrical connectors. 4. Remove the 4WD control module. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6181
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6182
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6183
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6184
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6185
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6186
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6187
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6188
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6189
Brake Switch - TCC: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6190
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6191
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6192
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6193
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6194
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6195
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6196
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6197
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6198
Brake Switch - TCC: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Overdrive Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6203
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6204
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6205
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6206
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6207
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6208
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6209
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6210
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6211
Overdrive Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6212
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6213
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6214
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6215
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6216
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6217
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6218
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6219
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6224
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6225
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6226
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6227
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6228
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6229
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6230
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6231
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6232
Throttle Position Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6233
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6234
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6235
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6236
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6237
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6238
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6239
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Throttle Position Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6240
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6246
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6247
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6248
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6249
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6250
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6251
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6252
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6253
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6254
Transmission Mode Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6255
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6256
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6257
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6258
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6259
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6260
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6261
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6262
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6263
C2135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 6264
Transmission Mode Switch: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL SWITCH (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
Typical Transmission Control Switch (TCS)
The TCS signals the PCM with VPWR whenever the TCS is pressed. On vehicles with this feature,
the transmission control indicator lamp (TCIL) illuminates when the TCS is cycled to disengage
overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (TC) switch is not replaceable. If a new TC switch is required,
install a new transmission selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Mode Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Column Shift > Page 6267
Transmission Mode Switch: Service and Repair Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Transmission Control (TC) Switch - Floor Shift
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The transmission control (+/-) switch is not serviced. If a new switch is required, install a
new selector lever assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6272
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6273
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6274
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6275
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6276
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6277
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6278
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6279
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6280
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6281
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6282
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6283
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6284
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6285
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6286
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6287
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6288
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6293
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6294
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6295
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6296
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6297
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6298
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6299
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6300
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6301
Transmission Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6302
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6303
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6304
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6305
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6306
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6307
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6308
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6309
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6314
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6315
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6316
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6317
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6318
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6319
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6320
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6321
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6322
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6323
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6324
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6325
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6326
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6327
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6328
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6329
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6330
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transfer Case > Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6335
Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch: Diagrams
C284
C2071
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations
ABS Sensor Block: Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6341
View 151-22 (RH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6342
C3073
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6343
ABS Sensor Block: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the bracket.
^ To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Sensor Block >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6344
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake Control
Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Electronic Brake Control Module: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC
C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake Control
Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6353
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake Control
Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6354
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Electronic Brake Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon
ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6360
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6361
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6362
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6363
C135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6364
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new module, it must be calibrated and configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. Disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air cleaner cover.
^ to install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.)
3. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 4. Release the retaining clips
and position the air cleaner cover aside. 5. Remove the 3 hydraulic control unit (HCU) bracket
bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
6. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical connector. 7. Remove the 4 bolts
and the ABS module.
^ To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.)
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ If installing a new ABS module, program the module. For additional information, refer to
Information Bus (Module Configuration).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic Control
Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6368
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical connector.
3. CAUTION: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of
specific design and only authorized parts
should be used when installing new inlet brake tubes.
NOTE: Plug each open port to prevent brake fluid from spilling.
Disconnect the 6 brake tube fittings. ^
To install: tighten the master cylinder brake tube fittings to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
- tighten the remaining brake tube fittings to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove the 3 hydraulic control unit (HCU)-to-bracket bolts and the HCU.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the bracket.
^ To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6372
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Angle
Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set
TSB 08-20-8
10/13/08
STEERING WHEEL ANGLE CIRCUIT AND/OR SIGNAL FAILURE - C1277-C1278 - BUILT
ON/OR BEFORE 4/10/2008
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 08-10-3 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 4/10/2008 may
exhibit a traction control light (TCL) on with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1277 and/or C1278
(steering wheel angle 1 and 2 circuit failure and/or signal faulted).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check to see if the steering wheel rotation (SWR) sensor wiring near the connector has come in
contact with or is touching the brake pedal bracket. Vibration of the harness may cause interruption
in the SWR signal.
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, do not continue with this procedure. Refer to normal diagnosis in the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09.
2. Repair any chafing that may have occurred.
3. Move the harness towards the driver's side of the vehicle and tuck in front of the 14401 harness
above the steering column. Use a tie strap to secure in place.
4. Replace the SWR sensor following WSM, Section 206-09.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082008A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor, Includes Time To Reposition Harness,
Check DTCs, Repair Wires If Required, And Calibrate New Sensor. (Do Not Use With 12650D,
14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Angle
Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set > Page 6381
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14401 12
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Angle
Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996
Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Angle
Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6386
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Angle
Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6387
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC
C1277/C1278 Set
TSB 08-20-8
10/13/08
STEERING WHEEL ANGLE CIRCUIT AND/OR SIGNAL FAILURE - C1277-C1278 - BUILT
ON/OR BEFORE 4/10/2008
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 08-10-3 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 4/10/2008 may
exhibit a traction control light (TCL) on with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1277 and/or C1278
(steering wheel angle 1 and 2 circuit failure and/or signal faulted).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check to see if the steering wheel rotation (SWR) sensor wiring near the connector has come in
contact with or is touching the brake pedal bracket. Vibration of the harness may cause interruption
in the SWR signal.
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, do not continue with this procedure. Refer to normal diagnosis in the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09.
2. Repair any chafing that may have occurred.
3. Move the harness towards the driver's side of the vehicle and tuck in front of the 14401 harness
above the steering column. Use a tie strap to secure in place.
4. Replace the SWR sensor following WSM, Section 206-09.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082008A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor, Includes Time To Reposition Harness,
Check DTCs, Repair Wires If Required, And Calibrate New Sensor. (Do Not Use With 12650D,
14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set > Page 6393
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14401 12
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon
ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6398
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6399
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Steering Angle
Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6400
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and
the steering wheel rotation sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.)
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6404
C2361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6405
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair
Stability/Traction Control Switch - Expedition
Stability/Traction Control Switch - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower instrument cluster center finish panel. 2. Remove the upper instrument cluster
center finish panel.
^ Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. Depress the 4 tabs and remove the traction control switch assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Traction Control
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6406
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 08-14-2 >
Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 08-14-2 >
Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6415
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 08-14-2 >
Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6416
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 07-25-6 >
Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation
TSB 07-25-6
12/24/07
ABS LIGHT ON - VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 2/15/2007
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 02/15/2007 may experience an
ABS light on and the base brake system continuing to function normally. This may be due to
corrosion in the connector of the rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition as it may be necessary to
replace the rear wheel speed sensor and the female side of the connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics. If the diagnostics lead to replacement of the
rear wheel speed sensor, follow these steps to prevent water leaking into the connector.
1. Disconnect the rear wheel speed sensor connector.
2. Inspect the female terminals, on the harness side of the connector (C440 and C426).
3. If corrosion or evidence of water damage is present, replace the connector with wiring pigtail kit
and follow the instruction sheet which is included.
4. Replace rear wheel speed sensor. Refer to WSM, Section 206-09.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072506A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: One Side (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
072506B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 2.4 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: Both Sides (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: > 07-25-6 >
Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation > Page 6421
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C204 95
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon
ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6427
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6428
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-25-6 > Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake
Operation
TSB 07-25-6
12/24/07
ABS LIGHT ON - VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 2/15/2007
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 02/15/2007 may experience an
ABS light on and the base brake system continuing to function normally. This may be due to
corrosion in the connector of the rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition as it may be necessary to
replace the rear wheel speed sensor and the female side of the connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics. If the diagnostics lead to replacement of the
rear wheel speed sensor, follow these steps to prevent water leaking into the connector.
1. Disconnect the rear wheel speed sensor connector.
2. Inspect the female terminals, on the harness side of the connector (C440 and C426).
3. If corrosion or evidence of water damage is present, replace the connector with wiring pigtail kit
and follow the instruction sheet which is included.
4. Replace rear wheel speed sensor. Refer to WSM, Section 206-09.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072506A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: One Side (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
072506B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 2.4 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: Both Sides (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-25-6 > Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation > Page 6433
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C204 95
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left/Right Front
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left/Right Front > Page 6436
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Left/Right Rear
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left/Right Front > Page 6437
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6440
C440
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6441
C160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6442
C426
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the wheel speed sensor
harness retainer bolt and detach the retainers.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the 2 caliper anchor bolts and position the caliper, pads and anchor plate aside. ^
Support the caliper with mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.)
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 6445
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake shoes. 2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the
retaining clips. 3. Remove the rear wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 >
ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Yaw Rate Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 >
ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6454
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 >
ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6455
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul
> 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Yaw Rate Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC
C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul
> 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6461
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul
> 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6462
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6463
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the bracket.
^ To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Yaw Rate Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6464
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6469
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tube fittings.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6470
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the anti-lock brake (ABS) hydraulic control unit (HCU)
has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the ABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in a
container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6471
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the scan tool.
Connect the scan tool to the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the dash and follow the scan
tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the scan tool service bleed procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6472
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Gravity
Gravity
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid. 2. Bleed the rear disc
brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH rear disc brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6473
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6474
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Manual
Manual
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the clean, specified brake fluid.
Never reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6475
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper. 6. Place a box-end wrench on the
RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6476
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6477
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tube fittings.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6478
with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the anti-lock brake (ABS) hydraulic control unit (HCU)
has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the ABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in a
container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the scan tool.
Connect the scan tool to the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the dash and follow the scan
tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the scan tool service bleed procedure.
Gravity
Gravity
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6479
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid. 2. Bleed the rear disc
brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH rear disc brake caliper.
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
Manual
Manual
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6480
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the clean, specified brake fluid.
Never reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper. 6. Place a box-end wrench on the
RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6481
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Pressure
Pressure
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6482
NOTE: Bleed the longest line first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough clean, specified brake
fluid to complete the bleeding operation.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 5. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then tighten rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
6. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
7. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter. 8. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid and install the
brake master cylinder filler cap.
Master Cylinder, Bench
Master Cylinder, Bench
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6483
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Support the brake master cylinder body in a vise and fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with
clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6484
3. Slowly depress the primary piston until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Pedal Assy: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple
DTC's
Brake Pedal Assy: Customer Interest Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Pedal Assy: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple
DTC's > Page 6493
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Pedal Assy: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No
Crank/Multiple DTC's
Brake Pedal Assy: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple
DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Pedal Assy: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No
Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 6499
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 6500
Brake Pedal Assy: Service and Repair
Brake Pedal and Bracket
Brake Pedal and Bracket
Removal and Installation
Adjustable pedal vehicles
1. CAUTION: The brake pedal and the accelerator pedal must be in the same position when
installing a new cable or a new pedal. The
pedals must be all the way forward or all the way rearward.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Pedal Assy > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 6501
Disconnect the battery negative cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. If equipped, disconnect the accelerator pedal-to-brake pedal cable from the adjustable brake
pedal motor.
All vehicles
3. CAUTION: Always remove the stoplamp switch with the brake pedal secured to the brake
booster push rod and with the brake pedal in
the at-rest position. Do not press or pull on the brake pedal when removing the switch or damage
to the switch can occur.
CAUTION: The stoplamp switch must be removed prior to removing the brake pedal and bracket,
brake booster and associated mounting fasteners or damage to the switch can occur.
Disconnect the electrical connector and turn the stoplamp switch clockwise to detach it from the
brake pedal bracket.
4. NOTE: An 11 mm, 12-point socket or wrench can be used to compress the 2 tabs on the brake
pedal arm pin.
Remove the brake pedal arm pin and disconnect the brake booster push rod from the brake pedal
arm.
5. Remove the bulkhead sound insulator. 6. Remove the 4 brake pedal bracket nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
7. Remove the 2 brake pedal bracket bolts and remove the brake pedal and bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper
Material
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6507
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the brake pads. 3. Remove the brake caliper flow bolt
and the 2 copper washers.
^ Discard the copper washers.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
4. Inspect the brake caliper for leaks.
^ If leaks are found, a new brake caliper must be installed.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6508
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Caliper
Material
Disc Brake System - Exploded View - Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6509
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the brake hose flow bolt and disconnect the hose.
^ Remove and discard the copper washers.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
3. Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin caps and bolts.
^ Inspect the guide pin threads for damage and inspect the guide pin bushings for damage/wear.
Install a new guide pin(s) and bushing(s) as necessary.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove the brake caliper and remove the brake pads from the caliper. 5. Inspect the disc brake
caliper dust boot for leaks and/or damage.
^ If leaks or damage are found, install a new brake caliper.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6510
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Front
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6511
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Removal
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted or plastic surfaces. Do not spill brake fluid onto painted
or plastic surfaces. If spilled, wipe up immediately.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid from the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional
information, refer to Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: If the anchor housing spring is to be removed, do not force the spring off the brake
caliper or damage to the spring can
occur.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6512
CAUTION: Do not use any tools to remove the spring, use hand force only. Do not use excessive
force or damage to the spring can occur.
NOTE: The LH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the upper
brake caliper cavity.
For the LH brake caliper, release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force to the center of the spring and pull outward at the bottom of the spring to remove it from
the lower brake caliper cavity.
4. Rotate the spring upward and remove it from the brake caliper.
5. NOTE: The RH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the lower
brake caliper cavity.
For the RH brake caliper, release the upper portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force to the center of the spring and pull outward at the top of the spring to remove it from the
upper brake caliper cavity.
6. Rotate the spring downward and remove it from the brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6513
7. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs to disengage them from the brake
caliper anchor plate.
8. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 guide pin bushing caps, remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and
position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ Remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bushings.
9. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the anchor plate.
Installation
1. Position the brake caliper anchor plate and install the 2 anchor plate bolts.
^ Tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.)
2. Install new brake hardware as follows:
1 Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
2 Apply grease to the inside of the guide pin bushings. Do not apply grease to the guide pin
threads.
3 Push the guide pins into the bushings.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the inner brake pad retaining springs are correctly seated onto the brake
caliper anchor plate.
Position the brake caliper assembly onto the anchor plate.
4. Install the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and the 2 bushing caps.
^ Tighten the bolts to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.)
5. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs until they are correctly seated on
the anchor plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6514
6. NOTE: If present, the 2-tabbed end of the anchor housing spring must be installed first.
Install the anchor housing spring using this procedure: 1
Insert the tab of the spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2 Twist the tab into the cavity (LH side in the upper brake caliper cavity, RH side in the lower brake
caliper cavity).
7. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown.
Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
8. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown.
Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the anchor plate.
9. Push down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched
and seated in the brake caliper cavities.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6515
10. NOTE: Latch MUST be positioned as shown.
Verify that the anchor housing spring is correctly latched by pulling on the spring.
11. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6516
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Rear
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6517
Disc Brake System - Exploded View - Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 brake fluid will cause permanent damage to
brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
^ If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is half full.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper and brake pad assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin caps and bolts and position the caliper and brake pad
assembly aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ Inspect the guide pin threads for damage and inspect the guide pin bushings for wear. Install a
new guide pin(s) and bushing(s) as necessary.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the brake caliper anchor plate.
^ Inspect the caliper anchor plate bolt threads for damage and foreign material. Install cleaned and
dried anchor plate bolts or install new as necessary.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Test the brakes for normal operation.
6. Clean, dry and inspect the brake caliper anchor plate. Apply a light coat of lubricant to the 4
brake pad contact points on the anchor plate as
indicated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications > Front
Brake Pad: Specifications Front
Brake Pads
Minimum thickness...............................................................................................................................
............................................... 2.0 mm (0.079 inch) Maximum thickness variation
(pad-to-pad).........................................................................................................................................
2.0 mm (0.079 inch) Maximum taper wear (in any
direction)...............................................................................................................................................
3.0 mm (0.118 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Specifications > Front > Page 6522
Brake Pad: Specifications Rear
Brake Pads
Minimum thickness...............................................................................................................................
............................................... 2.0 mm (0.079 inch) Maximum thickness variation
(pad-to-pad).........................................................................................................................................
2.0 mm (0.079 inch) Maximum taper wear (in any
direction)...............................................................................................................................................
3.0 mm (0.118 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Front
Brake Pads
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6525
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Removal
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted or plastic surfaces. Do not spill brake fluid onto painted
or plastic surfaces. If spilled, wipe up immediately.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid from the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional
information, refer to Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: If the anchor housing spring is to be removed, do not force the spring off the brake
caliper or damage to the spring can
occur.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6526
CAUTION: Do not use any tools to remove the spring, use hand force only. Do not use excessive
force or damage to the spring can occur.
NOTE: The LH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the upper
brake caliper cavity.
For the LH brake caliper, release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force to the center of the spring and pull outward at the bottom of the spring to remove it from
the lower brake caliper cavity.
4. Rotate the spring upward and remove it from the brake caliper.
5. NOTE: The RH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the lower
brake caliper cavity.
For the RH brake caliper, release the upper portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force to the center of the spring and pull outward at the top of the spring to remove it from the
upper brake caliper cavity.
6. Rotate the spring downward and remove it from the brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6527
7. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs to disengage them from the brake
caliper anchor plate.
8. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 guide pin busing caps, remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and
position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ Remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bushings.
9. Remove the 2 brake pads from the caliper.
10. Inspect the brake pads for wear and contamination, install new pads as necessary.
11. NOTE: Use a wood block or a used brake pad to protect the brake caliper piston boots.
Compress the brake caliper piston.
12. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install new as necessary.
Installation
1. Clean the brake pad contact areas of the brake caliper. 2. Install new brake hardware as follows:
1 Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
2 Apply grease to the inside of the guide pin bushings. Do not apply grease to the guide pin
threads.
3 Push the guide pins into the bushings.
3. Install the inboard brake pad onto the caliper. 4. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower
retaining springs 90 degrees.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6528
5. Remove the protective paper from the outboard brake pad and install it onto the brake caliper.
6. NOTE: Make sure that the inner brake pad retaining springs are correctly seated onto the brake
caliper anchor plate.
Position the brake caliper assembly onto the anchor plate.
7. Install the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and the 2 bushing caps.
^ Tighten the bolts to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.)
8. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs until they are correctly seated on
the anchor plate.
9. NOTE: If present, the 2-tabbed end of the anchor housing spring must be installed first.
Install the anchor housing spring using this procedure: 1
Insert the tab of the spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2 Twist the tab into the cavity (LH side in the upper brake caliper cavity, RH side in the lower brake
caliper cavity).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6529
10. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown.
Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
11. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown.
Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the anchor plate.
12. Push down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched
and seated in the brake caliper cavities.
13. NOTE: The latch MUST be positioned as shown.
Verify that the anchor housing spring is correctly latched by pulling on the spring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6530
14. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6531
Brake Pad: Service and Repair Rear
Brake Pads
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 6532
Disc Brake System - Exploded View - Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Using a suitable suction device, remove brake fluid in the master cylinder reservoir until the
reservoir is half full. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional
information, refer to Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper to hang by the flexible brake hose or damage to the
hose can occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin caps and bolts and position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ Inspect the guide pin threads for damage and inspect the guide pin bushings for damage/wear.
Install a new guide pin(s) and bushing(s) as necessary.
4. Remove the brake pads from the caliper.
5. CAUTION: Install new pads if the lining(s) are worn to or past the specified thickness above the
metal backing plate. Install new pads in
complete axle sets.
Inspect the brake pads for wear or contamination and install new pads as necessary.
6. Using a suitable clamp, press the piston into the caliper. 7. Inspect the brake disc and resurface
or install a new brake disc as necessary.
Installation
1. Clean, dry and inspect the brake caliper anchor plate. Apply a light coat of lubricant to the 4
brake pad contact points on the anchor plate as
indicated.
2. Install the brake pads to the caliper. 3. Position the caliper onto the anchor plate and install the 2
brake caliper guide pin bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
4. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Specifications > Front
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications Front
Brake Disc
Minimum thickness...............................................................................................................................
.............................................. 27.0 mm (1.06 inch) Minimum thickness to machine............................
............................................................................................................................... 27.6 mm (1.08
inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Specifications > Front > Page 6537
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications Rear
Brake Disc
Minimum thickness...............................................................................................................................
............................................... 19.0 mm (0.74 inch) Maximum runout..................................................
........................................................................................................................... 0.025 mm (0.001
inch) Maximum thickness variation.......................................................................................................
................................................... 0.013 mm (0.005 inch)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Rotor/Disc: Procedures
Brake Disc Machining
Material
CAUTION: Do not use a bench lathe to machine the brake discs.
NOTE: Read the entire operating manual and view the video shipped with the lathe before
installing, operating or repairing the lathe.
NOTE: If the thickness of the brake disc is less than the minimum thickness to machine
specification, install a new brake disc. This will make sure that the brake disc will be above
minimum thickness after machining.
NOTE: Do not machine new brake discs.
NOTE: Lateral runout and disc thickness variation measurements are not required because correct
adjustment of the on-vehicle brake lathe will make sure that these dimensions are within
specifications.
1. NOTE: It is not necessary to disconnect the brake line from the brake caliper.
Position the brake caliper and brake caliper anchor bracket aside.
2. For vehicles with a 2-piece brake disc and hub assembly:
1 Mark the brake disc and the wheel stud for correct indexing during re-assembly.
2 Remove the brake disc from the hub.
3 CAUTION: Do not use an abrasive sanding disc since it will remove paint or other protective
finishes from the wheel or metal from the mounting surfaces, adversely affecting corrosion
protection and brake disc lateral runout.
Remove corrosion from the wheel mounting surface, both disc mounting surfaces and hub
mounting surface.
4 Align the match marks and install the brake disc on the hub.
3. Machine the brake disc using an on-vehicle brake lathe.
1 Install the hub adapter and silencer belt if necessary.
2 Install the cutting lathe.
3 If the lathe is not self adjusting, adjust the lathe oscillation using a dial indicator. Total indicated
reading (TIR) target is 0.000 mm (0.000 inch), maximum is 0.08 mm (0.003 inch).
4 Center the cutting head, adjust the cutting bits and install the chip deflector.
5 NOTE: The depth of cut should be between 0.10 and 0.20 mm (0.004 and 0.008 inch). Lighter
cuts will cause the bit to heat up and wear faster. Heavier cuts will cause poor brake disc surface
finish.
Machine the brake disc.
6 Remove the lathe and, if installed, the silencer belt.
7 Remove the hub adapter.
4. Remove the metal shavings. 5. For vehicles with a 2-piece brake disc and hub assembly:
1 Remove the brake disc from the hub.
2 Remove metal shavings from the hub, the brake disc mounting surfaces and from the ABS
sensors.
3 Apply anti-seize lubricant to the hub mounting surface to prevent corrosion.
4 Align the match marks and install the brake disc on the hub.
6. NOTE: It is not required to install new brake pads if friction material properties are within
guidelines.
Install the brake caliper and brake caliper anchor bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6540
Brake Rotor/Disc: Removal and Replacement
Disc Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Disc
Removal and Installation
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
1. Remove the brake caliper anchor plate. 2. Remove the brake disc. 3. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Disc Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Disc
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6541
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL. position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang by the flexible
brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the brake caliper anchor plate bolts and position the anchor plate and caliper assembly
aside. ^
Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly with mechanic's wire.
^ Inspect the anchor plate bolt threads for damage and foreign material. Install cleaned and dried
anchor plate bolts or install new as necessary.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.)
3. NOTE: If the brake disc binds on the parking brake shoe, remove the adjustment hole access
plug and contract the parking brake shoe.
Remove the brake disc.
4. Inspect the brake disc and resurface or install a new brake disc as necessary. 5. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Shield Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Disc Shield
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6542
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
1. Remove the brake disc. 2. Remove the brake disc shield screws.
^ To install, tighten to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
3. Remove the brake disc shield. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6548
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tube fittings.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6549
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the anti-lock brake (ABS) hydraulic control unit (HCU)
has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the ABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in a
container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6550
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the scan tool.
Connect the scan tool to the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the dash and follow the scan
tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the scan tool service bleed procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6551
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Gravity
Gravity
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid. 2. Bleed the rear disc
brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH rear disc brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6552
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6553
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Manual
Manual
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the clean, specified brake fluid.
Never reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6554
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper. 6. Place a box-end wrench on the
RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6555
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6556
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tube fittings.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6557
with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: This procedure must be performed if the anti-lock brake (ABS) hydraulic control unit (HCU)
has been installed new.
NOTE: One conventional pressure bleed cycle consists of advancing the brake pedal to its
depressed position, opening the disc brake caliper bleeder screw, allowing fluid to be released into
the waste container, closing the disc brake caliper bleeder screw and releasing the brake pedal.
NOTE: Performing the diagnostic program routine drives entrapped air from the otherwise
inaccessible lower section of the ABS valve into the upper sections (accessible by bleeding the
brakes). Subsequent bleeding removes the air from the system.
NOTE: Add clean, specified brake fluid as necessary throughout the procedure.
1. Connect a clear hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and the other end in a
container partially filled with clean, specified brake
fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw, RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw and the LH front disc brake
caliper bleeder screw. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
6. NOTE: Go to the Help menu in the scan tool.
Connect the scan tool to the vehicle data link connector (DLC) under the dash and follow the scan
tool instructions.
7. Repeat the conventional bleed procedure as outlined in Steps 1 through 5. 8. If the brake pedal
feels spongy, repeat the scan tool service bleed procedure.
Gravity
Gravity
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6558
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied, or
partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent air from getting into the system.
1. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid. 2. Bleed the rear disc
brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH rear disc brake caliper.
3. Tighten the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
4. Bleed the front disc brake calipers.
^ Place a box-end wrench on the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw and submerge the
free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified brake fluid.
^ Open the bleeder screw and leave open until clear bubble-free brake fluid flows. Repeat for LH front disc brake caliper.
5. Tighten the front disc brake caliper bleeder screws.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
Manual
Manual
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6559
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with the clean, specified brake fluid.
Never reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
2. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 3.
Loosen the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
4. Tighten the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 for the LH rear disc brake caliper. 6. Place a box-end wrench on the
RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain hose to the RH front disc brake
caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the tube in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6560
7. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal. 8.
Loosen the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have
an assistant maintain pressure on the brake
pedal while tightening the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. ^
Repeat until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
^ Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary.
9. Tighten the RH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw.
^ Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
10. Repeat Steps 6 through 9 for the LH front disc brake caliper bleeder screw. 11. If necessary,
bleed the brake master cylinder.
Pressure
Pressure
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6561
NOTE: Bleed the longest line first. Be sure the bleeder tank contains enough clean, specified brake
fluid to complete the bleeding operation.
1. Clean all dirt from and remove the brake master cylinder filler cap and fill the brake master
cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid.
2. NOTE: Master cylinder pressure bleeder adapter tools are available from various manufacturers
of pressure bleeding equipment. Follow the
instructions of the manufacturer when installing the adapter.
Install the bleeder adapter to the brake master cylinder reservoir and attach the bleeder tank hose
to the fitting on the adapter.
3. Place a box-end wrench on the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Attach a rubber drain
hose to the RH rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and submerge the free end of the hose in a container partially filled with clean, specified
brake fluid.
4. Open the valve on the bleeder tank. 5. Loosen the rear disc brake caliper bleeder screw. Leave
open until clear, bubble-free brake fluid flows, then tighten rear disc brake caliper bleeder
screw and remove the rubber hose. ^
Tighten to 16 Nm (12 ft. lbs.)
6. Continue bleeding the rest of the system, going in order from the LH rear disc brake caliper to
the RH front disc brake caliper, ending with the LH
front disc brake caliper.
7. Close the bleeder tank valve and remove the tank hose from the adapter and remove the
adapter. 8. Fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with clean, specified brake fluid and install the
brake master cylinder filler cap.
Master Cylinder, Bench
Master Cylinder, Bench
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6562
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Support the brake master cylinder body in a vise and fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with
clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System Information
> Service and Repair > Master Cylinder, In Vehicle > Page 6563
3. Slowly depress the primary piston until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Front
Brake Caliper
Material
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6568
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the brake pads. 3. Remove the brake caliper flow bolt
and the 2 copper washers.
^ Discard the copper washers.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
4. Inspect the brake caliper for leaks.
^ If leaks are found, a new brake caliper must be installed.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6569
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Caliper Removal and Installation, Rear
Brake Caliper
Material
Disc Brake System - Exploded View - Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6570
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Remove the brake hose flow bolt and disconnect the hose.
^ Remove and discard the copper washers.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
3. Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin caps and bolts.
^ Inspect the guide pin threads for damage and inspect the guide pin bushings for damage/wear.
Install a new guide pin(s) and bushing(s) as necessary.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove the brake caliper and remove the brake pads from the caliper. 5. Inspect the disc brake
caliper dust boot for leaks and/or damage.
^ If leaks or damage are found, install a new brake caliper.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6571
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Front
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6572
Disc Brake System - Exploded View
Removal
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted or plastic surfaces. Do not spill brake fluid onto painted
or plastic surfaces. If spilled, wipe up immediately.
1. If necessary, using a suitable suction device, remove the brake fluid from the master cylinder
reservoir until it is half filled. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional
information, refer to Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: If the anchor housing spring is to be removed, do not force the spring off the brake
caliper or damage to the spring can
occur.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6573
CAUTION: Do not use any tools to remove the spring, use hand force only. Do not use excessive
force or damage to the spring can occur.
NOTE: The LH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the upper
brake caliper cavity.
For the LH brake caliper, release the lower portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force to the center of the spring and pull outward at the bottom of the spring to remove it from
the lower brake caliper cavity.
4. Rotate the spring upward and remove it from the brake caliper.
5. NOTE: The RH side anchor housing spring must be installed with the 2-tabbed end in the lower
brake caliper cavity.
For the RH brake caliper, release the upper portion of the anchor housing spring. ^
Apply force to the center of the spring and pull outward at the top of the spring to remove it from the
upper brake caliper cavity.
6. Rotate the spring downward and remove it from the brake caliper.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6574
7. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs to disengage them from the brake
caliper anchor plate.
8. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
occur.
Remove the 2 guide pin bushing caps, remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and
position the caliper aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ Remove and discard the 2 brake caliper guide pin bushings.
9. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the anchor plate.
Installation
1. Position the brake caliper anchor plate and install the 2 anchor plate bolts.
^ Tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.)
2. Install new brake hardware as follows:
1 Install the guide pin bushings into the caliper bores.
2 Apply grease to the inside of the guide pin bushings. Do not apply grease to the guide pin
threads.
3 Push the guide pins into the bushings.
3. NOTE: Make sure that the inner brake pad retaining springs are correctly seated onto the brake
caliper anchor plate.
Position the brake caliper assembly onto the anchor plate.
4. Install the 2 brake caliper guide pin bolts and the 2 bushing caps.
^ Tighten the bolts to 55 Nm (41 ft. lbs.)
5. Rotate the outer brake pad upper and lower retaining springs until they are correctly seated on
the anchor plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6575
6. NOTE: If present, the 2-tabbed end of the anchor housing spring must be installed first.
Install the anchor housing spring using this procedure: 1
Insert the tab of the spring into the brake caliper cavity.
2 Twist the tab into the cavity (LH side in the upper brake caliper cavity, RH side in the lower brake
caliper cavity).
7. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown.
Rotate the anchor housing spring and position the upper portion onto the anchor plate.
8. NOTE: LH anchor housing spring shown.
Position the other anchor housing spring portion onto the anchor plate.
9. Push down and inward until the upper and lower ends of the anchor housing spring are latched
and seated in the brake caliper cavities.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6576
10. NOTE: Latch MUST be positioned as shown.
Verify that the anchor housing spring is correctly latched by pulling on the spring.
11. Apply the brake several times to verify correct brake operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6577
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Brake Caliper Anchor Plate, Rear
Brake Caliper Anchor Plate
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Caliper Removal and Installation, Front > Page 6578
Disc Brake System - Exploded View - Rear Brake Disc Components
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 brake fluid will cause permanent damage to
brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these instructions may
result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Check the brake fluid level in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
^ If required, remove the fluid until the brake master cylinder reservoir is half full.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair.
3. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper and brake pad assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose can occur.
Remove the 2 brake caliper guide pin caps and bolts and position the caliper and brake pad
assembly aside. ^
Support the caliper using mechanic's wire.
^ Inspect the guide pin threads for damage and inspect the guide pin bushings for wear. Install a
new guide pin(s) and bushing(s) as necessary.
^ To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove the 2 brake caliper anchor plate bolts and the brake caliper anchor plate.
^ Inspect the caliper anchor plate bolt threads for damage and foreign material. Install cleaned and
dried anchor plate bolts or install new as necessary.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Test the brakes for normal operation.
6. Clean, dry and inspect the brake caliper anchor plate. Apply a light coat of lubricant to the 4
brake pad contact points on the anchor plate as
indicated.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component Information
> Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Motorcraft High Performance DOT 3 Motor Vehicle Brake Fluid
Ford P/N ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. PM-1-C Ford Specification ...............................................
.....................................................................................................................................
WSS-M6C62-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6585
C124
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock
Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair
Hydraulic Control Unit (HCU)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock
Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6589
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical connector.
3. CAUTION: Only authorized inlet hydraulic brake tubes should be used. These tubes are of
specific design and only authorized parts
should be used when installing new inlet brake tubes.
NOTE: Plug each open port to prevent brake fluid from spilling.
Disconnect the 6 brake tube fittings. ^
To install: tighten the master cylinder brake tube fittings to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
- tighten the remaining brake tube fittings to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove the 3 hydraulic control unit (HCU)-to-bracket bolts and the HCU.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Brake Master Cylinder: Procedures
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Master Cylinder, In Vehicle
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. NOTE: When a new brake master cylinder has been installed or the system has been emptied,
or partially emptied, it should be primed to prevent
air from getting into the system.
Disconnect the brake master cylinder outlet tubes.
2. Install short brake tubes with ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir and fill the
brake master cylinder reservoir with clean,
specified brake fluid.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6594
3. Have an assistant pump the brake pedal until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes and install the brake outlet tubes. 5. Bleed each brake
tube at the brake master cylinder as follows:
1 Have an assistant pump the brake pedal and then hold firm pressure on the brake pedal.
2 Loosen the rearmost brake tube fitting until a stream of brake fluid comes out. Have an assistant
maintain pressure on the brake pedal while tightening the brake tube fitting.
3 Repeat this operation until clear, bubble-free fluid comes out.
4 Refill the brake master cylinder reservoir as necessary. Repeat the bleeding operation at the front
brake tube.
6. While the assistant maintains pressure on the brake pedal, tighten the brake tube fittings.
^ Tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
Master Cylinder, Bench
Master Cylinder, Bench
Special Tool(s)
Material
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Do not allow the brake master cylinder reservoir to run dry during the bleeding
operation. Keep the brake master cylinder reservoir filled with clean, specified brake fluid. Never
reuse the brake fluid that has been drained from the hydraulic system.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
NOTE: When any part of the hydraulic system has been disconnected for repair or new installation,
air may get into the system and cause spongy brake pedal action. This requires bleeding of the
hydraulic system after it has been correctly connected. The hydraulic system can be bled manually
or
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6595
with pressure bleeding equipment.
1. Support the brake master cylinder body in a vise and fill the brake master cylinder reservoir with
clean, specified brake fluid.
2. Install short brake tubes with the ends submerged in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
3. Slowly depress the primary piston until clear fluid flows from both brake tubes, without air
bubbles. 4. Remove the short brake tubes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6596
Brake Master Cylinder: Removal and Replacement
Brake Master Cylinder
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6597
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Use of any other than approved DOT 3 motor vehicle brake fluid will cause permanent
damage to brake components and will render the brakes inoperative. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in personal injury.
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product label. For EMERGENCY MEDICAL
INFORMATION seek medical advice. In the USA or Canada on Ford/Motorcraft products call:
1-800-959-3673. For additional information, consult the product Material Safety Data Sheet
(MSDS) if available. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Brake fluid is harmful to painted and plastic surfaces. If brake fluid is spilled onto a
painted or plastic surface, immediately wash it with water.
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Disconnect
the brake fluid level switch. 3. Loosen the brake tube fittings and disconnect the brake tubes.
^ Plug the master cylinder ports.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove the 2 brake master cylinder nuts and the brake master cylinder.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Bleed the brake system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Actuator > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Actuator: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Release Solenoid
Parking Brake Release Solenoid
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking brake release solenoid electrical connector. 2. Remove the parking brake
release solenoid.
^ Pry the mounting bracket apart slightly to release the solenoid.
^ Disengage the solenoid from the release lever.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Parking Brake Cable: Procedures
Parking Brake Cable Tension Release
1. Remove the LH cowl side trim panel. For additional information, refer to Trim Panel. 2. With the
help of an assistant, release the parking brake cable tension by pulling down on the intermediate
cable at the cable-to-cable connector clip
until the parking brake control sector rotates to its stop and a 4 mm (0.15 inch) x 150 mm (5.9 inch)
retainer pin can be inserted.
3. Disconnect the cable-to-cable connector clip.
4. To reload the tension on the parking brake cable, follow the release procedure in reverse.
^ Make sure the cable-to-cable connector clip is connected to the front and rear cable before
removing the brake control retaining pin, and the cable tension is reloaded slowly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6606
Parking Brake Cable: Removal and Replacement
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, LH
Removal and Installation
1. Relieve the tension on the parking brake cable system. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position
it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to Maintenance/Service and Repair. 3. Separate the
LH rear cable from the equalizer. 4. Remove the conduit from the bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6607
1 Compress the 2 tabs.
2 Remove the conduit from the bracket.
5. NOTE: Be sure to correctly install the park brake cable retainer spring and route cables between
suspension links.
Remove the LH rear cable. 1
Remove the LH rear cable from the retaining clip.
2 Disconnect the park brake cable retainer spring.
3 If equipped, disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) sensor wire from the retaining clip.
6. Remove the wireform bracket retaining bolt and the bracket.
^ To install, tighten to 17 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
7. Compress the retainer and release the conduit, then unclip the cable end fitting from the parking
brake shoe lever. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, RH
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6608
Parking Brake Cable - Rear, RH
Removal and Installation
1. Relieve the tension on the parking brake cable system. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position
it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to Maintenance/Service and Repair. 3. Disconnect the
RH rear cable from the cable union. 4. Compress the 2 tabs and release the conduit from the
equalizer. 5. Remove the RH rear cable from the retaining clip. 6. Remove the bolt and the wire
form bracket from the LH side of the vehicle.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
7. Remove the rear park brake cable-to-crossmember bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6609
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
8. Remove the bolt and the wire form bracket from the RH side of the vehicle.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
9. Compress the 2 tabs and release the conduit, then unclip the cable end fitting from the parking
brake shoe lever.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Parking Brake Cable - Front
Parking Brake Cable - Front
Parking Brake Cable - Front
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake control. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For
additional information, refer to Maintenance/Service and Repair.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 6610
3. Remove the front park brake cable P-clip-to-frame bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
4. Remove the front parking brake cable and conduit.
^ Pry the rubber seal from the front floor pan.
^ Compress the retainer and release the conduit from the bracket.
^ Remove the front cable and conduit from the cable union.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Control: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Control
Parking Brake Control
Removal and Installation
1. Relieve tension on the parking brake cable system. 2. If equipped, remove the parking brake
release solenoid. 3. Remove the door scuff plate. 4. Remove the 2 screws and the instrument
panel steering column cover.
^ Pull the weatherstrip back to release the edge of the panel.
5. Remove the parking brake release handle bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.)
6. Remove the retainer and the cowl trim panel. 7. Compress the 2 tabs and disconnect the parking
brake release cable from the parking brake control assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Control > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6614
8. Disconnect the parking brake release cable from the release lever and remove the parking brake
release handle.
9. Disconnect the parking brake switch electrical connector.
10. Remove the 3 parking brake control assembly bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
11. Position the parking brake control assembly onto the floor. 12. Disconnect the parking brake
cable from the take-up spool.
13. Compress the 2 tabs, disconnect the parking brake cable from the control assembly and
remove the control assembly.
14. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Release Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams
C2132
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Parking Brake Shoe: Service and Repair
Parking Brake Shoes
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6621
Removal
1. Relieve the tension on the parking brake cable system. 2. Remove the brake disc. 3. Remove
the front parking brake shoe retaining clip and pin. 4. Remove the parking brake shoe adjuster.
^ Using a suitable tool, spread the bottom of the parking brake shoes apart.
^ Remove the parking brake shoe adjuster.
5. Remove the parking brake shoe adjuster spring. 6. Slide the front parking brake shoe up and out
of the guide flange. 7. Remove the front parking brake shoe.
^ Rotate the front parking brake shoe outward.
^ Remove the parking brake shoe return spring.
8. Remove the rear parking brake shoe.
^ Remove the retaining clip and pin.
^ Remove the rear parking brake shoe.
9. Inspect the components for excessive wear or damage and install new parts as required.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Apply the grease only where indicated, do not apply the grease to the parking brake
shoes. The grease will contaminate the
brake shoe linings and damage to the linings will result.
Apply a light coat of grease to the 6 parking brake shoe contact points on the disc brake shield.
2. Install the rear parking brake shoe.
^ Hold the rear parking brake shoe in position.
^ Install the retaining pin and clip.
3. Install the front parking brake shoe.
^ Install the parking brake shoe return spring to the rear parking brake shoe and to the front parking
brake shoe.
^ Rotate the front parking brake shoe into the guide flange.
4. Slide the front parking brake shoe down into position on the flange. 5. Install the front parking
brake shoe retaining pin and clip. 6. Install the parking brake shoe adjuster spring. 7. Install the
parking brake shoe adjuster.
^ Using a suitable tool, spread the bottom of the parking brake shoes apart.
^ Install the parking brake shoe adjuster.
8. Using the special tool, measure the inside diameter of the drum portion of the rear brake disc.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Shoe > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 6622
^ Record the measurement.
9. NOTE: Make sure that the parking brake shoes are correctly centered. Take the measurement at
the widest point across the center of the parking
brake shoes.
Using the special tool, measure the parking brake shoe diameter. ^
Rotate the adjuster to set the parking brake shoe diameter to 0.45 mm (0.02 inch) less than the
recorded inside diameter of the drum portion of the rear brake disc.
10. Install the brake disc.
11. NOTE: This step will require the aid of an assistant.
Enable the parking brake cable system. ^
Pull down on the front parking brake cable at the coupler.
^ Remove the retaining pin from the parking brake lever.
12. Check the parking brake for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (LH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6626
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Brake Booster Vacuum Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6631
C149
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Specifications
Vacuum Brake Booster: Specifications
Torque Specifications
Torque Specifications (Part 1)
Torque Specifications (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Booster
Vacuum Brake Booster: Description and Operation Brake Booster
Brake Booster
The power brake booster: ^
is a dual diaphragm, vacuum-assisted power brake booster.
^ reduces brake pedal pressure and travel distance.
^ is divided into separate vacuum and atmospheric pressure chambers by a diaphragm.
If the power assist fails, the brake system will continue to operate with increased brake pedal effort.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Booster > Page 6637
Vacuum Brake Booster: Description and Operation Hose and Check Valve
Hose and Check Valve
The power brake booster check valve: ^
closes when the engine is turned off.
^ in the closed position, traps engine vacuum in the power brake booster.
^ retains vacuum to provide several power-assisted brake applications with the engine off.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6638
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection
Brake Booster
1. Check the hydraulic brake system for leaks or insufficient fluid. 2. With the transmission in
NEUTRAL, stop the engine and apply the parking brake control. Apply the brake pedal several
times to exhaust all
vacuum in the system.
3. Apply the brake pedal and hold it in the applied position. Start the engine. If the vacuum system
is operating, the brake pedal will tend to move
downward under constant foot pressure. If no motion is felt, the power brake booster system is not
functioning.
Brake Booster Operation
1. Remove the vacuum booster hose from the check valve connection. Manifold vacuum must be
available at the check valve end of the vacuum
booster hose with the engine at idle speed and the transmission in NEUTRAL. If the manifold
vacuum is available to the power brake booster, connect the vacuum booster hose to the power
brake booster check valve and repeat Steps 2 and 3 of the Brake Booster check. If no downward
movement of the brake pedal is felt, install a new power brake booster.
2. Operate the engine a minimum of 10 seconds at fast idle. Stop the engine, and let the vehicle
stand for 10 minutes. Then apply the brake pedal
with approximately 89 N (20 lb) of force. The brake pedal feel should be the same as that noted
with the engine operating. If the brake pedal feels hard (no power assist), install a new power brake
booster check valve and retest. If the brake pedal feels spongy, bleed the hydraulic system to
remove air.
Check Valve
The function of the power brake booster check valve is to allow manifold vacuum to enter the
power brake booster and prevent the escape of vacuum in case manifold vacuum is lost during
sustained full throttle operation.
To test the function of the power brake booster check valve: ^
start and run the engine for at least 10 seconds.
^ operate the brake pedal to check for power assist.
^ disconnect the vacuum booster hose from the power brake booster. Do not remove the power
brake booster check valve from the power brake booster.
^ there should be enough vacuum retained in the power brake booster for at least one more
power-assisted brake operation.
Brake Master Cylinder - Bypass Condition
1. Disconnect the brake tubes at the brake master cylinder. 2. Plug the outlet ports of the brake
master cylinder. 3. Apply the brakes. If brake pedal height cannot be maintained, the brake master
cylinder has an internal leak and a new one must be installed.
Brake Master Cylinder - Compensator Port
The purpose of the compensator ports in the brake master cylinder is to supply any additional
brake fluid required by the system due to brake pad wear and to allow brake fluid returning from the
brake tubes to the brake master cylinder to enter the brake master cylinder reservoir.
The returning brake fluid will cause a slight turbulence in the brake master cylinder reservoir.
Turbulence seen in the brake master cylinder reservoir upon release of the brake pedal is normal
and shows that the compensating ports are not plugged.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6639
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair
Brake Booster
Brake Booster
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery. 2. Loosen the
clamp and separate the air cleaner outlet tube and resonator from the air cleaner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 6640
3. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 4. Lift the air cleaner assembly
from the air cleaner tray. 5. Remove the 3 power steering fluid reservoir screws and position the
reservoir aside.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 ft. lbs.)
6. Depress the brake pedal at least 3 times to deplete the vacuum in the booster. 7. Disconnect the
brake fluid level switch.
8. NOTE: Support the master cylinder with mechanic's wire.
Remove and discard the 2 brake master cylinder nuts and position the master cylinder aside. ^
To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
9. Remove the 2 degas bottle bolts and position the degas bottle aside.
^ To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
Vehicles equipped with roll stability control
10. Disconnect the brake pedal travel solenoid electrical connector.
All vehicles
11. Disconnect the brake pedal travel sensor electrical connector. 12. Disconnect the manifold
vacuum outlet assembly from the brake booster.
13. CAUTION: Always remove the stoplamp switch with the brake pedal secured to the brake
booster push rod and with the brake pedal in
the at-rest position. Do not press or pull on the brake pedal when removing the switch or damage
to switch can occur.
CAUTION: The stoplamp switch must be removed prior to removing the brake pedal and bracket,
brake booster and associated mounting fasteners or damage to the switch can occur.
Disconnect the electrical connector and turn the stoplamp switch clockwise to detach it from the
brake pedal bracket.
14. Remove the brake pedal arm pin and disconnect the booster push rod from the brake pedal
arm. 15. Remove the 4 brake booster-to-pedal bracket nuts and remove the brake booster.
^ To access the retaining nuts, fold back the sound insulation.
^ To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 ft. lbs.)
16. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Vacuum Brake Booster Check Valve: Testing and Inspection
Check Valve
The function of the power brake booster check valve is to allow manifold vacuum to enter the
power brake booster and prevent the escape of vacuum in case manifold vacuum is lost during
sustained full throttle operation.
To test the function of the power brake booster check valve: ^
start and run the engine for at least 10 seconds.
^ operate the brake pedal to check for power assist.
^ disconnect the vacuum booster hose from the power brake booster. Do not remove the power
brake booster check valve from the power brake booster.
^ there should be enough vacuum retained in the power brake booster for at least one more
power-assisted brake operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brakes > Trailer Brake Control Module > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brakes > Trailer Brake Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6648
C2142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake
Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Electronic Brake Control Module: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC
C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake
Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6658
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake
Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6659
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Electronic Brake Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Electronic Brake Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon
ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Electronic Brake Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page
6665
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Electronic Brake Control Module: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page
6666
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6667
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6668
C135
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6669
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Module
Removal and Installation
NOTE: When installing a new module, it must be calibrated and configured (either by
download/upload or uploading the as-built data method).
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable. For additional information, refer to Battery.
2. Disconnect the air cleaner outlet pipe from the air cleaner cover.
^ to install, tighten the clamps to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.)
3. Disconnect the mass air flow (MAF) sensor electrical connector. 4. Release the retaining clips
and position the air cleaner cover aside. 5. Remove the 3 hydraulic control unit (HCU) bracket
bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.)
6. Disconnect the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module electrical connector. 7. Remove the 4 bolts
and the ABS module.
^ To install, tighten to 2 Nm (18 inch lbs.)
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ If installing a new ABS module, program the module. For additional information, refer to
Information Bus (Module Configuration).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Trailer Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 6673
C2142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations
ABS Sensor Block: Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 6678
View 151-22 (RH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 6679
C3073
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 6680
ABS Sensor Block: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the bracket.
^ To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Sensor Block > Component Information > Locations > Page 6681
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Booster Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Booster Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 6685
C149
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6689
C124
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lateral Accelerometer: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the bracket.
^ To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Lateral
Accelerometer > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6693
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (LH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6697
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering
Angle Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set
TSB 08-20-8
10/13/08
STEERING WHEEL ANGLE CIRCUIT AND/OR SIGNAL FAILURE - C1277-C1278 - BUILT
ON/OR BEFORE 4/10/2008
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 08-10-3 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 4/10/2008 may
exhibit a traction control light (TCL) on with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1277 and/or C1278
(steering wheel angle 1 and 2 circuit failure and/or signal faulted).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check to see if the steering wheel rotation (SWR) sensor wiring near the connector has come in
contact with or is touching the brake pedal bracket. Vibration of the harness may cause interruption
in the SWR signal.
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, do not continue with this procedure. Refer to normal diagnosis in the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09.
2. Repair any chafing that may have occurred.
3. Move the harness towards the driver's side of the vehicle and tuck in front of the 14401 harness
above the steering column. Use a tie strap to secure in place.
4. Replace the SWR sensor following WSM, Section 206-09.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082008A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor, Includes Time To Reposition Harness,
Check DTCs, Repair Wires If Required, And Calibrate New Sensor. (Do Not Use With 12650D,
14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering
Angle Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set > Page 6706
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14401 12
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering
Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996
Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering
Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6711
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering
Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6712
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC
C1277/C1278 Set
TSB 08-20-8
10/13/08
STEERING WHEEL ANGLE CIRCUIT AND/OR SIGNAL FAILURE - C1277-C1278 - BUILT
ON/OR BEFORE 4/10/2008
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 08-10-3 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built on or before 4/10/2008 may
exhibit a traction control light (TCL) on with diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) C1277 and/or C1278
(steering wheel angle 1 and 2 circuit failure and/or signal faulted).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check to see if the steering wheel rotation (SWR) sensor wiring near the connector has come in
contact with or is touching the brake pedal bracket. Vibration of the harness may cause interruption
in the SWR signal.
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, do not continue with this procedure. Refer to normal diagnosis in the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09.
2. Repair any chafing that may have occurred.
3. Move the harness towards the driver's side of the vehicle and tuck in front of the 14401 harness
above the steering column. Use a tie strap to secure in place.
4. Replace the SWR sensor following WSM, Section 206-09.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082008A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace The Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor, Includes Time To Reposition Harness,
Check DTCs, Repair Wires If Required, And Calibrate New Sensor. (Do Not Use With 12650D,
14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-20-8 > Oct > 08 > ABS/TCS - TC Lamp ON/DTC C1277/C1278 Set > Page 6718
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14401 12
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Steering Angle Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon
ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6723
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Steering Angle Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6724
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Steering
Angle Sensor, Traction Control > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6725
Steering Angle Sensor: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Steering Wheel Rotation Sensor
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the steering wheel rotation sensor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and
the steering wheel rotation sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 inch lbs.)
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6729
C2361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6730
Traction Control Switch: Service and Repair
Stability/Traction Control Switch - Expedition
Stability/Traction Control Switch - Expedition
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the lower instrument cluster center finish panel. 2. Remove the upper instrument cluster
center finish panel.
^ Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. Depress the 4 tabs and remove the traction control switch assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Traction
Control Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 6731
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6740
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6741
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-25-6 > Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation
TSB 07-25-6
12/24/07
ABS LIGHT ON - VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 2/15/2007
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 02/15/2007 may experience an
ABS light on and the base brake system continuing to function normally. This may be due to
corrosion in the connector of the rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition as it may be necessary to
replace the rear wheel speed sensor and the female side of the connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics. If the diagnostics lead to replacement of the
rear wheel speed sensor, follow these steps to prevent water leaking into the connector.
1. Disconnect the rear wheel speed sensor connector.
2. Inspect the female terminals, on the harness side of the connector (C440 and C426).
3. If corrosion or evidence of water damage is present, replace the connector with wiring pigtail kit
and follow the instruction sheet which is included.
4. Replace rear wheel speed sensor. Refer to WSM, Section 206-09.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072506A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: One Side (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
072506B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 2.4 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: Both Sides (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
07-25-6 > Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation > Page 6746
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C204 95
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon
ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6752
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6753
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 07-25-6 > Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake
Operation
TSB 07-25-6
12/24/07
ABS LIGHT ON - VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 2/15/2007
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 02/15/2007 may experience an
ABS light on and the base brake system continuing to function normally. This may be due to
corrosion in the connector of the rear wheel speed sensor.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition as it may be necessary to
replace the rear wheel speed sensor and the female side of the connector.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM) diagnostics. If the diagnostics lead to replacement of the
rear wheel speed sensor, follow these steps to prevent water leaking into the connector.
1. Disconnect the rear wheel speed sensor connector.
2. Inspect the female terminals, on the harness side of the connector (C440 and C426).
3. If corrosion or evidence of water damage is present, replace the connector with wiring pigtail kit
and follow the instruction sheet which is included.
4. Replace rear wheel speed sensor. Refer to WSM, Section 206-09.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072506A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.8 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: One Side (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
072506B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 2.4 Hrs.
Replace Wheel Speed Sensor And, Harness Side Female Wiring Connector, Includes Time To
Diagnose: Both Sides (Do Not Use With 2219D, 2219D5, 14200A)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 07-25-6 > Dec > 07 > Brakes - ABS Lamp ON/Normal Brake Operation > Page 6758
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C204 95
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left/Right Front
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left/Right Front > Page 6761
Wheel Speed Sensor: Locations Left/Right Rear
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Left/Right Front > Page 6762
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front
C150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6765
C440
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6766
C160
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front > Page 6767
C426
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Wheel Speed Sensor - Front
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE: If equipped, turn the air suspension switch to the OFF position.
With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist
2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the wheel speed sensor
harness retainer bolt and detach the retainers.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the 2 caliper anchor bolts and position the caliper, pads and anchor plate aside. ^
Support the caliper with mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 ft. lbs.)
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Remove the front wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor - Front > Page 6770
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Wheel Speed Sensor - Rear
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the parking brake shoes. 2. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor harness from the
retaining clips. 3. Remove the rear wheel speed sensor bolt and the sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul >
08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Yaw Rate Sensor: Customer Interest ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul >
08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6779
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Yaw Rate Sensor: > 08-14-2 > Jul >
08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6780
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Yaw Rate Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set
Yaw Rate Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC
C1996 Set
TSB 08-14-2
07/21/08
STABILITY/TRACTION CONTROL INDICATOR - SLIDING-CAR ICON-ON OR FLASHING - DTC
C1996 OR SENSITIVE ESC/RSC ACTIVATION NO CODES
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with electronic stability
control (ESC)/roll stability control (RSC) may exhibit the stability/traction control indicator
"sliding-car icon" on or flashing with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) C1996 or sensitive ESC/RSC
activation with no codes.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE EVALUATION PROCEDURE
Determine if this procedure applies by answering the following questions:
1. Was the customer pulling a trailer when the concern occurred?
a. No, go to question 2.
b. Yes, do not proceed with this procedure. Vehicles pulling heavy trailers have the possibility to
have a sensitive activation or DTC C1996. This is a normal characteristic and no corrective action
needed.
2. Was the stability/traction control indicator "sliding-car icon" on or flashing during the concern?
a. No, do not proceed with this procedure and refer to normal workshop manual diagnostics.
b. Yes, proceed to question 3.
3. Did the concern occur during acceleration?
a. Yes, proceed to question 4.
b. If no, go to question 5.
4. Test drive the vehicle on curves and/or bumpy roads. Monitor all four wheel speed sensors.
^ Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor (LF_WSPD).
^ Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor (RL_WSPD).
^ Left Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (LR_WSPD).
^ Right Rear Wheel Speed Sensor (RR_WSPD).
^ Are the values similar +/- 6 MPH (10 Km/h)?
a. No, they vary, proceed to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 5.
b. Yes, go to question 5.
5. Has this concern occurred more than once?
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Yaw Rate Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6786
a. Yes, go to question 6.
b. No, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
6. Has the Stability Control Sensor Cluster been previously replaced?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. No, go to question 7.
7. Did the activation occur in less than 2 minutes after starting and driving the vehicle?
a. Yes, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 6.
b. If no, go to Diagnostic Service Procedure Step 1.
DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Are after market accessories installed?
a. Yes, repair sources of vibration (sub-woofer, modified center console). Proceed to Step 2.
b. No, proceed to Step 2.
2. Steering wheel angle (SWA) sensor inspection.
a. Visually inspect the optical tone ring for contamination or debris.
(1) Clean as necessary.
b. Inspect the SWA connector for looseness. Reconnect as necessary.
(1) Push, click, and pull to verify a good connection.
c. Visually inspect around the area of the steering column/tone ring for signs of light entering the
cabin, shining through the windshield between the defroster grill and instrument panel (IP).
Defroster grill variation may allow for slight gaps, enough to leak light.
(1) Use IP colored foam to block any gaps (tape not recommended as it may loosen and fall off).
(2) If no problems found with the SWA system, proceed to Step 3.
3. Inspect mounting/torque of the bolts holding the stability control sensor cluster in position.
a. Look for looseness of bolts or distortion of the sheet metal.
b. Check the connector (pin push outs) and wiring (chafe) to the stability control sensor cluster.
c. If no problems found with the stability control sensor cluster proceed to Step 4.
4. Start engine and keep vehicle at a stand still. Monitor the YAW rate PID value for the Stability
Control Sensor Cluster. Expected values: +/- 2.0 d/s YAW.
a. If not within specification, replace the Stability Control Sensor Cluster per the Workshop Manual
(WSM), Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems.
b. If within specification, go to Step 5.
5. Refer to Symptom Chart in the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle Dynamic Systems: Unintended
ABS activation, ABS too sensitive, ABS activates on a normal stop.
a. If no problem found with the base brakes or wheel speed sensors, proceed to Step 6.
6. If all steps above have no concern or are repaired and concern still exhibited, or you have been
previously directed to this step, replace the ABS module per the WSM, Section 206-09: Vehicle
Dynamic Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Yaw Rate Sensor: >
08-14-2 > Jul > 08 > ABS/TCS - Sliding Car Icon ON/Flashing/DTC C1996 Set > Page 6787
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081402 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2C219 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6788
Yaw Rate Sensor: Service and Repair
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Stability Control Sensor Cluster
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The lateral and longitudinal accelerometer and the roll rate sensor are located within the
yaw rate sensor, stability control sensor cluster.
1. Remove the front floor console. For additional information, refer to Console. 2. Disconnect the
stability control sensor cluster electrical connector. 3. Remove the 4 bolts and the bracket.
^ To install: Tighten the upper bolts to 9 Nm (80 inch lbs.)
- Tighten the lower bolts to 40 Nm (30 ft. lbs.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Yaw Rate
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6789
4. Remove the 2 bolts and the stability control sensor cluster.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 ft. lbs.)
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - FUNCTIONAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional > Page
6797
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - NON FUNCTIONAL
Removal
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the ignition
lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer. 4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering
column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage. 2. Install
a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Starter Relay > Page 6803
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Run/Start Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6806
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6807
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6808
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6809
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6810
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair
Battery Cable: Service and Repair
BATTERY CABLES
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Page 6815
Part 2
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Remove the nut
and position the battery ground cable terminal aside at the starter.
- To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
4. Remove the nut and position the starter solenoid positive cable terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
5. Remove the nut and position the starter solenoid wire terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
6. Remove the 2 nuts and position the 2 battery cable harness brackets from the A/C compressor
mounting bolts.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Remove the bolt and position the battery ground cable-to-frame terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
8. Remove the nut and position the generator harness terminal and the CJB cable terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
9. Remove the bolt and position the battery ground cable-to-cowl panel terminal aside.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
10. Disconnect the battery cable harness in-line electrical connector, release the harness locator
and remove the battery cable harness assembly. 11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Alternator: Electrical Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Voltage.................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................12 volts Generator
amps...............................................................................89/157 amp (max) @ 1,800-6,000
generator rpm, approximately 500-2,000 engine rpm
Generator
Load at 2,000 rpm................................................................................................................................
....................................................................89 amps No Load at 2,000 rpm........................................
.......................................................................................................................between 13.2 and 15.5
volts
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 6821
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Alternator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6824
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6825
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6826
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6827
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6828
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6829
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6830
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6831
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6832
Alternator: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6833
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6834
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6835
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6836
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6837
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6838
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6839
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6840
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6841
Alternator: Connector Views
C102A
C102B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6842
Alternator: Application and ID
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Generator
Rating..............................................................................................89/157 amp (max) @
1,800-6,000 generator rpm, approximately 500-2,000 engine rpm Generator pulley ratio...................
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................2.96:1 Voltage regulator type...........................................................................................
...............................................................Electronic internal with generator
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6843
Alternator: Description and Operation
GENERATOR
The generator is belt-driven by the engine accessory drive system. The generator has an internal
voltage regulator that is not replaced separately. The generator and voltage regulator are repaired
as an assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6844
Alternator: Service and Repair
GENERATOR
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Do not allow any metal object to come in contact with the generator housing and
internal diode cooling fins. A short circuit may result and burn out the diodes.
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. For Navigator, release the 2 retainers and remove the engine cover. 3.
Remove the air cleaner intake pipe. 4. Rotate the front end accessory drive belt tensioner
counterclockwise and position the accessory drive belt aside.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 6845
5. Remove the harness locator from the generator bracket. 6. Remove the 4 bolts and the
generator bracket.
- To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. Remove the 2 bolts and position the generator aside.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
8. Disconnect the generator electrical connector. 9. Position the generator B+ protective cover
aside, remove and discard the nut, then position the generator B+ terminal aside.
- Install a new B+ terminal nut; tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
10. Remove the generator. 11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - FUNCTIONAL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver.
2. NOTE: The ignition lock cylinder must be in the RUN position.
Using a suitable tool, press the release pin and remove the ignition lock cylinder.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Ignition Lock Cylinder - Functional > Page 6852
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair Ignition Lock Cylinder - Non Functional
IGNITION LOCK CYLINDER - NON FUNCTIONAL
Removal
1. Remove the passive anti-theft system (PATS) transceiver. 2. Remove the ignition lock cylinder.
- Use a 1/8-inch diameter drill bit to drill out the lock cylinder retaining pin.
- Use a 3/8-inch diameter drill to drill down the middle of the ignition lock key slot until the ignition
lock cylinder breaks loose.
- Remove and discard the ignition lock cylinder and drill shavings from the steering column.
3. Remove the bearing retainer. 4. Remove the steering column lock housing bearing and steering
column lock gear.
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean all drill shavings from the steering column and inspect it for damage. 2. Install
a new ignition lock cylinder.
- Verify the ignition lock cylinder operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Starter Motor: Electrical Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Starting System
Normal engine cranking speed.............................................................................................................
................................................................140-220 rpm Starter motor armature shaft maximum
runout...........................................................................................................................................0.11
mm (0.004 in) Starter motor brush manufactured length......................................................................
..............................................................................16.8 mm (0.66 in.) Starter motor brush spring tens
ion.........................................................................................................................................................
...............18 N (65 oz) Starter motor commutator maximum runout.....................................................
..........................................................................................0.12 mm (0.005 in) Starter motor diameter
..............................................................................................................................................................
....................101.6 mm (4.0 in) Starter motor maximum load...............................................................
......................................................................................................................800 amps Starter motor
minimum stall torque (at 5
volts)........................................................................................................................................14.7
Nm (10.8 lb-ft) Starter motor no load current draw...............................................................................
..........................................................................................60-80 amps Starter motor normal load
current draw..........................................................................................................................................
....................130-220 amps Starter circuit maximum voltage drop (engine at normal operating
temperature).......................................................................................................0.5 volts
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 6857
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6858
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 6859
Starter Motor: Diagrams
C197A
C197B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Starter Motor - Load Test
Starter Motor: Testing and Inspection Starter Motor - Load Test
STARTER MOTOR - LOAD TEST
WARNING: When servicing the starter motor or carrying out other underhood work in the vicinity of
the starter motor, be aware that the heavy gauge battery input lead at the starter solenoid is
"electrically hot" at all times. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: A protective cap or boot is provided over the battery input terminal on all car lines and
must be installed after repair. Be sure to disconnect the battery ground cable before repairing the
starter motor.
1. Before carrying out this test inspection, check the battery to determine its state of charge. Carry
out a load test of the battery using the Starter,
Alternator, Battery, Regulator and Electrical (SABRE) Tester. Refer to Charging System for the test
procedure.
2. Disconnect the ignition coil connector from the ignition coil. 3. Connect the SABRE tester to the
vehicle using the amperage lead clipped around the positive battery cable. 4. Measure the
amperage of the starter motor while activating the starting system. 5. A correctly operating starter
motor will draw from 130 to 190 amps of current at room temperature.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Starter Motor - Load Test > Page 6862
Starter Motor: Testing and Inspection Starter Drive Test
STARTER DRIVE TEST
1. Remove the starter motor. 2. Secure the starter motor in a vise. 3. Connect the battery ground
cable of a fully charged battery to the case of the starter motor.
4. CAUTION: Do not leave the positive lead of the battery connected to the starter motor S-terminal
for more than 10 seconds.
Touch the positive lead from the battery to the S-terminal and verify that the starter drive ejects.
5. Remove the positive lead from the starter motor. The ejected starter drive should return to its
original position. 6. If the starter drive does not eject and return to position, install a new starter
motor. 7. Check the starter drive. It should turn freely in one direction, and positively engage to the
armature when turned in the opposite direction. If not as
specified, install a new starter motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Starter Motor - Load Test > Page 6863
Starter Motor: Testing and Inspection Starter Motor - No load test
STARTER MOTOR - NO-LOAD TEST
The starter No Load Test will identify open or shorted windings and a possible rubbing starter
motor armature or bent starter motor armature shaft.
1. WARNING: Make sure that the starter motor is securely mounted on a bench because the
starter motor may move or jump when it is
energized. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Connect a fully charged battery, a Starter, Alternator, Battery, Regulator and Electrical (SABRE)
Tester and a remote starter switch to the starter motor. Connect the remote starter switch between
the battery positive (+) post and the starter motor S-terminal. Connect the starter motor B-terminal
to the battery positive (+) post. Connect the SABRE positive (+) terminal and negative (-) terminal
to the corresponding battery post. Make sure that the battery and starter motor are grounded.
2. Engage the remote starter switch. 3. The starter motor should eject the starter drive and run
smoothly. If the starter motor does not run smoothly, install a new starter motor. 4. While the starter
motor is running, check the voltmeter and ammeter. 5. The amperage should be no more than 84
amps. 6. If the amperage is higher than 84 amps, install a new starter motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 6864
Starter Motor: Service and Repair
STARTER MOTOR
Removal
WARNING: When carrying out maintenance on the starting system, be aware that the heavy gauge
leads are connected directly to the battery. Make sure the protective caps are in place when
maintenance is completed. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 6865
2. Disconnect the battery ground cable. 3. Remove the starter terminal cover and remove the nut
and the solenoid S-terminal electrical connection. 4. Remove the nut and the solenoid B-terminal
electrical connection. 5. Remove the nut and the starter battery ground cable from the stud. 6.
Remove the 2 bolts, the stud bolt and the starter motor.
Installation
1. Position the starter and install the 2 bolts and the stud bolt in 3 stages.
- Stage 1: Install the 2 starter bolts and the stud bolt finger tight.
- Stage 2: Tighten the upper bolt to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Stage 3: Tighten the lower bolt and stud bolt to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
2. Position the starter battery ground cable onto the stud and install the nut.
- Tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
3. Connect the solenoid B-terminal electrical connection and install the nut.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Connect the solenoid S-terminal electrical connection and install the nut and the starter terminal
cover.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
5. Connect the battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Starter Relay > Page 6870
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Run/Start Relay
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Run/Start Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6873
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6874
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6875
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection Starter Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6876
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Run/Start Relay > Page 6877
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear
C474
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear > Page 6883
C2033
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear > Page 6884
C3063
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Point, Rear > Page 6885
C3064
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1
C174
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1 > Page 6890
C194
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6895
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6896
Fuse: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6897
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6898
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6899
Fuse: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6900
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6901
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6902
Fuse: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6903
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6904
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6907
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6908
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6909
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6910
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6911
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6912
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6913
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6914
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6915
Fuse: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6916
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6917
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6918
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6919
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6920
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6921
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6922
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6923
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6926
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6927
Fuse: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6928
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6929
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6930
Fuse: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6931
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6932
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6933
Fuse: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6934
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6935
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6940
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6941
Fuse Block: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6942
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6943
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6944
Fuse Block: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6945
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6946
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6947
Fuse Block: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6948
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6949
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6952
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6953
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6954
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6955
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6956
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6957
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6958
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6959
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6960
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6961
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6962
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6963
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6964
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6965
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6966
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6967
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6968
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6969
Fuse Block: Connector Views
C1035
C2280A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6970
C2280B
C2280C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6971
C2280D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6972
C2280E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6973
C2280F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6974
C2280G
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6977
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6978
Fuse Block: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6979
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6980
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6981
Fuse Block: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6982
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6983
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6984
Fuse Block: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6985
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information
> Application and ID > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 6986
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6990
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6991
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6995
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 6996
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C133-C327
C133
C134
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7001
C139
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7002
C140
C144
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7003
C145
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7004
C146
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7005
C192
C210
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7006
C211
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7007
C212
C213
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7008
C214
C219
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7009
C237
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7010
C238 (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7011
C238 (Part 2)
C248
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7012
C291
C298
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7013
C299
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7014
C311
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7015
C312
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7016
C313
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7017
C314
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7018
C315
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7019
C316
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7020
C327
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7021
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C328-C3052
C328
C405
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7022
C406
C408
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7023
C410
C411
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7024
C342
C431
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7025
C432
C465
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7026
C494
C495
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7027
C510
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7028
C610
C700
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7029
C800
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7030
C913
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7031
C922
C934
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7032
C935
C991
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7033
C1026
C2239
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7034
C3049
C3050
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7035
C3051
C3052
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB)
Removal
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new SJB after installation.
1. NOTE:
- The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) functionality is integral to the SJB.
- A new SJB is delivered in "manufacturing mode" with 7 pre-set DTCs. These 7 manufacturing
mode DTCs require that a successful configuration of the SJB occurs, then a successful TPMS
sensor training occurs, then a successful self-test occurs, including the clearing of all DTCs. All of
this is required in order to clear the 7 manufacturing mode DTCs. The 7 manufacturing mode DTCs
are as follows: B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured) This DTC is present
when the SJB is not configured, even on applications that are not equipped with initiators.
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-state)
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Remove the pin-type retainer and the RH A-pillar lower trim panel. 4.
Remove the glove compartment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7039
5. Disconnect the 7 electrical connectors. 6. Remove the 2 bolts and the SJB.
Installation
1. Position the SJB and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
2. Connect the 7 electrical connectors. 3. Position the RH A-pillar lower trim panel and install the
pin-type retainer. 4. Install the glove compartment. 5. Connect the battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and
clears DTCs B2477 and B106D. The clearing of
these DTCs indicate the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the SJB.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB on-demand self-test by clearing DTCs and then retrieving DTCs to confirm all
DTCs have been cleared.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7044
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7045
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7048
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7049
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7050
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7051
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7052
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7053
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7054
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7055
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7060
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7061
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7066
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB)
Removal
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new SJB after installation.
1. NOTE:
- The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) functionality is integral to the SJB.
- A new SJB is delivered in "manufacturing mode" with 7 pre-set DTCs. These 7 manufacturing
mode DTCs require that a successful configuration of the SJB occurs, then a successful TPMS
sensor training occurs, then a successful self-test occurs, including the clearing of all DTCs. All of
this is required in order to clear the 7 manufacturing mode DTCs. The 7 manufacturing mode DTCs
are as follows: B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured) This DTC is present
when the SJB is not configured, even on applications that are not equipped with initiators.
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-state)
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Remove the pin-type retainer and the RH A-pillar lower trim panel. 4.
Remove the glove compartment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7070
5. Disconnect the 7 electrical connectors. 6. Remove the 2 bolts and the SJB.
Installation
1. Position the SJB and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
2. Connect the 7 electrical connectors. 3. Position the RH A-pillar lower trim panel and install the
pin-type retainer. 4. Install the glove compartment. 5. Connect the battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and
clears DTCs B2477 and B106D. The clearing of
these DTCs indicate the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the SJB.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB on-demand self-test by clearing DTCs and then retrieving DTCs to confirm all
DTCs have been cleared.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn >
Page 7075
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn >
Page 7076
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay,
Left/Right Turn
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay,
Left/Right Turn > Page 7079
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay,
Left/Right Turn > Page 7080
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay,
Left/Right Turn > Page 7081
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay,
Left/Right Turn > Page 7082
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay,
Left/Right Turn > Page 7083
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay,
Left/Right Turn > Page 7084
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay,
Left/Right Turn > Page 7085
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay,
Left/Right Turn > Page 7086
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7091
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7092
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7093
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7094
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7095
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7096
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7097
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7098
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7099
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7100
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7103
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
C2280B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7104
C2280C
C2280D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7105
C2280E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7106
C2280F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7107
C2280G
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel >
Page 7110
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel >
Page 7111
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel >
Page 7112
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel >
Page 7113
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel >
Page 7114
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel >
Page 7115
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel >
Page 7116
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel >
Page 7117
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel >
Page 7118
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and
Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel >
Page 7119
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7124
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7125
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7126
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7127
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7128
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7129
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7130
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7131
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7132
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7133
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7136
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
C2280B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7137
C2280C
C2280D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7138
C2280E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7139
C2280F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7140
C2280G
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7143
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7144
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7145
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7146
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7147
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7148
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7149
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7150
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information >
Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7152
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines
Wiring Harness: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines
TSB 06-17-8
09/04/06
SERVICE WIRING HARNESS REPLACEMENT GUIDELINES - SERVICE TIPS
FORD: 2000-2003 Focus 2005-2006 Focus 2005-2007 Mustang 2002 Ranger 2004-2007 F-150,
Freestar 2005 Escape 2005-2007 Expedition 2007 E-Series 2006-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN:
2005-2007 Navigator 2006-2007 Mark LI
MERCURY: 2004-2007 Monterey 2005 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 05-16-12 to update vehicle lines and model years.
ISSUE Ford Motor Company has "consolidated" high and low content harnesses to make the
service selection easier, and to reduce the number of harnesses required for service. Due to this
consolidation, service replacement harnesses may or may not look exactly like the production
harness being replaced. Service replacement harnesses may come equipped with additional
connectors that will not be used.
ACTION Should replacement of a production wire harness become necessary, determine whether
the harness is to be used in a WET or DRY environment, then refer to the appropriate Service
Procedure below.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF UNSURE WHETHER THE ENVIRONMENT FOR THE HARNESS WILL BE "WET" OR "DRY"
ALWAYS TREAT AS A "WET" ENVIRONMENT.
Extra Open Connectors - Procedure For "Dry" Environment/Interior Wiring Harness:
Any extra open connectors should be tucked, folded, and taped out of the way to avoid creating a
rattle or becoming loose (Figure 1). If space allows,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7157
position the connectors so they point downward this will avoid the connector catching water in case
of a water leak.
Extra Open Connectors - Procedure For "Wet" Environment/Exterior Wiring Harness:
1. Cut each wire from the extra connector as close to the connector as possible (Figure 2).
2. Using dual wall heat shrink tubing, position tubing over each individual wire (Figure 3).
3. Use a shielded, flameless heat gun to heat the repair area until the tubing shrinks and adhesive
flows out of both ends of the shrink tubing. While the adhesive is still hot, use pliers to pinch the
ends of the heat shrink tubing closed to form a moisture proof seal (Figure 4).
4. Use electrical tape to bundle the wires together, then stow the bundle under an existing harness
in the area.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7158
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear
C474
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear > Page 7164
C2033
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear > Page 7165
C3063
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Auxiliary Power Outlet > Component Information > Diagrams >
Power Point, Rear > Page 7166
C3064
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1
C174
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Electronic Noise Suppressor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Ignition Transformer Capacitor 1 > Page 7171
C194
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1 > Page 7176
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1 > Page 7177
Fuse: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1 > Page 7178
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1 > Page 7179
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1 > Page 7180
Fuse: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1 > Page 7181
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1 > Page 7182
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1 > Page 7183
Fuse: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1 > Page 7184
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay
Box 1 > Page 7185
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Fuse: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7188
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7189
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7190
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7191
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7192
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7193
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7194
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7195
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7196
Fuse: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7197
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7198
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7199
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7200
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7201
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7202
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7203
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7204
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7207
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7208
Fuse: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7209
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7210
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7211
Fuse: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7212
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7213
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7214
Fuse: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7215
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Application and ID > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7216
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7221
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7222
Fuse Block: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7223
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7224
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7225
Fuse Block: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7227
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7228
Fuse Block: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7229
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7230
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7233
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7234
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7235
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7236
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7237
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7238
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7239
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7240
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7241
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7242
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7243
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7244
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7245
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7246
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7247
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7248
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7249
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7250
Fuse Block: Connector Views
C1035
C2280A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7251
C2280B
C2280C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7252
C2280D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7253
C2280E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7254
C2280F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 7255
C2280G
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7258
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7259
Fuse Block: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7260
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7261
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7262
Fuse Block: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7263
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7264
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7265
Fuse Block: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7266
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Application and ID >
Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7267
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7271
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Micro ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7272
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7276
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Mini ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7277
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C133-C327
C133
C134
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7282
C139
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7283
C140
C144
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7284
C145
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7285
C146
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7286
C192
C210
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7287
C211
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7288
C212
C213
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7289
C214
C219
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7290
C237
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7291
C238 (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7292
C238 (Part 2)
C248
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7293
C291
C298
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7294
C299
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7295
C311
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7296
C312
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7297
C313
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7298
C314
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7299
C315
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7300
C316
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7301
C327
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7302
Multiple Junction Connector: Diagrams C328-C3052
C328
C405
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7303
C406
C408
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7304
C410
C411
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7305
C342
C431
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7306
C432
C465
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7307
C494
C495
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7308
C510
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7309
C610
C700
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7310
C800
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7311
C913
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7312
C922
C934
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7313
C935
C991
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7314
C1026
C2239
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7315
C3049
C3050
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Multiple Junction Connector > Component Information >
Diagrams > C133-C327 > Page 7316
C3051
C3052
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB)
Removal
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new SJB after installation.
1. NOTE:
- The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) functionality is integral to the SJB.
- A new SJB is delivered in "manufacturing mode" with 7 pre-set DTCs. These 7 manufacturing
mode DTCs require that a successful configuration of the SJB occurs, then a successful TPMS
sensor training occurs, then a successful self-test occurs, including the clearing of all DTCs. All of
this is required in order to clear the 7 manufacturing mode DTCs. The 7 manufacturing mode DTCs
are as follows: B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured) This DTC is present
when the SJB is not configured, even on applications that are not equipped with initiators.
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-state)
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Remove the pin-type retainer and the RH A-pillar lower trim panel. 4.
Remove the glove compartment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Module > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 7320
5. Disconnect the 7 electrical connectors. 6. Remove the 2 bolts and the SJB.
Installation
1. Position the SJB and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
2. Connect the 7 electrical connectors. 3. Position the RH A-pillar lower trim panel and install the
pin-type retainer. 4. Install the glove compartment. 5. Connect the battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and
clears DTCs B2477 and B106D. The clearing of
these DTCs indicate the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the SJB.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB on-demand self-test by clearing DTCs and then retrieving DTCs to confirm all
DTCs have been cleared.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7325
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7326
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7329
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7330
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7331
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7332
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7333
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7334
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7335
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Power Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7336
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Micro ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7341
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Micro
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7342
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Mini ISO Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7346
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Mini
ISO Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7347
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Distribution Module: Service and Repair
SMART JUNCTION BOX (SJB)
Removal
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new SJB after installation.
1. NOTE:
- The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) functionality is integral to the SJB.
- A new SJB is delivered in "manufacturing mode" with 7 pre-set DTCs. These 7 manufacturing
mode DTCs require that a successful configuration of the SJB occurs, then a successful TPMS
sensor training occurs, then a successful self-test occurs, including the clearing of all DTCs. All of
this is required in order to clear the 7 manufacturing mode DTCs. The 7 manufacturing mode DTCs
are as follows: B2477 (Module Configuration Failure)
- B106D (Tire Pressure Monitor System [TPMS] Initiators Not Configured) This DTC is present
when the SJB is not configured, even on applications that are not equipped with initiators.
- B2868 (Left Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2869 (Right Front Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2870 (Right Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- B2871 (Left Rear Tire Pressure Sensor Fault)
- C2780 (ECU in Manufacturer Sub-state)
Upload the module configuration information from the SJB into the scan tool.
2. Disconnect the battery. 3. Remove the pin-type retainer and the RH A-pillar lower trim panel. 4.
Remove the glove compartment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7351
5. Disconnect the 7 electrical connectors. 6. Remove the 2 bolts and the SJB.
Installation
1. Position the SJB and install the 2 bolts.
- Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
2. Connect the 7 electrical connectors. 3. Position the RH A-pillar lower trim panel and install the
pin-type retainer. 4. Install the glove compartment. 5. Connect the battery.
6. NOTE: When successful, this step provides the calibration necessary for the SJB operation and
clears DTCs B2477 and B106D. The clearing of
these DTCs indicate the calibration data has been successfully downloaded to the SJB.
Download the SJB configuration information from the scan tool to the SJB.
7. NOTE: When successful, this step clears DTCs B2868, B2869, B2870 and B2871. The clearing
of these DTCs indicates the SJB has recognized
the tire pressure sensors during the training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensors.
8. NOTE: DTC C2780 will not clear if any other DTCs are present in the SJB.
Carry out the SJB on-demand self-test by clearing DTCs and then retrieving DTCs to confirm all
DTCs have been cleared.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7356
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7357
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7360
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7362
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7363
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7364
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7365
Power Distribution Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7366
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Power
Distribution Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 7367
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7372
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7373
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7374
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7375
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7376
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7377
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7378
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7379
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7380
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary Relay Box 1 > Page 7381
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB)
C1035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7384
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
C2280B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7385
C2280C
C2280D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7386
C2280E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7387
C2280F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7388
C2280G
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7391
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7392
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7393
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7394
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7395
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7396
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7397
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7398
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7399
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay
Box > Component Information > Application and ID > Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7400
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7405
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7406
Relay Box: Locations Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7407
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7408
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7409
Relay Box: Locations Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7410
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7411
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7412
Relay Box: Locations Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7413
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Relay Box 1 > Page 7414
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB)
C1035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7417
Relay Box: Diagrams Smart Junction Box (SJB)
C2280A
C2280B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7418
C2280C
C2280D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7419
C2280E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7420
C2280F
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Diagrams > Battery
Junction Box (BJB) > Page 7421
C2280G
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Relay Box: Application and ID Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7424
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7425
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7426
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7427
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7428
Relay Box: Application and ID Battery Junction Box (BJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7429
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7430
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7431
Relay Box: Application and ID Smart Junction Box (SJB)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7432
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box > Component Information > Application and ID >
Passenger Compartment Fuse Panel > Page 7433
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines
Wiring Harness: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines
TSB 06-17-8
09/04/06
SERVICE WIRING HARNESS REPLACEMENT GUIDELINES - SERVICE TIPS
FORD: 2000-2003 Focus 2005-2006 Focus 2005-2007 Mustang 2002 Ranger 2004-2007 F-150,
Freestar 2005 Escape 2005-2007 Expedition 2007 E-Series 2006-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN:
2005-2007 Navigator 2006-2007 Mark LI
MERCURY: 2004-2007 Monterey 2005 Mariner
This article supersedes TSB 05-16-12 to update vehicle lines and model years.
ISSUE Ford Motor Company has "consolidated" high and low content harnesses to make the
service selection easier, and to reduce the number of harnesses required for service. Due to this
consolidation, service replacement harnesses may or may not look exactly like the production
harness being replaced. Service replacement harnesses may come equipped with additional
connectors that will not be used.
ACTION Should replacement of a production wire harness become necessary, determine whether
the harness is to be used in a WET or DRY environment, then refer to the appropriate Service
Procedure below.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF UNSURE WHETHER THE ENVIRONMENT FOR THE HARNESS WILL BE "WET" OR "DRY"
ALWAYS TREAT AS A "WET" ENVIRONMENT.
Extra Open Connectors - Procedure For "Dry" Environment/Interior Wiring Harness:
Any extra open connectors should be tucked, folded, and taped out of the way to avoid creating a
rattle or becoming loose (Figure 1). If space allows,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7438
position the connectors so they point downward this will avoid the connector catching water in case
of a water leak.
Extra Open Connectors - Procedure For "Wet" Environment/Exterior Wiring Harness:
1. Cut each wire from the extra connector as close to the connector as possible (Figure 2).
2. Using dual wall heat shrink tubing, position tubing over each individual wire (Figure 3).
3. Use a shielded, flameless heat gun to heat the repair area until the tubing shrinks and adhesive
flows out of both ends of the shrink tubing. While the adhesive is still hot, use pliers to pinch the
ends of the heat shrink tubing closed to form a moisture proof seal (Figure 4).
4. Use electrical tape to bundle the wires together, then stow the bundle under an existing harness
in the area.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Wiring Harness Replacement Guidelines > Page 7439
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications
Part 1 Of 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7445
Part 2 Of 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7446
Alignment: Specifications Ride Height
Part 1 Of 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7447
Part 2 Of 3
Part 3 Of 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7448
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7449
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7450
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7451
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7452
Alignment: Specifications
Part 1 Of 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7453
Part 2 Of 2
Part 1 Of 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7454
Part 2 Of 3
Part 3 Of 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7455
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Coil Spring Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7456
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7457
Alignment Specifications Vehicles With Rear Air Suspension
General Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7458
General Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Alignment
Specifications > Page 7459
General Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 7460
Alignment: Description and Operation
Wheel Alignment Angles
The front caster and camber are adjusted by removing the lower arm front and rear bolts and
installing adjuster kits to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slots. Front toe is adjusted by the
use of the front wheel knuckle tie rods. The rear camber is adjusted by removing the upper arm
camber set shim or shim pins to allow the arm to be adjusted in the frame slot. The rear toe is
adjusted by the use of the rear toe link cam bolt and nut.
Camber
Negative and Positive Camber
Camber is the vertical tilt of the wheel when viewed from the front. Camber can be positive or
negative and has a direct affect on tire wear.
Caster
Caster
Caster is the deviation from vertical of an imaginary line drawn through the ball joints when viewed
from the side. The caster specifications will give the vehicle the best directional stability
characteristics when loaded and driven. The caster setting does not affect tire wear.
Toe
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 7461
Positive Toe (Toe In)
Negative Toe (Toe Out)
The vehicle toe setting: ^
affects tire wear and directional stability.
^ must be checked after adding aftermarket equipment, such as a snowplow.
Ride Height
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim height prior to measuring the vehicle ride height.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 7462
Front Ride Height Measurement
Rear Ride Height Measurement
Wander
Wander is the tendency of the vehicle to require frequent, random left and right steering wheel
corrections to maintain a straight path down a level road.
Shimmy
Shimmy, as observed by the driver, is large, consistent, rotational oscillations of the steering wheel
resulting from large, side-to-side (lateral) tire/wheel movements.
Shimmy is usually experienced near 64 km/h (40 mph), and can begin or be amplified when the tire
contacts pot holes or irregularities in the road surface.
Nibble
Sometimes confused with shimmy, nibble is a condition resulting from tire interaction with various
road surfaces or tire imbalance. This condition is observed by the driver as small rotational
oscillations of the steering wheel.
Poor Returnability/Sticky Steering
Poor returnability and sticky steering is used to describe the poor return of the steering wheel to
center after a turn or when the steering correction is completed.
Drift/Pull
Pull is a tugging sensation, felt by the hands on the steering wheel, that must be overcome to keep
the vehicle going straight.
Drift describes what a vehicle with this condition does with hands off the steering wheel. ^
A vehicle-related drift/pull, on a flat road, will cause a consistent deviation from the straight-ahead
path and require constant steering input in the opposite direction to counteract the effect.
^ Drift/pull may be induced by conditions external to the vehicle (such as wind or road camber).
Poor Groove Feel
Poor groove feel is characterized by little or no buildup of turning effort felt in the steering wheel as
the wheel is rocked slowly left and right within very small turns around center or straight-ahead
(under 20 degrees of steering wheel turn). Efforts may be said to be "flat on center." ^
Under 20 degrees of turn, most of the turning effort that builds up comes from the mesh of gear
teeth in the steering gear. In this range, the steering wheel is not yet turned enough to feel the
effort from the self-aligning forces at the road wheel or tire patch.
^ In the diagnosis of a steering or alignment concern, it is important to understand the difference
between wander and poor groove feel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment-Front
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber and Caster Adjustment-Front
Camber and Caster Adjustment-Front
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturers instructions, measure the front caster and
camber.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the caster and camber values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Remove and discard the lower arm front and rear nuts and bolts.
3. NOTE: New lower arm front and rear bolts must be installed with cam bolt kit (3B236 for the front
and rear bushing), to allow for adjustment of
the arm in the frame slot. The vehicle should be supported by the frame to ease movement of the
lower arm in the slot.
Install the cam bolt kit and loosely install the nut.
4. To adjust the caster and camber, refer to the following chart.
^ Adjustments that require moving the front and the rear of the lower arm should be made equally.
5. NOTE: The lower arm front and rear bolts must be tightened with the weight of the vehicle
resting on the wheel and tire assembles.
While holding the cam bolt, tighten the nut to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the front toe.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment-Front > Page 7465
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Front
Toe Adjustment - Front
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the
caster, camber or toe.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the front toe.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the front toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Start the engine and center the steering wheel. 3. Turn the engine off and, using a suitable
steering wheel holding device, lock the steering wheel in the straight-ahead position. 4. Remove
the steering gear bellows clamp(s).
5. Loosen the tie-rod end jam nut(s).
6. NOTE: Do not allow the steering gear bellows to twist while rotating the tie rod.
Rotate the tie rod(s) to achieve the desired toe setting.!
7. CAUTION: Make sure to hold the tie-rod end stationary while tightening the jam nut or damage
to the boot can occur.
NOTE: Make sure that the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the jam nuts.
Tighten the tie-rod end jam nut(s) to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment-Front > Page 7466
8. Install the steering gear bellows clamp(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment-Front > Page 7467
Alignment: Service and Repair Toe Adjustment - Rear
Toe Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
toe.
NOTE: Before carrying out a toe adjustment, check the tires for the correct pressure. Inspect the
tires for incorrect wear or damage. Inspect the suspension for wear or damage.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear toe.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the rear toe values are not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Loosen the toe link cam bolt nut(s).
3. Rotate the toe link cam bolt(s) until the toe setting is within specification.
4. NOTE: Make sure the toe settings are not disturbed while tightening the cam nut(s).
Tighten the toe link cam bolt nut(s) to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
5. Recheck the rear toe setting, adjust as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment-Front > Page 7468
Alignment: Service and Repair Camber Adjustment - Rear
Camber Adjustment - Rear
NOTE: Air suspension vehicles must be at trim ride height prior to measuring or adjusting the rear
camber or toe.
NOTE: Before carrying out a camber adjustment, check the tires for the correct pressure. Inspect
the tires for incorrect wear or damage. Inspect the suspension for wear or damage.
1. Using alignment equipment and the manufacturer's instructions, measure the rear camber.
^ Refer to Alignment Specifications for optimal alignment settings.
^ If the rear camber value is not within specification, go to the next step.
2. Remove the upper arm-to-frame bolt and the camber set shim.
^ Discard the camber set shim.
^ Install and snug the upper arm-to frame bolt.
3. Position the upper arm-to-frame bolt in the upper arm-to-frame slot until the camber setting is
within specification.
4. NOTE: Do not allow the upper arm to move and change the camber adjustment setting when
tightening the bolt.
Tighten the upper arm-to-frame bolt to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
5. Recheck the camber setting, adjust as necessary. 6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear
toe.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Camber and
Caster Adjustment-Front > Page 7469
Alignment: Service and Repair Ride Height Adjustments (Vehicle Dynamic Suspension)
Ride Height Adjustments
Special Tool(s)
CAUTION: The suspension height D dimensions are for reference only. The vehicle attitude must
be controlled by the correct dimensions to prevent vehicle damage.
NOTE: If one or both height sensors are installed new, both height sensors must be calibrated.
NOTE: Incorrect air suspension ride height D dimension can be caused by an air suspension
system that is incorrectly set.
NOTE: The air suspension module has a preprogrammed trim height.
1. NOTE: The vehicle must be on a level surface, such as a drive on alignment hoist.
Position the vehicle on a level surface.
2. Using the vehicle message center, verify that the air suspension is in the ON mode. 3. Using the
scan tool, run the accurate trim test. 4. Measure the ride height D dimension. 5. If ride height
dimension D is not within specification, use the scan tool to vent or fill the air suspension to the
correct dimension.
6. NOTE: The air suspension height sensor sends a signal to the air suspension module. The
output ranges from approximately 4.5 volts at minimum
height (when the vehicle is low or in full jounce) to 0.5 volt at maximum height (when the vehicle is
in high or in full rebound).
Using the scan tool, monitor the 2 suspension height sensors voltage parameter identifications
(PIDs).
7. Using the scan tool, save the vehicle's trim height for both sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 7475
Compressor/Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 7476
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 7477
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7481
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
C2131A
C2131B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Relays and Modules - Steering and Suspension > Relays and
Modules - Suspension > Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7482
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Module
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. NOTE: The air suspension control module is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 air suspension control module electrical connectors.
3. Remove the air suspension control module nuts and the air suspension control module.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. NOTE: The air suspension control module is calibrated with information from the ride height
sensors. A new or exchanged air suspension control
module requires that the LH and RH ride height sensors are calibrated and a pneumatic test is
carried out. For additional information, refer to Vehicle Dynamic Suspension Calibration Initialize
System - Clear C1990 and C1991 DTCs.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power
Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page 7489
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7493
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Telescoping Wheel Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
C2250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Tilt Wheel Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
C2250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
LH Side
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Ride Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
7504
RH Side
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the senor harness from the
sensor bracket. 3. Disconnect the sensor electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the sensor arm from
the ball stud on the lower control arm. 5. Remove and discard the 2 sensor bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensor assemblies cannot be used on opposite sides of the
vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the LH and RH height sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7508
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7513
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7516
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7517
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7518
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7519
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in the following sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 in) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7520
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear. ^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7521
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
Wheel Knuckle
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7526
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower shock nut until the installation procedure is complete and the
weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
CAUTION: When servicing the lower shock nut, take care not to damage the stabilizer link.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub. 2. Remove and discard the tie-rod end nut.
^ To install, tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
3. Using the special tool, separate the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle.
4. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7527
5. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nut. ^
To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
6. Remove and discard the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 475 Nm (350 lb-ft).
7. Remove the 3 integrated wheel end bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
8. Remove and discard the upper ball joint nut.
^ To install, tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
9. NOTE: Be sure not to damage the ball joint boot when installing the special tool.
Using the special tool, separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
10. Remove and discard the lower ball joint nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
11. CAUTION: Make sure to use the special tool when separating the lower ball joint from the
knuckle to prevent damage to the ball joint
boot.
Using the special tool, separate the lower ball joint from the wheel knuckle and remove the wheel
knuckle.
12. If necessary, remove the 3 brake disc shield bolts and remove the brake disc shield.
^ To install, tighten to 17 Nm (13 lb-ft).
13. CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower shock nut until the installation procedure is complete and
the weight of the vehicle is resting on the
wheel and tire assemblies.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7528
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
14. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Bleeding: Service and Repair
Power Steering System Purging
Special Tool(s)
Material
CAUTION: If the air is not purged from the power steering system correctly, premature power
steering pump failure can result. The condition can occur on pre-delivery vehicles with evidence of
aerated fluid or on vehicles that have had steering component repairs.
1. NOTE: A whine heard from the power steering pump can be caused by air in the system. The
power steering purge procedure must be carried out
prior to any component repair for which power steering noise complaints are accompanied by
evidence of aerated fluid.
Remove the power steering pump reservoir cap. Check the fluid.
2. Raise the front wheels off the floor. 3. Tightly insert the stopper of the vacuum pump into the
reservoir. 4. Start the engine. 5. Install the vacuum pump, apply vacuum and maintain the
maximum vacuum of 68-85 kPa (20-25 in-Hg). 6. If equipped with Hydro-Boost, apply the brake
pedal twice.
7. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel against the stops for more than 3 to 5 seconds at a
time. Damage to the power steering pump
can occur.
Cycle the steering wheel fully from stop-to-stop 10 times.
8. Stop the engine. 9. Release the vacuum and remove the vacuum pump.
10. CAUTION: Do not overfill the reservoir.
Fill the reservoir. ^
Use approved transmission fluid.
11. Start the engine. 12. Install the vacuum pump. Apply and maintain the maximum vacuum of
68-85 kPa (20-25 in-Hg).
13. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel against the stops for more than 3 to 5 seconds at a
time. Damage to the power steering pump
can occur.
Cycle the steering wheel fully from stop-to-stop 10 times.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7533
14. Stop the engine, release the vacuum and remove the vacuum pump.
15. CAUTION: Do not overfill the reservoir.
Fill the reservoir as needed and install the reservoir cap.
16. Visually inspect the power steering system for leaks.
17. CAUTION: Do not overfill the reservoir.
Fill the reservoir as needed and visually inspect the power steering system for leaks.
18. Install the reservoir cap.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage
Power Steering Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage
TSB 07-1-7
01/22/07
MERCON(R) ATF REPLACED BY MERCON(R) V AS A SERVICE FLUID FOR SOME POWER
STEERING SYSTEMS
FORD: 1996-1997 Thunderbird 1996-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 1998-2003 Escort
2000-2007 Focus 2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2006 Ford GT 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle
2006-2007 Fusion 1996-1997 Aerostar 1996-2007 E-Series, Explorer, Ranger 1997-2004 F-53
Motorhome Chassis 1997-2007 Expedition, F-150, F-Super Duty 1998-2003 Windstar 2000-2005
Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2005 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2007 Escape 2004-2007
Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1996-1997 Cargo 1996-1998 L-Series 1996-1999 F- B-Series
2000-2007 F-650, F-750 2006-2007 Low Cab Forward
LINCOLN: 1996-1998 Mark VIII 1996-1999 Continental 1996-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln
LS 2006 Zephyr 2007 MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator
2006-2007 Mark LT 2007 MKX
MERCURY: 1996-1997 Cougar 1996-2005 Sable 1996-2007 Grand Marquis 1999-2002 Cougar
2003-2004 Marauder 2005-2007 Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2007 Mountaineer 1998-2002
Villager 2004-2007 Monterey 2005-2007 Mariner Hybrid, Mariner
ISSUE MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission Fluid is being replaced by MERCON(R) V as a
service fluid for power steering systems originally requiring MERCON(R).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - Mercon V(R) Fluid Usage > Page 7538
ACTION Beginning immediately all power steering applications requiring MERCON(R) can now be
serviced using MERCON(R) V or MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission Fluid or dual usage fluids
labeled MERCON(R) / MERCON(R) V. After July 1, 2007, MERCON(R) Automatic Transmission
Fluid will no longer be manufactured, therefore, availability of this fluid will continue until remaining
inventory has been depleted.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Service power steering Systems requiring MERCON(R) with MERCON(R) V or MERCON(R)
Automatic Transmission Fluid or dual usage fluids labeled MERCON(R) / MERCON(R) V.
CAUTION
APPLICATIONS RECOMMENDING TYPE F AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION AND POWER
STEERING FLUID MUST CONTINUE TO USE THAT PARTICULAR FLUID. USE OF ANY
OTHER FLUID MAY CAUSE REDUCED FUNCTIONALITY OR DAMAGE
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Information Only
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7539
Power Steering Fluid: Testing and Inspection
Power Steering Fluid Leak Test
NOTE: This test should only be carried out if a leak in the system has not been detected during a
thorough visual inspection.
1. Check the power steering fluid level. If necessary, add the specified power steering fluid. 2.
Remove the power steering pump reservoir cap and tightly install the evacuation cap to the power
steering pump reservoir. 3. Install the hose from the fill adapter manifold tee to the evacuation cap
on the power steering pump reservoir. 4. Install the vacuum pump to the evacuation cap. 5. Using
the vacuum pump, apply 68-85 kPa (20-25 in-Hg) of vacuum to the power steering system. 6.
Observe the vacuum gauge for 30 seconds. If the vacuum gauge reading drops more than 3 kPa
(0.88 in-Hg) a leak is present. 7. Remove the vacuum pump.
8. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel at the stops for more than 3-5 seconds. Damage to
the power steering pump can occur.
Start the engine. With the engine at idle, raise the power steering fluid temperature to 74-80°C
(165-176°F) by rotating the steering wheel fully to the left and right several times.
9. Visually inspect the system for leaks. If a leak is evident, repair as necessary. If a leak is not
evident, add the specified UV fluorescent tracer dye
to the power steering fluid. Use 14.78 mL (1/2 oz) of dye solution for every 1.89L (2 qt) of power
steering fluid. For steering system fluid capacity, refer to Specifications.
10. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel at the stops for more than 3-5 seconds. Damage to
the power steering pump can occur.
Start the engine. With the engine at idle, raise the power steering fluid temperature to 74-80°C
(165-176°F) by rotating the steering wheel fully to the left and right several times.
11. NOTE: On vehicles with rack and pinion steering gear, it may be necessary to remove the
bellows boot clamp from the steering gear bellows
boots to inspect for internal steering gear leaks.
Using the special tool (UV lamp), inspect the system for traces of UV dye. Repair as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Steering Fluid Cooler: Description and Operation
A/C CONDENSER/POWER STEERING COMBO COOLER
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed
A/C compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
The A/C condenser/power steering combo cooler is an aluminum fin-and-tube design heat
exchanger located in front of the vehicle radiator. It cools compressed refrigerant gas by allowing
air to pass over fins and tubes to extract heat and by condensing gas to liquid refrigerant as it is
cooled.
The receiver/drier is incorporated onto the LH side of the condenser core. The receiver/drier
cartridge is a separate component and can be removed and installed separately from the
condenser core.
The top portion of the condenser/power steering combo cooler is partitioned from the refrigerant
system and is used for power steering fluid cooling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Cooler >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7543
Power Steering Fluid Cooler: Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Cooler
1. The power steering fluid cooler is integral to the A/C condenser core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir: Service and Repair
Power Steering Fluid Reservoir
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
1. Remove the upper air deflector
1 Remove the 10 upper air deflector pushpin-type retainers.
2 Remove the air deflector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid Reservoir >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7547
2. Remove the air cleaner element. 3. Using a suitable suction device, remove the power steering
fluid from the fluid reservoir. 4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering return hose
from the power steering fluid reservoir. 5. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering
pump supply hose from the power steering fluid reservoir. 6. Remove the power steering fluid
reservoir bolt and reservoir.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
^ Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose
Material
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the upper air deflector.
1 Remove the 10 upper air deflector pushpin-type retainers.
2 Remove the air deflector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 7552
3. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe. 4. Release the clamp and disconnect the power steering
return hose from the power steering fluid cooler. 5. Release the power steering return hose from
the cooling fan shroud clips. 6. Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab and rotate the shroud
upward.
7. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt, rotate the clamp plate and disconnect the power
steering return line from the power steering gear. ^
To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
^ Discard the steering line O-ring seals.
9. NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 7553
Power Steering Line/Hose: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure
Line
Power Steering Pump to Steering Gear Pressure Line
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 7554
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 7555
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
NOTE: A new Teflon O-ring seal must be installed any time the power steering line is disconnected
from the power steering pump.
1. Remove the power steering pump pulley. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: A new Teflon O-ring seal must be installed any time the power steering line is
disconnected from the power steering pump.
Disconnect the power steering pressure line-to-power steering pump fitting. ^
Discard the Teflon O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 lb-ft).
4. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-crossmember bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
5. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-engine nut.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Steering Gear to Fluid Cooler Return Hose > Page 7556
6. NOTE: A new O-ring seal must be installed any time the power steering line is disconnected
from the power steering gear.
Remove the power steering line clamp plate bolt, rotate the clamp plate and disconnect the power
steering line. ^
Discard the O-ring seals. ^
To install, tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
7. NOTE: A new O-ring seal must be installed any time the power steering line is disconnected
from the power steering gear.
NOTE: A new Teflon O-ring seal must be installed any time the power steering line is disconnected
from the power steering pump.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Using the special tool, install a new Teflon O-ring on the pressure line-to-pump fitting and pressure
line-to-steering gear.
8. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump
Power Steering Pump
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 7561
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: A new Teflon O-ring seal must be installed any time the line is disconnected from the power
steering pump.
1. Remove the power steering pump pulley. 2. Release the clamp and disconnect the supply hose
from power steering pump. 3. Remove the power steering pressure line bracket-to-engine nut.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 7562
4. NOTE: A new Teflon O-ring seal must be installed any time the line is disconnected from the
power steering pump.
Disconnect the power steering pressure line-to-power steering pump fitting. ^
Discard the Teflon O-ring seal.
^ To install, tighten to 65 Nm (48 lb-ft).
5. Remove the 3 bolts and the power steering pump.
^ To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: A new Teflon O-ring seal must be installed any time the line is disconnected from the
power steering pump.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. ^
Using the special tool, install a new Teflon O-ring on the pressure line-to-pump fitting.
7. Fill the power steering system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 7563
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Power Steering Pump Pulley
Power Steering Pump Pulley
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL , position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the upper air deflector
1 Remove the 10 upper air deflector pushpin-type retainers.
2 Remove the air deflector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 7564
3. Remove the air cleaner outlet pipe. 4. Remove the 2 upper cooling fan shroud bolts. 5. Release
the lower cooling fan shroud tab and rotate the shroud upwards.
6. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and remove the accessory drive belt from
the power steering pump pulley. 7. Position the cooling fan shroud assembly upward to gain
clearance to install the special tool. 8. Using the special tool, remove the power steering pump
pulley.
Installation
1. CAUTION: If the pulley has been removed and installed twice, install a new power steering
pump pulley.
CAUTION: Inspect the pulley for paint marks in the web area near the hub. If there are 2 paint
marks, install a new pulley. If there is 1 paint mark or none at all, use a paint pencil to mark the web
area of the pulley near the hub.
Using the special tool, install the power steering pump pulley.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Power Steering Pump > Page 7565
2. Rotate the accessory drive belt tensioner clockwise and install the accessory drive belt to the
power steering pump pulley. 3. Lower the cooling fan shroud assembly.
^ Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab, rotate shroud downward.
4. Install the 2 upper cooling fan shroud bolts.
^ Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
5. Install the air cleaner outlet pipe. 6. Install the upper air deflector and the 10 pushpin-type
retainers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Switch
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SWITCH
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch
The PSP switch monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP switch
is a normally closed switch that opens as the hydraulic pressure increases. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the PSP circuit. When the PSP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The PCM uses the input signal from the PSP switch to compensate
for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the idle RPM and preventing engine stall during
parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP switch signals the PCM to adjust the transmission electronic
pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased engine load, for example during parking
maneuvers
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Switch > Page
7571
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation Power Steering Pressure (PSP)
Sensor
POWER STEERING PRESSURE (PSP) SENSOR
Typical Power Steering Pressure (PSP) Sensor
The PSP sensor monitors the hydraulic pressure within the power steering system. The PSP
sensor voltage input to the PCM changes as the hydraulic pressure changes. The PCM uses the
input signal from the PSP sensor to compensate for additional loads on the engine by adjusting the
idle RPM and preventing engine stall during parking maneuvers. Also, the PSP sensor signals the
PCM to adjust the transmission electronic pressure control (EPC) pressure during increased
engine load, for example, during parking maneuvers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor
> Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Steering Angle Sensor
> Component Information > Locations > Page 7575
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Telescoping Wheel
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
C2250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Tilt Wheel Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
C2250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Angle Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7585
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module.Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped). Failure to
follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable (14301) and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all supplemental restraint system (SRS) components are connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install restraints control module (RCM) fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7591
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off.If an air bag SRS fault
is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7592
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body.This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down.This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin.Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module.Doing so can result in safety canopy
deployment, which can result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device.Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner.Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector.Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON.This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and
the restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors are located in the first row doors, behind the door trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7593
auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).Failure to follow these instructions may
increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position. 8. Center the tilt steering column.
9. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock
position).
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws and pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
11. Remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
All vehicles 12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws. 13. Release the clips and
remove the steering column upper shroud. 14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7594
15. CAUTION: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each
of the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel.Failure to do so will damage the driver
air bag module and steering wheel.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity.The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
- Use a mirror to look at the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
- Note the position of the 2 driver air bag module locator pins to the steering wheel for installation.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
16. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors, then disconnect the horn switch
electrical connector and remove the driver air bag
module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight ahead position (the 12
o'clock position). 18. Open and lower the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7595
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat.The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector.
21. Release the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
22. Remove the bolt and the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7596
23. Remove the cover and the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7597
27. Remove the bolt and the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
28. Remove the cover and the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7598
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat.The driver seat side air bag module
electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SPDJB. 33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7599
5. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7600
9. Connect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
10. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7601
13. Attach the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector. 16. Close the glove compartment
door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag
module.Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module.Do not force
the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the horn switch electrical connector, then connect the 2 driver air bag module electrical
connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7602
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE:
- Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated correctly to the
steering wheel.
- Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks. -
Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud. 22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
23. Install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. Install the lower steering column opening cover and the 3 screws.
All vehicles 25. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 26. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and install the cover.
27. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
28. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming >
System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page
7603
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position.This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps.If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Bearing: > 08-17-4 > Sep >
08 > Interior - Tick/Creak From Instrument Panel Area
Steering Column Bearing: Customer Interest Interior - Tick/Creak From Instrument Panel Area
TSB 08-17-4
09/01/08
TICKING OR CREAKING SOUND - INSTRUMENT PANEL AREA
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a ticking or creaking sound
coming from the instrument panel area.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To determine if column lower bearing is source of noise, do the following:
1. Park vehicle on level ground with steering wheel in straight ahead 12 o'clock position and engine
off.
2. From underneath instrument panel, grasp lower intermediate shaft U-joint and apply light
pressure up and down to load the lower column bearing.
3. Listen for any ticking or creaking sound while applying pressure up and down.
4. If no noise is heard at 12 o'clock wheel position, repeat Step 3 at the 3, 6, and 9 o'clock wheel
positions.
5. If noise is detected, use chassis ears to confirm noise is coming from plastic steering column
lower bearing. Noise will be loudest with chassis ears attached to the plastic tone ring disc, which is
part of bearing.
a. If the noise is confirmed go to Step 6.
b. If not confirmed this procedure does not apply. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
100-04.
NOTE
COMPLETE DISASSEMBLY OF STEERING COLUMN IS NOT REQUIRED. FOLLOW THE
WORKSHOP MANUAL STEPS NECESSARY TO REMOVE ONLY THE LOWER STEERING
COLUMN BEARING.
6. Replace steering column lower bearing following WSM, Section 211-04.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081704A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Steering Column Lower Bearing. Includes Time to Remove and Install Steering
column.(Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Column Bearing: > 08-17-4 > Sep >
08 > Interior - Tick/Creak From Instrument Panel Area > Page 7612
Use With 3514A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A510 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Bearing: >
08-17-4 > Sep > 08 > Interior - Tick/Creak From Instrument Panel Area
Steering Column Bearing: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Tick/Creak From Instrument
Panel Area
TSB 08-17-4
09/01/08
TICKING OR CREAKING SOUND - INSTRUMENT PANEL AREA
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a ticking or creaking sound
coming from the instrument panel area.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To determine if column lower bearing is source of noise, do the following:
1. Park vehicle on level ground with steering wheel in straight ahead 12 o'clock position and engine
off.
2. From underneath instrument panel, grasp lower intermediate shaft U-joint and apply light
pressure up and down to load the lower column bearing.
3. Listen for any ticking or creaking sound while applying pressure up and down.
4. If no noise is heard at 12 o'clock wheel position, repeat Step 3 at the 3, 6, and 9 o'clock wheel
positions.
5. If noise is detected, use chassis ears to confirm noise is coming from plastic steering column
lower bearing. Noise will be loudest with chassis ears attached to the plastic tone ring disc, which is
part of bearing.
a. If the noise is confirmed go to Step 6.
b. If not confirmed this procedure does not apply. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
100-04.
NOTE
COMPLETE DISASSEMBLY OF STEERING COLUMN IS NOT REQUIRED. FOLLOW THE
WORKSHOP MANUAL STEPS NECESSARY TO REMOVE ONLY THE LOWER STEERING
COLUMN BEARING.
6. Replace steering column lower bearing following WSM, Section 211-04.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081704A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Steering Column Lower Bearing. Includes Time to Remove and Install Steering
column.(Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Steering Column Bearing >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Column Bearing: >
08-17-4 > Sep > 08 > Interior - Tick/Creak From Instrument Panel Area > Page 7618
Use With 3514A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A510 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Telescoping Wheel Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams
C227
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Telescoping Wheel Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams
C2250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Tilt Wheel Motor > Component
Information > Diagrams
C227
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Tilt Wheel Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams
C2250
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection
Steering Gear: Testing and Inspection
Steering Gear Grunt/Shudder Test
1. Start and run the vehicle to operating temperature. 2. Set engine idle speed to 1200 rpm.
3. CAUTION: Do not hold the steering wheel against the stops for more than 3 to 5 seconds at a
time. Damage to the power steering pump
will occur.
Rotate the steering wheel to the RH stop, then turn the steering wheel 90 degrees back from that
position. Slowly turn the steering wheel back and forth approximately 1/12 of a full turn.
4. Turn the steering wheel another 90 degrees. Slowly turn the steering wheel back and forth
approximately 1/12 of a full turn. 5. Repeat the test with the power steering fluid at different
temperatures. 6. If a light grunt is heard or a low (50-200 Hz) shudder is present, this is a normal
steering system condition. 7. If a loud grunt is heard, or a strong shudder is felt, purge the power
steering system. If a loud grunt or strong shudder still exists, check the power
steering lines/hoses for restrictions or damage and repair as necessary. If the lines/hoses are OK,
install a new steering gear.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7634
Steering Gear: Service and Repair
Steering Gear
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7635
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: While repairing the power steering system, care should be taken to prevent the entry of
contaminants or premature failure of the power steering components can result.
NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the steering
gear.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. CAUTION: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while disconnected from the gear or
damage to the clockspring can occur. if
there is evidence that the steering column shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be recentered.
Hold the steering wheel in the straight ahead position using a suitable holding device.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7636
3. Remove and discard the tie-rod end nuts.
4. CAUTION: Do not damage the tie-rod boot when installing the special tool.
Using the special tool, disconnect the tie-rod ends from the wheel knuckles.
5. Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab and rotate the shroud upward.
6. Remove the 2 bolts and the oil drip shield.
7. CAUTION: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while it is disconnected from the
steering gear or damage to the clockspring
can result. If there is evidence that the steering column shaft has rotated, the clockspring must be
removed and recentered.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7637
Remove the steering column shaft-to-steering gear bolt and disconnect the steering column shaft
from the steering gear.
8. CAUTION: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the lines are disconnected from the
steering gear.
Remove the steering line clamp plate bolt, rotate the clamp plate and disconnect the power
steering lines. ^
Discard the O-rings seals.
9. Remove the 2 steering gear bolts and remove the steering gear.
^ Discard the bolts.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Make sure the LH steering gear bushing is seated correctly or premature failure of
the steering gear can occur. The RH side
bushing does not have locking tabs.
Position the steering gear and install the 2 steering gear bolts. ^
Tighten to 440 Nm (325 lb-ft).
2. Connect the steering column shaft and install the bolt.
^ Tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: New O-ring seals must be installed any time the line is disconnected from the power
steering gear.
Connect the steering lines, rotate the clamp plate and install the clamp plate bolt. ^
Tighten to 23 Nm (17 lb-ft).
4. Install the oil drip shield and the 2 bolts.
^ Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 7638
5. Release the lower cooling fan shroud tab and rotate the shroud downward.
6. CAUTION: Make sure that the tie-rod end boots are seated correctly on the tie-rod ends or
premature failure can occur.
Connect the tie-rod ends to the wheel knuckles and install the nuts. ^
Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
7. Fill the power steering system. 8. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Steering Shaft: Service and Repair
Steering Column Shaft
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position the vehicle on a hoist. 2. Place the steering wheel and
the front wheels in the straight-ahead position. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position and
remove the key.
3. CAUTION: Do not allow the steering column shaft to rotate while the intermediate shaft is
disconnected or damage to the clockspring
can result. If there is evidence that the shaft has rotated, the clock spring must be recentered.
Remove the bolt and disconnect the steering column shaft from the steering column. ^
Discard the bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
4. Remove the bolt and disconnect the upper intermediate shaft from the lower intermediate shaft.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Shaft > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 7642
^ Discard the bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
5. Remove the 2 bolts, the dash seal and the upper intermediate shaft.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
6. Remove the bolt and disconnect the lower steering column shaft from the steering gear.
^ Discard the bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
7. CAUTION: New steering column shaft bolts must be installed.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering
Wheel Is Loose
Steering Wheel: Customer Interest Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering Wheel Is Loose
TSB 07-4-3
03/05/07
LEATHER - WRAPPED STEERING WHEEL - LEATHER COMING LOOSE
FORD: 2000-2005 Thunderbird 2000-2007 Crown Victoria, Focus, Mustang, Taurus 2005-2007
Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1999-2003 Windstar 1999-2008 F-Super Duty
2000-2005 Excursion 2000-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, Ranger 2001-2003 Explorer Sport
2001-2007 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2008 Escape 2004-2007 F-150, Freestar 2005-2008 Escape
Hybrid 2007 Edge 2004-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 2000-2002 Continental 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2000-2007 Town Car 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 2000-2007 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT 2007 MKX
MERCURY: 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007 Montego 2006-2007 Milan
2000-2007 Mountaineer 2004-2007 Monterey 2005-2008 Mariner 2006-2008 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 04-24-3 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some vehicles equipped with leather-wrapped steering wheels may exhibit the leather
coming loose from the spoke area.
ACTION Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive to re-adhere the loose leather to the wheel spoke.
Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF RE-ADHERING LEATHER TO THE FRONT SIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL ONLY, OMIT
STEPS 1 AND 6. STEERING WHEEL/AIR BAG ASSEMBLY REMOVAL IS NECESSARY ONLY
WHEN REPAIRING LOOSE LEATHER ON THE BACKSIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL.
CAUTION
AVOID SKIN CONTACT WITH MOTORCRAFT INSTANT GEL ADHESIVE.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering
Wheel Is Loose > Page 7651
1. Remove the steering wheel (ONLY NECESSARY TO REPAIR BACKSIDE OF STEERING
WHEEL). Refer to Workshop Manual Sections 211-04 and 501-20B.
2. Fold loose leather out of the way.
3. Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive evenly over the wheel spoke.
4. Fold the leather back into its original position.
5. Smooth the leather tuck in for neat appearance, and apply pressure until the leather is bonded to
the wheel spoke (apply pressure for at least 30 seconds).
NOTE
THE ADHESIVE SHOULD BE COMPLETELY SET AFTER 5 MINUTES. DO NOT PULL ON THE
REPAIR AREA.
6. Reinstall steering wheel.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070403 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3600 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On
Steering Wheel Is Loose
Steering Wheel: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Leather Wrapping On Steering Wheel Is
Loose
TSB 07-4-3
03/05/07
LEATHER - WRAPPED STEERING WHEEL - LEATHER COMING LOOSE
FORD: 2000-2005 Thunderbird 2000-2007 Crown Victoria, Focus, Mustang, Taurus 2005-2007
Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1999-2003 Windstar 1999-2008 F-Super Duty
2000-2005 Excursion 2000-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, Ranger 2001-2003 Explorer Sport
2001-2007 Explorer Sport Trac 2001-2008 Escape 2004-2007 F-150, Freestar 2005-2008 Escape
Hybrid 2007 Edge 2004-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 2000-2002 Continental 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2000-2007 Town Car 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 2000-2007 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT 2007 MKX
MERCURY: 2000-2005 Sable 2000-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007 Montego 2006-2007 Milan
2000-2007 Mountaineer 2004-2007 Monterey 2005-2008 Mariner 2006-2008 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 04-24-3 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some vehicles equipped with leather-wrapped steering wheels may exhibit the leather
coming loose from the spoke area.
ACTION Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive to re-adhere the loose leather to the wheel spoke.
Refer to the following Service Procedure.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF RE-ADHERING LEATHER TO THE FRONT SIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL ONLY, OMIT
STEPS 1 AND 6. STEERING WHEEL/AIR BAG ASSEMBLY REMOVAL IS NECESSARY ONLY
WHEN REPAIRING LOOSE LEATHER ON THE BACKSIDE OF THE STEERING WHEEL.
CAUTION
AVOID SKIN CONTACT WITH MOTORCRAFT INSTANT GEL ADHESIVE.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Steering Wheel: > 07-4-3 > Mar > 07 > Interior - Leather Wrapping On
Steering Wheel Is Loose > Page 7657
1. Remove the steering wheel (ONLY NECESSARY TO REPAIR BACKSIDE OF STEERING
WHEEL). Refer to Workshop Manual Sections 211-04 and 501-20B.
2. Fold loose leather out of the way.
3. Apply Motorcraft Instant Gel Adhesive evenly over the wheel spoke.
4. Fold the leather back into its original position.
5. Smooth the leather tuck in for neat appearance, and apply pressure until the leather is bonded to
the wheel spoke (apply pressure for at least 30 seconds).
NOTE
THE ADHESIVE SHOULD BE COMPLETELY SET AFTER 5 MINUTES. DO NOT PULL ON THE
REPAIR AREA.
6. Reinstall steering wheel.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070403 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3600 33
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 7658
View 151-17 (Steering Wheel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left
Steering Wheel: Diagrams Steering Wheel Switch, Left
C2366
C2998
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Steering Wheel Switch, Left > Page 7661
Steering Wheel: Diagrams Steering Wheel Switch, Right
C2367
C2999
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 7662
Steering Wheel: Service and Repair
Steering Wheel
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driver air bag module. 2. Turn the steering wheel to the straight-ahead position. 3.
Remove and discard the steering wheel bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Remove the steering wheel while routing the wires from the clockspring through the steering
wheel.
5. NOTE: A new steering wheel bolt must be installed.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair
Tie Rod: Service and Repair
Inner Tie Rod
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 7666
Removal
CAUTION: The steering gear bellows boots and clamps are designed to provide an airtight seal
and protect the internal components of the steering gear. If the seal is not airtight, the vacuum
generated during turning will draw water and contamination into the gear, causing premature
damage.
CAUTION: Zip ties do not produce an airtight seal and must not be used.
CAUTION: The inner tie-rod ball joint grease is not compatible with water. Contamination trapped
in the grease will degrade the life of the joint.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 7667
CAUTION: If present, the orientation of the vent tube must be noted so the boots and vent tubes
can be installed in the correct location.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Loosen the tie-rod end jam nut. 3.
Remove and discard the tie-rod end nut.
4. CAUTION: Careful not to damage the tie-rod boot when installing the special tool.
Using the special tool, disconnect the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle.
5. NOTE: Count the number of turns required to remove the tie-rod end for reference during
installation.
Remove the tie-rod end.
6. Remove the tie-rod end jam nut.
7. NOTE: New bellows boot clamps must be installed.
Remove and discard the inner and outer bellows boot clamp.
8. Remove the steering gear bellows boot.
9. CAUTION: Place the steering gear at the center position. Use a 1-1/16 inch crowfoot on the flat
of the rack gear to resist rotation and to prevent
damage during removal and installation of the inner tie rod.
NOTE: If repairing the RH side, it will be necessary to pull back the LH inner tie-rod boot to hold the
steering gear.
NOTE: An assistant may be needed for removal of the RH inner tie rod.
Using the special tool, remove the inner tie rod.
10. CAUTION: Thoroughly remove any abrasive material. This material is extremely harmful to the
steering gear.
Thoroughly clean and inspect all the parts to be reused. Install new parts as necessary.
Installation
1. Using the special tool, install the inner tie rod.
^ Tighten to 120 Nm (89 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 7668
2. NOTE: Apply steering gear grease to the steering gear bellows boot groove in the inner tie rod.
NOTE: Make sure the steering gear bellows boot is positioned correctly over the steering gear
housing bead and the groove in the inner tie rod.
Install the steering gear bellows boot.
3. Using the special tool, install a new inner bellows boot clamp.
4. NOTE: Make sure the end of the steering gear bellows is positioned between the 2 grooves on
the inner tie rod or an internal leak can result.
Install a new outer bellows boot clamp.
5. Thread the tie-rod end jam nut onto the inner tie rod.
6. NOTE: Install the tie-rod end the same number of turns as recorded during the removal.
Install the tie-rod end to the inner tie rod.
7. CAUTION: Make sure that the tie-rod end boots are seated correctly on the tie-rod ends or
premature failure can occur.
Connect the tie-rod end to the wheel knuckle and install a new tie-rod end nut. ^
Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
8. Tighten the tie-rod end jam nut.
^ Tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
9. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications
Ball Joint: Specifications
Ball joint deflection
Lower ...................................................................................................................................................
.............................................. 0-0.8 mm (0-0.032 in.) Upper ...............................................................
.................................................................................................................................. 0-0.2 mm
(0-0.008 in.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 7673
Ball Joint: Testing and Inspection
Ball Joint Inspection
1. Prior to inspecting the ball joints for wear, inspect the wheel bearings.
2. WARNING: If equipped with vehicle dynamic suspension, the system must be disabled prior to
lifting the vehicle. Failure to do so can
result in unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the
vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
NOTE: In order to obtain accurate measurements, the suspension must be in full rebound with the
weight of the vehicle supported by the frame.
Raise and support the vehicle by the frame to allow the wheels to hang in the rebound position.
3. Inspect the ball joint and ball joint boot for damage.
^ If the ball joint or ball joint boot is damaged, install a new ball joint as necessary.
NOTE: Carry out Steps 4-6 to inspect the lower ball joint. Carry out Steps 7-9 to inspect the upper
ball joint.
4. CAUTION: Do not use any tools or equipment to move the wheel and tire assembly or
suspension components while checking for relative
movement. Suspension damage can occur. The use of tools or equipment will also create relative
movement that may not exist when using hand force. Relative movement must be measured using
hand force only.
NOTE: The weight of the wheel and tire assembly must be overcome to obtain an accurate
measurement on the dial indicator.
Inspect the ball joint for relative movement by alternately pulling downward and pushing upward on
the wheel and tire assembly by hand. Note any relative vertical movement between the wheel
knuckle and lower arm at the lower ball joint. ^
If relative movement is not felt or seen, the ball joint is OK. Do not install a new ball joint.
^ If relative movement is found, continue with Step 5.
5. NOTE: In order to obtain an accurate measurement, the dial indicator should be aligned as close
as possible with the vertical axis (center line) of
the ball joint.
To measure ball joint deflection, attach a suitable dial indicator with a flexible arm between the
lower control arm and the wheel knuckle or ball joint stud.
6. Measure the ball joint deflection while an assistant pushes up and pulls down on the wheel and
tire assembly by hand.
^ If the deflection exceeds the specification, a new ball joint must be installed.
^ If the deflection meets the specification, continue with the procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 7674
7. CAUTION: Do not use any tools or equipment to move the wheel and tire assembly or
suspension components while checking for relative
movement. Suspension damage can occur. The use of tools or equipment will also create relative
movement that may not exist when using hand force. Relative movement must be measured using
hand force only.
Inspect the ball joint for relative movement by alternately pulling downward and pushing upward on
the upper control arm by hand. Note any relative vertical movement between the wheel knuckle
and upper arm at the upper ball joint. ^
If relative movement is not felt or seen, the ball joint is OK. Do not install a new ball joint.
^ If relative movement is found, continue with Step 8.
8. NOTE: In order to obtain an accurate measurement, the dial indicator should be aligned as close
as possible with the vertical axis of the ball joint.
To measure ball joint deflection, attach a suitable dial indicator with a flexible arm between the
upper control arm and the wheel knuckle or ball joint stud.
9. Measure the ball joint deflection while an assistant pushes up and then pulls down on the upper
control arm by hand.
^ If the deflection exceeds the specification, a new ball joint must be installed.
^ If the deflection meets the specification, no further action is required.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Front
Ball Joint - Lower
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the wheel knuckle. 2. Remove and discard the lower ball joint snap ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7677
3. Using the special tools, remove the lower ball joint.
4. CAUTION: Do not damage the lower ball joint boot when installing the special tool.
NOTE: Clean and inspect the lower arm lower ball joint bore for damage before installing a new
ball joint.
NOTE: Make sure the lower ball joint is fully seated in the lower control arm.
NOTE: Make sure the new lower ball joint snap ring is fully seated.
NOTE: Always install new nuts and cotter pins.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7678
Ball Joint: Service and Repair Rear
Ball Joint - Lower
Special Tool(s)
Removal
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7679
1. Remove the wheel knuckle. 2. Remove and discard the ball joint snap ring.
3. Using the special tools, remove the ball joint.
Installation
1. CAUTION: Do not damage the ball joint boot when installing the special tool.
NOTE: Clean and inspect the ball joint bore for bore damage before installing a new ball joint.
Using the special tool, install the ball joint.
2. NOTE Always use a new ball joint snap ring. Install a new snap ring.
3. Install the wheel knuckle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front
Control Arm: Service and Repair Front
Lower Arm
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower shock nut, lower arm forward nut or lower arm rearward nut
until the installation procedure is complete and the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and
tire assemblies.
1. Remove the wheel knuckle.
2. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nut. ^
To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
3. Remove the lower arm rearward nut and bolt.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
4. Remove the lower arm forward nut and bolt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7684
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 350 Nm (258 lb-ft).
5. Remove the shock absorber lower nut, bolt and the lower arm.
^ Discard the shock absorber lower nut.
^ To install, tighten to 475 Nm (350 lb-ft).
6. CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower shock nut, lower arm forward nut or lower arm rearward nut
until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7685
Control Arm: Service and Repair Rear
Upper Arm
Upper Arm
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Do not tighten the upper arm-to-frame bushing until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove and discard the upper
arm-to-wheel knuckle nut.
^ To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
3. Remove and discard the upper arm-to-frame bolt, washer, camber set shim and flagnut.
^ To install, tighten to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
4. Remove the upper arm.
5. CAUTION: Do not tighten the upper arm-to-frame bushing until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle is
resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7686
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear alignment.
Lower Arm
Lower Arm
Special Tool(s)
Removal
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Orientation of the suspension fasteners is important. Make sure the fasteners are
installed in the same direction as they were in when removed.
CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower arm-to-frame bolt or shock absorber lower nut until the
installation procedure is complete and the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front > Page 7687
weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. If equipped, disconnect the air suspension
height sensor connecting link from the lower arm. 3. Remove and discard the shock absorber lower
bolt and flagnut. 4. Remove and discard the lower arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut. 5. Remove and
discard the lower ball joint nut.
6. CAUTION: Do not damage the ball joint boot while installing the special tool.
Using the special tool, separate the lower ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
7. Swing the lower arm to the rear of the vehicle and remove the lower arm.
Installation
1. Position the lower arm ball joint onto the wheel knuckle and install the lower ball joint nut.
^ Tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
2. CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower arm-to-frame bolt at this time.
Install the lower arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut. ^
Snug the bolt to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
3. CAUTION: Do not tighten the shock absorber lower nut at this time.
Position the lower arm and install a new shock absorber lower bolt and nut.
4. Lower the vehicle so that the weight of the vehicle is on the wheel and tire assemblies. 5.
Tighten the lower arm-to-frame bolt to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft). 6. Tighten the shock absorber lower bolt
to 475 Nm (350 lb-ft). 7. If equipped, connect the air suspension height sensor connecting link to
the lower arm. 8. Check and, if necessary, align the rear end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Cross-Member: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION SUPPORT CROSSMEMBER
Transmission Support Crossmember - Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. If equipped, remove the skid plate
fasteners and skid plate.
3. Remove the LH and RH exhaust heat shield-to-crossmember fasteners.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7692
4. Remove the 2 transmission mount nuts.
- To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
5. Support the transmission.
6. NOTE:
- Mark the transmission crossmember next to the edge of the frame bracket to make sure the
crossmember is installed in the same position it was removed from.
- The crossmember nuts are installed on the crossmember bolts facing the front of the vehicle.
Remove the 4 transmission crossmember bolts (2 each side) and the transmission crossmember. To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
Wheel Knuckle
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7696
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower shock nut until the installation procedure is complete and the
weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
CAUTION: When servicing the lower shock nut, take care not to damage the stabilizer link.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub. 2. Remove and discard the tie-rod end nut.
^ To install, tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
3. Using the special tool, separate the tie-rod end from the wheel knuckle.
4. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7697
5. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the stabilizer bar link lower nut. ^
To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
6. Remove and discard the shock absorber lower nut and bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 475 Nm (350 lb-ft).
7. Remove the 3 integrated wheel end bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
8. Remove and discard the upper ball joint nut.
^ To install, tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
9. NOTE: Be sure not to damage the ball joint boot when installing the special tool.
Using the special tool, separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
10. Remove and discard the lower ball joint nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
11. CAUTION: Make sure to use the special tool when separating the lower ball joint from the
knuckle to prevent damage to the ball joint
boot.
Using the special tool, separate the lower ball joint from the wheel knuckle and remove the wheel
knuckle.
12. If necessary, remove the 3 brake disc shield bolts and remove the brake disc shield.
^ To install, tighten to 17 Nm (13 lb-ft).
13. CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower shock nut until the installation procedure is complete and
the weight of the vehicle is resting on the
wheel and tire assemblies.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7698
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
14. Check and, if necessary, align the front end.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing
Rear Knuckle: Service and Repair Wheel Knuckle Bushing
Wheel Knuckle Bushing
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 7703
Removal
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Do not tighten the upper trailing arm-to-knuckle bolt until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove and discard the upper trailing
arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt.
^ Position the upper trailing arm upward to access the wheel knuckle bushing.
3. Using the special tools, remove the wheel knuckle bushing.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 7704
1. Clean and inspect the wheel knuckle bushing bore for damage or excessive wear. 2. Position the
new wheel knuckle bushing with the larger void facing towards the upper trailing arm.
3. Install the special tools.
4. CAUTION: Do not use the forward forcing screw nut to install the bushing. The forward forcing
screw nut is only used to properly
position and align the bushing for installation.
Hand tighten the forward forcing screw nut to align the bushing with the rearward side of the wheel
knuckle bore.
5. CAUTION: Use the rearward forcing screw nut to install the bushing or damage to the bushing
and/or the wheel knuckle bushing bore
can result.
Tighten the rearward forcing screw nut and install the bushing until it is centered in the wheel
knuckle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 7705
6. NOTE: After installing the wheel knuckle bushing, make sure to measure the bushings position
in the wheel knuckle bore. The measurement from
the bushings outer metal surface to the machined face surface of knuckle bore should be 2.54 mm
(0.16 in) +/- 0.25 mm (0.01 in).
If necessary, use the special tool to adjust the bushing position in the wheel knuckle bushing bore.
7. CAUTION: Do not tighten the upper trailing arm-to-knuckle bolt until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the
vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
Connect the upper trailing arm to the wheel knuckle. ^
Tighten the bolt to 250 Nm (184 lb-ft).
8. Remove the jack stand from under the lower arm.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 7706
Rear Knuckle: Service and Repair Wheel Knuckle
Wheel Knuckle
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Do not tighten the upper arm-to wheel knuckle bolt or the toe link-to-wheel knuckle bolt
until the installation procedure is complete and the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and
tire assemblies.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 7707
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub assembly. 2. Remove the parking brake shoes. 3.
Remove the brake disc shield. 4. Compress the spring and depress the retaining tabs and detach
the parking brake cable from the wheel knuckle.
5. Remove and discard the upper arm-to-wheel knuckle nut.
^ To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
6. Using the special tool, separate the upper arm from the wheel knuckle.
7. Remove and discard the lower ball joint nut.
^ To install, tighten to 150 Nm (111 lb-ft).
8. Using the special tool, separate the lower ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
9. Remove and discard the 2 bolts and disconnect the lower trailing arm from the wheel knuckle.
^ To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
10. CAUTION: Do not tighten the toe link-to- wheel knuckle bolt until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle is
resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
Remove and discard the bolt and disconnect the toe link from the wheel knuckle. ^
To install, tighten to 225 Nm (166 lb-ft).
11. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Using the hex hold feature, remove and discard the stabilizer bar link nut and disconnect the link
from the wheel knuckle. ^
To install, tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Wheel Knuckle Bushing > Page 7708
12. CAUTION: Do not tighten the upper arm-to wheel knuckle until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle is
resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
Remove the upper trailing arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt and the wheel knuckle. ^
Discard the bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 250 Nm (184 lb-ft).
13. CAUTION: Do not tighten the upper arm-to wheel knuckle bolt or the toe link-to wheel knuckle
bolt until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle Alignment Link > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Knuckle Alignment Link: Service and Repair
Toe Link
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Do not tighten the toe link-to-frame cam bolt or toe link-to-wheel knuckle bolt until the
installation procedure is complete and the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire
assemblies.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Index-mark the cam bolt and cam washer
positions. 3. Remove and discard the bolt and washer.
^ To install, tighten to 225 Nm (166 lb-ft).
4. Remove the toe link-to-frame cam bolt, cam washer and nut.
^ To install, tighten to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
5. Remove the toe link.
6. CAUTION: Do not tighten the toe link-to-frame cam bolt or the toe link-to-wheel knuckle bolt until
the installation procedure is complete
and the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
NOTE: Using the index marks made in Step 5, transfer the marks onto the new cam bolt and cam
washer. Use these index marks when installing the toe link.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Rear Knuckle Alignment Link > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7712
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Check and, if necessary, adjust the rear toe.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 7717
Compressor/Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 7718
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 7719
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7723
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
C2131A
C2131B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Relays and Modules - Suspension > Suspension
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7724
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Module
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. NOTE: The air suspension control module is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 air suspension control module electrical connectors.
3. Remove the air suspension control module nuts and the air suspension control module.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. NOTE: The air suspension control module is calibrated with information from the ride height
sensors. A new or exchanged air suspension control
module requires that the LH and RH ride height sensors are calibrated and a pneumatic test is
carried out. For additional information, refer to Vehicle Dynamic Suspension Calibration Initialize
System - Clear C1990 and C1991 DTCs.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Ride Height
Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
LH Side
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Ride Height
Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7729
RH Side
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the senor harness from the
sensor bracket. 3. Disconnect the sensor electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the sensor arm from
the ball stud on the lower control arm. 5. Remove and discard the 2 sensor bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensor assemblies cannot be used on opposite sides of the
vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the LH and RH height sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Suspension > Steering Angle
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 7733
C226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair Front
Stabilizer Bar and Link
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: The hex holding feature can be used to prevent turning of the stud while removing the
nut.
Remove and discard the 2 stabilizer bar link upper nuts. ^
To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 7739
3. CAUTION: Do not hold the stabilizer link boot with any tool, as damage to the boot will occur.
NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the 2 stabilizer bar link lower nuts and remove the 2 stabilizer bar links. ^
To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 4 stabilizer bar bracket nuts, brackets and the stabilizer bar.
^ Discard the nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
5. Remove and discard the stabilizer bracket bolt plates.
6. NOTE: Make sure the stabilizer bar bushing upset is installed into the bracket groove.
Inspect and, if necessary, install new stabilizer bar bushings.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 7740
Stabilizer Link: Service and Repair Rear
Stabilizer Bar and Link
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the stud from turning while removing the nut.
NOTE: The stabilizer bar links are designed with low friction ball joints that have a low breakaway
torque.
Remove the 4 stabilizer bar link nuts and the links. ^
Discard the nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 63 Nm (46 lb-ft).
3. Remove the 4 stabilizer bar bracket nuts, the 2 stabilizer bar brackets and the stabilizer bar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control > Stabilizer Link >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 7741
^ Discard the nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 48 Nm (35 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Inspect and, if necessary, install new bushings.
NOTE: The rear stabilizer must be installed with the center hump facing down.
NOTE: The rear stabilizer bar bushings must be installed outboard of the upset rings on the
stabilizer bar.
NOTE: The stabilizer bar link stone shields must be installed on the stabilizer bar attachment point.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Line, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Line: Service and Repair
Air Line Repair
1. Cut the line at the damaged area. 2. Trim the sleeve material from both ends of the damaged
line.
3. Taper both ends of the tube by shaving or sanding it 3 mm (0.11 in) from the tips.
4. Install the repair filling.
5. NOTE: Check system for leaks.
Inflate the air suspension system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Spring: > 08-24-7 > Dec > 08 >
Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
Air Spring: Customer Interest Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
TSB 08-24-7
12/08/08
REAR LOAD LEVELING LEAKS DOWN IN EXTREME COLD WEATHER
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigators vehicles equipped with rear load leveling
suspension, may exhibit air suspension leak down on one or both rear corners after extended
periods of time in temperatures of -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below. The leak
down is the result of premature wear of solenoid seat at low temperatures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Determine that concern occurs at -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below, after
sitting long periods of time, usually over night. If concern does not occur under these conditions, do
not continue with this procedure.
The concern may not be duplicated if the vehicle has been sitting inside for over 15 minutes.
Replace the air spring solenoid valve per Workshop Manual, Section 204-05: Vehicle Dynamic
Suspension.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082407A 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Replace ONE Rear Air Spring Solenoid. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
082407B 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator: Replace BOTH Rear Air Spring Solenoids. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3B486 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Spring: > 08-24-7 >
Dec > 08 > Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
Air Spring: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
TSB 08-24-7
12/08/08
REAR LOAD LEVELING LEAKS DOWN IN EXTREME COLD WEATHER
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigators vehicles equipped with rear load leveling
suspension, may exhibit air suspension leak down on one or both rear corners after extended
periods of time in temperatures of -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below. The leak
down is the result of premature wear of solenoid seat at low temperatures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Determine that concern occurs at -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below, after
sitting long periods of time, usually over night. If concern does not occur under these conditions, do
not continue with this procedure.
The concern may not be duplicated if the vehicle has been sitting inside for over 15 minutes.
Replace the air spring solenoid valve per Workshop Manual, Section 204-05: Vehicle Dynamic
Suspension.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082407A 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Replace ONE Rear Air Spring Solenoid. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
082407B 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator: Replace BOTH Rear Air Spring Solenoids. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3B486 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7759
Air Spring: Service and Repair
Air Shock Absorber - Rear
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7760
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not remove an air spring under any circumstances when there is pressure in the air
spring. Do not remove any components supporting an air spring without either exhausting the air or
providing support for the air spring. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital
components and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the
same part number must be used if installation is necessary. Do not use a new part of lesser quality
or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of
correct retention of these parts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Air
Spring > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7761
1. Using the scan tool, vent the appropriate air spring. 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it
on a hoist. 3. Remove the lower arm. 4. Disconnect the air spring solenoid valve electrical
connector. 5. Disconnect the air line at the air valve.
^ Compress the orange quick connect lock ring, then pull downward on the air supply line.
6. Remove and discard the 3 shock upper nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
7. Remove the air shock absorber.
8. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue with
Step 14.
NOTE: Use the hex holding feature to prevent the shock rod from turning while removing the nut.
Remove and discard the shock rod nut. ^
To install, tighten to 45 Nm (33 lb-ft).
9. CAUTION: If the retainer tabs are broken, a new air spring must be installed.
NOTE: Index-mark the air spring and shock absorber for reference during the installation
procedure.
Depress the retainer tabs and remove the air spring.
10. Remove the shock rod O-ring seal, washer and jounce bumper.
^ Discard the seal and washer.
11. Remove and discard the 2 air spring lower O-ring seals. 12. Remove the 2 retainer screws and
the upper mount.
^ Discard the screws.
13. Remove and discard the 2 air spring upper O-ring seals.
14. CAUTION: Use a suitable press to install the upper mount retainer pins. Do not use a hammer
or damage may occur.
NOTE: Make sure that all seals are clean and free of debris.
NOTE: Apply a thin coat of grease to the new O-ring seals.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump, Suspension Control > Component Information > Diagrams
C1179
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump, Suspension Control > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 7765
Compressor/Pump: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Compressor
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the inner fender splash shield. 2. Disconnect the air line from the compressor drier.
^ Compress the quick connect lock ring inward, then pull the line outward from the air drier.
3. Disconnect the air compressor air intake hose. 4. Disconnect the air compressor electrical
connector. 5. Remove the 3 air compressor bracket bolts and remove the air compressor and
bracket assembly.
^ To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: When installing the air lines, make sure the white inner air line is fully inserted into the
fitting for correct installation.
NOTE: Make sure that there are no objects trapped under or on the bracket.
Make sure that the air compressor is not in contact with any surrounding components that could
cause vibration noises.
NOTE: Make sure that the air compressor moves freely in the rubber isolators.
Make sure that the bracket has no deformations that could cause the 3 rubber isolators to load
against each other.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 7769
Compressor/Pump Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 7770
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Compressor/Pump Relay, Suspension Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 7771
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Damping Control Actuator > Component Information > Locations
Damping Control Actuator: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Damping Control Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 7775
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Damping Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Rear
C4044
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Damping Control Actuator > Component Information > Diagrams > Air Spring Solenoid Valve, Left Rear > Page 7778
C4045
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Level Control
Solenoid Valve: > 08-24-7 > Dec > 08 > Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
Level Control Solenoid Valve: Customer Interest Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
TSB 08-24-7
12/08/08
REAR LOAD LEVELING LEAKS DOWN IN EXTREME COLD WEATHER
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigators vehicles equipped with rear load leveling
suspension, may exhibit air suspension leak down on one or both rear corners after extended
periods of time in temperatures of -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below. The leak
down is the result of premature wear of solenoid seat at low temperatures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Determine that concern occurs at -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below, after
sitting long periods of time, usually over night. If concern does not occur under these conditions, do
not continue with this procedure.
The concern may not be duplicated if the vehicle has been sitting inside for over 15 minutes.
Replace the air spring solenoid valve per Workshop Manual, Section 204-05: Vehicle Dynamic
Suspension.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082407A 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Replace ONE Rear Air Spring Solenoid. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
082407B 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator: Replace BOTH Rear Air Spring Solenoids. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3B486 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Level
Control Solenoid Valve: > 08-24-7 > Dec > 08 > Suspension - Rear Load Leveling Leak Down
Level Control Solenoid Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Rear Load Leveling
Leak Down
TSB 08-24-7
12/08/08
REAR LOAD LEVELING LEAKS DOWN IN EXTREME COLD WEATHER
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigators vehicles equipped with rear load leveling
suspension, may exhibit air suspension leak down on one or both rear corners after extended
periods of time in temperatures of -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below. The leak
down is the result of premature wear of solenoid seat at low temperatures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Determine that concern occurs at -22 degrees Fahrenheit (-30 degrees Celsius) or below, after
sitting long periods of time, usually over night. If concern does not occur under these conditions, do
not continue with this procedure.
The concern may not be duplicated if the vehicle has been sitting inside for over 15 minutes.
Replace the air spring solenoid valve per Workshop Manual, Section 204-05: Vehicle Dynamic
Suspension.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082407A 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Replace ONE Rear Air Spring Solenoid. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
082407B 2007-2009 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
Navigator: Replace BOTH Rear Air Spring Solenoids. (Do Not Use With 5300A9 5300A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3B486 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7792
Level Control Solenoid Valve: Service and Repair
Air Spring Solenoid Valve
Special Tool(s)
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Level
Control Solenoid Valve > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7793
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not remove an air spring under any circumstances when there is pressure in the air
spring. Do not remove any components supporting an air spring without either exhausting the air or
providing support for the air spring. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. If the air spring solenoid valve is functional, use the scan tool to vent the appropriate air
spring(s). 2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Disconnect the air spring
solenoid valve electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the air line at the air valve.
^ Compress the orange quick connect lock ring, then pull downward on the air supply line.
5. CAUTION: Remove any dirt or other foreign material from the air spring assembly prior to
removing the air spring solenoid valve from
the air spring assembly.
Remove the air spring solenoid clip.
6. WARNING: The air spring solenoid valve has a 2-stage release. When removing a
non-functional solenoid and the air spring is inflated,
carefully rotate the solenoid counterclockwise until it reaches the first stage to release the air from
the air spring. Turn the solenoid to the second stage to remove the solenoid. Failure to follow these
instructions when removing a non-functional air spring solenoid may result in personal injury or
damage to components as high pressure air is vented uncontrolled.
Rotate the air spring solenoid and remove the solenoid.
7. NOTE: Inspect the air spring O-ring for damage and install a new O-ring as necessary. Lightly
lubricate the solenoid seal area with silicone
grease.
NOTE: After installing the solenoid, it is necessary to inflate the air suspension system.
NOTE: When installing the air spring solenoid, make sure that the electrical connector is positioned
away from the air spring.
NOTE: When installing the air lines, make sure the air line is fully inserted into the fitting for correct
installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Ride
Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ride Height Sensor: Service and Repair
Suspension Height Sensor
LH Side
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) > Ride
Height Sensor, Suspension Control > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7797
RH Side
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the senor harness from the
sensor bracket. 3. Disconnect the sensor electrical connector. 4. Disconnect the sensor arm from
the ball stud on the lower control arm. 5. Remove and discard the 2 sensor bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: The RH and LH height sensor assemblies cannot be used on opposite sides of the
vehicle.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Calibrate the LH and RH height sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7801
Suspension Control Module: Diagrams
C2131A
C2131B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Control ( Automatic - Electronic ) >
Suspension Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7802
Suspension Control Module: Service and Repair
Air Suspension Module
Removal and Installation
1. CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
Disconnect the battery ground cable.
2. NOTE: The air suspension control module is mounted to the lower left side of the dash above
the parking brake control.
Disconnect the 2 air suspension control module electrical connectors.
3. Remove the air suspension control module nuts and the air suspension control module.
^ To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. NOTE: The air suspension control module is calibrated with information from the ride height
sensors. A new or exchanged air suspension control
module requires that the LH and RH ride height sensors are calibrated and a pneumatic test is
carried out. For additional information, refer to Vehicle Dynamic Suspension Calibration Initialize
System - Clear C1990 and C1991 DTCs.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 08-19-11 > Sep >
08 > Suspension - Front/Rear Suspension Squeak/Rattle
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Customer Interest Suspension - Front/Rear Suspension
Squeak/Rattle
TSB 08-19-11
09/29/08
SQUEAK / RATTLE FRONT OR REAR SUSPENSION
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a squeak noise from the
front or rear suspension. The source of the noise may be the lower shock attachment bolt and nut.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use chassis ears to confirm the noise is coming from the shock to lower control arm attachment
nut and bolt.
2. If confirmed, loosen the nut and bolt and re-torque to the 350 lb-ft (475 N.m) specification in the
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 204.
3. Retest for the noise. If concern still exists, replace the shock, nut and attaching bolt per WSM,
Section 204.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081911A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Diagnosis, Includes Time To Install Chassis Ears, and Torque Fasteners. Includes All
Necessary Road Tests, This Labor Operation Can
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: > 08-19-11 > Sep >
08 > Suspension - Front/Rear Suspension Squeak/Rattle > Page 7811
Be Claimed With Any Of the Operations In This Article (Do Not Use With 18124A, 18125A, 5649A)
081911B 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace One Front Shock This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, D
Or E (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911C 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Both Front Shocks This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, D
Or E (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911D 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: Replace One Rear Shock This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, B
Or C (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911E 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Both Rear Shocks This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, B
Or C (Do Not Use With 18124A, 18125A, 5649A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18125 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: >
08-19-11 > Sep > 08 > Suspension - Front/Rear Suspension Squeak/Rattle
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Front/Rear
Suspension Squeak/Rattle
TSB 08-19-11
09/29/08
SQUEAK / RATTLE FRONT OR REAR SUSPENSION
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a squeak noise from the
front or rear suspension. The source of the noise may be the lower shock attachment bolt and nut.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use chassis ears to confirm the noise is coming from the shock to lower control arm attachment
nut and bolt.
2. If confirmed, loosen the nut and bolt and re-torque to the 350 lb-ft (475 N.m) specification in the
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 204.
3. Retest for the noise. If concern still exists, replace the shock, nut and attaching bolt per WSM,
Section 204.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081911A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Diagnosis, Includes Time To Install Chassis Ears, and Torque Fasteners. Includes All
Necessary Road Tests, This Labor Operation Can
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: >
08-19-11 > Sep > 08 > Suspension - Front/Rear Suspension Squeak/Rattle > Page 7817
Be Claimed With Any Of the Operations In This Article (Do Not Use With 18124A, 18125A, 5649A)
081911B 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace One Front Shock This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, D
Or E (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911C 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Both Front Shocks This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, D
Or E (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911D 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: Replace One Rear Shock This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, B
Or C (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911E 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Both Rear Shocks This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, B
Or C (Do Not Use With 18124A, 18125A, 5649A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18125 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Removal and Replacement
Shock Absorber and Spring Assembly
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the lower arm. 2. Remove and discard the upper mount nuts.
^ To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. Remove the shock absorber and spring assembly.
4. NOTE: If the individual spring and/or shock components are not being serviced, continue with
Step 7.
NOTE: For reference during assembly, index the upper mount, spring and shock absorber.
Using a suitable spring compressor, compress the spring until the tension is released from the
shock absorber.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal and Replacement > Page 7820
5. While holding the shock rod, remove the nut and washer.
^ Remove the shock absorber.
^ Discard the nut.
^ To install, tighten to 56 Nm (41 lb-ft).
6. Remove the upper mount, dust boot and insulator.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Trailing Arm - Upper
Trailing Arm: Service and Repair Trailing Arm - Upper
Trailing Arm - Upper
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Do not tighten the upper arm-to-frame bolt or upper arm-to-knuckle bolt until the
installation procedure is complete and the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire
assemblies.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove and discard the upper trailing
arm-to-wheel knuckle bolt.
^ To install, tighten to 250 Nm (184 lb-ft).
3. Remove and discard the upper trailing arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut.
^ To install, tighten to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: After removal of the upper trailing arm, inspect the knuckle bushing for excessive wear or
damage and replace if necessary.
Remove the upper trailing arm.
5. CAUTION: Do not tighten the upper arm-to-frame bolt or upper arm-to-knuckle bolt until the
installation procedure is complete and the
weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Trailing Arm - Upper > Page 7825
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Trailing Arm > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Trailing Arm - Upper > Page 7826
Trailing Arm: Service and Repair Trailing Arm - Lower
Trailing Arm - Lower
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower trailing arm-to-frame bolt until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove and discard the 2 lower trailing
arm-to-wheel knuckle bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
3. Remove and discard the lower trailing arm-to-frame bolt and flagnut.
^ To install, tighten to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
4. Remove the lower trailing arm.
5. CAUTION: Do not tighten the lower trailing arm-to-frame bolt until the installation procedure is
complete and the weight of the vehicle
is resting on the wheel and tire assemblies.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 7831
major service expense. A new part with the same part number must be installed if installation
becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque
values must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these
parts.
1. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness
bolt and detach the harness from the retainers.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Remove the halfshaft nut dust cap. 7. Remove and discard the
halfshaft nut.
^ To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
8. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and wheel hub bolts and the wheel hub.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 lb-ft).
9. If installing a new wheel bearing and wheel hub, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the
wheel speed sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
10. CAUTION: If the original wheel bearing and wheel hub is being installed, install a new wheel
hub O-ring seal.
CAUTION: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the halfshaft
nut.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 7832
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the halfshaft nut. ^
To install, tighten to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
3. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV joint from the wheel hub.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Front > Page 7833
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose can result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Detach the wheel speed sensor harness from the retainers and
disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
7. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and wheel hub bolts, the wheel bearing assembly and the wheel
speed sensor as an assembly.
^ Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
^ Discard the bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 lb-ft).
8. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and wheel hub.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications > Front
Axle Nut: Specifications Front
Front Axle nut.......................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 27 Nm (20 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications > Front > Page 7839
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear
Rear axle Nut .......................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 300 Nm (221 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7843
C1157
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Wheel Hub (Locking): Service and Repair
Integrated Wheel End (IWE)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the front wheel and tire.
3. Remove the dust cap.
4. Remove and discard the axle nut.
5. Disconnect the vacuum tubes from the Integrated Wheel End (IWE).
6. Remove the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
7. Remove the tie-rod nut and separate the tie rod from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the tie-rod nut.
8. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
9. Remove the front brake flexible hose bracket bolt and position the brake hose aside.
10. Remove the upper ball joint nut and separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the upper ball joint nut.
11. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, remove the halfshaft outboard end from the wheel knuckle hub
bearing.
12. Remove the IWE from the halfshaft outboard end.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 7847
1. Compress the IWE and install a vacuum cap on the vacuum port.
2. NOTICE: Do not dislodge the Integrated Wheel End (IWE) seal spring when installing the IWE
on halfshaft outboard end or component
damage may occur.
Install the IWE onto the halfshaft outboard end.
3. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, install the halfshaft outboard end into the wheel knuckle hub bearing.
4. Connect the upper ball joint and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
5. Connect the tie rod and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
6. Position the front brake flexible hose bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Position the wheel speed sensor harness bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
8. Install the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
9. Remove the IWE vacuum cap and connect the vacuum tubes.
10. NOTICE: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the axle nut
or component damage may occur.
Install the new axle nut.
- Tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
11. Install the dust cap.
12. Install the front wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Vehicle Lifting: Description and Operation
JACKING
WARNING:
- The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting or jacking an
air suspension equipped vehicle. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or deflation of
the air springs which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations. Failure to follow
these instructions may result in personal injury.
- Do not run the engine when jacking the vehicle. The wheels contacting the ground could cause
the vehicle to move.
- Support the vehicle prior to carrying out any procedure requiring the vehicle to be jacked off the
ground.
- Make sure the jack and jack stands are correctly located to prevent the vehicle from falling.
- Wheel chocks should be used to prevent the vehicle from rolling and falling off the jack.
CAUTION:
- Never use a halfshaft as a lifting point.
- If equipped with retractable running board, disable the system through the instrument cluster
controls.
Disable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level Control.
Jacking Points - Front
The front jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located behind the front tire and
wheel assembly.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
Jacking Points - Rear
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7852
CAUTION: Do not use the differential housing as a lift point. Leaks or damage to the rear axle
cover and adjoining differential housing surface can occur if a floor jack or any lifting device is
allowed to contact the cover at any point where the cover joins the housing.
CAUTION: Do not use the rear control arms as a lifting point.
The rear jacking point is indicated by an arrow cutout in the frame, located in front of the rear tire
and wheel assembly.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
LIFTING
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting or
jacking an air suspension equipped vehicle. Failure to do so may result in unexpected inflation or
deflation of the air springs which may result in shifting of the vehicle during these operations.
Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Damage to suspension, exhaust and steering linkage components can occur if care is
not exercised when positioning the hoist adapters prior to lifting the vehicle.
Disable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level Control.
Lifting Points - Twin Post Hoist
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Vehicle Lifting > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 7853
Locate the front hoist adapters and rear hoist adapters (top of frame arc) as indicated.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
Lifting Points - Drive On Hoist
The vehicle is supported by tires and suspension components.
After the vehicle has been lowered, enable the air suspension system. Refer to Electronic Level
Control.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7858
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7861
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7862
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7863
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7864
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in the following sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 in) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7865
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear. ^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Sensors and Switches - Wheels and Tires > Tire
Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor >
Page 7866
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure
Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPMS Indicator and Message Center Messages
The TPMS indicator and vehicle message center (if equipped) sometimes displays faults that
cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these messages as TPMS faults that must be serviced.
TPMS Indicator Illuminates Continuously
NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPMS functionality before carrying out any diagnosis.
1. The TPMS indicator remains on continuously for the following condition:
^ Low Tire Pressure - The TPMS indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low.
When this condition exists, the tire pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold pressure
as indicated on the vehicle certification label.
2. NOTE: The TPMS sensors do not transmit when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle has been
stationary for more than 30 minutes, it will be
necessary to wake up the sensors so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information to the
SJB.
If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, carry out the following procedure to
wake up the TPMS sensors. 1
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2 Adjust the air pressure in the LF tire (as necessary).
3 Activate the LF TPMS sensor, at least 2 times, using the tire pressure monitor activation tool.
4 Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5 If the TPMS indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and activating each sensor, GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
TPMS Indicator Flashes
The TPMS indicator flashes for 70 seconds, then remains ON solid when the ignition switch is
turned to the ON position, for the following conditions: 1. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped,
the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
2. No communication with the SJB (TPMS is integral to the SJB) - The TPMS indicator is
illuminated when the instrument cluster has received no
signals from the SJB for more than 5 seconds. If equipped, the message center displays TIRE
PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
3. Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT when the tire pressure
monitoring system is malfunctioning or communication with the instrument cluster has been lost.
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 7874
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7877
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7878
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7879
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7880
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in the following sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 in) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7881
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear. ^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure Sensor
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 7882
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns
Tires: Customer Interest 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns
TSB 08-21-11
10/27/08
4 WHEEL DRIVE/ALL WHEEL DRIVE - WITH CONTROL TRAC - SHUDDER ON
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION OR BINDING ON SLOW TURNS
FORD: 1997-2008 Expedition, Explorer 2006-2008 F-150 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac 2008
F-150
LINCOLN: 1998-2008 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2005 Mountaineer 2006-2008 Mountaineer
ISSUE Various 1997-2008 vehicles equipped with either 4 wheel drive or all wheel drive and
equipped with control trac may exhibit a shudder on acceleration/deceleration, binding in slow
speed turns or noise from the front driveline and/or transfer case. The shudder/binding will occur
with the vehicle being operated in the awd/auto 4x4 mode. The shudder/binding may be due to
incorrect tire circumference or improper tire inflation pressures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS DOES NOT APPLY TO 2006-2008 MOUNTAINEER WITH A 4.0L ENGINE OR 2007-2008
EXPLORER AND SPORT TRAC WITH 20 INCH WHEELS.
NOTE
VEHICLES ON THE LIST MAY REQUIRE REPLACEMENT OF TIRE/S IF THE TIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AVERAGE BETWEEN THE FRONT AND REAR AXLES ARE OUTSIDE OF
THE 1/2 INCH SPECIFICATION OR IF THE TIRE CIRCUMFERENCE FROM SIDE TO SIDE ON
EITHER AXLE EXCEEDS 1/2 INCH DIFFERENCE, THE SMALLER TIRE(S) MUST BE
REPLACED.
NOTE
REVIEW THE WARRANTY AND POLICY MANUAL FOR FORD MOTOR COMPANY TIRE
REPLACEMENT WARRANTY BEFORE PERFORMING THE SERVICE PROCEDURE.
NOTE
ONLY USE REPLACEMENT TIRE AND WHEEL THAT ARE THE SAME SIZE, LOAD INDEX,
SPEED RATING AND TYPE (SUCH AS P-METRIC VERSUS LT-METRIC OR ALL-SEASON
VERSUS ALL-TERRAIN) AS THOSE ORIGINALLY PROVIDED BY FORD. THE
RECOMMENDED TIRE AND WHEEL SIZE MAY BE FOUND ON EITHER THE SAFETY
COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION LABEL OR THE TIRE LABEL WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE
B-PILLAR OR EDGE OF THE DRIVER'S DOOR.
NOTE
ON SOME 4WD MODELS, THE INITIAL SHIFT FROM 2WD TO 4WD WHILE THE VEHICLE IS
MOVING CAN CAUSE A MOMENTARY CLUNK AND/OR BRIEF RATCHETING SOUND. THESE
SOUNDS ARE NORMAL AS THE FRONT DRIVETRAIN COMES UP TO SPEED AND IS NOT
CAUSE FOR CONCERN.
1. Review the tire label for correct tire size and tire inflation pressures located at the B-Pillar of the
driver's door.
2. If the tire size does not match the label, this procedure does not apply, follow normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
3. If the tire size is correct, ensure tire pressures are within specifications.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 7891
4. Raise the vehicle on the hoist, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 100-02.
5. Disconnect all wiring going to the transfer case and road test.
6. Is the shudder/binding present?
a. If the shudder/binding is still present, do not continue with this procedure, continue with WSM
normal diagnostic for 4X4.
b. If the shudder/binding is gone, proceed to Step 7.
7. Raise the vehicle on the hoist and reconnect all the wiring previously disconnected.
8. Using a tailor's tape or flexible measuring tape and measure the circumference of all four (4)
tires and record the measurements. (Figure 1)
9. Calculate the average of the circumference of the two (2) front tires and calculate the average of
the circumference of the two (2) rear tires. (Figure 2)
10. If the difference between these two averages is greater than 1/2" (12.7 mm), front to back or
side to side, replace the smallest circumference tire(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 7892
and remeasure the tire averages. Refer to WSM, Section 204-04 for tire replacement.
NOTE
WARRANTY COVERAGE ELIGIBILITY STARTS WITH 2007 NEW VEHICLE LIMITED
WARRANTY COVERAGE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082111A 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111A 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace TWO Tires. (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace Two (2) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 7893
Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150
Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do
Not Use With 1007A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A195 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns
Tires: All Technical Service Bulletins 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On Accel/Decel/Binding On
Turns
TSB 08-21-11
10/27/08
4 WHEEL DRIVE/ALL WHEEL DRIVE - WITH CONTROL TRAC - SHUDDER ON
ACCELERATION/DECELERATION OR BINDING ON SLOW TURNS
FORD: 1997-2008 Expedition, Explorer 2006-2008 F-150 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac 2008
F-150
LINCOLN: 1998-2008 Navigator 2003-2005 Aviator
MERCURY: 2005 Mountaineer 2006-2008 Mountaineer
ISSUE Various 1997-2008 vehicles equipped with either 4 wheel drive or all wheel drive and
equipped with control trac may exhibit a shudder on acceleration/deceleration, binding in slow
speed turns or noise from the front driveline and/or transfer case. The shudder/binding will occur
with the vehicle being operated in the awd/auto 4x4 mode. The shudder/binding may be due to
incorrect tire circumference or improper tire inflation pressures.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS DOES NOT APPLY TO 2006-2008 MOUNTAINEER WITH A 4.0L ENGINE OR 2007-2008
EXPLORER AND SPORT TRAC WITH 20 INCH WHEELS.
NOTE
VEHICLES ON THE LIST MAY REQUIRE REPLACEMENT OF TIRE/S IF THE TIRE
CIRCUMFERENCE AVERAGE BETWEEN THE FRONT AND REAR AXLES ARE OUTSIDE OF
THE 1/2 INCH SPECIFICATION OR IF THE TIRE CIRCUMFERENCE FROM SIDE TO SIDE ON
EITHER AXLE EXCEEDS 1/2 INCH DIFFERENCE, THE SMALLER TIRE(S) MUST BE
REPLACED.
NOTE
REVIEW THE WARRANTY AND POLICY MANUAL FOR FORD MOTOR COMPANY TIRE
REPLACEMENT WARRANTY BEFORE PERFORMING THE SERVICE PROCEDURE.
NOTE
ONLY USE REPLACEMENT TIRE AND WHEEL THAT ARE THE SAME SIZE, LOAD INDEX,
SPEED RATING AND TYPE (SUCH AS P-METRIC VERSUS LT-METRIC OR ALL-SEASON
VERSUS ALL-TERRAIN) AS THOSE ORIGINALLY PROVIDED BY FORD. THE
RECOMMENDED TIRE AND WHEEL SIZE MAY BE FOUND ON EITHER THE SAFETY
COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATION LABEL OR THE TIRE LABEL WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE
B-PILLAR OR EDGE OF THE DRIVER'S DOOR.
NOTE
ON SOME 4WD MODELS, THE INITIAL SHIFT FROM 2WD TO 4WD WHILE THE VEHICLE IS
MOVING CAN CAUSE A MOMENTARY CLUNK AND/OR BRIEF RATCHETING SOUND. THESE
SOUNDS ARE NORMAL AS THE FRONT DRIVETRAIN COMES UP TO SPEED AND IS NOT
CAUSE FOR CONCERN.
1. Review the tire label for correct tire size and tire inflation pressures located at the B-Pillar of the
driver's door.
2. If the tire size does not match the label, this procedure does not apply, follow normal Workshop
Manual (WSM) diagnostics.
3. If the tire size is correct, ensure tire pressures are within specifications.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 7899
4. Raise the vehicle on the hoist, refer to Workshop Manual, Section 100-02.
5. Disconnect all wiring going to the transfer case and road test.
6. Is the shudder/binding present?
a. If the shudder/binding is still present, do not continue with this procedure, continue with WSM
normal diagnostic for 4X4.
b. If the shudder/binding is gone, proceed to Step 7.
7. Raise the vehicle on the hoist and reconnect all the wiring previously disconnected.
8. Using a tailor's tape or flexible measuring tape and measure the circumference of all four (4)
tires and record the measurements. (Figure 1)
9. Calculate the average of the circumference of the two (2) front tires and calculate the average of
the circumference of the two (2) rear tires. (Figure 2)
10. If the difference between these two averages is greater than 1/2" (12.7 mm), front to back or
side to side, replace the smallest circumference tire(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 7900
and remeasure the tire averages. Refer to WSM, Section 204-04 for tire replacement.
NOTE
WARRANTY COVERAGE ELIGIBILITY STARTS WITH 2007 NEW VEHICLE LIMITED
WARRANTY COVERAGE.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082111A 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111A 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.0 Hr.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace One (1) Tire (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace TWO Tires. (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111B 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer,
2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150 Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In
Service Procedure And Replace Two (2) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 2003-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator, 2003-2005 Aviator, Explorer, Mountaineer 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service
Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do Not Use With 1007A)
082111C 1997-2002 Expedition, 1.4 Hrs.
1998-2002 Navigator, 2006-2008 F-150 Harley
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Tires: > 08-21-11 > Oct > 08 > 4X4/AWD System - Shudder On
Accel/Decel/Binding On Turns > Page 7901
Davidson, Mountaineer, 1997-2008 Explorer, 2007-2008 Explorer Sport Trac, And 2008 F-150
Limited 4X4: Perform Diagnosis Outlined In Service Procedure And Replace Three (3) Tires (Do
Not Use With 1007A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7A195 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front
Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 7906
major service expense. A new part with the same part number must be installed if installation
becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of lesser quality or substitute design. Torque
values must be used as specified during reassembly to make sure of correct retention of these
parts.
1. Disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector.
2. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 3. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness
bolt and detach the harness from the retainers.
^ To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper to hang from the brake hose or damage to the hose can
result.
Remove the bolts and position the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the brake caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 200 Nm (148 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Remove the halfshaft nut dust cap. 7. Remove and discard the
halfshaft nut.
^ To install, tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
8. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and wheel hub bolts and the wheel hub.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 lb-ft).
9. If installing a new wheel bearing and wheel hub, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the
wheel speed sensor.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
10. CAUTION: If the original wheel bearing and wheel hub is being installed, install a new wheel
hub O-ring seal.
CAUTION: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the halfshaft
nut.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 7907
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
Wheel Bearing and Wheel Hub
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. NOTE: Have an assistant press the brake pedal to keep the axle from rotating.
Remove and discard the halfshaft nut. ^
To install, tighten to 300 Nm (221 lb-ft).
3. Using a suitable hub puller, separate the outboard CV joint from the wheel hub.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front > Page 7908
4. CAUTION: Do not allow the caliper and anchor plate assembly to hang from the brake hose or
damage to the hose can result.
Remove the bolts and position the caliper and anchor plate assembly aside. ^
Support the caliper and anchor plate assembly using mechanic's wire.
^ To install, tighten to 190 Nm (140 lb-ft).
5. Remove the brake disc. 6. Detach the wheel speed sensor harness from the retainers and
disconnect the wheel speed sensor electrical connector. Push the wheel speed sensor
harness grommet through the brake disc shield.
7. Remove the 4 wheel bearing and wheel hub bolts, the wheel bearing assembly and the wheel
speed sensor as an assembly.
^ Route the sensor wiring through the access hole in the brake disc shield.
^ Discard the bolts.
^ To install, tighten to 185 Nm (136 lb-ft).
8. If necessary, remove the wheel speed sensor bolt and the wheel speed sensor from the wheel
bearing and wheel hub.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information
> Specifications > Front
Axle Nut: Specifications Front
Front Axle nut.......................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 27 Nm (20 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information
> Specifications > Front > Page 7914
Axle Nut: Specifications Rear
Rear axle Nut .......................................................................................................................................
.................................................... 300 Nm (221 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Wheel Hub Lock Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7918
C1157
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Wheel Hub (Locking): Service and Repair
Integrated Wheel End (IWE)
Removal
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
2. Remove the front wheel and tire.
3. Remove the dust cap.
4. Remove and discard the axle nut.
5. Disconnect the vacuum tubes from the Integrated Wheel End (IWE).
6. Remove the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
7. Remove the tie-rod nut and separate the tie rod from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the tie-rod nut.
8. Remove the wheel speed sensor harness bracket bolt and position the harness aside.
9. Remove the front brake flexible hose bracket bolt and position the brake hose aside.
10. Remove the upper ball joint nut and separate the upper ball joint from the wheel knuckle.
- Discard the upper ball joint nut.
11. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, remove the halfshaft outboard end from the wheel knuckle hub
bearing.
12. Remove the IWE from the halfshaft outboard end.
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub (Locking) > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Page 7922
1. Compress the IWE and install a vacuum cap on the vacuum port.
2. NOTICE: Do not dislodge the Integrated Wheel End (IWE) seal spring when installing the IWE
on halfshaft outboard end or component
damage may occur.
Install the IWE onto the halfshaft outboard end.
3. NOTE: Allow the wheel knuckle to swing outward while keeping the halfshaft pushed inward.
Once clearance is available, install the halfshaft outboard end into the wheel knuckle hub bearing.
4. Connect the upper ball joint and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
5. Connect the tie rod and install a new nut.
- Tighten to 115 Nm (85 lb-ft).
6. Position the front brake flexible hose bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
7. Position the wheel speed sensor harness bracket and install the bolt.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
8. Install the 3 IWE-to-wheel knuckle retaining bolts.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (106 lb-in).
9. Remove the IWE vacuum cap and connect the vacuum tubes.
10. NOTICE: Verify the spline engagement by checking for spline lash before installing the axle nut
or component damage may occur.
Install the new axle nut.
- Tighten to 27 Nm (20 lb-ft).
11. Install the dust cap.
12. Install the front wheel and tire.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Fastener: Specifications
Wheel nuts............................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 204 Nm (150 lb-ft)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7926
Wheel Fastener: Service and Repair
Wheel Studs
Special Tool(s)
Removal
WARNING: The electrical power to the air suspension system must be shut off prior to hoisting,
jacking or towing an air suspension vehicle. This can be accomplished by turning off the air
suspension switch located in the LH rear quarter trim panel. Failure to do so can result in
unexpected inflation or deflation of the air springs, which can result in shifting of the vehicle during
these operations. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Suspension fasteners are critical parts because they affect performance of vital parts
and systems and their failure can result in major service expense. A new part with the same part
number must be installed if installation becomes necessary. Do not use a replacement part of
lesser quality or substitute design. Torque values must be used as specified during reassembly to
make sure of correct retention of these parts.
1. Remove the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
2. CAUTION: Never use a hammer to remove a wheel stud. Damage to the wheel hub can result.
Place the wheel hub in a soft-jawed vice and, using the special tool, remove the wheel stud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 7927
Installation
1. Position the new wheel stud in the wheel bearing and hub assembly, aligning the serrations in
the wheel hub flange made by the original wheel
stud.
2. CAUTION: Do not use power tools to install the wheel stud. The serrations on the flange can be
stripped.
NOTE: Do not use the wheel nut that came with the vehicle.
Install 4 washers and a wheel nut on the wheel stud and tighten the wheel nut until the stud seats
against the flange.
3. Remove the wheel nut and washers.
^ Discard the wheel nut.
4. Install the wheel bearing and wheel hub.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations Mode Door Actuator, Rear
View 151-48 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7934
View 151-49 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7935
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations Blend Door Actuator, Rear
View 151-48 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7936
View 151-49 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7937
View 151-46 (Climate Control System - Manual A/C)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7938
View 151-47 (Climate Control System - EATC)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7939
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Locations
View 151-48 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7940
View 151-49 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7941
View 151-48 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7942
View 151-49 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7943
View 151-46 (Climate Control System - Manual A/C)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7944
View 151-47 (Climate Control System - EATC)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7945
View 151-46 (Climate Control System - Manual A/C)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7946
View 151-47 (Climate Control System - EATC)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7947
View 151-46 (Climate Control System - Manual A/C)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Mode Door Actuator, Rear > Page 7948
View 151-47 (Climate Control System - EATC)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator
C2278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator > Page 7951
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Diagrams Blend Door Actuator, Rear
C3004
C4342
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator > Page 7952
C2091
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator > Page 7953
C2092
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator > Page 7954
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Diagrams
C2278
C3004
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator > Page 7955
C4342
C2091
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator > Page 7956
C2092
C3044
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator > Page 7957
C4341
C289
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Diagrams > Mode Door Actuator > Page 7958
C2363
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door
MODE DOOR ACTUATOR - DEFROST/PANEL/FLOOR DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator can be accessed from underneath the LH side
of the instrument panel.
1. Disconnect the defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2
defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator screws. 3. Remove the defrost/panel/floor mode door 4. To
install, reverse the removal procedure. actuator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7961
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Mode Door Actuator - Air Inlet Door
MODE DOOR ACTUATOR - AIR INLET DOOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped). 2. Remove the junction box cover
at the RH lower A-pillar. 3. Remove the 3 air inlet mode door actuator screws. 4. Disconnect the air
inlet mode door actuator electrical connector. 5. Remove the air inlet mode door actuator. 6. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7962
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Temperature Blend Door Actuator - RH
TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - RH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the audio unit. 2. Disconnect the RH temperature blend door actuator electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 RH temperature blend door actuator screws. 4. Remove the RH
temperature blend door actuator. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7963
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair Temperature Blend Door Actuator - LH
TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - LH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the 4 floor duct screws. 3.
Remove the floor duct. 4. Disconnect the LH temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
5. Remove the 2 LH temperature blend door actuator screws. 6. Remove the LH temperature blend
door actuator. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7964
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Service and Repair
Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door
MODE DOOR ACTUATOR - DEFROST/PANEL/FLOOR DOOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator can be accessed from underneath the LH side
of the instrument panel.
1. Disconnect the defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2
defrost/panel/floor mode door actuator screws. 3. Remove the defrost/panel/floor mode door 4. To
install, reverse the removal procedure. actuator.
Mode Door Actuator - Air Inlet Door
MODE DOOR ACTUATOR - AIR INLET DOOR
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7965
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped). 2. Remove the junction box cover
at the RH lower A-pillar. 3. Remove the 3 air inlet mode door actuator screws. 4. Disconnect the air
inlet mode door actuator electrical connector. 5. Remove the air inlet mode door actuator. 6. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Temperature Blend Door Actuator - RH
TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - RH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7966
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the audio unit. 2. Disconnect the RH temperature blend door actuator electrical
connector. 3. Remove the 2 RH temperature blend door actuator screws. 4. Remove the RH
temperature blend door actuator. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Temperature Blend Door Actuator - LH
TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - LH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7967
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the 4 floor duct screws. 3.
Remove the floor duct. 4. Disconnect the LH temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
5. Remove the 2 LH temperature blend door actuator screws. 6. Remove the LH temperature blend
door actuator. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Auxiliary Mode Door Actuator
AUXILIARY MODE DOOR ACTUATOR
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7968
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel cup holder. 2. Remove the RH quarter trim panel utility tray.
3. Remove the 3 auxiliary mode door actuator screws. 4. Disconnect the auxiliary mode door
actuator electrical connector. 5. Remove the auxiliary mode door actuator. 6. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Auxiliary Mode Door Actuator - Expedition EL, Navigator L
AUXILIARY MODE DOOR ACTUATOR - EXPEDITION EL, NAVIGATOR L
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7969
Removal and Installation
1. Fold the third row seats fully forward. 2. Remove the RH D-pillar trim panel.
3. Remove the liftgate sill plate.
4. Remove the rear floor cargo space trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7970
5. Position the rear floor cargo space floor trim aside and remove the RH rear quarter trim panel
bolt.
6. Remove the RH quarter trim panel utility tray.
7. Detach the 3 rear and 5 upper RH quarter trim panel clips and position the quarter trim panel
aside. 8. Disconnect the auxiliary mode door actuator electrical connector. 9. Remove the 2
auxiliary mode door actuator screws.
10. Remove the auxiliary mode door actuator. 11. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator
AUXILIARY TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7971
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel. 2. Disconnect the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator
electrical connector. 3. Remove the 4 auxiliary temperature blend door actuator screws. 4. Remove
the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Auxiliary Temperature Blend Door Actuator - Expedition EL, Navigator L
AUXILIARY TEMPERATURE BLEND DOOR ACTUATOR - EXPEDITION EL, NAVIGATOR L
Removal and Installation
1. Fold the third row seats fully forward. 2. Remove the RH D-pillar trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7972
3. Remove the liftgate sill plate.
4. Remove the rear floor cargo space trim panel.
5. Position the rear floor cargo space floor trim aside and remove the RH rear quarter trim panel
bolt.
6. Remove the RH quarter trim panel utility tray.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Mode Door Actuator - Defrost/Panel/Floor Door > Page 7973
7. Detach the 3 rear and 5 upper RH quarter trim panel clips and position the quarter trim panel
aside. 8. Disconnect the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator electrical connector. 9. Remove
the 2 auxiliary temperature blend door actuator screws.
10. Remove the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator. 11. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair > Floor
Duct
Air Duct: Service and Repair Floor Duct
FLOOR DUCT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the 4 floor duct screws. 3.
Remove the floor duct. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Service and Repair > Floor
Duct > Page 7978
Air Duct: Service and Repair Footwell Duct - Rear
FOOTWELL DUCT - REAR
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the front seats. 2. Remove the front floor console. 3. Remove the RH and LH lower
cowl trim panels and front door sill plates.
Navigator only
4. Remove the upper and lower instrument panel bracket bolts and position the instrument panel
bracket aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
All vehicles
5. Fold back the carpet to completely uncover the rear footwell duct. 6. Remove the 2 rear footwell
duct pin-type retainers. 7. Remove the rear footwell duct. 8. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Climate Control
Air Register: Service and Repair Climate Control
REGISTER
Removal and Installation
LH register
1. Remove the steering column opening cover. 2. Remove the 4 steering column opening
reinforcement bolts and the steering column reinforcement. 3. Remove the LH outer instrument
panel trim panel.
RH register
4. Lower the glove compartment
LH or RH register
5. Working through the instrument panel opening, depress the 2 clips on the sides of the register
barrel and tilt the bottom of the register outward to
keep the clips from re-engaging.
6. NOTE: RH register shown, LH similar.
Using 2 suitable tools, release the clips through the demister nozzle opening and remove the
register.
Center registers
7. Remove the center instrument panel finish panel. 8. Working through the opening below the
audio unit, release the 3 register retaining clips and remove the register.
All registers
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Register > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Climate Control > Page 7983
Air Register: Service and Repair Auxiliary Climate Control
REGISTER
Removal and Installation
1. Fabricate a removal tool from a 3.175 mm (0.12 in) diameter rod.
2. Rotate the register with the removal tool to align the retaining ears with the clearance openings
and remove the register. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7987
C132
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7988
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the upper radiator sight shield. 2. Detach and disconnect the ambient temperature
sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the ambient air temperature sensor. 4. To install, reverse
the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-9-1 > May > 08 > A/C - Blower Intermittently Inop/Stuck On High
Blower Motor: Customer Interest A/C - Blower Intermittently Inop/Stuck On High
TSB 08-9-1
05/12/08
EATC BLOWER INTERMITTENTLY INOPERATIVE - STUCK ON HIGH/OFF
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with Electronic Automatic
Temperature Control (EATC) may exhibit a condition where the blower motor is inoperative no
matter what speed or temp setting or the blower motor is stuck on high speed or off. Cycling the
ignition may resume operation. The concern may also occur when using the electrical power point.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Open the glove box and remove Connector C297 from the Heater Blower Controller Module
(HBCM).
2. Remove the right front door scuff plate.
3. Remove the right side kick panel to gain access to Ground G200.
4. Cut black/white wire about 8" (20.3 cm) from C297. Strip the end 1/4" (6.3 mm).
5. Obtain pigtail kit and using the approved splicing methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD),
Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing) the splice between the 13" (33 cm)
pigtail and the black/white wire from C297.
6. Disconnect the existing 14401 single ground eyelet from G200 and cut existing eyelet from the
ground wire.
7. Strip 1/4" (6.3 mm) insulation from the 14401 ground wire.
8. Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal
(with shrink tubing) the splice between the 3" (7.6 cm) pigtail and the 14401 wire.
9. Attach the new interlocked ground eyelet to G200. Torque to 11 +/- 1.6 lb-ft (15 +/- 2.3 N.m )
10. Install the right side kick panel and scuff plate.
11. Replace the HBCM.
12. Attach C297 to the HBCM.
13. Close the glove box door.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-9-1 > May > 08 > A/C - Blower Intermittently Inop/Stuck On High > Page 7997
080901A 2007-2008 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The HBCM, Includes Time To Isolate Ground (Do Not Use With
19700D8, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19E624 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-9-1 > May > 08 > A/C - Blower Intermittently Inop/Stuck On High
Blower Motor: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Blower Intermittently Inop/Stuck On High
TSB 08-9-1
05/12/08
EATC BLOWER INTERMITTENTLY INOPERATIVE - STUCK ON HIGH/OFF
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with Electronic Automatic
Temperature Control (EATC) may exhibit a condition where the blower motor is inoperative no
matter what speed or temp setting or the blower motor is stuck on high speed or off. Cycling the
ignition may resume operation. The concern may also occur when using the electrical power point.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Open the glove box and remove Connector C297 from the Heater Blower Controller Module
(HBCM).
2. Remove the right front door scuff plate.
3. Remove the right side kick panel to gain access to Ground G200.
4. Cut black/white wire about 8" (20.3 cm) from C297. Strip the end 1/4" (6.3 mm).
5. Obtain pigtail kit and using the approved splicing methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD),
Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing) the splice between the 13" (33 cm)
pigtail and the black/white wire from C297.
6. Disconnect the existing 14401 single ground eyelet from G200 and cut existing eyelet from the
ground wire.
7. Strip 1/4" (6.3 mm) insulation from the 14401 ground wire.
8. Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal
(with shrink tubing) the splice between the 3" (7.6 cm) pigtail and the 14401 wire.
9. Attach the new interlocked ground eyelet to G200. Torque to 11 +/- 1.6 lb-ft (15 +/- 2.3 N.m )
10. Install the right side kick panel and scuff plate.
11. Replace the HBCM.
12. Attach C297 to the HBCM.
13. Close the glove box door.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-9-1 > May > 08 > A/C - Blower Intermittently Inop/Stuck On High > Page
8003
080901A 2007-2008 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The HBCM, Includes Time To Isolate Ground (Do Not Use With
19700D8, 14200A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19E624 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage >
Page 8009
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage >
Page 8010
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage >
Page 8016
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage >
Page 8017
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Blower Motor
Blower Motor: Locations Auxiliary Blower Motor
View 151-48 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Blower Motor > Page 8020
View 151-49 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Blower Motor > Page 8021
Blower Motor: Locations Blower Motor
View 151-46 (Climate Control System - Manual A/C)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Locations > Auxiliary
Blower Motor > Page 8022
View 151-47 (Climate Control System - EATC)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Blower Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8025
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8026
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8027
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8028
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8029
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8030
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8031
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8032
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8033
Blower Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8034
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8035
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8036
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8037
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8038
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8039
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8041
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8042
Blower Motor: Connector Views
C288
C4106
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 8043
C4334
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8044
Blower Motor: Description and Operation
BLOWER MOTOR
The auxiliary climate control system is equipped with a blower motor controlled by the blower motor
switch on the front or rear auxiliary control assembly. The auxiliary blower motor is mounted to the
auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing behind the RH quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Blower Motor
Blower Motor: Service and Repair Blower Motor
BLOWER MOTOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The blower motor vent tube must be completely removed from the blower motor before it
can be rotated and disengaged from the heater core and evaporator core housing.
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped). 2. Remove the RH lower A-pillar
junction box cover. 3. Position the carpet below the blower motor aside. 4. Release the 2 blower
motor vent tube clips and remove the blower motor vent tube. 5. Disconnect the blower motor
electrical connector.
6. NOTE: The blower motor will have to be carefully manipulated along the dash panel insulator,
and the dash panel insulator will have to be
slightly deflected to allow the blower motor to clear the heater core and evaporator core housing.
Rotate the blower motor counterclockwise to disengage it from the housing and remove the blower
motor.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Blower Motor > Page 8047
Blower Motor: Service and Repair Auxiliary Blower Motor
AUXILIARY BLOWER MOTOR
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the blower motor.
- Disconnect the blower motor electrical connector.
- Remove the blower motor screws.
- Remove the blower motor.
Expedition or Navigator only
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Blower Motor > Page 8048
3. Remove the blower motor wheel.
1 Remove the blower motor wheel clip.
2 Remove the blower motor wheel.
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8053
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8054
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8055
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8058
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8059
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8060
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8061
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8062
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8063
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8064
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8066
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8067
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8068
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor Assembly
Blower Motor Resistor: Locations Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor Assembly
View 151-48 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor Assembly > Page 8073
View 151-49 (Auxiliary HVAC - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Locations >
Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor Assembly > Page 8074
View 151-46 (Climate Control System - Manual A/C)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Blower Motor Resistor
C2185
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Blower Motor Resistor > Page 8077
Blower Motor Resistor: Diagrams Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor Assembly
C4107
C4343
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 8078
Blower Motor Resistor: Description and Operation
BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
The blower motor switch varies the blower motor ground circuit resistance by adding or bypassing
series resistance in the blower motor resistor. Increased resistance will lower the blower motor
speed, and lowered resistance will increase blower motor speed. When the blower motor is in the
HIGH position, the blower motor resistor is bypassed.
The blower motor resistor is located on the heater core and evaporator core housing near the
blower motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Blower Motor Resistor
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Blower Motor Resistor
BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the blower motor resistor electrical connector. 2. Remove the 2 blower motor resistor
screws. 3. Remove the blower motor resistor. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Blower Motor Resistor > Page 8081
Blower Motor Resistor: Service and Repair Auxiliary Blower Motor Resistor
AUXILIARY BLOWER MOTOR RESISTOR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Expedition or Navigator shown, Expedition EL or Navigator L similar.
All vehicles
1. Remove the RH quarter trim panel access panel.
Expedition or Navigator only
2. Remove the blower motor resistor.
- Disconnect the blower motor resistor electrical connector.
- Remove the 2 blower motor resistor screws and the blower motor resistor.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
3. Remove the blower motor resistor.
- Disconnect the blower motor resistor electrical connector.
- Remove the blower motor resistor screw.
- Detach the 2 blower motor resistor clips and remove the blower motor resistor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Blower Motor Resistor > Page 8082
All vehicles
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Blower Motor Switch: Description and Operation
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
The blower motor switch controls blower motor speed by adding or bypassing resistors in the
blower motor resistor in all function selector positions except OFF. The blower motor switch is
mounted to the climate control assembly and can be separately installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8086
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair
BLOWER MOTOR SPEED CONTROL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped). 2. Disconnect the blower motor
speed control electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 blower motor speed control screws. 4. Remove
the blower motor speed control. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Air Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cabin Air Filter: Service and Repair
NOTE: The air distribution system of this vehicle cannot be equipped with a cabin air filter.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
C233
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor > Page 8095
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity Sensor
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity
Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 3 lower steering column cover screws and the lower steering column cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the 4 steering column reinforcement bolts and position the steering column
reinforcement aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Remove the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor.
1 Detach the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor from the instrument panel finish panel.
2 Disconnect the aspirator hose.
3 Disconnect the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity Sensor > Page 8098
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor. 3. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications
Compressor Clutch: Specifications
Item.......................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................Specification
Magnetic Clutch
Air gap clearance..................................................................................................................................
...................................0.35-0.65 mm (0.014-0.026 in)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 8103
Compressor Clutch: Adjustments
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH AIR GAP ADJUSTMENT
1. Check the A/C clutch air gap at 3 equally spaced places between the clutch plate and the A/C
clutch pulley. 2. Remove the clutch plate. Add or remove spacers between the clutch plate hub and
the compressor shaft until the clearance is within specification.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 8104
Compressor Clutch: Service and Repair
CLUTCH AND CLUTCH FIELD COIL
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal
1. Remove the A/C compressor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 8105
2. Remove the A/C clutch disc and hub nut.
1 Using the special tool, hold the A/C clutch disc and hub.
2 Remove the A/C clutch disc and hub nut.
3. Remove the A/C clutch disc and hub. 4. Remove the A/C compressor pulley snap ring.
5. CAUTION: Do not use air tools. Damage to the A/C clutch pulley or A/C compressor may result.
Using the special tool, remove the A/C compressor pulley. 1
Install the special tool.
2 Remove the A/C compressor pulley.
6. Remove the A/C clutch field coil snap ring. 7. Remove the A/C clutch field coil connector screw.
8. Remove the A/C clutch field coil.
Installation
NOTE: The A/C clutch components should be reused unless obvious signs of damage are found. If
excessive grooving is found, a new A/C clutch disc and hub and a new A/C compressor pulley
must be installed together. Otherwise, each component can be installed individually where needed.
1. Visually inspect the A/C clutch disc and hub, A/C compressor pulley and A/C clutch field coil for
damage.
- Inspect for physical damage, including cracked or melted components or discoloration due to
excessive heat.
- Inspect for excessive wear, including grooving in the A/C clutch disc and hub or A/C compressor
pulley that is more than fingernail depth.
- Inspect for roughness in the A/C compressor pulley bearing.
2. Clean the A/C clutch field coil and pulley mounting surfaces. 3. Install the A/C clutch field coil. 4.
Install the A/C clutch field coil snap ring.
5. NOTE: The A/C compressor pulley is a tight fit on the A/C compressor. It must be correctly
aligned during installation.
Install the A/C compressor pulley.
6. Install the A/C compressor pulley snap ring with the bevel side out. 7. Place one nominal
thickness A/C clutch disc and hub spacer inside the clutch hub spline opening. 8. Install the A/C
clutch disc and hub.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 8106
9. Using the special tool, install the A/C compressor clutch disc and hub nut.
1 Hold the A/C clutch disc and hub with the special tool.
2 Tighten the nut to 13 Nm (10 lb-ft).
10. Measure and adjust the clutch air gap by removing or adding A/C clutch disc and hub spacers.
11. Install the A/C compressor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Diagrams
C100
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 8113
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH RELAY (A/CCR)
NOTE: The PCM PIDs WAC and wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WACF) are used to
monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR is wired normally open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch
or electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module and the A/C clutch. The PCM receives
a signal indicating that A/C is requested. For some applications, this message is sent through the
communications network. When A/C is requested, the PCM checks other A/C related inputs that
are available, such as A/C pressure switch and A/C cycling switch. If these inputs indicate A/C
operation is OK, and the engine conditions are OK (coolant temperature, engine RPM, throttle
position), the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending voltage to
the A/CCR.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 8114
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 8115
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 8116
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
Condenser HVAC: Customer Interest A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
TSB 07-26-3
12/24/07
A/C COMPRESSOR - CUTS OUT HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES/SEIZED - POOR A/C
PERFORMANCE - BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-25-1 to update the symptoms, Service Procedure and vehicle built
date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 11/1/2007 may exhibit
symptoms of slow to cool, not cool enough or variations in cooling performance. This may be due
to lack of desiccant cartridge filtering causing system contamination and/or shifting of the desiccant
cartridge in the integrated receiver/drier causing erratic condenser performance.
Additionally, some vehicles may exhibit a loss of A/C compressor operation in ambient
temperatures greater than 110 °F (43 °C) when the vehicle is stationary for longer than 15 minutes,
with the transmission in gear. Placing the vehicle in Park does not resume A/C operation. This may
be due to high A/C head pressures caused by contamination in the system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow standard workshop manual diagnostic procedures for customer complaints of A/C slow to
cool, not cool enough. If no issues are identified and on-road evaluations indicate a lack of cooling
performance relative to similar vehicles, use the following.
Proceed directly to the Flushing Service Procedure steps, to correct the condition of A/C
compressor seized or high A/C head pressures.
NOTE
AFTER PERFORMING THE TSB FOR THE A/C SHUT DOWN, DURING HIGH AMBIENT TEMPS
AND EXTENDED IDLE, ADVISE CUSTOMER TO RUN THE A/C IN THE MAX A/C POSITION,
REDUCE BLOWER FAN SPEED FROM THE HIGHEST SETTING, TURN OFF THE AUXILIARY
A/C AND PUT THE VEHICLE'S TRANSMISSION INTO THE PARK GEAR POSITION TO
CONTINUE TO RECEIVE COOL AIR FROM YOUR A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
CHECK THE AIR DEFLECTORS THAT SURROUND THE CONDENSER FOR BEING OUT OF
POSITION OR BEING UNSECURED. THIS MAY ALLOW THE HOT ENGINE COMPARTMENT
AIR TO RECIRCULATE AND CAUSE ADDITIONAL LOAD ON THE A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
WHEN DEBRIS IS PRESENT THROUGHOUT THE ENTIRE SYSTEM, IT IS IMPERATIVE TO
COMPLETELY CLEAN THE A/C SYSTEM TO PREVENT REPEAT FAILURES FROM RESIDUAL
DEBRIS THAT CONTAMINATES THE SYSTEM AFTER THE INITIAL FAILURE. TO PREVENT
REPEAT FAILURES, THE FOLLOWING SERVICE PROCEDURE MUST BE PERFORMED, FOR
ALL SYMPTOMS LISTED IN THIS TSB.
A/C SLOW TO COOL/NOT COOL ENOUGH
1. Measure compressor suction and discharge pressures and compare them with the ranges
shown in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
3. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and inspect
for debris at the bottom of the cartridge below the lip seal before discarding.
4. If there is no debris below the cartridge lip seal and the compressor suction and discharge
pressures are within the shop manual ranges, only replace the desiccant cartridge. Install a new
Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in the kit, and install
condenser into the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures > Page 8125
5. If debris is found below the cartridge lip seal or the compressor suction/discharge pressure are
not within shop manual ranges, proceed to the Flushing procedure below.
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
FLUSHING SERVICE PROCEDURE With Rotunda A/C Flush And Purge Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass-through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures > Page 8126
.33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C Flush And Purge - Without Rotunda
Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear lxv if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/O-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
22 oz. - Front A/C
33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures > Page 8127
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL A/C FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL
SUBSET OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF
THE TWO LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072603 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Condenser HVAC: Customer Interest A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8132
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8133
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8134
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
Condenser HVAC: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures
TSB 07-26-3
12/24/07
A/C COMPRESSOR - CUTS OUT HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES/SEIZED - POOR A/C
PERFORMANCE - BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-25-1 to update the symptoms, Service Procedure and vehicle built
date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 11/1/2007 may exhibit
symptoms of slow to cool, not cool enough or variations in cooling performance. This may be due
to lack of desiccant cartridge filtering causing system contamination and/or shifting of the desiccant
cartridge in the integrated receiver/drier causing erratic condenser performance.
Additionally, some vehicles may exhibit a loss of A/C compressor operation in ambient
temperatures greater than 110 °F (43 °C) when the vehicle is stationary for longer than 15 minutes,
with the transmission in gear. Placing the vehicle in Park does not resume A/C operation. This may
be due to high A/C head pressures caused by contamination in the system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow standard workshop manual diagnostic procedures for customer complaints of A/C slow to
cool, not cool enough. If no issues are identified and on-road evaluations indicate a lack of cooling
performance relative to similar vehicles, use the following.
Proceed directly to the Flushing Service Procedure steps, to correct the condition of A/C
compressor seized or high A/C head pressures.
NOTE
AFTER PERFORMING THE TSB FOR THE A/C SHUT DOWN, DURING HIGH AMBIENT TEMPS
AND EXTENDED IDLE, ADVISE CUSTOMER TO RUN THE A/C IN THE MAX A/C POSITION,
REDUCE BLOWER FAN SPEED FROM THE HIGHEST SETTING, TURN OFF THE AUXILIARY
A/C AND PUT THE VEHICLE'S TRANSMISSION INTO THE PARK GEAR POSITION TO
CONTINUE TO RECEIVE COOL AIR FROM YOUR A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
CHECK THE AIR DEFLECTORS THAT SURROUND THE CONDENSER FOR BEING OUT OF
POSITION OR BEING UNSECURED. THIS MAY ALLOW THE HOT ENGINE COMPARTMENT
AIR TO RECIRCULATE AND CAUSE ADDITIONAL LOAD ON THE A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
WHEN DEBRIS IS PRESENT THROUGHOUT THE ENTIRE SYSTEM, IT IS IMPERATIVE TO
COMPLETELY CLEAN THE A/C SYSTEM TO PREVENT REPEAT FAILURES FROM RESIDUAL
DEBRIS THAT CONTAMINATES THE SYSTEM AFTER THE INITIAL FAILURE. TO PREVENT
REPEAT FAILURES, THE FOLLOWING SERVICE PROCEDURE MUST BE PERFORMED, FOR
ALL SYMPTOMS LISTED IN THIS TSB.
A/C SLOW TO COOL/NOT COOL ENOUGH
1. Measure compressor suction and discharge pressures and compare them with the ranges
shown in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
3. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and inspect
for debris at the bottom of the cartridge below the lip seal before discarding.
4. If there is no debris below the cartridge lip seal and the compressor suction and discharge
pressures are within the shop manual ranges, only replace the desiccant cartridge. Install a new
Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in the kit, and install
condenser into the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures >
Page 8140
5. If debris is found below the cartridge lip seal or the compressor suction/discharge pressure are
not within shop manual ranges, proceed to the Flushing procedure below.
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
FLUSHING SERVICE PROCEDURE With Rotunda A/C Flush And Purge Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass-through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures >
Page 8141
.33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C Flush And Purge - Without Rotunda
Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear lxv if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/O-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
22 oz. - Front A/C
33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures >
Page 8142
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL A/C FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL
SUBSET OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF
THE TWO LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072603 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Condenser HVAC: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8147
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8148
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8149
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Condenser HVAC: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise From Front Door
B-Pillar Area
Front Door Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Wind Noise From Front Door
B-Pillar Area
TSB 07-13-4
07/09/07
WIND NOISE AROUND FRONT DOORS - BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-8-6 to clarify vehicle build date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience wind
noise around the exterior driver and/or passenger doors. This may be most noticeable near the
b-pillar area of the door.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE VEHICLE IS BUILT AFTER 12/6/2006, THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. PROCEED WITH
NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTICS, REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL (WSM),
SECTION 100-04.
1. Check the build date of the vehicle.
a. If the build date of the vehicle is before 12/1/2006, continue to Step 2.
b. If the build date of the vehicle is between 12/1/06 and 12/6/06, continue to Step 3.
2. Verify that the glass run inserts at the b-pillar corner are still in the correct position. (Figure 1)
a. First roll down the window and peel back the inner flocked sealing lip in the b-pillar corner.
b. There will be two inserts located in the corner. They should both be touching in the corner and at
a 90 degree angle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Condenser HVAC: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise From Front Door
B-Pillar Area > Page 8155
c. Sometimes they can shift or fall down into the channel. After verifying the correct plug position,
continue to Step 3.
NOTE
SOME TRUCKS BUILT DURING THE MONTH OF NOVEMBER MAY NOT HAVE THE TWO
INSERTS MENTIONED IN FIGURE 1, THERE MAY BE A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG INSTEAD. IF
THERE IS A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG AS SHOWN IN FIGURE 1, CONTINUE TO STEP 3.
3. With the front door window in the up position, inspect the b-pillar metal carrier for being slightly
bowed out and not making contact to the outside glass surface. (Figure 2)
a. To adjust, compress the b-pillar metal carrier inward just below the b-pillar corner to ensure it
seals to the glass. This can be done by rolling the window down and pressing inward in the location
mentioned above.
NOTE
BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVER COMPRESS THE METAL B-PILLAR CARRIER.
b. Continue to Step 4.
4. Next, with the window in the up position, Inspect the front glass run for any gaps by running a
piece of paper between the glass run and window to
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Condenser HVAC: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise From Front Door
B-Pillar Area > Page 8156
determine any areas where sealing may be an issue. (Figure 3)
a. Make sure to run the paper along both the inside and outside sealing sur[aces of the window to
glass run inter[ace.
b. If a piece of paper freely slips between the glass run and the window at any location then there
may be a sealing issue and the glass run needs to be replaced.
NOTE
IF THE WIND NOISE CONCERN IS STILL PRESENT AFTER PERFORMING THIS SERVICE
PROCEDURE, CONTINUE WITH NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSIS, REFER TO
WSM, SECTION 100-04.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071304A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.9 Hr.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: One Door (23943A,
23943A14, 21 596A)
071304B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.7 Hrs.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: Both Doors (23943A,
23943A14 21596A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7821546/7821547 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Condenser HVAC: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise From Front Door
B-Pillar Area > Page 8162
c. Sometimes they can shift or fall down into the channel. After verifying the correct plug position,
continue to Step 3.
NOTE
SOME TRUCKS BUILT DURING THE MONTH OF NOVEMBER MAY NOT HAVE THE TWO
INSERTS MENTIONED IN FIGURE 1, THERE MAY BE A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG INSTEAD. IF
THERE IS A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG AS SHOWN IN FIGURE 1, CONTINUE TO STEP 3.
3. With the front door window in the up position, inspect the b-pillar metal carrier for being slightly
bowed out and not making contact to the outside glass surface. (Figure 2)
a. To adjust, compress the b-pillar metal carrier inward just below the b-pillar corner to ensure it
seals to the glass. This can be done by rolling the window down and pressing inward in the location
mentioned above.
NOTE
BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVER COMPRESS THE METAL B-PILLAR CARRIER.
b. Continue to Step 4.
4. Next, with the window in the up position, Inspect the front glass run for any gaps by running a
piece of paper between the glass run and window to
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Condenser HVAC: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise From Front Door
B-Pillar Area > Page 8163
determine any areas where sealing may be an issue. (Figure 3)
a. Make sure to run the paper along both the inside and outside sealing sur[aces of the window to
glass run inter[ace.
b. If a piece of paper freely slips between the glass run and the window at any location then there
may be a sealing issue and the glass run needs to be replaced.
NOTE
IF THE WIND NOISE CONCERN IS STILL PRESENT AFTER PERFORMING THIS SERVICE
PROCEDURE, CONTINUE WITH NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSIS, REFER TO
WSM, SECTION 100-04.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071304A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.9 Hr.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: One Door (23943A,
23943A14, 21 596A)
071304B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.7 Hrs.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: Both Doors (23943A,
23943A14 21596A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7821546/7821547 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 8164
Condenser HVAC: Description and Operation
A/C CONDENSER/POWER STEERING COMBO COOLER
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed
A/C compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
The A/C condenser/power steering combo cooler is an aluminum fin-and-tube design heat
exchanger located in front of the vehicle radiator. It cools compressed refrigerant gas by allowing
air to pass over fins and tubes to extract heat and by condensing gas to liquid refrigerant as it is
cooled.
The receiver/drier is incorporated onto the LH side of the condenser core. The receiver/drier
cartridge is a separate component and can be removed and installed separately from the
condenser core.
The top portion of the condenser/power steering combo cooler is partitioned from the refrigerant
system and is used for power steering fluid cooling.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 8165
Condenser HVAC: Service and Repair
CONDENSER CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Recover the refrigerant. 3. Disconnect the
battery cables. 4. Remove the upper radiator sight shield. 5. Remove the RH and LH headlamp
assemblies. 6. Remove the air cleaner outlet tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 8166
7. Remove the 4 junction box bolts and position the junction box aside.
8. Detach the power steering cooler line clip. 9. Remove the condenser inlet fitting bolt and
disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring and gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
10. Remove the condenser outlet fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring and gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
11. NOTE: RH bolts shown, LH similar.
Remove the 2 cooling module and 2 cooling fan shroud bolts.
12. Release the clamps and disconnect the 2 power steering cooler lines from the condenser core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Condenser HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 8167
13. NOTE: LH air deflector shown, RH similar.
Remove the 6 pin-type retainers and detach the RH and LH air deflectors from the condenser.
14. Remove the 9 lower radiator splash shield pin-type retainers and position the shield aside. 15.
Release the clamps and disconnect the 2 transmission cooler lines from the transmission cooler.
16. Detach the transmission cooler line pin-type retainer from the condenser core bracket.
17. NOTE:
- The cooling module must be positioned rearward to raise and detach the 4 condenser mounts
from the cooling module.
- The condenser must be removed from below the vehicle.
Detach and remove the condenser core and transmission cooler as an assembly. 1. Position the
cooling module rearward enough to allow the condenser to be lifted upward. 2. Depress the
retaining tabs on the 2 lower condenser mounting brackets and detach the 4 condenser mounting
brackets from the cooling module 3. Position the top of the condenser forward to detach the top lip
of the condenser bracket from the cooling module and remove the condenser
core and bracket.
18. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals and O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
19. Fill the power steering fluid level. 20. Fill the transmission fluid level. 21. Evacuate, leak test
and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Function Selector Switch Assembly, Rear
View 151-19 (Center Console - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
> Auxiliary Function Selector Switch Assembly, Rear > Page 8172
View 151-47 (Climate Control System - EATC)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Control Assembly: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8175
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8176
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8177
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8178
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8179
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8180
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8181
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8182
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8183
Control Assembly: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8184
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8185
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8186
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8187
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8188
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8189
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8190
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8191
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8192
Control Assembly: Connector Views
C297
C3198
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Auxiliary Climate Control
Control Assembly: Description and Operation Auxiliary Climate Control
CONTROL ASSEMBLY
The auxiliary climate control system has dual controls for the front and rear passengers consisting
of temperature/mode and blower speed. The front auxiliary A/C control functionality is integrated
into the main instrument panel mounted climate control assembly. The rear auxiliary A/C control is
mounted in the rear finish panel of the front floor console. Temperature and airflow mode are
combined into a single setting. When the temperature is set to full cool the airflow mode will be
automatically set to discharge from the headliner registers. When the temperature is set to full
warm, the airflow mode will be set to discharge from the floor register.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Auxiliary Climate Control > Page 8195
Control Assembly: Description and Operation Control Components
CONTROL COMPONENTS
Two climate control systems are available:
- Electronic manual temperature control (EMTC) (Expedition only)
- Dual-zone electronic automatic temperature control (EATC)
Refer to the appropriate heading below for information concerning each system.
Manual Climate Control
The manual climate control components are used to select the following: Air inlet source (outside or recirculated)
- Blower motor speed
- Discharge air temperature (temperature blend)
- Discharge air location (DEFROST, PANEL, FLOOR)
- A/C compressor operation
Control System Inputs - Electronic Manual Temperature Control
Climate Control Assembly (EMTC Module) The climate control assembly integrates the
temperature control, airflow mode selection, A/C request button, recirculated air request button and
rear defog switch into a single unit.
The temperature control setting determines air temperature. Movement of the temperature control
from COOL (blue) to WARM (red) causes a corresponding movement of the temperature blend
door and determines the air discharge temperature that the air distribution system will maintain.
The temperature control switch is an integral part of the climate control assembly and cannot be
installed separately.
The airflow mode setting determines discharge air location. Movement of the mode selector causes
a corresponding movement of the airflow mode door actuators. The mode selector is an integral
part of the climate control assembly and cannot be installed separately.
The A/C request button determines A/C compressor operation, except when the mode selector is in
the OFF, MAX or DEFROST mode. The A/C request button is an integral part of the climate control
assembly and cannot be installed separately.
The recirculated air request button determines air inlet source, except when the airflow mode
selector is in the OFF, MAX or DEFROST mode. The recirculated air request button is an integral
part of the climate control assembly and cannot be installed separately.
The rear defog button signals activation of the heated backlight and heated mirrors. The rear defog
button is an integral part of the manual climate control assembly and cannot be installed
separately.
The EMTC module is not equipped with self-test capabilities.
Control System Outputs - Electronic Manual Temperature Control
Temperature Blend Door Actuator The temperature blend door actuator moves the temperature
blend door on command from the EMTC module.
The temperature blend door actuator contains a reversible electric motor and a potentiometer. The
potentiometer circuit consists of a 5-volt reference signal connected to one end of a variable
resistor, and a signal ground connected to the other. A signal return circuit is connected to a wiper
which is driven along the variable resistor by the actuator shaft. The signal returned to the EMTC
module from the wiper indicates the position of the temperature blend door. The EMTC module
drives the actuator motor in whichever direction is necessary to make the actuator wiper voltage
agree with the expected EMTC module wiper voltage value.
The temperature blend door actuator is located on the heater core and evaporator core housing.
Mode Door Actuators Electric mode door actuators are used to position the 3 airflow mode doors
on command from the EMTC module. The 2 mode door actuators each contain a reversible electric
motor. The DEFROST/PANEL/FLOOR door actuator contains a potentiometer to allow the EMTC
module to monitor the position of the airflow mode doors. The potentiometer circuit consists of a
5-volt reference signal connected to one end of a variable resistor, and a signal ground connected
to the other. A signal return circuit is connected to a wiper which is driven along the variable
resistor by the actuator shaft. The signal returned to the EMTC module from the wiper indicates the
position of the airflow mode door. The air inlet mode door actuator is driven to the full RECIRC or
full FRESH air inlet position, and does not require a potentiometer circuit to monitor its position.
Dual-Zone Electronic Automatic Temperature Control
The dual-zone EATC module analyzes input from the following major sources:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Auxiliary Climate Control > Page 8196
- Temperature, mode and blower selection (made by the vehicle occupants)
- In-vehicle temperature
- In-vehicle humidity (Navigator only)
- Ambient temperature
- Evaporator discharge air temperature
- Sunload
- Vehicle speed
- Engine coolant temperature
Using these inputs, the dual-zone EATC module determines the correct conditions for the following
outputs: A/C compressor operation
- Blower speed
- LH side temperature blend door position
- RH side temperature blend door position
- Airflow mode door positions
Control System Inputs - Dual-Zone EATC
EATC Module (Climate Control Assembly) The EATC module provides an interface for the vehicle
occupants to control the climate control system, or automatically controls the climate control
system in the AUTO mode. The EATC module has a vacuum fluorescent display for displaying set
temperature, airflow direction, blower speed and diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs). An on-board
diagnostic (OBD) feature is incorporated to supply the technician with DTCs. These DTCs help
direct the technician to the inoperative component.
Steering Wheel Audio/Climate Control Switch The steering wheel audio/climate control switch
allows the driver to adjust the passenger compartment temperature setting and manually override
the blower motor speed setting.
For removal and installation of the steering wheel audio/climate control switch, refer to Radio,
Stereo, and Compact Disc.
Ambient Air Temperature Sensor The ambient air temperature sensor contains a thermistor, which
measures the temperature of outside air as a resistance and sends that reading to the dual-zone
EATC module.
In-Vehicle Temperature/Humidity Sensor - Navigator The in-vehicle temperature sensor contains 2
thermistors, which separately measure the in-vehicle air temperature and humidity and send those
readings to the EATC module. An aspirator hose and elbow is connected between the heater core
and evaporator core housing and the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor. The aspirator
hose uses airflow from the heater core and evaporator core housing air stream to create a
venturi-type suction to draw in-vehicle air through the in-vehicle temperature sensor and across the
thermistors.
In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor - Expedition The in-vehicle temperature sensor contains a
thermistor, which measures the in-vehicle air temperature and sends that reading to the EATC
module. An aspirator hose and elbow is connected between the heater core and evaporator core
housing and the in-vehicle temperature sensor. The aspirator hose uses airflow through the heater
core and evaporator core housing to create a venturi-type suction to draw in-vehicle air through the
in-vehicle temperature sensor and across the thermistor.
Dual-Zone Solar Amplifier (Sunload Sensor) The solar amplifier is a dual-zone type that supplies
separate information to the dual-zone EATC module indicating LH side and RH side sunload. For
information on the location and service of the solar amplifier, refer to Lighting and Horns.
Control System Outputs - EATC
Blower Motor Speed Control The blower motor speed control controls the blower motor speed by
converting low power signals from the EATC module to a high current, variable ground feed for the
blower motor. A delay function is used to provide a gradual increase or decrease in blower motor
speed under all conditions.
The blower motor speed control is located on the heater core and evaporator core housing near the
blower motor.
Temperature Blend Door Actuators The dual-zone EATC system uses 2 temperature blend door
actuators to control 2 separate temperature blend doors. The temperature blend doors
independently vary the LH side and RH side temperature settings, as desired. The temperature
blend door actuators each contain a reversible electric motor and a potentiometer. The
potentiometer circuit consists of a 5-volt reference signal connected to one end of a variable
resistor, and a signal ground connected to the other. A signal return circuit is connected to a wiper
which is driven along the variable resistor by the actuator shaft. The signal returned to the EATC
module from the wiper indicates the position of the temperature blend door. The EATC module
drives the actuator motor in whichever direction is necessary to make the actuator wiper voltage
agree with the expected EATC module wiper voltage value.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Auxiliary Climate Control > Page 8197
Mode Door Actuators Electric mode door actuators are used to position the 3 airflow mode doors
on command from the EATC module. The 2 mode door actuators each contain a reversible electric
motor. The DEFROST/PANEL/FLOOR door actuator contains a potentiometer to allow the EATC
module to monitor the position of the airflow mode doors. The potentiometer circuit consists of a
5-volt reference signal connected to one end of a variable resistor, and a signal ground connected
to the other. A signal return circuit is connected to a wiper, which is driven along the variable
resistor by the actuator shaft. The signal returned to the EATC module from the wiper indicates the
position of the airflow mode door. The air inlet mode door actuator is driven to the full RECIRC or
full FRESH air inlet position, and does not require a potentiometer circuit to monitor its position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Auxiliary Climate Control > Page 8198
Control Assembly: Description and Operation Heating and Ventilation
HEATING AND VENTILATION
The heating and ventilation system has the following features:
- Controls the temperature and, during A/C operation, reduces the relative humidity of the air inside
the vehicle.
- Delivers heated or cooled air to maintain the vehicle interior temperature and comfort level.
- Cooling or heating can be adjusted to maintain the desired temperature.
- Uses a reheat method to provide conditioned air to the passenger compartment.
- All airflow from the blower motor passes through the A/C evaporator core.
- Temperature blending is controlled by the temperature blend door(s), which regulate(s) the
amount of air that flows through and around the heater core, where it is then mixed and distributed.
Blower Motor
The blower motor pulls air from the air inlet and forces it into the heater core and evaporator core
housing and the plenum chamber where it is mixed and distributed.
Heater Core
The heater core consists of fins and tubes arranged to extract heat from the engine coolant and
transfer the heat to air passing through the plenum.
Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing
The heater core and evaporator core housing directs airflow from the blower motor through the
evaporator core and heater core. All airflow from the blower motor passes through the evaporator
core. The airflow is then directed through or around the heater core by the temperature blend
door(s). After passing through the heater core, the airflow is distributed to plenum chamber where it
is distributed to the selected vehicle outlets.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Climate Control Assembly
Control Assembly: Service and Repair Climate Control Assembly
CLIMATE CONTROL ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Navigator shown, expedition similar.
1. Remove the center instrument panel finish panel. 2. Remove the 4 climate control assembly
screws. 3. Remove the climate control assembly. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Climate Control Assembly > Page 8201
Control Assembly: Service and Repair Auxiliary Climate Control Assembly
AUXILIARY CLIMATE CONTROL ASSEMBLY
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the floor console upper finish panel. 2. Remove the 2 floor console rear finish panel
screws. 3. Disengage the 6 clips and remove the floor console rear finish panel.
- Disconnect the 3 floor console harness electrical connectors.
4. Remove the 4 auxiliary climate control assembly screws. 5. Remove the auxiliary climate control
assembly. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 8206
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
C228A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 8209
C228B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 8210
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Manual Climate Control Module
C2357A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 8211
C2357B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Module HVAC > Component Information > Diagrams >
Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 8212
C2357C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
Coupler HVAC: Service and Repair
SPRING LOCK COUPLING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect
1. Remove the spring lock coupling clip, if equipped.
2. CAUTION: Do not use metal tools to remove the O-ring seals. They can cause axial scratches
across the O-ring seal grooves, resulting in
refrigerant leaks.
Push the tool into the cage opening to release the female fitting from the spring lock coupling
spring and pull the fitting apart. Remove the O-ring seals using a non-metallic tool.
3. CAUTION: Do not use a screwdriver or similar tool to remove the A/C tube lock coupling spring;
this can cause axial scratches across
the O-ring seal grooves resulting in refrigerant leaks.
Remove the spring lock coupling spring with a small hooked wire.
Cleaning
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 8216
1. Fabricate a cleaning tool from a 1/8-in diameter brazing rod.
2. Cut an abrasive pad from maroon colored 3M Scotch Brite(R) with the dimensions
corresponding to the coupling size.
3. Assemble the pad to the tool. 4. Coat the abrasive pad with PAG oil. 5. Roll the pad on the tool
and install it in a variable speed drill motor.
6. CAUTION: Maintain low speed drill rotation when inserting or removing the cleaning tool to
prevent axial scratches which may cause
future leaks.
Polish for one minute at moderate speed (less than 1,500 rpm) or until the surface is clean and free
of scratches or foreign material.
7. Clean the fitting with a lint-free cloth. 8. Inspect the surface for grooves or scratches. If grooves
and scratches are still present, install a new component.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 8217
9. Clean the O-ring seal grooves with a 300 mm (12 in) length of natural fiber string.
- Loop the string around the grooves and pull the string back and forth.
10. Remove any foreign material from the grooves with a lint-free cloth.
Connect
1. Install the spring lock coupling spring.
2. Lubricate the inside of the coupling with PAG oil.
3. CAUTION: Use only the new O-ring seals. The use of any O-ring seals other than those
specified in the Ford Master Parts Catalog may
result in intermittent leakage during vehicle operation.
Install the O-ring seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Coupler HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Page 8218
4. Connect the spring lock coupling fittings with a twisting motion until the spring lock coupling
spring snaps over the flared end of the female
fitting.
5. Install the spring lock coupling clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 08-9-8 > May > 08 > A/C - Whistle Noise When Changing Temperature
Setting
Evaporator Core: Customer Interest A/C - Whistle Noise When Changing Temperature Setting
TSB 08-9-8
05/12/08
WHISTLE NOISE FROM THE HEATER/AIR CONDITIONING WHILE CHANGING
TEMPERATURE SETTING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/4/2007 may exhibit a
whistle noise from the heater/air conditioning while changing temperature setting.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Confirm customer symptom by cycling the temperature door as follows:
Manual System:
1. Set blower motor speed to number 2.
2. Set mode to PNL/FLR mode (most noticeable). Whistle may be audible in Vent or DEF/FLR but
to a lesser extent.
3. Set the temperature knob all the way to full hot.
4. Start backing off full hot incrementally while listening for whistles. Whistle should be audible
when the knob position is roughly between 5/8 and 3/4 position.
Dual Air Temperature Control (DATC) System:
1. Manually set the blower motor speed to medium or medium high.
2. Manually set mode to PNL/FLR (most noticeable). May be audible in Vent and DEF/FLR.
3. Set the temperature set point to highest temperature 90 °F (32 °C).
4. Start reducing the temperature set point incrementally while listening for whistles. Since the
blend door position is dictated by several inputs like in-car temp sensor, ambient temp sensor, and
sun load sensor. The whistle can be anywhere in the range except full cold.
If the whistle noise is present during the conditions above, replace the evaporator assembly. If the
noise is not present during these conditions, refer to workshop manual diagnostics.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 08-9-8 > May > 08 > A/C - Whistle Noise When Changing Temperature
Setting > Page 8227
080908A 2007-2008 Expedition, 4.6 Hrs.
Navigator Built Before 12/04/07: Replace The Evaporator Assembly, Includes Time To Evacuate
And Charge System, Remove And Install Console, Instrument Panel, Steering Column (Do Not
Use With 19700A, 19700A15, 19680A, 04320A, 04320B, 3514A, 04536A, 04536B, 18476A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19B555 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 08-9-8 > May > 08 > A/C - Whistle Noise When Changing
Temperature Setting
Evaporator Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Whistle Noise When Changing Temperature
Setting
TSB 08-9-8
05/12/08
WHISTLE NOISE FROM THE HEATER/AIR CONDITIONING WHILE CHANGING
TEMPERATURE SETTING - BUILT ON OR BEFORE 12/4/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/4/2007 may exhibit a
whistle noise from the heater/air conditioning while changing temperature setting.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Confirm customer symptom by cycling the temperature door as follows:
Manual System:
1. Set blower motor speed to number 2.
2. Set mode to PNL/FLR mode (most noticeable). Whistle may be audible in Vent or DEF/FLR but
to a lesser extent.
3. Set the temperature knob all the way to full hot.
4. Start backing off full hot incrementally while listening for whistles. Whistle should be audible
when the knob position is roughly between 5/8 and 3/4 position.
Dual Air Temperature Control (DATC) System:
1. Manually set the blower motor speed to medium or medium high.
2. Manually set mode to PNL/FLR (most noticeable). May be audible in Vent and DEF/FLR.
3. Set the temperature set point to highest temperature 90 °F (32 °C).
4. Start reducing the temperature set point incrementally while listening for whistles. Since the
blend door position is dictated by several inputs like in-car temp sensor, ambient temp sensor, and
sun load sensor. The whistle can be anywhere in the range except full cold.
If the whistle noise is present during the conditions above, replace the evaporator assembly. If the
noise is not present during these conditions, refer to workshop manual diagnostics.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 08-9-8 > May > 08 > A/C - Whistle Noise When Changing
Temperature Setting > Page 8233
080908A 2007-2008 Expedition, 4.6 Hrs.
Navigator Built Before 12/04/07: Replace The Evaporator Assembly, Includes Time To Evacuate
And Charge System, Remove And Install Console, Instrument Panel, Steering Column (Do Not
Use With 19700A, 19700A15, 19680A, 04320A, 04320B, 3514A, 04536A, 04536B, 18476A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19B555 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Climate Control
Evaporator Core: Description and Operation Climate Control
EVAPORATOR CORE
NOTE:
- If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator core must be vacuum leak tested before it
is removed from the vehicle. Refer to Heating and Air Conditioning.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air conditioning
system except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
The evaporator core is an aluminum plate/fin type and is located in the heater core and evaporator
core housing. A mixture of refrigerant and oil enters the bottom of the evaporator core through the
evaporator core inlet tube, continues over to the remaining plate/fin sections and then moves out of
the evaporator core through the evaporator core outlet tube. Air from the blower motor is cooled
and dehumidified as it flows through the evaporator core fins.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Climate Control > Page 8236
Evaporator Core: Description and Operation Auxiliary Climate Control
EVAPORATOR CORE
NOTE:
- If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator core must be vacuum leak tested before it
is removed from the vehicle. Refer to Heating and Air Conditioning.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air conditioning
system except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
The evaporator core is an aluminum plate/fin type and is located in the auxiliary climate control
housing. A mixture of refrigerant and oil enters the bottom of the evaporator core through the
evaporator core inlet tube and then moves out of the evaporator core through the evaporator core
outlet tube. When the A/C compressor is operating, air from the blower motor is cooled and
dehumidified as it flows through the evaporator core fins.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Evaporator Core
EVAPORATOR CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator core must be vacuum leak tested before it
is removed from the vehicle.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air conditioning
system except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
- A new evaporator core seal is supplied as a kit with the evaporator core service part. Failure to
install this seal, or failure to install it correctly, will result in air bypassing the evaporator core and
loss of cooling efficiency.
1. Remove the plenum chamber. 2. Remove 2 heater core quick disconnect fitting clips and the
dash panel seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core > Page 8239
3. Detach the wire harness from the upper half of the heater core and evaporator core housing. 4.
Remove the 6 air inlet duct screws and the air inlet duct. 5. Remove the 15 heater core and
evaporator core housing screws. 6. Separate the 2 halves of the heater core and evaporator core
housing.
7. Remove the evaporator core. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core > Page 8240
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Evaporator Core
AUXILIARY EVAPORATOR CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- The auxiliary evaporator core is not available as a separate component for Expedition EL or
Navigator L vehicles and is serviced only as an assembly with the auxiliary heater core and
evaporator core housing. The auxiliary evaporator core is serviced as an individual component for
Expedition and Navigator vehicles.
- If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator core must be vacuum leak tested before it
is removed from the vehicle.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air conditioning
system except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
All vehicles
1. Remove the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing.
Expedition EL
2. Transfer the components from the old heater core and evaporator core housing to the new
heater core and evaporator core housing as needed. 3. Install the auxiliary heater core and
evaporator core housing.
Expedition or Navigator only
4. Remove the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Evaporator Core > Page 8241
5. Remove the 12 evaporator/heater core access cover screws. 6. Remove the evaporator/heater
core access cover.
- Disconnect the evaporator drain tube.
7. Remove the evaporator core. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
View 151-46 (Climate Control System - Manual A/C)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8245
View 151-47 (Climate Control System - EATC)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8246
C2323
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Discharge Air Temperature Sensor
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Evaporator Discharge Air
Temperature Sensor
EVAPORATOR DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The evaporator discharge air temperature sensor communicates the evaporator discharge air
temperature to the electronic manual temperature control (EMTC) module (if equipped) or
electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped).
The PCM maintains evaporator core temperature and prevents icing of the evaporator core, by
disengaging the A/C compressor clutch when the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor
reading falls below acceptable levels, and by engaging the A/C compressor clutch when the
discharge air temperature rises above acceptable levels.
The evaporator discharge air temperature sensor is located on the heater core and evaporator core
housing in the air-stream leaving the evaporator core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Discharge Air Temperature Sensor > Page 8249
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Evaporator
Temperature (ACET) Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE (ACET) SENSOR
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance changes the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling, improve defrost/demist
performance, and reduce A/C clutch cycling.
NOTE: These values can vary 15% due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 8250
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) EVAPORATOR DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Detach the glove compartment dampener and lower the glove compartment. 2. Disconnect the
evaporator discharge air temperature sensor electrical connector. 3. Carefully pry the evaporator
discharge air temperature sensor probe out of the heater core and evaporator core housing. 4. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Expansion Valve: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures
Expansion Valve: Customer Interest A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
TSB 07-26-3
12/24/07
A/C COMPRESSOR - CUTS OUT HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES/SEIZED - POOR A/C
PERFORMANCE - BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-25-1 to update the symptoms, Service Procedure and vehicle built
date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 11/1/2007 may exhibit
symptoms of slow to cool, not cool enough or variations in cooling performance. This may be due
to lack of desiccant cartridge filtering causing system contamination and/or shifting of the desiccant
cartridge in the integrated receiver/drier causing erratic condenser performance.
Additionally, some vehicles may exhibit a loss of A/C compressor operation in ambient
temperatures greater than 110 °F (43 °C) when the vehicle is stationary for longer than 15 minutes,
with the transmission in gear. Placing the vehicle in Park does not resume A/C operation. This may
be due to high A/C head pressures caused by contamination in the system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow standard workshop manual diagnostic procedures for customer complaints of A/C slow to
cool, not cool enough. If no issues are identified and on-road evaluations indicate a lack of cooling
performance relative to similar vehicles, use the following.
Proceed directly to the Flushing Service Procedure steps, to correct the condition of A/C
compressor seized or high A/C head pressures.
NOTE
AFTER PERFORMING THE TSB FOR THE A/C SHUT DOWN, DURING HIGH AMBIENT TEMPS
AND EXTENDED IDLE, ADVISE CUSTOMER TO RUN THE A/C IN THE MAX A/C POSITION,
REDUCE BLOWER FAN SPEED FROM THE HIGHEST SETTING, TURN OFF THE AUXILIARY
A/C AND PUT THE VEHICLE'S TRANSMISSION INTO THE PARK GEAR POSITION TO
CONTINUE TO RECEIVE COOL AIR FROM YOUR A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
CHECK THE AIR DEFLECTORS THAT SURROUND THE CONDENSER FOR BEING OUT OF
POSITION OR BEING UNSECURED. THIS MAY ALLOW THE HOT ENGINE COMPARTMENT
AIR TO RECIRCULATE AND CAUSE ADDITIONAL LOAD ON THE A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
WHEN DEBRIS IS PRESENT THROUGHOUT THE ENTIRE SYSTEM, IT IS IMPERATIVE TO
COMPLETELY CLEAN THE A/C SYSTEM TO PREVENT REPEAT FAILURES FROM RESIDUAL
DEBRIS THAT CONTAMINATES THE SYSTEM AFTER THE INITIAL FAILURE. TO PREVENT
REPEAT FAILURES, THE FOLLOWING SERVICE PROCEDURE MUST BE PERFORMED, FOR
ALL SYMPTOMS LISTED IN THIS TSB.
A/C SLOW TO COOL/NOT COOL ENOUGH
1. Measure compressor suction and discharge pressures and compare them with the ranges
shown in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
3. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and inspect
for debris at the bottom of the cartridge below the lip seal before discarding.
4. If there is no debris below the cartridge lip seal and the compressor suction and discharge
pressures are within the shop manual ranges, only replace the desiccant cartridge. Install a new
Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in the kit, and install
condenser into the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Expansion Valve: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures > Page 8259
5. If debris is found below the cartridge lip seal or the compressor suction/discharge pressure are
not within shop manual ranges, proceed to the Flushing procedure below.
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
FLUSHING SERVICE PROCEDURE With Rotunda A/C Flush And Purge Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass-through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Expansion Valve: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures > Page 8260
.33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C Flush And Purge - Without Rotunda
Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear lxv if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/O-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
22 oz. - Front A/C
33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Expansion Valve: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures > Page 8261
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL A/C FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL
SUBSET OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF
THE TWO LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072603 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Expansion Valve: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Expansion Valve: Customer Interest A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Expansion Valve: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8266
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Expansion Valve: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8267
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Expansion Valve: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8268
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Expansion Valve: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures
Expansion Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
TSB 07-26-3
12/24/07
A/C COMPRESSOR - CUTS OUT HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES/SEIZED - POOR A/C
PERFORMANCE - BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-25-1 to update the symptoms, Service Procedure and vehicle built
date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 11/1/2007 may exhibit
symptoms of slow to cool, not cool enough or variations in cooling performance. This may be due
to lack of desiccant cartridge filtering causing system contamination and/or shifting of the desiccant
cartridge in the integrated receiver/drier causing erratic condenser performance.
Additionally, some vehicles may exhibit a loss of A/C compressor operation in ambient
temperatures greater than 110 °F (43 °C) when the vehicle is stationary for longer than 15 minutes,
with the transmission in gear. Placing the vehicle in Park does not resume A/C operation. This may
be due to high A/C head pressures caused by contamination in the system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow standard workshop manual diagnostic procedures for customer complaints of A/C slow to
cool, not cool enough. If no issues are identified and on-road evaluations indicate a lack of cooling
performance relative to similar vehicles, use the following.
Proceed directly to the Flushing Service Procedure steps, to correct the condition of A/C
compressor seized or high A/C head pressures.
NOTE
AFTER PERFORMING THE TSB FOR THE A/C SHUT DOWN, DURING HIGH AMBIENT TEMPS
AND EXTENDED IDLE, ADVISE CUSTOMER TO RUN THE A/C IN THE MAX A/C POSITION,
REDUCE BLOWER FAN SPEED FROM THE HIGHEST SETTING, TURN OFF THE AUXILIARY
A/C AND PUT THE VEHICLE'S TRANSMISSION INTO THE PARK GEAR POSITION TO
CONTINUE TO RECEIVE COOL AIR FROM YOUR A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
CHECK THE AIR DEFLECTORS THAT SURROUND THE CONDENSER FOR BEING OUT OF
POSITION OR BEING UNSECURED. THIS MAY ALLOW THE HOT ENGINE COMPARTMENT
AIR TO RECIRCULATE AND CAUSE ADDITIONAL LOAD ON THE A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
WHEN DEBRIS IS PRESENT THROUGHOUT THE ENTIRE SYSTEM, IT IS IMPERATIVE TO
COMPLETELY CLEAN THE A/C SYSTEM TO PREVENT REPEAT FAILURES FROM RESIDUAL
DEBRIS THAT CONTAMINATES THE SYSTEM AFTER THE INITIAL FAILURE. TO PREVENT
REPEAT FAILURES, THE FOLLOWING SERVICE PROCEDURE MUST BE PERFORMED, FOR
ALL SYMPTOMS LISTED IN THIS TSB.
A/C SLOW TO COOL/NOT COOL ENOUGH
1. Measure compressor suction and discharge pressures and compare them with the ranges
shown in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
3. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and inspect
for debris at the bottom of the cartridge below the lip seal before discarding.
4. If there is no debris below the cartridge lip seal and the compressor suction and discharge
pressures are within the shop manual ranges, only replace the desiccant cartridge. Install a new
Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in the kit, and install
condenser into the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Expansion Valve: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures > Page 8274
5. If debris is found below the cartridge lip seal or the compressor suction/discharge pressure are
not within shop manual ranges, proceed to the Flushing procedure below.
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
FLUSHING SERVICE PROCEDURE With Rotunda A/C Flush And Purge Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass-through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Expansion Valve: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures > Page 8275
.33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C Flush And Purge - Without Rotunda
Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear lxv if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/O-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
22 oz. - Front A/C
33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Expansion Valve: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures > Page 8276
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL A/C FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL
SUBSET OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF
THE TWO LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072603 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Expansion Valve: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Expansion Valve: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Expansion Valve: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8281
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Expansion Valve: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8282
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Expansion Valve: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8283
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Climate Control
Expansion Valve: Description and Operation Climate Control
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE
The thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) is located between the evaporator core lines and the
thermostatic expansion valve manifold and tube assembly at the RH rear of the engine
compartment. The TXV provides a restriction to the flow of refrigerant from the high-pressure side
of the refrigerant system, and separates the low-pressure and high-pressure sides of the refrigerant
system. Refrigerant entering and exiting the evaporator core passes through the TXV through 2
separate flow paths. An internal temperature sensing bulb senses the temperature of the
refrigerant flowing out of the evaporator core and adjusts an internal pin-type valve to meter the
refrigerant flow into the evaporator core. The internal pin-type valve decreases the amount of
refrigerant entering the evaporator core at lower temperatures and increases the amount of
refrigerant entering the evaporator core at higher temperatures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Climate Control > Page 8286
Expansion Valve: Description and Operation Auxiliary Climate Control
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE (TXV)
The TXV restricts the flow of refrigerant from the high-pressure side of the refrigerant system and
separates the low-pressure and high-pressure sides of the auxiliary refrigerant system. Refrigerant
entering and exiting the auxiliary evaporator core passes through the TXV through 2 separate flow
paths. An internal temperature sensing bulb senses the temperature of the refrigerant flowing out of
the evaporator core and adjusts an internal pin-type valve to meter the refrigerant flow into the
evaporator core. The internal pin-type valve decreases the amount of refrigerant entering the
evaporator core at lower temperatures and increases the amount of refrigerant entering the
evaporator core at higher temperatures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Climate Control
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair Climate Control
Thermostatic Expansion Valve
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed
A/C compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
All vehicles
1. Recover the refrigerant.
Vehicles with auxiliary A/C
2. Remove the auxiliary evaporator inlet line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the gasket seal and O-ring seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
All vehicles
3. Disconnect the evaporator inlet and outlet fittings.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Climate Control > Page 8289
4. Detach the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) manifold and tube assembly from the 2 TXV
manifold and tube brackets.
5. Remove the tie-strap from the TXV insulator. 6. Remove the TXV fitting bolt.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
7. Remove the 2 bolts and the TXV.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals and O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
9. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Thermostatic Expansion Valve Manifold and Tube Assembly
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE MANIFOLD AND TUBE ASSEMBLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Climate Control > Page 8290
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the RH headlamp assembly. 3. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator inlet line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. Disconnect the evaporator core inlet and outlet fittings.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
5. Detach the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) manifold and tube assembly from the 2 TXV
manifold and tube brackets. 6. Remove the condenser outlet fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
7. Remove the TXV manifold and tube suction fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
8. Remove the TXV manifold and tube assembly. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Climate Control > Page 8291
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
10. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Climate Control > Page 8292
Expansion Valve: Service and Repair Auxiliary Climate Control
Thermostatic Expansion Valve
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE
Removal and Installation
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the RH quarter trim panel. 3. Remove the thermostatic
expansion valve (TXV) fitting bolt and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
4. Remove the 2 TXV bolts. 5. Remove the TXV.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
7. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Thermostatic Expansion Valve - Expedition EL, Navigator L
THERMOSTATIC EXPANSION VALVE - EXPEDITION EL, NAVIGATOR L
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Climate Control > Page 8293
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Recover the refrigerant. 3. Remove the
auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting nut.
- Discard the gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 2 thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) bolts and the TXV.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals and gasket seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
6. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Core: Customer Interest A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
8302
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
8303
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
> Page 8309
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Core: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
> Page 8310
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 8311
Heater Core: Description and Operation
HEATER CORE
The heater core consists of fins and tubes arranged to extract heat from the engine coolant and
transfer the heat to air passing through the auxiliary climate control housing.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core
Heater Core: Service and Repair Heater Core
HEATER CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be leak tested before it is removed
from the vehicle.
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Remove the 8 plenum chamber
screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core > Page 8314
3. Release the plenum chamber clip and position the plenum chamber aside. 4. Remove 2 heater
core fitting clips and the dash panel seal. 5. Remove the heater core tube bracket screw and the
heater core tube bracket. 6. Remove the heater core bracket screw and the heater core bracket. 7.
Remove the heater core. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core > Page 8315
Heater Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core
AUXILIARY HEATER CORE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be pressure leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing.
2. Release the clip and open the floorpan bracket. 3. Remove the heater core tube bracket screw
and the heater core tube bracket. 4. Remove the 12 evaporator/heater core access cover screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core > Page 8316
5. Remove the evaporator/heater core access cover. 6. Remove the heater core. 7. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core > Page 8317
Heater Core: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core - Expedition EL, Navigator L
AUXILIARY HEATER CORE - EXPEDITION EL, NAVIGATOR L
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
- If a heater core leak is suspected, the heater core must be pressure leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
- It is not necessary to install the new heater core tubes contained in the heater core service kit
unless there is evidence of damage to the heater core tubes. New O-ring seals must be installed
any time the heater core tubes are detached from the heater core.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain the engine coolant. 3. Remove the
RH quarter trim panel. 4. Position a suitable drain pan and disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater outlet
and inlet line quick disconnect fittings at the floorpan connections to
allow any residual coolant to drain from the auxiliary heater core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Heater Core > Page 8318
5. Remove the heater core door screw.
6. Remove the 2 auxiliary heater core tube fitting clips.
7. Disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater core tubes.
1 Position the auxiliary heater core partially out of the housing.
2 Disconnect the auxiliary heater core inlet tube.
3 Disconnect the auxiliary heater core outlet tube. Discard the O-ring seals.
8. Remove the auxiliary heater core.
9. NOTE:
- Use only the O-ring seals contained in the auxiliary heater core service kit.
- Verify that the heater core tube fittings are completely seated in the heater core before installing
the heater core tube fitting clips.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
10. Fill the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: Customer Interest A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
8327
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page
8328
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
> Page 8334
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Heater Hose: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
> Page 8335
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures
Heater Hose: Procedures
HEATER HOSE COUPLING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Disconnect
1. WARNING: The engine must be off, fully cool and the cooling system fully depressurized before
attempting to disconnect any heater
water hoses. Failure to comply with this warning can result in serious injury or burns from hot liquid
escaping out of the engine cooling system.
Depressurize the engine cooling system.
2. Push the heater water hose toward the tube to fully expose the locking tabs.
3. NOTE: When compressing the white coupling retainer, the Heater Hose Disconnect Tool must
be perpendicular to and on the highest point of the
coupling.
Push the special tool over the coupling retainer windows to compress the retainer locking tabs.
4. NOTE: A slight twisting motion while pulling on the heater water hose may be necessary to
assist in the removal.
Pull the heater water hose away from the heater core tube.
5. Plug the heater water hose. 6. Remove the white coupling retainer from the tube.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8338
7. Spread the retainer tabs apart and slide the retainer off the tube. 8. Discard the retainer.
Connect
1. Clean the tubes and lubricate with MERPOL meeting Ford specification ESE-M99B144-B or
plain water.
2. Install a new coupling retainer, spacer, and lubricated O-ring seals into the quick disconnect
coupling housing.
3. Push the heater water hose with a quick disconnect coupling onto the tube. 4. Make sure the
coupling is fully engaged by lightly pulling on the heater water hose.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8339
Heater Hose: Removal and Replacement
AUXILIARY HEATER OUTLET AND INLET LINE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8340
Part 2
Removal
NOTE:
- The auxiliary heater inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly. The auxiliary
heater inlet line and outlet line are each installed from the factory as one-piece assemblies. The
replacement parts are supplied as separate kits containing multiple-piece lines for ease of
installation.
- The following procedure can be used to remove and install one or both the auxiliary evaporator
inlet and auxiliary evaporator outlet lines. If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed and
installed, cut or disconnect only the desired line at the specified points within the procedure.
All vehicles
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Drain the engine coolant. 3. Remove the
spare tire. 4. Remove the RH fender splash shield.
5. NOTE: If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the auxiliary heater outlet and/or inlet line front quick disconnect fitting(s).
6. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the front auxiliary line bracket nut and the
front auxiliary line bracket.
7. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
8. Remove the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8341
9. NOTE: If only one auxiliary heater line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Disconnect the auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line rear quick disconnect fitting(s).
10. Remove the muffler. 11. Remove the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts and the spare tire
carrier splash shield. 12. Remove the 3 muffler heat shield bolts and the muffler heat shield. 13.
Remove the 2 exhaust hanger bolts and the exhaust hanger. 14. Remove the RH catalyst
monitoring sensor. 15. Remove the 3 remaining RH catalytic converter heat shield bolts and the
heat shield.
16. Remove the 3 remaining auxiliary line bracket nuts and the line brackets.
17. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary heater line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary heater line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new line(s).
18. Remove the auxiliary heater line(s) in 3 separate pieces.
Installation
Expedition or Navigator only
1. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary heater outlet and inlet line(s) and connect the quick
disconnect fittings.
All vehicles
2. Install the front auxiliary heater line(s) and connect the quick disconnect fittings.
3. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the middle auxiliary heater line(s).
4. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 auxiliary line brackets and nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
5. Tighten the middle auxiliary heater line fittings. 6. Inspect the auxiliary heater lines for correct
installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as needed. 7. Install the RH catalytic converter heat
shield and the 3 catalytic converter heat shield rear bolts. 8. Install the RH catalyst monitoring
sensor. 9. Install the exhaust hanger and the 2 exhaust hanger bolts.
10. Install the muffler heat shield and the 3 muffler heat shield bolts. 11. Install the muffler. 12.
Install the spare tire carrier splash shield and the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts. 13.
Working through the RH fender well opening, Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt. 14. Install the front auxiliary line bracket and the front auxiliary line bracket and nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
15. Install the RH front fender splash shield. 16. Install the RH front wheel.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only
17. Install the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Procedures > Page 8342
All vehicles
18. Install the spare tire. 19. Fill the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component Information >
Description and Operation
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Description and Operation
A/C COMPRESSOR PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE
An A/C compressor pressure relief valve is incorporated in the compressor to prevent damage to
the A/C compressor and other system components, and to avoid total refrigerant loss by relieving
unusually high refrigerant system discharge pressure buildups.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Hose/Line HVAC: Customer Interest A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8354
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8355
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8356
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Hose/Line HVAC: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8362
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8363
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hose/Line HVAC: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8364
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 8365
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation
AUXILIARY A/C - HEATER LINES
The auxiliary lines are secured to the underbody of the vehicle. Each auxiliary line is only available
as a multiple-piece kit for ease of installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line
AUXILIARY EVAPORATOR OUTLET AND INLET LINE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 8368
Part 2
Removal
NOTE:
- The auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet lines are not supplied together as an assembly for
Expedition or Navigator vehicles. The auxiliary evaporator inlet line and outlet line are each
installed from the factory as one-piece assemblies. The replacement parts are supplied as
separate kits containing multiple-piece lines for ease of installation.
- The auxiliary evaporator inlet and outlet lines for Expedition EL or Navigator L vehicles are
installed from the factory as a single one-piece assembly including both lines. The replacement
part is supplied as a multiple-piece kit for ease of installation.
- For Expedition or Navigator vehicles, the following procedure can be used to remove and install
one or both the auxiliary evaporator inlet and auxiliary evaporator outlet lines. If only one auxiliary
evaporator line is to be removed and installed, cut or disconnect only the desired line at the
specified points within the procedure. For Expedition EL or Navigator L vehicles, both lines must be
removed.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air conditioning
system except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
All vehicles 1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Recover the refrigerant.
3. NOTE: If only one auxiliary evaporator line is to be removed, disconnect only the desired line.
Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line front fitting nut(s) and disconnect the fitting(s).
Discard the O-ring seals and gasket seals.
4. Remove the spare tire. 5. Remove the RH fender splash shield. 6. Working through the RH
fender well opening, remove the front auxiliary line bracket nut and the front auxiliary line bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 8369
7. Working through the RH fender well opening, remove the RH catalytic converter heat shield front
bolt.
Expedition or Navigator only
8. NOTE: Both A/C fittings must be disconnected even if only one line is to be removed.
Disconnect the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fittings. Discard the O-ring seals.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only 9. Remove the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
10. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the gasket seals.
All vehicles 11. Remove the muffler. 12. Remove the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts and the
spare tire carrier splash shield. 13. Remove the 3 muffler heat shield bolts and the heat shield. 14.
Remove the 2 exhaust hanger bolts and the exhaust hanger. 15. Remove the RH catalyst
monitoring sensor. 16. Remove the 3 remaining RH catalytic converter heat shield bolts and the
heat shield.
17. Remove the 3 remaining auxiliary line bracket nuts and the auxiliary line brackets.
18. NOTE: If installing only one auxiliary evaporator line, cut only the desired line.
Assemble and lay out the replacement line(s) in the same position as the existing line(s) and, using
a suitable tool, cut the auxiliary evaporator line(s) in the same position as the fittings on the new
line(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 8370
19. NOTE:
- Expedition EL shown.
- For Expedition EL or Navigator L vehicles, the middle portion of the auxiliary evaporator outlet
and inlet lines can be removed through the RH rear wheel well opening between the body and the
frame.
Remove the auxiliary evaporator line(s) in 3 separate pieces.
Installation
Expedition or Navigator only 1. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary evaporator line(s) and
connect the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fittings.
- Install new O-ring seals.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only 2. Install the rear portion of the auxiliary evaporator outlet and
inlet line. 3. Connect the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting and install the nut.
- Install new gasket seals.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
All vehicles 4. Install the front portion of the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line(s). 5. Connect
the evaporator outlet and inlet line front fitting(s) and install the nut(s).
- Install new O-ring seals and gasket seals.
- Tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
6. NOTE: Loosely connect, but do not tighten, the fittings.
Install the middle auxiliary evaporator line(s).
7. Starting from the rear of the vehicle, install the first 3 auxiliary line brackets and nuts.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 8371
8. NOTE: Expedition/Navigator shown, Expedition EL or Navigator L similar.
Tighten the middle auxiliary evaporator line fittings.
9. Inspect the auxiliary evaporator lines for correct installation. Loosen, reposition and tighten as
needed.
10. Install the RH catalytic converter heat shield and the 3 rear catalytic converter heat shield bolts.
11. Install the exhaust hanger and the 2 exhaust hanger bolts. 12. Install the muffler heat shield
and the 3 muffler heat shield bolts. 13. Install the RH catalyst monitoring sensor. 14. Install the
muffler. 15. Working through the RH fender well opening, Install the RH catalytic converter heat
shield front bolt. 16. Install the front auxiliary line bracket and the front auxiliary line bracket nut.
- Tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
17. Install the spare tire carrier splash shield and the 3 spare tire carrier splash shield bolts. 18.
Install the RH front fender splash shield. 19. Install the RH front wheel.
Expedition EL or Navigator L only 20. Install the RH rear wheel and tire assembly.
All vehicles 21. Install the spare tire. 22. Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of
clean PAG oil. 23. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 8372
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair Compressor to Condenser Discharge Line
COMPRESSOR TO CONDENSER DISCHARGE LINE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Remove the compressor discharge fitting nut and disconnect the
fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
3. Remove the condenser inlet jumper line fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring seal and gasket seal.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. Remove the compressor-to-condenser discharge line. 5. If removing the condenser inlet jumper
line, remove the RH headlamp assembly. 6. If removing the condenser inlet jumper line, disconnect
the A/C pressure transducer electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Auxiliary Evaporator Outlet and Inlet Line > Page 8373
7. If removing the condenser inlet jumper line, remove the condenser inlet fitting bolt and
disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the O-ring and gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
8. Remove the condenser inlet jumper line. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals and O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing
HEATER CORE AND EVAPORATOR CORE HOUSING
Removal and Installation
NOTE:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing > Page 8378
- If an evaporator core leak is suspected, the evaporator must be vacuum leak tested before it is
removed from the vehicle.
- Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air conditioning
system except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C compressor or
damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
1. Recover the refrigerant. 2. Drain the engine coolant. 3. Remove the instrument panel. 4.
Disconnect the 2 heater hose quick disconnect fittings at the heater core. 5. Remove the auxiliary
evaporator outlet and inlet line fitting nuts and disconnect the fittings.
- Discard the O-ring seals and gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
6. Disconnect the evaporator outlet and inlet fittings.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
7. Detach the thermostatic expansion valve (TXV) manifold and tube assembly from the line 2
brackets. 8. Detach the TXV manifold and tube assembly bracket from the heater core and
evaporator core housing stud at the dash panel. 9. Remove the 3 heater core and evaporator core
housing nuts.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
10. Detach the 4 satellite radio antenna cable pin-type retainers from the heater core and
evaporator core housing (if equipped). 11. Detach the 3 body harness electrical connectors from
the bracket below the air inlet duct. 12. Remove the air inlet duct bracket nut.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
13. Remove the plenum chamber nut.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
14. Remove the 4 tunnel instrument panel bracket bolts and the tunnel instrument panel bracket.
15. Detach the rear footwell duct from the heater core and evaporator core housing. 16. Remove
the plenum chamber nut. 17. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 18. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals and O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
19. Fill the engine coolant level. 20. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing > Page 8379
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Plenum Chamber
PLENUM CHAMBER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the heater core and evaporator core housing. 2. Disconnect the mode door actuator
electrical connector and position the wire harness aside. 3. Remove the 8 plenum chamber screws.
4. Release the plenum chamber clip and remove 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. the
plenum chamber.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing > Page 8380
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing
AUXILIARY HEATER CORE AND EVAPORATOR CORE HOUSING
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Recover the refrigerant.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing > Page 8381
3. Drain the engine coolant.
4. NOTE: Allow any residual coolant to drain from the auxiliary heater core after disconnecting the
auxiliary heater hose fittings.
Position a suitable drain pan and disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater hose fittings at the floorpan
connection.
5. Disconnect the 2 auxiliary evaporator line fittings at the floorpan connection.
- Discard the O-ring seals.
6. Remove the 2 floorpan bracket bolts. 7. Remove the auxiliary headliner duct pin-type retainer
and disconnect the duct. 8. Disconnect the auxiliary mode door actuator electrical connector. 9.
Disconnect the auxiliary temperature blend door actuator electrical connector.
10. Disconnect the auxiliary blower motor resistor electrical connector. 11. Disconnect the auxiliary
blower motor electrical connector and detach the wire harness from the housing. 12. Remove the 2
auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
13. Remove the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing. 14. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
- Install new O-ring seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
15. Fill the engine cooling system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing > Page 8382
Housing Assembly HVAC: Service and Repair Auxiliary Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing
- Expedition EL, Navigator L
AUXILIARY HEATER CORE AND EVAPORATOR CORE HOUSING - EXPEDITION EL,
NAVIGATOR L
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Housing Assembly HVAC > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Heater Core and Evaporator Core Housing > Page 8383
2. Recover the refrigerant. 3. Drain the engine coolant. 4. Remove the RH rear quarter trim panel.
5. NOTE: Allow any residual coolant to drain from the auxiliary heater core after disconnecting the
auxiliary heater core fittings.
Position a suitable drain pan and disconnect the 2 auxiliary heater core quick disconnect fittings.
6. Remove the auxiliary evaporator outlet and inlet line rear fitting nut and disconnect the fitting.
- Discard the gasket seals.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
7. Disconnect the auxiliary climate control harness electrical connector. 8. Remove the auxiliary
airflow duct bolt.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
9. Remove the 2 heater core and evaporator core housing bolts.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
10. Remove the auxiliary heater core and evaporator core housing. 11. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
- Install new gasket seals.
- Lubricate the refrigerant system with the correct amount of clean PAG oil.
12. Fill the engine coolant level. 13. Evacuate, leak test and charge the refrigerant system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Humidity Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Receiver Dryer: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
Receiver Dryer: Customer Interest A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
TSB 07-26-3
12/24/07
A/C COMPRESSOR - CUTS OUT HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES/SEIZED - POOR A/C
PERFORMANCE - BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-25-1 to update the symptoms, Service Procedure and vehicle built
date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 11/1/2007 may exhibit
symptoms of slow to cool, not cool enough or variations in cooling performance. This may be due
to lack of desiccant cartridge filtering causing system contamination and/or shifting of the desiccant
cartridge in the integrated receiver/drier causing erratic condenser performance.
Additionally, some vehicles may exhibit a loss of A/C compressor operation in ambient
temperatures greater than 110 °F (43 °C) when the vehicle is stationary for longer than 15 minutes,
with the transmission in gear. Placing the vehicle in Park does not resume A/C operation. This may
be due to high A/C head pressures caused by contamination in the system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow standard workshop manual diagnostic procedures for customer complaints of A/C slow to
cool, not cool enough. If no issues are identified and on-road evaluations indicate a lack of cooling
performance relative to similar vehicles, use the following.
Proceed directly to the Flushing Service Procedure steps, to correct the condition of A/C
compressor seized or high A/C head pressures.
NOTE
AFTER PERFORMING THE TSB FOR THE A/C SHUT DOWN, DURING HIGH AMBIENT TEMPS
AND EXTENDED IDLE, ADVISE CUSTOMER TO RUN THE A/C IN THE MAX A/C POSITION,
REDUCE BLOWER FAN SPEED FROM THE HIGHEST SETTING, TURN OFF THE AUXILIARY
A/C AND PUT THE VEHICLE'S TRANSMISSION INTO THE PARK GEAR POSITION TO
CONTINUE TO RECEIVE COOL AIR FROM YOUR A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
CHECK THE AIR DEFLECTORS THAT SURROUND THE CONDENSER FOR BEING OUT OF
POSITION OR BEING UNSECURED. THIS MAY ALLOW THE HOT ENGINE COMPARTMENT
AIR TO RECIRCULATE AND CAUSE ADDITIONAL LOAD ON THE A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
WHEN DEBRIS IS PRESENT THROUGHOUT THE ENTIRE SYSTEM, IT IS IMPERATIVE TO
COMPLETELY CLEAN THE A/C SYSTEM TO PREVENT REPEAT FAILURES FROM RESIDUAL
DEBRIS THAT CONTAMINATES THE SYSTEM AFTER THE INITIAL FAILURE. TO PREVENT
REPEAT FAILURES, THE FOLLOWING SERVICE PROCEDURE MUST BE PERFORMED, FOR
ALL SYMPTOMS LISTED IN THIS TSB.
A/C SLOW TO COOL/NOT COOL ENOUGH
1. Measure compressor suction and discharge pressures and compare them with the ranges
shown in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
3. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and inspect
for debris at the bottom of the cartridge below the lip seal before discarding.
4. If there is no debris below the cartridge lip seal and the compressor suction and discharge
pressures are within the shop manual ranges, only replace the desiccant cartridge. Install a new
Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in the kit, and install
condenser into the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Receiver Dryer: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
> Page 8395
5. If debris is found below the cartridge lip seal or the compressor suction/discharge pressure are
not within shop manual ranges, proceed to the Flushing procedure below.
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
FLUSHING SERVICE PROCEDURE With Rotunda A/C Flush And Purge Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass-through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Receiver Dryer: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
> Page 8396
.33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C Flush And Purge - Without Rotunda
Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear lxv if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/O-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
22 oz. - Front A/C
33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Receiver Dryer: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
> Page 8397
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL A/C FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL
SUBSET OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF
THE TWO LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072603 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Receiver Dryer: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Receiver Dryer: Customer Interest A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Receiver Dryer: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8402
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Receiver Dryer: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8403
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Receiver Dryer: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8404
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Receiver Dryer: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures
Receiver Dryer: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High Temperatures
TSB 07-26-3
12/24/07
A/C COMPRESSOR - CUTS OUT HIGH AMBIENT TEMPERATURES/SEIZED - POOR A/C
PERFORMANCE - BUILT BEFORE 11/1/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-25-1 to update the symptoms, Service Procedure and vehicle built
date.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 11/1/2007 may exhibit
symptoms of slow to cool, not cool enough or variations in cooling performance. This may be due
to lack of desiccant cartridge filtering causing system contamination and/or shifting of the desiccant
cartridge in the integrated receiver/drier causing erratic condenser performance.
Additionally, some vehicles may exhibit a loss of A/C compressor operation in ambient
temperatures greater than 110 °F (43 °C) when the vehicle is stationary for longer than 15 minutes,
with the transmission in gear. Placing the vehicle in Park does not resume A/C operation. This may
be due to high A/C head pressures caused by contamination in the system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Follow standard workshop manual diagnostic procedures for customer complaints of A/C slow to
cool, not cool enough. If no issues are identified and on-road evaluations indicate a lack of cooling
performance relative to similar vehicles, use the following.
Proceed directly to the Flushing Service Procedure steps, to correct the condition of A/C
compressor seized or high A/C head pressures.
NOTE
AFTER PERFORMING THE TSB FOR THE A/C SHUT DOWN, DURING HIGH AMBIENT TEMPS
AND EXTENDED IDLE, ADVISE CUSTOMER TO RUN THE A/C IN THE MAX A/C POSITION,
REDUCE BLOWER FAN SPEED FROM THE HIGHEST SETTING, TURN OFF THE AUXILIARY
A/C AND PUT THE VEHICLE'S TRANSMISSION INTO THE PARK GEAR POSITION TO
CONTINUE TO RECEIVE COOL AIR FROM YOUR A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
CHECK THE AIR DEFLECTORS THAT SURROUND THE CONDENSER FOR BEING OUT OF
POSITION OR BEING UNSECURED. THIS MAY ALLOW THE HOT ENGINE COMPARTMENT
AIR TO RECIRCULATE AND CAUSE ADDITIONAL LOAD ON THE A/C SYSTEM.
NOTE
WHEN DEBRIS IS PRESENT THROUGHOUT THE ENTIRE SYSTEM, IT IS IMPERATIVE TO
COMPLETELY CLEAN THE A/C SYSTEM TO PREVENT REPEAT FAILURES FROM RESIDUAL
DEBRIS THAT CONTAMINATES THE SYSTEM AFTER THE INITIAL FAILURE. TO PREVENT
REPEAT FAILURES, THE FOLLOWING SERVICE PROCEDURE MUST BE PERFORMED, FOR
ALL SYMPTOMS LISTED IN THIS TSB.
A/C SLOW TO COOL/NOT COOL ENOUGH
1. Measure compressor suction and discharge pressures and compare them with the ranges
shown in Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00.
2. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
3. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and inspect
for debris at the bottom of the cartridge below the lip seal before discarding.
4. If there is no debris below the cartridge lip seal and the compressor suction and discharge
pressures are within the shop manual ranges, only replace the desiccant cartridge. Install a new
Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in the kit, and install
condenser into the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Receiver Dryer: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures > Page 8410
5. If debris is found below the cartridge lip seal or the compressor suction/discharge pressure are
not within shop manual ranges, proceed to the Flushing procedure below.
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
FLUSHING SERVICE PROCEDURE With Rotunda A/C Flush And Purge Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00: Climate
Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass-through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Receiver Dryer: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures > Page 8411
.33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C Flush And Purge - Without Rotunda
Machine:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear lxv if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/O-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
22 oz. - Front A/C
33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Receiver Dryer: > 07-26-3 > Dec > 07 > A/C - Compressor Cuts Out in High
Temperatures > Page 8412
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL A/C FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL
SUBSET OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF
THE TWO LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT072603 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Receiver Dryer: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Receiver Dryer: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Receiver Dryer: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8417
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Receiver Dryer: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8418
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Receiver Dryer: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8419
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 8420
Receiver Dryer: Description and Operation
RECEIVER/DRIER
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of system contamination from a failed
A/C compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
The receiver/drier is integral to the A/C condenser/power steering combo cooler. It stores
high-pressure liquid after it leaves the condenser core. An A/C desiccant cartridge mounted inside
the receiver/drier removes any retained moisture from the refrigerant. The receiver/drier cartridge is
a separate component and can be removed and installed separately from the A/C
condenser/power steering combo cooler.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Receiver Dryer > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 8421
Receiver Dryer: Service and Repair
RECEIVER DRIER
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Installation of a new receiver/drier cartridge is not required when repairing the air
conditioning system except when there is physical evidence of contamination from a failed A/C
compressor or damage to the receiver/drier cartridge.
1. Remove the condenser core. 2. Unscrew and remove the plastic receiver/drier cap.
3. Remove the receiver/drier plug.
1 Push the receiver/drier plug upwards and remove the snap ring.
2 Install the bolt included with the receiver/drier cartridge service kit in the center of the receiver
drier plug and remove the plug.
4. Using a suitable tool, grasp the receiver/drier cartridge grab handle and remove the
receiver/drier cartridge. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Lubricate the receiver/drier plug O-ring seals using residual refrigerant oil from inside the
receiver/drier.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 8426
Refrigerant: Fluid Type Specifications
REFRIGERANT TYPE
R134a Refrigerant Ford P/N ................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. YN-19 Ford Specification ..................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. WSH-M17B19-A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Specifications > Page
8427
Refrigerant: Description and Operation
REFRIGERANT SYSTEM DYE
Fluorescent refrigerant system dye is added to the refrigerant system at the factory to assist in
refrigerant system leak diagnosis using a Rotunda-approved ultraviolet blacklight. It is not
necessary to add additional dye to the refrigerant system before diagnosing leaks, even if a
significant amount of refrigerant has been removed from the system. Additional refrigerant system
dye should only be added if more than 50% of the refrigerant system lubricant capacity has been
lost due to a fitting separation, hose rupture or other damage. Refer to Heating and Air
Conditioning.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Refrigerant Filter: Customer Interest A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8436
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8437
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 8438
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Refrigerant Filter: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8444
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8445
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Filter > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant Filter: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page
8446
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 8451
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL TYPE
(R-134a Systems) PAG Refrigerant Compressor Oil Ford P/N ...........................................................
..................................................................................................................................................
YN-12-D Ford Specification .................................................................................................................
................................................................. WSH-M1C231-B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8455
C1260
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation A/C Pressure Transducer
A/C PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
The A/C pressure transducer communicates the compressor discharge pressure to the PCM. The
PCM will interrupt A/C compressor operation in the event that the A/C pressure transducer
indicates excessively high system discharge pressures. It is also used to sense low charge
conditions. If the pressure is below a predetermined value for a given ambient temperature, the
PCM will not allow the clutch to engage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 8458
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling
Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CYCLING SWITCH
The A/C cycling switch may be wired to either the ACCS or ACPSW PCM input. When the A/C
cycling switch opens, the PCM turns off the A/C clutch. For information on the specific function of
the A/C cycling switch, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning, Climate Control System. Also, refer to
the applicable Vehicle/Diagrams for vehicle specific wiring.
If the ACCS signal is not received by the PCM, the PCM circuit will not allow the A/C to operate.
Some applications do not have a dedicated (separate) input to the PCM indicating that A/C is
requested. This information is received by the PCM through the communication link.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 8459
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) High
Pressure Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH
The A/C high pressure switch is used for additional A/C system pressure control. The A/C high
pressure switch is either dual function for multiple speed, relay controlled electric fan applications,
or single function for all others.
For refrigerant containment control, the normally closed high pressure contacts open at a
predetermined A/C pressure. This results in the A/C turning off, preventing the A/C pressure from
rising to a level that would open the A/C high pressure relief valve.
For fan control, the normally open medium pressure contacts close at a predetermined A/C
pressure. This grounds the ACPSW circuit input to the PCM. The PCM then turns on the high
speed fan to help reduce the pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 8460
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP)
Transducer Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING PRESSURE (ACP) TRANSDUCER SENSOR
A/C Pressure Transducer Sensor Output Voltage
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
The ACP transducer sensor is located in the high pressure (discharge) side of the A/C system. The
ACP transducer sensor provides a voltage signal to the PCM that is proportional to the A/C
pressure. The PCM uses this information for A/C clutch control, fan control and idle speed control.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8466
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8467
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8468
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Front Blower Motor Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8471
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8472
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8473
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8474
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8476
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8477
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8478
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8479
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection Rear Blower Motor Relay 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8480
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Front Blower Motor Relay > Page 8481
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8485
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH RELAY (A/CCR)
NOTE: The PCM PIDs WAC and wide open throttle air conditioning cutoff fault (WACF) are used to
monitor the A/CCR output.
The A/CCR is wired normally open. There is no direct electrical connection between the A/C switch
or electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module and the A/C clutch. The PCM receives
a signal indicating that A/C is requested. For some applications, this message is sent through the
communications network. When A/C is requested, the PCM checks other A/C related inputs that
are available, such as A/C pressure switch and A/C cycling switch. If these inputs indicate A/C
operation is OK, and the engine conditions are OK (coolant temperature, engine RPM, throttle
position), the PCM grounds the A/CCR output, closing the relay contacts and sending voltage to
the A/CCR.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8486
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8487
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8488
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 8493
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module
C228A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 8496
C228B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 8497
Control Module HVAC: Diagrams Manual Climate Control Module
C2357A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 8498
C2357B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Control Module HVAC >
Component Information > Diagrams > Electronic Automatic Temperature Control (EATC) Module > Page 8499
C2357C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 8504
C132
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 8505
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
AMBIENT AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the upper radiator sight shield. 2. Detach and disconnect the ambient temperature
sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove the ambient air temperature sensor. 4. To install, reverse
the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Blower Motor Switch: Description and Operation
BLOWER MOTOR SWITCH
The blower motor switch controls blower motor speed by adding or bypassing resistors in the
blower motor resistor in all function selector positions except OFF. The blower motor switch is
mounted to the climate control assembly and can be separately installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8509
Blower Motor Switch: Service and Repair
BLOWER MOTOR SPEED CONTROL
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH lower instrument panel insulator (if equipped). 2. Disconnect the blower motor
speed control electrical connector. 3. Remove the 2 blower motor speed control screws. 4. Remove
the blower motor speed control. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
C233
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor > Page 8515
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity Sensor
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity
Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE AND HUMIDITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 3 lower steering column cover screws and the lower steering column cover.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. Remove the 4 steering column reinforcement bolts and position the steering column
reinforcement aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Remove the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor.
1 Detach the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor from the instrument panel finish panel.
2 Disconnect the aspirator hose.
3 Disconnect the in-vehicle temperature and humidity sensor electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Cabin Temperature Sensor /
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > In-Vehicle Temperature and Humidity Sensor > Page 8518
Cabin Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair In-Vehicle Temperature Sensor
IN-VEHICLE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Remove the in-vehicle temperature sensor. 3. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Locations
View 151-46 (Climate Control System - Manual A/C)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8522
View 151-47 (Climate Control System - EATC)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 8523
C2323
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Discharge Air Temperature Sensor
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Evaporator Discharge Air
Temperature Sensor
EVAPORATOR DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
The evaporator discharge air temperature sensor communicates the evaporator discharge air
temperature to the electronic manual temperature control (EMTC) module (if equipped) or
electronic automatic temperature control (EATC) module (if equipped).
The PCM maintains evaporator core temperature and prevents icing of the evaporator core, by
disengaging the A/C compressor clutch when the evaporator discharge air temperature sensor
reading falls below acceptable levels, and by engaging the A/C compressor clutch when the
discharge air temperature rises above acceptable levels.
The evaporator discharge air temperature sensor is located on the heater core and evaporator core
housing in the air-stream leaving the evaporator core.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Evaporator Discharge Air Temperature Sensor >
Page 8526
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Evaporator
Temperature (ACET) Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE (ACET) SENSOR
A/C Evaporator Temperature (ACET) Sensor Voltage And Resistance
The ACET sensor measures the evaporator air discharge temperature. The ACET sensor is a
thermistor device in which resistance changes with temperature. The electrical resistance of a
thermistor decreases as the temperature increases, and the resistance increases as the
temperature decreases. The PCM sources a low current 5 volts on the ACET circuit. With SIG RTN
also connected to the ACET sensor, the varying resistance changes the voltage drop across the
sensor terminals. As A/C evaporator air temperature changes, the varying resistance of the ACET
sensor changes the voltage the PCM detects.
The ACET sensor is used to more accurately control A/C clutch cycling, improve defrost/demist
performance, and reduce A/C clutch cycling.
NOTE: These values can vary 15% due to sensor and VREF variations. Voltage values were
calculated for VREF equals 5.0 volts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Evaporator Temperature
Sensor / Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8527
Evaporator Temperature Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) EVAPORATOR DISCHARGE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Detach the glove compartment dampener and lower the glove compartment. 2. Disconnect the
evaporator discharge air temperature sensor electrical connector. 3. Carefully pry the evaporator
discharge air temperature sensor probe out of the heater core and evaporator core housing. 4. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Humidity Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams
C2247
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 8534
C1260
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation A/C Pressure Transducer
A/C PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
The A/C pressure transducer communicates the compressor discharge pressure to the PCM. The
PCM will interrupt A/C compressor operation in the event that the A/C pressure transducer
indicates excessively high system discharge pressures. It is also used to sense low charge
conditions. If the pressure is below a predetermined value for a given ambient temperature, the
PCM will not allow the clutch to engage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 8537
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) Cycling
Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CYCLING SWITCH
The A/C cycling switch may be wired to either the ACCS or ACPSW PCM input. When the A/C
cycling switch opens, the PCM turns off the A/C clutch. For information on the specific function of
the A/C cycling switch, refer to Heating and Air Conditioning, Climate Control System. Also, refer to
the applicable Vehicle/Diagrams for vehicle specific wiring.
If the ACCS signal is not received by the PCM, the PCM circuit will not allow the A/C to operate.
Some applications do not have a dedicated (separate) input to the PCM indicating that A/C is
requested. This information is received by the PCM through the communication link.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 8538
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning (A/C) High
Pressure Switch
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) HIGH PRESSURE SWITCH
The A/C high pressure switch is used for additional A/C system pressure control. The A/C high
pressure switch is either dual function for multiple speed, relay controlled electric fan applications,
or single function for all others.
For refrigerant containment control, the normally closed high pressure contacts open at a
predetermined A/C pressure. This results in the A/C turning off, preventing the A/C pressure from
rising to a level that would open the A/C high pressure relief valve.
For fan control, the normally open medium pressure contacts close at a predetermined A/C
pressure. This grounds the ACPSW circuit input to the PCM. The PCM then turns on the high
speed fan to help reduce the pressure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Description and Operation > A/C Pressure Transducer > Page 8539
Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation Air Conditioning Pressure (ACP)
Transducer Sensor
AIR CONDITIONING PRESSURE (ACP) TRANSDUCER SENSOR
A/C Pressure Transducer Sensor Output Voltage
Typical ACP Transducer Sensor
The ACP transducer sensor is located in the high pressure (discharge) side of the A/C system. The
ACP transducer sensor provides a voltage signal to the PCM that is proportional to the A/C
pressure. The PCM uses this information for A/C clutch control, fan control and idle speed control.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Solar Sensor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8543
Solar Sensor: Diagrams
C286
C2360
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Service Port HVAC > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Service Port HVAC: Description and Operation
SERVICE GAUGE PORT VALVES
The high-pressure service gauge port valve is located on the high-pressure side of the TXV
manifold and tube at the RH rear of the engine compartment.
The low-pressure service gauge port valve is located on the low-pressure side of the TXV manifold
and tube at the RH rear of the engine compartment.
The fitting is an integral part of the refrigeration line or component.
- Special couplings are required for both the high-side and low-side service gauge ports.
- A very small amount of leakage will always be detectable around the Schrader-type valve, with
the service gauge port valve cap removed, and is considered normal. A new Schrader-type valve
core can be installed if the seal leaks excessively.
- The service gauge port valve caps are used as primary seals in the refrigerant system to prevent
leakage through the Schrader-type valves from reaching the atmosphere. Always install and tighten
the A/C service gauge port valve caps to the correct torque after they are removed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Solar Sensor, HVAC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 8550
Solar Sensor: Diagrams
C286
C2360
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Wiring Harness HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness HVAC: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat Function
Inoperative
Wiring Harness HVAC: Customer Interest A/C - Climate Seat Function Inoperative
TSB 08-23-11
11/24/08
INOPERATIVE OR NO COMMUNICATION WITH DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
(DCSM)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr
2007-2008 MKZ, MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
may exhibit inoperative climate seat function with no communication to the DCSM due to a ground
concern.
ACTION Follow service procedure to correct concern.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE ONLY APPLIES IF DAMAGE HAS BEEN IDENTIFIED AT THE SPECIFIC
CONNECTOR AND PIN. IF DAMAGE IS NOT VISIBLE AT THE SPECIFIC CONNECTOR AND
PIN, THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY AND CONTINUE WITH NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS IN
THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL.
Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-10 to gain access to the DCSM connector. Seat
removal may be required.
Zephyr-MKZ:
If Connector C3305A is damaged at Pin M GD139 (BK-YE), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
Expedition-Navigator:
If Connector C3265A is damaged at Pin M GD138 (BK-WH), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Wiring Harness HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness HVAC: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat Function
Inoperative > Page 8559
position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
MKX:
If Connector C3036A is damaged at Pin M GD145 (BK-WH), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
NOTE
IF PIN M IS DAMAGED ON THE MODULE THE DCSM MAY NEED TO BE REPLACED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082311A 2007-2008 MKX: Replace 1.5 Hrs.
Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With 63100A, 12650D)
082311A 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 1.4 Hrs.
MKZ: Replace Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With 63100A,
12650D)
082311A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With
63100A, 12650D)
082311B 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 1.6 Hrs.
MKX And MKZ: Replace Connector And DCSM, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do
Not Use With 63100A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Wiring Harness HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiring Harness HVAC: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat Function
Inoperative > Page 8560
12650D)
082311B 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.5 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Connector And DCSM, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not
Use With 63100A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14S411 X1
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Wiring Harness HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness HVAC: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat
Function Inoperative
Wiring Harness HVAC: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Climate Seat Function Inoperative
TSB 08-23-11
11/24/08
INOPERATIVE OR NO COMMUNICATION WITH DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
(DCSM)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr
2007-2008 MKZ, MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
may exhibit inoperative climate seat function with no communication to the DCSM due to a ground
concern.
ACTION Follow service procedure to correct concern.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE ONLY APPLIES IF DAMAGE HAS BEEN IDENTIFIED AT THE SPECIFIC
CONNECTOR AND PIN. IF DAMAGE IS NOT VISIBLE AT THE SPECIFIC CONNECTOR AND
PIN, THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY AND CONTINUE WITH NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS IN
THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL.
Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-10 to gain access to the DCSM connector. Seat
removal may be required.
Zephyr-MKZ:
If Connector C3305A is damaged at Pin M GD139 (BK-YE), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
Expedition-Navigator:
If Connector C3265A is damaged at Pin M GD138 (BK-WH), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Wiring Harness HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness HVAC: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat
Function Inoperative > Page 8566
position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
MKX:
If Connector C3036A is damaged at Pin M GD145 (BK-WH), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
NOTE
IF PIN M IS DAMAGED ON THE MODULE THE DCSM MAY NEED TO BE REPLACED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082311A 2007-2008 MKX: Replace 1.5 Hrs.
Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With 63100A, 12650D)
082311A 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 1.4 Hrs.
MKZ: Replace Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With 63100A,
12650D)
082311A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With
63100A, 12650D)
082311B 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 1.6 Hrs.
MKX And MKZ: Replace Connector And DCSM, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do
Not Use With 63100A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Wiring Harness HVAC > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness HVAC: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat
Function Inoperative > Page 8567
12650D)
082311B 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.5 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Connector And DCSM, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not
Use With 63100A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14S411 X1
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Inspection and Repair After
A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
Inspection and Repair After a Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment
WARNING: Remove restraint system diagnostic tools from the vehicle prior to road testing. If tools
are not removed, the supplemental restraint system (SRS) device may not deploy in a crash.
Failure to follow this instruction may result in serious personal injury or death in a crash and
possibly violate vehicle safety standards.
NOTE: After diagnosing or repairing a supplemental restraint system (SRS), the restraint system
diagnostic tools (if required) must be removed before operating the vehicle over the road.
NOTE: Deployable devices (such as air bag modules, pretensioners) may deploy alone or in
various combinations depending on the impact event.
NOTE: Always refer to the appropriate workshop manual procedures prior to carrying out vehicle
repairs affecting the SRS and safety belt system.
NOTE: The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the
customer.
All vehicles
1. NOTE: Refer to the correct removal and installation procedure for all SRS components being
installed.
When any deployable device or combination of devices are deployed and/or the restraints control
module (RCM) has the DTC B1231 (Event Threshold Exceeded) in memory, the repair of the
vehicle's SRS is to include the removal of all deployed devices and the installation of new
deployable devices, the removal and installation of new impact sensors, and the removal and
installation of a new RCM. DTCs must cleared from all required modules after repairs are carried
out.
Vehicles with occupant classification sensor (OCS) system
2. NOTE: After installation of new occupant classification sensor (OCS) system components carry
out the OCS System Reset procedure as
instructed in the workshop manual. Refer to the appropriate workshop manual for OCS system
removal and installation procedure.
When a vehicle has been involved in a collision and the occupant classification system module
(OCSM) has DTC B1231 stored in memory, the repair of the OCS system is to include the following
procedures for the specified system:
- For rail type OCS system, inspect the passenger side floorpan for damage and repair as
necessary. Install new OCS system rails.
- For weight sensor bolt type OCS system, inspect the passenger side floorpan for damage and
repair as necessary. Install a new seat track with OCS system weight sensor bolts. DTC must be
cleared from the OCSM before carrying out Occupant Classification Sensor (OCS) System Reset.
Do not install a new OCSM unless DTC B1231 cannot be cleared.
- NOTE: Most bladder type OCSM do not store a DTC B1231 in memory after deployment. The
DTC B1231 is stored only by the RCM.
For bladder type OCS system, inspect for damage and repair as necessary. If installation of an
OCS system component is required, an OCS system service kit must be installed.
All vehicles
3. When any damage to the impact sensor mounting points or mounting hardware has occurred,
repair or install new mounting points and mounting
hardware as needed.
4. When the driver air bag module has deployed, a new clockspring must be installed.
5. New driver and/or front passenger safety belt systems (including retractors, buckles and height
adjusters) must be installed if the vehicle is
involved in a collision that results in deployment of the driver and/or front passenger safety belt
pretensioners. For additional information, refer to Safety Belt System.
6. Inspect the entire vehicle for damage, including the following components:
Steering column (deployable column if equipped) Instrument panel knee bolsters and mounting
points Instrument panel braces and brackets Instrument panel and mounting points Seats and seat
mounting points Safety belts, safety belt buckles and safety belt retractors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment > Page 8573
SRS wiring, wiring harnesses and connectors
7. After carrying out the review and inspection of the entire vehicle for damage, repair or install new
components as needed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision > System Information >
Service and Repair > Inspection and Repair After A Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Deployment > Page 8574
Repairs and Inspections Required After a Collision: Service and Repair Safety Belt Procedure After
A Collision
SAFETY BELT PROCEDURE AFTER A COLLISION
1. WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if
equipped, buckles, shoulder belt height
adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching hardware) should be
inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed unless a qualified
technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt assemblies not in use
during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if either damage or
incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase the risk of injury in
collisions.
NOTE: Safety belt assemblies should be periodically inspected to make sure they have not
become damaged and that they remain in correct operating condition, particularly if they have been
subjected to severe stress.
Before installing the new safety belt assembly, the safety belt attaching areas must be inspected
for damage and distortion. If the attaching points are damaged and distorted, the sheet metal must
be reworked back to its original shape and structural integrity.
Install the new safety belt(s) using the appropriate instructions. Carry out the Functional Test. See:
Seat Belt Systems/Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module.Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped). Failure to
follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable (14301) and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all supplemental restraint system (SRS) components are connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install restraints control module (RCM) fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8580
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off.If an air bag SRS fault
is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8581
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body.This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down.This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin.Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module.Doing so can result in safety canopy
deployment, which can result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device.Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner.Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector.Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON.This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and
the restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors are located in the first row doors, behind the door trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8582
auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).Failure to follow these instructions may
increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position. 8. Center the tilt steering column.
9. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock
position).
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws and pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
11. Remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
All vehicles 12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws. 13. Release the clips and
remove the steering column upper shroud. 14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8583
15. CAUTION: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each
of the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel.Failure to do so will damage the driver
air bag module and steering wheel.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity.The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
- Use a mirror to look at the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
- Note the position of the 2 driver air bag module locator pins to the steering wheel for installation.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
16. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors, then disconnect the horn switch
electrical connector and remove the driver air bag
module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight ahead position (the 12
o'clock position). 18. Open and lower the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8584
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat.The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector.
21. Release the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
22. Remove the bolt and the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8585
23. Remove the cover and the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8586
27. Remove the bolt and the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
28. Remove the cover and the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8587
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat.The driver seat side air bag module
electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SPDJB. 33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8588
5. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8589
9. Connect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
10. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8590
13. Attach the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector. 16. Close the glove compartment
door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag
module.Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module.Do not force
the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the horn switch electrical connector, then connect the 2 driver air bag module electrical
connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8591
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE:
- Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated correctly to the
steering wheel.
- Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks. -
Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud. 22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
23. Install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. Install the lower steering column opening cover and the 3 screws.
All vehicles 25. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 26. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and install the cover.
27. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
28. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System Information
> Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8592
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position.This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps.If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module
View 151-17 (Steering Wheel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 8597
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 8598
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Locations > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 8599
View 151-12 (Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module
Air Bag: Diagrams Driver Air Bag Module
C216A
C216B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 8602
C256
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 8603
C9006
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 8604
C9007
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 8605
Air Bag: Diagrams
C216A
C216B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 8606
C256
C9006
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 8607
C9007
C3226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver
Air Bag Module > Page 8608
C3227
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
8609
Air Bag: Description and Operation
Driver Air Bag Module
The driver air bag module: is installed new as an assembly.
- is mounted in the center of the steering wheel.
- cannot be interchanged between Expedition and Navigator vehicles.
Passenger Air Bag Module
The passenger air bag module: is installed new as an assembly.
- is mounted in the passenger side of the instrument panel.
- cannot be interchanged between Expedition and Navigator vehicles.
Safety Canopy Module
Vehicles are equipped with safety canopies for protection during side impacts or rollover.
Vehicles with safety canopies require a specific headliner. When installing a new headliner on a
vehicle equipped with safety canopies, make sure a headliner for safety canopies is being used.
The word AIRBAG will appear on the headliner where it meets each B-pillar trim panel.
The safety canopy module: is installed as an assembly.
- is mounted above the headliner.
- attaches from the A-pillar frame to the D-pillar frame.
- is standard equipment.
- cannot be interchanged from side to side.
- is used in conjunction with side air bag module.
Loops/Squib
All deployable devices contain an initiating device called a squib. The squib is part of the
deployment loop. Air bag/safety canopy modules can contain more than one squib, some vehicles
may have up to 4 squibs in one air bag module. Squibs are often referred to as loops during the
diagnostic process.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module
Air Bag: Service and Repair Driver Air Bag Module
DRIVER AIR BAG MODULE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body.This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8612
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down.This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin.Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module.Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each of
the 3 steering wheel hooks before removing the driver air bag module from the steering
wheel.Failure to do so will damage the driver air bag module and steering wheel.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON.This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only.If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All vehicles
1. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position. 2. Center the tilt steering column.
3. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock
position). 4. Depower the system.
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
5. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws and pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8613
6. Remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
All vehicles
7. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws. 8. Release the clips and remove the
steering column upper shroud. 9. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
10. CAUTION: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each
of the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel.Failure to do so will damage the driver
air bag module and steering wheel.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity.The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
- Use a mirror to look at the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
- Note the position of the 2 driver air bag module locator pins to the steering wheel for installation.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
11. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors, then disconnect the horn switch
electrical connector and remove the driver air bag
module.
12. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight ahead position (the 12'o
clock position).
Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8614
All vehicles
1. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag
module.Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module.Do not force
the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the horn switch electrical connector, then connect the 2 driver air bag module electrical
connectors.
2. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel lining up the locator pins.
3. NOTE:
- Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated correctly to the
steering wheel.
- Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks. Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
4. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch.
5. Install the steering column upper shroud. 6. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel 7. Install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
8. Install the lower steering column opening cover and the 3 screws.
All vehicles 9. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8615
Air Bag: Service and Repair Passenger Air Bag Module
PASSENGER AIR BAG MODULE
Expedition Passenger Air Bag
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8616
Navigator Passenger Air Bag
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and deployment door pointed away from your
body.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the deployment door face down.This will reduce the
risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin.Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module.Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8617
- Air bag modules with discolored or damaged deployment doors must be replaced, not repainted.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON.This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only.If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All vehicles
1. Depower the system. 2. Open and lower the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
3. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
Expedition vehicles
4. Remove the 4 passenger air bag module deployment door screws.
All vehicles
5. Remove the 4 passenger air bag module bolts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. CAUTION: Do not handle the passenger air bag module by grabbing the edges of the
deployment door.
Reaching one hand into the glove box opening, push out on the bottom of the passenger air bag
module deployment door releasing the bottom clips.Then remove the passenger air bag module
from the instrument panel.
7. NOTE: During passenger air bag module installation, make sure all the deployment door clips
are fully seated into the instrument panel.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8618
Air Bag: Service and Repair Safety Canopy Module
SAFETY CANOPY MODULE
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8619
Part 2
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury from an accidental deployment, always carry or place a live
safety canopy module with the safety canopy and tear seam pointed away from your body. Failure
to do so can result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- After deployment, the surface of the safety canopy can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a
product of the gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap
and water afterwards.
- Never probe the connector on the safety canopy module. Doing so can result in safety canopy
deployment which can result in personal injury.
- Anytime the safety canopy has deployed, the headliner, and all A, B, C, and D-pillar upper trim
panels and attaching hardware must be replaced along with any other damaged components and
hardware. Failure to do so can result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy deployment.
- Vehicles equipped with safety canopy modules require a specific headliner. When installing a new
headliner on a vehicle equipped with safety canopy modules, make sure a headliner for safety
canopy modules is being used. The word AIRBAG will appear on the headliner where it meets
each B-pillar trim panel. Failure to do so can result in personal injury in the event of a safety
canopy module deployment.
- Before installing the safety canopy module, inspect the roofline for any damage. If necessary, the
sheet metal must be reworked to its original condition and structural integrity. All damaged
fasteners must be replaced and any foreign objects removed. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury in the event of a safety canopy deployment.
- Inspect the safety canopy before installation. If the safety canopy is damaged or the cover has
separated or safety canopy material has been exposed, a new safety canopy module must be
installed. Do not attempt to repair the safety canopy module. Failure to follow these instructions can
result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of injury, do not obstruct or place objects in the deployment path of the safety
canopy module. Failure to follow these instructions can result in personal injury in the event of a
safety canopy module deployment.
- Never put any type of fastener or tie strap around any part of the safety canopy module or interior
trim panel. This will prevent the safety canopy module from deploying correctly. Failure to do so
can result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and perform the diagnostic procedure again.
- The passenger side safety canopy module is shown, driver side similar.
All vehicles 1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the headliner.
Vehicles with a moon roof
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8620
3. Disconnect the moon roof rear drain hose and release the drain hose retainer from the coat hook
bracket.
All vehicles 4. Disconnect the safety canopy module electrical connector.
5. NOTE: Note the locator tab on the front tether anchor bracket to the A-pillar sheetmetal for
installation.
Remove the front tether cord bolt and bracket from the A-pillar.
6. Remove the 2 front tether cord pin-type retainers from the A-pillar sheetmetal. 7. Remove the 2
safety canopy module front bolts and the one B-pillar bracket bolt.
Expedition/Navigator vehicles 8. Detach the safety canopy module rear tether cord routing clip
pin-type retainer from the sheetmetal.
9. NOTE: Note the locator tab on the rear tether cord anchor bracket to the D-pillar sheetmetal for
installation.
Remove the bolt and the safety canopy module rear tether cord anchor bracket from the D-pillar.
Expedition EL/Navigator L vehicles
10. Detach the 3 safety canopy module rear tether cord routing clip pin-type retainers from the
sheetmetal.
11. NOTE: Note the locator tab on the rear tether cord anchor bracket to the D-pillar sheetmetal for
installation.
Remove the bolt and the safety canopy module rear tether cord anchor bracket from the D-pillar.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8621
All vehicles 12. Remove the C-pillar safety canopy module bolt. 13. Remove the 2 safety canopy
module rear bolts and the one roof bracket bolt.
14. Gently lift the safety canopy module up and inward at the B-pillar to release the bracket hook
from the sheetmetal.
15. Move the safety canopy module forward to release the rear bracket hook from the sheetmetal
and remove the safety canopy module.
Installation
All vehicles
1. WARNING :
- Before installing the safety canopy module, inspect the roofline for any damage. If necessary, the
sheet metal must be reworked to its original condition and structural integrity. All damaged
fasteners must be replaced and any foreign objects removed. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
- Before installing the safety canopy module, if the module is damaged or the cover has separated
or the safety canopy material has been exposed, install a new safety canopy module. Do not
attempt to repair the safety canopy. Failure to follow these instructions could result in personal
injury in the event of a safety canopy deployment.
- Never put any type of fastener or tie strap around any part of the safety canopy module or interior
trim panel. This will prevent the safety canopy module from deploying correctly. Failure to do so
can result in personal injury in the event of a safety canopy module deployment.
Position safety canopy module by moving it rearward installing the rear bracket hook in the
sheetmetal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8622
2. Install the safety canopy module B-pillar bracket hook in the sheetmetal. 3. Install the safety
canopy module B-pillar bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
4. Install the safety canopy module roof bracket bolt.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. Install the 2 safety canopy module rear bolts.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Install the C-pillar safety canopy module bolt.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
Expedition EL/Navigator L vehicles
7. Install the safety canopy module rear tether cord anchor bracket and bolt to the D-pillar.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
8. Attach the 3 safety canopy module rear tether cord routing clip pin-type retainers to the
sheetmetal.
Expedition/Navigator vehicles 9. Install the safety canopy module rear tether cord anchor bracket
and bolt to the D-pillar.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
10. Attach the safety canopy module rear tether cord routing clip pin-type retainer to the
sheetmetal.
All vehicles 11. Install the 2 safety canopy module front bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Driver Air Bag Module > Page 8623
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
12. Install the 2 front tether cord pin-type retainers to the A-pillar sheetmetal. 13. Install the front
tether cord bracket and bolt to the A-pillar.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
14. Connect the safety canopy module electrical connector.
Vehicles with a moonroof
15. Connect the moon roof rear drain hose and attach the drain hose retainer to the coat hook
bracket.
All vehicles 16. Install the headliner. 17. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-22 (RH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8627
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8628
C310B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8629
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
WARNING:
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON.Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation.If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation.If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have
deployed.In addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original
condition.Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a
crash.
CAUTION: Prior to removal of the RCM module, it is necessary to upload module configuration
information to the scan tool.This information needs to be downloaded into the new RCM module
once installed.Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network).
NOTE:
- When a new PCM is installed, the air bag warning indicator will illuminate when the ignition switch
is ON.The warning indicator will remain on until PCM configuration is restored.Clear RCM DTCs.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM is
being installed.RCMs are not interchangeable between vehicles or vehicle lines.If an incorrect
RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs and incorrect diagnosis will result.
The restraints control module (RCM) carries out the following functions:
- deploys the air bag(s) in the event of a deployable crash.
- activates the safety belt buckle pretensioners to remove slack from the safety belt.
- monitors the SRS for faults.
- illuminates the air bag warning indicator if a fault is detected.
- communicates through the data link connector (DLC) the current or historical diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs).
The RCM monitors the SRS for possible faults.If a fault is detected while the ignition switch is in the
ON position, the RCM will request illumination of the air bag warning indicator located in the
instrument cluster.
When the ignition switch is cycled (turned OFF and then ON), the air bag warning indicator will
prove out by lighting for 6 seconds and then turn off.If a SRS fault exists, the air bag warning
indicator will illuminate and remain illuminated for the rest of the key cycle.The RCM will also
communicate the on-demand (current) and continuous (historical) DTCs through the DLC, to the
scan tool.If the RCM requests illumination of the air bag warning indicator and the air bag warning
indicator does not function, the instrument cluster module will automatically activate an audible
chime.The chime is a series of 5 sets of 5 tone bursts.If the chime is heard, the SRS and the air
bag warning indicator require repair.
The RCM includes a backup power supply.This feature provides sufficient backup power to deploy
the air bags in the event that the ignition circuit is lost or damaged during impact.The backup power
supply will deplete its stored energy approximately one minute after the battery ground cable is
disconnected.
A new RCM installed in a vehicle will flash lamp fault code (LFC) 54 until programmable module
installation (PMI) has been carried out on the RCM.If a LFC is present after completing PMI, a fault
is present in the SRS and on-demand DTCs must be retrieved and diagnosed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8630
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The RCM orientation is critical for proper air bag SRS operation. If a vehicle equipped with an
SRS system has been involved in a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8631
collision in which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have deployed.
In addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
can result.
- When installing a new RCM, it is necessary to carry out programmable module installation (PMI).
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- When installing a new RCM, always make sure the correct RCM is being installed. If an incorrect
RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All vehicles 1. If installing a new restraints control module (RCM), carry out the steps necessary to
prepare for programmable module installation (PMI). 2. Depower the system.
Vehicles with a center console 3. Remove the center console.
Vehicles with bucket seats and no center console 4. Remove the 3 RCM push-nut retainers and
the RCM cover.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
1 Push down to release the retaining tab.
2 While releasing the retaining tab, pull out and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
6. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1 Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever away from the RCM,
disengaging the lever.
2 Pull out and disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
7. Remove the 3 bolts and RCM.
Installation
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8632
1. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag RCM retaining bolts is critical for correct system
operation.
Install the RCM and 3 bolts. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
2. Make sure the connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before attempting
to connect the connector.
3. CAUTION: Putting the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM on an angle can cause bad
electrical connections and damage
components.
Position the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM.
- CAUTION: Do not push the connector on to where the lever pivots and seats itself. Light pressure
is needed to get the connector into position on the RCM before using the lever to fully seat the
connector.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8633
4. Connect the RCM electrical connector.
- Pivot the connector position assurance lever toward the RCM, drawing the connector in to the
RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with bucket seats and no center console 6. Install the 3 RCM push-nut retainers and the
RCM cover.
Vehicles with a center console 7. Install the center console.
All vehicles 8. Repower the SRS. Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 9. When installing a new
RCM, carry out the steps necessary to complete programmable module installation (PMI).
10. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8634
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous memory diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Diagrams
C218A
C218B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8638
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Description and Operation
CLOCKSPRING
The clockspring:
- is mounted on the steering column, behind the steering wheel.
- allows for continuous electrical connections between the driver air bag module and the restraints
control module (RCM) when the steering wheel is turned.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8639
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service and Repair
CLOCKSPRING
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Center the tilt steering column. 2. Depower the system. 3. Remove the driver air bag module.
4. NOTE: Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
Remove the steering wheel.
5. Disconnect the clockspring electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and remove the
clockspring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8640
Installation
All vehicles 1. Install the clockspring and the 2 screws. 2. Connect the clockspring electrical
connector.
Vehicles installing a new clockspring
3. Install the steering wheel.
- After the steering wheel installation, remove the clockspring sealing key.
Vehicle repairs reusing the same clockspring
4. WARNING: Incorrect centralization may result in premature component failure. If in doubt when
centralizing the clockspring, repeat
the centralizing procedure. Failure to follow this instruction may result in personal injury.
CAUTION: Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position.
If the vehicle's clockspring has rotated out of center, follow these steps to center the clockspring. 1
Hold the clockspring outer housing stationary.
2 CAUTION: Overturning will destroy the clockspring. The internal ribbon wire acts as the stop and
can be broken from its internal connection.
While turning the rotor counterclockwise, carefully feel for the ribbon wire to run out of length and
for a slight resistance. Stop turning at this
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8641
point.
3 Turn the clockspring clockwise (approximately 2 turns) until the clockspring rotor wiring and
connector are in the 12 o'clock position. clockspring is now centered. Do not allow the rotor to turn from this position.
5. CAUTION: If the vehicle is left unattended by the technician between centralizing the clockspring
and installing the steering wheel, the
centralizing procedure must be repeated.
Install the steering wheel.
All vehicles 6. Install the driver air bag module. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8646
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8647
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8648
Impact Sensor: Locations Safety Canopy Sensor, Driver 2
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8649
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8650
Impact Sensor: Locations Safety Canopy Sensor, Passenger 2
View 151-26 (Right Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8651
View 151-30 (Right Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Severity Sensor
C177
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8654
C539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8655
C631
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8656
C3314
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8657
C3315
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 8658
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation
SENSORS
WARNING:
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have deployed.
In addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition. Failure to
follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install a new and correctly position the sensor or any
other damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is
deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a
crash.
For these vehicles, the SRS uses 5 satellite sensors in addition to the RCM. The RCM is mounted
to the center tunnel beneath the console. All vehicles will have one front impact severity sensor
located in the front-center area of the vehicle, behind the grille mounted on the lower radiator
support. The first row impact sensors are located in each of the front doors behind the trim panel,
the second row sensors are located on each C-pillar. The side impact sensors are not
interchangeable between the first and second row. Mounting orientation is critical for correct
operation of all impact sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
FRONT IMPACT SEVERITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system SRS is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged SRS components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the lower radiator support.
1. Depower the system. 2. Disconnect the front impact severity sensor electrical connector.
3. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag front impact severity sensor retaining bolt is
critical for correct system operation.
NOTE:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8661
- Make sure the radiator support and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are clean and
free of foreign material.
- Note position of the locator tab on the front impact severity sensor for installation.
Remove the bolt and front impact severity sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8662
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - C-PILLAR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag SRS is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting bracket and wiring pigtail for
deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other damaged SRS components
whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8663
procedure again.
- RH side shown, LH similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the rear door scuff plate. 3. Detach the rear door weatherstrip.
4. NOTE: Make sure the second row safety belt retractor belt webbing is not twisted prior to
installation.
Remove the bolt and second row safety belt retractor anchor. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Position aside the quarter trim panel.
- Pull out on the quarter trim panel at the C-pillar to release the retaining clips to access the C-pillar
side impact sensor.
6. WARNING: The tightening torque of the side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for correct
system operation.
NOTE: Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tab for installation.
- Make sure the C-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
Remove the side impact sensor bolt. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
7. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the side impact sensor. 8. To install, reverse the
removal procedure. 9. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8664
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag SRS is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting bracket and wiring pigtail for
deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other damaged SRS components
whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- Avoid applying corrosion protection to any safety, mechanical and electrical parts, electric motors,
speakers, door locks and drain holes.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Driver side shown, passenger similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the front interior door trim panel on the side with the affected
side impact sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Impact Sensor > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8665
3. Separate the weathershield from the door enough to access the side impact sensor. 4.
Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
5. WARNING: The tightening torque of the side impact sensor retaining screws is critical for correct
system operation.
NOTE: Make sure the side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign material.
- Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tab for installation.
Remove the 2 screws and side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Position Sensor > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Power seat track seat position sensor shown, manual seat track position sensor similar.
1. Raise the driver seat and then position it to the rear of the track. 2. Depower the system. 3.
Remove the seat position sensor and bracket bolt. 4. Unhook the seat position sensor and bracket
from the seat track cross brace. 5. Disconnect the seat position sensor electrical connector and
remove the seat position sensor and bracket. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7.
Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Side Air Bag > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Side Air Bag: Description and Operation
SIDE AIR BAG MODULE
NOTE:
- References to side air bag modules refer to the seat-mounted, not to the steering wheel or
instrument panel mounted air bag components of the SRS.
- When servicing a seat equipped with a side air bag module, refer Seats.
A side air bag module provides protection of the thorax area (between the neck and abdomen) of
the body, working in conjunction with the head protection provided by a safety canopy module.
The side air bag module:
- will deploy upon receiving a flow of current from the RCM, initiated by the side impact sensor and
internal RCM circuitry.
- is installed as an assembly.
- is mounted in the driver or passenger seat backrest.
- is used in conjunction with a safety canopy module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Side Air Bag > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 8672
Side Air Bag: Service and Repair
SIDE AIR BAG MODULE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- Front seat back trim covers installed on seats equipped with side air bags cannot be repaired,
they are to be replaced. Cleaning is permissible.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a side air bag deployment took place, a new seat back pad, trim cover, side air bag module and
nuts must be installed. The seat back frame should be replaced if necessary.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Side Air Bag > Component Information > Description
and Operation > Page 8673
operation and does not indicate a supplemental restraint system SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
1. Position the affected seat and backrest fully up and forward. 2. Depower the system.
3. Release the seat backrest cover lower rear J-clip, then unzip the 2 side zippers.
4. NOTE: Note the position of the side air bag module locator pin to the seat backrest frame for
installation.
Remove the 2 side air bag module nuts. To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Note the position of the side air bag module locator pin and mounting studs in the seat
backrest trim cover deployment chute for
installation.
Position the seat backrest foam aside and remove the side air bag module from the seat backrest
frame. Then slide the side air bag module out of the seat backrest trim cover deployment chute.
6. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the side air bag module.
7. WARNING:
- Check the side air bag module deployment chute for damage. The side air bag module
deployment chute must not be repaired. If there is any damage to the side air bag module
deployment chute, a new seat back trim cover and side air bag module deployment chute must be
installed as a unit.
- Inspect the mounting surfaces of the side air bag module for any foreign objects before installing
the side air bag module. If any foreign objects are found, remove them. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
- If the side air bag module cover has separated or the side air bag module material has been
exposed, install a new side air bag module. Do not attempt to repair the side air bag module.
Failure to do so may result in personal injury in the event of an air bag deployment.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Description and Operation
SECONDARY AIR BAG WARNING (CHIME)
The secondary air bag warning chime, is an audible chime controlled by the instrument cluster
module (ICM). If the ICM has detected a fault with the air bag warning indicator a diagnostic trouble
code (DTC) will be stored in memory of the ICM. Upon receiving the message from the restraints
control module (RCM) that a SRS fault has been detected, the ICM will sound the secondary air
bag warning chime in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-22 (RH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8681
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
C310A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8682
C310B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8683
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
WARNING:
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON.Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation.If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation.If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have
deployed.In addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original
condition.Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a
crash.
CAUTION: Prior to removal of the RCM module, it is necessary to upload module configuration
information to the scan tool.This information needs to be downloaded into the new RCM module
once installed.Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network).
NOTE:
- When a new PCM is installed, the air bag warning indicator will illuminate when the ignition switch
is ON.The warning indicator will remain on until PCM configuration is restored.Clear RCM DTCs.
- When installing a new restraints control module (RCM), always make sure the correct RCM is
being installed.RCMs are not interchangeable between vehicles or vehicle lines.If an incorrect
RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs and incorrect diagnosis will result.
The restraints control module (RCM) carries out the following functions:
- deploys the air bag(s) in the event of a deployable crash.
- activates the safety belt buckle pretensioners to remove slack from the safety belt.
- monitors the SRS for faults.
- illuminates the air bag warning indicator if a fault is detected.
- communicates through the data link connector (DLC) the current or historical diagnostic trouble
codes (DTCs).
The RCM monitors the SRS for possible faults.If a fault is detected while the ignition switch is in the
ON position, the RCM will request illumination of the air bag warning indicator located in the
instrument cluster.
When the ignition switch is cycled (turned OFF and then ON), the air bag warning indicator will
prove out by lighting for 6 seconds and then turn off.If a SRS fault exists, the air bag warning
indicator will illuminate and remain illuminated for the rest of the key cycle.The RCM will also
communicate the on-demand (current) and continuous (historical) DTCs through the DLC, to the
scan tool.If the RCM requests illumination of the air bag warning indicator and the air bag warning
indicator does not function, the instrument cluster module will automatically activate an audible
chime.The chime is a series of 5 sets of 5 tone bursts.If the chime is heard, the SRS and the air
bag warning indicator require repair.
The RCM includes a backup power supply.This feature provides sufficient backup power to deploy
the air bags in the event that the ignition circuit is lost or damaged during impact.The backup power
supply will deplete its stored energy approximately one minute after the battery ground cable is
disconnected.
A new RCM installed in a vehicle will flash lamp fault code (LFC) 54 until programmable module
installation (PMI) has been carried out on the RCM.If a LFC is present after completing PMI, a fault
is present in the SRS and on-demand DTCs must be retrieved and diagnosed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8684
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
RESTRAINTS CONTROL MODULE (RCM)
Removal
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Do not handle, move or change the original horizontal mounting position of the restraints control
module (RCM) while the RCM is connected and the ignition switch is ON. Failure to follow these
instructions may result in the inadvertent deployment of the safety canopy and risk of personal
injury.
- The RCM orientation is critical for proper air bag SRS operation. If a vehicle equipped with an
SRS system has been involved in a
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8685
collision in which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have deployed.
In addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
CAUTION:
- Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these charges, damage
can result.
- When installing a new RCM, it is necessary to carry out programmable module installation (PMI).
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- When installing a new RCM, always make sure the correct RCM is being installed. If an incorrect
RCM is installed, erroneous DTCs will result.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
All vehicles 1. If installing a new restraints control module (RCM), carry out the steps necessary to
prepare for programmable module installation (PMI). 2. Depower the system.
Vehicles with a center console 3. Remove the center console.
Vehicles with bucket seats and no center console 4. Remove the 3 RCM push-nut retainers and
the RCM cover.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
1 Push down to release the retaining tab.
2 While releasing the retaining tab, pull out and disconnect the small RCM electrical connector.
6. Disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
1 Pinch the thumb tab and pivot the connector position assurance lever away from the RCM,
disengaging the lever.
2 Pull out and disconnect the large RCM electrical connector.
7. Remove the 3 bolts and RCM.
Installation
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8686
1. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag RCM retaining bolts is critical for correct system
operation.
Install the RCM and 3 bolts. Tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
2. Make sure the connector position assurance lever is in the full release position before attempting
to connect the connector.
3. CAUTION: Putting the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM on an angle can cause bad
electrical connections and damage
components.
Position the large RCM electrical connector into the RCM.
- CAUTION: Do not push the connector on to where the lever pivots and seats itself. Light pressure
is needed to get the connector into position on the RCM before using the lever to fully seat the
connector.
With the large RCM electrical connector uniformly aligned to the RCM, lightly push in until a subtle
audible click is heard and slight resistance is felt.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8687
4. Connect the RCM electrical connector.
- Pivot the connector position assurance lever toward the RCM, drawing the connector in to the
RCM. Make sure the thumb tab is engaged to the retainer on the RCM and locked in place.
5. Connect the small RCM electrical connector.
Vehicles with bucket seats and no center console 6. Install the 3 RCM push-nut retainers and the
RCM cover.
Vehicles with a center console 7. Install the center console.
All vehicles 8. Repower the SRS. Do not prove out the SRS at this time. 9. When installing a new
RCM, carry out the steps necessary to complete programmable module installation (PMI).
10. Prove out the supplemental restraint system (SRS) as follows:
Turn the ignition switch from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the ignition switch back to ON
and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed. The air bag
warning indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn OFF. If an air
bag SRS fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator might not light until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition switch
has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS. If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and a SRS fault
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8688
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator and any SRS fault discovered must be diagnosed and repaired.
Clear all continuous memory diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) from the RCM.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module.Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped). Failure to
follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable (14301) and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all supplemental restraint system (SRS) components are connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install restraints control module (RCM) fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8694
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off.If an air bag SRS fault
is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8695
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body.This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down.This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin.Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module.Doing so can result in safety canopy
deployment, which can result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device.Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner.Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector.Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON.This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and
the restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors are located in the first row doors, behind the door trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8696
auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).Failure to follow these instructions may
increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position. 8. Center the tilt steering column.
9. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock
position).
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws and pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
11. Remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
All vehicles 12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws. 13. Release the clips and
remove the steering column upper shroud. 14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8697
15. CAUTION: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each
of the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel.Failure to do so will damage the driver
air bag module and steering wheel.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity.The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
- Use a mirror to look at the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
- Note the position of the 2 driver air bag module locator pins to the steering wheel for installation.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
16. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors, then disconnect the horn switch
electrical connector and remove the driver air bag
module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight ahead position (the 12
o'clock position). 18. Open and lower the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8698
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat.The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector.
21. Release the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
22. Remove the bolt and the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8699
23. Remove the cover and the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8700
27. Remove the bolt and the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
28. Remove the cover and the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8701
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat.The driver seat side air bag module
electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SPDJB. 33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8702
5. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8703
9. Connect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
10. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8704
13. Attach the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector. 16. Close the glove compartment
door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag
module.Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module.Do not force
the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the horn switch electrical connector, then connect the 2 driver air bag module electrical
connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8705
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE:
- Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated correctly to the
steering wheel.
- Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks. -
Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud. 22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
23. Install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. Install the lower steering column opening cover and the 3 screws.
All vehicles 25. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 26. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and install the cover.
27. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
28. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming > System
Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and Repowering > Page 8706
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position.This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps.If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Description and Operation
LOWER ANCHORS AND TETHERS FOR CHILDREN (LATCH)
The lower anchors and tethers for children (LATCH) system is a standardized and uniform
attachment system for installing child safety seats in passenger vehicles. LATCH-equipped child
safety seats have 2 lower attachments that connect to the vehicle portion of the LATCH system.
The vehicle portion of the system consists of 2 attachment points (6 mm wires) welded to the rear
seat cushion frame. The attachment points protrude from the bite line between the seat cushion
and seat backrest.
If a child safety seat was in use during a collision, inspect the vehicle portion of the system for
damage. If any of the attachment points (6 mm wires) are damaged, install a new seat cushion
frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 8711
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Service and Repair
CHILD SAFETY SEAT TETHER ANCHOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Position the third row seat backrest downward.
2. Release the seat back J-clips.
3. With the seat backrest trim cover and cushion positioned aside, remove the nut, bolt and the
tether anchor.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. WARNING: It is important that the bolt/anchor be securely tightened to specification. Otherwise,
the child's safety seat may not be
correctly secured and the child could be injured in case of a sudden stop or accident.
NOTE: Inspect the seat for damage. If the seat is found to be damaged, install new seat
components.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Seat Belt: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT EXTENSION ASSEMBLY
In certain cases, the safety belt may be too short, even when it is fully extended. About 20 cm (8 in)
can be added to the belt length by using a safety belt extension. Safety belt extensions are
available through any Ford or Lincoln Mercury dealer parts department at no cost. Safety belt
extensions are only available with black webbing. There are 2 extension assemblies available, one
for the front seating positions and one for the rear seating positions. They are not interchangeable.
Only use extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the safety belt. Manufacturer
identification is located at the end of the webbing on the label. Also, use the safety belt extension
only if the safety belt is too short for you when fully extended. Do not use the extension to change
the fit of the shoulder belt across the torso.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 8715
Seat Belt: Service and Repair
SAFETY BELT - FRONT, CENTER
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Move the driver seat to the most forward position. 2. Move the passenger seat to the most
rearward position. 3. Remove the bolt and route the safety belt out from the seat.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
4. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- When installing, make sure the safety belt anchor is on top of the seat bracket.
- Make sure the safety belt is accessible to the occupant after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Buckle: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER
All vehicles have a pretensioner system used with the front outboard safety belt buckles. This
works in conjunction with the front air bag system mounted in the steering wheel and instrument
panel.
The safety belt buckle and pretensioners are for the front outboard occupants, located on the
inboard side of the seats. This allows the front safety belt buckle end to move with the front seat.
The safety belt buckle and pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device that removes excess webbing from
the safety belt system. When the front air bag system is deployed, the pretensioner in the buckle
deploys, causing the buckle to move downward, pulling excess webbing from the lap and shoulder
safety belts.
If the vehicle is involved in a collision that results in deployment of the front air bags and safety belt
pretensioners, the driver and passenger seat belt system (including safety belt buckle and
pretensioners, safety belt retractors and height adjusters) must be replaced.
If the ignition switch is turned to the ON or START position with the safety belt buckle pretensioner
electrical connector(s) disconnected, the DTC and fault PIDs for an open circuit will be activated.
For safety belt buckle pretensioner diagnostic information, refer Air Bag Systems.
For safety belt buckle pretensioner disposal information, refer Air Bag Systems.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Position the seat upright. 2. Remove the nut and safety belt buckle assembly from underneath
the seat.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
seat frame.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8721
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 40 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - SECOND ROW, 40 PERCENT SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Pivot the 40 percent seat upward. 2. Remove the rearward screw (not shown) and seat side
shield.
- Release the pin-type retainer (not shown).
3. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
seat frame.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8722
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 40 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - THIRD ROW, 40 PERCENT SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Remove the third row 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. NOTE:
- When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the sheet
metal.
- Make sure the safety belt buckle is accessible to the passenger after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8723
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 60 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - THIRD ROW, 60 PERCENT SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Fold the 60 percent seat down. 2. Position the load floor panels up. 3. Remove the bolt and
safety belt buckle assembly.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Fold the 60 percent seat up and remove the safety belt buckle assembly through the seat.
5. NOTE:
- When installing the safety belt buckle assembly, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
sheet metal.
- Make sure the safety belt buckles are accessible to the passengers after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8724
Seat Belt Buckle: Service and Repair
Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT SEAT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Position the seat upright. 2. Remove the nut and safety belt buckle assembly from underneath
the seat.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
3. NOTE: When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
seat frame.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 40 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - SECOND ROW, 40 PERCENT SEAT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8725
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Pivot the 40 percent seat upward. 2. Remove the rearward screw (not shown) and seat side
shield.
- Release the pin-type retainer (not shown).
3. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 50 Nm (37 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
seat frame.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 40 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - THIRD ROW, 40 PERCENT SEAT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8726
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Remove the third row 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. NOTE:
- When installing the safety belt buckle, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the sheet
metal.
- Make sure the safety belt buckle is accessible to the passenger after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Safety Belt Buckle - Third Row, 60 Percent Seat
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - THIRD ROW, 60 PERCENT SEAT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8727
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Fold the 60 percent seat down. 2. Position the load floor panels up. 3. Remove the bolt and
safety belt buckle assembly.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Fold the 60 percent seat up and remove the safety belt buckle assembly through the seat.
5. NOTE:
- When installing the safety belt buckle assembly, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the
sheet metal.
- Make sure the safety belt buckles are accessible to the passengers after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner - 60 Percent
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER - 60 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8728
Removal
WARNING:
- All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped, buckles,
shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching
hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed
unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt
assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if
either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase the
risk of injury in collisions.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat fasteners. 2. Depower the supplemental restraint
system (SRS). 3. Remove the 60 percent front seat.
4. NOTE: Make note of the wire harness routing for installation.
Remove the tie strap from the pretensioner. Disconnect the safety belt buckle switch electrical connector.
- Disconnect the safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector.
5. Remove the nut and safety belt buckle pretensioner assembly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8729
Installation
1. Install the safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
1 Position the safety belt buckle and pretensioner to the seat. Align the safety belt buckle and pretensioner locator tab to the hole in the seat frame.
- Check that the safety belt buckle end is accessible after positioning.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
3 Route the safety belt buckle switch and pretensioner electrical connectors as noted in removal.
2. Connect the electrical connectors. Attach the electrical connectors and route the wire harnesses
as noted in removal. 3. Install the 60 percent front seat. 4. Repower the SRS. 5. Check the active
restraint system for correct operation.
Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner - 40 Percent
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER - 40 PERCENT
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
- All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS] if equipped, buckles,
shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching
hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed
unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt
assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if
either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase the
risk of injury in collisions.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8730
handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt retractor pretensioner. Never probe a
pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in pretensioner or air bag deployment and
could result in personal injury.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat fasteners. 2. Depower the supplemental restraint
system (SRS). 3. Remove the 40 percent front seat.
4. Release the hook-and-loop strip and pull the seat cushion trim cover up enough to expose the
safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
5. NOTE: Make note of the wire harness routing for installation.
Remove the tie strap from the pretensioner. Disconnect the safety belt buckle switch electrical connector.
- Disconnect the safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector.
6. Remove the nut and safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 8. Install the 40 percent front seat. 9. Repower the
SRS.
10. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Safety Belt Buckle - Front, Center
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE - FRONT, CENTER
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle - Second Row, 20 Percent Seat > Page 8731
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase
the risk of injury in collisions.
1. Move the seat to the most forward position. 2. Remove the bolt and route the safety belt buckle
out of the seat.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- Make sure the safety belt buckle is accessible to the occupant after installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
4. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger > Page 8736
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver
C3065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver > Page 8739
C3066
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 8740
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE SWITCHES
As part of the supplemental restraint system (SRS), the driver and front outboard passenger safety
belt buckles are equipped with safety belt buckle switches.The safety belt buckle switches indicate
to the restraints control module (RCM) Whether the safety belts are connected or
disconnected.The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver and passenger air bag modules.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Seat Belt Height Adjuster: Service and Repair
SAFETY BELT SHOULDER HEIGHT ADJUSTER
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to
install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE: RH shown, LH similar.
1. NOTE: Inspect the D-ring cover for damage. If the cover is damaged or does not remain closed,
install new D-ring cover and bolt.
Position the safety belt guide to the lowest position.
Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel.
2. Access the bolt behind the safety belt shoulder height adjuster trim cover in the following
sequence.
1 Lower the safety belt shoulder height adjuster to the lowest point.
2 Fold the trim cover over.
3. Remove the safety belt shoulder height adjuster bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Height Adjuster > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 8744
4. Remove the safety belt shoulder height adjuster.
1 Rotate the safety belt shoulder height adjuster downward to release the lower tab.
2 Remove the safety belt shoulder height adjuster.
5. NOTE: Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
6. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Description and Operation
Warning System - Driver Safety Belt
The driver safety belt incorporates a safety belt warning indicator switch, warning indicator and
chime. The warning indicator and chime are reminders to fasten the safety belt. If the driver safety belt is not buckled before the ignition key is turned to ON, the safety belt warning
light illuminates for 1 to 2 minutes and the warning chime sounds for 4 to 8 seconds.
- If the driver side safety belt is buckled while the indicator light is illuminated and the warning
chime is sounding, the safety belt warning light and warning chime turn OFF.
- If the safety belt is buckled before the key is turned to the ON position, the warning indicator will
come on for 4 to 8 seconds with no chime.
Belt Minder
Feature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt warning function. This feature provides
additional reminders to the driver that the driver's safety belt is unbuckled by intermittently
sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster.
To activate or deactivate the Belt Minder feature, refer to Seat Belt Systems or the owner's
literature.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Seat Belt Retractor: Description and Operation
Dual Locking Mode Retractors
WARNING: After any vehicle collision, the safety belt system at all outboard seating positions
(except driver, which has no automatic locking retractor [ALR] feature) must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for child seats is still functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when checked according to the procedures. Failure to install a new belt and
retractor assembly could increase the risk of serious personal injury in collisions.
NOTE: When replacing a dual locking mode retractor, the retractor should be checked to make
sure it is not in the automatic locking retractor (ALR) mode after installation in the stowed position.
All outboard continuous-loop, 3-point retractor systems, except the driver position, are equipped
with the dual locking mode system.
The emergency locking retractor (ELR) mode will allow the occupant freedom of movement, locking
tight only on hard braking, hard cornering or an impact of approximately 8 km/h (5 mph). The ELR
mode helps to reduce the forward movement of the driver and passengers. The ELR mode is
continuously in operation at all seating positions.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) portion of this system does not allow the occupant freedom
of movement. The ALR mode is used when locking a child seat in at a seating position or when a
tight belt fit is desired. The ALR mode is automatically engaged when the webbing is fully extracted
from the retractor and then allowed to retract. As the webbing is retracted back onto the spool, an
audible clicking sound is made, indicating that the retractor is in ALR mode. The ALR mode is
automatically disengaged when most of the webbing is retracted back onto the spool.
The automatic locking mode must be used when installing a child safety seat in the front or rear
passenger seating positions where dual locking mode retractors are provided.
Energy Management Retractor
This vehicle has a safety belt system with an energy management feature at the front seating
positions to help further reduce the risk of injury in the event of a head-on collision.
The energy management retractor feature is designed to pay out webbing in a controlled manner.
This feature is designed to help reduce the belt force acting on the occupant's chest
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Front
SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - FRONT
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to
install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 8753
injury in collisions.
1. NOTE: Inspect the D-ring cover for damage. If the cover is damaged or does not remain closed,
install a new D-ring cover.
Remove the upper and lower B-pillar trim panels.
2. Release the 2 pin-type retainers and safety belt guide. 3. Remove the bolt and safety belt
retractor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- When installing the safety belt retractor, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the sheet
metal
- Remove the shipping clip after safety belt retractor installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
5. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 8754
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row and Third Row,
Outboard
SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - SECOND ROW AND THIRD ROW, OUTBOARD
Expedition/Navigator
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 8755
Expedition EL/Navigator L (Part 1)
Expedition EL/Navigator L (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 8756
Safety Belt Retractor Sling, Expedition EL/Navigator L, 3rd Row
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt.ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not operating
correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to install a new
belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE: RH shown,LH similar.
Both retractors
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 8757
2. For RH 3rd row safety belt retractor, remove the 2 screws and position aside the auxiliary relay
box, if equipped.
Second row retractor (Expedition/Navigator)
3. Remove the safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: Inspect the D-ring cover for damage. If the cover is damaged or does not remain closed,
install new D-ring cover and bolt.
Open the D-ring cover and remove the D-ring bolt. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Remove the bolt and safety belt retractor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Second row retractor (Expedition EL/Navigator L)
6. NOTE: Inspect the D-ring cover for damage. If the cover is damaged or does not remain closed,
install new D-ring cover and bolt.
Open the D-ring cover and remove the D-ring bolt. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
7. Remove the bolt and safety belt retractor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Third row retractor (Expedition/Navigator)
8. Open the D-ring cover and remove the D-ring bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
9. Remove the bolt and safety belt retractor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Third row retractor (Expedition EL/Navigator L)
10. Remove the sling cover and bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
11. Remove the bolt and safety belt retractor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Both retractors
12. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- Before installing the third row safety belt anchor, make sure the floor slotted plastic insert is still
present. If it is not, another insert must be installed.
- When installing the safety belt retractor, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the sheet
metal.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
13. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 8758
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Second Row, Center
SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - SECOND ROW, CENTER
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 8759
inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to install a new belt and
retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in collisions.
NOTE: The retractor may be equipped with an additional web stop button (small, thin, round button,
not to be confused with the larger web stop button) located on the safety belt webbing. This button
is only used for vehicle assembly and serves no other functional purpose. The button can possibly
be retracted under the trim bezel making it difficult to pull the safety belt webbing out of the
retractor. To service, remove this web stop button. Do not install a new safety belt retractor to
eliminate this condition. Any resulting appearance concerns with the webbing can be worked out by
hand.
1. Remove the second row 20 percent seat backrest trim cover. 2. Remove the seat backrest foam
pad. 3. Remove the safety belt retractor cover foam. 4. Remove the 2 screws from the seat belt
retractor cover and remove the cover. 5. Remove the safety belt retractor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
6. Pinch and release the safety belt retractor guide from the seat backrest frame and remove the
safety belt retractor.
7. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- When installing the safety belt retractor, make sure to engage the anti-rotation tab to the sheet
metal.
- Remove the shipping clip after safety belt retractor installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
8. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 8760
Seat Belt Retractor: Service and Repair Safety Belt Retractor - Third Row, Center
SAFETY BELT RETRACTOR - THIRD ROW, CENTER
Removal and Installation
WARNING: All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensors [BTS] if equipped,
buckles, shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and
attaching hardware) should be inspected after any collision. All new belt assemblies should be
installed unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly.
Belt assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed
if either damage or incorrect operation is noted.
The automatic locking retractor (ALR) feature of the safety belt retractor must be checked by a
qualified technician to verify that the ALR feature for a child safety seat is functioning correctly, in
addition to other checks for correct safety belt system function. A new belt and retractor assembly
must be installed if the safety belt assembly's ALR feature, or any other safety belt function, is not
operating correctly when inspected according to the functional inspection procedures. Failure to
install a new belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Retractor - Front > Page 8761
injury in collisions.
NOTE: The retractor may be equipped with an additional web stop button (small, thin, round button,
not to be confused with the larger web stop button) located on the safety belt webbing. This button
is only used for vehicle assembly and serves no other functional purpose. The button can possibly
be retracted under the trim bezel making it difficult to pull the safety belt webbing out of the
retractor. To service, remove this web stop button. Do not install a new safety belt retractor to
eliminate this condition. Any resulting appearance concerns with the webbing can be worked out by
hand.
1. Remove the third row 60 percent seat backrest trim cover. 2. Remove the seat backrest foam
pad. 3. Remove the 4 screws from the seat belt retractor cover (2 shown). 4. Remove the safety
belt retractor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Pinch to release the safety belt retractor guide and remove the safety belt retractor.
6. NOTE:
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
- Remove the shipping clip after safety belt retractor installation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
7. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Pretensioner, Driver
C3201
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Diagrams > Safety Belt Pretensioner, Driver > Page 8766
C3202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Safety Belt Pretensioners
Seat Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation Safety Belt Pretensioners
SAFETY BELT PRETENSIONERS
As part of the SRS, the driver and front outboard passenger safety belt buckles are equipped with
pretensioners. The safety belt buckle pretensioners remove excess slack from the safety belt
webbing. The pretensioners are activated by the restraints control module (RCM) when the module
detects a crash event force exceeding a programmed limit.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Safety Belt Pretensioners > Page 8769
Seat Belt Tensioner: Description and Operation Attaching Safety Seats With Tether Straps
ATTACHING SAFETY SEATS WITH TETHER STRAPS
Some manufacturers make child safety seats that include a tether strap that goes over the back of
the vehicle seat and attaches to an anchoring point. Other manufacturers offer the tether strap as
an accessory. Contact the manufacturer of the child safety seat for information about ordering a
tether strap.
Child safety seat tether anchors are manufactured into the vehicle. See the active restraint system
component location at the beginning the owner's literature for locations.
For removal and installation of child safety seat tether anchors, refer to the appropriate procedure
or Seats for seat cushion frame replacement.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner - 60 Percent
Seat Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner - 60 Percent
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER - 60 PERCENT
Removal
WARNING:
- All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS], if equipped, buckles,
shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching
hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed
unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt
assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if
either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase the
risk of injury in collisions.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat fasteners. 2. Depower the supplemental restraint
system (SRS). 3. Remove the 60 percent front seat.
4. NOTE: Make note of the wire harness routing for installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner - 60 Percent > Page 8772
Remove the tie strap from the pretensioner. Disconnect the safety belt buckle switch electrical connector.
- Disconnect the safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector.
5. Remove the nut and safety belt buckle pretensioner assembly.
Installation
1. Install the safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
1 Position the safety belt buckle and pretensioner to the seat. Align the safety belt buckle and pretensioner locator tab to the hole in the seat frame.
- Check that the safety belt buckle end is accessible after positioning.
2 Install the nut. Tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
3 Route the safety belt buckle switch and pretensioner electrical connectors as noted in removal.
2. Connect the electrical connectors. Attach the electrical connectors and route the wire harnesses
as noted in removal. 3. Install the 60 percent front seat. 4. Repower the SRS. 5. Check the active
restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner - 60 Percent > Page 8773
Seat Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner - 40 Percent
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE AND PRETENSIONER - 40 PERCENT
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
- All safety belt assemblies (including retractors, belt tension sensor [BTS] if equipped, buckles,
shoulder belt height adjusters [if equipped], child safety seat tether attachments and attaching
hardware) should be inspected after every collision. All new belt assemblies should be installed
unless a qualified technician finds the assemblies show no damage and operate correctly. Belt
assemblies not in use during a collision should also be inspected and new assemblies installed if
either damage or incorrect operation is noted. Failure to follow these instructions could increase the
risk of injury in collisions.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
NOTE:
- If a seat equipped with a supplemental restraint system (SRS) component is being serviced, the
SRS must be depowered.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the seat to gain access to all seat fasteners. 2. Depower the supplemental restraint
system (SRS). 3. Remove the 40 percent front seat.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tensioner > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Safety Belt Buckle and Pretensioner - 60 Percent > Page 8774
4. Release the hook-and-loop strip and pull the seat cushion trim cover up enough to expose the
safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
5. NOTE: Make note of the wire harness routing for installation.
Remove the tie strap from the pretensioner. Disconnect the safety belt buckle switch electrical connector.
- Disconnect the safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connector.
6. Remove the nut and safety belt buckle and pretensioner.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 8. Install the 40 percent front seat. 9. Repower the
SRS.
10. Check the active restraint system for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the outboard side of the driver
seat track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver
seat position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8781
C356
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8787
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8788
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8789
Impact Sensor: Locations Safety Canopy Sensor, Driver 2
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8790
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8791
Impact Sensor: Locations Safety Canopy Sensor, Passenger 2
View 151-26 (Right Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8792
View 151-30 (Right Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor
C177
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8795
C539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8796
C631
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8797
C3314
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8798
C3315
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8799
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation
SENSORS
WARNING:
- The restraints control module (RCM) orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle
equipped with an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) has been involved in a collision in
which the center tunnel area has been damaged, inspect the mounting and bracket for
deformation. If damaged, a new RCM must be installed whether or not the air bags have deployed.
In addition, make sure the area of the RCM mounting is restored to its original condition. Failure to
follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install a new and correctly position the sensor or any
other damaged supplemental restraint system (SRS) components whether or not the air bag is
deployed. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a
crash.
For these vehicles, the SRS uses 5 satellite sensors in addition to the RCM. The RCM is mounted
to the center tunnel beneath the console. All vehicles will have one front impact severity sensor
located in the front-center area of the vehicle, behind the grille mounted on the lower radiator
support. The first row impact sensors are located in each of the front doors behind the trim panel,
the second row sensors are located on each C-pillar. The side impact sensors are not
interchangeable between the first and second row. Mounting orientation is critical for correct
operation of all impact sensors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Front Impact Severity Sensor
FRONT IMPACT SEVERITY SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag supplemental restraint system SRS is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting
bracket and wiring pigtail for deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other
damaged SRS components whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the lower radiator support.
1. Depower the system. 2. Disconnect the front impact severity sensor electrical connector.
3. WARNING: The tightening torque of the air bag front impact severity sensor retaining bolt is
critical for correct system operation.
NOTE:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8802
- Make sure the radiator support and front impact severity sensor mating surfaces are clean and
free of foreign material.
- Note position of the locator tab on the front impact severity sensor for installation.
Remove the bolt and front impact severity sensor. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8803
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - C-Pillar
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - C-PILLAR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag SRS is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting bracket and wiring pigtail for
deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other damaged SRS components
whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8804
procedure again.
- RH side shown, LH similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the rear door scuff plate. 3. Detach the rear door weatherstrip.
4. NOTE: Make sure the second row safety belt retractor belt webbing is not twisted prior to
installation.
Remove the bolt and second row safety belt retractor anchor. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
5. Position aside the quarter trim panel.
- Pull out on the quarter trim panel at the C-pillar to release the retaining clips to access the C-pillar
side impact sensor.
6. WARNING: The tightening torque of the side impact sensor retaining bolt is critical for correct
system operation.
NOTE: Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tab for installation.
- Make sure the C-pillar and side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign
material.
Remove the side impact sensor bolt. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
7. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the side impact sensor. 8. To install, reverse the
removal procedure. 9. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8805
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair Side Impact Sensor - Front Door
SIDE IMPACT SENSOR - FRONT DOOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Vehicle sensor orientation is critical for correct system operation. If a vehicle equipped with an air
bag SRS is involved in a collision, inspect the sensor mounting bracket and wiring pigtail for
deformation. Install and correctly position the sensor or any other damaged SRS components
whether or not the air bag is deployed.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- Avoid applying corrosion protection to any safety, mechanical and electrical parts, electric motors,
speakers, door locks and drain holes.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Driver side shown, passenger similar.
1. Depower the system. 2. Remove the front interior door trim panel on the side with the affected
side impact sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Front Impact Severity Sensor > Page 8806
3. Separate the weathershield from the door enough to access the side impact sensor. 4.
Disconnect the side impact sensor electrical connector.
5. WARNING: The tightening torque of the side impact sensor retaining screws is critical for correct
system operation.
NOTE: Make sure the side impact sensor mating surfaces are clean and free of foreign material.
- Note the position of the side impact sensor locating tab for installation.
Remove the 2 screws and side impact sensor. To install, tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Passenger > Page 8811
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver
C3065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Safety Belt Buckle Switch, Driver > Page 8814
C3066
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8815
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Description and Operation
SAFETY BELT BUCKLE SWITCHES
As part of the supplemental restraint system (SRS), the driver and front outboard passenger safety
belt buckles are equipped with safety belt buckle switches.The safety belt buckle switches indicate
to the restraints control module (RCM) Whether the safety belts are connected or
disconnected.The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver and passenger air bag modules.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Tower Position
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the outboard side of the driver
seat track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver
seat position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Position Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Seat Position Sensor: Service and Repair
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module. This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Repair is made by installing a new part only. If the new part does not correct the condition, install
the original part and carry out the diagnostic procedure again.
- Power seat track seat position sensor shown, manual seat track position sensor similar.
1. Raise the driver seat and then position it to the rear of the track. 2. Depower the system. 3.
Remove the seat position sensor and bracket bolt. 4. Unhook the seat position sensor and bracket
from the seat track cross brace. 5. Disconnect the seat position sensor electrical connector and
remove the seat position sensor and bracket. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7.
Repower the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Sensor/Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8825
C356
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Control Display > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Accessory Control Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors
Accessory Control Display: Customer Interest Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other
Errors
TSB 07-7-4
04/16/07
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCHES INOP-TEXT BLANK/SCRAMBLED/COMPASS INOP/WASHER
LIGHT ON/OAT READS HIGH
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/22/2006 may exhibit concerns
with the Instrument Cluster (IC). The outside air temp reads 140 °F (60 °C), message center
switches unresponsive/text blank or scrambled, compass display is inoperative, washer fluid level
light is on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE IC ASSEMBLY UNTIL COMPLETE DIAGNOSIS HAS BEEN PERFORMED.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check the build date code of the IC. The date code is displayed in the message center during
"engineering test mod&'.
Engineering Test Mode:
1. Ignition in "OFF" position.
2. Cluster type.
a. For Base Clusters (without message center cluster): depress the reset stem on the cluster while
turning the ignition switch to the "ON" position.
b. Message Center Clusters: depress the reset button in the vehicle while turning the ignition switch
to the "ON" position.
3. Continue to hold down the reset stem/button for 5 seconds until the cluster message center
displays "engineering test mode".
4. Press/cycle reset stem/button until the message center displays "manufacture" and the date of
manufacture (MM-DD-YYYY).
5. If the date is after 12/22/2006, this TSB does not apply and proceed with normal diagnostics
found in Workshop Manual (WSM), Sections 413-01 and 413-08.
6. Turn the vehicle ignition to the "OFF" position to exit the "engineering test mode".
Outside Air Temperature (OAT) Diagnostics
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS FOR VEHICLES WITHOUT (ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE
CONTROL) EATC.
1. Run vehicle for 5 minutes.
2. Verify the OAT reads 140 °F (60 °C) in the Message Center.
3. Disconnect the OAT sensor.
4. Does the Message Center still read 140 °F (60 °C)?
a. Yes - proceed to Step 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Control Display > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Accessory Control Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 8835
b. No - follow WSM, Section 413-08.
5. Disconnect battery.
6. Disconnect IC.
7. Measure the resistance between pins 1 and 2 on Connector C132.
a. Resistance less than 1 Meg-Ohms - Repair shorted circuits.
b. Resistance greater than 1 Meg-Ohms - Proceed to Step 8.
8. Reconnect IC and OAT sensor.
9. Reconnect battery, to verify IC connection. If Message Center still reads 140 °F (60 °C), replace
IC.
Message Center (MC) Switch, Diagnostics:
Refer to WSM, Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate
Correctly
Low Washer Fluid Level Light On, Diagnostics
1. Verify low washer fluid level light is on and washer bottle is full.
2. Verify washer fluid level switch is fully seated in the bottle. Is light still on?
a. No - repair is complete.
b. Yes - proceed to Step 3.
3. Disconnect the washer fluid level switch. Does the light go out after one minute?
a. Yes - proceed with normal WSM, Section 413-01 Diagnostics.
b. No - proceed to Step 4.
4. Disconnect battery.
5. Disconnect IC.
6. Measure the resistance on Pins 1 and 2 of Connector C138. Is the resistance less than 1
Meg-Ohms?
a. Yes - repair shorted wires.
b. No - proceed to step 7.
7. Reconnect the washer fluid level switch, IC and then battery to verify IC connections. If light is
still on, replace the IC.
No Compass Display Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative.
Message Center Display Blank/Text Scrambled, Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Symptom Chart
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070704 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Control Display > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Accessory Control Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 8836
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
10849 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Control Display > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Accessory Control Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 >
Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors
Accessory Control Display: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Message Center Switches
Inop/Other Errors
TSB 07-7-4
04/16/07
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCHES INOP-TEXT BLANK/SCRAMBLED/COMPASS INOP/WASHER
LIGHT ON/OAT READS HIGH
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/22/2006 may exhibit concerns
with the Instrument Cluster (IC). The outside air temp reads 140 °F (60 °C), message center
switches unresponsive/text blank or scrambled, compass display is inoperative, washer fluid level
light is on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE IC ASSEMBLY UNTIL COMPLETE DIAGNOSIS HAS BEEN PERFORMED.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check the build date code of the IC. The date code is displayed in the message center during
"engineering test mod&'.
Engineering Test Mode:
1. Ignition in "OFF" position.
2. Cluster type.
a. For Base Clusters (without message center cluster): depress the reset stem on the cluster while
turning the ignition switch to the "ON" position.
b. Message Center Clusters: depress the reset button in the vehicle while turning the ignition switch
to the "ON" position.
3. Continue to hold down the reset stem/button for 5 seconds until the cluster message center
displays "engineering test mode".
4. Press/cycle reset stem/button until the message center displays "manufacture" and the date of
manufacture (MM-DD-YYYY).
5. If the date is after 12/22/2006, this TSB does not apply and proceed with normal diagnostics
found in Workshop Manual (WSM), Sections 413-01 and 413-08.
6. Turn the vehicle ignition to the "OFF" position to exit the "engineering test mode".
Outside Air Temperature (OAT) Diagnostics
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS FOR VEHICLES WITHOUT (ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE
CONTROL) EATC.
1. Run vehicle for 5 minutes.
2. Verify the OAT reads 140 °F (60 °C) in the Message Center.
3. Disconnect the OAT sensor.
4. Does the Message Center still read 140 °F (60 °C)?
a. Yes - proceed to Step 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Control Display > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Accessory Control Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 >
Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 8842
b. No - follow WSM, Section 413-08.
5. Disconnect battery.
6. Disconnect IC.
7. Measure the resistance between pins 1 and 2 on Connector C132.
a. Resistance less than 1 Meg-Ohms - Repair shorted circuits.
b. Resistance greater than 1 Meg-Ohms - Proceed to Step 8.
8. Reconnect IC and OAT sensor.
9. Reconnect battery, to verify IC connection. If Message Center still reads 140 °F (60 °C), replace
IC.
Message Center (MC) Switch, Diagnostics:
Refer to WSM, Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate
Correctly
Low Washer Fluid Level Light On, Diagnostics
1. Verify low washer fluid level light is on and washer bottle is full.
2. Verify washer fluid level switch is fully seated in the bottle. Is light still on?
a. No - repair is complete.
b. Yes - proceed to Step 3.
3. Disconnect the washer fluid level switch. Does the light go out after one minute?
a. Yes - proceed with normal WSM, Section 413-01 Diagnostics.
b. No - proceed to Step 4.
4. Disconnect battery.
5. Disconnect IC.
6. Measure the resistance on Pins 1 and 2 of Connector C138. Is the resistance less than 1
Meg-Ohms?
a. Yes - repair shorted wires.
b. No - proceed to step 7.
7. Reconnect the washer fluid level switch, IC and then battery to verify IC connections. If light is
still on, replace the IC.
No Compass Display Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative.
Message Center Display Blank/Text Scrambled, Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Symptom Chart
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070704 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Control Display > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Accessory Control Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 >
Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 8843
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
10849 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8848
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8849
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8850
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Control Module > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Antenna Control Module: Service and Repair
ANTENNA ISOLATOR MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH C-pillar trim panel. 2. Disconnect the antenna cable connector, the antenna
isolator module electrical connector, and the antenna isolator module-to-quarter glass
connector.
3. Remove the stud and the antenna isolator module.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Navigation > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Antenna, Navigation: Service and Repair
GLOBAL POSITIONING SYSTEM (GPS) ANTENNA
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the audio unit. 2. Unclip the GPS antenna from the instrument panel brace and remove
the GPS antenna. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Antenna Cable: Service and Repair
ANTENNA LEAD-IN CABLE - FRONT
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the audio unit.
2. Remove the RH scuff plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna, Radio > Antenna Cable >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 8862
3. Remove the RH A-pillar lower trim panel. 4. Disconnect the rear antenna lead-in cable from the
front antenna lead-in cable.
5. NOTE: The antenna is an integral part of the wiring harness and cannot be replaced separately
from the harness. Cut the ends off the old antenna
cable and tape the remainder to the wiring harness to prevent noise.
Remove the ground plate and remove the antenna cable ends.
6. NOTE: When installing the new cable, tape or wire-tie the new cable to the wiring harness to
prevent noise.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System Transmitter
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Alarm System Transmitter: Service and Repair
PASSIVE ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM (PATS) TRANSCEIVER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the steering wheel. 2. Remove the 2 screws and the lower steering column shroud. 3.
Remove the ignition lock cylinder cover. 4. Disconnect the PATS transceiver electrical connector.
5. Remove the screw and the PATS transceiver.
6. NOTE: Replacement of the PATS transceiver does not require the PATS keys to be
programmed into the instrument cluster again.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Alarm System
Transponder > Component Information > Diagrams
C2007
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Diagrams
C500
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8874
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Testing and Inspection
KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD CODE PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Up to 3 codes can be programmed. Once there are 3 programmed codes, any attempt to
program additional codes will be unsuccessful.
1. Enter the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code.
2. NOTE: The locks should lock and unlock to indicate programming mode has been entered.
Press the 1/2 button within 5 seconds to activate the programming mode. Holding the 1/2 button for
more than 2 seconds after activation erases the stored customer codes.
3. Within 5 seconds, enter the new 5-digit keypad code. The doors lock and unlock to confirm the
new code is programmed. If the locks do not lock
and unlock, the new code programming has not been successful and the procedure must be
started from the beginning.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Key-Pad > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8875
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair
KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the exterior mirror. 2. Remove the front door outer glass weatherstrip.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Release the tabs and remove the keyless entry keypad.
- Disconnect the keypad harness retaining clips from the weatherstrip.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Programming
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Programming
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY TRANSMITTER PROGRAMMING
NOTE:
- All remote keyless entry (RKE) transmitters must be programmed at the same time.
- Programming (or reprogramming) of the RKE transmitters can be accomplished using a scan tool
or by carrying out the following steps.
- Do not apply the brake pedal during this sequencing, as doing so ends the sequence and the
transmitters will not be programmed.
1. Electronically unlock the door locks using the door lock control switch. 2. Turn the ignition switch
from the OFF to the RUN position 8 times in rapid succession (within 10 seconds), with the eighth
turn ending in RUN.
If the module successfully enters program mode, it locks and then unlocks all the doors.
3. NOTE: If no action is taken within 20 seconds after a transmitter has been programmed, the
programming sequence ends (the doors lock and
unlock to confirm that programming is complete).
Within 20 seconds, press any button on the RKE transmitter to be programmed. The doors lock
and then unlock to confirm that each RKE transmitter is programmed. Repeat this step for each
RKE transmitter.
4. Exiting the programming mode is accomplished if one of the following occurs:
- The key transitions to the OFF position.
- 20 seconds have passed since entering programming mode or since the last RKE transmitter was
programmed.
- The maximum number (4) of RKE transmitters have been programmed.
5. Check the operation of the transmitter. If the door locks do not respond for the programmed RKE
transmitter(s), wait several seconds and press the
button again. If the door locks still fail to respond, refer to Locks, Latches and Entry Systems.
(Make sure that no more than the maximum number of RKE transmitters are attempted to be
programmed.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Programming >
Page 8880
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Autolock and Horn Chirp Programming
AUTOLOCK AND HORN CHIRP PROGRAMMING
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE:
- This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
- The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
- The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position. 2. Press the unlock button on the
door lock control 3 times. 3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position. 4. Press the
unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times. 5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN
position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The unlock button must be pressed twice within 5 seconds.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the unlock button on the door lock
control switch twice within 5 seconds to enable/disable the autolock feature. The horn chirps once if
the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE:
- This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
- The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
- The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position. 2. Press the unlock button on the
door unlock control 3 times. 3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position. 4. Press
the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times. 5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN
position.The horn chirps one time to indicate that programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The lock and unlock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the lock button on the door lock
control switch then the unlock button to enable/disable the auto-unlock feature. The horn chirps
once if the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Perimeter Lighting Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position. 2. Press the unlock button on the
door unlock control 3 times. 3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position. 4. Press
the unlock button on the door unlock control switch 3 times. 5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN
position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The lock and unlock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the lock button on the door lock
control switch then the unlock button to enable/disable the perimeter lighting feature. The horn
chirps once if the perimeter lighting is disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the perimeter lighting
is enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Programming >
Page 8881
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE:
- The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
- The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure needs to be repeated.
If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code. 2. Press and hold the 3/4 button. 3. While holding the 3/4
button, press and release the 7/8 button. 4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if the
autolocks are disabled, or chirps once followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE:
- The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
- The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code. 2. Press and hold the 3/4 button. 3. While holding the 3/4
button, press and release the 7/8 button twice. 4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if
auto-unlock is disabled, or chirps once followed by a honk if auto-unlock is enabled.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Memory Activation
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Remote Memory Activation
REMOTE MEMORY ACTIVATION
1. Move the seat, rear view mirrors, and adjustable pedals to the desired position. 2. Press the
memory set switch SET button. 3. Within 5 seconds, press any button on the remote transmitter
(except the PANIC button), and then press the appropriate memory set switch
button.
4. Repeat Steps 1-3 for each remote transmitter to be programmed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Keyless Entry > Keyless
Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Remote Memory Activation > Page 8884
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Remote Memory Deactivation
REMOTE MEMORY DEACTIVATION
1. Press the memory set switch SET button. 2. Within 5 seconds, press any button on the remote
transmitter that is to be deactivated (except the PANIC button), and then press the memory set
switch SET button.
3. Repeat Steps 1 and 2 for each remote transmitter to be deactivated from the memory setting.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Parking Assist Control Module: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8889
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8890
C4226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8891
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
PARKING AID MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking aid module sub-harness from the body harness. 2. Remove the rear
bumper cover. 3. Remove the 4 insulator-to-bumper cover nuts and the insulator from the bumper
cover. 4. Disconnect the parking aid module sub-harness from the parking aid module. 5. Remove
the 2 parking aid module bracket bolts. 6. Remove the parking aid module bracket assembly. 7.
Release the module tabs from the bracket and remove the module from the bracket. 8. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams
C4015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Collision Avoidance and Parking Assist Systems >
Parking Assist Warning Indicator > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8895
Parking Assist Warning Indicator: Service and Repair
PARKING AID SPEAKER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the bolt and the speaker and bracket assembly.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Driver/Vehicle Information Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 >
Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Customer Interest Instruments - Message Center Switches
Inop/Other Errors
TSB 07-7-4
04/16/07
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCHES INOP-TEXT BLANK/SCRAMBLED/COMPASS INOP/WASHER
LIGHT ON/OAT READS HIGH
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/22/2006 may exhibit concerns
with the Instrument Cluster (IC). The outside air temp reads 140 °F (60 °C), message center
switches unresponsive/text blank or scrambled, compass display is inoperative, washer fluid level
light is on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE IC ASSEMBLY UNTIL COMPLETE DIAGNOSIS HAS BEEN PERFORMED.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check the build date code of the IC. The date code is displayed in the message center during
"engineering test mod&'.
Engineering Test Mode:
1. Ignition in "OFF" position.
2. Cluster type.
a. For Base Clusters (without message center cluster): depress the reset stem on the cluster while
turning the ignition switch to the "ON" position.
b. Message Center Clusters: depress the reset button in the vehicle while turning the ignition switch
to the "ON" position.
3. Continue to hold down the reset stem/button for 5 seconds until the cluster message center
displays "engineering test mode".
4. Press/cycle reset stem/button until the message center displays "manufacture" and the date of
manufacture (MM-DD-YYYY).
5. If the date is after 12/22/2006, this TSB does not apply and proceed with normal diagnostics
found in Workshop Manual (WSM), Sections 413-01 and 413-08.
6. Turn the vehicle ignition to the "OFF" position to exit the "engineering test mode".
Outside Air Temperature (OAT) Diagnostics
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS FOR VEHICLES WITHOUT (ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE
CONTROL) EATC.
1. Run vehicle for 5 minutes.
2. Verify the OAT reads 140 °F (60 °C) in the Message Center.
3. Disconnect the OAT sensor.
4. Does the Message Center still read 140 °F (60 °C)?
a. Yes - proceed to Step 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Driver/Vehicle Information Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 >
Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 8904
b. No - follow WSM, Section 413-08.
5. Disconnect battery.
6. Disconnect IC.
7. Measure the resistance between pins 1 and 2 on Connector C132.
a. Resistance less than 1 Meg-Ohms - Repair shorted circuits.
b. Resistance greater than 1 Meg-Ohms - Proceed to Step 8.
8. Reconnect IC and OAT sensor.
9. Reconnect battery, to verify IC connection. If Message Center still reads 140 °F (60 °C), replace
IC.
Message Center (MC) Switch, Diagnostics:
Refer to WSM, Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate
Correctly
Low Washer Fluid Level Light On, Diagnostics
1. Verify low washer fluid level light is on and washer bottle is full.
2. Verify washer fluid level switch is fully seated in the bottle. Is light still on?
a. No - repair is complete.
b. Yes - proceed to Step 3.
3. Disconnect the washer fluid level switch. Does the light go out after one minute?
a. Yes - proceed with normal WSM, Section 413-01 Diagnostics.
b. No - proceed to Step 4.
4. Disconnect battery.
5. Disconnect IC.
6. Measure the resistance on Pins 1 and 2 of Connector C138. Is the resistance less than 1
Meg-Ohms?
a. Yes - repair shorted wires.
b. No - proceed to step 7.
7. Reconnect the washer fluid level switch, IC and then battery to verify IC connections. If light is
still on, replace the IC.
No Compass Display Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative.
Message Center Display Blank/Text Scrambled, Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Symptom Chart
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070704 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Driver/Vehicle Information Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 >
Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 8905
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
10849 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Driver/Vehicle Information Display: > 07-7-4 >
Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Message Center
Switches Inop/Other Errors
TSB 07-7-4
04/16/07
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCHES INOP-TEXT BLANK/SCRAMBLED/COMPASS INOP/WASHER
LIGHT ON/OAT READS HIGH
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/22/2006 may exhibit concerns
with the Instrument Cluster (IC). The outside air temp reads 140 °F (60 °C), message center
switches unresponsive/text blank or scrambled, compass display is inoperative, washer fluid level
light is on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE IC ASSEMBLY UNTIL COMPLETE DIAGNOSIS HAS BEEN PERFORMED.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check the build date code of the IC. The date code is displayed in the message center during
"engineering test mod&'.
Engineering Test Mode:
1. Ignition in "OFF" position.
2. Cluster type.
a. For Base Clusters (without message center cluster): depress the reset stem on the cluster while
turning the ignition switch to the "ON" position.
b. Message Center Clusters: depress the reset button in the vehicle while turning the ignition switch
to the "ON" position.
3. Continue to hold down the reset stem/button for 5 seconds until the cluster message center
displays "engineering test mode".
4. Press/cycle reset stem/button until the message center displays "manufacture" and the date of
manufacture (MM-DD-YYYY).
5. If the date is after 12/22/2006, this TSB does not apply and proceed with normal diagnostics
found in Workshop Manual (WSM), Sections 413-01 and 413-08.
6. Turn the vehicle ignition to the "OFF" position to exit the "engineering test mode".
Outside Air Temperature (OAT) Diagnostics
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS FOR VEHICLES WITHOUT (ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE
CONTROL) EATC.
1. Run vehicle for 5 minutes.
2. Verify the OAT reads 140 °F (60 °C) in the Message Center.
3. Disconnect the OAT sensor.
4. Does the Message Center still read 140 °F (60 °C)?
a. Yes - proceed to Step 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Driver/Vehicle Information Display: > 07-7-4 >
Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 8911
b. No - follow WSM, Section 413-08.
5. Disconnect battery.
6. Disconnect IC.
7. Measure the resistance between pins 1 and 2 on Connector C132.
a. Resistance less than 1 Meg-Ohms - Repair shorted circuits.
b. Resistance greater than 1 Meg-Ohms - Proceed to Step 8.
8. Reconnect IC and OAT sensor.
9. Reconnect battery, to verify IC connection. If Message Center still reads 140 °F (60 °C), replace
IC.
Message Center (MC) Switch, Diagnostics:
Refer to WSM, Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate
Correctly
Low Washer Fluid Level Light On, Diagnostics
1. Verify low washer fluid level light is on and washer bottle is full.
2. Verify washer fluid level switch is fully seated in the bottle. Is light still on?
a. No - repair is complete.
b. Yes - proceed to Step 3.
3. Disconnect the washer fluid level switch. Does the light go out after one minute?
a. Yes - proceed with normal WSM, Section 413-01 Diagnostics.
b. No - proceed to Step 4.
4. Disconnect battery.
5. Disconnect IC.
6. Measure the resistance on Pins 1 and 2 of Connector C138. Is the resistance less than 1
Meg-Ohms?
a. Yes - repair shorted wires.
b. No - proceed to step 7.
7. Reconnect the washer fluid level switch, IC and then battery to verify IC connections. If light is
still on, replace the IC.
No Compass Display Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative.
Message Center Display Blank/Text Scrambled, Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Symptom Chart
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070704 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Driver/Vehicle Information Display: > 07-7-4 >
Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 8912
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
10849 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8913
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8914
C253
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8915
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Description and Operation
INFORMATION AND MESSAGE CENTER
The message center display is a green (Expedition) items or white (Navigator) vacuum fluorescent,
fixed units format, 2-line display integrated into the center of enable/ the instrument cluster and is
controlled by the entry/ message center switches. There are two basic equipped), instrument
cluster/message center configurations. items The first is the full function message center and can
in be identified by the three button message center approximately switch located in the instrument
panel center finish The panel. The second is the base cluster message decrease center and can
be identified by the single reset can button located in the instrument cluster. Both approximately
instrument cluster configurations display messages was based upon vehicle option content.
The base cluster message center functions and menus listed below can be selected through the
reset button by pressing and releasing the reset button to scroll through the menu items. The INFO
items (trip A, trip B and average fuel economy) can be reset by holding the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds. The SETUP items, (language, system configurable items [autolamps,
autolock, auto unlock etc.]) can be reset by holding the reset button for approximately 2 seconds
when the selected menu item is displayed. Refer to the Owner's Literature for complete operating
instructions for both the full function message center and the base instrument cluster message
center.
The message center provides the following features:
- Information displays
- Setup displays
- System check messages
- System warning messages
The full function message center features and menus listed below can be selected through a set of
3 buttons:
- INFO
- SETUP
- RESET
Message Center Configuration
The message center has the capability to configure items such as oil life, oil life start value,
language, units (English or metric), autolamp delay, to enable/disable a variety of options such as
easy entry/easy exit (if equipped) and air suspension (if equipped), or to carry out
calibrations/settings on items such as the compass. The oil life is displayed in percent and is preset
to a maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) or 180 days. The oil life start value is used
to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The value can be changed back to the
maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) if the value was previously changed or lowered
by 10% decrements down to 10%.
On configurable items such as parking aid on/off and air suspension on/off (if equipped) the
message center indicates the appropriate selection (ON/OFF) by bracketing the selection. An
example is as follows: PARKING AID OFF. The parking aid is enabled or on in the previous
example. If the driver selects the parking aid off, the display would be: PARKING AID ON .
Reconfigurable Telltale Indicators
The message center displays reconfigurable telltale indicators in the RH side of the display area.
Reconfigurable telltale indicators replace indicators that have been typically displayed in the
instrument cluster and use the same iconic representation.
Compass and Outside Air Temperature Displays
The message center provides a compass display and uses directional information sent from a
compass module, located on the underside of the inside rear view mirror.
The message center provides an outside air temperature display on vehicles that are not equipped
with electronic automatic temperature control (EATC).
Information Displays
The information displays are non-timed modes. The selected mode remains on until the driver
presses a message center button to change the mode or it is overridden by another mode.
The information display modes are: Odometer
- Trip odometer
- Outside air temperature display (if equipped)
- Compass
- Distance to empty (DTE)
- Average fuel economy
- Instantaneous fuel economy
- Blank display
Setup Displays
The setup displays are timed modes and terminate after a finite interval.The setup display modes
are:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8916
- System check
- Oil life
- Units English/metric
- Autolamp delay in seconds (if equipped)
- Easy entry/easy exit seat on/off (if equipped)
- Air suspension on/off (if equipped)
- Autolocks on/off (if equipped)
- Power liftgate on/off (if equipped)
- Power running boards auto/off/out (if equipped)
- Compass zone
- Compass calibration
- Language
System Check
The system check provides a check of all the monitored systems on the vehicle. The system check
scrolls through each of the monitored systems and provides a visual indication to report out the
status of each system. The message center displays OK for approximately 2 seconds if the system
check does not detect a fault in the system and displays a warning message for approximately 2
seconds if the system check detects a fault in the system. Press the RESET button to scroll
through the system check messages.
The system check messages are: OIL LIFE
- CHARGING SYSTEM
- WASHER FLUID LOW
- DOOR STATUS
- LIFTGATE/GLASS
- BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
- TIRE PRESSURE SYSTEM (if equipped)
- AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM (if equipped)
- FUEL LEVEL
System Warning Messages
The system warning messages alert the operator to possible problems or malfunctions in the
vehicle operating systems. The message center displays the last selected feature if there are no
additional warning messages. Once a warning message has been displayed, the message must be
acknowledged to allow full functionality of the message center. Press the RESET to acknowledge
and clear the warning message. The warning messages are divided into 4 categories: -
Cannot be cleared until the condition is corrected.
- Reappear on the display 10 minutes from the reset if the condition has not been corrected.
- Do not reappear until an ignition OFF-ON cycle has been completed.
- Reappear if the condition clears then reoccurs within the same ignition cycle ON-OFF cycle.
The warning display that cannot be reset is: PARK AID ON/OFF
The warning messages that reoccur after 10 minutes are: CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM
- XXX MILES (km) TO E FUEL LOW
- PARK BRAKE ENGAGED
The warning messages that display whenever the ignition switch is turned from the OFF position to
the ON position are: BRAKE FLUID LEVEL LOW
- CHECK PARK BRAKE
- WASHER FLUID LEVEL LOW
- OIL CHANGE REQUIRED
- XXX% OIL LIFE CHANGE SOON
- CHECK AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM (if equipped)
The warning messages that return after a condition has cleared then reoccurs within the same
ignition ON-OFF cycle are: DRIVER DOOR AJAR
- PASSENGER DOOR AJAR
- REAR LEFT DOOR AJAR
- REAR RIGHT DOOR AJAR
- LIFTGATE/GLASS AJAR
- CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM
- TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT (if equipped)
- LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped)
- TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT (if equipped)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 8917
- 4X4 SHIFT IN PROGRESS (if equipped)
- AIR SUSPENSION OFF (if equipped)
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during the operation
of the four wheel drive (4WD) system (late build only). The displayed warning messages are as
follows: FOR 4X4 STOP VEHICLE (if equipped)
- FOR 4X4 LOW APPLY BRAKE (if equipped)
- FOR 4X4 LOW SHIFT TO N (if equipped)
- TO EXIT 4X4 LOW STOP VEHICLE (if equipped)
- TO EXIT 4X4 LOW APPLY BRAKE (if equipped)
- TO EXIT 4X4 LOW SHIFT TO N (if equipped)
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during repair
procedures related to the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). The displayed warning
messages are as follows: TRAIN LEFT TIRE (if equipped)
- TRAIN LEFT REAR TIRE (if equipped)
- TRAIN RIGHT FRONT TIRE (if equipped)
- TRAIN RIGHT REAR TIRE (if equipped)
- TRAIN SPARE TIRE (if equipped)
- TRAINING COMPLETE (if equipped)
- TIRES NOT TRAINED-REPEAT (if equipped)
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during repair
procedures related to the compass display. The displayed warning messages are as follows: RESET FOR ZONE SETTING
- ZONE XX RESET = CHANGE
- RESET FOR CALIBRATION
- CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE
- CALIBRATION COMPLETED
- COMPASS DATA ERROR
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during repair
procedures related to the oil life and oil life start value. The displayed warning messages are as
follows: OIL LIFE XXX% HOLD RESET = NEW
- OIL LIFE SET TO XXX%
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network), No Power To The Scan Tool, to
diagnose no communication with the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to diagnose no response from the
powertrain control module (PCM).
7. Carry out the network test:
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus (Module Communications Network).
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the instrument cluster. 9. If
the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, refer to the Instrument Cluster Diagnostic Trouble
Code (DTC) Chart. See: Diagnostic Trouble
Code Descriptions
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
The message center is an integral part of the instrument cluster that receives and acts upon much
of the same information that is input and used to operate the instrument cluster gauges, indicators,
warning indicators and reconfigurable telltale indicators. The message center, located in the center
of the instrument cluster is a vacuum fluorescent 2-line display. The message center electronic
functions use both hardwired, and the controller area network (CAN) circuitry to transmit and
receive information.
Whenever conditions are present that require a warning message, the message center replaces
the last selected display with the new warning display. Once the message is reset or cleared, the
message center returns to the last selected display. If multiple warnings are present, the message
center displays each warning for approximately 4 seconds. Warning messages are also generally
associated with other observable instrument cluster indications. For example, when the LH front
door is opened, the message center displays the message DRIVER DOOR AJAR along with the
door ajar reconfigurable telltale indicator. This allows the message center to be a more informative
supplement to the instrument cluster gauges and indicators.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8920
It is very important to understand:
- where the input (command) originates.
- all the information (messages) necessary in order for a feature to operate.
- which module(s) receive(s) the input or command message.
- if the module that received the input (message) controls the output of the feature, or if it outputs a
message over the CAN to another module.
- which module controls the output of the feature.
Instrument Cluster Messages
NOTE: Whenever a message is suspected as missing, confirmed by a missing message DTC, it is
important to look for other symptoms that may also be present in the instrument cluster and
throughout the vehicle. Once a DTC is set in the instrument cluster it may be helpful to review the
complete message list available in Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to see what
other modules also rely on the same message and run the self-test for those modules. If the
message is missing from other modules, the same DTC may also be set in those modules.
Confirmation of missing messages common to multiple modules may indicate that the originating
module is the source of the concern or the communication network may be experiencing some
problems.
The instrument cluster uses input messages from other modules to control the gauges,
informational indicators, warning indicators and reconfigurable telltale indicators over the
communication networks. If a required message is missing or invalid for less than 5 seconds, the
gauge or indicator that requires the message remains at the last commanded state based upon the
last known good message. For example, if the message is missing the O/D off status for less than
5 seconds and the O/D off indicator was ON (O/D cancelled), the indicator remains in the ON state
until the next good message is received. If the message remains missing or invalid for greater than
5 seconds, the instrument cluster sets a U-code DTC and the output becomes a default action for
the indicator or gauge. Each indicator or gauge utilizes a different default strategy depending on
the nature of the indication. Refer Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators. for further
descriptions of the default action specific to each indicator or gauge. If the messaged input to the
cluster returns at any time, the normal function of the gauge or indicator resumes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8921
B1255-B2097 / U2013
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8922
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8923
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8924
Symptom Chart (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8925
Symptom Chart (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8926
Symptom Chart (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8927
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Pinpoint Tests
Test A: The Message Center Is Not Operating Correctly
PINPOINT TEST A: THE MESSAGE CENTER IS NOT OPERATING CORRECTLY
A1
Normal Operation
The message center is located in the center of the instrument cluster between the tachometer and
the speedometer in the vacuum fluorescent display area. The message center is integral to the
instrument cluster and uses the same voltage supply as the instrument cluster. The RUN/START
voltage is supplied to the instrument cluster on circuit CBP29 (WH/VT) and the keep alive B+
voltage is received on circuit SBP26 (YE/RD). The instrument cluster ground is received through
circuit GD133 (BK). The message center functionality is controlled through the message center
switches, which are hardwired to the instrument cluster through the input circuit CMC29 (GN/VT)
and the return circuit VMC29 (YE).
Possible Causes
- Message center switches
- Instrument cluster
Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST B: THE MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY
B1-B2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8928
B2-B4
Normal Operation
The message center functionality is controlled through the message center switch, which is
hardwired to the instrument cluster through the input circuit CMC29 (GN/VT) and the return circuit
VMC29 (YE). There are 3 message center switch buttons with each button operating a switch that
uses different resistance values. The instrument cluster sends out a reference voltage to the
message center switch on the input circuit and monitors the input voltage when a message center
switch button is pressed. The input voltage will vary depending upon the resistance of each button,
providing a specific indication to the instrument cluster which switch is pressed.
Possible Causes
- Circuit CMC29 (GN/VT) open or short to ground
- Circuit VMC29 (YE) open or short to ground
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8929
- Message center switch
- Instrument cluster
Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST C: THE COMPASS IS INOPERATIVE
C1-C3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8930
C3-C4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8931
C5
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module receives voltage from the smart junction box (SJB) through circuit
CBP31 (BU/OG) and is grounded through circuit GD133 (BK). The compass sensor module
communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster through the compass communication
data plus circuit VMC31 (YE/GN) and compass communication data minus circuit VMC30 (BU/GY).
DTC B2097 - sets in continuous memory if the instrument cluster detects invalid data sent from the
compass module.
DTC U2013 - is a continuous memory and on-demand DTC that sets if the instrument cluster is
missing the compass data from the compass module. If the instrument cluster fails to receive the
compass data, the instrument cluster sets DTC U2013 and defaults the compass display to (----).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBP31 (BU/OG) open
- Circuit GD133 (BK) open
- Circuit VMC30 (BU/GY) open or short to ground
- Circuit VMC31 (YE/GN) open or short to ground
- Compass sensor module
Test D: The Compass Is Inaccurate
PINPOINT TEST D: THE COMPASS IS INACCURATE
D1
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster through
the compass communication data plus circuit
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8932
VMC31 (YE/GN) and compass communication data minus circuit VMC30 (BU/GY). The magnetic
fields generated by the earths north and south poles are divided into zones that differ from each
other with respect to how the magnetic fields appear. The magnetic north can change by up to 4
degrees between zones and become noticeable across multiple zones. The compass zone must
be set to the correct zone for the compass to read accurately. Factors within the vehicle may affect
the ability of the compass module to accurately read the magnetic north. Calibrating the compass
allows the compass module to compensate for vehicle factors that influence the accuracy of the
compass.
NOTE: Outside factors such as bridges, steel structures, tall buildings and power lines also affect
compass accuracy.
Possible Causes
- Compass sensor module
- Zone setting
- Calibration
Test E: The Outside Air Temperature Sensor Does Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST E: THE OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR DOES NOT OPERATE
CORRECTLY
E1-E4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8933
E4-E5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8934
E6-E7
Normal Operation
The outside air temperature sensor is mounted on the radiator core support in front of the radiator
and A/C condenser and is hardwired to the instrument cluster through input circuit VH407 (YE/GN)
and return circuit VMC29 (YE). The instrument cluster provides a reference voltage to the ambient
air temperature sensor and monitors the change in voltage resulting from changes in resistance as
determined by outside air temperature. When the engine has been off for 2 hours, or the engine
temperature is cold, the instrument cluster displays the current outside air temperature as
measured by the ambient air temperature sensor. When the time is less than 2 hours, or if the
engine is not cold, the instrument cluster takes a reading of the current temperature and compares
the current reading against the last reading at key off. If the temperature is less than the last key off
temperature reading, the instrument cluster displays the current temperature. If the temperature is
greater than the last key off temperature reading, the instrument cluster displays the last key off
temperature reading until the ambient air temperature has had time to stabilize with vehicle
movement.
DTC B1255 - is a continuous and on-demand DTC that sets if the instrument cluster detects an
open on the outside air temperature sensor input, circuit VH407 (YE/GN). If the instrument cluster
detects an open on the outside air temperature input, the instrument cluster defaults the display to
23.89°C (75°F).
DTC B1257 - is a continuous and on-demand DTC that sets if the instrument cluster detects a short
to ground on the outside air temperature sensor input, circuit VH407 (YE/GN). If the instrument
cluster detects a short to ground on the outside air temperature input, the instrument cluster
defaults the display to 23.89°C (75°F).
Possible Causes
- Circuit RH111 (GY/BU) open
- Circuit VH407 (YE/GN) open, short to voltage or ground
- Circuit VMC29 (YE) open or short to voltage
- Outside air temperature sensor
- Instrument cluster
Test F: The Parking Aid On/Off Warning Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST F: THE PARKING AID ON/OFF WARNING IS INOPERATIVE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8935
F1-F5
Normal Operation
The parking aid on/off status is sent from the parking aid module to the instrument cluster over the
medium speed controller area network (MS-CAN) communication bus lines. When the RESET
button is pressed, the instrument cluster sends a query to the parking aid module, requesting a
system status. The parking aid module responds to the instrument cluster with the status of the
system, either on or off. If the return status message is missing or corrupted, the instrument cluster
does not display the brackets around either the ON or OFF selection.
Possible Causes
- Instrument cluster configuration
- Parking aid system
- Instrument cluster
Test G: The Check Air Suspension or Air Suspension Off Warning Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST G: THE CHECK AIR SUSPENSION OR AIR SUSPENSION OFF WARNING IS
INOPERATIVE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8936
G1-G3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8937
G4-G6
Normal Operation
The air suspension on/off status is sent from the air suspension module to the instrument cluster
over the high speed controller area network (HS-CAN) communication bus lines. When the RESET
button is pressed, the instrument cluster sends a query to the air suspension module, requesting a
system status. The air suspension module responds to the instrument cluster with the status of the
system, either on or off. If the return status message is missing or corrupted, the instrument cluster
does not display the brackets around either the ON or OFF selection.
Possible Causes
- Instrument cluster configuration
- Air suspension system
- Air suspension module
- Instrument cluster
Test H: The 4X4 Shift In Progress Warning Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST H: THE 4X4 SHIFT IN PROGRESS WARNING IS INOPERATIVE
H1-H4
Normal Operation
The four wheel drive (4WD) control module sends the instrument cluster a message over the high
speed controller area network (HS-CAN) communication bus lines when the 4WD system is in the
process of shifting out of two wheel drive (2WD) and has not yet fully shifted into 4x4 high, 4x4 low
or 4x4 auto. Once the shift is completed, the 4WD control module removes the 4x4 shift in progress
message and sends a new message to turn on the applicable reconfigurable telltale indicator.
Possible Causes
- Instrument cluster configuration
- 4WD system
- 4WD control module
- Instrument cluster
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Procedures
Oil Life Reset - Message Center Cluster
OIL LIFE RESET - MESSAGE CENTER CLUSTER
NOTE:
- The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) or 180 days.
- The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example, the
message center may display OIL LIFE =80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW. 2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 3. Press and release the SETUP button to exit
the procedure.
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster
OIL LIFE RESET - BASE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
NOTE:
- All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the instrument
cluster.
- The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) or 180 days.
- The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example, the
message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press and release the reset button to exit the
procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
OIL LIFE START VALUE - MESSAGE CENTER CLUSTER
NOTE:
- The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The value
can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) if the value was
previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
- The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example, the
message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW. 2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Press the RESET button once for each 10% reduction below the default 100% until the message
center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
4. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster
OIL LIFE START VALUE - BASE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
NOTE:
- All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the instrument
cluster.
- The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The value
can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) if the value was
previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press the RESET button to lower 10% from
the default 100% until the message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
6. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Repeat steps 2-5 for each desired 10% reduction.
7. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8940
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Removal and Replacement
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 8941
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Pull the instrument panel center finish panel straight out to release the retaining clips.
Navigator
2. NOTE: The transmission selector lever bezel is held in place by 4 tabs that are located in the
shifter assembly.
Remove the transmission selector lever bezel.
3. Open the floor console compartment door and pull the floor console finish panel straight up to
release the retainer clips. 4. Remove the 2 screws and pull the instrument panel center finish panel
straight out to release the retainer clips.
- Position the instrument panel center finish panel aside.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 6. Press the 4 retaining tabs and remove the message
center switch from the center instrument panel finish panel. 7. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Driver/Vehicle Information Display > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 8942
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Diagrams
Auxiliary Input / Output Jack: Diagrams
C2362
C3312
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > Auxiliary Input / Output Jack,
Entertainment System > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8947
Auxiliary Input / Output Jack: Service and Repair
AUDIO INPUT JACK
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Remove the instrument panel center finish panel.
Navigator
2. Remove the front floor console center finish panel.
All vehicles
3. Release the tabs and remove the audio input jack.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Diagrams
C949
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8951
DVD Player: Service and Repair
DIGITAL VERSATILE DISC (DVD) PLAYER
Removal
NOTE: Programmable module installation (PMI) only needs to be carried out if the DVD player is
being replaced.
1. Upload the DVD player configuration to the scan tool.
2. NOTE: Open the DVD player display.
Remove the 4 screws.
3. Remove the DVD player.
- Pull down on the sides of the DVD player to disengage the clips from the bracket.
- Using a suitable tool, push the rear most U-hook forward and release the U-hooks.
- Hang the DVD player on the J-hooks and disconnect the electrical connector.
- Remove the DVD player from the J-hooks.
Installation
1. Hang the DVD player on the J-hooks. 2. Connect the electrical connector. 3. Remove the DVD
player from the J-hooks.
4. NOTE: Tilt the DVD player, as necessary, to align it correctly.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Entertainment Systems > DVD Player > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 8952
Align the left side guide pin with the left side locating hole.
5. Lift up the right side of the DVD player and engage the U-hooks. 6. Install the 4 screws. 7. Push
on the left and right sides of the DVD player to engage the clips. 8. Download the DVD player
configuration from the scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Description and Operation
UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER
The universal transmitter is an integral part of the LH sun visor and provides a convenient way to
substitute up to 3 hand-held transmitters with a single built-in device. The universal transmitter can
learn the radio frequency codes of most current transmitters. The universal transmitter:
- operates garage doors, gates and home/office lighting and security systems.
- learns and transmits the radio frequency of up to 3 hand-held transmitters from any of the
systems mentioned above.
- is powered by the vehicle battery and charging system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Visually inspect the following for obvious signs of mechanical
damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Mechanical Universal transmitter
- Receiver
3. If an obvious cause for an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible)
before proceeding to the next step. 4. If the fault is not visually evident, verify the symptom. GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8958
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8959
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Pinpoint Tests
PINPOINT TEST A: THE UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER IS INOPERATIVE
A1-A2
Normal Operation
The universal transmitter receives voltage on circuit CLN09 (YE/GN) and ground on circuit GD150
(BK/WH).
Possible Causes
- Receiver unit
- Universal transmitter
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Garage Door Opener Transmitter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 8960
Garage Door Opener Transmitter: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Universal Transmitter Programming
UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER PROGRAMMING
WARNING: A garage door opening system that cannot stop or reverse itself after detecting an
object in its path does not meet current federal safety standards. To decrease the risk of serious
injury or death, do not use this universal transmitter with a door opening system that lacks stop and
reverse features as required by federal standards. This includes any garage door opening system
manufactured before April 1, 1982. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
1. Verify the hand-held transmitter is operative. 2. Prepare for programming the universal
transmitter by erasing all 3 channels by holding down the 2 outside buttons until the red light begins
to
flash (20-30 seconds). Release both buttons.
3. Select 1 of the 3 universal transmitter channels to be programmed by pressing the desired
button. 4. Hold the end of the hand-held transmitter 25-51 mm (1-2 in) from the front surface of the
universal transmitter so that the red light can still be
seen.
5. NOTE: During programming, the hand-held transmitter may automatically stop transmitting after
2 seconds, which may not be long enough to
program the universal transmitter. If programming this type of hand-held transmitter, continue to
hold the button on the universal transmitter while pressing the hand-held transmitter button every 2
seconds.
Use both hands to press the hand-held transmitter button and the desired button on the universal
transmitter. Do not release either button.
6. Hold down both buttons until the red light on the universal transmitter flashes, first slowly and
then rapidly. Release both buttons when the rapid
flashing begins. The universal transmitter has successfully learned the new frequency signal and
can be used in place of the hand-held transmitter(s).
7. To operate, press the appropriate button on the universal transmitter. The red light is on while
the signal is being transmitted. 8. To program additional hand-held transmitters repeat Steps 3-6.
Training a Garage Door Opener Equipped With "Rolling Codes"
1. Program the hand-held transmitter to the universal transmitter. 2. Train the garage door opener
receiver to recognize the universal transmitter.
1 Remove the cover panel from the garage door opener receiver.
2 Locate the training button on the garage door opener receiver. Location and color of the button
may vary by garage door opener manufacturer. Refer to the garage door opener instruction
manual.
3 Press the training button on the garage door opener receiver for 1-2 seconds.
4 Press the programmed universal transmitter button for as long as the universal transmitter red
light flashes (1-2 seconds). Release the button and press the button to confirm the universal
transmitter is trained to the receiver.
5 The garage door opener should recognize the universal transmitter.
Erasing Channels
ERASING CHANNELS
1. NOTE: Individual channels cannot be erased, but can be reprogrammed using the procedures
for programming.
To erase all 3 programmed channels, hold down the 2 outside buttons until the red light begins to
flash (20-30 seconds). Release both buttons.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8965
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C341A
C341B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8966
C341C
C341D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8967
C341E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Belt Tower Position
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the outboard side of the driver
seat track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver
seat position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8974
C3246
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop
Navigation System: Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek
Inop
TSB 06-25-3
11/30/06
PIONEER NAVIGATION RADIO - SEEK FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - SERVICE TIP
FORD: 2006-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2007 Fusion, Mustang 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Edge,
Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, F-150
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007 MKZ, Mark LT, MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Montego 2007 Milan 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 vehicles equipped with a Pioneer Navigation Radio may appear to have a
defective seek function. It may be reported that the radio Seek function is inoperative, Seek will not
stop (keeps scrolling through stations) or the radio exhibits Poor FM reception. This may be due to
a misunderstanding of how the operation of the PTY (Program Type) feature functions. The PTY
feature filters out radio stations that do not fit a selected category of radio programming like: Top
40, Classical, and News. The result is a "continuous seek" condition if the feature is activated and
no stations are found under the selected category.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to identify the PTY (Program Type) setting.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To confirm the PTY (Program Type) setting use the following steps:
1. Under MEDIA, select the FM tab. (If you do not see an RDS and PTY button, push the SHOW
OPTIONS buttons).
2. Verify RDS and PTY are enabled by the buttons being illuminated. If the text, above the SET
PTY button says anything other than ALL, the unit is filtering for radio stations that transmit RDS
text and are categorized as the selected Program Type, like: Top 40, Classical, and News. (See
Figure 1)
3. To change the setting, either press the SET PTY button and select ALL. Or disable the PTY
feature by pushing the PTY button.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop > Page 8979
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18806 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop > Page 8980
Navigation System: Technical Service Bulletins Navigation System - Service Tips
TSB 06-23-15
12/06/06
SERVICE TIPS FOR OPTIONAL NAVIGATION SYSTEM RADIO
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 06-5-15 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid, 2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid, and 2003-2007 Expedition
vehicles equipped with optional Navigation systems may exhibit concerns of the Navigation display
locking up, periodic rebooting concerns and a lack of accuracy of location information. Escape
Hybrids may also experience loss of HEV power flow display and fuel economy screen displays.
ACTION
The following Service Procedure will assist with diagnosis and prevent the replacement of good
components.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Navigation radio software update procedures:
Under no circumstances should you use an update CD on an Escape Hybrid. On 2003-2004 model
year Expeditions, do not update the Radio software unless the update disc is part of a complete set
of Navigation Map Discs/DVD. Only those map discs should be used with the update included with
the set. The map CD's and the update disc's are matched sets.
The table above shows compatible audio / navigational software version numbers for the Hybrid
Escape and Expedition navigation radios. These software version numbers can be accessed
through a menu on the navigational unit, refer to 2006 Expedition Workshop Manual, Section
419-07 for more details. This table may be helpful in determining whether the software on a
particular navigational unit has been incorrectly updated in the past.
NOTE
DO NOT REPROGRAM SOFTWARE UNLESS A CUSTOMER HAS PURCHASED A MAP
UPGRADE AND IT IS REQUIRED FOR AN 03/04 EXPEDITION.
2. Hybrid fuel economy / PowerFlow screen display issues:
These functions are unique to the HEV navigation radio. Following these tips will prevent the
unnecessary replacement of good parts.
^ If the PowerFlow screen or Fuel Economy screens do not display, or have no information shown,
the radio itself is not likely defective
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop > Page 8981
^ The wiring to the gateway-SCP module (also referred to as the Audio Control Protocol Module)
and the gateway-SCP module itself should be inspected. Specifically, Connectors C2294 (A and B)
at the Gateway module, and Connector C229c at the navigation radio should be checked for issues
such as pushed out pins, connector fully seated and pin fit
^ Continuity should be measured on circuits 833, 856, and 1068 between the connectors
mentioned above
^ Powers and grounds to the gateway-SCP module should also be checked
^ The gateway module itself should also be inspected for damage before replacing the radio
^ If another HEV unit is available, swapping the gateway-SCP module can determine if the module
is functioning correctly
3. Navigation disc care and handling:
For some concerns of the navigation display locking up, periodic rebooting, blank screen, no
vehicle cursor display, vehicle cursor display with no map screen display, and inability to eject disc
maybe caused by dirty or damaged CDs. In most cases dirty or scratched map CDs are the likely
cause of the listed concerns and can be detected with the "CDROM status" diagnostic function test.
NOTE
INFORMATION DISCS ARE MOR[ SENSITIVE TO CLEANLINESS AND CONDITION THAN
AUDIO DISCS. TO CLEAN DISCS, USE A SOFT, NONABRASIVE, LINT FREE CLOTH. DO NOT
CLEAN THE DISC IN A CIRCULAR MOTION. CLEAN THE DISC FROM THE INNER HUB TO
THE OUTSIDE TO MINIMIZE SCRATCHING. DO NOT USE A CLEANING SOLUTION ON
DISCS. IF POSSIBLE, TRY KNOWN GOOD DISCS FROM ANOTHER VEHICLE IN SUSPECT
UNIT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18K931 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Navigation System: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8984
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8985
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8986
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8987
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8988
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8989
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8990
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8991
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8992
Navigation System: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8993
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8994
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8995
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8996
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8997
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8998
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8999
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9000
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9001
Navigation System: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
130-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9002
130-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9003
130-3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9004
130-4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9005
130-5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9006
130-6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9007
130-7
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9008
130-8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9009
130-9
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9010
130-10
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9011
130-11
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9012
130-12
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9013
130-13
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9014
130-14
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9015
130-15
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9016
130-16
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9017
130-18
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9018
130-19
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9019
130-20
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 9020
Navigation System: Description and Operation
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
The vehicle navigation system audibly and visually guides the user to a selected destination. The
system uses a global positioning system (GPS) antenna, a vehicle speed input, and other sensor
information to accurately establish the vehicle position. The audio unit provides the visual and
audible instructions of the maneuvers required to arrive at the pre-entered destination.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Navigation System: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If the fault is visually
evident, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network), No Power To The Scan Tool, to
diagnose no communication with the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to diagnose no response from the
powertrain control module (PCM).
7. NOTE: Do not press any buttons on the audio unit while the audio unit is carrying out the
self-test.
Carry out the network test: If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information Bus
(Module Communications Network).
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the audio unit. 9. If the
DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, go to the Audio Unit Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)
Chart. See: Diagnostic Trouble Code
Descriptions
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, go to the Navigation Audio Unit
Self-Diagnostics. See: Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble
Codes
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
Navigation System
The navigation module is integrated in the audio unit and controls the operation and the interface
between the user, the vehicle subsystems, and the external components. The navigation audio unit
is on the medium speed controller area network (MS-CAN) and can be diagnosed with a scan tool.
The vehicle navigation system guides the user to a pre-entered destination. A map digital versatile
disc (DVD) stored in the navigation audio unit is used for calculating the vehicle course. The audio
unit display audibly and visually instructs the user of the maneuvers required to arrive at the
destination entered.
A voice recognition system allows the user to interface with the system without using the touch
screen. A microphone located in the rear view mirror provides a direct input to the navigation
module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9023
In order to calculate initial vehicle position, the global positioning system (GPS) antenna is used to
track several available satellites simultaneously.
The vehicle speed signal (VSS) and transmission gear selected signal are received by the
navigation audio unit through the MS-CAN. These signals are used to increase the accuracy of the
displayed course.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9024
Navigation System: Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes
NAVIGATION AUDIO UNIT SELF-DIAGNOSTICS
The navigation system provides on-board diagnostics to assist with diagnosing a concern. To carry
out self-diagnostics, do the following:
Press and hold presets 3 and 6 simultaneously for 3 seconds.
Press the End Test button on the screen to exit the speaker walk-around test.
The following options are available using the on-screen buttons:
- On Demand Self Test: provides internal self-test diagnostics and displays all the diagnostic
trouble codes (DTCs) resulting from the self-test.
- View DTC's: provides a list of all DTCs currently stored in memory.
- Configuration Status: displays the current navigation audio unit configuration.
- System Info: displays the navigation audio unit part number and software information.
- GPS Info: provides satellite and current vehicle information.
- Speaker Walk Test: performs the speaker walk-around test.
- Multi-disc Test: checks the status of the compact disc (CD) player mechanism.
- Display Test: allows checking of the screen colors, and allows checking individual sectors of the
touch screen.
- Hardkey Test: provides the status (active/not active) of the audio unit buttons and touch screen.
- Radio Signal Strength: tests the antenna signal.
- Exit Diagnostics: exits diagnostics and returns to the main navigation screen.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9025
Navigation System: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
B1117-B1119
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9026
B1136-B2656
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9027
B2924-B2965 / C1992 / P0812 / U0140-U0196
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9028
U0197-U2473
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9029
Navigation System: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9030
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9031
Navigation System: Pinpoint Tests
Test A: Navigation System Does Not Operate Correctly - No Global Positioning System (GPS)
Antenna Signal
PINPOINT TEST A: NAVIGATION SYSTEM DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY - NO GLOBAL
POSITIONING SYSTEM (GPS) ANTENNA SIGNAL
A1-A4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9032
A4-A5
Normal Operation
The GPS antenna provides information from the GPS satellite system to the GPS receiver in the
audio unit. This information is used to calculate vehicle position and direction of travel.
B2204 - sets when an open, short to ground, or short to voltage is detected in the GPS antenna
circuit.
Possible Causes
- GPS antenna
- Audio unit
Test B: Navigation System Does Not Operate Correctly - The Audible Switch Feedback Is
Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST B: NAVIGATION SYSTEM DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY - THE
AUDIBLE SWITCH FEEDBACK IS INOPERATIVE
B1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9033
B1-B2
Normal Operation
The audible switch feedback settings are controlled by the audio unit. The notification can be set to
ALL, TOUCH SCREEN, or NONE, depending on user preference.
Possible Causes
- Audible switch feedback setting
- Audio unit
Test C: Navigation System Does Not Operate Correctly - The Voice Guidance Is Inoperative/Does
Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST C: NAVIGATION SYSTEM DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY - THE VOICE
GUIDANCE IS INOPERATIVE/DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9034
C1-C4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9035
C4-C7
Normal Operation
For the Audiophile navigation system, the audio unit provides voice-assisted route guidance
through the front speakers.
For the THX(R) navigation system, the audio unit sends voice guidance audio signals to the
THX(R) amplifier through circuits RMN14 (GY/BN) and VMN14 (WH/VT). The voice-assisted route
guidance is broadcast through the instrument panel speaker.
For all navigation audio systems, the volume of the voice guidance is controlled by the audio unit.
Possible Causes
- Circuit RMN14 (GY/BN) open, short to ground or voltage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9036
- Circuit VMN14 (WH/VT) open, short to ground or voltage
- THX amplifier
- Audio unit
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 9037
Navigation System: Adjustments
NAVIGATION SYSTEM CALIBRATION
1. Access the current set of regional map digital versatile discs (DVDs). 2. Start the vehicle. 3. Turn
on the audio unit. 4. Insert the appropriate regional map DVD into the DVD slot in the audio unit. 5.
Press the NAV button. 6. Press ACCEPT after reading the disclaimer. 7. Press the MAP button. 8.
Road test the vehicle until the red compass heading indicator turns green/white. 9. Leave the map
DVD in the audio unit.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Navigation System > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 9038
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Motor >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9043
C2003
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams
C2090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 07-18-5 > Sep >
07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
Pedal Positioning Switch: Customer Interest Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 07-18-5 > Sep >
07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 9055
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Pedal Positioning Switch: >
07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
Pedal Positioning Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Battery Drain/No
Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Pedal Positioning Switch: >
07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 9061
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9062
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9063
C2089
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9064
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Pedal Positioning System > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9066
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer Amplifier
C466
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer Amplifier > Page 9072
Amplifier: Diagrams THX Amplifier
C2364A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Subwoofer Amplifier > Page 9073
C2364B
C2364C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9074
Amplifier: Service and Repair
AUDIO AMPLIFIER - THX(R)
THX(R) Amplifier Lower Attachment
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9075
THX(R) Amplifier Upper Attachment
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Amplifier, Sound
System > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9076
THX(R) Amplifier Removal Routing
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the audio unit. 2. Remove the necessary attachments and move the center console 5
cm (2.0 in) towards the rear of the vehicle. 3. Disconnect the THX(R) amplifier electrical
connectors. 4. Remove the 2 lower THX(R) amplifier nuts.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. CAUTION: The THX(R) amplifier is heavy. Be sure to support the amplifier during removal, or
damage to the vehicle may occur.
Remove the 2 upper THX(R) amplifier nuts. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Remove the THX(R) amplifier.
- Route the THX(R) amplifier down and towards the passenger side of the vehicle.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop
Radio/Stereo: Technical Service Bulletins Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop
TSB 06-25-3
11/30/06
PIONEER NAVIGATION RADIO - SEEK FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - SERVICE TIP
FORD: 2006-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2007 Fusion, Mustang 2006-2007 Explorer 2007 Edge,
Expedition, Explorer Sport Trac, F-150
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007 MKZ, Mark LT, MKX, Navigator
MERCURY: 2006-2007 Montego 2007 Milan 2006-2007 Mountaineer
ISSUE Some 2006-2007 vehicles equipped with a Pioneer Navigation Radio may appear to have a
defective seek function. It may be reported that the radio Seek function is inoperative, Seek will not
stop (keeps scrolling through stations) or the radio exhibits Poor FM reception. This may be due to
a misunderstanding of how the operation of the PTY (Program Type) feature functions. The PTY
feature filters out radio stations that do not fit a selected category of radio programming like: Top
40, Classical, and News. The result is a "continuous seek" condition if the feature is activated and
no stations are found under the selected category.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure to identify the PTY (Program Type) setting.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To confirm the PTY (Program Type) setting use the following steps:
1. Under MEDIA, select the FM tab. (If you do not see an RDS and PTY button, push the SHOW
OPTIONS buttons).
2. Verify RDS and PTY are enabled by the buttons being illuminated. If the text, above the SET
PTY button says anything other than ALL, the unit is filtering for radio stations that transmit RDS
text and are categorized as the selected Program Type, like: Top 40, Classical, and News. (See
Figure 1)
3. To change the setting, either press the SET PTY button and select ALL. Or disable the PTY
feature by pushing the PTY button.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio System - Pioneer Navigation Radio - Seek Inop > Page 9081
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18806 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9082
C3290
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9083
Radio/Stereo: Service and Repair
SATELLITE RADIO RECEIVER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the center console. 2. Remove the 4 screws and the satellite radio receiver.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
- To install, tighten the screws to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control,
Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Audio Module
Remote Control: Service and Repair Auxiliary Audio Module
AUXILIARY AUDIO MODULE
Removal and Installation
Navigator
1. Remove the floor console cupholders. 2. Remove the 2 screws securing the rear trim panel to
the floor console.
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control,
Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Audio Module > Page 9088
3. Remove the 2 screws under the armrest cover.
All vehicles
4. Remove the bolt and the center console rear trim panel.
- Disengage the pin-type retainers.
- Disconnect the auxiliary audio module electrical connector.
5. Remove the auxiliary audio module.
- Remove the 4 screws.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control,
Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Service and Repair > Auxiliary Audio Module > Page 9089
Remote Control: Service and Repair Steering Wheel Controls
STEERING WHEEL CONTROLS
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE:
- It is not necessary to remove the driver air bag module during this procedure.
- When removing the steering wheel controls, disengage the RH side of the controls first.
Using an appropriate tool, pry the steering wheel controls out of the steering wheel.
2. NOTE: Do not allow the electrical connector to fall back into the steering wheel.
Remove the steering wheel controls. Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control
Module, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Center Console - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Remote Control
Module, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Page 9093
C3077
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker
C2359
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 9099
C513
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 9100
C613
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 9101
C4212
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 9102
Speaker: Diagrams
C2359
C513
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 9103
C613
C4212
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 9104
C523A
C523B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 9105
C570
C612A
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 9106
C612B
C647
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 9107
C702
C802
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Instrument Panel Speaker > Page 9108
C4337
C4338
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 9109
Speaker: Description and Operation
SPEAKERS
The following speaker configurations are available:
- Base/Premium Two front door speakers
- Two rear door speakers
- Two sail-mounted tweeter speakers
- Audiophile Two front door speakers
- Two rear door speakers
- Two sail-mounted tweeter speakers
- Two subwoofers (mounted in a single enclosure)
- THX(R) Two front door speakers
- Two rear door speakers
- Three front center imaging speakers (mounted in a single enclosure)
- Two D-pillar rear imaging speakers (part of the D-pillar trim panels)
- Two subwoofers (mounted in a single enclosure)
The THX(R) audio system is available with either the 6-CD or navigation audio unit.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Speaker
Speaker: Service and Repair Door Speaker
DOOR SPEAKER
Removal and Installation
All speakers
1. Remove the door trim panels.
Front door tweeter speaker
2. Remove the 2 screws and the door tweeter speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Speaker > Page 9112
Front or rear door speaker
3. Remove the 4 screws and the speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All speakers
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Speaker > Page 9113
Speaker: Service and Repair Subwoofer Speaker
SUBWOOFER SPEAKER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the 2 nuts, the bolt, and the subwoofer speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Speaker > Page 9114
Speaker: Service and Repair Instrument Panel Speaker
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument panel center finish panel. 2. Remove the 4 screws and the instrument
panel speaker cover. 3. Remove the 4 screws and the instrument panel speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Door Speaker > Page 9115
Speaker: Service and Repair Quarter Panel Speaker
QUARTER PANEL SPEAKER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the D-pillar trim panel. 2. Remove the 4 screws and the speaker bracket. 3. Separate
the quarter panel speaker assembly from the D-pillar trim panel. 4. Remove the 2 screws and the
quarter panel speaker. 5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9121
Accessory Delay Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9122
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Accessory Delay Module > Accessory Delay Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 9123
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Antenna Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Antenna Control Module: Service and Repair
ANTENNA ISOLATOR MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the RH C-pillar trim panel. 2. Disconnect the antenna cable connector, the antenna
isolator module electrical connector, and the antenna isolator module-to-quarter glass
connector.
3. Remove the stud and the antenna isolator module.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations
Parking Assist Control Module: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 9130
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 9131
C4226
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Parking Assist Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 9132
Parking Assist Control Module: Service and Repair
PARKING AID MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Disconnect the parking aid module sub-harness from the body harness. 2. Remove the rear
bumper cover. 3. Remove the 4 insulator-to-bumper cover nuts and the insulator from the bumper
cover. 4. Disconnect the parking aid module sub-harness from the parking aid module. 5. Remove
the 2 parking aid module bracket bolts. 6. Remove the parking aid module bracket assembly. 7.
Release the module tabs from the bracket and remove the module from the bracket. 8. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Control Module, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations
View 151-19 (Center Console - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Remote Control Module, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Page 9136
C3077
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams
C2090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
Pedal Positioning Switch: Customer Interest Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: >
07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 9149
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
Pedal Positioning Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Battery Drain/No
Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 9155
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins
for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
Heater Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage
TSB 06-21-19
10/30/06
HEATER CORE LEAKAGE AND ELECTROLYSIS (INFORMATION ONLY)
FORD: 1997-2002 Contour 1997-2007 Crown Victoria, Mustang, Taurus 2000-2007 Focus
2002-2005 Thunderbird 2005-2007 Five Hundred, Freestyle 2006-2007 Fusion 1997-1999 F-250
Light Duty 1997-2003 Windstar 1997-2007 E-Series, Expedition, Explorer, F-150, F-53 Motorhome
Chassis, F-Super Duty, Ranger
2000-2005 Excursion 2001-2003 Explorer Sport 2001-2007 Escape, Explorer Sport Trac 2004
F-150 Heritage 2004-2007 Freestar 2005-2007 Escape Hybrid 1999-2007 F-650, F-750
LINCOLN: 1997-2002 Continental 1997-2007 Town Car 2000-2006 Lincoln LS 2006 Zephyr 2007
MKZ 1998-2007 Navigator 2002-2003 Blackwood 2003-2005 Aviator 2006-2007 Mark LT
MERCURY: 1997-2002 Cougar, Mystique 1997-2005 Sable 1997-2007 Grand Marquis 2005-2007
Montego 2006-2007 Milan 1997-2002 Villager 1997-2007 Mountaineer 2005-2007 Mariner
2006-2007 Mariner Hybrid
This article supersedes TSB 01-15-6 to update the vehicle model years and Service Procedure.
ISSUE The majority of repeat heater core leaks are due to high flow rate or use of poor quality
coolant. However, electrolysis should also be checked, especially when repeat repairs have
occurred.
ACTION If the heater core is leaking, review the location of the leakage and check the condition of
the coolant.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Review the location of the leakage and check the condition of the coolant:
a. If leaks are found on the inlet (or outlet) tubes entering / exiting the heater core, it is most likely
due to due to high flow rate - replace the
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins
for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 9161
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins
for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 9162
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins
for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 9168
heater core and install a restrictor in the heater hose closest to the engine block, reference
Workshop Manual, Section 412.
b. If leaks are found in the body of the heater core itself, and does not appear to be the result of
physical damage like contact or puncture, check the coolant for possible electrolysis.
Testing For Electrolysis
Check for voltage in the cooling system by touching the negative contact of a voltmeter to the
battery ground or a known good ground and suspend the positive lead in the coolant, making sure
it is in contact with the coolant but not touching any metal part of the radiator or cooling system.
Both AC and DC voltages must be checked. Vehicles normally have DC voltages; however, a faulty
engine block heater or faulty diode in the alternator can produce AC voltages. It is understood that
coolant is lost due to heater core failure but try to obtain a voltage reading on the old coolant in the
engine block before addition to or replacement of. To keep more coolant from exiting the heater
core clamp off heater core lines and measure coolant in the engine block. Try not to dilute the
original coolant with new coolant during testing if possible.
1. Determine whether coolant condition is acceptable.
a. Remove both cables from the battery and ensure they do not contact each other or the vehicle.
b. Touch negative lead of voltmeter to engine ground and positive lead in the coolant.
NOTE
POSITIVE TEST PROBE IS IN THE COOLANT FOR TESTING.
c. Check the voltage in the cooling system. If less than or equal to 0.4 volts (V) OK, reconnect
battery cables and proceed to Step 2.
d. If greater than 0.4 V, flush cooling system thoroughly.
e. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
f. Reconnect battery cables.
g. Refill the system with appropriate Motorcraft® engine coolant.
2. Check for loose or missing grounds at static conditions.
a. Turn off all accessories. Turn ignition on but do not start engine.
b. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
c. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V on all grounds OK.
d. Any one greater than 0.4 V, check and clean ground cable connections.
e. Check accessories without using the on off switch on the vehicle instrument panel, use a jumper
wire to ground.
f. Plug in engine block heater, if equipped, and test.
g. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V.
h. Unplug engine block heater, if equipped.
3. Check for loose, missing, or inadequate grounds.
a. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
b. Crank engine but do not start.
c. Monitor voltage while cranking. less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
d. If greater than 0.4 V, ground or repair starter.
e. Start engine and run at about 2000 rpm.
f. Turn on all accessories including those customer only uses occasionally such as CB radio, cell
phone, etc.
g. Test with ground probe to battery ground, engine ground, and vehicle ground sequentially.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins
for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 06-21-19 > Oct > 06 > A/C - Heater Core Electrolysis/Leakage > Page 9169
h. Voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V OK
i. If greater than 0.4 V, turn off one item at a time until V drops to less than or equal to 0.4 V. Repair
ground to the accessory just identified.
j. Recheck voltage less than or equal to 0.4 V
k. Turn the DVOM to AC volts.
l. Check for ANY AC voltage greater than 0.4.
m. If any AC voltage is present then try turning off each accessory one at a time including blower
motor and any fan motors.
n. If AC voltage is still present then shut engine off and remove B+ from the alternator and tape it
up then retest.
o. If voltage drop is gradual to less than or equal to 0.4 V, the ground straps may simply be
overloaded by added accessories. Test by using heavy gauge jumper to ground. If indicated, install
heavier gauge ground strap(s) and recheck.
NOTE
If vehicle is equipped with electric cooling fans, be sure they cycle during this testing and monitor
voltage when they are on and when off.
CAUTION
DO NOT GROUND HEATER CORE. IF THE HEATER CORE IS GROUNDED, YOU HAVE
PROVIDED THE ELECTROLOSIS A PATH THROUGH THE HEATER CORE. THIS WOULD
CAUSE THE HEATER CORE TO BECOME AN ANODE OR RECEIVER AND IT WOULD
PROMOTE THE ELECTROLOSIS, OR ANY STRAY VOLTAGE TO USE THE COOLANT AS THE
GROUND PATH.
4. Refill the engine cooling system, reference Workshop Manual, Section 303-03.
NOTE
IF THE HEAT OUTPUT IS INSUFFICIENT, OR THE ENGINE DOES NOT REACH NORMAL
OPERATING TEMPERATURES, VERIFY PROPER THERMOSTAT OPERATION AND REPEAT
PROCEDURE IF REQUIRED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18476 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9170
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9171
C2089
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9172
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9173
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Pedal Positioning Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9174
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Brake Control Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Brake Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9179
C2142
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9184
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9185
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9186
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9187
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9188
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9189
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9190
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9191
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9192
Trailer Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9193
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9194
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9195
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9196
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9197
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9198
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9199
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9200
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9201
Trailer Connector: Connector Views
C4098
C4099
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9202
Trailer Connector: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9203
95-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Connector >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9204
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch: Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch
Trailer Hitch
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9208
WARNING: Do not permanently remove the trailer hitch. The trailer hitch is an integral part of the
vehicle frame. Always reinstall the hitch before delivery of the vehicle to the customer. Failure to
follow this instruction may compromise vehicle crash integrity and increase the risk of personal
injury in a rear end collision.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the trailer hitch rear bumper
cover trim panel, if equipped. 3. Remove the 4 trailer lighting plug cover bolts.
4. Remove the trailer lighting plug.
- Position the plug away from the trailer hitch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Remove the trailer lighting plug.
5. Remove the electrical connector from the trailer hitch and unclip the harness from the retainers
on the frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9209
6. Remove the 4 trailer hitch side mounting bolts (2 each side).
- To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
7. Remove the 4 trailer hitch lower mounting bolts (2 each side) and remove the trailer hitch.
- To install, tighten to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Hitch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9210
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Lamps: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9215
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9216
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9217
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9218
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9219
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9220
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9221
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9222
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9223
Trailer Lamps: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9224
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9225
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9226
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9227
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9228
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9229
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9230
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9231
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9232
Trailer Lamps: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9233
95-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9234
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Trailer Lamps: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Verify the exterior lighting system of the vehicle is operating
correctly. If not, refer to the appropriate pinpoint test. 3. Visually inspect the following for obvious
signs of electrical damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Battery junction box (BJB) fuse(s): 5 (40A) (trailer electric brake controller)
- 12 (25A) (trailer tow parking lamps)
- 13 (30A) (trailer tow battery charge relay switch side)
- 34 (25A) (trailer tow turn relays)
- 63 (15A) (trailer tow reversing lamps)
- Smart junction box (SJB) fuse 42 (10A) (trailer tow battery charge relay coil)
- Circuitry
- Trailer tow turn/stop relays
- Trailer tow battery charge relay
- Trailer tow parking lamp relay
- Trailer brake control module
- Trailer
- SJB
4. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9237
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9238
Trailer Lamps: Pinpoint Tests
Test X: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - All
PINPOINT TEST X: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - ALL
X1
X1 Continued
Normal Operation
The trailer tow connectors receive ground through circuit RAT08 (WH) for all of the trailer lamps.
Possible Causes
- Circuit RAT08 (WH) open
- Trailer
Test Y: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - Trailer Turn/Stoplamp
PINPOINT TEST Y: THE INDIVIDUAL TRAILER LAMP IS INOPERATIVE - TRAILER
TURN/STOPLAMP
Y1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9239
Y1-Y2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9240
Y3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9241
Y4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9242
Y5
Normal Operation
The trailer tow LH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the vehicle
LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 (YE).
The trailer tow RH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the vehicle
RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (OG).
The battery junction box (BJB) fuse 34 (25A) supplies voltage to both trailer tow turn relays. The
trailer tow turn/stop relay coils are grounded through circuit GD123 (BK/GY).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CAT06 (YE) open
- Circuit CAT09 (OG) open
- Circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) open
- Circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) open
- Circuit GD123 (BK/GY) open
- BJB
- Trailer tow turn relay
- Trailer
Test Z: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Parking Lamps
PINPOINT TEST Z: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER PARKING LAMPS
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9243
Z1-Z3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9244
Z3-Z4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9245
Z4 Continued
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9246
Z5
Normal Operation
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil is grounded through
circuit GD123 (BK/GY). The battery junction box (BJB) supplies voltage to the trailer tow parking
lamp relay switch side through circuit SBB12 (GN/RD). When the trailer tow parking lamp relay is
energized, the voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT11 (BN).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CAT11 (BN) open
- Circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) open
- Circuit GD123 (BK/GY) open
- Circuit SBB12 (GN/RD) open
- Trailer tow parking lamp relay
- Trailer
Tests AA: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Reversing Lamps
PINPOINT TEST AA: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER REVERSING
LAMPS
AA1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9247
AA1-AA2
Normal Operation
The battery junction box (BJB) fuse 63 (15A) receives voltage from circuit CLS10 (GY/BN) when
the vehicle reversing lamps are illuminated. The voltage is then routed to the trailer tow connector
through circuit CAT16 (GY/BN).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CAT16 (GY/BN) open
- Circuit CLS10 (GY/BN) open
- Trailer
Tests AB: The Trailer Lamps Are On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST AB: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9248
AB1-AB2
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Turn/Stoplamp
The trailer tow LH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the vehicle
LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 YE).
The trailer tow RH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the vehicle
RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (OG).
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Parking
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. When the trailer tow parking lamp relay is energized, the
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT11 (BN).
Possible Causes
- Circuit CAT06 (YE) short to voltage
- Circuit CAT09 (OG) short to voltage
- Circuit CAT11 (BN) short to voltage
- Trailer tow relay
- Trailer
Tests AC: The Trailer Battery Charging Is Inoperative/Does Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST AC: THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGING IS INOPERATIVE/DOES NOT
OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9249
AC1-AC2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9250
AC3-AC4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9251
AC4-AC5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9252
AC5-AC6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9253
AC6-AC8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9254
AC8-AC10
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9255
AC10-AC11
Normal Operation
The trailer battery charge relay coil receives voltage from the smart junction box (SJB) fuse 42
(10A) through circuit CAT23 (GY/YE) when the ignition switch is in the RUN position. Ground for
the trailer battery charge relay coil is supplied through circuit GD123 (BK/GY). The battery junction
box (BJB) fuse 13 (30A) supplies voltage to the trailer battery charge relay switch side through
circuit SSB13 (GY/RD). When the trailer battery charge relay is energized, the voltage is routed to
the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT14 (OG).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CAT14 (OG) open or short to voltage
- Circuit CAT23 (GY/YE) open or short to voltage
- Circuit GD123 (BK/GY) open
- Circuit SSB13 (GY/RD) open
- Trailer battery charge relay
- Trailer
- SJB
Tests AD: The Trailer Electric Brakes Are Inoperative/Do Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST AD: THE TRAILER ELECTRIC BRAKES ARE INOPERATIVE/DO NOT
OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9256
AD1-AD2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9257
AD2-AD4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9258
AD5-AD7
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 9259
AD8-AD9
Normal Operation
The trailer brake control module is provided voltage at all times by the battery junction box (BJB)
fuse 5 (40A) through circuit SBB05 (GY/RD). Ground for the trailer brake control module is
provided through circuit GD138 (BK/WH). The trailer brake control module receives voltage from
the stoplamp switch through circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) when the brake pedal is applied. When
requested, the trailer brake control module sends voltage to the trailer tow connector through circuit
CAT19 (BU). Circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) supplies voltage to the trailer brake control module when the
parking lamps are on.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CAT19 (BU) open, short to ground or voltage
- Circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) open
- Circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) open
- Circuit GD138 (BK/WH) open
- Circuit SBB05 (GY/RD) open
- Trailer brake control module
- Trailer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lamps > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 9260
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9265
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9266
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9269
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9270
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9271
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9272
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9273
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9274
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9275
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9276
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 9281
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 9282
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9285
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9286
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9287
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9288
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9289
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9290
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9291
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Towing / Trailer System > Trailer Towing Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9292
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Trailer Connector: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9297
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9298
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9299
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9300
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9301
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9302
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9303
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9304
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9305
Trailer Connector: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9306
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9307
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9308
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9309
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9310
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9311
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9312
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9313
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9314
Trailer Connector: Connector Views
C4098
C4099
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9315
Trailer Connector: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9316
95-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Trailer Connector > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9317
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Specifications
Torque Specifications
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programmable Module Installation
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Programmable Module Installation
PROGRAMMABLE MODULE INSTALLATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Programmable Module Installation (PMI) Using the Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS) When the
Original Module is Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure be
carried out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal
and installation procedures.
1. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle as normal. 2. From the Toolbox icon, select Module
Programming and press the check mark. 3. Select Programmable Module Installation. 4. Select the
module that is being replaced. 5. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the OFF
position, and press the check mark. 6. Install the new module and press the check mark. 7. Follow
the on-screen instructions, turn the ignition key to the ON position, and press the check mark. 8.
The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration Complete. 9.
Test module for correct operation.
Programmable Module Installation Using the Integrated Diagnostic System IDS) When the Original
Module is NOT Available
NOTE: Following module installation, some modules require a separate learning procedure carried
out. For adaptive learning and calibration instructions, refer to the specific module removal and
installation procedures.
1. Install the new module. 2. Connect the IDS and identify the vehicle normal. 3. From the Toolbox
icon, select Module Programming and press the check mark. 4. Select Programmable Module
Installation. 5. Select the module that was replaced. 6. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn the
ignition key to the OFF position, and press check mark. 7. Follow the on-screen instructions, turn
the ignition key to the ON position, and press check mark. 8. If the data is not available, the IDS
displays screen stating to contact the As-Built Data Center. Retrieve the data from the technician
service
publication website at this time and press the check mark.
9. Enter the module data and press the check mark.
10. The IDS downloads the data into the new module and displays Module Configuration
Complete. 11. Test module for correct operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Body Control Systems > Body Control Module > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Programmable Module Installation > Page 9325
Body Control Module: Service and Repair Driver Seat Module (Dsm)
DRIVER SEAT MODULE (DSM)
Removal and Installation
CAUTION: Electronic modules are sensitive to static electrical charges. If exposed to these
charges, damage may result.
NOTE: Prior to the removal of the module, it is necessary to upload the module configuration
information to a scan tool. This information must be downloaded into the new DSM after
installation.
1. Upload the module configuration information from the DSM into the scan tool.
2. NOTE: The module is accessed with the seat fully in the UP position.
Position the DSM forward to remove it from the bracket.
3. Disconnect the battery. 4. Disconnect the electrical connectors and remove the DSM.
5. NOTE: Once the module is installed it is necessary to download the module configuration
information from the scan tool into the new module.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Service and Repair
RETRACTABLE RUNNING BOARD MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH B-pillar trim panel. 2. Disconnect the retractable running board module electrical
connectors. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the retractable running board module assembly. 4. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Running Board Motor, Left
C3185
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board > Auxiliary Step / Running Board Motor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Running Board Motor, Left > Page 9334
C3186
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Procedures
TAB REPAIR - BUMPER
1. NOTE:
- Inspect the bumper cover to determine if part can be repaired to an acceptable level of quality of
appearance, fit and durability. Will labor and material cost of the repair meet or exceed the cost of a
new replacement bumper cover. If the bumper cover is determined to be repairable, proceed to the
following steps.
- The following steps are to be used as a guideline. Depending on what brand of adhesives, patch
material etc., are used, procedures may vary slightly. Remove the affected bumper. Refer to
Bumpers.
2. Clean the broken tab(s) with a plastics wax and grease remover. 3. Hand sand the repair area
with 80-grit sandpaper and remove any foreign material with compressed air. 4. Apply a plastics
adhesion promoter per label directions to the repair area. 5. Measure and cut a patch of fiberglass
cloth or equivalent large enough to form the front of the tab, then slope back in a wedge shape
approximately 51 mm (2 in) from original tab.
6. Prepare the repair adhesive per manufacturer's instructions and apply to the affected area.
- Immediately apply the plastic repair material to form the tab shape.
7. Allow appropriate cure time and shape the repair tab using a small angle sander. Use extreme
care to not sand through the exterior surface. 8. Perform any required paint repair operations to the
bumper cover using Ford-approved paint systems. 9. Reassemble and install the bumper cover.
Refer to Bumpers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9341
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Removal and Replacement
BUMPER COVER - FRONT
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 3 lower air deflector pin-type retainers.
- Position the air deflector aside.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9342
2. Remove the 2 front bumper cover lower pin-type retainers. 3. Remove the 4 LH and RH front
fender splash shield screws. 4. Remove the 4 LH and RH front bumper cover-to-fender bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
5. If equipped, disconnect the LH and RH fog lamp electrical connectors.
6. Remove the upper air deflector.
- Remove the 10 pin-type retainers.
NOTE: Right side shown, left side similar.
7. Remove the 2 upper pin-type retainers for the lower air deflector. 8. Remove the 4
grille-to-radiator support bolts. 9. Remove the front bumper cover.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Bumper Reinforcement: Service and Repair
BUMPER - FRONT
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front bumper cover.
2. Remove the front bumper.
- Remove the 6 nuts.
- To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Procedures
TAB REPAIR - BUMPER
1. NOTE:
- Inspect the bumper cover to determine if part can be repaired to an acceptable level of quality of
appearance, fit and durability. Will labor and material cost of the repair meet or exceed the cost of a
new replacement bumper cover. If the bumper cover is determined to be repairable, proceed to the
following steps.
- The following steps are to be used as a guideline. Depending on what brand of adhesives, patch
material etc., are used, procedures may vary slightly. Remove the affected bumper. Refer to
Bumpers.
2. Clean the broken tab(s) with a plastics wax and grease remover. 3. Hand sand the repair area
with 80-grit sandpaper and remove any foreign material with compressed air. 4. Apply a plastics
adhesion promoter per label directions to the repair area. 5. Measure and cut a patch of fiberglass
cloth or equivalent large enough to form the front of the tab, then slope back in a wedge shape
approximately 51 mm (2 in) from original tab.
6. Prepare the repair adhesive per manufacturer's instructions and apply to the affected area.
- Immediately apply the plastic repair material to form the tab shape.
7. Allow appropriate cure time and shape the repair tab using a small angle sander. Use extreme
care to not sand through the exterior surface. 8. Perform any required paint repair operations to the
bumper cover using Ford-approved paint systems. 9. Reassemble and install the bumper cover.
Refer to Bumpers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9351
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Removal and Replacement
BUMPER COVER - REAR
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 4 LH and RH rear fender splash shield screws.
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
2. Remove the 4 LH and RH inner bumper cover nuts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System Information
> Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 9352
3. If equipped, disconnect the reverse parking aid electrical connector.
4. Remove the 2 rear bumper cover lower pin-type retainers. 5. Remove the rear bumper cover.
- Remove the 2 rear bumper cover pin-type retainers and the 3 rear bumper cover bolts.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL PANEL GRILLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the windshield wipers. 2. Remove the cowl grille seal. 3. Remove the pin-type retainer
and left side cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
4. Remove the right side cowl trim panel.
1 Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
2 Remove the pin-type retainer.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. If necessary, adjust the windshield wiper arms.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR FRONT DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The front door window glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
2. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9364
3. If equipped, disconnect the door lock cylinder actuating rod from the lock cylinder.
4. NOTE: Push the exterior door handle out from the bottom surface of the handle.
Remove the 2 nuts and the exterior front door handle. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Make sure the exterior door handle and the door handle actuating rod are in a relaxed
position and that the exterior door handle rod is all
the way up before closing the clip.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Front Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 08S03 Date: 080206
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated by February 6, 2008.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by February 6, 2008. Owner names and
addresses will be available by February 21, 2008.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Front Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9373
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refund or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from Special Service
Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
LABOR ALLOWANCES
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Front Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9374
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are currently available to service 100% of the affected vehicle population.
Parts will not be direct shipped for this program. Order your parts requirements through normal
order processing channels.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
EXCESS STOCK RETURN
Excess stock returned for credit must have been purchased from Ford Customer Service Division
in accordance with Policy Procedure Bulletin 4000.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves replacing the front and rear interior side door handle springs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the interior side door handle bezel screw cover, screw and bezel. See Figure 1.
2. NOTICE: Use caution not to damage the plastic retaining clip when removing the interior side
door handle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Front Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9375
Remove the interior side door handle by using a flat-blade screwdriver to pry upon the plastic
retaining clip while pulling the interior side door handle out of the retainer. See Figure 2.
3. Disconnect the interior side door handle cable from the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
4. NOTICE: When removing the interior side door handle pin, hold the interior side door handle with
extreme care so it is not scratched or damaged.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Front Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9376
Remove the interior side door handle spring pin and spring. See Figure 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Front Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9377
5.
NOTE: The interior side door handle spring retainer may be cracked or missing. See Figure 6 for
the location of the spring retainer. The new re-designed spring has a longer leg and does not need
the retainer to function. The door handle does not need to be replaced, even if the spring retainer is
damaged. See Figure 5 for example of re-designed spring.
Position the new interior side door handle spring (LH is green, RH is gray) into the interior side door
handle and install the interior side door handle spring pin. The new spring can be installed into the
retainer even if the retainer is damaged or broken. See Figure 6 for example of correct assembly.
6. Install the interior side door handle cable to the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
7. Install the interior side door handle into the retaining clip. Make sure the handle is seated
correctly in the retainer. See Figure 3.
8. Install the door handle bezel, screw and screw cover. See Figure 1.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Front Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9378
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Front Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9379
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Front Door Interior Handle: >
NHTSA08V058000 > Feb > 08 > Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Front Door Interior Handle: Recalls Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2007-2008 Lincoln/Navigator
2007-2008 MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: February 04, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V058000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Latches/Locks/Linkages: Doors: Latch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 123632
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 123,632 M/Y 2007-2008 Expedition and Lincoln Navigator vehicles.
The door handle housing embossment retaining the bottom of the interior door handle spring on all
side doors may fracture during normal customer usage. This can result in insufficient spring force
to return the handle to the fully closed position. The handle may be loose causing a rattle or noise
and the handle may not return to the fully closed position. This condition may also provide a
delayed resistance when actuating the handle prior to opening the door.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a side impact crash, the interior door handle may cause the door
latch to open increasing the risk of injury to a vehicle occupant.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the interior handle spring on all side doors. The recall is expected to
begin during February 2008. Owners may contact Ford at 1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 08S03. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Front Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 08S03 Date: 080206
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated by February 6, 2008.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by February 6, 2008. Owner names and
addresses will be available by February 21, 2008.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Front Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9389
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refund or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from Special Service
Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
LABOR ALLOWANCES
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Front Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9390
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are currently available to service 100% of the affected vehicle population.
Parts will not be direct shipped for this program. Order your parts requirements through normal
order processing channels.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
EXCESS STOCK RETURN
Excess stock returned for credit must have been purchased from Ford Customer Service Division
in accordance with Policy Procedure Bulletin 4000.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves replacing the front and rear interior side door handle springs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the interior side door handle bezel screw cover, screw and bezel. See Figure 1.
2. NOTICE: Use caution not to damage the plastic retaining clip when removing the interior side
door handle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Front Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9391
Remove the interior side door handle by using a flat-blade screwdriver to pry upon the plastic
retaining clip while pulling the interior side door handle out of the retainer. See Figure 2.
3. Disconnect the interior side door handle cable from the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
4. NOTICE: When removing the interior side door handle pin, hold the interior side door handle with
extreme care so it is not scratched or damaged.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Front Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9392
Remove the interior side door handle spring pin and spring. See Figure 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Front Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9393
5.
NOTE: The interior side door handle spring retainer may be cracked or missing. See Figure 6 for
the location of the spring retainer. The new re-designed spring has a longer leg and does not need
the retainer to function. The door handle does not need to be replaced, even if the spring retainer is
damaged. See Figure 5 for example of re-designed spring.
Position the new interior side door handle spring (LH is green, RH is gray) into the interior side door
handle and install the interior side door handle spring pin. The new spring can be installed into the
retainer even if the retainer is damaged or broken. See Figure 6 for example of correct assembly.
6. Install the interior side door handle cable to the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
7. Install the interior side door handle into the retaining clip. Make sure the handle is seated
correctly in the retainer. See Figure 3.
8. Install the door handle bezel, screw and screw cover. See Figure 1.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Front Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9394
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Front Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9395
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Front Door Interior Handle: >
NHTSA08V058000 > Feb > 08 > Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Front Door Interior Handle: By Symptom Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle Spring
Replacement
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2007-2008 Lincoln/Navigator
2007-2008 MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: February 04, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V058000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Latches/Locks/Linkages: Doors: Latch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 123632
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 123,632 M/Y 2007-2008 Expedition and Lincoln Navigator vehicles.
The door handle housing embossment retaining the bottom of the interior door handle spring on all
side doors may fracture during normal customer usage. This can result in insufficient spring force
to return the handle to the fully closed position. The handle may be loose causing a rattle or noise
and the handle may not return to the fully closed position. This condition may also provide a
delayed resistance when actuating the handle prior to opening the door.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a side impact crash, the interior door handle may cause the door
latch to open increasing the risk of injury to a vehicle occupant.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the interior handle spring on all side doors. The recall is expected to
begin during February 2008. Owners may contact Ford at 1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 08S03. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 08S03 Date: 080206
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated by February 6, 2008.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by February 6, 2008. Owner names and
addresses will be available by February 21, 2008.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9405
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refund or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from Special Service
Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
LABOR ALLOWANCES
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9406
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are currently available to service 100% of the affected vehicle population.
Parts will not be direct shipped for this program. Order your parts requirements through normal
order processing channels.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
EXCESS STOCK RETURN
Excess stock returned for credit must have been purchased from Ford Customer Service Division
in accordance with Policy Procedure Bulletin 4000.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves replacing the front and rear interior side door handle springs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the interior side door handle bezel screw cover, screw and bezel. See Figure 1.
2. NOTICE: Use caution not to damage the plastic retaining clip when removing the interior side
door handle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9407
Remove the interior side door handle by using a flat-blade screwdriver to pry upon the plastic
retaining clip while pulling the interior side door handle out of the retainer. See Figure 2.
3. Disconnect the interior side door handle cable from the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
4. NOTICE: When removing the interior side door handle pin, hold the interior side door handle with
extreme care so it is not scratched or damaged.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9408
Remove the interior side door handle spring pin and spring. See Figure 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9409
5.
NOTE: The interior side door handle spring retainer may be cracked or missing. See Figure 6 for
the location of the spring retainer. The new re-designed spring has a longer leg and does not need
the retainer to function. The door handle does not need to be replaced, even if the spring retainer is
damaged. See Figure 5 for example of re-designed spring.
Position the new interior side door handle spring (LH is green, RH is gray) into the interior side door
handle and install the interior side door handle spring pin. The new spring can be installed into the
retainer even if the retainer is damaged or broken. See Figure 6 for example of correct assembly.
6. Install the interior side door handle cable to the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
7. Install the interior side door handle into the retaining clip. Make sure the handle is seated
correctly in the retainer. See Figure 3.
8. Install the door handle bezel, screw and screw cover. See Figure 1.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9410
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9411
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door
Interior Handle: > NHTSA08V058000 > Feb > 08 > Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Front Door Interior Handle: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle
Spring Replacement
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2007-2008 Lincoln/Navigator
2007-2008 MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: February 04, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V058000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Latches/Locks/Linkages: Doors: Latch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 123632
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 123,632 M/Y 2007-2008 Expedition and Lincoln Navigator vehicles.
The door handle housing embossment retaining the bottom of the interior door handle spring on all
side doors may fracture during normal customer usage. This can result in insufficient spring force
to return the handle to the fully closed position. The handle may be loose causing a rattle or noise
and the handle may not return to the fully closed position. This condition may also provide a
delayed resistance when actuating the handle prior to opening the door.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a side impact crash, the interior door handle may cause the door
latch to open increasing the risk of injury to a vehicle occupant.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the interior handle spring on all side doors. The recall is expected to
begin during February 2008. Owners may contact Ford at 1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 08S03. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle > Front
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9416
Front Door Interior Handle: Service and Repair
INTERIOR DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front or rear door trim panel.
2. Release the door handle retaining clip and position the interior door handle aside. 3. Release the
interior door handle actuating cable from the interior door handle.
4. NOTE: Make sure the interior door handle spring is realigned before installation of the door
handle. Check for normal operation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Front Door, Fore and Aft
Front Door Hinge: Adjustments Hinge Adjustment - Front Door, Fore and Aft
HINGE ADJUSTMENT-FRONT DOOR, FORE AND AFT
NOTE: Check the rear door hinge adjustment before adjusting the front door hinge.
1. Remove the 2 door striker bolts and door striker. 2. Remove the front fender.
3. Loosen the front door hinge-to-body bolts. 4. Adjust the front door alignment to specification.
5. Tighten the front door hinge-to-body bolts to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft). 6. Install the front fender.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Front Door, Fore and Aft > Page 9421
7. Install and adjust the door striker.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Front Door, Fore and Aft > Page 9422
Front Door Hinge: Adjustments Hinge Adjustment - Front Door, Horizontal and Vertical
HINGE ADJUSTMENT-FRONT DOOR, HORIZONTAL AND VERTICAL
1. Remove the 2 door striker bolts and the door striker.
2. Loosen the front door hinge-to-front door bolts enough to allow movement of the door. 3. Adjust
the front door. 4. Tighten the front door hinge-to-front door bolts to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft). 5. Install and
adjust the door striker.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Latch: Service and Repair
FRONT DOOR LATCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The door glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9426
2. For the LH door, disconnect the door lock cylinder actuating lock rod from the lock cylinder.
3. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod.
4. Disconnect the manual actuating lock rod from the door latch. 5. Remove and discard the 3 bolts
and position the front door latch aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
6. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
- Separate the door harness from the door latch.
7. Release the interior door handle actuating cable and remove the front door latch.
1 Position the cable cover aside.
2 Release the conduit and the interior door handle actuating cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9427
8. NOTE: Make sure the exterior door handle and the door handle actuating rod are in a relaxed
position and that the exterior door handle rod is all
the way up before closing the clip.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Limiter > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Limiter: Service and Repair
DOOR CHECK ARM
Left and right sides
1. Remove the lower cowl trim panel.
- Remove the door scuff plate.
Left side
2. Remove the parking brake control assembly and position aside.
Left and right sides
3. Remove the lower cowl panel weather shield. 4. Remove the 2 door check arm-to-door bolts.
5. NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
Remove the 2 door check arm nuts.
6. Remove the door check arm from the opening in the lower cowl panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Limiter > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9431
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Panel: Service and Repair
DOOR TRIM PANEL - FRONT
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left front door shown, right front door similar.
1. Remove the door handle screw cover.
- Use the service notch.
2. Remove the door handle screw. 3. Remove the front door trim panel finish cover. 4. Remove the
2 door trim panel screws. 5. Remove the door trim panel screw.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9435
6. Remove the 2 lower door trim panel screws.
7. Disengage the sail panel clip.
8. CAUTION: To avoid damage to the door trim panel, lift the door trim panel by pulling directly
upward on the armrest to disengage the
panel clips.
Remove the front door trim panel. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Weatherstrip >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Weatherstrip: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07
> Body - Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area
Front Door Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Body - Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area
TSB 07-13-4
07/09/07
WIND NOISE AROUND FRONT DOORS - BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-8-6 to clarify vehicle build date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience wind
noise around the exterior driver and/or passenger doors. This may be most noticeable near the
b-pillar area of the door.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE VEHICLE IS BUILT AFTER 12/6/2006, THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. PROCEED WITH
NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTICS, REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL (WSM),
SECTION 100-04.
1. Check the build date of the vehicle.
a. If the build date of the vehicle is before 12/1/2006, continue to Step 2.
b. If the build date of the vehicle is between 12/1/06 and 12/6/06, continue to Step 3.
2. Verify that the glass run inserts at the b-pillar corner are still in the correct position. (Figure 1)
a. First roll down the window and peel back the inner flocked sealing lip in the b-pillar corner.
b. There will be two inserts located in the corner. They should both be touching in the corner and at
a 90 degree angle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Weatherstrip >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Weatherstrip: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07
> Body - Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area > Page 9444
c. Sometimes they can shift or fall down into the channel. After verifying the correct plug position,
continue to Step 3.
NOTE
SOME TRUCKS BUILT DURING THE MONTH OF NOVEMBER MAY NOT HAVE THE TWO
INSERTS MENTIONED IN FIGURE 1, THERE MAY BE A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG INSTEAD. IF
THERE IS A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG AS SHOWN IN FIGURE 1, CONTINUE TO STEP 3.
3. With the front door window in the up position, inspect the b-pillar metal carrier for being slightly
bowed out and not making contact to the outside glass surface. (Figure 2)
a. To adjust, compress the b-pillar metal carrier inward just below the b-pillar corner to ensure it
seals to the glass. This can be done by rolling the window down and pressing inward in the location
mentioned above.
NOTE
BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVER COMPRESS THE METAL B-PILLAR CARRIER.
b. Continue to Step 4.
4. Next, with the window in the up position, Inspect the front glass run for any gaps by running a
piece of paper between the glass run and window to
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Weatherstrip >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Weatherstrip: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07
> Body - Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area > Page 9445
determine any areas where sealing may be an issue. (Figure 3)
a. Make sure to run the paper along both the inside and outside sealing sur[aces of the window to
glass run inter[ace.
b. If a piece of paper freely slips between the glass run and the window at any location then there
may be a sealing issue and the glass run needs to be replaced.
NOTE
IF THE WIND NOISE CONCERN IS STILL PRESENT AFTER PERFORMING THIS SERVICE
PROCEDURE, CONTINUE WITH NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSIS, REFER TO
WSM, SECTION 100-04.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071304A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.9 Hr.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: One Door (23943A,
23943A14, 21 596A)
071304B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.7 Hrs.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: Both Doors (23943A,
23943A14 21596A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7821546/7821547 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Weatherstrip >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Weatherstrip: >
07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area
Front Door Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Wind Noise From Front Door
B-Pillar Area
TSB 07-13-4
07/09/07
WIND NOISE AROUND FRONT DOORS - BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-8-6 to clarify vehicle build date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience wind
noise around the exterior driver and/or passenger doors. This may be most noticeable near the
b-pillar area of the door.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE VEHICLE IS BUILT AFTER 12/6/2006, THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. PROCEED WITH
NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTICS, REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL (WSM),
SECTION 100-04.
1. Check the build date of the vehicle.
a. If the build date of the vehicle is before 12/1/2006, continue to Step 2.
b. If the build date of the vehicle is between 12/1/06 and 12/6/06, continue to Step 3.
2. Verify that the glass run inserts at the b-pillar corner are still in the correct position. (Figure 1)
a. First roll down the window and peel back the inner flocked sealing lip in the b-pillar corner.
b. There will be two inserts located in the corner. They should both be touching in the corner and at
a 90 degree angle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Weatherstrip >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Weatherstrip: >
07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area > Page 9451
c. Sometimes they can shift or fall down into the channel. After verifying the correct plug position,
continue to Step 3.
NOTE
SOME TRUCKS BUILT DURING THE MONTH OF NOVEMBER MAY NOT HAVE THE TWO
INSERTS MENTIONED IN FIGURE 1, THERE MAY BE A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG INSTEAD. IF
THERE IS A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG AS SHOWN IN FIGURE 1, CONTINUE TO STEP 3.
3. With the front door window in the up position, inspect the b-pillar metal carrier for being slightly
bowed out and not making contact to the outside glass surface. (Figure 2)
a. To adjust, compress the b-pillar metal carrier inward just below the b-pillar corner to ensure it
seals to the glass. This can be done by rolling the window down and pressing inward in the location
mentioned above.
NOTE
BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVER COMPRESS THE METAL B-PILLAR CARRIER.
b. Continue to Step 4.
4. Next, with the window in the up position, Inspect the front glass run for any gaps by running a
piece of paper between the glass run and window to
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Weatherstrip >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Weatherstrip: >
07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area > Page 9452
determine any areas where sealing may be an issue. (Figure 3)
a. Make sure to run the paper along both the inside and outside sealing sur[aces of the window to
glass run inter[ace.
b. If a piece of paper freely slips between the glass run and the window at any location then there
may be a sealing issue and the glass run needs to be replaced.
NOTE
IF THE WIND NOISE CONCERN IS STILL PRESENT AFTER PERFORMING THIS SERVICE
PROCEDURE, CONTINUE WITH NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSIS, REFER TO
WSM, SECTION 100-04.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071304A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.9 Hr.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: One Door (23943A,
23943A14, 21 596A)
071304B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.7 Hrs.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: Both Doors (23943A,
23943A14 21596A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7821546/7821547 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
DOOR GLASS TOP RUN-FRONT
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Glass >
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9457
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door window glass.
2. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
3. Remove the front door glass channel bolt and front door glass top run.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR-FRONT DOOR
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9461
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For Navigator, the LF/RF door power window regulator motor must be reinitialized
whenever the LF/RF motor is removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
2. Position the front door weathershield aside.
3. NOTE: Use a flat-blade screwdriver between the window regulator motor and window regulator
assembly to hold the window regulator assembly
drum in place.
Remove the bolts and the front door window regulator motor. 1
Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- For Navigator, reinitialize the LF/RF window regulator motor.
- Cycle the window glass to make sure the gears engage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR-FRONT DOOR
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9465
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For Navigator, the LF/RF door power window regulator motor must be reinitialized
whenever the LF/RF window regulator is removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
2. Unlock the tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. Remove the screws and the front door speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the front door weathershield. 5. Re-connect the electrical connectors to the window
control switch. 6. Lower the window glass to access the 2 window glass clamp bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9466
7. Loosen the window glass clamp bolts.
- To install, raise the window glass until it stalls in the UP position. Tighten the window glass clamp
bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: Secure the front window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the front window glass with tape to the front door frame.
9. Position the interior door handle aside.
1 Remove the cable conduit fitting from the carrier assembly.
2 Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
3 Remove the cable from the door handle.
10. Release the crash sensor harness pin-type retainers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Regulator > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9467
11. Position the front door window regulator harness aside.
1 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2 Release the pin-type retainers.
12. Remove the front window regulator.
1 Loosen the 2 hanger bolts.
2 Remove the front window regulator bolts and front top run channel bolt. -
To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 14. For Navigator, reinitialize the LF/RF window
regulator motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Exterior Handle: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR REAR DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The door glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove the rear door trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
2. Remove and discard the 3 bolts and position the rear door latch aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod. 4. Remove the 2 nuts and
the exterior rear door handle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Exterior Handle > System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9473
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
5. NOTE: Make sure the exterior door handle and the door handle actuating rod are in a relaxed
position and that the exterior door handle rod is all
the way up before closing the clip.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Rear Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 08S03 Date: 080206
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated by February 6, 2008.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by February 6, 2008. Owner names and
addresses will be available by February 21, 2008.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Rear Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9482
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refund or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from Special Service
Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
LABOR ALLOWANCES
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Rear Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9483
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are currently available to service 100% of the affected vehicle population.
Parts will not be direct shipped for this program. Order your parts requirements through normal
order processing channels.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
EXCESS STOCK RETURN
Excess stock returned for credit must have been purchased from Ford Customer Service Division
in accordance with Policy Procedure Bulletin 4000.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves replacing the front and rear interior side door handle springs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the interior side door handle bezel screw cover, screw and bezel. See Figure 1.
2. NOTICE: Use caution not to damage the plastic retaining clip when removing the interior side
door handle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Rear Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9484
Remove the interior side door handle by using a flat-blade screwdriver to pry upon the plastic
retaining clip while pulling the interior side door handle out of the retainer. See Figure 2.
3. Disconnect the interior side door handle cable from the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
4. NOTICE: When removing the interior side door handle pin, hold the interior side door handle with
extreme care so it is not scratched or damaged.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Rear Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9485
Remove the interior side door handle spring pin and spring. See Figure 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Rear Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9486
5.
NOTE: The interior side door handle spring retainer may be cracked or missing. See Figure 6 for
the location of the spring retainer. The new re-designed spring has a longer leg and does not need
the retainer to function. The door handle does not need to be replaced, even if the spring retainer is
damaged. See Figure 5 for example of re-designed spring.
Position the new interior side door handle spring (LH is green, RH is gray) into the interior side door
handle and install the interior side door handle spring pin. The new spring can be installed into the
retainer even if the retainer is damaged or broken. See Figure 6 for example of correct assembly.
6. Install the interior side door handle cable to the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
7. Install the interior side door handle into the retaining clip. Make sure the handle is seated
correctly in the retainer. See Figure 3.
8. Install the door handle bezel, screw and screw cover. See Figure 1.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Rear Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9487
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Rear Door Interior Handle: > 08S03 >
Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9488
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Rear Door Interior Handle: >
NHTSA08V058000 > Feb > 08 > Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Rear Door Interior Handle: Recalls Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2007-2008 Lincoln/Navigator
2007-2008 MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: February 04, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V058000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Latches/Locks/Linkages: Doors: Latch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 123632
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 123,632 M/Y 2007-2008 Expedition and Lincoln Navigator vehicles.
The door handle housing embossment retaining the bottom of the interior door handle spring on all
side doors may fracture during normal customer usage. This can result in insufficient spring force
to return the handle to the fully closed position. The handle may be loose causing a rattle or noise
and the handle may not return to the fully closed position. This condition may also provide a
delayed resistance when actuating the handle prior to opening the door.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a side impact crash, the interior door handle may cause the door
latch to open increasing the risk of injury to a vehicle occupant.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the interior handle spring on all side doors. The recall is expected to
begin during February 2008. Owners may contact Ford at 1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 08S03. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Rear Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 08S03 Date: 080206
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated by February 6, 2008.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by February 6, 2008. Owner names and
addresses will be available by February 21, 2008.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Rear Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9498
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refund or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from Special Service
Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
LABOR ALLOWANCES
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Rear Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9499
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are currently available to service 100% of the affected vehicle population.
Parts will not be direct shipped for this program. Order your parts requirements through normal
order processing channels.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
EXCESS STOCK RETURN
Excess stock returned for credit must have been purchased from Ford Customer Service Division
in accordance with Policy Procedure Bulletin 4000.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves replacing the front and rear interior side door handle springs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the interior side door handle bezel screw cover, screw and bezel. See Figure 1.
2. NOTICE: Use caution not to damage the plastic retaining clip when removing the interior side
door handle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Rear Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9500
Remove the interior side door handle by using a flat-blade screwdriver to pry upon the plastic
retaining clip while pulling the interior side door handle out of the retainer. See Figure 2.
3. Disconnect the interior side door handle cable from the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
4. NOTICE: When removing the interior side door handle pin, hold the interior side door handle with
extreme care so it is not scratched or damaged.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Rear Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9501
Remove the interior side door handle spring pin and spring. See Figure 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Rear Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9502
5.
NOTE: The interior side door handle spring retainer may be cracked or missing. See Figure 6 for
the location of the spring retainer. The new re-designed spring has a longer leg and does not need
the retainer to function. The door handle does not need to be replaced, even if the spring retainer is
damaged. See Figure 5 for example of re-designed spring.
Position the new interior side door handle spring (LH is green, RH is gray) into the interior side door
handle and install the interior side door handle spring pin. The new spring can be installed into the
retainer even if the retainer is damaged or broken. See Figure 6 for example of correct assembly.
6. Install the interior side door handle cable to the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
7. Install the interior side door handle into the retaining clip. Make sure the handle is seated
correctly in the retainer. See Figure 3.
8. Install the door handle bezel, screw and screw cover. See Figure 1.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Rear Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9503
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Rear Door Interior Handle: >
08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9504
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Rear Door Interior Handle: >
NHTSA08V058000 > Feb > 08 > Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Rear Door Interior Handle: By Symptom Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle Spring
Replacement
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2007-2008 Lincoln/Navigator
2007-2008 MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: February 04, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V058000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Latches/Locks/Linkages: Doors: Latch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 123632
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 123,632 M/Y 2007-2008 Expedition and Lincoln Navigator vehicles.
The door handle housing embossment retaining the bottom of the interior door handle spring on all
side doors may fracture during normal customer usage. This can result in insufficient spring force
to return the handle to the fully closed position. The handle may be loose causing a rattle or noise
and the handle may not return to the fully closed position. This condition may also provide a
delayed resistance when actuating the handle prior to opening the door.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a side impact crash, the interior door handle may cause the door
latch to open increasing the risk of injury to a vehicle occupant.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the interior handle spring on all side doors. The recall is expected to
begin during February 2008. Owners may contact Ford at 1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 08S03. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Technical Service Bulletin # 08S03 Date: 080206
Attachment I - Administrative Information
OASIS ACTIVATED?
Yes, OASIS will be activated by February 6, 2008.
FSA VIN LIST ACTIVATED?
Yes, FSA VIN list will be available through the website by February 6, 2008. Owner names and
addresses will be available by February 21, 2008.
NOTE:
Your FSA VIN list may contain owner names and addresses obtained from motor vehicle
registration records. The use of such motor vehicle registration data for any purpose other than in
connection with this recall is a violation of law in several states, provinces, and countries.
Accordingly, you must limit the use of this listing to the follow-up necessary to complete this recall
action.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9514
STOCK VEHICLES
Correct all affected units in your new vehicle inventory before delivery.
SOLD VEHICLES
^ Owners of affected vehicles will be directed to dealers for repairs.
^ Immediately contact any of your affected owners whose vehicles are not on your VIN lists but are
identified in OASIS. Give the owner a copy of the Customer Notification Letter (when available) and
schedule a service date.
^ Correct other affected vehicles identified in OASIS which are brought to your dealership.
TITLE BRANDED / SALVAGED VEHICLES
Affected title branded and salvaged vehicles are eligible for this Field Service Action.
RELATED DAMAGE
If a related damage condition exists that you believe to be caused by the covered condition, call the
Special Service Support Center to request approval prior to the repair of any related damage.
Requests for approval after completion of the repair will not be granted. Ford Motor Company
reserves the right to deny coverage for related damage in cases where the vehicle owner has not
had this recall performed on a timely basis.
ADDITIONAL LABOR TIME
^ If a condition exists that requires additional labor to complete the repair, call the Special Service
Support Center to request approval prior to performing any additional labor. Requests for approval
after completion of the repair will not be granted.
^ If you encounter aftermarket equipment or modifications to the vehicle which might prevent the
repair of the covered condition, call the Special Service Support Center.
OWNER REFUNDS
Refunds are not authorized for this program.
RENTAL VEHICLES
The use of rental vehicles is not authorized for this program.
CLAIMS PREPARATION AND SUBMISSION
^ Enter claims using Direct Warranty Entry (DWE).
^ Refund or related damage must be claimed on a repair line that is separate from the repair line
on which the FSA is claimed. Related damage requires prior approval from Special Service
Support Center.
^ "MT" labor should be submitted on a separate repair line with the related damage flag checked.
"MT" labor requires prior approval from Special Service Support Center.
^ Refer to ACESII manual for claims preparation and submission information.
Attachment II - Labor and Parts Information
LABOR ALLOWANCES
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9515
PARTS REQUIREMENTS / ORDERING INFORMATION
Parts are currently available to service 100% of the affected vehicle population.
Parts will not be direct shipped for this program. Order your parts requirements through normal
order processing channels.
Questions regarding parts should be directed to the Special Service Support Center or E-mailed.
DEALER PRICE
For latest prices, refer to DOES II.
PARTS RETENTION AND RETURN
Follow the provisions of the Warranty and Policy Manual for "Parts Retention and Return
Procedures."
EXCESS STOCK RETURN
Excess stock returned for credit must have been purchased from Ford Customer Service Division
in accordance with Policy Procedure Bulletin 4000.
Attachment III - Technical Information
OVERVIEW
This program involves replacing the front and rear interior side door handle springs.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Remove the interior side door handle bezel screw cover, screw and bezel. See Figure 1.
2. NOTICE: Use caution not to damage the plastic retaining clip when removing the interior side
door handle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9516
Remove the interior side door handle by using a flat-blade screwdriver to pry upon the plastic
retaining clip while pulling the interior side door handle out of the retainer. See Figure 2.
3. Disconnect the interior side door handle cable from the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
4. NOTICE: When removing the interior side door handle pin, hold the interior side door handle with
extreme care so it is not scratched or damaged.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9517
Remove the interior side door handle spring pin and spring. See Figure 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9518
5.
NOTE: The interior side door handle spring retainer may be cracked or missing. See Figure 6 for
the location of the spring retainer. The new re-designed spring has a longer leg and does not need
the retainer to function. The door handle does not need to be replaced, even if the spring retainer is
damaged. See Figure 5 for example of re-designed spring.
Position the new interior side door handle spring (LH is green, RH is gray) into the interior side door
handle and install the interior side door handle spring pin. The new spring can be installed into the
retainer even if the retainer is damaged or broken. See Figure 6 for example of correct assembly.
6. Install the interior side door handle cable to the interior side door handle. See Figure 3.
7. Install the interior side door handle into the retaining clip. Make sure the handle is seated
correctly in the retainer. See Figure 3.
8. Install the door handle bezel, screw and screw cover. See Figure 1.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9519
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Interior Handle: > 08S03 > Feb > 08 > Recall - Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement > Page 9520
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Rear Door
Interior Handle: > NHTSA08V058000 > Feb > 08 > Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle Spring Replacement
Rear Door Interior Handle: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 08V058000: Inner Door Handle
Spring Replacement
MAKE/MODELS: MODEL/BUILD YEARS: Ford/Expedition 2007-2008 Lincoln/Navigator
2007-2008 MANUFACTURER: Ford Motor Company
MFR'S REPORT DATE: February 04, 2008
NHTSA CAMPAIGN ID NUMBER: 08V058000
NHTSA ACTION NUMBER: N/A COMPONENT: Latches/Locks/Linkages: Doors: Latch
POTENTIAL NUMBER OF UNITS AFFECTED: 123632
SUMMARY: Ford is recalling 123,632 M/Y 2007-2008 Expedition and Lincoln Navigator vehicles.
The door handle housing embossment retaining the bottom of the interior door handle spring on all
side doors may fracture during normal customer usage. This can result in insufficient spring force
to return the handle to the fully closed position. The handle may be loose causing a rattle or noise
and the handle may not return to the fully closed position. This condition may also provide a
delayed resistance when actuating the handle prior to opening the door.
CONSEQUENCE: In the event of a side impact crash, the interior door handle may cause the door
latch to open increasing the risk of injury to a vehicle occupant.
REMEDY: Dealers will replace the interior handle spring on all side doors. The recall is expected to
begin during February 2008. Owners may contact Ford at 1-800-392-3673.
NOTES: Ford recall No. 08S03. Customers may also contact The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration's Vehicle Safety Hotline at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153), or go to
http://www.safercar.gov.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Handle > Rear
Door Interior Handle > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9525
Rear Door Interior Handle: Service and Repair
INTERIOR DOOR HANDLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front or rear door trim panel.
2. Release the door handle retaining clip and position the interior door handle aside. 3. Release the
interior door handle actuating cable from the interior door handle.
4. NOTE: Make sure the interior door handle spring is realigned before installation of the door
handle. Check for normal operation.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Door, Rear, Fore, Aft and Tilt
Rear Door Hinge: Adjustments Hinge Adjustment - Door, Rear, Fore, Aft and Tilt
HINGE ADJUSTMENT-REAR DOOR, FORE, AFT AND TILT
1. Position the front seat in the full forward position.
2. Remove the 2 door striker bolts and the door striker. 3. Remove the front seat belt retractor.
4. Remove the B-pillar weathershield.
5. Loosen the rear door hinge-to-B-pillar nuts enough to allow movement of the rear door. 6. Adjust
the rear door. 7. Tighten the rear door hinge-to-B-pillar nuts to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft). 8. Install the B-pillar
weathershield. 9. Install the front seat belt retractor.
10. Install and adjust the door striker.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Hinge > System
Information > Adjustments > Hinge Adjustment - Door, Rear, Fore, Aft and Tilt > Page 9530
Rear Door Hinge: Adjustments Hinge Adjustment - Door, Rear, In, Out, Up and Down
HINGE ADJUSTMENT-REAR DOOR, IN, OUT, UP AND DOWN
1. Remove the 2 door striker bolts and the door striker.
2. Loosen the rear door hinge-to-rear door bolts enough to allow movement of the door. 3. Adjust
the rear door. 4. Tighten the rear door hinge-to-rear door bolts to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft). 5. Install and
adjust the door striker.
- Tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Latch: Service and Repair
REAR DOOR LATCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The rear door window glass must be completely raised.
1. Remove rear door trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
2. Remove and discard the 3 bolts and position the rear door latch aside.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Latch > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9534
3. Open the clip and disconnect the exterior door handle actuating rod.
4. Disconnect the electrical connectors.
5. Release the interior door handle actuating cable and remove the rear door latch.
1 Position the cable cover aside.
2 Release the conduit and the interior door handle actuating cable.
6. NOTE: Make sure the exterior door handle and the door handle actuating rod are in a relaxed
position and that the exterior door handle rod is all
the way up before closing the clip.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Panel: Service and Repair
DOOR TRIM PANEL - REAR
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left rear door shown, right rear door similar.
1. Remove the door handle screw cover.
- Use the service notch.
2. Remove the door handle screw. 3. Remove the rear door trim panel finish cover. 4. Remove the
2 door trim panel screws. 5. Remove the door trim panel screw.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Panel > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 9538
6. Remove the 2 lower door trim panel screws.
7. CAUTION: To avoid damage to the door trim panel, lift the door trim panel by pulling directly
upward on the armrest to disengage the
panel clips.
Remove the rear door trim panel. If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors.
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
DOOR GLASS TOP RUN-REAR
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Glass >
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9543
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Lower the rear door window glass. 2. Remove the rear door trim panel.
3. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
4. Remove the rear door glass channel bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
5. Remove the rear door glass top run. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR-REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9547
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel
2. Position the rear door weathershield aside.
3. NOTE: Use a flat-blade screwdriver between the window regulator motor and the window
regulator assembly to hold the window regulator
assembly drum in place.
Remove the rear door window regulator motor. 1
Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Cycle the door glass to make sure of gear engagement.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR-REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9551
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel
2. NOTE: LF shown, LR and RR are similar.
Unlock the tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. Remove the rear door speaker.
1 Remove the screws.
2 Disconnect the electrical connector.
3 Remove the speaker.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9552
4. Remove the rear door weathershield. 5. Connect the window control switch. 6. Lower the
window glass to access the window glass clamp bolts. 7. Disconnect the window control switch. 8.
Loosen the window glass clamp bolts and remove the rear door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
9. NOTE: Secure the rear window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the rear window glass with tape to the front door frame.
10. Disconnect the rear door window regulator electrical connectors.
11. Position the interior door handle aside.
- Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Rear Door > Rear Door Window Regulator
> System Information > Service and Repair > Page 9553
12. Remove the rear door window regulator assembly.
- Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Hood Latch: Service and Repair
HOOD LATCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 10 pin-type retainers and the upper radiator sight shield. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and
the hood latch.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
3. Release the hood latch cable from the hood latch. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9558
- Verify the hood latch engages the striker in the latched position (secondary).
- Verify the hood latch engages the striker in the fully latched position (primary).
- Adjust the hood latch as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Hood Latch Release > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Hood Latch Release: Service and Repair
HOOD LATCH RELEASE HANDLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the hood latch.
- Note the routing of the hood release cable.
2. Remove the 3 screws and the steering column cover. 3. Remove the 2 screws and the hood
latch release handle.
4. Release the cable guides and pull the cable through the cowl panel. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair
WINDOW GLASS-LIFTGATE
Material
Material
Removal and Installation
Window glass assembly
1. Remove the rear window wiper motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9566
2. Disconnect the rear window defrost electrical connectors.
3. CAUTION:
- The liftgate glass must be supported when removing and installing the liftgate assist cylinders.
- Do not extend the socket clips more than 2.0 mm (0.08 in) or failure of the socket can occur.
Disconnect the 2 liftgate glass assist cylinders. 1
Insert a screwdriver blade under the socket clip and lift.
2 Gently pull the socket off the ball stud.
Window glass assembly or hinge assembly
4. Remove the liftgate glass hinge-to-body fasteners and remove the glass.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Window hinge assembly
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Liftgate Window Glass >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9567
5. Remove the liftgate glass to hinge fasteners and remove the glass.
- Apply Threadlock 262 to the liftgate glass to hinge fasteners during installation.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Window glass assembly or window hinge assembly
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Customer Interest Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC
B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 9576
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Power Liftgate
Inoperative/DTC B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 9582
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9583
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Locations
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9584
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9585
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
C4174A
C4174B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9586
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair
POWER LIFTGATE MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the power liftgate module.
1 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2 Remove the bolt. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Locations
View 151-41 (Liftgate - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Actuator > Component Information > Locations > Page 9590
C4040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-41 (Liftgate - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch
C4340
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch > Page 9596
C4039
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard Sensor: Service and Repair
PINCH STRIP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove brake light.
- Remove the screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9600
2. Disconnect the pinch strip electrical connector.
3. Remove the pinch strip.
1 Remove the pin-type retainers.
2 Remove the grommet and route the harness out of the vehicle.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hinge >
Component Information > Adjustments
Trunk / Liftgate Hinge: Adjustments
HINGE ADJUSTMENT - LIFTGATE
1. Loosen the liftgate hinge to liftgate bolts.
2. Adjust the liftgate alignment.
3. NOTE: The bolt washers must make full contact with the liftgate bracket when tightened.
Tighten the liftgate hinge-to-liftgate bolts to 28 Nm (21 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Handle >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Handle: Service and Repair
LIFTGATE RELEASE HANDLE
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Handle >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9607
Navigator
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Handle >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9608
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
Expedition
2. Remove the 2 nuts and the liftgate release handle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
Navigator
3. Remove the 6 nuts and the license plate housing.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
4. Remove the 2 nuts and the liftgate release handle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Control
Unit > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-18-3 > Sep > 08 > Body - Power
Liftgate Grunt/Groan/Squeal Noise
Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Control Unit: Customer Interest Body - Power Liftgate
Grunt/Groan/Squeal Noise
TSB 08-18-3
09/15/08
POWER LIFTGATE - GRUNT/GROAN/SQUEAL NOISE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with power liftgates may
exhibit a grunt/groan/squeal noise when powered open/close.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the power liftgate actuator / lift rod assembly from the liftgate and body, then
manually open and close liftgate.
2. If the noise is gone, replace power liftgate actuator / lift rod and initialize the power liftgate.
Reference Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-03.
3. If the noise does not go away, reconnect the liftgate actuator rod and initialize the power liftgate.
See Power Liftgate Initialization procedure in WSM, Section 501-03, under general procedures.
Follow normal WSM, Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081803A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Power Lift Rod, Includes Time To Remove And Install Interior Trim Panels
And Perform Initialization Procedure. (Do Not Use With 14350A, 31012A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78431 A78 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Control
Unit > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-18-3 > Sep > 08 > Body
- Power Liftgate Grunt/Groan/Squeal Noise
Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Control Unit: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Power Liftgate
Grunt/Groan/Squeal Noise
TSB 08-18-3
09/15/08
POWER LIFTGATE - GRUNT/GROAN/SQUEAL NOISE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with power liftgates may
exhibit a grunt/groan/squeal noise when powered open/close.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the power liftgate actuator / lift rod assembly from the liftgate and body, then
manually open and close liftgate.
2. If the noise is gone, replace power liftgate actuator / lift rod and initialize the power liftgate.
Reference Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-03.
3. If the noise does not go away, reconnect the liftgate actuator rod and initialize the power liftgate.
See Power Liftgate Initialization procedure in WSM, Section 501-03, under general procedures.
Follow normal WSM, Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081803A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Power Lift Rod, Includes Time To Remove And Install Interior Trim Panels
And Perform Initialization Procedure. (Do Not Use With 14350A, 31012A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78431 A78 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Control
Unit > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Control Unit: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors
Accessory Control Display: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Message Center Switches
Inop/Other Errors
TSB 07-7-4
04/16/07
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCHES INOP-TEXT BLANK/SCRAMBLED/COMPASS INOP/WASHER
LIGHT ON/OAT READS HIGH
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/22/2006 may exhibit concerns
with the Instrument Cluster (IC). The outside air temp reads 140 °F (60 °C), message center
switches unresponsive/text blank or scrambled, compass display is inoperative, washer fluid level
light is on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE IC ASSEMBLY UNTIL COMPLETE DIAGNOSIS HAS BEEN PERFORMED.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check the build date code of the IC. The date code is displayed in the message center during
"engineering test mod&'.
Engineering Test Mode:
1. Ignition in "OFF" position.
2. Cluster type.
a. For Base Clusters (without message center cluster): depress the reset stem on the cluster while
turning the ignition switch to the "ON" position.
b. Message Center Clusters: depress the reset button in the vehicle while turning the ignition switch
to the "ON" position.
3. Continue to hold down the reset stem/button for 5 seconds until the cluster message center
displays "engineering test mode".
4. Press/cycle reset stem/button until the message center displays "manufacture" and the date of
manufacture (MM-DD-YYYY).
5. If the date is after 12/22/2006, this TSB does not apply and proceed with normal diagnostics
found in Workshop Manual (WSM), Sections 413-01 and 413-08.
6. Turn the vehicle ignition to the "OFF" position to exit the "engineering test mode".
Outside Air Temperature (OAT) Diagnostics
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS FOR VEHICLES WITHOUT (ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE
CONTROL) EATC.
1. Run vehicle for 5 minutes.
2. Verify the OAT reads 140 °F (60 °C) in the Message Center.
3. Disconnect the OAT sensor.
4. Does the Message Center still read 140 °F (60 °C)?
a. Yes - proceed to Step 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Control
Unit > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Control Unit: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 9627
b. No - follow WSM, Section 413-08.
5. Disconnect battery.
6. Disconnect IC.
7. Measure the resistance between pins 1 and 2 on Connector C132.
a. Resistance less than 1 Meg-Ohms - Repair shorted circuits.
b. Resistance greater than 1 Meg-Ohms - Proceed to Step 8.
8. Reconnect IC and OAT sensor.
9. Reconnect battery, to verify IC connection. If Message Center still reads 140 °F (60 °C), replace
IC.
Message Center (MC) Switch, Diagnostics:
Refer to WSM, Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate
Correctly
Low Washer Fluid Level Light On, Diagnostics
1. Verify low washer fluid level light is on and washer bottle is full.
2. Verify washer fluid level switch is fully seated in the bottle. Is light still on?
a. No - repair is complete.
b. Yes - proceed to Step 3.
3. Disconnect the washer fluid level switch. Does the light go out after one minute?
a. Yes - proceed with normal WSM, Section 413-01 Diagnostics.
b. No - proceed to Step 4.
4. Disconnect battery.
5. Disconnect IC.
6. Measure the resistance on Pins 1 and 2 of Connector C138. Is the resistance less than 1
Meg-Ohms?
a. Yes - repair shorted wires.
b. No - proceed to step 7.
7. Reconnect the washer fluid level switch, IC and then battery to verify IC connections. If light is
still on, replace the IC.
No Compass Display Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative.
Message Center Display Blank/Text Scrambled, Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Symptom Chart
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070704 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Control
Unit > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Control Unit: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 9628
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
10849 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Control
Unit > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Control Unit: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 9634
b. No - follow WSM, Section 413-08.
5. Disconnect battery.
6. Disconnect IC.
7. Measure the resistance between pins 1 and 2 on Connector C132.
a. Resistance less than 1 Meg-Ohms - Repair shorted circuits.
b. Resistance greater than 1 Meg-Ohms - Proceed to Step 8.
8. Reconnect IC and OAT sensor.
9. Reconnect battery, to verify IC connection. If Message Center still reads 140 °F (60 °C), replace
IC.
Message Center (MC) Switch, Diagnostics:
Refer to WSM, Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate
Correctly
Low Washer Fluid Level Light On, Diagnostics
1. Verify low washer fluid level light is on and washer bottle is full.
2. Verify washer fluid level switch is fully seated in the bottle. Is light still on?
a. No - repair is complete.
b. Yes - proceed to Step 3.
3. Disconnect the washer fluid level switch. Does the light go out after one minute?
a. Yes - proceed with normal WSM, Section 413-01 Diagnostics.
b. No - proceed to Step 4.
4. Disconnect battery.
5. Disconnect IC.
6. Measure the resistance on Pins 1 and 2 of Connector C138. Is the resistance less than 1
Meg-Ohms?
a. Yes - repair shorted wires.
b. No - proceed to step 7.
7. Reconnect the washer fluid level switch, IC and then battery to verify IC connections. If light is
still on, replace the IC.
No Compass Display Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative.
Message Center Display Blank/Text Scrambled, Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Symptom Chart
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070704 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Control
Unit > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Control Unit: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 9635
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
10849 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-18-3 > Sep > 08 > Body - Power
Liftgate Grunt/Groan/Squeal Noise
Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Cylinder: Customer Interest Body - Power Liftgate Grunt/Groan/Squeal
Noise
TSB 08-18-3
09/15/08
POWER LIFTGATE - GRUNT/GROAN/SQUEAL NOISE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with power liftgates may
exhibit a grunt/groan/squeal noise when powered open/close.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the power liftgate actuator / lift rod assembly from the liftgate and body, then
manually open and close liftgate.
2. If the noise is gone, replace power liftgate actuator / lift rod and initialize the power liftgate.
Reference Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-03.
3. If the noise does not go away, reconnect the liftgate actuator rod and initialize the power liftgate.
See Power Liftgate Initialization procedure in WSM, Section 501-03, under general procedures.
Follow normal WSM, Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081803A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Power Lift Rod, Includes Time To Remove And Install Interior Trim Panels
And Perform Initialization Procedure. (Do Not Use With 14350A, 31012A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78431 A78 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-18-3 > Sep > 08 >
Body - Power Liftgate Grunt/Groan/Squeal Noise
Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic Cylinder: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Power Liftgate
Grunt/Groan/Squeal Noise
TSB 08-18-3
09/15/08
POWER LIFTGATE - GRUNT/GROAN/SQUEAL NOISE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with power liftgates may
exhibit a grunt/groan/squeal noise when powered open/close.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disconnect the power liftgate actuator / lift rod assembly from the liftgate and body, then
manually open and close liftgate.
2. If the noise is gone, replace power liftgate actuator / lift rod and initialize the power liftgate.
Reference Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-03.
3. If the noise does not go away, reconnect the liftgate actuator rod and initialize the power liftgate.
See Power Liftgate Initialization procedure in WSM, Section 501-03, under general procedures.
Follow normal WSM, Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081803A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Power Lift Rod, Includes Time To Remove And Install Interior Trim Panels
And Perform Initialization Procedure. (Do Not Use With 14350A, 31012A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78431 A78 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure
Hose/Line HVAC: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Compressor Failure
TSB 07-18-3
09/17/07
A/C COMPRESSOR FAILURE
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/18/2007 may have A/C
system filters (integral to the receiver/dryer desiccant cartridge) that fail to filter the system. If the
unit has had a compressor failure that has sent debris into the system, the filter will not stop the
debris from contaminating the entire system.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
When debris is present throughout the entire system, it is imperative to completely clean the A/C
system to prevent repeat failures from residual debris that contaminates the system after the initial
failure. To prevent repeat failures, the following service procedure must be performed.
WITH ROTUNDA A/C FLUSH AND PURGE MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Drain and refill the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine with a new 1 gallon can of A/C
Flushing Solvent. Replace the filter (Motorcraft(R) FL-1A) on the machine.
3. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM, Section 412-01. Pour 2 fl.oz. of
PAG oil into the suction port of the new compressor. Install the new compressor.
4. Remove and replace the A/C discharge and muffler line from the system.
5. Remove the condenser from the vehicle.
6. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
7. Install the original plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser without a cartridge
present.
8. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate adapters, and flush the
solvent through the condenser for a minimum of 30 minutes, followed by a minimum of 20 minutes
of the purge mode of the machine.
9. Remove the original plug and snap-ring and discard.
10. Install the new Receiver Drier Cartridge, plug with 0-rings, snap-ring and dust cap included in
the kit, and install condenser into the vehicle.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
11. Remove and replace the Front Thermal Expansion Valve (TXV). Be sure to re-use the
insulating foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
12. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate spring lock connectors
and flush solvent through the Front evaporator for a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of
a minimum of 20 minutes.
13. For units with auxiliary A/C, disconnect the rear A/C lines underneath the rear of the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 9654
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 9655
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 9656
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 9662
14. Remove the rear TXV and discard if equipped.
15. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the correct TXV pass through adapter
to the rear evaporator (FS-00707 part of Rotunda 219-00074 Adaptor Kit). Flush the evaporator for
a minimum of 20 minutes followed by a purge of a minimum of 20 minutes.
16. Install a new rear TXV.
17. Using fittings included with the Flushing Adapter kit, and a section of hose with hose clamps,
loop the underbody lines together at the rear of the vehicle.
18. With the Rotunda A/C Flush and Purge machine, attach the appropriate fittings to the under
body lines in the engine compartment where they connect to the A/C under hood lines. Flush the
underbody lines for 5 minutes, followed by not less than a 10 minute purge. Remove the loop
connection in the rear, and reattach to the rear TXV and rear evaporator.
19. Reconnect all A/C fittings.
20. Ensure the entire A/C system is now fully assembled. Put the system under a vacuum for not
less than 1 hour. (Required to ensure that all solvent has been evaporated).
21. Recharge the A/C system with the correct amount of R134a and inject 5 fl.oz. of PAG oil during
the charging process into the low-side service port.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
22. Leak test and evaluate the system for proper operation. Run system at least 30 minutes.
A/C FLUSH AND PURGE - WITHOUT ROTUNDA MACHINE:
1. Conduct the evacuation of R134a per the standard procedures in the WSM, Section 412-00:
Climate Control System - General Procedures.
2. Remove the defective compressor from the vehicle per WSM Section 412-01. Add the
appropriate amount of PAG oil per WSM, Section 412-00. Add refrigerant oil recommendations
based on system damage level. Install the new compressor into the vehicle.
3. Remove and replace the discharge line.
4. Remove and replace the front TXV and rear TXV if equipped. Be sure to re-use the insulating
foam from the original TXV and apply electrical tape or tie straps to hold it in place.
5. Remove the Receiver Drier Cartridge from the vehicle per the WSM, Section 412-01 and
discard.
6. Reinstall the original cartridge's plug with 0-rings and snap ring back into the condenser.
7. Remove the right front headlamp assembly per the WSM, Section 417-01.
8. Disconnect the lower (liquid) line connection to the condenser.
9. Pull the liquid line slightly forward so it will clear the condenser.
10. Attach the A/C Pancake Filter Kit with the 1/2" DSL A/C filter adapter fittings and lines (Rotunda
Parts 219-00077 & 023-00185). Ensure that the side of the filter with the label "Inlet from
Condenser" is connected to the condenser.
11. Charge the system with the correct amount of R134a.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
12. Follow WSM, Section 412-00 "Refrigerant System Filtering Following Air Conditioning (A/C)
Compressor Installation". Ensure that the elevated RPM (1200) running of the engine is run for not
less than the recommended 1 hour. If equipped with Auxiliary A/C, ensure that the REAR system is
on, high blower, coldest temperature.
13. Recover the R134a in the system.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 9663
14. Remove the condenser.
15. Remove the original desiccant cartridge plug and 0-rings and discard.
16. Install a new desiccant cartridge, plug w/ 0-rings, snap ring, and cap.
NOTE
IF THE RECEIVER DRIER CARTRIDGE IS NOT AVAILABLE, REPLACE THE CONDENSER
ASSEMBLY.
17. Install the condenser
18. Install the headlamp assembly per WSM, Section 417-01.
19. Charge system with correct amount of R134a and leak test and evaluate the system for proper
operation. Run at least 30 minutes. If pulley, clutch and coil are damaged, replace per WSM.
^ 22 oz. - Front A/C
^ 33 oz. - With Auxiliary A/C
NOTE
COMPONENTS OF THE ROTUNDA 1/2" DSL AC FILTER ADAPTER KIT ARE A SMALL SUBSET
OF THE A/C FLUSHING ADAPTER KITS 219-00074 AND 219-00024. PURCHASE OF THE TWO
LARGER KITS WILL PROVIDE ADAPTERS FOR THE ENTIRE F/L/M VEHICLE LINES
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Trunk / Liftgate Hydraulic
Cylinder: > 07-18-3 > Sep > 07 > A/C - Compressor Failure > Page 9664
MTO71803 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
19C836 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim Panel: Service and Repair
LIFTGATE TRIM PANEL
All vehicles
1. Open the liftgate and remove the scrivets.
Vehicles with power liftgate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Interior Trim
Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9668
2. Remove the power liftgate rod-to-liftgate cover and nut.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
3. Remove the power liftgate rod.
All vehicles
4. Open the liftgate and remove the upper liftgate trim panel.
- Pull lower corners toward the center on both sides and pull down along the top.
5. Remove the assist handle.
1 Remove the screws.
2 Remove the assist handle.
6. Remove the lower liftgate trim panel.
1 Hold the trim panel at the center area and slightly pull on the center clips to allow a tool to access
the clips.
2 Release the 12 clips 2 to 3 at a time, starting from the right side working to the left side.
3 Once all the clips are released, slide the liftgate trim panel forward and down, away from the
sheet metal.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Latch
C457
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Latch > Page 9673
C4339
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch
LIFTGATE LATCH
Manual Liftgate
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch > Page 9676
Power Liftgate
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
- Position the water shield aside.
2. Remove and discard the 3 bolts (4 bolts if equipped with a power liftgate) and the liftgate latch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Liftgate Latch > Page 9677
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Service and Repair Liftgate Latch - Window
LIFTGATE LATCH - WINDOW
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 2. Remove the 2 screws and the liftgate window latch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Motor: Locations
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9681
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9682
C4332
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Liftgate Motor
Trunk / Liftgate Motor: Service and Repair Power Liftgate Motor
POWER LIFTGATE MOTOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the power liftgate rod assembly.
2. Disconnect the power liftgate motor electrical connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Liftgate Motor > Page 9685
3. Remove the power liftgate retaining fasteners and the power liftgate motor assembly.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Liftgate Motor > Page 9686
Trunk / Liftgate Motor: Service and Repair Power Liftgate Rod
POWER LIFTGATE ROD
Material
Material
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Power Liftgate Motor > Page 9687
2. Unclip the power liftgate rod from the motor assembly.
- Squeeze the clip as shown to release and position upward on the rod assembly.
3. Remove the cover and the power liftgate rod-to-liftgate retaining nut.
- To install, apply Threadlock 262 to the threads of fastener and tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. Remove the power liftgate rod-to-bracket bolt and the power liftgate rod assembly.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations Liftgate Rear Control Switch
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 9692
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 9693
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
C4333
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 9696
C2361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information >
Service and Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL PANEL GRILLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the windshield wipers. 2. Remove the cowl grille seal. 3. Remove the pin-type retainer
and left side cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
4. Remove the right side cowl trim panel.
1 Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
2 Remove the pin-type retainer.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. If necessary, adjust the windshield wiper arms.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information > Service
and Repair
Front Fender Liner: Service and Repair
FENDER SPLASH SHIELD
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Fender > Front Fender > Front Fender Liner > System Information > Service
and Repair > Page 9706
Part 2
Exploded View
Vehicles with power running boards
1. Lower the running board.
All vehicles
2. Remove the lower pin-type retainer from the fender. 3. Remove the 8 fender splash shield
screws. 4. Remove the 2 inner pin-type retainers from the fender splash shield. 5. Remove the
fender splash shield. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION
Frame and Body Mounting
The frame is made up of 2 steel boxed side rails and crossmembers, which are welded to the 2
side rails. The transmission crossmember is bolted to the side rails. The side welded rails and
crossmembers are not replaced separately.
The service kits available for the frame are the following: RH front horn replacement kit
- LH front horn replacement kit
- Front bumper bracket replacement kit
- 1B crossmember replacement kit
- Transmission crossmember replacement kit
Refer to the instructions included in the kits for installation instructions.
Frame Mounted Heat Shields
All frame mounted heat shields, except the spare tire heat shield, are tightened to 20 Nm (15 lb-ft).
The spare tire heat shield is tightened to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
Frame Components
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 9711
Frame Components
Spare Tire Winch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 9712
Spare Tire Winch
Skid Plates
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Page 9713
Skid Plates
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Service and Repair Body Support - Number 1
Body Support - Number 1
Removal and Installation
No. 1 Body Support Mount
N0. 1 Body Support Mount
1. Remove the body mount bolt.
- To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
2. Loosen the remaining body mount bolts. 3. Raise the vehicle body enough to remove the body
mount bolts and body mount.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 9716
4. NOTE:
- No lubricants of any kind are to be used during body mount installation.
- Do not reuse body mount fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each fastener that has
been removed or loosened.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 9717
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Service and Repair Body Support - Number 2 and Number 3
Body Support - Number 2 and Number 3
Removal and Installation
No. 2 Body Support Mount
NOTE: No. 2 body mount is shown, body mount No. 3 similar.
N0. 2 Body Support Mount
Upper and lower body support mount
1. Remove the body mount bolt and lower body mount.
- To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 9718
Upper body mount
2. Loosen the remaining body mount bolts. 3. Raise the vehicle body enough to remove the upper
body mount.
Upper and lower body mount
4. NOTE:
- No lubricants of any kind are to be used during body mount installation.
- Do not reuse body mount fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each fastener that has
been removed or loosened.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 9719
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Service and Repair Body Support - Number 4
Body Support - Number 4
Removal and Installation
No. 4 Body Mount
N0. 4 Body Support Mount
1. Remove the liftgate scuff plate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 9720
2. Remove the body mount bolt cover.
3. Remove the body mount nut.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
4. Loosen the remaining body mount bolts. 5. Raise the vehicle body enough to remove the body
mount bolts.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
6. NOTE:
- No lubricants of any kind are to be used during body mount installation.
- Do not reuse body mount fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each fastener that has
been removed or loosened.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 9721
Body / Frame Mount Bushing: Service and Repair Body Support - Front End Sheet Metal
Body Support - Front End Sheet Metal
Removal and Installation
Front End Sheet Metal Body Mount
Front End Sheet Metal Body Mount
Upper and lower body mount
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Body / Frame Mount Bushing > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Body Support - Number 1 > Page 9722
1. Remove the lower front end sheet metal body mount.
1 Remove the lower front end sheet metal body mount bolt.
2 Remove the lower front end sheet metal body mount. To install, tighten to 80 Nm (59 lb-ft).
Upper body mount
2. Loosen the remaining body mount bolts. 3. Raise the vehicle body enough to remove the upper
front end sheet metal body mount.
Upper and lower body mount
4. NOTE:
- No lubricants of any kind are to be used during body mount installation.
- Do not reuse body mount fasteners. New fasteners must be installed for each fastener that has
been removed or loosened.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Service and Repair
Rear Cross-Member: Service and Repair
TRANSMISSION SUPPORT CROSSMEMBER
Transmission Support Crossmember - Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. If equipped, remove the skid plate
fasteners and skid plate.
3. Remove the LH and RH exhaust heat shield-to-crossmember fasteners.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Cross-Member > Rear Cross-Member > System Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9727
4. Remove the 2 transmission mount nuts.
- To install, tighten to 103 Nm (76 lb-ft).
5. Support the transmission.
6. NOTE:
- Mark the transmission crossmember next to the edge of the frame bracket to make sure the
crossmember is installed in the same position it was removed from.
- The crossmember nuts are installed on the crossmember bolts facing the front of the vehicle.
Remove the 4 transmission crossmember bolts (2 each side) and the transmission crossmember. To install, tighten to 90 Nm (66 lb-ft).
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch: Service and Repair
Trailer Hitch
Trailer Hitch
Removal and Installation
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
9731
WARNING: Do not permanently remove the trailer hitch. The trailer hitch is an integral part of the
vehicle frame. Always reinstall the hitch before delivery of the vehicle to the customer. Failure to
follow this instruction may compromise vehicle crash integrity and increase the risk of personal
injury in a rear end collision.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Remove the trailer hitch rear bumper
cover trim panel, if equipped. 3. Remove the 4 trailer lighting plug cover bolts.
4. Remove the trailer lighting plug.
- Position the plug away from the trailer hitch.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Remove the trailer lighting plug.
5. Remove the electrical connector from the trailer hitch and unclip the harness from the retainers
on the frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
9732
6. Remove the 4 trailer hitch side mounting bolts (2 each side).
- To install, tighten to 175 Nm (129 lb-ft).
7. Remove the 4 trailer hitch lower mounting bolts (2 each side) and remove the trailer hitch.
- To install, tighten to 275 Nm (203 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Hitch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
9733
8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer
Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer
Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 9738
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer
Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 9739
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9742
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9743
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9744
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9745
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9746
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9747
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9748
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9749
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair
Grille: Service and Repair
RADIATOR GRILLE
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9753
Navigator
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the front bumper cover.
Expedition only
2. Remove the 4 bumper assembly-to-grille bracket retainer nuts and the bumper assembly-to-grille
bracket.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Grille > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9754
3. NOTE: Expedition shown, Navigator similar.
Remove the clips and remove the front grille.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Console Lamp Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Console Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module.Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped). Failure to
follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable (14301) and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all supplemental restraint system (SRS) components are connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install restraints control module (RCM) fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9765
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off.If an air bag SRS fault
is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9766
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body.This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down.This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin.Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module.Doing so can result in safety canopy
deployment, which can result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device.Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner.Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector.Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON.This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and
the restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors are located in the first row doors, behind the door trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9767
auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).Failure to follow these instructions may
increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position. 8. Center the tilt steering column.
9. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock
position).
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws and pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
11. Remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
All vehicles 12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws. 13. Release the clips and
remove the steering column upper shroud. 14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9768
15. CAUTION: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each
of the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel.Failure to do so will damage the driver
air bag module and steering wheel.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity.The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
- Use a mirror to look at the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
- Note the position of the 2 driver air bag module locator pins to the steering wheel for installation.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
16. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors, then disconnect the horn switch
electrical connector and remove the driver air bag
module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight ahead position (the 12
o'clock position). 18. Open and lower the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9769
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat.The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector.
21. Release the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
22. Remove the bolt and the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9770
23. Remove the cover and the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9771
27. Remove the bolt and the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
28. Remove the cover and the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9772
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat.The driver seat side air bag module
electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SPDJB. 33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9773
5. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9774
9. Connect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
10. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9775
13. Attach the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector. 16. Close the glove compartment
door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag
module.Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module.Do not force
the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the horn switch electrical connector, then connect the 2 driver air bag module electrical
connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9776
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE:
- Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated correctly to the
steering wheel.
- Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks. -
Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud. 22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
23. Install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. Install the lower steering column opening cover and the 3 screws.
All vehicles 25. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 26. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and install the cover.
27. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
28. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s) Arming
and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering and
Repowering > Page 9777
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position.This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps.If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Glove Compartment: Service and Repair
GLOVE COMPARTMENT
Removal and Installation
1. Open the glove compartment.
2. CAUTION: Forcing the glove compartment past the stops will damage the dampener.
If equipped, disconnect the dampener.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Glove Compartment > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 9781
3. Release the stops.
4. Remove the 3 glove compartment screws and the glove compartment. 5. To install, reverse the
removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Headliner: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 > Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof
Panel
Headliner: Customer Interest Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof Panel
TSB 07-22-3
11/12/07
GAP/FIT - HEADLINER TO ROOF OPENING PANEL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel
may experience customer concerns with the fit/gap between the headliner and roof opening panel.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the fit of the roof opening panel to headliner (Figure 1).
a. If there is a gap or poor fit between roof opening panel and headliner or the roof opening panel is
not covering all the outlying areas of the headliner, go to Step 2.
b. If no gap is present, this TSB does not apply, follow Workshop Manual, Section 501-17.
2. Use a sofi pick or equivalent to lift the roof opening panel weatherstrip over the headliner.
3. Finesse and smooth the headliner material to the backing of the headliner if needed.
4. Reposition, finesse and smooth the roof opening panel weatherstrip so it covers the gap or poor
fit area of the headliner. The glue that is on the headliner backing will then adhere to the headliner
material keeping it in place and the repositioning of the weatherstrip will repair the concern.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072203A 2007-2008 0.2 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Correct The Condition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Headliner: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 > Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof
Panel > Page 9790
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7852124 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Headliner: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 > Interior - Gap Between Headliner
and Sunroof Panel
Headliner: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof Panel
TSB 07-22-3
11/12/07
GAP/FIT - HEADLINER TO ROOF OPENING PANEL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel
may experience customer concerns with the fit/gap between the headliner and roof opening panel.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the fit of the roof opening panel to headliner (Figure 1).
a. If there is a gap or poor fit between roof opening panel and headliner or the roof opening panel is
not covering all the outlying areas of the headliner, go to Step 2.
b. If no gap is present, this TSB does not apply, follow Workshop Manual, Section 501-17.
2. Use a sofi pick or equivalent to lift the roof opening panel weatherstrip over the headliner.
3. Finesse and smooth the headliner material to the backing of the headliner if needed.
4. Reposition, finesse and smooth the roof opening panel weatherstrip so it covers the gap or poor
fit area of the headliner. The glue that is on the headliner backing will then adhere to the headliner
material keeping it in place and the repositioning of the weatherstrip will repair the concern.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072203A 2007-2008 0.2 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Correct The Condition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Headliner: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 > Interior - Gap Between Headliner
and Sunroof Panel > Page 9796
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7852124 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 9797
Headliner: Service and Repair
HEADLINER
All vehicles
1. Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
2. Position aside the front and rear door seals.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 9798
3. If equipped, remove the roof opening panel trim. 4. Remove the LH and RH A-pillar trim panels.
5. Remove the 2 wiring harness pin-type retainers from the A-pillar.
6. Open and fully lower the glove compartment.
- Release the glove compartment tabs.
7. If equipped, disconnect the satellite radio antenna.
8. Remove the pin-type retainer and disconnect the electronic compass/auto-dimming rearview
mirror electrical connector. 9. If equipped, separate the satellite antenna cable from the wiring
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 9799
10. If equipped, remove the electronic compass sensor.
11. If equipped, disconnect the auto-dimming mirror electrical connector. 12. Remove the LH and
RH sun visor clips.
- Remove the 8 screws.
- Remove the sun visors and visor clips. If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors.
13. If equipped, remove the overhead console.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
14. If equipped, remove the DVD player. 15. Remove the LH and RH B-pillar trim panels. 16.
Remove the LH and RH C-pillar trim panels. 17. Remove the LH and RH D-pillar trim panels.
18. Disconnect the rear electrical connector.
Vehicles with safety canopies
19. Remove the 4 garment hangers.
- Open the access panel.
- Remove the garment hanger screws.
Vehicles without safety canopies
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Headliner > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 9800
20. CAUTION: To prevent damage to the garment hanger retainer, use a 3/16-inch flat-blade
screwdriver for this step.
NOTE: The garment hanger is shown without the roof sheet metal to show the metal retainer clip.
The metal retainer clip will remain engaged in the sheet metal after the garment hanger is
removed.
Remove the 2 garment hangers. 1
Open the access cover.
2 Insert the flat-blade screwdriver fully into the garment slot.
3 Rotate the screwdriver 90 degrees so that the screwdriver spreads the metal retainer clip.
Remove the plastic garment hanger.
All vehicles
21. Remove the center pin-type retainers. 22. Remove the rear pin-type retainers.
Vehicles with rear climate control
23. Tilt the headliner to release the vent duct.
All vehicles
24. Remove the headliner. 25. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Transfer parts as necessary.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel
Trim Panel: Service and Repair A-Pillar Trim Panel
A-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9805
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 2 front assist handle bolt covers. 2. Remove the 2 assist handle bolts.
- To install, tighten to 5 Nm (44 lb-in).
3. NOTE: Carefully rotate the A-pillar trim panel during this step.
Pry the A-pillar trim panel to remove.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9806
Trim Panel: Service and Repair B-Pillar Trim Panel
B-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9807
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
Upper and lower
1. Move the front seat to the full forward position.
2. NOTE:
- Position the shoulder safety belt guide to the lowest position.
- Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide cover is
damaged or the cover does not remain closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide cover. Detach the top of the shoulder safety belt guide cover.
- Rotate the shoulder safety belt guide cover 90 degrees and remove from the safety belt guide
bolt.
3. Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
- Remove the shoulder safety belt guide bolt. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
- Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9808
4. Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel.
1 Remove the bolt cover and bolt. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
2 Remove the upper B-pillar trim panel by pulling outward to release the clips.
Lower
5. Remove the front and rear door scuff plates.
6. Position the lower B-pillar trim panel aside.
7. Remove the front safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Feed the safety belt through the lower B-pillar trim panel and remove.
Upper and lower
9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- When installing the upper B-pillar trim panel, insert the safety belt guide slide into the upper
B-pillar trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9809
Trim Panel: Service and Repair C-Pillar Trim Panel
C-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9810
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide
cover is damaged or the cover does not remain
closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide. 1
Position the shoulder safety belt cover up.
2 Remove the safety belt guide bolt. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
2. Detach the safety belt holder pin-type retainer.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9811
3. Remove the C-pillar trim panel fastener cover.
Expedition EL/Navigator L only
4. Remove the C-pillar trim panel nut.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles except Expedition EL
5. Remove the C-pillar trim panel bolt.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
All vehicles
6. Remove the C-pillar trim panel.
- Remove the C-pillar trim panel by pulling outward to release the retainers.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9812
Trim Panel: Service and Repair D-Pillar Trim Panel
D-PILLAR TRIM PANEL
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9813
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
All vehicles except Expedition EL/Navigator L
NOTE: Right side with power vent windows shown, all others similar.
1. NOTE: Inspect the shoulder safety belt guide cover for damage. If the shoulder safety belt guide
cover is damaged or cover does not remain
closed, install a new shoulder safety belt guide cover.
Remove the shoulder safety belt guide. 1
Position the shoulder safety guide cover up.
2 Remove the shoulder safety belt guide bolt. To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
3 Remove the shoulder safety belt guide.
All vehicles
2. Remove rear upper headliner trim panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9814
3. Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
1 Disengage the upper clip by pulling downward.
2 Unseat the D-pillar trim panel and rotate forward to remove. If equipped, disconnect the speaker electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9815
Trim Panel: Service and Repair Quarter Trim Panel
QUARTER TRIM PANEL
All vehicles
1. Remove the C-pillar trim panel. 2. Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
3. Remove the liftgate scuff plate by pulling upward.
All vehicles except Expedition EL/Navigator L
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9816
4. Remove the rear floor cargo space trim panel.
All vehicles
5. Remove the floor jack assembly.
Expedition EL/Navigator L
6. Remove the cargo space trim panel.
1 Move the cargo shelf to the upright position.
2 Remove the cargo space trim panel.
7. NOTE: RH cargo shelf bracket shown, LH similar.
Remove the 4 cargo shelf bracket bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9817
All vehicles
8. Remove the pin-type retainers and pull back the carpeting.
9. Remove the 2 bolts and the cargo space panel by pulling upward.
All vehicles except Expedition EL/Navigator L
10. Remove the third row seat safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
11. Remove the rear quarter trim panel pin-type retainer.
Expedition EL/Navigator L
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9818
12. Remove the third row seat safety belt anchor and scrivet.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
13. Remove the rear quarter trim panel bolt.
14. Open the third row seat safety belt guide bolt cover and remove the safety belt guide bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
All vehicles
15. Remove the second row safety belt anchor.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
16. Remove the rear door scuff plate by pulling upward. 17. Fold the seat back of the third row seat
to the full down position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Trim Panel > Component Information > Service and
Repair > A-Pillar Trim Panel > Page 9819
18. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
- Disengage the rear clip on the base of the trim panel first, by pulling the bottom rear edge toward
the center of the vehicle.
- Disengage the remaining clips.
- If equipped, disconnect the power point, power liftgate switch or the power third row seat switch
electrical connector at the rear.
19. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Lock Cylinder > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Door Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
DOOR LOCK CYLINDER
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Individual lock cylinders are repaired by discarding the inoperative lock cylinder and
building a new lock cylinder using the appropriate lock repair package. The lock repair package
includes a detailed instruction sheet to build the new lock cylinder to the current code of the
vehicle.
1. Remove the exterior front door handle. 2. Remove the retainer and the front door lock cylinder.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Diagrams
C500
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 9829
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Testing and Inspection
KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD CODE PROGRAMMING
NOTE: Up to 3 codes can be programmed. Once there are 3 programmed codes, any attempt to
program additional codes will be unsuccessful.
1. Enter the permanent factory keyless entry keypad code.
2. NOTE: The locks should lock and unlock to indicate programming mode has been entered.
Press the 1/2 button within 5 seconds to activate the programming mode. Holding the 1/2 button for
more than 2 seconds after activation erases the stored customer codes.
3. Within 5 seconds, enter the new 5-digit keypad code. The doors lock and unlock to confirm the
new code is programmed. If the locks do not lock
and unlock, the new code programming has not been successful and the procedure must be
started from the beginning.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Key-Pad > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 9830
Keyless Entry Key-Pad: Service and Repair
KEYLESS ENTRY KEYPAD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the exterior mirror. 2. Remove the front door outer glass weatherstrip.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. Release the tabs and remove the keyless entry keypad.
- Disconnect the keypad harness retaining clips from the weatherstrip.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Programming
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Programming
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY TRANSMITTER PROGRAMMING
NOTE:
- All remote keyless entry (RKE) transmitters must be programmed at the same time.
- Programming (or reprogramming) of the RKE transmitters can be accomplished using a scan tool
or by carrying out the following steps.
- Do not apply the brake pedal during this sequencing, as doing so ends the sequence and the
transmitters will not be programmed.
1. Electronically unlock the door locks using the door lock control switch. 2. Turn the ignition switch
from the OFF to the RUN position 8 times in rapid succession (within 10 seconds), with the eighth
turn ending in RUN.
If the module successfully enters program mode, it locks and then unlocks all the doors.
3. NOTE: If no action is taken within 20 seconds after a transmitter has been programmed, the
programming sequence ends (the doors lock and
unlock to confirm that programming is complete).
Within 20 seconds, press any button on the RKE transmitter to be programmed. The doors lock
and then unlock to confirm that each RKE transmitter is programmed. Repeat this step for each
RKE transmitter.
4. Exiting the programming mode is accomplished if one of the following occurs:
- The key transitions to the OFF position.
- 20 seconds have passed since entering programming mode or since the last RKE transmitter was
programmed.
- The maximum number (4) of RKE transmitters have been programmed.
5. Check the operation of the transmitter. If the door locks do not respond for the programmed RKE
transmitter(s), wait several seconds and press the
button again. If the door locks still fail to respond, refer to Locks, Latches and Entry Systems.
(Make sure that no more than the maximum number of RKE transmitters are attempted to be
programmed.)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Programming > Page 9835
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Testing and Inspection Autolock and Horn Chirp Programming
AUTOLOCK AND HORN CHIRP PROGRAMMING
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE:
- This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
- The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
- The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position. 2. Press the unlock button on the
door lock control 3 times. 3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position. 4. Press the
unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times. 5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN
position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The unlock button must be pressed twice within 5 seconds.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the unlock button on the door lock
control switch twice within 5 seconds to enable/disable the autolock feature. The horn chirps once if
the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE:
- This feature can also be enabled or disabled using the message center switch functions, if
equipped.
- The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
- The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position. 2. Press the unlock button on the
door unlock control 3 times. 3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position. 4. Press
the unlock button on the door lock control switch 3 times. 5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN
position.The horn chirps one time to indicate that programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The lock and unlock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the lock button on the door lock
control switch then the unlock button to enable/disable the auto-unlock feature. The horn chirps
once if the autolocks are disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Programming the Perimeter Lighting Feature Using the Door Lock Control Switch
NOTE: The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Turn the ignition switch from the OFF to the RUN position. 2. Press the unlock button on the
door unlock control 3 times. 3. Turn the ignition switch from the RUN to the OFF position. 4. Press
the unlock button on the door unlock control switch 3 times. 5. Turn the ignition switch to the RUN
position. The horn chirps one time to indicate that programming mode is entered.
6. NOTE: The lock and unlock buttons must be pressed within 5 seconds of each other.
Within 30 seconds of entering the programming mode, press the lock button on the door lock
control switch then the unlock button to enable/disable the perimeter lighting feature. The horn
chirps once if the perimeter lighting is disabled or a chirp followed by a honk if the perimeter lighting
is enabled.
7. Programming ends when the ignition switch state changes or times out after 2 minutes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Programming > Page 9836
Programming the Autolock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE:
- The autolock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the auto-unlock feature.
- The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure needs to be repeated.
If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code. 2. Press and hold the 3/4 button. 3. While holding the 3/4
button, press and release the 7/8 button. 4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if the
autolocks are disabled, or chirps once followed by a honk if the autolocks are enabled.
Programming the Auto-Unlock Feature Using the Keyless Entry Keypad
NOTE:
- The auto-unlock feature can be enabled or disabled independently of the autolock feature.
- The following steps must be carried out within 30 seconds or the procedure will need to be
repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, wait 30 seconds between programming sessions.
1. Enter the factory set 5 digit entry code. 2. Press and hold the 3/4 button. 3. While holding the 3/4
button, press and release the 7/8 button twice. 4. Release the 3/4 button. The horn chirps once if
auto-unlock is disabled, or chirps once followed by a honk if auto-unlock is enabled.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Remote Memory Activation
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Remote Memory Activation
REMOTE MEMORY ACTIVATION
1. Move the seat, rear view mirrors, and adjustable pedals to the desired position. 2. Press the
memory set switch SET button. 3. Within 5 seconds, press any button on the remote transmitter
(except the PANIC button), and then press the appropriate memory set switch
button.
4. Repeat Steps 1-3 for each remote transmitter to be programmed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Keyless Entry > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information
> Service and Repair > Remote Memory Activation > Page 9839
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Service and Repair Remote Memory Deactivation
REMOTE MEMORY DEACTIVATION
1. Press the memory set switch SET button. 2. Within 5 seconds, press any button on the remote
transmitter that is to be deactivated (except the PANIC button), and then press the memory set
switch SET button.
3. Repeat Steps 1 and 2 for each remote transmitter to be deactivated from the memory setting.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 9845
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 9846
View 151-39 (LH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Locations > Door Lock Actuator, Right Front > Page 9847
View 151-40 (RH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front
C525
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front > Page 9850
C603
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front > Page 9851
C704
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Door Lock Actuator, Left Front > Page 9852
C804
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 9853
Power Door Lock Actuator: Service and Repair
DOOR LOCK ACTUATOR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door lock actuator. 3. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 9858
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
C505
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side > Page 9861
C605
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 9862
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 9863
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 9864
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door trim panel. 2. Release the tabs and remove the door lock control switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9870
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C341A
C341B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9871
C341C
C341D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9872
C341E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the outboard side of the driver
seat track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver
seat position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 9879
C3246
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Mirror Motor: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRROR MOTOR
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: If equipped with power folding mirrors, they must be synchronized any time the mirrors
have been folded or unfolded without using the mirror control switch.
1. Remove the mirror glass. 2. Remove the 3 exterior mirror motor screws and exterior mirror
motor.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- If equipped with power folding mirrors, they must be synchronized.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9886
C527
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9887
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9888
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9889
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Power Mirror Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
9890
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driver front door trim panel.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
1 Depress the locking tabs.
2 Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes
Paint: Application and ID Paint Codes
PAINT CODES
Vehicle Certification Label
Exterior Paint Code
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 9896
Exterior Paint Code
Paint codes may be listed as a 2-part code. The first set of characters listed indicate the vehicle
primary body color. The second set of characters listed (if applicable) indicate a 2-tone or accent
body color. All colors are base coat/clear coat. DX - Dark Blue Pearl
- G2 - Redfire
- G3 - Pueblo Gold
- G5 - Alloy Gray
- JP - Silver Birch Metallic
- PG - Dark Amethyst
- PV - White Chocolate (tri-coat)
- T5 - Dark Copper
- UA - Ebony
- YZ - Oxford White
Interior Trim
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 9897
Interior Trim
Interior trim codes are listed as a 2-part code. The first character identifies the trim type. The
second character identifies the interior trim color.
Trim Type 1 - Verona leather, 40/40 captain's chairs - Expedition
- 2 - Verona Leather, 40/40 captain's chairs - Expedition
- 3 - Verona Leather, 40/40 captain's chairs with accent - Expedition
- F - Beck cloth captain's chairs - Expedition
- M - Adobe/Beck cloth, 40/60 split bench seat - Expedition
- T - Premium/Soho Leather, 40/40 captain's chairs - Navigator
Interior Trim Color C - Camel Tan
- L - Medium Light Stone
- W - Charcoal Black
Tape/Paint Stripe
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 9898
Tape/Paint Stripe
Tape and paint stripe codes do not apply
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Application and ID
> Paint Codes > Page 9899
Paint: Application and ID Paint Code Sticker Location
PAINT CODE STICKER LOCATION
Vehicle Certification (VC) Label Locator
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9904
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C341A
C341B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9905
C341C
C341D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9906
C341E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Power Seat Control Module: Description and Operation
DRIVER SEAT MODULE - MEMORY SEAT
The power driver seat, power outside rear view mirrors, power adjustable pedals and adjustable
steering column are controlled by the driver seat module (DSM) only when the vehicle is equipped
with the programmable/recall memory option. The DSM is located on the driver seat track.
This system allows automatic positioning of the driver seat to 2 programmable positions.
The memory seat system consists of the following components:
- DSM
- Driver memory seat control switch
- Memory set switch
- Adjustable pedal switch
- Power mirror switch
- Adjustable steering column switch
- Memory seat track assembly (with seat position sensors integral to motors) Horizontal motor (part of seat track)
- Front height motor (part of seat track)
- Rear height motor (part of seat track)
- Backrest power recliner motor (with integral position sensor) (part of backrest frame)
- LH memory power mirror
- RH memory power mirror
- Power adjustable memory pedals
- Power adjustable steering column
- Remote keyless entry transmitter
Two personalized seat positions may be programmed into the memory seat system. A memory
seat position may be set by first positioning the driver seat using the driver power seat switch and
depressing the memory set switch. Memory seat position 1 or 2 must be selected within 5 seconds
to set a personalized seat position. If position 1 or 2 is not selected within 5 seconds, the operation
is aborted. This operation also aborts if any input is received from the driver power seat switch, the
power mirror switch, the adjustable pedal switch, the power adjustable steering column switch or if
the memory set switch is depressed again during the 5-second limit. The personalized memory
seat positions are recalled using the memory switch positions 1 and 2 or with the remote keyless
entry transmitter.
A programmed seat position can only be recalled when the transmission selector is in PARK or
NEUTRAL with the ignition switch in the RUN position. A position may be programmed at any time.
For information on the DSM, refer to Body Control Systems (Multifunction Electronic Control
Module).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 9914
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 9917
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 9918
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 9919
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 9920
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Seat Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 9921
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Customer Interest Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC
B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 9930
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Power Liftgate
Inoperative/DTC B117B
TSB 08-14-5
07/21/08
POWER LIFT GATE INOPERATIVE - ALL FUNCTIONAL SWITCHES, REMOTE KEYLESS
ENTRY, WITH POWER LIFT GATE TRUNK MODULE DTC B117B
FORD: 2008 Taurus X 2007-2008 Edge, Expedition
Ford: 2009 Flex
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition, Navigator Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X and 2009 Flex may
exhibit an inoperative power lift gate from remote keyless entry, inside switches or the outside lift
gate handle with a power lift gate/trunk module (LTM) with diagnostic trouble code (DTC) B117B
and PID UCH_OUT set to Active.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check power lift gate operation from all buttons.
2. If the power lift gate is inoperative, then check the LTM for DTC B117B and for PID UCH_Out
set to "Active".
NOTE
THE PID UCH_OUT IS SET TO "INACTIVE" OR ANY OTHER DTC ARE RETRIEVED, DO NOT
CONTINUE WITH THIS PROCEDURE, PERFORM NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS PER THE WORK
SHOP MANUAL SECTION 501-03.
3. If both the DTC B117B and the PID UCH_Out equal "Active" are present, then clear the LTM
memory and proceed to Step 4.
4. Reprogram the LTM module to the latest calibration using IDS release 55.13 Patch 28 and
higher or 56.1 and higher. This new calibration is not included in the VCM 2008.7 DVD. Calibration
files may also be obtained at the website.
5. Initialize LTM per Work Shop Manual Section 501-03.
6. Check the operation of the power lift gate. Check for any DTCs. If lift gate operation passes from
all switches and there are NO DTCs in the LTM, return the vehicle to the customer.
7. If any DTCs are present after retesting or lift gate is inoperative, from any switches, perform
Work Shop Manual diagnosis per Section 501-03.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081405A 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator, Edge, MKX, 2008 Taurus X, 2009 Flex: Reprogram The LTM, Includes Time To Check
DTCs And, Lift Gate Operation, Authorization Decal Not Required (Do Not Use With 12650D,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Trunk / Liftgate
Control Module: > 08-14-5 > Jul > 08 > Body - Power Liftgate Inoperative/DTC B117B > Page 9936
12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9937
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Locations
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9938
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9939
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Diagrams
C4174A
C4174B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9940
Power Trunk / Liftgate Control Module: Service and Repair
POWER LIFTGATE MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. Remove the power liftgate module.
1 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2 Remove the bolt. To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Auxiliary Step / Running Board
Module > Component Information > Service and Repair
Auxiliary Step / Running Board Module: Service and Repair
RETRACTABLE RUNNING BOARD MODULE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH B-pillar trim panel. 2. Disconnect the retractable running board module electrical
connectors. 3. Remove the 2 bolts and the retractable running board module assembly. 4. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 07-21-6 > Oct
> 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
Seat Heater Control Module: Customer Interest A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
TSB 07-21-6
10/29/07
CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - NO COMMUNICATION - DCSM VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 8/31/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 KZ, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
built before 8/31/2007 and equipped with climate control seats may exhibit inoperative heating
and/or cooling. There are no diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) associated with this issue and
IDS/PDS will not communicate with the dual climate control seat module (DCSM).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn the ignition switch to key on engine off (KOEO) position.
2. Run self test on DCSM.
a. If DTCs are present do not continue with this TSB, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM)
diagnostics for the DTCs.
b. If no communication with the DCSM, proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove power to the DCSM and wait a minimum of 2 minutes. This will reset the DCSM.
^ Expedition/Navigator - remove Fuse 8 in the battery junction box (BJB).
^ Zephyr/MKZ - remove Fuse 11 and 12 in the BJB.
4. Reinstall the fuse(s) and recheck for communication.
a. If communication does not return, refer to WSM, Section 418-00.
b. If the communication is restored by resetting:
(1) Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ - reprogram the DCSM to the latest calibration using IDS
release 51.4 or later with patch 7. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
(2) 2006 Zephyr/2007 MKZ - replace the DCSM.
5. Recheck operation of the heated/cooled seat and for DTCs. If no DTCs return the vehicle to the
customer.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 07-21-6 > Oct
> 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative > Page 9952
072106A 2007-2008 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ With Climate Control Seats Built Before 8/31/2007: Reprogram
The DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not Use
With 12650D 12651D, 12651D4)
072106A 2006 Zephyr, 2007 MKZ: 1.0 Hr.
Replace DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not
Use With 12650D, 12651D,
12651D4, 63100A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
Seat Heater Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Climate Control Seats
Inoperative
TSB 07-21-6
10/29/07
CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - NO COMMUNICATION - DCSM VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 8/31/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 KZ, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
built before 8/31/2007 and equipped with climate control seats may exhibit inoperative heating
and/or cooling. There are no diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) associated with this issue and
IDS/PDS will not communicate with the dual climate control seat module (DCSM).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn the ignition switch to key on engine off (KOEO) position.
2. Run self test on DCSM.
a. If DTCs are present do not continue with this TSB, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM)
diagnostics for the DTCs.
b. If no communication with the DCSM, proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove power to the DCSM and wait a minimum of 2 minutes. This will reset the DCSM.
^ Expedition/Navigator - remove Fuse 8 in the battery junction box (BJB).
^ Zephyr/MKZ - remove Fuse 11 and 12 in the BJB.
4. Reinstall the fuse(s) and recheck for communication.
a. If communication does not return, refer to WSM, Section 418-00.
b. If the communication is restored by resetting:
(1) Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ - reprogram the DCSM to the latest calibration using IDS
release 51.4 or later with patch 7. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
(2) 2006 Zephyr/2007 MKZ - replace the DCSM.
5. Recheck operation of the heated/cooled seat and for DTCs. If no DTCs return the vehicle to the
customer.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: >
07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative > Page 9958
072106A 2007-2008 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ With Climate Control Seats Built Before 8/31/2007: Reprogram
The DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not Use
With 12650D 12651D, 12651D4)
072106A 2006 Zephyr, 2007 MKZ: 1.0 Hr.
Replace DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not
Use With 12650D, 12651D,
12651D4, 63100A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9959
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9960
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams
C3265A
C3265B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9961
C3265C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 9962
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair
CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), carry out the appropriate steps in
the programmable module installation (PMI)
procedure.
2. Position the front passenger seat fully upward and depower the supplemental restraint system
(SRS).
3. CAUTION: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield. Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
4. Release the 2 tabs and slide out the CCSM.
5. Remove the CCSM.
- Cut and remove the wiring harness tie strap.
- Release the 2 locking wedges.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the SRS. 8. If a new CCSM has been
installed, carry out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Locations
View 151-43 (Roof - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9966
View 151-45 (Roof - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Sunroof / Moonroof Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 9967
C921
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 9972
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn > Page 9973
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9976
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9977
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9978
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9979
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9980
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9981
Trailer Towing Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9982
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trailer Towing Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 9983
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Motor: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL MOTOR
Exploded View
Removal
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed. Refer to Roof Opening Panel Motor
Initialization.
1. Remove the headliner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9989
2. Disconnect the roof opening panel motor electrical connector and cut the tie strap.
3. Remove the roof opening panel motor.
- Remove the 3 screws.
Installation
1. Connect the roof opening panel motor electrical connector. Install a new tie strap and trim off
excess.
2. NOTE: When installing the roof opening panel motor/module, align the 3 attach holes before
engaging the drive gear into the roof opening panel
drive cable. Do not rotate the motor assembly after the drive gear is engaged with the roof opening
panel drive cable. Otherwise, the cable can bind.
Install the roof opening panel motor. Align the attach holes, then install the 3 screws and tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9990
3. Connect the overhead console electrical connectors. 4. Initialize the roof opening panel
motor/module. 5. Disconnect the overhead console electrical connectors. 6. Install the headliner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Track: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL REAR TROUGH GUIDE
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed.
1. Remove the roof opening panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9994
2. Remove the 2 trough guide retaining screws.
- To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
3. Remove the trough from the trough guide assembly.
4. Disconnect the trough guide rods from the lifter arm assemblies.
5. Slide the trough guide back to the slot (approximately 15 mm [0.6 in]) cut in track.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9995
6. Carefully twist trough guide through the slot in the track to remove. 7. Inspect the trough guide
assembly for damage. If damage is found, inspect the track for broken pieces and remove them. 8.
To install, reverse the removal procedure. 9. Adjust roof opening panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Windguard: Service and Repair
AIR DEFLECTOR
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Open the roof opening panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Windguard > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 9999
2. NOTE: RH side shown, LH similar.
Remove the 2 air deflector tether screws. To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
3. Raise the front of the air deflector.
4. Slide the air deflector toward the rear, then lift up to release it from the pivot shafts. 5. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Frame > Component Information > Service and Repair
Sunroof / Moonroof Frame: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL FRAME
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed. Refer to Roof Opening Panel Motor
Initialization. See: Service and Repair
1. Remove the headliner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Frame > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10003
2. Remove the overhead console bracket.
- Remove the screws.
3. Disconnect the electrical connector and cut the tie strap.
4. Remove the roof opening panel frame.
1 Disconnect the 4 roof opening panel drain hoses.
2 Remove the 11 bolts. To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
3 Remove the roof opening panel frame.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. If a new roof opening panel frame is being installed,
transfer the existing roof opening panel motor, air
deflector, rear trough, roof opening panel glass and roof opening panel shield onto the new frame
assembly. Check for correct alignment of the roof opening panel.
- Initialize the roof opening panel motor. Refer to Roof Opening Panel Motor Initialization. See:
Service and Repair
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Locations
Sunroof / Moonroof Module: Locations
View 151-43 (Roof - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 10007
View 151-45 (Roof - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 10008
C921
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel
ROOF OPENING PANEL
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed.
1. Position the roof opening panel in the VENT position.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel > Page 10013
2. Remove the 4 roof opening panel glass screws.
- To install, tighten to 4 Nm (35 lb-in).
3. Remove the roof opening panel from the outside of the vehicle by lifting up and out. 4. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
- Adjust the roof opening panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel > Page 10014
Sunroof / Moonroof Panel: Service and Repair Roof Opening Panel Shield
ROOF OPENING PANEL SHIELD
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed.
1. Remove the roof opening panel glass.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Panel > Component Information > Service and Repair > Roof Opening Panel > Page 10015
2. Remove the water trough.
1 Remove the 2 screws. To install, tighten to 1 Nm (9 lb-in).
2 Remove the water trough.
3. Flex the opening shield to remove the guides from the tracks and remove the roof opening panel
shield. 4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High
Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 10024
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 10025
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 > Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof Panel
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof
Panel
TSB 07-22-3
11/12/07
GAP/FIT - HEADLINER TO ROOF OPENING PANEL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel
may experience customer concerns with the fit/gap between the headliner and roof opening panel.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the fit of the roof opening panel to headliner (Figure 1).
a. If there is a gap or poor fit between roof opening panel and headliner or the roof opening panel is
not covering all the outlying areas of the headliner, go to Step 2.
b. If no gap is present, this TSB does not apply, follow Workshop Manual, Section 501-17.
2. Use a sofi pick or equivalent to lift the roof opening panel weatherstrip over the headliner.
3. Finesse and smooth the headliner material to the backing of the headliner if needed.
4. Reposition, finesse and smooth the roof opening panel weatherstrip so it covers the gap or poor
fit area of the headliner. The glue that is on the headliner backing will then adhere to the headliner
material keeping it in place and the repositioning of the weatherstrip will repair the concern.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072203A 2007-2008 0.2 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Correct The Condition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof
Weatherstrip: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 > Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof Panel > Page 10030
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7852124 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Sunroof Water Leaks
During High Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page
10036
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page
10037
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 > Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof Panel
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Gap Between Headliner
and Sunroof Panel
TSB 07-22-3
11/12/07
GAP/FIT - HEADLINER TO ROOF OPENING PANEL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel
may experience customer concerns with the fit/gap between the headliner and roof opening panel.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the fit of the roof opening panel to headliner (Figure 1).
a. If there is a gap or poor fit between roof opening panel and headliner or the roof opening panel is
not covering all the outlying areas of the headliner, go to Step 2.
b. If no gap is present, this TSB does not apply, follow Workshop Manual, Section 501-17.
2. Use a sofi pick or equivalent to lift the roof opening panel weatherstrip over the headliner.
3. Finesse and smooth the headliner material to the backing of the headliner if needed.
4. Reposition, finesse and smooth the roof opening panel weatherstrip so it covers the gap or poor
fit area of the headliner. The glue that is on the headliner backing will then adhere to the headliner
material keeping it in place and the repositioning of the weatherstrip will repair the concern.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072203A 2007-2008 0.2 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Correct The Condition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof
/ Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 > Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof Panel > Page 10042
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7852124 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10043
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL WEATHERSTRIP
Exploded View
Removal
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed.
1. Remove the roof opening panel. 2. Place roof opening panel, topside up, on a worktable. Take
care to support the glass assembly from below to prevent damaging the mounting tabs.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Sunroof /
Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10044
3. Remove the old roof opening panel weatherstrip by pulling up on the weatherstrip.
Installation
1. Place a new weatherstrip into position on the glass assembly, with the splice (seam) on the
passenger side. 2. Starting with the corners, push the weatherstrip into position. Continue pushing
the weatherstrip into position around the glass assembly until
complete. Use a plastic or rubber hammer if necessary.
3. Install the roof opening panel. 4. Adjust the roof panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10050
Memory Positioning Module: Diagrams
C341A
C341B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10051
C341C
C341D
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Memory Positioning Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10052
C341E
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the outboard side of the driver
seat track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver
seat position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Memory Positioning Systems > Seat Memory Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10059
C3246
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Control Module > Component Information > Description
and Operation
Power Seat Control Module: Description and Operation
DRIVER SEAT MODULE - MEMORY SEAT
The power driver seat, power outside rear view mirrors, power adjustable pedals and adjustable
steering column are controlled by the driver seat module (DSM) only when the vehicle is equipped
with the programmable/recall memory option. The DSM is located on the driver seat track.
This system allows automatic positioning of the driver seat to 2 programmable positions.
The memory seat system consists of the following components:
- DSM
- Driver memory seat control switch
- Memory set switch
- Adjustable pedal switch
- Power mirror switch
- Adjustable steering column switch
- Memory seat track assembly (with seat position sensors integral to motors) Horizontal motor (part of seat track)
- Front height motor (part of seat track)
- Rear height motor (part of seat track)
- Backrest power recliner motor (with integral position sensor) (part of backrest frame)
- LH memory power mirror
- RH memory power mirror
- Power adjustable memory pedals
- Power adjustable steering column
- Remote keyless entry transmitter
Two personalized seat positions may be programmed into the memory seat system. A memory
seat position may be set by first positioning the driver seat using the driver power seat switch and
depressing the memory set switch. Memory seat position 1 or 2 must be selected within 5 seconds
to set a personalized seat position. If position 1 or 2 is not selected within 5 seconds, the operation
is aborted. This operation also aborts if any input is received from the driver power seat switch, the
power mirror switch, the adjustable pedal switch, the power adjustable steering column switch or if
the memory set switch is depressed again during the 5-second limit. The personalized memory
seat positions are recalled using the memory switch positions 1 and 2 or with the remote keyless
entry transmitter.
A programmed seat position can only be recalled when the transmission selector is in PARK or
NEUTRAL with the ignition switch in the RUN position. A position may be programmed at any time.
For information on the DSM, refer to Body Control Systems (Multifunction Electronic Control
Module).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10067
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10068
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10069
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10070
Power Seat Motor: Locations
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10071
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10072
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10073
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10074
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10075
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10076
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10077
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10078
View 151-26 (Right Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Passenger Seat Front/Rear Height Motor > Page 10079
View 151-30 (Right Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor
C332
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10082
C3074
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10083
C3075
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10084
C3187
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10085
Power Seat Motor: Diagrams
C332
C3074
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10086
C3075
C3187
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10087
C363
C382
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10088
C362
C3189
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10089
C3215
C3216
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Passenger Seat Horizontal Motor > Page 10090
C4181
C4182
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
10091
Power Seat Motor: Service and Repair
POWER-FOLD SEAT MOTOR
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
10092
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
10093
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
10094
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
10095
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
10096
Seat Cushion - 60 Percent
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LH seat shown, RH seat similar.
1. Remove the load floor panel. 2. Remove the 2 bolts and mid-floor panel support.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
10097
- Detach the 3 pin-type retainers.
3. Detach the wiring harness pin-type retainer and disconnect the affected power seat motor
electrical connector.
4. NOTE: Note position of bushing shoulder for installation.
Remove the bracket-to-pivot bolt and bushing from the power-fold seat motor. To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Remove the bracket-to-latch bolt and power-fold seat motor.
- Slide the power-fold seat motor and bracket away from the latch and torque shaft. For installation, slightly rotate the torque shaft until seated into the power-fold seat motor.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor > Page 10102
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor > Page 10103
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Locations Height Sensor, Left/Right Rear
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor > Page 10104
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor
C372
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 10107
C373
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 10108
C383
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 10109
C4092
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Motor Position Sensor > Component Information >
Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 10110
C4093
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Locations > Third
Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10115
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10118
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10119
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10120
Power Seat Relay: Testing and Inspection Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10121
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Third Row Folding Seat Relay, Left > Page 10122
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Power
Seat Switch, Left
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Power
Seat Switch, Left > Page 10127
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Power
Seat Switch, Left > Page 10128
Power Seat Switch: Locations Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left/Right
View 151-26 (Right Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Locations > Power
Seat Switch, Left > Page 10129
View 151-30 (Right Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Power
Seat Switch, Left
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Power Seat Switch, Left
C352
C3016
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Power
Seat Switch, Left > Page 10132
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Power Seat Switch, Right
C355
C3026
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Power
Seat Switch, Left > Page 10133
C4179
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Power
Seat Switch, Left > Page 10134
C4180
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10137
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10138
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10139
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10140
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 10-Way Power Seat - Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10141
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10142
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 10-Way Power Seat - Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10143
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10144
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10145
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10146
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10147
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10148
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10149
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10150
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10151
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10152
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10153
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10154
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10155
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 10156
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair
MEMORY SET SWITCH
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 10157
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 10158
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 10159
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Power Seat Switch > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 10160
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat shown, passenger similar.
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Detach and position aside the driver seat
cushion side shield cover. 3. Release the clips and remove the memory set switch.
- Disconnect the seat control switch.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement
Seat Back: Removal and Replacement
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent
SEAT BACKREST - FRONT, 40 PERCENT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10165
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10166
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10167
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10168
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- Front seat back trim covers installed on seats equipped with side air bags cannot be repaired,
they are to be replaced. Cleaning is permissible.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a side air bag deployment took place, a new seat back pad, trim cover and side air bag module
and nuts must be installed. The seat back frame should be replaced if necessary.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat shown, passenger seat similar.
All seats
1. Remove the affected seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. If equipped,
release the tab and remove the manual recliner lever handle. 3. If equipped, remove the manual
lumbar control knob.
- Adjust the manual lumbar to the fully relaxed position.
- Pull outward and remove the manual lumbar knob.
4. Detach and remove the cushion side shield cover.
- If equipped, disconnect the seat control switch.
- If equipped, disconnect the memory set switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10169
Power seat with manual recliner
5. Remove the seat control switch knob.
6. Remove the cushion side shield cover forward screw.
7. CAUTION: Do not damage the manual recliner lever when removing the cushion side shield
cover.
Remove the cushion side shield cover. Partially remove the cover to gain access to the seat control switch.
- Release the retainers and detach the seat control switch from the side shield cover.
- Remove the cushion side shield cover.
All seats
8. NOTE: For power seats, note the wiring harness routing for installation.
Remove the 5 screws and cushion side shield. Detach the pin-type retainer.
- If equipped, route out the wiring harness.
9. Release the backrest lower J-strip and unzip the 2 side zippers.
Seats with manual lumbar
10. NOTE: The lumbar support assembly must be fully relaxed.
Remove the manual lumbar actuator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10170
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Remove the manual lumbar actuator.
- Detach the lumbar cable.
11. NOTE: Note manual lumbar cable routing for installation.
Route the manual lumbar cable from the backrest.
12. NOTE: Note the position of the side air bag module locator pin to the seat backrest frame for
installation.
Remove the 2 side air bag module nuts. To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
13. NOTE: Note the position of the side air bag module locator pin and mounting studs in the seat
backrest trim cover deployment chute for
installation.
Position the seat backrest foam aside and remove the side air bag module from the backrest
frame. Then slide the side air bag module out of the seat backrest trim cover deployment chute.
14. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the side air bag module.
15. NOTE: Note wiring harness routing for installation.
Detach the 3 pin-type retainers and route out the side air bag wiring harness.
Power and climate controlled seats
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10171
16. Disconnect the backrest wiring harness electrical connector.
17. NOTE: Note wiring harness routing for installation.
Route the backrest wiring harness from the cushion.
All seats
18. Release the cushion trim cover rear hook and loop strip from the inboard side. 19. Remove the
4 backrest frame-to-seat track bolts and backrest.
- To install, tighten to 45 Nm (33 lb-ft).
20. WARNING:
- Check the side air bag module deployment chute for damage. The side air bag module
deployment chute must not be repaired. If there is any damage to the deployment chute, a new
seat back trim cover and deployment chute must be installed as a unit. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
- Inspect the mounting surfaces of the side air bag module for any foreign objects before installing
the side air bag module. If any foreign objects are found, remove them. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
- If the side air bag module cover has separated or the air bag material has been exposed, install a
new side air bag module. Do not attempt to repair the air bag module. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
21. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Seat Backrest - Front, 60 Percent
SEAT BACKREST - FRONT, 60 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10172
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10173
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10174
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10175
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10176
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- Front seat back trim covers installed on seats equipped with side air bags cannot be repaired,
they are to be replaced. Cleaning is permissible.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a side air bag deployment took place, a new seat back pad, trim cover and side air bag module
and nuts must be installed. The seat back frame should be replaced if necessary.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the front 60 percent seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2.
Release tab and remove the manual recliner lever handle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10177
3. Remove the cushion side shield cover.
- Remove the forward screw.
- Detach the retainer clips and remove the cover.
4. Remove the 5 screws and cushion side shield. 5. Release the backrest lower J-strip and unzip
the 2 side zippers.
6. NOTE: Note the position of the side air bag module locator pin to the seat backrest frame for
installation.
Remove the 2 side air bag module nuts. To install, tighten to 10 Nm (89 lb-in).
7. NOTE: Note the position of the side air bag module locator pin and mounting studs in the seat
backrest trim cover deployment chute for
installation.
Position the seat backrest foam aside and remove the side air bag module from the backrest
frame. Then slide the side air bag module out of the seat backrest trim cover deployment chute.
8. Disconnect the electrical connector and remove the side air bag module.
9. NOTE: Note wiring harness routing for installation.
Route the backrest wiring harness from the cushion. Detach the clip and 3 pin-type retainers.
10. Remove the 4 backrest frame-to-seat track bolts and backrest.
- To install, tighten to 45 Nm (33 lb-ft).
11. WARNING:
- Check the side air bag module deployment chute for damage. The side air bag module
deployment chute must not be repaired. If there is any damage to the deployment chute, a new
seat back trim cover and deployment chute must be installed as a unit. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
- Inspect the mounting surfaces of the side air bag module for any foreign objects before installing
the side air bag module. If any foreign objects are found, remove them. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
- If the side air bag module cover has separated or the air bag material has been exposed, install a
new side air bag module. Do not attempt to repair the air bag module. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
12. Install the 60 percent seat and repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10178
Seat Backrest - Second Row, 20 Percent
SEAT BACKREST - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10179
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10180
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10181
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10182
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 20 percent seat from the vehicle. 2. Remove the screw and pivot bolt cover.
- Route the attaching strap through the pivot bolt cover.
3. Release the 2 lower backrest trim cover J-clips. 4. Remove the pin-type retainer and detach the
LH side attaching strap. 5. Remove the 2 screws and RH side shield.
- Raise the backrest upright to access and remove the center screw.
- Release the 2 pin-type retainers.
6. NOTE: Note attaching strap routing for installation.
Remove the pin-type retainer and detach the RH attaching strap.
7. Remove the bolt and detach the safety belt retractor anchor.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
8. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and lower panel.
9. Release the 3 lower backrest J-clips and route the RH trim cover flap through the child safety
seat lower anchor and tether for children (LATCH)
anchor.
10. Detach the 2 J-clips and remove the attaching straps.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10183
11. Detach the cable end and latch release cable from the seat base.
12. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-an-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Partially invert the backrest trim cover to access the backrest fasteners.
13. Position aside the foam pad and remove the 2 swivel bolts.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
14. Remove the pivot bolt.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
15. Remove the 2 backrest-to-cushion bolts.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
16. NOTE: Note cable routing for installation.
Remove the seat backrest. Route out the latch release cable.
17. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 40 Percent
SEAT BACKREST - THIRD ROW, 40 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10184
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10185
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10186
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10187
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10188
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10189
Seat Cushion - 60 Percent
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
All seats
1. Remove the third row 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the 2 screws and the inboard and outboard
slide bracket covers. 3. Release the backrest trim cover lower and inboard J-clips.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10190
Manual fold seat
4. Remove the manual seat cable.
1 Pinch the cable end and remove the cable from the retainer.
2 Release the cable end hook from the retaining hole.
All seats
5. Remove the outboard slide bracket-to-backrest frame and outboard slide bracket-to-outboard
latch nuts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
6. Remove the inboard slide bracket-to-backrest frame and inboard slide bracket-to-inboard latch
nuts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
7. Remove the backrest from the cushion. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 60 Percent
SEAT BACKREST - THIRD ROW, 60 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10191
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10192
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10193
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10194
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10195
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10196
Seat Cushion - 60 Percent
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
All seats
1. Remove the third row 60 percent seat. 2. Remove the 2 screws and the inboard and outboard
slide bracket covers. 3. Release the backrest trim cover lower and inboard J-clips.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10197
Manual fold seats
4. Remove the manual seat cable.
1 Pinch the cable end and remove the cable from retainer.
2 Release the cable end hook from the retaining hole.
All seats
5. Remove the outboard slide bracket-to-backrest frame and outboard slide bracket-to-outboard
latch nuts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
6. Remove the inboard slide bracket-to-backrest frame and inboard slide bracket-to-inboard latch
nuts.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
7. Remove the backrest from the cushion. 8. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10198
Seat Back: Overhaul
Seat Backrest - Front
SEAT BACKREST - FRONT
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10199
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- Front seat back trim covers installed on seats equipped with side air bags cannot be repaired,
they are to be replaced. Cleaning is permissible.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a side air bag deployment took place, a new seat back pad, trim cover and side air bag module
and nuts must be installed. The seat back frame should be replaced if necessary.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. Remove the affected seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Remove the
backrest assembly. 3. Remove the head restraint.
- Push in the RH guide button to release and remove the head restraint.
4. Raise the rear trim cover flap and release the inner J-clip.
5. NOTE: The head restraint guides are not interchangeable. Note location for installation.
Remove the headrest guides.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10200
- Reach into the backrest and pinch the headrest guide ends together to release from the backrest
frame.
- Pull the backrest trim cover away from the spring clips while pulling out the headrest guides.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Partially invert the backrest trim cover and remove the lower hog rings from the support wires.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
NOTE: Note the side air bag module deployment chute routing for installation.
Continue to invert the trim cover and remove the upper hog rings. Route the side air bag module deployment chute through the slot in the foam pad.
8. Remove the backrest trim cover. 9. Release the lower flap from the backrest frame hooks and
remove the backrest foam pad.
10. Remove the 4 bolts and lumbar assembly.
- To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
- If equipped, disconnect the electrical connector from the lumbar assembly.
- If equipped, route out the manual lumbar cable.
Climate controlled seats
11. Remove the climate controlled seat thermo-electric device (TED).
- Disconnect the TED electrical connector.
- Remove the scrivet.
- Detach the 2 retainer clips from the backrest frame support wires.
Seats with power recliner
12. Disconnect the recliner motor electrical connector.
Power and climate controlled seats
13. NOTE: Note the wiring harness routing for installation.
Detach the clip and pin-type retainer and remove the backrest wiring harness.
All seats
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10201
14. WARNING:
- Check the air bag deployment chute for damage. The air bag deployment chute must not be
repaired. If there is any damage to the deployment chute, a new seat back trim cover and
deployment chute must be installed as a unit. Failure to do so may result in personal injury, in the
event of an air bag deployment.
- Inspect the mounting surfaces of the side air bag module for any foreign objects before installing
the side air bag module. If any foreign objects are found, remove them. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
- If the air bag cover has separated or the air bag material has been exposed, install a new side air
bag module. Do not attempt to repair the air bag module. Failure to do so may result in personal
injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
15. Install the backrest assembly. 16. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Seat Backrest - Second Row, 20 Percent
SEAT BACKREST - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10202
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10203
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the 20 percent seat. 2. Remove the 20 percent seat backrest. 3. Remove the safety belt
guide cover.
- Insert an appropriate tool into the holes and release the 3 locking tabs.
- Detach the safety belt guide cover.
- Route the safety belt webbing through the slot.
4. Remove the latch release handle bezel.
- Release the upper tab and separate the bezel from the latch release handle.
5. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the backrest trim cover to the row of hog rings.
6. Remove the row of hog rings. 7. Continue inverting and remove the backrest trim cover.
- Route the safety belt webbing through the trim cover opening.
8. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and foam pad. 9. Remove the safety belt retractor foam cover.
10. Remove the 2 screws and safety belt retractor cover. 11. Remove the safety belt retractor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
12. Release the 2 tabs and detach the safety belt retractor guide.
13. NOTE:
- Note safety belt routing for installation.
- Make sure the safety belt webbing is not twisted prior to installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10204
Remove the safety belt retractor. Route out the safety belt webbing, guide, tongue and anchor through the backrest frame.
14. Release the pin-type retainer and detach the release cable from the backrest frame.
15. NOTE: Note cable routing for installation.
Remove the 2 screws and latch release handle. Route out the release cable.
16. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and 2 attaching straps. 17. Remove the 8 backrest support
panel screws. 18. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 40 Percent
SEAT BACKREST - THIRD ROW, 40 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10205
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10206
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10207
Part 3
Disassembly and Assembly
All seats
1. Remove the third row 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the third row 40 percent seat backrest. 3.
Remove the bolt and the safety belt buckle.
- During assembly make sure anti-rotation tab is engaged into seat locator.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. Release the backrest trim cover outboard J-clip.
5. Remove all the staples.
6. NOTE:
- Note the spring clip position for installation.
- Use care when releasing the spring clips. They can fall inside the backrest frame.
Remove the head restraint. Pull the trim cover material away from the head restraint guide to access the spring clips.
- Release the 2 spring clips by pushing on the side shown.
- Raise and remove the head restraint.
Manual seat
7. NOTE: Note cable routing for installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10208
Remove the 2 screws and the manual latch handle and cable assembly. Route out the cable.
All seats
8. NOTE: The head restraint guides are not interchangeable. Note location for installation.
Reach up into backrest and squeeze the head restraint guide ends together to release and pull the
2 head restraint guides out.
9. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the backrest trim cover to the row of hog rings.
10. Remove the row of hog rings and backrest trim cover. 11. Remove the nut, screw and support
bracket. 12. Remove the 2 inboard latch-to-backrest frame bolts and the inboard latch.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
13. Remove the outboard latch-to-cushion frame bolt and the outboard latch.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
14. Remove the 6 screws and the backrest support panel. 15. To assemble, reverse the
disassembly procedure.
Seat Backrest - Third Row, 60 Percent
SEAT BACKREST - THIRD ROW, 60 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10209
60 Percent Backrest (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10210
60 Percent Backrest (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10211
60 Percent Backrest (Part 3)
Disassembly and Assembly
All seats
1. Remove the third row 60 percent seat. 2. Remove the third row 60 percent seat backrest. 3.
Remove the safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
4. NOTE:
- Note the spring clip position for installation.
- Use care when releasing the spring clips. They can fall inside the backrest frame.
Remove the head restraint. Pull the trim cover material away from the head restraint guide to access the spring clips.
- Release the 2 spring clips by pushing on the side shown.
- Raise and remove the head restraint.
5. Release all the backrest trim cover J-clips.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10212
6. Remove all the staples. 7. Release the hook-and-loop strip.
Manual seat
8. NOTE: Note cable routing for installation.
Remove the 2 screws and the manual latch handle and cable assembly. Route out the cable.
All seats
9. Remove the safety belt guide cover.
10. NOTE: The head restraint sleeve pins are not interchangeable. Note location for installation.
Reach up into the backrest and squeeze the head restraint guide ends together to release and pull
the 2 head restraint guides out.
11. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the backrest trim cover to the row of hog rings.
12. Remove the row of hog rings. 13. Remove the trim cover.
- Route the safety belt webbing through the trim cover.
14. Remove the backrest foam pad. 15. Remove the nut, screw and support bracket. 16. Remove
the outboard latch-to-cushion frame bolt and outboard latch.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
17. Remove the 2 inboard latch-to-backrest frame bolts and the inboard latch.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
18. Remove the 4 screws and the safety belt retractor cover. 19. Remove the safety belt retractor
bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
20. Pinch to release the safety belt guide and remove the safety belt retractor.
- Route through the backrest frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Back > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Removal and Replacement > Page 10213
21. Remove the 15 screws and the backrest support panel.
22. Remove the bolt and child safety seat tether anchor.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
23. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Seat Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent
SEAT BACKREST COVER - FRONT, 40 PERCENT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10218
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10219
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10220
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10221
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- Front seat back trim covers installed on seats equipped with side air bags cannot be repaired,
they are to be replaced. Cleaning is permissible.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a side air bag deployment took place, a new seat back pad, trim cover and side air bag module
and nuts must be installed. The seat back frame should be replaced if necessary.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the seat and depower the SRS. 2. Remove the backrest assembly. 3. Remove the head
restraint.
- Push in the RH guide button to release and remove the head restraint.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10222
4. Raise the rear trim cover flap and release the inner J-clip.
5. NOTE: The head restraint guides are not interchangeable. Note location for installation.
Remove the headrest guides. Reach into the backrest and pinch the headrest guide ends together to release from the backrest
frame.
- Pull the backrest trim cover away from the spring clips while pulling out the headrest guides.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Partially invert the backrest trim cover and remove the lower hog rings from the support wires.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
NOTE: Note the side air bag module deployment chute routing for installation. Continue to invert
the trim cover and remove the upper hog rings.
- Route the side air bag module deployment chute through the slot in the foam pad.
8. Remove the backrest trim cover.
9. WARNING:
- Check the side air bag module deployment chute for damage. The side air bag module
deployment chute must not be repaired. If there is any damage to the deployment chute, a new
seat back trim cover and deployment chute must be installed as a unit. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
- Inspect the mounting surfaces of the side air bag module for any foreign objects before installing
the side air bag module. If any foreign objects are found, remove them. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10223
- If the side air bag module cover has separated or the air bag material has been exposed, install a
new side air bag module. Do not attempt to repair the air bag module. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
10. Install the backrest assembly. 11. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10224
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Seat Backrest Cover - Front, 60 Percent
SEAT BACKREST COVER - FRONT, 60 PERCENT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10225
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10226
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10227
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10228
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- Front seat back trim covers installed on seats equipped with side air bags cannot be repaired,
they are to be replaced. Cleaning is permissible.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a side air bag deployment took place, a new seat back pad, trim cover and side air bag module
and nuts must be installed. The seat back frame should be replaced if necessary.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the seat and depower the SRS. 2. Remove the backrest assembly. 3. Remove the head
restraint
- Push in the RH guide button to release and remove the head restraint.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10229
4. Raise the rear trim cover flap and release the inner J-clip.
5. NOTE: The head restraint guides are not interchangeable. Note location for installation.
Remove the headrest guides. Reach a hand into the backrest and pinch the headrest guide ends together to release from the
backrest frame.
- Pull the backrest trim cover away from the spring clips while pulling out the headrest guides.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Partially invert the backrest trim cover and remove the lower hog rings from the support wires.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
NOTE: Note the side air bag module deployment chute routing for installation.
Continue to invert the trim cover and remove the upper hog rings. Route the side air bag module deployment chute through the slot in the foam pad.
8. Remove the trim cover.
9. WARNING:
- Check the side air bag module deployment chute for damage. The side air bag module
deployment chute must not be repaired. If there is any damage to the deployment chute, a new
seat back trim cover and deployment chute must be installed as a unit. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
- Inspect the mounting surfaces of the side air bag module for any foreign objects before installing
the side air bag module. If any
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10230
foreign objects are found, remove them. Failure to do so may result in personal injury, in the event
of an air bag deployment.
- If the side air bag module cover has separated or the air bag material has been exposed, install a
new side air bag module. Do not attempt to repair the air bag module. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
10. Install the backrest assembly. 11. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10231
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Cover - Front, 40 Percent
SEAT CUSHION COVER - FRONT, 40 PERCENT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10232
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10233
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10234
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10235
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the affected seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Release the
cushion trim cover front and rear J-clips and hook-and-loop strip.
3. NOTE:
- Note wiring harness routing for installation.
- Use care when removing the thermo-electric device (TED). The U-nuts can slip into the cushion
frame.
If equipped, remove the climate controlled seat thermo-electric device (TED). Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Detach the pin-type retainer and wiring harness.
- Remove the 2 screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10236
- Route the wiring harness and remove the TED.
4. Remove the cushion frame from the seat track.
- Remove the 4 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Release the 2 cushion frame rear clips and straps from the seat track and remove the cushion
frame.
5. Release the 2 cushion trim cover retainer clips and remove the trim cover and foam pad from the
cushion frame.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover. Partially invert the cushion trim cover to the row of hog rings and separate the hook-and-loop strips.
- Remove the hog rings and separate the trim cover and foam pad.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 8. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10237
Seat Cover: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Cover - Front, 60 Percent
SEAT CUSHION COVER - FRONT, 60 PERCENT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10238
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10239
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10240
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10241
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the 60 percent seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Release
the cushion trim cover front and rear J-clips and hook-and-loop strips. 3. Remove the 2 cushion
frames from the seat track.
- Remove the 8 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Release the 4 cushion frame rear clips and straps from the seat track and remove both cushion
frames.
4. Release the 4 cushion trim cover retainer clips and remove the trim cover and foam pad from the
cushion frames.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10242
5. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover. Partially invert the cushion trim cover and separate the hook-and-loop strips.
- Remove the hog rings and separate the trim cover and foam pad.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10243
Seat Cover: Service and Repair
Seat Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent
SEAT BACKREST COVER - FRONT, 40 PERCENT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10244
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10245
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10246
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10247
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- Front seat back trim covers installed on seats equipped with side air bags cannot be repaired,
they are to be replaced. Cleaning is permissible.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a side air bag deployment took place, a new seat back pad, trim cover and side air bag module
and nuts must be installed. The seat back frame should be replaced if necessary.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the seat and depower the SRS. 2. Remove the backrest assembly. 3. Remove the head
restraint.
- Push in the RH guide button to release and remove the head restraint.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10248
4. Raise the rear trim cover flap and release the inner J-clip.
5. NOTE: The head restraint guides are not interchangeable. Note location for installation.
Remove the headrest guides. Reach into the backrest and pinch the headrest guide ends together to release from the backrest
frame.
- Pull the backrest trim cover away from the spring clips while pulling out the headrest guides.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Partially invert the backrest trim cover and remove the lower hog rings from the support wires.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
NOTE: Note the side air bag module deployment chute routing for installation. Continue to invert
the trim cover and remove the upper hog rings.
- Route the side air bag module deployment chute through the slot in the foam pad.
8. Remove the backrest trim cover.
9. WARNING:
- Check the side air bag module deployment chute for damage. The side air bag module
deployment chute must not be repaired. If there is any damage to the deployment chute, a new
seat back trim cover and deployment chute must be installed as a unit. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
- Inspect the mounting surfaces of the side air bag module for any foreign objects before installing
the side air bag module. If any foreign objects are found, remove them. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10249
- If the side air bag module cover has separated or the air bag material has been exposed, install a
new side air bag module. Do not attempt to repair the air bag module. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
10. Install the backrest assembly. 11. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Seat Backrest Cover - Front, 60 Percent
SEAT BACKREST COVER - FRONT, 60 PERCENT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10250
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10251
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10252
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10253
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- Carry a live side air bag module with the air bag and tear seam pointed away from your body.
This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live side air bag module down on the cover tear seam. This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin. Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Side air bag modules with damaged covers must be replaced.
- Front seat back trim covers installed on seats equipped with side air bags cannot be repaired,
they are to be replaced. Cleaning is permissible.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- If a side air bag deployment took place, a new seat back pad, trim cover and side air bag module
and nuts must be installed. The seat back frame should be replaced if necessary.
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the seat and depower the SRS. 2. Remove the backrest assembly. 3. Remove the head
restraint
- Push in the RH guide button to release and remove the head restraint.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10254
4. Raise the rear trim cover flap and release the inner J-clip.
5. NOTE: The head restraint guides are not interchangeable. Note location for installation.
Remove the headrest guides. Reach a hand into the backrest and pinch the headrest guide ends together to release from the
backrest frame.
- Pull the backrest trim cover away from the spring clips while pulling out the headrest guides.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Partially invert the backrest trim cover and remove the lower hog rings from the support wires.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
NOTE: Note the side air bag module deployment chute routing for installation.
Continue to invert the trim cover and remove the upper hog rings. Route the side air bag module deployment chute through the slot in the foam pad.
8. Remove the trim cover.
9. WARNING:
- Check the side air bag module deployment chute for damage. The side air bag module
deployment chute must not be repaired. If there is any damage to the deployment chute, a new
seat back trim cover and deployment chute must be installed as a unit. Failure to do so may result
in personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
- Inspect the mounting surfaces of the side air bag module for any foreign objects before installing
the side air bag module. If any
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10255
foreign objects are found, remove them. Failure to do so may result in personal injury, in the event
of an air bag deployment.
- If the side air bag module cover has separated or the air bag material has been exposed, install a
new side air bag module. Do not attempt to repair the air bag module. Failure to do so may result in
personal injury, in the event of an air bag deployment.
To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
10. Install the backrest assembly. 11. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Seat Cushion Cover - Front, 40 Percent
SEAT CUSHION COVER - FRONT, 40 PERCENT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10256
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10257
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10258
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10259
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the affected seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Release the
cushion trim cover front and rear J-clips and hook-and-loop strip.
3. NOTE:
- Note wiring harness routing for installation.
- Use care when removing the thermo-electric device (TED). The U-nuts can slip into the cushion
frame.
If equipped, remove the climate controlled seat thermo-electric device (TED). Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Detach the pin-type retainer and wiring harness.
- Remove the 2 screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10260
- Route the wiring harness and remove the TED.
4. Remove the cushion frame from the seat track.
- Remove the 4 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Release the 2 cushion frame rear clips and straps from the seat track and remove the cushion
frame.
5. Release the 2 cushion trim cover retainer clips and remove the trim cover and foam pad from the
cushion frame.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover. Partially invert the cushion trim cover to the row of hog rings and separate the hook-and-loop strips.
- Remove the hog rings and separate the trim cover and foam pad.
7. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 8. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Seat Cushion Cover - Front, 60 Percent
SEAT CUSHION COVER - FRONT, 60 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10261
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10262
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10263
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10264
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10265
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the 60 percent seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Release
the cushion trim cover front and rear J-clips and hook-and-loop strips. 3. Remove the 2 cushion
frames from the seat track.
- Remove the 8 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Release the 4 cushion frame rear clips and straps from the seat track and remove both cushion
frames.
4. Release the 4 cushion trim cover retainer clips and remove the trim cover and foam pad from the
cushion frames.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10266
5. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover. Partially invert the cushion trim cover and separate the hook-and-loop strips.
- Remove the hog rings and separate the trim cover and foam pad.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Seat Backrest Cover - Second Row, 20 Percent
SEAT BACKREST COVER - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10267
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10268
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10269
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10270
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10271
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 20 percent seat from the vehicle. 2. Remove the screw and pivot bolt cover.
- Route the attaching strap through the pivot bolt cover.
3. Release the 2 lower backrest trim cover J-clips. 4. Remove the pin-type retainer and detach the
LH side attaching strap. 5. Remove the 2 screws and RH side shield.
- Raise the backrest upright to access and remove the center screw.
- Release the 2 pin-type retainers.
6. NOTE: Note attaching strap routing for installation.
Remove the pin-type retainer and detach the RH attaching strap.
7. Remove the bolt and detach the safety belt retractor anchor.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
8. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and lower panel.
9. Release the 3 lower backrest J-clips and route the RH trim cover flap through the child safety
seat lower anchor and tether for children (LATCH)
anchor.
10. Detach the 2 J-clips and remove the attaching straps. 11. Remove the safety belt guide cover.
- Insert an appropriate tool into the holes and release the 3 locking tabs.
- Detach the safety belt guide cover.
- Route the safety belt webbing through the slot.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10272
12. Remove the latch release handle bezel.
- Release the upper tab and separate the bezel from the latch release handle.
13. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-an-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the backrest trim cover to the row of hog rings.
14. Remove the row of hog rings. 15. Continue inverting and remove the backrest trim cover.
- Route the safety belt webbing through the trim cover opening.
16. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Backrest Cover - Second Row, 40 Percent
SEAT BACKREST COVER - SECOND ROW, 40 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10273
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10274
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10275
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10276
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10277
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. NOTE:
- Note the spring clip position for installation.
- Use care when releasing the spring clips. They can fall inside the backrest frame.
Remove the head restraint. Pull the trim cover material away from the head restraint guide to access the spring clips.
- Release the 2 spring clips by pushing on the side shown.
- Raise and remove the head restraint.
2. Position the backrest downward. 3. Remove the kneeling release (cargo mode) handle.
- Raise the handle to access the cable.
- Detach the cable jacket from the kneeling release handle.
- Release the retainers and position aside the kneeling release handle.
4. Release the lower backrest trim cover J-clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10278
5. Position aside the backrest trim cover rear flap and remove the 4 pin-type retainers. 6. Raise the
backrest upright and route the backrest trim cover from between the cushion and backrest.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip,
or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat backrest foam pad.
Invert the backrest trim cover to the row of hog rings. Separate the hook-and-loop strips.
8. Remove the row of hog rings. 9. Continue inverting the backrest trim cover to the head restraint
guides.
10. CAUTION: Be careful not to tear the material when separating the head restraints and spring
clips from the backrest trim cover.
Pinch the head restraint guide ends to release and remove the 2 head restraint guides. Separate the head restraint guides from the backrest trim cover.
11. Remove the backrest trim cover. 12. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Cushion Cover - Second Row, 20 Percent
SEAT CUSHION COVER - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10279
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10280
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10281
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10282
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10283
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the 20 percent seat. 2. Release the 2 backrest trim cover lower J-clips. 3. Remove the
screw and pivot bolt cover.
- Route out the attaching strap.
4. Remove the 2 pin-type retainers and lower panel. 5. Release the cushion trim cover rear J-clip.
- Position the backrest downward to aid in trim cover removal.
- Route the cushion trim cover rear flap and J-clip from between the cushion and backrest.
6. Release the hook-and-loop strip and remaining cushion J-clips. 7. Remove the cushion foam
pad and trim cover.
8. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip,
or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat cushion foam.
Release the hook-and-loop strips and invert the cushion trim cover to the row of hog rings.
9. Remove the hog rings and cushion trim cover.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Cushion Cover - Second Row, 40 Percent
SEAT CUSHION COVER - SECOND ROW, 40 PERCENT
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10284
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10285
Seat Backrest - 20 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10286
Seat Cushion - 20 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10287
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10288
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent Seat (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Place the seat in the E-Z entry position. 2. Release the trim cover J-clips from both sides of the
cushion. 3. Release the outer and inner rear J-clips from the cushion. 4. Latch the seat to the floor
and raise the backrest. 5. Release the front J-clip from the cushion.
6. Release the 2 cushion trim cover retainers from the 2 child safety seat LATCH anchors.
- Pull the cushion trim cover rearward and release the 2 clips.
7. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip,
or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat cushion foam.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the cushion trim cover to the row of hog rings.
8. Remove the row of hog rings. 9. Remove the cushion trim cover.
- Route the trim cover from between the cushion and backrest.
10. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Backrest Cover - Third Row
SEAT BACKREST COVER - THIRD ROW
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10289
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10290
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10291
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10292
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10293
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10294
Seat Cushion - 60 Percent
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LH seat shown, RH seat similar.
All seats
1. Remove the affected seat.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10295
2. Remove the seat backrest.
3. NOTE:
- Note the spring clip position for installation.
- Use care when releasing the spring clips. They can fall inside the backrest frame.
Remove the head restraint. Pull the trim cover material away from the head restraint guide to access the spring clips.
- Release the 2 spring clips by pushing on the side shown.
- Raise and remove the head restraint.
4. Release all the backrest trim cover J-clips.
5. Remove all the staples.
LH seat
6. Release the hook-and-loop strip. 7. Remove the safety belt anchor bolt.
- To install, tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Remove the safety belt guide cover.
Manual fold seat
9. NOTE: Note cable routing for installation. Remove the 2 screws and the manual latch handle
and cable assembly.
- Route out the cable.
All seats
10. NOTE: The head restraint sleeve pins are not interchangeable. Note location for installation.
Reach up into backrest and squeeze the head restraint guide ends together to release and pull the
2 head restraint guides out.
11. CAUTION: Use care when separating the backrest trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the backrest foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the backrest trim cover to the row of hog rings.
12. Remove the row of hog rings. 13. Remove the trim cover.
- For LH seat backrest, route the safety belt webbing through the trim cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10296
14. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Seat Cushion Cover - Third Row
SEAT CUSHION COVER - THIRD ROW
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10297
Seat Backrest - 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10298
Seat Cushion - 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10299
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10300
Seat Backrest - 60 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10301
Seat Cushion - 60 Percent
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LH seat shown, RH seat similar.
1. Remove the affected seat. 2. Raise the cushion and release the trim cover hook-and-loop strips
and J-clips.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Cover - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10302
3. Remove the cushion trim cover and foam pad from the cushion frame.
4. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the trim cover to the row of hog rings.
5. Remove the row of hog rings and remove the trim cover. 6. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent
SEAT CUSHION - FRONT, 40 PERCENT
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10307
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. Remove the affected seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Remove the
seat backrest. 3. Release the cushion trim cover front and rear J-clips and rear hook-and-loop strip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10308
4. Remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
- Remove the tie strap.
- Disconnect the 2 safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connectors.
- Remove the nut and safety belt buckle pretensioner. To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
Climate controlled seats
5. NOTE:
- Use care when removing the thermo-electric device (TED). The U-nuts can slip into the cushion
frame.
- Note wiring harness routing for installation.
Remove the climate controlled seat thermo-electric device (TED). Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Detach the pin-type retainer and wiring harness.
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Route the wiring harness and remove the TED.
6. Release the 2 tabs and slide out the climate control seat module (CCSM).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10309
7. NOTE: When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), it is necessary to carry out
programmable module installation (PMI).
If passenger seat, remove the CCSM. Cut and remove the wiring harness tie strap.
- Release the 2 locking wedges.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
Driver memory seat
8. Remove the driver seat module (DSM).
- Disconnect the 5 electrical connectors.
- Release the 2 tabs and slide out the DSM.
All seats
9. Remove the cushion frame from the seat track.
- Remove the 4 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Release the 2 cushion frame rear clips and straps from the seat track and remove the cushion
frame.
10. Release the 2 cushion trim cover retainer clips and remove the trim cover and foam pad from
the cushion frame.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10310
11. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover. Partially invert the cushion trim cover and separate the hook-and-loop strips.
- Remove the hog rings and separate the trim cover and foam pad.
Driver seat
12. Disconnect the SRS seat position sensor electrical connector and detach the wiring harness
pin-type retainer.
Power seat
13. Disconnect the seat track motor electrical connectors.
- For power seat track, disconnect the 3 motor electrical connectors.
- For memory seat track, disconnect the 6 motor electrical connectors.
14. NOTE: Note wiring harness routing for installation.
Remove the wiring harness. Remove the 3 wiring harness bracket screws.
- Remove the tie strap and release the rear wiring harness bracket clip from the seat track.
- Separate the electrical connectors and wiring harness from the seat track.
- Route and remove the wiring harness and bracket.
Manual seat
15. Remove the inboard and outboard seat track rails.
- Remove the 6 seat track rail-to-seat track nuts from the inboard and outboard seat track rails. To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
- Remove the inboard and outboard seat track rails.
- Release and separate the seat track adjust handle from the seat track rails.
- NOTE: Note the spring position for installation.
Disconnect the spring.
- Slightly bend the tab and detach the seat adjust handle from the inboard seat track rail.
All seats
16. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10311
17. Install the seat backrest. 18. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10312
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent
SEAT CUSHION - FRONT, 60 PERCENT
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10313
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Remove the 60 percent seat. 3. Remove
the 60 percent seat backrest. 4. Separate and remove the armrest bracket inner and outer covers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10314
5. Open the armrest latch lower cover. 6. Remove the armrest and brackets from the seat track.
- Remove the 2 armrest latch-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 45 Nm (33 lb-ft).
- Remove the 2 armrest bracket-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 45 Nm (33 lb-ft).
Armrest disassembly
7. Remove the screw, release the clips and remove the armrest latch upper cover.
8. Detach the 2 pin-type retainers and remove the armrest latch lower cover. 9. Remove the
armrest pivot bolt and armrest bracket.
- To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
10. Remove the 2 armrest latch bolts and armrest latch.
- To install, tighten to 45 Nm (33 lb-ft).
All seats
11. Release the cushion trim cover front and rear J-clips. 12. Remove the center seat safety belt
bolt and center seat safety belt.
- To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10315
13. Remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
- Remove the tie strap.
- Disconnect the 2 safety belt buckle pretensioner electrical connectors.
- Remove the nut and safety belt buckle pretensioner. To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
14. Remove the 2 cushion frames from the seat track.
- Remove the 8 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Release the 4 cushion frame rear clips and straps from the seat track and remove both cushion
frames.
15. Release the 4 cushion trim cover retainer clips and remove the trim cover and foam pad from
the cushion frames.
16. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or
the hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Remove the cushion trim cover. Partially invert the cushion trim cover and separate the hook-and-loop strips.
- Remove the hog rings and separate the trim cover and foam pad.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10316
17. Remove the inboard and outboard seat track rails.
- Remove the 6 seat track rail-to-seat track nuts from the inboard and outboard seat track rails. To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
- Remove the inboard and outboard seat track rails.
- Release and separate the seat track adjust handle from the seat track rails.
- NOTE: Note the spring position for installation.
Disconnect the spring.
- Slightly bend the tab and detach the seat adjust handle from the inboard seat track rail.
18. NOTE: Note wiring harness routing for installation.
Remove the wiring harness. Remove the 3 wiring harness bracket screws.
- Remove the tie strap and release the rear wiring harness bracket clip from the seat track.
- Separate the electrical connectors and wiring harness from the seat track.
- Route and remove the wiring harness and bracket.
19. To assemble, reverse the disassembly procedure. 20. Install the 60 percent seat backrest. 21.
Install the 60 percent seat. 22. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10317
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion - Second Row, 20 Percent
SEAT CUSHION - SECOND ROW, 20 PERCENT
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10318
Part 2
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the 20 percent seat. 2. Remove the 20 percent seat backrest. 3. Remove the 2 screws
and LH side shield. 4. Remove the nut and safety belt buckle.
- To install, align the anti-rotation tab. To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
5. Release the cushion trim cover front J-clip. 6. Remove the 2 riser-to-cushion frame bolts and
cushion frame.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
7. Release the hook-and-loop strip and remaining cushion J-clips. 8. Remove the cushion frame
from the foam pad and trim cover.
9. CAUTION: Use care when separating the seat cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip,
or the hook-and-loop strip can be torn
from the seat cushion foam.
Release the hook-and-loop strips and invert the cushion trim cover to the row of hog rings.
10. Remove the hog rings and cushion trim cover. 11. To assemble, reverse the disassembly
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10319
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion - Third Row, 40 Percent
SEAT CUSHION - THIRD ROW, 40 PERCENT
40 Percent Cushion (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10320
40 Percent Cushion (Part 2)
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the third row 40 percent seat. 2. Remove the third row 40 percent seat backrest. 3.
Remove the inboard and outboard slide bracket-to-cushion frame nuts and remove the slide
bracket from both sides of the seat cushion.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 2 seat riser-to-cushion frame bolts and the riser.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Release the cushion trim cover J-clips and remove the cushion frame.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the trim cover to the row of hog rings.
7. Remove the row of hog rings and remove the trim cover. 8. To assemble, reverse the
disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10321
Seat Cushion: Service and Repair Seat Cushion - Third Row, 60 Percent
SEAT CUSHION - THIRD ROW, 60 PERCENT
60 Percent Cushion (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cushion > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Cushion - Front, 40 Percent > Page 10322
60 Percent Cushion (Part 2)
Disassembly and Assembly
1. Remove the third row 60 percent seat. 2. Remove the third row 60 percent seat backrest. 3.
Remove the inboard and outboard slide bracket-to-cushion frame nuts and remove the slide
bracket from both sides of the seat cushion.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. Remove the 2 seat riser-to-cushion frame bolts and the riser.
- To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
5. Release the cushion trim cover J-clips and remove the cushion frame.
6. CAUTION: Use care when separating the cushion trim cover from the hook-and-loop strip, or the
hook-and-loop strip can be torn from
the cushion foam pad.
Separate the hook-and-loop strips and invert the trim cover to the row of hog rings.
7. Remove the row of hog rings and remove the trim cover. 8. To assemble, reverse the
disassembly procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Fan > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Seat Fan: > 07-22-4 > Nov > 07 > A/C - Poor Seat Cooling Performance
Seat Fan: Customer Interest A/C - Poor Seat Cooling Performance
TSB 07-22-4
11/12/07
POOR SEAT COOLING PERFORMANCE - BUILT BEFORE 7/16/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-15-5 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/16/2007 and equipped
with climate control seats, may exhibit poor cooling performance in the seat.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify there are no diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and that the thermal emitting device and fan
assemblies are working properly. Then use IDS to select the Maximum Output Mode. This will
increase fan speed to provide quicker cooling.
1. Using IDS (equipped with release B51.5 or higher) normally ID the vehicle.
2. Select "Toolbox" at the top of the screen.
3. Select "Module Programming" from the menu.
4. Select "Programmable Parameters".
5. Select "Climate Control Seats".
6. Select "High Cool Blower Voltage" to change setting.
7. Select "Maximum Output Mode".
8. After the preference has been successfully changed, verify that the seat fan assemblies are
operating according to the new setting.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072204A 2007-2008 0.3 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator Vehicles Built Before 7/16/2007: Check For DTCs, Then Change The High
Cool Blower Voltage to Maximum Output (Do Not Use With 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Fan > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Seat Fan: > 07-22-4 > Nov > 07 > A/C - Poor Seat Cooling Performance > Page 10331
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Fan > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Seat Fan: > 07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
Seat Fan: Customer Interest A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
TSB 07-21-6
10/29/07
CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - NO COMMUNICATION - DCSM VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 8/31/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 KZ, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
built before 8/31/2007 and equipped with climate control seats may exhibit inoperative heating
and/or cooling. There are no diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) associated with this issue and
IDS/PDS will not communicate with the dual climate control seat module (DCSM).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn the ignition switch to key on engine off (KOEO) position.
2. Run self test on DCSM.
a. If DTCs are present do not continue with this TSB, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM)
diagnostics for the DTCs.
b. If no communication with the DCSM, proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove power to the DCSM and wait a minimum of 2 minutes. This will reset the DCSM.
^ Expedition/Navigator - remove Fuse 8 in the battery junction box (BJB).
^ Zephyr/MKZ - remove Fuse 11 and 12 in the BJB.
4. Reinstall the fuse(s) and recheck for communication.
a. If communication does not return, refer to WSM, Section 418-00.
b. If the communication is restored by resetting:
(1) Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ - reprogram the DCSM to the latest calibration using IDS
release 51.4 or later with patch 7. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
(2) 2006 Zephyr/2007 MKZ - replace the DCSM.
5. Recheck operation of the heated/cooled seat and for DTCs. If no DTCs return the vehicle to the
customer.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Fan > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest for Seat Fan: > 07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative > Page 10336
072106A 2007-2008 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ With Climate Control Seats Built Before 8/31/2007: Reprogram
The DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not Use
With 12650D 12651D, 12651D4)
072106A 2006 Zephyr, 2007 MKZ: 1.0 Hr.
Replace DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not
Use With 12650D, 12651D,
12651D4, 63100A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Fan > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Fan: > 07-22-4 > Nov > 07 > A/C - Poor Seat Cooling Performance
Seat Fan: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Poor Seat Cooling Performance
TSB 07-22-4
11/12/07
POOR SEAT COOLING PERFORMANCE - BUILT BEFORE 7/16/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-15-5 to update the Service Procedure.
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 7/16/2007 and equipped
with climate control seats, may exhibit poor cooling performance in the seat.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Verify there are no diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) and that the thermal emitting device and fan
assemblies are working properly. Then use IDS to select the Maximum Output Mode. This will
increase fan speed to provide quicker cooling.
1. Using IDS (equipped with release B51.5 or higher) normally ID the vehicle.
2. Select "Toolbox" at the top of the screen.
3. Select "Module Programming" from the menu.
4. Select "Programmable Parameters".
5. Select "Climate Control Seats".
6. Select "High Cool Blower Voltage" to change setting.
7. Select "Maximum Output Mode".
8. After the preference has been successfully changed, verify that the seat fan assemblies are
operating according to the new setting.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072204A 2007-2008 0.3 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator Vehicles Built Before 7/16/2007: Check For DTCs, Then Change The High
Cool Blower Voltage to Maximum Output (Do Not Use With 12651D, 12651D4)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Fan > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Fan: > 07-22-4 > Nov > 07 > A/C - Poor Seat Cooling Performance > Page 10342
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Fan > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Fan: > 07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
Seat Fan: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
TSB 07-21-6
10/29/07
CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - NO COMMUNICATION - DCSM VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 8/31/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 KZ, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
built before 8/31/2007 and equipped with climate control seats may exhibit inoperative heating
and/or cooling. There are no diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) associated with this issue and
IDS/PDS will not communicate with the dual climate control seat module (DCSM).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn the ignition switch to key on engine off (KOEO) position.
2. Run self test on DCSM.
a. If DTCs are present do not continue with this TSB, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM)
diagnostics for the DTCs.
b. If no communication with the DCSM, proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove power to the DCSM and wait a minimum of 2 minutes. This will reset the DCSM.
^ Expedition/Navigator - remove Fuse 8 in the battery junction box (BJB).
^ Zephyr/MKZ - remove Fuse 11 and 12 in the BJB.
4. Reinstall the fuse(s) and recheck for communication.
a. If communication does not return, refer to WSM, Section 418-00.
b. If the communication is restored by resetting:
(1) Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ - reprogram the DCSM to the latest calibration using IDS
release 51.4 or later with patch 7. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
(2) 2006 Zephyr/2007 MKZ - replace the DCSM.
5. Recheck operation of the heated/cooled seat and for DTCs. If no DTCs return the vehicle to the
customer.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Fan > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Fan: > 07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative > Page 10347
072106A 2007-2008 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ With Climate Control Seats Built Before 8/31/2007: Reprogram
The DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not Use
With 12650D 12651D, 12651D4)
072106A 2006 Zephyr, 2007 MKZ: 1.0 Hr.
Replace DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not
Use With 12650D, 12651D,
12651D4, 63100A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat Function Inoperative
Seat Heater: Customer Interest A/C - Climate Seat Function Inoperative
TSB 08-23-11
11/24/08
INOPERATIVE OR NO COMMUNICATION WITH DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
(DCSM)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr
2007-2008 MKZ, MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
may exhibit inoperative climate seat function with no communication to the DCSM due to a ground
concern.
ACTION Follow service procedure to correct concern.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE ONLY APPLIES IF DAMAGE HAS BEEN IDENTIFIED AT THE SPECIFIC
CONNECTOR AND PIN. IF DAMAGE IS NOT VISIBLE AT THE SPECIFIC CONNECTOR AND
PIN, THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY AND CONTINUE WITH NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS IN
THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL.
Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-10 to gain access to the DCSM connector. Seat
removal may be required.
Zephyr-MKZ:
If Connector C3305A is damaged at Pin M GD139 (BK-YE), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
Expedition-Navigator:
If Connector C3265A is damaged at Pin M GD138 (BK-WH), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat Function Inoperative > Page 10356
position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
MKX:
If Connector C3036A is damaged at Pin M GD145 (BK-WH), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
NOTE
IF PIN M IS DAMAGED ON THE MODULE THE DCSM MAY NEED TO BE REPLACED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082311A 2007-2008 MKX: Replace 1.5 Hrs.
Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With 63100A, 12650D)
082311A 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 1.4 Hrs.
MKZ: Replace Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With 63100A,
12650D)
082311A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With
63100A, 12650D)
082311B 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 1.6 Hrs.
MKX And MKZ: Replace Connector And DCSM, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do
Not Use With 63100A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Customer Interest for Seat Heater: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat Function Inoperative > Page 10357
12650D)
082311B 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.5 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Connector And DCSM, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not
Use With 63100A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14S411 X1
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat Function Inoperative
Seat Heater: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Climate Seat Function Inoperative
TSB 08-23-11
11/24/08
INOPERATIVE OR NO COMMUNICATION WITH DUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT MODULE
(DCSM)
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr
2007-2008 MKZ, MKX, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
may exhibit inoperative climate seat function with no communication to the DCSM due to a ground
concern.
ACTION Follow service procedure to correct concern.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE ONLY APPLIES IF DAMAGE HAS BEEN IDENTIFIED AT THE SPECIFIC
CONNECTOR AND PIN. IF DAMAGE IS NOT VISIBLE AT THE SPECIFIC CONNECTOR AND
PIN, THIS PROCEDURE DOES NOT APPLY AND CONTINUE WITH NORMAL DIAGNOSTICS IN
THE APPROPRIATE WORKSHOP MANUAL.
Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 501-10 to gain access to the DCSM connector. Seat
removal may be required.
Zephyr-MKZ:
If Connector C3305A is damaged at Pin M GD139 (BK-YE), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
Expedition-Navigator:
If Connector C3265A is damaged at Pin M GD138 (BK-WH), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat Function Inoperative > Page
10363
position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
MKX:
If Connector C3036A is damaged at Pin M GD145 (BK-WH), then replace connector pigtail. The
replacement pigtail will have an extra wire in Pin L position. (Figure 1)
1. Obtain Pigtail Kit. Strip the ends of the wires from Pins L and M, 1/4" (6.3 mm). Twist them
together. Insert twisted wires into one end of a 12-10 gage butt splice. Using the approved splicing
methods found in the Wiring Diagram (WD), Cell 5, crimp the butt connector.
2. Strip the end of GD139 (vehicle harness side - ground) and insert into open end of the 12-10 butt
splice (at Pin M). Using the approved splicing methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt
connector and seal with shrink tubing.
3. Continue to attach the rest of the pigtail wires to the vehicle harness, using the approved splicing
methods found in the WD, Cell 5, crimp the butt connector and seal (with shrink tubing). Wires from
pins E and F will require 12-10 butt splice which is not included in the pigtail kit.
NOTE
IF PIN M IS DAMAGED ON THE MODULE THE DCSM MAY NEED TO BE REPLACED.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082311A 2007-2008 MKX: Replace 1.5 Hrs.
Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With 63100A, 12650D)
082311A 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 1.4 Hrs.
MKZ: Replace Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With 63100A,
12650D)
082311A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Connector, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not Use With
63100A, 12650D)
082311B 2006 Zephyr, 2007-2008 1.6 Hrs.
MKX And MKZ: Replace Connector And DCSM, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do
Not Use With 63100A,
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater: > 08-23-11 > Nov > 08 > A/C - Climate Seat Function Inoperative > Page
10364
12650D)
082311B 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.5 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Connector And DCSM, Includes Time To Remove And Install Seat (Do Not
Use With 63100A, 12650D)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14S411 X1
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Seat Heater: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10367
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10368
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10369
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10370
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10371
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10372
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10373
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10374
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10375
Seat Heater: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10376
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10377
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10378
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10379
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10380
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10381
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10382
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10383
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10384
Seat Heater: Connector Views
C3034
C3035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10385
C3039
C3316
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10386
C3040
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10387
Seat Heater: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
119-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10388
119-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10389
119-3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 10390
119-4
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Seat Backrest Thermo-Electric Device
SEAT BACKREST THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICE
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10393
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10394
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10395
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10396
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Position the affected seat backrest fully forward. 2. Depower the supplemental restraint system
(SRS).
3. Release the seat backrest cover lower rear J-clip, then unzip the 2 side zippers. 4. Remove the
climate controlled seat thermo-electric device (TED).
- Disconnect the TED electrical connector.
- Remove the scrivet.
- Detach the 2 retainer clips from the backrest frame support wires.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10397
Seat Heater: Service and Repair Seat Cushion Thermo-Electric Device
SEAT CUSHION THERMO-ELECTRIC DEVICE
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10398
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10399
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10400
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10401
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the affected seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS).
2. NOTE:
- Use care when removing the thermo-electric device (TED). The U-nuts can slip into the cushion
frame.
- Note wiring harness routing for installation.
Remove the climate controlled seat thermo-electric device (TED). Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Detach the pin-type retainer and wiring harness.
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Route the wiring harness and remove the TED.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Backrest Thermo-Electric Device > Page 10402
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 4. Install the seat and repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats
Inoperative
Seat Heater Control Module: Customer Interest A/C - Climate Control Seats Inoperative
TSB 07-21-6
10/29/07
CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - NO COMMUNICATION - DCSM VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 8/31/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 KZ, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
built before 8/31/2007 and equipped with climate control seats may exhibit inoperative heating
and/or cooling. There are no diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) associated with this issue and
IDS/PDS will not communicate with the dual climate control seat module (DCSM).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn the ignition switch to key on engine off (KOEO) position.
2. Run self test on DCSM.
a. If DTCs are present do not continue with this TSB, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM)
diagnostics for the DTCs.
b. If no communication with the DCSM, proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove power to the DCSM and wait a minimum of 2 minutes. This will reset the DCSM.
^ Expedition/Navigator - remove Fuse 8 in the battery junction box (BJB).
^ Zephyr/MKZ - remove Fuse 11 and 12 in the BJB.
4. Reinstall the fuse(s) and recheck for communication.
a. If communication does not return, refer to WSM, Section 418-00.
b. If the communication is restored by resetting:
(1) Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ - reprogram the DCSM to the latest calibration using IDS
release 51.4 or later with patch 7. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
(2) 2006 Zephyr/2007 MKZ - replace the DCSM.
5. Recheck operation of the heated/cooled seat and for DTCs. If no DTCs return the vehicle to the
customer.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Heater Control Module: > 07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate Control Seats
Inoperative > Page 10411
072106A 2007-2008 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ With Climate Control Seats Built Before 8/31/2007: Reprogram
The DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not Use
With 12650D 12651D, 12651D4)
072106A 2006 Zephyr, 2007 MKZ: 1.0 Hr.
Replace DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not
Use With 12650D, 12651D,
12651D4, 63100A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate
Control Seats Inoperative
Seat Heater Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Climate Control Seats
Inoperative
TSB 07-21-6
10/29/07
CLIMATE CONTROL SEAT FUNCTION INOPERATIVE - NO COMMUNICATION - DCSM VEHICLES BUILT PRIOR TO 8/31/2007
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2006 Zephyr 2007-2008 KZ, Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator, 2006 Zephyr and 2007-2008 MKZ vehicles
built before 8/31/2007 and equipped with climate control seats may exhibit inoperative heating
and/or cooling. There are no diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs) associated with this issue and
IDS/PDS will not communicate with the dual climate control seat module (DCSM).
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Turn the ignition switch to key on engine off (KOEO) position.
2. Run self test on DCSM.
a. If DTCs are present do not continue with this TSB, follow normal Workshop Manual (WSM)
diagnostics for the DTCs.
b. If no communication with the DCSM, proceed to Step 3.
3. Remove power to the DCSM and wait a minimum of 2 minutes. This will reset the DCSM.
^ Expedition/Navigator - remove Fuse 8 in the battery junction box (BJB).
^ Zephyr/MKZ - remove Fuse 11 and 12 in the BJB.
4. Reinstall the fuse(s) and recheck for communication.
a. If communication does not return, refer to WSM, Section 418-00.
b. If the communication is restored by resetting:
(1) Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ - reprogram the DCSM to the latest calibration using IDS
release 51.4 or later with patch 7. Calibration files may also be obtained at the website.
(2) 2006 Zephyr/2007 MKZ - replace the DCSM.
5. Recheck operation of the heated/cooled seat and for DTCs. If no DTCs return the vehicle to the
customer.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Heater Control Module: > 07-21-6 > Oct > 07 > A/C - Climate
Control Seats Inoperative > Page 10417
072106A 2007-2008 0.5 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator/2008 MKZ With Climate Control Seats Built Before 8/31/2007: Reprogram
The DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not Use
With 12650D 12651D, 12651D4)
072106A 2006 Zephyr, 2007 MKZ: 1.0 Hr.
Replace DCSM, Includes Time For The Diagnosis Described In The Service Procedure (Do Not
Use With 12650D, 12651D,
12651D4, 63100A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
14C724 04
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 10418
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 10419
Seat Heater Control Module: Diagrams
C3265A
C3265B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 10420
C3265C
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Control Module > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 10421
Seat Heater Control Module: Service and Repair
CLIMATE CONTROLLED SEAT MODULE
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), carry out the appropriate steps in
the programmable module installation (PMI)
procedure.
2. Position the front passenger seat fully upward and depower the supplemental restraint system
(SRS).
3. CAUTION: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield. Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
4. Release the 2 tabs and slide out the CCSM.
5. Remove the CCSM.
- Cut and remove the wiring harness tie strap.
- Release the 2 locking wedges.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 7. Repower the SRS. 8. If a new CCSM has been
installed, carry out the appropriate steps in the PMI procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat Control Switch - Front
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Front
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - FRONT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10426
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10427
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10428
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10429
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat shown, passenger similar.
All seats
1. Position the seat forward and upward to aid in seat control switch removal. 2. Depower the
supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Pull and remove the seat control switch button(s).
- If equipped, remove the power recliner switch button.
Power seat with manual recliner
4. CAUTION: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield. Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10430
5. Remove the cushion side shield cover forward screw.
6. CAUTION: Do not damage the manual recliner lever when removing the cushion side shield
cover.
Remove the cushion side shield cover. Partially remove the cover to gain access to the seat control switch.
- Release the retainers and detach the seat control switch from the side shield cover.
- Remove the cushion side shield cover.
All seats
7. Detach and remove the cushion side shield cover.
- Disconnect the seat control switch.
- If equipped, disconnect the memory set switch electrical connector.
8. Release the clips and remove the seat control switch. 9. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
10. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Heater Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
> Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10431
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Third Row
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - THIRD ROW
Removal and Installation
1. Release and remove the tray from the RH rear quarter trim panel.
2. NOTE: The LH and RH switch wiring harness electrical connectors are not interchangeable.
Remove the affected seat control switch. Reach a hand behind the RH rear quarter trim panel and squeeze together the 2 tabs on the
affected seat control switch to release.
- Pull the seat control switch through the opening and disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual
Seat Track: Service and Repair Seat Track - Manual
SEAT TRACK - MANUAL
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10436
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10437
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10438
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10439
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Remove the affected seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS).
2. Remove the inboard and outboard seat track rails.
- Remove the 6 seat track rail-to-seat track nuts from the inboard and outboard seat track rails. To install, tighten to 30 Nm (22 lb-ft).
- Remove the inboard and outboard seat track rails.
- Release and separate the seat track adjust handle from the seat track rails.
- NOTE: Note the spring position for installation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10440
Disconnect the spring.
- Slightly bend the tab and detach the seat adjust handle from the inboard seat track rail.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 4. Install the seat. 5. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10441
Seat Track: Service and Repair Seat Track - Power
SEAT TRACK - POWER
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10442
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10443
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10444
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10445
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All seats
1. Remove the affected seat and depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Remove the
seat backrest.
3. Remove the safety belt buckle pretensioner.
- Remove the tie strap.
- Disconnect the 2 electrical connectors.
- Remove the nut and safety belt buckle pretensioner. To install, tighten to 55 Nm (41 lb-ft).
4. Release the cushion trim cover front and rear J-clips and rear hook-and-loop strip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10446
Climate controlled seats
5. NOTE:
- Use care when removing the thermo-electric device (TED). The U-nuts can slip into the cushion
frame.
- Note wiring harness routing for installation.
Remove the climate controlled seat thermo-electric device (TED). Disconnect the electrical connector.
- Detach the pin-type retainer and wiring harness.
- Remove the 2 screws.
- Route the wiring harness and remove the TED.
6. Release the 2 tabs and slide out the climate controlled seat module (CCSM).
7. NOTE: When installing a new climate control seat module (CCSM), it is necessary to carry out
programmable module installation (PMI).
If passenger seat, remove the CCSM. Cut and remove the wiring harness tie strap.
- Release the 2 locking wedges.
- Disconnect the 3 electrical connectors.
Driver memory seat
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Track > Component Information > Service and Repair > Seat
Track - Manual > Page 10447
8. Remove the driver seat module (DSM).
- Disconnect the 5 electrical connectors.
- Release the 2 tabs and slide out the DSM.
All seats
9. Remove the cushion frame, foam pad and trim cover assembly from the seat track.
- Remove the 4 cushion frame-to-seat track bolts. To install, tighten to 25 Nm (18 lb-ft).
- Release the 2 cushion frame rear clips and straps from the seat track and remove the cushion
frame.
10. Disconnect the seat track motor electrical connector.
- For 6-way power seat, disconnect the 3 motor electrical connectors.
- For memory seat, disconnect the 6 motor electrical connectors.
11. NOTE: Note wiring harness routing for installation.
Remove the wiring harness. Remove the 3 wiring harness bracket screws.
- Remove the tie strap and release the rear wiring harness bracket clip from the seat track.
- Separate the electrical connectors and wiring harness from the seat track.
- Route and remove the wiring harness and bracket.
12. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 13. Install the seat backrest. 14. Install the seat and
repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Console Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Console Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams
C2090
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery
Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
Pedal Positioning Switch: Customer Interest Electrical - Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical - Battery
Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 10463
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's
Pedal Positioning Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Battery Drain/No
Crank/Multiple DTC's
TSB 07-18-5
09/17/07
BATTERY DRAW AND/OR CRANK/NO START- VEHICLES BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience a
battery draw and/or crank/no start concern with these specific diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
P0230, P0600, P2105, P2107, and U0300 in the PCM.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check for possible internal short at the brake pedal position (BPP) switch. An internal short will not
allow the PCM to go into sleep mode.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the off position. Check fuses F70, F74, and F76 in the battery junction
box (BJB). Is voltage present on the fuses?
a. If yes, go to Step 2.
b. If no, this TSB does not apply. Proceed with normal Powertrain Controls/Emissions Diagnosis
(PC/ED) Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
2. Disconnect the BPP switch and recheck fuses. Is voltage still present?
a. If no, replace the BPP switch and go to Step 3.
b. If yes, proceed with normal PC/ED Diagnostics, Pinpoint Test QT1.
3. Start the vehicle. Clear and recheck for DTCs.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
Parts Block
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071805A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.4 Hr.
Replace The BPP Switch, Includes Time To Perform The Diagnosis In The Service Procedure (Do
Not Use With 13480A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
13480 42
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-18-5 > Sep > 07 > Electrical Battery Drain/No Crank/Multiple DTC's > Page 10469
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 08-17-4 >
Sep > 08 > Interior - Tick/Creak From Instrument Panel Area
Steering Column Bearing: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Tick/Creak From Instrument
Panel Area
TSB 08-17-4
09/01/08
TICKING OR CREAKING SOUND - INSTRUMENT PANEL AREA
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a ticking or creaking sound
coming from the instrument panel area.
ACTION
Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
To determine if column lower bearing is source of noise, do the following:
1. Park vehicle on level ground with steering wheel in straight ahead 12 o'clock position and engine
off.
2. From underneath instrument panel, grasp lower intermediate shaft U-joint and apply light
pressure up and down to load the lower column bearing.
3. Listen for any ticking or creaking sound while applying pressure up and down.
4. If no noise is heard at 12 o'clock wheel position, repeat Step 3 at the 3, 6, and 9 o'clock wheel
positions.
5. If noise is detected, use chassis ears to confirm noise is coming from plastic steering column
lower bearing. Noise will be loudest with chassis ears attached to the plastic tone ring disc, which is
part of bearing.
a. If the noise is confirmed go to Step 6.
b. If not confirmed this procedure does not apply. Refer to Workshop Manual (WSM), Section
100-04.
NOTE
COMPLETE DISASSEMBLY OF STEERING COLUMN IS NOT REQUIRED. FOLLOW THE
WORKSHOP MANUAL STEPS NECESSARY TO REMOVE ONLY THE LOWER STEERING
COLUMN BEARING.
6. Replace steering column lower bearing following WSM, Section 211-04.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081704A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.2 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Steering Column Lower Bearing. Includes Time to Remove and Install Steering
column.(Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 08-17-4 >
Sep > 08 > Interior - Tick/Creak From Instrument Panel Area > Page 10475
Use With 3514A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A510 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Pedal Positioning Switch: > 08-17-4 >
Sep > 08 > Interior - Tick/Creak From Instrument Panel Area > Page 10481
Use With 3514A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
3A510 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10482
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10483
C2089
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10484
Pedal Positioning Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10485
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Pedal Positioning Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10486
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Door Lock Switch, Passenger Side > Page 10491
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side
C505
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Door Lock Switch, Driver Side > Page 10494
C605
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10495
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10496
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10497
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR LOCK CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door trim panel. 2. Release the tabs and remove the door lock control switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10501
C527
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10502
Power Mirror Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10503
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10504
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10505
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
EXTERIOR MIRROR CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the driver front door trim panel.
2. Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
1 Depress the locking tabs.
2 Remove the exterior mirror control switch.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor > Page 10510
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor > Page 10511
Power Seat Motor Position Sensor: Locations Height Sensor, Left/Right Rear
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Driver Memory Seat Front/Rear Height Position Sensor > Page 10512
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor
C372
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 10515
C373
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 10516
C383
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 10517
C4092
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Motor Position
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Driver Memory Seat Horizontal Position Sensor > Page 10518
C4093
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Power Seat Switch, Left
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 10523
View 151-34 (Passenger Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 10524
Power Seat Switch: Locations Third Row Power-Fold Seat Switch, Left/Right
View 151-26 (Right Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 10525
View 151-30 (Right Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Switch, Left
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Power Seat Switch, Left
C352
C3016
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 10528
Power Seat Switch: Diagrams Power Seat Switch, Right
C355
C3026
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 10529
C4179
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Power Seat Switch, Left > Page 10530
C4180
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10533
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10534
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10535
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10536
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 10-Way Power Seat - Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10537
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10538
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Seat Switch, 10-Way Power Seat - Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10539
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10540
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10541
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10542
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10543
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10544
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10545
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10546
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10547
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10548
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10549
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10550
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Power Seat Switch, 6-Way Power Seat - Left > Page 10551
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10552
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair
MEMORY SET SWITCH
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10553
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10554
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10555
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 10556
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat shown, passenger similar.
1. Depower the supplemental restraint system (SRS). 2. Detach and position aside the driver seat
cushion side shield cover. 3. Release the clips and remove the memory set switch.
- Disconnect the seat control switch.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 5. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard Sensor: Service and Repair
PINCH STRIP SWITCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: Left side shown, right side similar.
1. Remove brake light.
- Remove the screws.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Hazard
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10560
2. Disconnect the pinch strip electrical connector.
3. Remove the pinch strip.
1 Remove the pin-type retainers.
2 Remove the grommet and route the harness out of the vehicle.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-41 (Liftgate - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch
C4340
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Trunk / Liftgate Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Handle Release Switch > Page 10566
C4039
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor
> Component Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Tower Position Sensor: Description and Operation
SEAT TRACK POSITION SENSOR
The seat track position sensor is mounted to a bracket attached to the outboard side of the driver
seat track. The seat track position sensor informs the restraints control module (RCM) of the driver
seat position. The RCM uses this information in determining the deployment rate of the dual-stage
driver air bag module.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Front
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - FRONT
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10574
Seat Backrest - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10575
Seat Cushion - Front, 40 Percent (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10576
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10577
Seat Cushion - Front, 60 Percent (Part 2)
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
WARNING:
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device. Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner. Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector. Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
- Driver seat shown, passenger similar.
All seats
1. Position the seat forward and upward to aid in seat control switch removal. 2. Depower the
supplemental restraint system (SRS). 3. Pull and remove the seat control switch button(s).
- If equipped, remove the power recliner switch button.
Power seat with manual recliner
4. CAUTION: Do not pull from the inboard side of the front seat cushion panel shield to avoid
damaging it.
Remove the front seat cushion panel shield. Release the upper retaining clips working from the outboard side and then release the lower
retaining clips.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10578
5. Remove the cushion side shield cover forward screw.
6. CAUTION: Do not damage the manual recliner lever when removing the cushion side shield
cover.
Remove the cushion side shield cover. Partially remove the cover to gain access to the seat control switch.
- Release the retainers and detach the seat control switch from the side shield cover.
- Remove the cushion side shield cover.
All seats
7. Detach and remove the cushion side shield cover.
- Disconnect the seat control switch.
- If equipped, disconnect the memory set switch electrical connector.
8. Release the clips and remove the seat control switch. 9. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
10. Repower the SRS.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Heater Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Seat Control Switch - Front > Page 10579
Seat Heater Switch: Service and Repair Seat Control Switch - Third Row
SEAT CONTROL SWITCH - THIRD ROW
Removal and Installation
1. Release and remove the tray from the RH rear quarter trim panel.
2. NOTE: The LH and RH switch wiring harness electrical connectors are not interchangeable.
Remove the affected seat control switch. Reach a hand behind the RH rear quarter trim panel and squeeze together the 2 tabs on the
affected seat control switch to release.
- Pull the seat control switch through the opening and disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-33 (Driver Seat)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Seat Memory Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10583
C3246
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Locations Liftgate Rear Control Switch
View 151-25 (Left Rear - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 10588
View 151-29 (Left Rear - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 10589
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch
C4333
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Liftgate Rear Control Switch > Page 10592
C2361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sound Proofing / Insulation > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Sound Proofing / Insulation: Description and Operation
INSULATION
Insulation is installed:
- under the roof.
- above and below the instrument panel.
- at the cowl sides.
- over the transmission tunnel.
- over the floorpan areas.
- inside the quarter panels.
And has heat-bondable mastic deadeners for improved NVH characteristics (Navigator).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Unibody > Cowl > Cowl Moulding / Trim > System Information > Service and
Repair
Cowl Moulding / Trim: Service and Repair
COWL PANEL GRILLE
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the windshield wipers. 2. Remove the cowl grille seal. 3. Remove the pin-type retainer
and left side cowl trim panel.
- Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
4. Remove the right side cowl trim panel.
1 Disconnect the windshield washer tube.
2 Remove the pin-type retainer.
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 6. If necessary, adjust the windshield wiper arms.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Weatherstrip: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise
From Front Door B-Pillar Area
Front Door Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Body - Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area
TSB 07-13-4
07/09/07
WIND NOISE AROUND FRONT DOORS - BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-8-6 to clarify vehicle build date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience wind
noise around the exterior driver and/or passenger doors. This may be most noticeable near the
b-pillar area of the door.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE VEHICLE IS BUILT AFTER 12/6/2006, THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. PROCEED WITH
NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTICS, REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL (WSM),
SECTION 100-04.
1. Check the build date of the vehicle.
a. If the build date of the vehicle is before 12/1/2006, continue to Step 2.
b. If the build date of the vehicle is between 12/1/06 and 12/6/06, continue to Step 3.
2. Verify that the glass run inserts at the b-pillar corner are still in the correct position. (Figure 1)
a. First roll down the window and peel back the inner flocked sealing lip in the b-pillar corner.
b. There will be two inserts located in the corner. They should both be touching in the corner and at
a 90 degree angle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Weatherstrip: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise
From Front Door B-Pillar Area > Page 10610
c. Sometimes they can shift or fall down into the channel. After verifying the correct plug position,
continue to Step 3.
NOTE
SOME TRUCKS BUILT DURING THE MONTH OF NOVEMBER MAY NOT HAVE THE TWO
INSERTS MENTIONED IN FIGURE 1, THERE MAY BE A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG INSTEAD. IF
THERE IS A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG AS SHOWN IN FIGURE 1, CONTINUE TO STEP 3.
3. With the front door window in the up position, inspect the b-pillar metal carrier for being slightly
bowed out and not making contact to the outside glass surface. (Figure 2)
a. To adjust, compress the b-pillar metal carrier inward just below the b-pillar corner to ensure it
seals to the glass. This can be done by rolling the window down and pressing inward in the location
mentioned above.
NOTE
BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVER COMPRESS THE METAL B-PILLAR CARRIER.
b. Continue to Step 4.
4. Next, with the window in the up position, Inspect the front glass run for any gaps by running a
piece of paper between the glass run and window to
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Door Weatherstrip: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body - Wind Noise
From Front Door B-Pillar Area > Page 10611
determine any areas where sealing may be an issue. (Figure 3)
a. Make sure to run the paper along both the inside and outside sealing sur[aces of the window to
glass run inter[ace.
b. If a piece of paper freely slips between the glass run and the window at any location then there
may be a sealing issue and the glass run needs to be replaced.
NOTE
IF THE WIND NOISE CONCERN IS STILL PRESENT AFTER PERFORMING THIS SERVICE
PROCEDURE, CONTINUE WITH NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSIS, REFER TO
WSM, SECTION 100-04.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071304A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.9 Hr.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: One Door (23943A,
23943A14, 21 596A)
071304B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.7 Hrs.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: Both Doors (23943A,
23943A14 21596A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7821546/7821547 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Weatherstrip: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area
Front Door Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Wind Noise From Front Door
B-Pillar Area
TSB 07-13-4
07/09/07
WIND NOISE AROUND FRONT DOORS - BUILT BEFORE 1216/2006
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 07-8-6 to clarify vehicle build date.
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/6/2006 may experience wind
noise around the exterior driver and/or passenger doors. This may be most noticeable near the
b-pillar area of the door.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
NOTE
IF THE VEHICLE IS BUILT AFTER 12/6/2006, THIS TSB DOES NOT APPLY. PROCEED WITH
NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSTICS, REFER TO WORKSHOP MANUAL (WSM),
SECTION 100-04.
1. Check the build date of the vehicle.
a. If the build date of the vehicle is before 12/1/2006, continue to Step 2.
b. If the build date of the vehicle is between 12/1/06 and 12/6/06, continue to Step 3.
2. Verify that the glass run inserts at the b-pillar corner are still in the correct position. (Figure 1)
a. First roll down the window and peel back the inner flocked sealing lip in the b-pillar corner.
b. There will be two inserts located in the corner. They should both be touching in the corner and at
a 90 degree angle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Weatherstrip: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area > Page 10617
c. Sometimes they can shift or fall down into the channel. After verifying the correct plug position,
continue to Step 3.
NOTE
SOME TRUCKS BUILT DURING THE MONTH OF NOVEMBER MAY NOT HAVE THE TWO
INSERTS MENTIONED IN FIGURE 1, THERE MAY BE A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG INSTEAD. IF
THERE IS A SINGLE MOLDED PLUG AS SHOWN IN FIGURE 1, CONTINUE TO STEP 3.
3. With the front door window in the up position, inspect the b-pillar metal carrier for being slightly
bowed out and not making contact to the outside glass surface. (Figure 2)
a. To adjust, compress the b-pillar metal carrier inward just below the b-pillar corner to ensure it
seals to the glass. This can be done by rolling the window down and pressing inward in the location
mentioned above.
NOTE
BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVER COMPRESS THE METAL B-PILLAR CARRIER.
b. Continue to Step 4.
4. Next, with the window in the up position, Inspect the front glass run for any gaps by running a
piece of paper between the glass run and window to
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Door Weatherstrip: > 07-13-4 > Jul > 07 > Body Wind Noise From Front Door B-Pillar Area > Page 10618
determine any areas where sealing may be an issue. (Figure 3)
a. Make sure to run the paper along both the inside and outside sealing sur[aces of the window to
glass run inter[ace.
b. If a piece of paper freely slips between the glass run and the window at any location then there
may be a sealing issue and the glass run needs to be replaced.
NOTE
IF THE WIND NOISE CONCERN IS STILL PRESENT AFTER PERFORMING THIS SERVICE
PROCEDURE, CONTINUE WITH NORMAL WORKSHOP MANUAL DIAGNOSIS, REFER TO
WSM, SECTION 100-04.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071304A 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 0.9 Hr.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: One Door (23943A,
23943A14, 21 596A)
071304B 2007 Expedition/Navigator: 1.7 Hrs.
Replace The Glass Run, Includes Time To Follow Service Procedure: Both Doors (23943A,
23943A14 21596A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7821546/7821547 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
DOOR GLASS TOP RUN-FRONT
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10622
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door window glass.
2. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
3. Remove the front door glass channel bolt and front door glass top run.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
DOOR GLASS TOP RUN-REAR
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10626
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Lower the rear door window glass. 2. Remove the rear door trim panel.
3. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
4. Remove the rear door glass channel bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
5. Remove the rear door glass top run. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High
Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 10635
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 > Body Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 10636
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 > Interior - Gap
Between Headliner and Sunroof Panel
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof
Panel
TSB 07-22-3
11/12/07
GAP/FIT - HEADLINER TO ROOF OPENING PANEL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel
may experience customer concerns with the fit/gap between the headliner and roof opening panel.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the fit of the roof opening panel to headliner (Figure 1).
a. If there is a gap or poor fit between roof opening panel and headliner or the roof opening panel is
not covering all the outlying areas of the headliner, go to Step 2.
b. If no gap is present, this TSB does not apply, follow Workshop Manual, Section 501-17.
2. Use a sofi pick or equivalent to lift the roof opening panel weatherstrip over the headliner.
3. Finesse and smooth the headliner material to the backing of the headliner if needed.
4. Reposition, finesse and smooth the roof opening panel weatherstrip so it covers the gap or poor
fit area of the headliner. The glue that is on the headliner backing will then adhere to the headliner
material keeping it in place and the repositioning of the weatherstrip will repair the concern.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072203A 2007-2008 0.2 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Correct The Condition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 > Interior - Gap
Between Headliner and Sunroof Panel > Page 10641
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7852124 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 >
Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Sunroof Water Leaks
During High Pressure Car Wash
TSB 08-24-8
12/08/08
WATER LEAKS - ROOF OPENING PANEL DURING HIGH PRESSURE CAR WASH
FORD: 2005-2008 F-150, F-250, F-350, F-450, F-550 2005-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2005-2009 Navigator 2006-2008 Mark LT
This article supersedes TSB 08-1-4 to update the Part List and Service procedure.
ISSUE Some 2005-2009 Expedition, Navigator, 2005-2008 F-150, F-Super Duty and 2006-2008
Mark LT vehicles with factory installed roof opening panel may experience a water leak at the rear
of roof opening panel during a high pressure car wash.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
2005-2008 F-150 / F-Super Duty 250-550 / 2006-2008 Mark LT
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to Work Shop Manual (WSM), Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. With rear trough removed; wipe clean the top inside of the trough with an alcohol based cleaner
or equivalent.
5. Remove the adhesive tape covering from trough seal.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 >
Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 10647
6. Attach seal to front of trough starting at one end of the trough. Make sure the vertical leg of seal
lines up against front flange of trough. (Figures 1-3)
7. Secure seal across entire trough. Apply pressure along entire seal to ensure bonding to trough.
8. Install the rear trough onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2) trough guide retaining
screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
9. Remove protective covering.
10. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
2005-2009 Expedition / Navigator
1. Remove roof opening panel glass only. Refer to WSM, Section 501-17.
2. To avoid paint damage to the roof, apply protective covering on roof finish.
3. From above vehicle, remove the two (2) trough guide retaining screws and the rear trough from
the trough guide assembly.
4. Install new trough and seal assembly.
5. Install the rear trough and seal assembly onto the trough guide assembly. Install the two (2)
trough guide retaining screws and torque to 9 lb-in. (1 N.m)
6. Remove protective covering.
7. Install roof opening panel following WSM, Section 501-17.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 08-24-8 > Dec > 08 >
Body - Sunroof Water Leaks During High Pressure Car Wash > Page 10648
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
082408A 2005-2009 Expedition, 0.5 Hr.
Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use With 5028A)
082408A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.6 Hr.
F-150, 2005-2008 Mark LT: Follow The Service Procedure To Repair The Water leak (Do Not Use
With 5028A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
78502C50 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 >
Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof Panel
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Gap Between Headliner
and Sunroof Panel
TSB 07-22-3
11/12/07
GAP/FIT - HEADLINER TO ROOF OPENING PANEL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles equipped with a roof opening panel
may experience customer concerns with the fit/gap between the headliner and roof opening panel.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Check the fit of the roof opening panel to headliner (Figure 1).
a. If there is a gap or poor fit between roof opening panel and headliner or the roof opening panel is
not covering all the outlying areas of the headliner, go to Step 2.
b. If no gap is present, this TSB does not apply, follow Workshop Manual, Section 501-17.
2. Use a sofi pick or equivalent to lift the roof opening panel weatherstrip over the headliner.
3. Finesse and smooth the headliner material to the backing of the headliner if needed.
4. Reposition, finesse and smooth the roof opening panel weatherstrip so it covers the gap or poor
fit area of the headliner. The glue that is on the headliner backing will then adhere to the headliner
material keeping it in place and the repositioning of the weatherstrip will repair the concern.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
072203A 2007-2008 0.2 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Follow The Service Procedure To Correct The Condition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: > 07-22-3 > Nov > 07 >
Interior - Gap Between Headliner and Sunroof Panel > Page 10653
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
7852124 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10654
Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
ROOF OPENING PANEL WEATHERSTRIP
Exploded View
Removal
NOTE: The roof opening panel must be initialized when repairs are carried out on any part of the
roof opening panel, including: whenever the roof opening panel has been removed from the roof
opening panel assembly, a new roof opening panel motor/module has been installed or when a
new roof opening panel assembly has been installed.
1. Remove the roof opening panel. 2. Place roof opening panel, topside up, on a worktable. Take
care to support the glass assembly from below to prevent damaging the mounting tabs.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Sunroof / Moonroof Weatherstrip > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10655
3. Remove the old roof opening panel weatherstrip by pulling up on the weatherstrip.
Installation
1. Place a new weatherstrip into position on the glass assembly, with the splice (seam) on the
passenger side. 2. Starting with the corners, push the weatherstrip into position. Continue pushing
the weatherstrip into position around the glass assembly until
complete. Use a plastic or rubber hammer if necessary.
3. Install the roof opening panel. 4. Adjust the roof panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations > Page
10660
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 10663
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS) Brake
Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS) BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page
10670
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the driver air bag module during this procedure.
- Be careful not to allow the speed control switch electrical connector to fall back into the steering
wheel.
1. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the driver air bag module. 3. Remove the 2 screws and the steering wheel controls
bezel. 4. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10675
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Pedal Position (BPP) Switch > Page 10678
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Brake Pedal Switch (BPS) Brake
Deactivator Switch
BRAKE PEDAL SWITCH (BPS) BRAKE DEACTIVATOR SWITCH
The BPS, also called the brake deactivator switch, is for vehicle speed control deactivation. A
normally closed switch supplies battery positive voltage (B+) to the PCM when the brake pedal is
not applied. When the brake pedal is applied, the normally closed switch opens and power is
removed from the PCM.
On some applications the normally closed BPS, along with the normally open BPP switch, are used
for a brake rationality test within the PCM. The PCM misfire monitor profile learn function may be
disabled if a brake switch concern occurs. If one or both brake pedal inputs to the PCM is not
changing states when they were expected to, a diagnostic trouble code (DTC) is set by the PCM
strategy.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
CLUTCH PEDAL POSITION (CPP) SWITCH
Typical Clutch Pedal Position (CPP) Switch
The CPP switch is an input to the PCM indicating the clutch pedal position. The PCM provides a
low current voltage on the CPP circuit. When the CPP switch is closed, this voltage is pulled low
through the SIG RTN circuit. The CPP input to the PCM is used to detect a reduction in engine
load. The PCM uses the load information for mass air flow and fuel calculations.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 10685
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the driver air bag module during this procedure.
- Be careful not to allow the speed control switch electrical connector to fall back into the steering
wheel.
1. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the driver air bag module. 3. Remove the 2 screws and the steering wheel controls
bezel. 4. Remove the speed control switch by pulling the switch toward the rear of the vehicle.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams
C4186
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cigarette Lighter: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10694
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10695
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10696
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10697
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10698
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10699
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10700
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10701
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10702
Cigarette Lighter: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10703
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10704
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10705
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10706
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10707
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10708
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10709
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10710
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10711
C2031
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10712
Cigarette Lighter: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
44-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10713
44-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10714
44-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Diagrams
C2016
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 10718
Clock: Description and Operation
CLOCK
The stand-alone electric analog clock, available in the Navigator only, is centrally located on the
instrument panel and displays time in a 12-hour format. The clock is backlit when the headlamps
and parking lamps are on. The Expedition clock is integrated into the radio.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Clock: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step. 4. If the fault is not visually evident, verify the symptom. GO to Symptom Chart. See:
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10721
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10722
Clock: Pinpoint Tests
PINPOINT TESTS A: THE CLOCK OPERATION IS INOPERATIVE
A1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10723
A1-A3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10724
A4
Normal Operation
The clock receives battery voltage from the smart junction box (SJB) through circuit SBP14
(BN/RD). Ground for the clock is supplied through circuit GD138 (BK/WH).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit SBP14 (BN/RD) open
- Circuit GD138 (BK/WH) open
- Clock
- SJB
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 10725
Clock: Service and Repair
CLOCK
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster center finish panel. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector. 3.
Release the retaining clips and remove the clock from the instrument cluster center finish panel. 4.
To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Clock > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 10726
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Diagrams
C909
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center
COMPASS ZONE ADJUSTMENT - WITH MESSAGE CENTER
1. Determine which magnetic zone you are in for your geographic location. 2. Start the engine. 3.
Press the message center SETUP button until RESET FOR ZONE SETTING is displayed. 4. Press
and release the RESET button until ZONE XX RESET = CHANGE is displayed.
5. NOTE: The zone selection increases with each subsequent button press with a range of zones
from 1 to 15 scrolling back to the beginning.
Press and release the RESET button until the desired zone appears in the message center display.
6. To exit the zone setting mode and lock in the changes, press and release either the RESET or
SETUP button or simply wait 4 seconds and the
message center locks in the zone.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center > Page 10732
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Zone Adjustment - Without Message Center
COMPASS ZONE ADJUSTMENT - WITHOUT MESSAGE CENTER
1. Determine which magnetic zone you are in for your geographic location. 2. Start the engine.
3. Locate the reset button on the top of the compass module at the base of the interior rear view
mirror. 4. Press and hold the reset button for 6 seconds and release when ZONE appears in the
instrument cluster display.
5. NOTE: The zone selection increases with each subsequent button press with a range of zones
from 1 to 15 scrolling back to the beginning.
Press and release the reset button until the desired zone number appears.
6. When the desired zone number appears in the instrument cluster display, do not press the reset
button. The instrument cluster locks in the zone
setting and returns to normal operation when the reset button is not pressed for approximately 4
seconds.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center > Page 10733
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Calibration - With Message Center
COMPASS CALIBRATION - WITH MESSAGE CENTER
1. NOTE: For optimum calibration, drive to an open, level location away from large metallic objects
or structures. Switch off all non-essential
electrical accessories (heated rear window, heater, A/C, map lamps, wiper, etc.) and make sure all
the doors are closed.
Start the vehicle.
2. Press the message center SETUP button until RESET FOR CALIBRATION is displayed.
3. NOTE: The message center displays CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE in the calibration
function.
Press the RESET control button to start the compass calibration function.
4. NOTE:
- This step may require up to 5 circles to complete the calibration.
- If the RESET button is pressed during the calibration or 3 minutes has elapsed since the
beginning of the calibration without driving the vehicle, the message center reverts back to normal
operation and the INFO displays CAL until a successful calibration is carried out.
Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle less than 5 km/h (3 mph) until the CIRCLE SLOWLY TO
CALIBRATE display changes to CALIBRATION COMPLETED.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Compass > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Compass Zone Adjustment - With Message Center > Page 10734
Compass: Service and Repair Compass Calibration - Without Message Center
COMPASS CALIBRATION - WITHOUT MESSAGE CENTER
1. NOTE: For optimum calibration, drive to an open, level location away from large metallic objects
or structures. Switch off all non-essential
electrical accessories (heated rear window, heater, A/C, map lamps, wiper, etc.) and make sure all
the doors are closed.
Start the vehicle.
2. Locate the reset button on the top of the compass module at the base of the interior rear view
mirror. 3. Press and hold the reset button for 8 seconds and release when CAL appears in the
instrument cluster display.
4. NOTE: This step may require up to 5 circles to complete the calibration.
Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle at no more than 5 km/h (3 mph) until CAL turns off in the
instrument cluster display.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module.Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped). Failure to
follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable (14301) and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all supplemental restraint system (SRS) components are connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install restraints control module (RCM) fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10740
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off.If an air bag SRS fault
is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10741
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body.This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down.This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin.Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module.Doing so can result in safety canopy
deployment, which can result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device.Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner.Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector.Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON.This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and
the restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors are located in the first row doors, behind the door trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10742
auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).Failure to follow these instructions may
increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position. 8. Center the tilt steering column.
9. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock
position).
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws and pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
11. Remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
All vehicles 12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws. 13. Release the clips and
remove the steering column upper shroud. 14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10743
15. CAUTION: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each
of the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel.Failure to do so will damage the driver
air bag module and steering wheel.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity.The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
- Use a mirror to look at the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
- Note the position of the 2 driver air bag module locator pins to the steering wheel for installation.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
16. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors, then disconnect the horn switch
electrical connector and remove the driver air bag
module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight ahead position (the 12
o'clock position). 18. Open and lower the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10744
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat.The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector.
21. Release the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
22. Remove the bolt and the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10745
23. Remove the cover and the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10746
27. Remove the bolt and the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
28. Remove the cover and the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10747
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat.The driver seat side air bag module
electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SPDJB. 33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10748
5. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10749
9. Connect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
10. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10750
13. Attach the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector. 16. Close the glove compartment
door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag
module.Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module.Do not force
the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the horn switch electrical connector, then connect the 2 driver air bag module electrical
connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10751
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE:
- Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated correctly to the
steering wheel.
- Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks. -
Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud. 22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
23. Install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. Install the lower steering column opening cover and the 3 screws.
All vehicles 25. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 26. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and install the cover.
27. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
28. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dashboard / Instrument Panel > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10752
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position.This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps.If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel
dimmer switch. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch > Page 10757
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch > Page 10758
Vehicles with power tilt
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
View 151-39 (LH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 10763
View 151-40 (RH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 10764
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 10765
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 10768
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 10769
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 10770
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Driver/Vehicle Information Display: > 07-7-4 >
Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Customer Interest Instruments - Message Center Switches
Inop/Other Errors
TSB 07-7-4
04/16/07
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCHES INOP-TEXT BLANK/SCRAMBLED/COMPASS INOP/WASHER
LIGHT ON/OAT READS HIGH
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/22/2006 may exhibit concerns
with the Instrument Cluster (IC). The outside air temp reads 140 °F (60 °C), message center
switches unresponsive/text blank or scrambled, compass display is inoperative, washer fluid level
light is on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE IC ASSEMBLY UNTIL COMPLETE DIAGNOSIS HAS BEEN PERFORMED.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check the build date code of the IC. The date code is displayed in the message center during
"engineering test mod&'.
Engineering Test Mode:
1. Ignition in "OFF" position.
2. Cluster type.
a. For Base Clusters (without message center cluster): depress the reset stem on the cluster while
turning the ignition switch to the "ON" position.
b. Message Center Clusters: depress the reset button in the vehicle while turning the ignition switch
to the "ON" position.
3. Continue to hold down the reset stem/button for 5 seconds until the cluster message center
displays "engineering test mode".
4. Press/cycle reset stem/button until the message center displays "manufacture" and the date of
manufacture (MM-DD-YYYY).
5. If the date is after 12/22/2006, this TSB does not apply and proceed with normal diagnostics
found in Workshop Manual (WSM), Sections 413-01 and 413-08.
6. Turn the vehicle ignition to the "OFF" position to exit the "engineering test mode".
Outside Air Temperature (OAT) Diagnostics
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS FOR VEHICLES WITHOUT (ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE
CONTROL) EATC.
1. Run vehicle for 5 minutes.
2. Verify the OAT reads 140 °F (60 °C) in the Message Center.
3. Disconnect the OAT sensor.
4. Does the Message Center still read 140 °F (60 °C)?
a. Yes - proceed to Step 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Driver/Vehicle Information Display: > 07-7-4 >
Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 10779
b. No - follow WSM, Section 413-08.
5. Disconnect battery.
6. Disconnect IC.
7. Measure the resistance between pins 1 and 2 on Connector C132.
a. Resistance less than 1 Meg-Ohms - Repair shorted circuits.
b. Resistance greater than 1 Meg-Ohms - Proceed to Step 8.
8. Reconnect IC and OAT sensor.
9. Reconnect battery, to verify IC connection. If Message Center still reads 140 °F (60 °C), replace
IC.
Message Center (MC) Switch, Diagnostics:
Refer to WSM, Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate
Correctly
Low Washer Fluid Level Light On, Diagnostics
1. Verify low washer fluid level light is on and washer bottle is full.
2. Verify washer fluid level switch is fully seated in the bottle. Is light still on?
a. No - repair is complete.
b. Yes - proceed to Step 3.
3. Disconnect the washer fluid level switch. Does the light go out after one minute?
a. Yes - proceed with normal WSM, Section 413-01 Diagnostics.
b. No - proceed to Step 4.
4. Disconnect battery.
5. Disconnect IC.
6. Measure the resistance on Pins 1 and 2 of Connector C138. Is the resistance less than 1
Meg-Ohms?
a. Yes - repair shorted wires.
b. No - proceed to step 7.
7. Reconnect the washer fluid level switch, IC and then battery to verify IC connections. If light is
still on, replace the IC.
No Compass Display Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative.
Message Center Display Blank/Text Scrambled, Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Symptom Chart
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070704 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Driver/Vehicle Information Display: > 07-7-4 >
Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 10780
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
10849 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Driver/Vehicle Information
Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Message Center
Switches Inop/Other Errors
TSB 07-7-4
04/16/07
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCHES INOP-TEXT BLANK/SCRAMBLED/COMPASS INOP/WASHER
LIGHT ON/OAT READS HIGH
FORD: 2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles built before 12/22/2006 may exhibit concerns
with the Instrument Cluster (IC). The outside air temp reads 140 °F (60 °C), message center
switches unresponsive/text blank or scrambled, compass display is inoperative, washer fluid level
light is on.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
NOTE
DO NOT REPLACE IC ASSEMBLY UNTIL COMPLETE DIAGNOSIS HAS BEEN PERFORMED.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Check the build date code of the IC. The date code is displayed in the message center during
"engineering test mod&'.
Engineering Test Mode:
1. Ignition in "OFF" position.
2. Cluster type.
a. For Base Clusters (without message center cluster): depress the reset stem on the cluster while
turning the ignition switch to the "ON" position.
b. Message Center Clusters: depress the reset button in the vehicle while turning the ignition switch
to the "ON" position.
3. Continue to hold down the reset stem/button for 5 seconds until the cluster message center
displays "engineering test mode".
4. Press/cycle reset stem/button until the message center displays "manufacture" and the date of
manufacture (MM-DD-YYYY).
5. If the date is after 12/22/2006, this TSB does not apply and proceed with normal diagnostics
found in Workshop Manual (WSM), Sections 413-01 and 413-08.
6. Turn the vehicle ignition to the "OFF" position to exit the "engineering test mode".
Outside Air Temperature (OAT) Diagnostics
NOTE
THIS PROCEDURE IS FOR VEHICLES WITHOUT (ELECTRONIC AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE
CONTROL) EATC.
1. Run vehicle for 5 minutes.
2. Verify the OAT reads 140 °F (60 °C) in the Message Center.
3. Disconnect the OAT sensor.
4. Does the Message Center still read 140 °F (60 °C)?
a. Yes - proceed to Step 4.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Driver/Vehicle Information
Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 10786
b. No - follow WSM, Section 413-08.
5. Disconnect battery.
6. Disconnect IC.
7. Measure the resistance between pins 1 and 2 on Connector C132.
a. Resistance less than 1 Meg-Ohms - Repair shorted circuits.
b. Resistance greater than 1 Meg-Ohms - Proceed to Step 8.
8. Reconnect IC and OAT sensor.
9. Reconnect battery, to verify IC connection. If Message Center still reads 140 °F (60 °C), replace
IC.
Message Center (MC) Switch, Diagnostics:
Refer to WSM, Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate
Correctly
Low Washer Fluid Level Light On, Diagnostics
1. Verify low washer fluid level light is on and washer bottle is full.
2. Verify washer fluid level switch is fully seated in the bottle. Is light still on?
a. No - repair is complete.
b. Yes - proceed to Step 3.
3. Disconnect the washer fluid level switch. Does the light go out after one minute?
a. Yes - proceed with normal WSM, Section 413-01 Diagnostics.
b. No - proceed to Step 4.
4. Disconnect battery.
5. Disconnect IC.
6. Measure the resistance on Pins 1 and 2 of Connector C138. Is the resistance less than 1
Meg-Ohms?
a. Yes - repair shorted wires.
b. No - proceed to step 7.
7. Reconnect the washer fluid level switch, IC and then battery to verify IC connections. If light is
still on, replace the IC.
No Compass Display Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Pinpoint Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative.
Message Center Display Blank/Text Scrambled, Diagnostics
Refer to WSM Section 413-08 Symptom Chart
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage And
Emissions Warranty Coverage IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a
TSB. Warranty coverage limits are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT070704 Use SLTS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Driver/Vehicle Information
Display: > 07-7-4 > Apr > 07 > Instruments - Message Center Switches Inop/Other Errors > Page 10787
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
10849 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10788
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10789
C253
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10790
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Description and Operation
INFORMATION AND MESSAGE CENTER
The message center display is a green (Expedition) items or white (Navigator) vacuum fluorescent,
fixed units format, 2-line display integrated into the center of enable/ the instrument cluster and is
controlled by the entry/ message center switches. There are two basic equipped), instrument
cluster/message center configurations. items The first is the full function message center and can
in be identified by the three button message center approximately switch located in the instrument
panel center finish The panel. The second is the base cluster message decrease center and can
be identified by the single reset can button located in the instrument cluster. Both approximately
instrument cluster configurations display messages was based upon vehicle option content.
The base cluster message center functions and menus listed below can be selected through the
reset button by pressing and releasing the reset button to scroll through the menu items. The INFO
items (trip A, trip B and average fuel economy) can be reset by holding the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds. The SETUP items, (language, system configurable items [autolamps,
autolock, auto unlock etc.]) can be reset by holding the reset button for approximately 2 seconds
when the selected menu item is displayed. Refer to the Owner's Literature for complete operating
instructions for both the full function message center and the base instrument cluster message
center.
The message center provides the following features:
- Information displays
- Setup displays
- System check messages
- System warning messages
The full function message center features and menus listed below can be selected through a set of
3 buttons:
- INFO
- SETUP
- RESET
Message Center Configuration
The message center has the capability to configure items such as oil life, oil life start value,
language, units (English or metric), autolamp delay, to enable/disable a variety of options such as
easy entry/easy exit (if equipped) and air suspension (if equipped), or to carry out
calibrations/settings on items such as the compass. The oil life is displayed in percent and is preset
to a maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) or 180 days. The oil life start value is used
to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The value can be changed back to the
maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) if the value was previously changed or lowered
by 10% decrements down to 10%.
On configurable items such as parking aid on/off and air suspension on/off (if equipped) the
message center indicates the appropriate selection (ON/OFF) by bracketing the selection. An
example is as follows: PARKING AID OFF. The parking aid is enabled or on in the previous
example. If the driver selects the parking aid off, the display would be: PARKING AID ON .
Reconfigurable Telltale Indicators
The message center displays reconfigurable telltale indicators in the RH side of the display area.
Reconfigurable telltale indicators replace indicators that have been typically displayed in the
instrument cluster and use the same iconic representation.
Compass and Outside Air Temperature Displays
The message center provides a compass display and uses directional information sent from a
compass module, located on the underside of the inside rear view mirror.
The message center provides an outside air temperature display on vehicles that are not equipped
with electronic automatic temperature control (EATC).
Information Displays
The information displays are non-timed modes. The selected mode remains on until the driver
presses a message center button to change the mode or it is overridden by another mode.
The information display modes are: Odometer
- Trip odometer
- Outside air temperature display (if equipped)
- Compass
- Distance to empty (DTE)
- Average fuel economy
- Instantaneous fuel economy
- Blank display
Setup Displays
The setup displays are timed modes and terminate after a finite interval.The setup display modes
are:
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10791
- System check
- Oil life
- Units English/metric
- Autolamp delay in seconds (if equipped)
- Easy entry/easy exit seat on/off (if equipped)
- Air suspension on/off (if equipped)
- Autolocks on/off (if equipped)
- Power liftgate on/off (if equipped)
- Power running boards auto/off/out (if equipped)
- Compass zone
- Compass calibration
- Language
System Check
The system check provides a check of all the monitored systems on the vehicle. The system check
scrolls through each of the monitored systems and provides a visual indication to report out the
status of each system. The message center displays OK for approximately 2 seconds if the system
check does not detect a fault in the system and displays a warning message for approximately 2
seconds if the system check detects a fault in the system. Press the RESET button to scroll
through the system check messages.
The system check messages are: OIL LIFE
- CHARGING SYSTEM
- WASHER FLUID LOW
- DOOR STATUS
- LIFTGATE/GLASS
- BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
- TIRE PRESSURE SYSTEM (if equipped)
- AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM (if equipped)
- FUEL LEVEL
System Warning Messages
The system warning messages alert the operator to possible problems or malfunctions in the
vehicle operating systems. The message center displays the last selected feature if there are no
additional warning messages. Once a warning message has been displayed, the message must be
acknowledged to allow full functionality of the message center. Press the RESET to acknowledge
and clear the warning message. The warning messages are divided into 4 categories: -
Cannot be cleared until the condition is corrected.
- Reappear on the display 10 minutes from the reset if the condition has not been corrected.
- Do not reappear until an ignition OFF-ON cycle has been completed.
- Reappear if the condition clears then reoccurs within the same ignition cycle ON-OFF cycle.
The warning display that cannot be reset is: PARK AID ON/OFF
The warning messages that reoccur after 10 minutes are: CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM
- XXX MILES (km) TO E FUEL LOW
- PARK BRAKE ENGAGED
The warning messages that display whenever the ignition switch is turned from the OFF position to
the ON position are: BRAKE FLUID LEVEL LOW
- CHECK PARK BRAKE
- WASHER FLUID LEVEL LOW
- OIL CHANGE REQUIRED
- XXX% OIL LIFE CHANGE SOON
- CHECK AIR SUSPENSION SYSTEM (if equipped)
The warning messages that return after a condition has cleared then reoccurs within the same
ignition ON-OFF cycle are: DRIVER DOOR AJAR
- PASSENGER DOOR AJAR
- REAR LEFT DOOR AJAR
- REAR RIGHT DOOR AJAR
- LIFTGATE/GLASS AJAR
- CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM
- TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT (if equipped)
- LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped)
- TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT (if equipped)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10792
- 4X4 SHIFT IN PROGRESS (if equipped)
- AIR SUSPENSION OFF (if equipped)
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during the operation
of the four wheel drive (4WD) system (late build only). The displayed warning messages are as
follows: FOR 4X4 STOP VEHICLE (if equipped)
- FOR 4X4 LOW APPLY BRAKE (if equipped)
- FOR 4X4 LOW SHIFT TO N (if equipped)
- TO EXIT 4X4 LOW STOP VEHICLE (if equipped)
- TO EXIT 4X4 LOW APPLY BRAKE (if equipped)
- TO EXIT 4X4 LOW SHIFT TO N (if equipped)
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during repair
procedures related to the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS). The displayed warning
messages are as follows: TRAIN LEFT TIRE (if equipped)
- TRAIN LEFT REAR TIRE (if equipped)
- TRAIN RIGHT FRONT TIRE (if equipped)
- TRAIN RIGHT REAR TIRE (if equipped)
- TRAIN SPARE TIRE (if equipped)
- TRAINING COMPLETE (if equipped)
- TIRES NOT TRAINED-REPEAT (if equipped)
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during repair
procedures related to the compass display. The displayed warning messages are as follows: RESET FOR ZONE SETTING
- ZONE XX RESET = CHANGE
- RESET FOR CALIBRATION
- CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE
- CALIBRATION COMPLETED
- COMPASS DATA ERROR
The message center displays warning messages that indicate a system state during repair
procedures related to the oil life and oil life start value. The displayed warning messages are as
follows: OIL LIFE XXX% HOLD RESET = NEW
- OIL LIFE SET TO XXX%
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network), No Power To The Scan Tool, to
diagnose no communication with the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to diagnose no response from the
powertrain control module (PCM).
7. Carry out the network test:
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus (Module Communications Network).
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the instrument cluster. 9. If
the DTCs retrieved are related to the concern, refer to the Instrument Cluster Diagnostic Trouble
Code (DTC) Chart. See: Diagnostic Trouble
Code Descriptions
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
The message center is an integral part of the instrument cluster that receives and acts upon much
of the same information that is input and used to operate the instrument cluster gauges, indicators,
warning indicators and reconfigurable telltale indicators. The message center, located in the center
of the instrument cluster is a vacuum fluorescent 2-line display. The message center electronic
functions use both hardwired, and the controller area network (CAN) circuitry to transmit and
receive information.
Whenever conditions are present that require a warning message, the message center replaces
the last selected display with the new warning display. Once the message is reset or cleared, the
message center returns to the last selected display. If multiple warnings are present, the message
center displays each warning for approximately 4 seconds. Warning messages are also generally
associated with other observable instrument cluster indications. For example, when the LH front
door is opened, the message center displays the message DRIVER DOOR AJAR along with the
door ajar reconfigurable telltale indicator. This allows the message center to be a more informative
supplement to the instrument cluster gauges and indicators.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10795
It is very important to understand:
- where the input (command) originates.
- all the information (messages) necessary in order for a feature to operate.
- which module(s) receive(s) the input or command message.
- if the module that received the input (message) controls the output of the feature, or if it outputs a
message over the CAN to another module.
- which module controls the output of the feature.
Instrument Cluster Messages
NOTE: Whenever a message is suspected as missing, confirmed by a missing message DTC, it is
important to look for other symptoms that may also be present in the instrument cluster and
throughout the vehicle. Once a DTC is set in the instrument cluster it may be helpful to review the
complete message list available in Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to see what
other modules also rely on the same message and run the self-test for those modules. If the
message is missing from other modules, the same DTC may also be set in those modules.
Confirmation of missing messages common to multiple modules may indicate that the originating
module is the source of the concern or the communication network may be experiencing some
problems.
The instrument cluster uses input messages from other modules to control the gauges,
informational indicators, warning indicators and reconfigurable telltale indicators over the
communication networks. If a required message is missing or invalid for less than 5 seconds, the
gauge or indicator that requires the message remains at the last commanded state based upon the
last known good message. For example, if the message is missing the O/D off status for less than
5 seconds and the O/D off indicator was ON (O/D cancelled), the indicator remains in the ON state
until the next good message is received. If the message remains missing or invalid for greater than
5 seconds, the instrument cluster sets a U-code DTC and the output becomes a default action for
the indicator or gauge. Each indicator or gauge utilizes a different default strategy depending on
the nature of the indication. Refer Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators. for further
descriptions of the default action specific to each indicator or gauge. If the messaged input to the
cluster returns at any time, the normal function of the gauge or indicator resumes.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10796
B1255-B2097 / U2013
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10797
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Chart (Part 1)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10798
Symptom Chart (Part 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10799
Symptom Chart (Part 3)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10800
Symptom Chart (Part 4)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10801
Symptom Chart (Part 5)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10802
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Pinpoint Tests
Test A: The Message Center Is Not Operating Correctly
PINPOINT TEST A: THE MESSAGE CENTER IS NOT OPERATING CORRECTLY
A1
Normal Operation
The message center is located in the center of the instrument cluster between the tachometer and
the speedometer in the vacuum fluorescent display area. The message center is integral to the
instrument cluster and uses the same voltage supply as the instrument cluster. The RUN/START
voltage is supplied to the instrument cluster on circuit CBP29 (WH/VT) and the keep alive B+
voltage is received on circuit SBP26 (YE/RD). The instrument cluster ground is received through
circuit GD133 (BK). The message center functionality is controlled through the message center
switches, which are hardwired to the instrument cluster through the input circuit CMC29 (GN/VT)
and the return circuit VMC29 (YE).
Possible Causes
- Message center switches
- Instrument cluster
Test B: The Message Center Switch Does Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST B: THE MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY
B1-B2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10803
B2-B4
Normal Operation
The message center functionality is controlled through the message center switch, which is
hardwired to the instrument cluster through the input circuit CMC29 (GN/VT) and the return circuit
VMC29 (YE). There are 3 message center switch buttons with each button operating a switch that
uses different resistance values. The instrument cluster sends out a reference voltage to the
message center switch on the input circuit and monitors the input voltage when a message center
switch button is pressed. The input voltage will vary depending upon the resistance of each button,
providing a specific indication to the instrument cluster which switch is pressed.
Possible Causes
- Circuit CMC29 (GN/VT) open or short to ground
- Circuit VMC29 (YE) open or short to ground
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10804
- Message center switch
- Instrument cluster
Test C: The Compass Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST C: THE COMPASS IS INOPERATIVE
C1-C3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10805
C3-C4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10806
C5
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module receives voltage from the smart junction box (SJB) through circuit
CBP31 (BU/OG) and is grounded through circuit GD133 (BK). The compass sensor module
communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster through the compass communication
data plus circuit VMC31 (YE/GN) and compass communication data minus circuit VMC30 (BU/GY).
DTC B2097 - sets in continuous memory if the instrument cluster detects invalid data sent from the
compass module.
DTC U2013 - is a continuous memory and on-demand DTC that sets if the instrument cluster is
missing the compass data from the compass module. If the instrument cluster fails to receive the
compass data, the instrument cluster sets DTC U2013 and defaults the compass display to (----).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CBP31 (BU/OG) open
- Circuit GD133 (BK) open
- Circuit VMC30 (BU/GY) open or short to ground
- Circuit VMC31 (YE/GN) open or short to ground
- Compass sensor module
Test D: The Compass Is Inaccurate
PINPOINT TEST D: THE COMPASS IS INACCURATE
D1
Normal Operation
The compass sensor module communicates the vehicle direction to the instrument cluster through
the compass communication data plus circuit
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10807
VMC31 (YE/GN) and compass communication data minus circuit VMC30 (BU/GY). The magnetic
fields generated by the earths north and south poles are divided into zones that differ from each
other with respect to how the magnetic fields appear. The magnetic north can change by up to 4
degrees between zones and become noticeable across multiple zones. The compass zone must
be set to the correct zone for the compass to read accurately. Factors within the vehicle may affect
the ability of the compass module to accurately read the magnetic north. Calibrating the compass
allows the compass module to compensate for vehicle factors that influence the accuracy of the
compass.
NOTE: Outside factors such as bridges, steel structures, tall buildings and power lines also affect
compass accuracy.
Possible Causes
- Compass sensor module
- Zone setting
- Calibration
Test E: The Outside Air Temperature Sensor Does Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST E: THE OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR DOES NOT OPERATE
CORRECTLY
E1-E4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10808
E4-E5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10809
E6-E7
Normal Operation
The outside air temperature sensor is mounted on the radiator core support in front of the radiator
and A/C condenser and is hardwired to the instrument cluster through input circuit VH407 (YE/GN)
and return circuit VMC29 (YE). The instrument cluster provides a reference voltage to the ambient
air temperature sensor and monitors the change in voltage resulting from changes in resistance as
determined by outside air temperature. When the engine has been off for 2 hours, or the engine
temperature is cold, the instrument cluster displays the current outside air temperature as
measured by the ambient air temperature sensor. When the time is less than 2 hours, or if the
engine is not cold, the instrument cluster takes a reading of the current temperature and compares
the current reading against the last reading at key off. If the temperature is less than the last key off
temperature reading, the instrument cluster displays the current temperature. If the temperature is
greater than the last key off temperature reading, the instrument cluster displays the last key off
temperature reading until the ambient air temperature has had time to stabilize with vehicle
movement.
DTC B1255 - is a continuous and on-demand DTC that sets if the instrument cluster detects an
open on the outside air temperature sensor input, circuit VH407 (YE/GN). If the instrument cluster
detects an open on the outside air temperature input, the instrument cluster defaults the display to
23.89°C (75°F).
DTC B1257 - is a continuous and on-demand DTC that sets if the instrument cluster detects a short
to ground on the outside air temperature sensor input, circuit VH407 (YE/GN). If the instrument
cluster detects a short to ground on the outside air temperature input, the instrument cluster
defaults the display to 23.89°C (75°F).
Possible Causes
- Circuit RH111 (GY/BU) open
- Circuit VH407 (YE/GN) open, short to voltage or ground
- Circuit VMC29 (YE) open or short to voltage
- Outside air temperature sensor
- Instrument cluster
Test F: The Parking Aid On/Off Warning Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST F: THE PARKING AID ON/OFF WARNING IS INOPERATIVE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10810
F1-F5
Normal Operation
The parking aid on/off status is sent from the parking aid module to the instrument cluster over the
medium speed controller area network (MS-CAN) communication bus lines. When the RESET
button is pressed, the instrument cluster sends a query to the parking aid module, requesting a
system status. The parking aid module responds to the instrument cluster with the status of the
system, either on or off. If the return status message is missing or corrupted, the instrument cluster
does not display the brackets around either the ON or OFF selection.
Possible Causes
- Instrument cluster configuration
- Parking aid system
- Instrument cluster
Test G: The Check Air Suspension or Air Suspension Off Warning Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST G: THE CHECK AIR SUSPENSION OR AIR SUSPENSION OFF WARNING IS
INOPERATIVE
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10811
G1-G3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 10812
G4-G6
Normal Operation
The air suspension on/off status is sent from the air suspension module to the instrument cluster
over the high speed controller area network (HS-CAN) communication bus lines. When the RESET
button is pressed, the instrument cluster sends a query to the air suspension module, requesting a
system status. The air suspension module responds to the instrument cluster with the status of the
system, either on or off. If the return status message is missing or corrupted, the instrument cluster
does not display the brackets around either the ON or OFF selection.
Possible Causes
- Instrument cluster configuration
- Air suspension system
- Air suspension module
- Instrument cluster
Test H: The 4X4 Shift In Progress Warning Is Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST H: THE 4X4 SHIFT IN PROGRESS WARNING IS INOPERATIVE
H1-H4
Normal Operation
The four wheel drive (4WD) control module sends the instrument cluster a message over the high
speed controller area network (HS-CAN) communication bus lines when the 4WD system is in the
process of shifting out of two wheel drive (2WD) and has not yet fully shifted into 4x4 high, 4x4 low
or 4x4 auto. Once the shift is completed, the 4WD control module removes the 4x4 shift in progress
message and sends a new message to turn on the applicable reconfigurable telltale indicator.
Possible Causes
- Instrument cluster configuration
- 4WD system
- 4WD control module
- Instrument cluster
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Procedures
Oil Life Reset - Message Center Cluster
OIL LIFE RESET - MESSAGE CENTER CLUSTER
NOTE:
- The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) or 180 days.
- The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example, the
message center may display OIL LIFE =80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW. 2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 3. Press and release the SETUP button to exit
the procedure.
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster
OIL LIFE RESET - BASE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
NOTE:
- All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the instrument
cluster.
- The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) or 180 days.
- The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example, the
message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press and release the reset button to exit the
procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
OIL LIFE START VALUE - MESSAGE CENTER CLUSTER
NOTE:
- The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The value
can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) if the value was
previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
- The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example, the
message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET = NEW. 2. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Press the RESET button once for each 10% reduction below the default 100% until the message
center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
4. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster
OIL LIFE START VALUE - BASE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
NOTE:
- All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the instrument
cluster.
- The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The value
can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) if the value was
previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press the RESET button to lower 10% from
the default 100% until the message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
6. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Repeat steps 2-5 for each desired 10% reduction.
7. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 10815
Driver/Vehicle Information Display: Removal and Replacement
MESSAGE CENTER SWITCH
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures > Page 10816
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Pull the instrument panel center finish panel straight out to release the retaining clips.
Navigator
2. NOTE: The transmission selector lever bezel is held in place by 4 tabs that are located in the
shifter assembly.
Remove the transmission selector lever bezel.
3. Open the floor console compartment door and pull the floor console finish panel straight up to
release the retainer clips. 4. Remove the 2 screws and pull the instrument panel center finish panel
straight out to release the retainer clips.
- Position the instrument panel center finish panel aside.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the electrical connectors. 6. Press the 4 retaining tabs and remove the message
center switch from the center instrument panel finish panel. 7. To install, reverse the removal
procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Driver/Vehicle Information Display >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 10817
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Filler Cap Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
CHECK FUEL CAP INDICATOR
The check fuel cap indicator is a communications network message sent by the PCM. The PCM
sends the message to illuminate the lamp when the strategy determines that there is a failure in the
vapor management system due to the fuel filler cap not being sealed correctly. This would be
detected by the inability to pull vacuum in the fuel tank, after a fueling event.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads
Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge: Customer Interest Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads
Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 10829
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel
Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8
Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel
Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 10835
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuel Gauge: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10838
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10839
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10840
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10841
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10842
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10843
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10844
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10845
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10846
Fuel Gauge: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10847
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10848
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10849
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10850
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10851
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10852
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10853
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10854
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 10863
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 > Instruments Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 > Instruments Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 10868
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill
Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 >
Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 10874
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 >
Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4
& 7/8 Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 >
Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 10879
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10880
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10881
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10882
C433
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10883
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10884
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE AND RESERVOIR
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the key has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10885
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All fuel tanks
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10886
1. Remove the fuel tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the nuts and the fuel pump module cover.
All fuel tanks
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect coupling, the fuel tank
pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump
module quick connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
4. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
5. CAUTION:
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Depowering and Repowering
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEPOWERING AND REPOWERING
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Depowering Procedure
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module.Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON. This is normal operation and does not indicate a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
1. Turn all vehicle accessories OFF. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart power
distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and the
restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition switch to OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors (if equipped) are located in the first row doors, behind the door
trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped). Failure to
follow these instructions may increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable (14301) and wait at least one minute.
Repowering Procedure
1. Make sure that all supplemental restraint system (SRS) components are connected. 2. Turn the
ignition switch from OFF to ON. 3. Install restraints control module (RCM) fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and close the cover.
4. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in front
of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.Failure to follow these instructions may increase the risk of
personal injury or death in a crash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10892
Connect the battery ground cable.
5. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off.If an air bag SRS fault
is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position. This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps. If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10893
Air Bag(s) Arming and Disarming: Service and Repair Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
Deactivation and Reactivation
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS) DEACTIVATION AND REACTIVATION
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Deactivation
WARNING:
- Always wear safety glasses when repairing an air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS)
vehicle and when handling an air bag module.This will reduce the risk of injury in the event of an
accidental deployment.
- Carry a live air bag module with the air bag and trim cover pointed away from your body.This will
reduce the risk of injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- Do not set a live air bag module down with the trim cover face down.This will reduce the risk of
injury in the event of an accidental deployment.
- After deployment, the air bag surface can contain deposits of sodium hydroxide, a product of the
gas generant combustion that is irritating to the skin.Wash your hands with soap and water
afterwards.
- Never probe the connectors on the air bag module. Doing so can result in air bag deployment,
which can result in personal injury.
- Never probe the connectors on the safety canopy module.Doing so can result in safety canopy
deployment, which can result in personal injury.
- The safety belt pretensioner is a pyrotechnic device.Always wear safety glasses when repairing
an air bag equipped vehicle and when handling a safety belt buckle pretensioner or safety belt
retractor pretensioner.Never probe a pretensioner electrical connector.Doing so could result in
pretensioner or air bag deployment and could result in personal injury.
- To reduce the risk of personal injury, do not use any memory saver devices.
NOTE:
- The air bag warning lamp illuminates when the restraints control module (RCM) fuse is removed
and the ignition switch is ON.This is normal operation and does not indicate a SRS fault.
- The SRS must be fully operational and free of faults before releasing the vehicle to the customer.
All vehicles 1. Turn all vehicle accessories off. 2. Turn the ignition switch to OFF. 3. At the smart
power distribution junction box (SPDJB), located in the RH lower kick panel, remove the cover and
the restraints control module
(RCM) fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB.
4. Turn the ignition ON and visually monitor the air bag warning indicator for at least 30
seconds.The air bag warning indicator will remain lit
continuously (no flashing) if the correct RCM fuse has been removed.If the air bag warning
indicator does not remain lit continuously, remove the correct RCM fuse before proceeding.
5. Turn the ignition OFF.
6. WARNING: To avoid accidental deployment and possible personal injury, the backup power
supply must be depleted before repairing
or replacing any front or side air bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) components and before
servicing, replacing, adjusting or striking components near the front or side air bag sensors, such
as doors, instrument panel, console, door latches, strikers, seats and hood latches.
The front impact severity sensor is located on the bottom of the radiator support bracket.
The front door side impact sensors are located in the first row doors, behind the door trim panel.
The C-pillar side impact sensors (if equipped) are located on the C-pillar.
To deplete the backup power supply energy, disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least
one minute. Be sure to disconnect
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10894
auxiliary batteries and power supplies (if equipped).Failure to follow these instructions may
increase the risk of personal injury or death in a crash.
Disconnect the battery ground cable and wait at least one minute.
7. Make sure the road wheels are in the straight-ahead position. 8. Center the tilt steering column.
9. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is 90 degrees to the left (at the 9 o'clock
position).
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
10. Remove the lower steering column opening cover.
- Remove the 3 screws and pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
11. Remove the screw and steering column manual tilt lever.
All vehicles 12. Remove the 3 steering column lower shroud screws. 13. Release the clips and
remove the steering column upper shroud. 14. Remove the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, disconnect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10895
15. CAUTION: Make sure each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are disengaged from each
of the 3 steering wheel hooks before
removing the driver air bag module from the steering wheel.Failure to do so will damage the driver
air bag module and steering wheel.
NOTE: Steering wheel is removed for clarity.The rear of the steering wheel is shown.
- Use a mirror to look at the rear of the steering wheel to locate where the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips attach to the steering wheel hooks.
- Note the position of the 2 driver air bag module locator pins to the steering wheel for installation.
Using a screwdriver or a suitable tool, release each of the 3 driver air bag module wire clips from
the steering wheel hooks. Access the 3 driver air bag module wire clips through the back of the steering wheel cover and
push the wire clips toward the center of the steering wheel to release.
16. Disconnect the 2 driver air bag module electrical connectors, then disconnect the horn switch
electrical connector and remove the driver air bag
module.
17. Turn the steering wheel so the top of the wheel is back in the straight ahead position (the 12
o'clock position). 18. Open and lower the glove compartment door.
- If equipped, disconnect the glove compartment door dampener.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10896
19. Disconnect the passenger air bag module electrical connector.
20. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the passenger seat.The passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector is located toward the
seat outboard position.
Remove the passenger front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the passenger seat side air
bag module electrical connector.
21. Release the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
22. Remove the bolt and the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10897
23. Remove the cover and the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut.
24. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the passenger side C-pillar trim panel.
25. Disconnect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
26. Release the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10898
27. Remove the bolt and the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring.
28. Remove the cover and the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut.
29. Release the rear door weatherstrip and remove the driver side C-pillar trim panel.
30. Disconnect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10899
31. NOTE: There are 2 similar connectors under the driver seat.The driver seat side air bag module
electrical connector is located toward the seat
outboard position.
Remove the driver front seat cushion panel shield and disconnect the driver seat side air bag
module electrical connector.
32. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the SPDJB. 33. Connect the battery ground cable.
Reactivation
All vehicles 1. Remove the RCM fuse 32 (10A) from the SPDJB. 2. Disconnect the battery ground
cable and wait at least one minute.
3. Connect the driver seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the driver front seat
cushion panel shield.
4. Connect the driver side safety canopy module electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10900
5. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
6. Install the driver side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
7. Install the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
8. Attach the driver side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10901
9. Connect the passenger side safety canopy module electrical connector.
10. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel and attach the rear door weatherstrip.
11. Install the passenger side C-pillar trim panel nut and cover.
12. Install the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring and bolt.
- Tighten to 40 Nm (30 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10902
13. Attach the passenger side second row safety belt retractor D-ring cover.
- Verify the safety belt retractor operates without excessive effort or binding.
14. Connect the passenger seat side air bag module electrical connector and install the passenger
front seat cushion panel shield.
15. Connect the passenger air bag module electrical connector. 16. Close the glove compartment
door.
- If equipped, connect the glove compartment door dampener.
17. CAUTION: The clockspring electrical connectors are unique and cannot be reversed when
connected to the driver air bag
module.Match the electrical connector key to the keyway in the driver air bag module.Do not force
the electrical connectors into the driver air bag module.
Connect the horn switch electrical connector, then connect the 2 driver air bag module electrical
connectors.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10903
18. Position the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, lining up the locator pins.
19. NOTE:
- Make sure that all 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged and seated correctly to the
steering wheel.
- Audible clicks will be heard when the 3 driver air bag module wire clips are fully engaged.
Firmly press the driver air bag module to the steering wheel, seating the 3 driver air bag module
wire clips to the steering wheel hooks. -
Check the driver air bag module trim cover to the steering wheel for an even gap clearance and
correct movement.
20. Install the steering column lower shroud.
- If equipped, connect the power tilt steering column switch located on the lower shroud.
21. Install the steering column upper shroud. 22. Install the 3 steering column lower shroud screws.
Vehicles with manual tilt wheel
23. Install the steering column manual tilt lever and screw.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
24. Install the lower steering column opening cover and the 3 screws.
All vehicles 25. Turn the ignition switch from OFF to ON. 26. Install the RCM fuse 32 (10A) to the
SPDJB and install the cover.
27. WARNING: Be sure that nobody is in the vehicle and that there is nothing blocking or set in
front of any air bag module when the
battery ground cable is connected.
Connect the battery ground cable.
28. Prove out the SRS as follows:
Turn the ignition key from ON to OFF. Wait 10 seconds, then turn the key back to ON and visually
monitor the air bag warning indicator with the air bag modules installed.The air bag warning
indicator will light continuously for approximately 6 seconds and then turn off. If an air bag SRS
fault is present, the air bag warning indicator will either: fail to light.
- remain lit continuously.
- flash.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier > Air Bag(s)
Arming and Disarming > System Information > Service and Repair > Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Depowering
and Repowering > Page 10904
The air bag warning indicator may not illuminate until approximately 30 seconds after the ignition
switch has been turned from the OFF to the ON position.This is the time required for the RCM to
complete the testing of the SRS.If the air bag warning indicator is inoperative and an SRS fault
exists, a chime will sound in a pattern of 5 sets of 5 beeps.If this occurs, the air bag warning
indicator will need to be repaired before diagnosis can continue.
Clear all continuous memory DTCs from the restraints control module using a scan tool.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Tire Pressure Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPMS Indicator and Message Center Messages
The TPMS indicator and vehicle message center (if equipped) sometimes displays faults that
cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these messages as TPMS faults that must be serviced.
TPMS Indicator Illuminates Continuously
NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPMS functionality before carrying out any diagnosis.
1. The TPMS indicator remains on continuously for the following condition:
^ Low Tire Pressure - The TPMS indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low.
When this condition exists, the tire pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold pressure
as indicated on the vehicle certification label.
2. NOTE: The TPMS sensors do not transmit when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle has been
stationary for more than 30 minutes, it will be
necessary to wake up the sensors so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information to the
SJB.
If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, carry out the following procedure to
wake up the TPMS sensors. 1
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2 Adjust the air pressure in the LF tire (as necessary).
3 Activate the LF TPMS sensor, at least 2 times, using the tire pressure monitor activation tool.
4 Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5 If the TPMS indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and activating each sensor, GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
TPMS Indicator Flashes
The TPMS indicator flashes for 70 seconds, then remains ON solid when the ignition switch is
turned to the ON position, for the following conditions: 1. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped,
the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
2. No communication with the SJB (TPMS is integral to the SJB) - The TPMS indicator is
illuminated when the instrument cluster has received no
signals from the SJB for more than 5 seconds. If equipped, the message center displays TIRE
PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and
Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
3. Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT when the tire pressure
monitoring system is malfunctioning or communication with the instrument cluster has been lost.
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Tire Monitoring System/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Maintenance Required Lamp/Indicator: Service and Repair
This vehicle is not equipped with a maintenance required lamp/indicator.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP (MIL)
CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE SOON, Or ISO Standard Engine Symbol
The MIL notifies the driver that the powertrain control module (PCM) has detected an on board
diagnostic (OBD) emission-related component or system concern. When this occurs, an OBD
diagnostic trouble code (DTC) sets.
- The MIL is located in the instrument cluster and is labeled CHECK ENGINE, SERVICE ENGINE
SOON or the international standards organization (ISO) standard engine symbol.
- The MIL is illuminated during the instrument cluster prove out for approximately 4 seconds.
- The MIL remains illuminated after instrument cluster prove out if: an emission-related concern and DTC exists.
- the PCM does not send a control message to the instrument cluster (applications with the MIL
controlled through the communication link).
- the PCM is operating in the hardware limited operation strategy (HLOS).
- The MIL remains off during the instrument cluster prove out if an indicator or instrument cluster
concern is present.
- To turn off the MIL after a repair, a reset command from the scan tool must be sent, or 3
consecutive drive cycles must be completed without a concern.
- For all MIL concerns, go to Symptom Charts. See: Powertrain Management/Computers and
Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
- If the MIL flashes at a steady rate, a severe misfire condition may exist.
- If the MIL flashes erratically, the PCM can reset while cranking if the battery voltage is low.
- The MIL flashes after a period of time with the key in the RUN position (engine not running) if
DTC P1000 is set.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Change Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Oil Change Reminder Lamp: Service and Repair
CHANGE OIL SOON/OIL CHANGE REQUIRED
Displayed when the engine oil life remaining is 5 percent or less. When oil life left is between 5%
and 0%, the CHANGE OIL SOON message will be displayed. When oil life left reaches 0%, the OIL
CHANGE REQUIRED message will be displayed.
An oil change is required whenever indicated by the message center and according to the
recommended maintenance schedule. USE ONLY RECOMMENDED ENGINE OILS.
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change [approximately 5,000 miles (8,000
km) or 180 days] perform the following:
1. Press and release the SETUP control to display "OIL LIFE=XXX% HOLD RESET=NEW ".
2. Press and hold the RESET control for 2 seconds and release. Oil life is set to 100% and "OIL
LIFE SET TO 100%" is displayed. 3. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Reset - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE: All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
instrument cluster (IC).
NOTE: The oil life calculation is set at a maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) or 180
days.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately 2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press and release the reset button to exit the
procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Message Center Cluster
NOTE: The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by10% increments down to 10%.
NOTE: The XX's in the message center displays below represent a numeric value. For example,
the message center may display OIL LIFE = 80%.
1. Press and release the SETUP button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX%
HOLD RESET NEW. 2.
Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the message center displays
OIL LIFE SET TO 100%.
3. NOTE: The oil life start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 100% increments then the
value starts again at 100%.
Press the RESET button once for each 10% reduction below the default 100% until the message
center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%.
4. Press and release the SETUP button to exit the procedure.
Oil Life Start Value - Base Instrument Cluster (IC)
NOTE:All message center functions are carried out using the single stem reset button in the
instrument cluster (IC).
NOTE:The oil life start value is used to increase or decrease the starting point of the oil life. The
value can be changed back to the maximum of approximately 8,000 km (5,000 miles) if the value
was previously changed or lowered by 10% increments down to 10%.
1. Press and release the reset button to scroll through the information displays until the message
center displays HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU. 2. Press and hold the reset button for
approximately2 seconds until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK.
3. Press and release the reset button until the message center displays OIL LIFE = XXX% HOLD
RESET = NEW. 4. Press and hold the RESET button for 2 seconds and release when the
message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO 100%. 5. Press the RESET button to lower 10% from
the default 100% until the message center displays OIL LIFE SET TO XX%. 6. NOTE:The oil life
start value can be lowered from 100% to 10% in 10% increments then the value starts again at
100%. Repeat steps 2-5 for each
desired 10% reduction.
7. Press and release the reset button to exit the procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-5 (Engine, Front)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10920
C103
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 10921
Oil Pressure Sender: Service and Repair
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) Switch
Removal and Installation
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. For additional information, refer to
Maintenance/Service and Repair. 2. Disconnect the engine oil pressure (EOP) switch electrical
connector.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
3. Remove the EOP switch.
^ To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 ft. lbs.)
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams
C4015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Assist Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 10925
Parking Assist Warning Indicator: Service and Repair
PARKING AID SPEAKER
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the LH quarter trim panel. 2. Remove the bolt and the speaker and bracket assembly.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (LH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 10929
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Seat Belt Reminder Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Seat Belt Reminder Lamp: Description and Operation
Warning System - Driver Safety Belt
The driver safety belt incorporates a safety belt warning indicator switch, warning indicator and
chime. The warning indicator and chime are reminders to fasten the safety belt. If the driver safety belt is not buckled before the ignition key is turned to ON, the safety belt warning
light illuminates for 1 to 2 minutes and the warning chime sounds for 4 to 8 seconds.
- If the driver side safety belt is buckled while the indicator light is illuminated and the warning
chime is sounding, the safety belt warning light and warning chime turn OFF.
- If the safety belt is buckled before the key is turned to the ON position, the warning indicator will
come on for 4 to 8 seconds with no chime.
Belt Minder
Feature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt warning function. This feature provides
additional reminders to the driver that the driver's safety belt is unbuckled by intermittently
sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster.
To activate or deactivate the Belt Minder feature, refer to Seat Belt Systems or the owner's
literature.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel
dimmer switch. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch > Page 10938
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair > Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch > Page 10939
Vehicles with power tilt
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
View 151-39 (LH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 10944
View 151-40 (RH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 10945
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 10946
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 10949
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 10950
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 10951
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: >
09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: >
09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 10960
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: >
08-19-1 > Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: >
08-19-1 > Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 10965
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge
Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill
Capacity
TSB 09-11-7
06/15/09
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB), LOWER THAN EXPECTED FUEL FILL CAPACITY - BUILT
BEFORE 4/10/2009
FORD: 2007-2009 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2009 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2009 Expedition and Navigator long wheel base (LWB) vehicles built before
4/10/2009, may encounter the amount of fuel needed to fill the fuel tank may be lower than
expected. This may be encountered when the distance to empty (DIE) states 50 miles or lower to
empty, or the fuel gauge reads lower than 1/8 tank of fuel prior to refueling.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
Ask the customer the following questions.
1. Does the customer refill the fuel tank with the engine off?
a. No - Retest the vehicle with engine off before proceeding, if concern does not occur, this
procedure does not apply.
b. Yes - Go to Step 2.
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
2. Does the customer refill the fuel tank until 1 to 3 gas pump automatic shutoffs?
a. Yes - Go to Step 3.
b. No - Retest the vehicle using the gasoline pump automatic shutoff function before proceeding, if
concern does not occur, this procedure does not
apply.
3. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) using the Workshop Manual, Section 310-01 with
certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near the
gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
091107A 2007-2009 Expedition, 1.8 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace The Fuel Delivery Module (Do
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge
Sender: > 09-11-7 > Jun > 09 > Fuel System - Lower Than Expected Fuel Fill Capacity > Page 10971
Not Use With 9002A, 9002A6)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge
Sender: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4
& 7/8 Full
TSB 08-19-1
09/29/08
LONG WHEEL BASE (LWB) - FUEL GAUGE READS BETWEEN 3/4 AND 7/8 WHEN FULL
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator LWB vehicles may exhibit a refueling issue
where the customer states they refuel the fuel tank and the gauge reads between 3/4 and 7/8 full.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Question the customer - yes/no.
a. Refueling event more than a 5 gallon fill?
b. Customer refilled with the engine off?
c. Customer refilled to 1 to 3 auto-shutoffs?
NOTE
SOME CREDIT CARDS HAVE PRESET LIMITS ON THE DOLLAR AMOUNT AVAILABLE FUEL
TRANSACTION. THE PUMP WILL SHUT OFF AT THIS LIMIT. THIS LIMIT MAY BE IN THE
RANGE OF $50 TO $75.
If the answer is No to any question, this procedure does not apply. This is the normal system
function. The system may not recognize less than a 5 gallon fill or filling up with the engine on and
it will be slow to update the gage to the correct fill level. Also, the first auto-shutoff is designed to
read full.
2. Follow Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 413-0 Pinpoint Test A: Instrument Cluster, Message
Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster is capable of reading the 4 fuel levels,
using IDS active commands.
a. If not okay, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 3.
3. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01:
Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning Chimes to determine if the cluster can read 4
fuel levels using the gage tester.
a. If not, refer to WSM recommendations.
b. If okay, go to Step 4.
4. If the vehicle was built prior to 7/1/2008, remove and inspect the fuel pump. Verify sender float
rod clearance to convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. Is the
clearance more than 3/16" (5 mm) between the fuel soaked hose and the rod?
a. If clearance is equal to or greater than specified, go to Step 6.
b. If clearance is less than specified, go to Step 5.
5. Follow Pinpoint Test A Section 413-01: Instrument Cluster, Message Center, and Warning
Chimes to determine if the sender card meets the 10 to 180 ohms specification?
a. If within specification, follow WSM recommendation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge
Sender: > 08-19-1 > Sep > 08 > Instruments - Fuel Gauge Reads Between 3/4 & 7/8 Full > Page 10976
b. If not within specification, go to Step 6.
6. Replace the fuel delivery module (FDM) with certified stock. Check for a blue pen marking near
the gray fuel supply port on the sender flange.
a. If blue pen mark is present, use the FDM as the replacement.
b. If blue pen mark is not present on the FDM flange, please verify the sender float rod clearance to
convolute fuel supply hose by sweeping the float to the full position. If the clearance between the
float rod and the convolute fuel supply hose is less than 13/16" (20 mm) on a dry hose, do not use.
Order a new FDM and repeat inspection for blue markings and/or clearance before replacing.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
MT081901 Use SLIS Operations If Actual
Available; Claim Additional Time
Diagnosis Or Labor Performed As Actual Time.
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
9H307 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10977
Fuel Gauge Sender: Locations
View 151-31 (Rear End - Expedition And Navigator)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10978
View 151-32 (Rear End - Expedition EL And Navigator L)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10979
C433
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10980
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE
Typical Electronic Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10981
Typical Mechanical Returnless Fuel Pump (FP) Module
The FP module is a device that contains the fuel pump and sender assembly. The fuel pump is
located inside the FP module reservoir and supplies fuel through the FP module manifold to the
engine and FP module jet pump. The jet pump continuously refills the reservoir with fuel, and a
check valve located in the manifold outlet maintains system pressure when the fuel pump is not
energized. A flapper valve located in the bottom of the reservoir allows fuel to enter the reservoir
and prime the fuel pump during the initial fill.
FUEL PUMP (FP) MODULE AND RESERVOIR
The FP module is mounted inside the fuel tank in a reservoir. The pump has a discharge check
valve that maintains the system pressure after the key has been turned off to minimize starting
concerns. The reservoir prevents fuel flow interruptions during extreme vehicle maneuvers with low
tank fill levels.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10982
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
FUEL PUMP MODULE
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Do not smoke, carry lighted tobacco or open flame of any type when working on or
near any fuel-related component. Highly flammable mixtures are always present and can be
ignited. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
All fuel tanks
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 10983
1. Remove the fuel tank.
127L (33.5 gal) fuel tank
2. Remove the nuts and the fuel pump module cover.
All fuel tanks
3. Disconnect the return fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect coupling, the fuel tank
pressure sensor and vapor tube assembly-to-fuel pump
module quick connect coupling and the supply fuel tube-to-fuel pump module quick connect
coupling.
4. Using the special tool, remove the fuel pump lock ring.
5. CAUTION:
- Note the location of the fuel pump alignment tabs.
- Carefully remove the fuel pump assembly to avoid damaging the fuel level sensor.
Remove the fuel pump module assembly. Remove and discard the O-ring seal.
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-21 (LH A-Pillar - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 10987
C2015
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Speedometer Head: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Speedometer Head: Customer Interest Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Speedometer Head: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 > Instruments Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 10996
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Speedometer Head: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 >
Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop
Speedometer Head: All Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero
At A Stop
TSB 10-4-2
03/15/10
SPEEDOMETER - NOT RETURNING TO ZERO WHILE IN PARK AND ENGINE RUNNING
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition vehicles may exhibit symptoms of speedometer fluctuation
while the engine is running and transmission is in park position.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Install Integrated Diagnostic System (IDS)/Portable Diagnostic Software (PDS) or equivalent and
start a session, identify (ID) vehicle.
2. Update the powertrain control module (PCM)/transmission control module (TCM) calibration
using IDS release 65.06 and higher. This new
calibration is not included in the VCM 2010.1 DVD. Calibration files may also be obtained at the
website.
NOTE
THE TCM CANNOT BE INDEPENDENTLY REPROGRAMMED, REPROGRAM USING THE PMI
FUNCTION TO ENSURE THAT ENGINE AND TRANSMISSION CALIBRATIONS ARE UPDATED
TO THE LATEST LEVEL SIMULTANEOUSLY.
3. Verify that the 1CM Calibration shows 8L1P-7J104-AD (8L1P-7J104-BD for later production
2008 model year) part number after reprogramming is
complete.
a. Select the following from the IDS tool:
(1) Toolbox.
(2) Powertrain.
(3) 0DB Test Modes.
(4) Mode Level 9 Vehicle Information.
(5) TCM Cal Part Number.
NOTE
IT IS CRITICAL THAT TCM KEEP ALIVE MEMORY (KAM) BE CLEARED FOR PROCEDURE TO
BE FULLY EFFECTIVE
4. Clear TCM KAM and adaptive tables.
a. Using IDS:
(1) Open Toolbox.
(2) Choose Powertrain.
(3) Choose Reset KAM.
(4) Choose TCM.
b. Using PDS:
(1) Choose all Tests and Calibrations.
(2) Scroll down the menu and choose reset TCM KAM
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Speedometer Head: > 10-4-2 > Mar > 10 >
Instruments - Speedo. Doesn't Return To Zero At A Stop > Page 11002
NOTE
FOR PDS, RESET 1CM KAM IS NOT THE SAME AS CLEAR TRANSMISSION ADAPTIVE
TABLES, WHICH IS UNDER THE POWERTRAIN - TRANSMISSION MENU TREE.
NOTE
DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY WILL NOT CLEAR THE TCM KAM. IT IS CRITICAL THAT
TCM KAM BE CLEARED PRIOR TO RELEARNING THE ADAPTIVE TABLES FOR THE
TRANSMISSION.
NOTE
DO NOT CLEAR THE PCM KAM.
5. Verify the transmission fluid temperature (TFT) PID is above 175 °F (80 °C). If it is not at 175 °F
(80 °C), drive unit approximately 3 miles (5 Km)
to reach temperature.
NOTE
TFT MUST BE AT 175 °F (80 °C) OR ABOVE BEFORE PROCEEDING TO STEP 5.
NOTE
PERFORM ADAPTIVE SHIFT STRATEGY LEARN ON LEVEL SURFACE ROAD.
6. Drive unit to perform adaptive shift strategy learn.
a. Accelerate from a stopped position with light throttle to 15 MPH (24 Km/h) and remove foot from
accelerator pedal.
b. Brake very gently to a complete stop (allow at least six (6) seconds).
c. Repeat steps (a-b) five (5) times in the dealership parking lot or similar setting.
d. Accelerate from rest with light throttle ensuring that the 1-2, 2-3 and 3-4 shifts occur at engine
speeds between 1700-2000 RPM.
e. Continue to accelerate until you achieve 50 MPH (80 Km/h) or the 5-6 upshift.
f. Brake gently to a complete stop and hold foot on brake for ten (10) seconds.
g. Repeat steps (d-f) three (3) times.
NOTE
SEVERAL DAYS OF DRIVING ARE REQUIRED FOR THE TRANSMISSION TO FULLY ADAPT.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
100402A 2007-2008 Expedition: 1.0 Hr.
Reprogram The PCM And TCM Includes Time To Clear TCM KAM And Perform Road Tests (Do
Not Use With Any Other Labor Operations)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
RECAL 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Low Tire Pressure
Indicator > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Low Tire Pressure Indicator: Testing and Inspection
TPMS Indicator and Message Center Messages
The TPMS indicator and vehicle message center (if equipped) sometimes displays faults that
cannot be resolved by the customer. Treat these messages as TPMS faults that must be serviced.
TPMS Indicator Illuminates Continuously
NOTE: If the spare tire is in use, the damaged road tire must be repaired and installed on the
vehicle to restore complete TPMS functionality before carrying out any diagnosis.
1. The TPMS indicator remains on continuously for the following condition:
^ Low Tire Pressure - The TPMS indicator is illuminated solid and the message center displays
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped). This is displayed when any of the tire pressures are low.
When this condition exists, the tire pressure must be adjusted to the recommended cold pressure
as indicated on the vehicle certification label.
2. NOTE: The TPMS sensors do not transmit when the vehicle is stationary. If the vehicle has been
stationary for more than 30 minutes, it will be
necessary to wake up the sensors so they will transmit the latest tire pressure information to the
SJB.
If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, carry out the following procedure to
wake up the TPMS sensors. 1
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.
2 Adjust the air pressure in the LF tire (as necessary).
3 Activate the LF TPMS sensor, at least 2 times, using the tire pressure monitor activation tool.
4 Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for the remaining tires.
5 If the TPMS indicator remains illuminated after adjusting and activating each sensor, GO to
Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
TPMS Indicator Flashes
The TPMS indicator flashes for 70 seconds, then remains ON solid when the ignition switch is
turned to the ON position, for the following conditions: 1. Tire Pressure Sensor Fault - If equipped,
the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT when a tire pressure sensor is
malfunctioning. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures
2. No communication with the SJB (TPMS is integral to the SJB) - The TPMS indicator is
illuminated when the instrument cluster has received no
signals from the SJB for more than 5 seconds. If equipped, the message center displays TIRE
PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
3. Tire Pressure Monitor Fault - If equipped, the message center will display TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR FAULT when the tire pressure
monitoring system is malfunctioning or communication with the instrument cluster has been lost.
GO to Symptom Chart. See: Testing and Inspection/Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor Training
Special Tool(s)
NOTE: If the vehicle has been stationary for more than 30 minutes, the sensors will go into a "sleep
mode" to conserve battery power. It will be necessary to wake them up so they will transmit the
latest tire pressure information to the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
NOTE: The tire pressure sensor training procedure must be done on a single vehicle, in an area
without radio frequency noise and at least 1 m (3 ft) away from other vehicles equipped with a Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).
Radio frequency noise is generated by electrical motors and appliance operation, cellular
telephones, remote transmitters, power inverters and portable entertainment equipment.
NOTE: If a sensor does not respond to the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool, attempt to
activate the same sensor with the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. If the sensor still does not
respond, move the vehicle to rotate the wheels at least one-fourth of a turn and attempt to activate
the same sensor again.
NOTE: The SJB has a 2-minute time limit between sensor responses. If the SJB does not
recognize any 1 of the 4 tire pressure sensors during this time limit, the horn will sound twice and
the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE NOT TRAINED REPEAT and the entire
procedure must be repeated.
NOTE: For vehicles with different front and rear tire pressures (such as the E-Series and certain
F-Series), the tire pressure sensors must be trained following a tire rotation. Failure to train the
sensors will cause the TPMS indicator to illuminate. For vehicles with the same tire pressure for
front and rear tires, tire rotation will not affect the system.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, then press and release the brake pedal. 2. Cycle the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position. 3.
Press and release the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF position. 5. Turn the
ignition switch from the OFF position to the RUN position 3 times, ending in the RUN position.
- The horn will sound once and the TPMS indicator will flash if the training mode has been entered
successfully. If equipped, the message center will display TRAIN LF TIRE.
NOTE: It may take up to 6 seconds to activate a tire pressure sensor. During this time, the Tire
Pressure Monitor Activation Tool must remain in place 180 degrees from the valve stem.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11010
6. Place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the LF tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees)
from the valve stem. Press and release the test
button on the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool. The horn will sound briefly to indicate that the
tire pressure sensor has been recognized by the SJB.
7. Within 2 minutes of the horn sounding, place the Tire Pressure Monitor Activation Tool on the RF
tire sidewall opposite (180 degrees) from the
valve stem and press and release the test button to train the RF tire pressure sensor.
NOTE: Do not wait more than 2 minutes between training each sensor or the SJB will time out and
the entire procedure must be repeated.
8. Repeat Step 7 for the RR and LR tires.
The procedure is completed after the last tire has been trained. When the training procedure is
complete, the message center (if equipped) will display TIRE TRAINING COMPLETE. For vehicles
not equipped with a message center, successful completion of the training procedure will be
verified by turning the ignition switch to the OFF position without the horn sounding. If the horn
sounds twice when the switch is turned to the OFF position, the training procedure was not
successful.
9. Using the scan tool, locate the updated TPMS sensor identifiers trained to the SJB and
document them on the applicable warranty claim.
NOTE: This step is required to clear DTC C2780, cause the SJB to exit the manufacturing mode
and to make sure there are no other concerns with a newly programmed SJB.
10. If the sensors are being trained due to the installation of a new SJB, clear any DTCs and carry
out the SJB On-Demand Self Test.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor can be removed and installed without removing the strap or the cradle.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Dismount the tire only as
instructed.
Remove the tire from the wheel.
2. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor locking clip can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the sensor locking clip.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 11013
3. CAUTION: Do not use a large screwdriver. Apply minimum force during removal or damage to
the sensor can occur.
Using a pocket screwdriver or similar tool, detach the sensor from the cradle.
4. Remove the sensor.
Assembly
1. CAUTION: Damage to the sensor can occur if excessive force is applied during sensor
installation.
NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the cradle. The sensor will make a "click" noise
when correctly seated.
Position the sensor into the cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end of the
cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. NOTE: The locking clip can only be fully seated when installed in the correct orientation. If the
sensor locking clip cannot be fully inserted, then
the sensor may not be fully seated on the cradle or the locking clip may be inserted backward.
Insert a new locking clip into the sensor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 11014
3. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
4. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 11015
Tire Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and
Cradle
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Strap and Cradle
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 11016
Disassembly
CAUTION: Tire pressure sensors are manufactured in multiple colors based on their application.
When installing a new sensor, make sure the color of the sensor being installed matches the color
of the sensor that was removed. The different colored sensors are not interchangeable.
NOTE: The sensor is available separately, the cradle and strap are available as a strap kit. There
are several different strap kits available based on wheel diameter but all strap kits share the same
base part number.
NOTE: Tire pressure sensors are equipped with Lithium-ion batteries and must be disposed of
accordingly.
1. Remove the tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.
2. WARNING: The TPMS band is under tension. Always use safety goggles or a face shield and
gloves when removing the TPMS
band/strap. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
Remove a factory installed strap in the following sequence: 1
Locate the strap buckle and secure the strap to the wheel using duct tape or a similar item, on both
sides of the buckle approximately 25 mm (0.98 in) from the buckle.
2 Using a large screwdriver and a twisting motion, unbuckle the strap.
3 Discard the strap.
3. To remove a dealer installed strap, turn the worm gear screw until the strap is fully released from
the worm gear.
^ Discard the strap.
4. NOTE: To aid assembly, mark the location of the cradle prior to disassembly.
Using a screwdriver, or similar tool, remove the cradle by inserting the screwdriver under the cradle
and prying up.
Assembly
1. NOTE: Make sure the sensor is fully seated into the new cradle. The sensor will make a "click"
noise when fully seated.
Position the sensor into the new cradle by inserting the hinge end of the sensor into the hook end
of the cradle and pushing the opposite end of the sensor down onto the cradle.
2. CAUTION: Metal scrapers can damage the wheel. Use only plastic or non-metallic scrapers to
remove the cradle adhesive strip residue.
NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be installed in the drop well of the wheel, 180 degrees from the
valve stem.
Clean the area where the sensor and cradle are to be installed.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 11017
3. NOTE: The sensor and cradle must be positioned with the hinge side of the sensor on the RH
side when viewed from the curb side (beauty side)
of the wheel.
NOTE: The sensor has raised markings indicating how to position the sensor.
Remove the adhesive tape liner from the cradle and position the sensor and cradle into the wheel
drop well 180 degrees from the valve stem.
4. Install the tapered end of the strap through the opening of the cradle on the hinge side of the
sensor. This will position the worm gear on the
locking clip side of the sensor.
5. CAUTION: Steel wheels have a "high spot" along their circumference. Make sure the strap is
positioned in the lowest spot possible for
correct sensor and cradle retention.
NOTE: Keep the strap parallel with the wheel flange while tightening the worm gear.
Position the worm gear 13-26 mm (0.5-1.0 in) away from the sensor and tighten the worm gear. ^
Tighten to 3 Nm (27 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Tire Monitoring System > Tire Pressure
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Sensor > Page 11018
6. CAUTION: The sensor, cradle and strap can be damaged by incorrect tire mounting or
dismounting. Mount the tire only as instructed.
Install the tire onto the wheel.
7. NOTE: A new tire pressure sensor is shipped in an off mode (or battery saver mode) and must
be turned on before it can be trained. To turn the
sensor on, install it on a wheel, mount the tire and inflate the tire to the recommended inflation
pressure. Wait at least 2 minutes, then continue with the sensor training procedure.
Train the tire pressure sensor(s).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Transmission Mode Indicator - A/T: Description and Operation
TRANSMISSION CONTROL INDICATOR LAMP (TCIL)
The TCIL is an output signal from the PCM that controls the lamp on/off function depending on the
engagement or disengagement of overdrive.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
LIGHT SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Using a suitable tool, remove the light sensor from the instrument panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 11030
Backup Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 11031
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Page 11032
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Brake Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11037
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11038
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11039
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11040
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11041
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11042
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11043
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11044
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11045
Brake Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11046
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11047
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11048
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11049
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11050
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11051
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11052
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11053
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11054
Brake Lamp: Connector Views
C4032
C4035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11055
C4112
C4113
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11056
C4114
C4115
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11057
Brake Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
90-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11058
90-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11059
90-3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11060
90-4
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Brake Lamp: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern.
Visual Inspection Chart
2. Visually inspect for obvious signs of mechanical or electrical damage. 3. If an obvious cause for
an observed or reported concern is found, correct the cause (if possible) before proceeding to the
next step.
NOTE: Make sure the headlamp switch is in the OFF position.
- Make sure the multifunction switch is in the LOW BEAM position.
4. NOTE: Make sure to use the latest scan tool software release.
If the cause is not visually evident, connect the scan tool to the data link connector (DLC).
5. NOTE: The vehicle communication module (VCM) LED prove-out confirms power and ground
from the DLC are provided to the VCM.
If the scan tool does not communicate with the VCM: Check the VCM connection to the vehicle.
- Check the scan tool connection to the VCM.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network), No Power To The Scan Tool, to
diagnose no communication with the scan tool.
6. If the scan tool does not communicate with the vehicle:
- Verify the ignition key is in the ON position.
- Verify the scan tool operation with a known good vehicle.
- Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network) to diagnose no response from the
powertrain control module (PCM).
7. Carry out the network test.
- If the scan tool responds with no communication for one or more modules, refer to Information
Bus (Module Communications Network).
- If the network test passes, retrieve and record the continuous memory DTCs.
8. Clear the continuous DTCs and carry out the self-test diagnostics for the SJB. 9. If the DTCs
retrieved are related to the concern, go to the Smart Junction Box (SJB) Diagnostic Trouble Code
(DTC) Chart. For all other DTCs,
refer to Body Control Systems (Multifunction Electronic Control Module). See: Diagnostic Trouble
Code Descriptions
10. If no DTCs related to the concern are retrieved, GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom Related
Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11063
B1485-B2047
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11064
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11065
Brake Lamp: Pinpoint Tests
Test H: The Stoplamps Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST H: THE STOPLAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
H1
H1-H2
Normal Operation
The stoplamp switch is supplied voltage through circuit SBB31 (WH/RD) from the battery junction
box (BJB). When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the smart
junction box (SJB) and the high mounted stoplamp through circuit CLS17 (YE/GY).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) open
- Circuit SBB31 (WH/RD) open
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11066
- Stoplamp switch
Test I: One Or More Stoplamps Are Inoperative
PINPOINT TEST I: ONE OR MORE STOPLAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE
I1-I2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11067
I3-I7
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11068
I7-I9
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11069
I9-I10
Normal Operation
When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the smart junction box
(SJB) and the high mounted stoplamp through circuit CLS17 (YE/GY). When the SJB detects the
brake pedal applied, the SJB provides voltage to the LH and RH rear stoplamps, and the LH and
RH trailer tow turn relays through circuits CLS18 (GY/BN) and CLS19 (VT/OG), respectively.
Ground for the LH and RH rear stoplamps is provided through circuits GD149 (BK/GY) and GD151
(BK/GN), respectively. Ground for the high mounted stoplamp is provided through circuit GD150
(BK/WH).
DTC B2044 - is a continuous and on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects a short to
ground on the LH rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
DTC B2045 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects an open on the LH rear
stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
DTC B2046 - is a continuous and on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects a short to
ground on the RH rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
DTC B2047 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects an open on the RH rear
stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
Possible Causes
- Circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) open
- Circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) open or short to ground
- Circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) open or short to ground
- Circuit GD149 (BK/GY) open
- Circuit GD150 (BK/WH) open
- Circuit GD151 (BK/GN) open
- High mounted stoplamp
- Trailer tow turn relay
- SJB
Test J: The Stoplamps Are On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST J: THE STOPLAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11070
J1-J8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11071
J9-J10
When the brake pedal is applied, the stoplamp switch routes voltage to the smart junction box
(SJB) and the high mounted stoplamp, the powertrain control module (PCM), the anti-lock brake
system (ABS) module and the trailer electric brake controller through circuit CLS17 (YE/GY). When
the SJB detects the brake pedal applied, the SJB provides voltage to the LH and RH rear
stoplamps, and the LH and RH trailer tow turn relays through circuits CLS18 (GY/BN) and CLS19
(VT/OG), respectively.
DTC B1485 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects a short to voltage from the
stoplamp switch input circuit.
DTC B2045 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects a short to voltage on the LH
rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
DTC B2047 - is an on-demand DTC that sets when the SJB detects a short to voltage on the RH
rear stop/turn lamp voltage supply circuit.
Possible Causes
- Circuit CCB08 (VT/WH) short to voltage
- Circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) short to voltage
- Circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) short to voltage
- Circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) short to voltage
- Stoplamp switch
- Trailer electric brake controller
- ABS module
- PCM
- SJB
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
11072
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11076
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11077
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11078
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
STOPLAMP SWITCH
Removal
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to
depress the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 N [1-3 lb]), pull rearward on the brake pedal, rotate the
stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the stoplamp switch.
Installation
CAUTION: It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the
installation of the stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the stoplamp
switch.
1. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise. 2. Connect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Cargo Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
C926
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
C475
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Ash Tray Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
C2246
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Console Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Console Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams
C254
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Daytime Running Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11099
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11100
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11101
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11102
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11103
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11104
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11105
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11106
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11107
Daytime Running Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11108
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11109
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11110
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11111
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11112
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11113
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11114
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11115
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11116
Daytime Running Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
97-1
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
11117
Daytime Running Lamp: Description and Operation
DAYTIME RUNNING LAMPS (DRL)
NOTE: The smart junction box (SJB) must be configured when installing a new module.
The DRL system operates the low beam headlamps at a reduced intensity.
The SJB supplies pulse width modulated (PWM) voltage to illuminate the low beam headlamps at a
reduced intensity when the following conditions are met:
- The ignition switch is in the RUN position.
- The headlamps have not been turned on by the autolamp system or the headlamp switch.
- The transmission is not in PARK (P).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Inspection and Verification
Daytime Running Lamp: Testing and Inspection Inspection and Verification
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern by operating the daytime running lamps (DRL) following these
steps:
- Place the ignition switch in the RUN position.
- Place the headlamp switch in the OFF position.
- Place the transmission in any gear other than PARK (P).
- If the DRL does not operate, make sure the SJB is configured for DRL before proceeding to the
next step.
2. Carry out the continuous and on-demand self tests for the SJB.
- If any DTCs are retrieved related to the concern, refer to Body Control Systems (Multifunction
Electronic Control Module). If no DTCs are retrieved, go to the next step.
3. For Expedition, verify the low beam operation.
- Place the headlamp switch in the HEADLAMPS ON position. If the low beams do not operate correctly, refer to Lighting and Horns.
- If the low beams operate correctly and the DRL operation is incorrect, proceed to the next step.
4. For Navigator, verify the fog lamp operation.
- Place the ignition switch in the RUN position.
- Place the headlamp switch in the HEADLAMPS ON position and engage the fog lamp switch. If the fog lamps do not operate correctly, refer to Lighting and Horns.
- If the fog lamps operate correctly and the DRL operation is incorrect, proceed to the next step.
5. Check the SJB inputs.
- Monitor the ignition switch, the headlamp switch input PIDs and the transmission gear status
PIDs. If the ignition switch PIDs do not agree with the ignition switch position, refer to Ignition Switch.
- If the transmission gear status PIDs do not agree with the gear selector lever position, refer to
Transmission Control Systems.
- If the headlamp switch PIDs do not agree with the headlamp switch position, refer to Lighting and
Horns.
- If the PIDs indicate correct ignition, headlamp switch and transmission gear status, install a new
SJB. Refer to Body Control Systems (Multifunction Electronic Control Module). Test the system for
normal operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Inspection and Verification > Page 11120
Daytime Running Lamp: Testing and Inspection Principles of Operation
PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION
NOTE: When installing a new smart junction box (SJB), it must be configured for this feature, if
originally equipped. Refer to Information Bus (Module Communications Network).
The SJB controls the DRL by using various inputs to determine whether or not the DRL should be
illuminated. These inputs include:
- Ignition switch position
- Headlamp switch position
- Headlamps on or off
- Transmission gear selection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Page 11121
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch
INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMER SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the instrument cluster finish panel. 2. Press the tabs and remove the instrument panel
dimmer switch. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch > Page 11126
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair Steering Column Multifunction Switch
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Instrument Panel Dimmer Switch > Page 11127
Vehicles with power tilt
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear
View 151-39 (LH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 11132
View 151-40 (RH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 11133
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch,
Driver Side Rear > Page 11134
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left
Front
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left
Front > Page 11137
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left
Front > Page 11138
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left
Front > Page 11139
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp > Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Fog/Driving Lamp Bulb: Service and Repair
FOG LAMP BULB
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The fog lamp bulb contains gas under pressure. The bulb may shatter if the glass
envelope is scratched or if the bulb is dropped. Handle the bulb only by its base. Avoid touching the
glass envelope. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
NOTE:
- The fog lamp bulb should not be removed from the fog lamp until just before a new bulb is
installed. Removing the bulb for an extended period of time may affect headlamp bulb
performance. Contaminants may enter the headlamp where they can settle on the lens and
reflector. Never turn on the fog lamp with the bulb removed from the fog lamp.
- Make sure the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
1. With the vehicle in NEUTRAL, position it on a hoist. 2. Disconnect the electrical connector and
remove the fog lamp bulb. 3. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Application and ID
Hazard Warning Flasher: Application and ID
The flasher function for this vehicle is provided by the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 11151
C2361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Headlamp Bulb: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP BULB
Expedition Headlamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Bulb > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Page 11156
Navigator High Intensity Discharge (HID) Headlamp Bulb
Removal and Installation
WARNING: The headlamp bulb contains gas under pressure. The bulb may shatter if the glass
envelope is scratched or if the bulb is dropped. Handle the bulb only by its base. Avoid touching the
glass envelope. Failure to follow these instructions may result in personal injury.
NOTE:
- The headlamp bulb should not be removed from the headlamp until just before a new bulb is
installed. Removing the bulb for an extended period of time may affect headlamp bulb
performance. Contaminants may enter the headlamp where they can settle on the lens and
reflector. Never turn on the headlamp with the bulb removed from the headlamp.
- Make sure that the headlamp switch and the ignition switch are in the OFF position.
All vehicles
1. Remove the headlamp assembly.
Expedition
2. Rotate the headlamp bulb approximately 1/8 turn counterclockwise and remove the bulb from
the headlamp assembly.
Navigator
3. Remove the HID bulb access cover. 4. Remove the 2 screws and the HID bulb.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
All vehicles
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Multifunction Switch
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information >
Diagrams > Multifunction Switch > Page 11162
C2065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Illumination Dimmer Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 11165
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 11166
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 11167
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Locations > High
Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Locations > High
Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11172
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11175
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11176
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11177
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11178
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11179
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11183
C205
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11184
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11185
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11186
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP SWITCH
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11187
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Remove the screw and the LH lower instrument panel finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the 3 screws and the steering column finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
All vehicles
3. NOTE: The headlamp switch is removed by releasing the tabs and pushing from behind.
Remove the headlamp switch. Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-17 (Steering Wheel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11192
C217
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
License Plate Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11197
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11198
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11199
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11200
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11201
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11202
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11203
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11204
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11205
License Plate Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11206
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11207
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11208
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11209
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11210
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11211
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11212
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11213
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11214
License Plate Lamp: Connector Views
C452
C462
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11215
License Plate Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11216
92-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > License Plate Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11217
92-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Marker Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11222
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11223
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11224
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11225
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11226
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11227
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11228
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11229
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11230
Marker Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11231
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11232
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11233
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11234
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11235
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11236
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11237
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11238
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11239
Marker Lamp: Connector Views
C151
C161
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11240
Marker Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11241
92-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Marker Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11242
92-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Locations
> Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11248
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11251
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11252
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11253
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Reset Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11254
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Parking Lamp Relay > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11255
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11260
Backup Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11261
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11262
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Locations > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Locations > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11267
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11270
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11271
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11272
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Right
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11273
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > High Intensity Discharge Headlamp Relay, Left > Page 11274
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11279
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Release Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11282
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11283
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11284
Parking Lamp Relay: Testing and Inspection Electronic Park Brake Reset Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11285
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Electronic Park Brake Release Relay > Page 11286
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11291
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11292
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11295
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11296
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11297
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11298
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11299
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11300
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11301
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11302
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Ambient Light Sensor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Ambient Light Sensor: Service and Repair
LIGHT SENSOR
Removal and Installation
1. Using a suitable tool, remove the light sensor from the instrument panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
2. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11310
C278
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11311
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation
BRAKE PEDAL POSITION (BPP) SWITCH
Typical BPP Switch
The BPP switch is sometimes referred to stoplamp switch. The BPP switch provides a signal to the
PCM indicating that the brakes are applied. The BPP switch is normally open and is mounted on
the brake pedal support. Depending on the vehicle application the BPP switch can be hardwired as
follows:
- to the PCM supplying battery positive voltage (B+) when the vehicle brake pedal is applied.
- to the anti-lock brake system (ABS) module, or lighting control module (LCM), the BPP signal is
then broadcast over the network to be received by the PCM.
- to the ABS traction control/stability assist module. The ABS module interprets the BPP switch
input along with other ABS inputs and generates an output called the driver brake application
(DBA) signal. The DBA signal is then sent to the PCM and to other BPP signal users.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11312
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
STOPLAMP SWITCH
Removal
1. Disconnect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
2. NOTE: The stoplamp switch will be difficult to remove if the switch plunger is not depressed. A
slight rearward force should be adequate to
depress the plunger.
With a light force (approximately 1-4 N [1-3 lb]), pull rearward on the brake pedal, rotate the
stoplamp switch 45 degrees clockwise and remove the stoplamp switch.
Installation
CAUTION: It is very important to not press, pull or touch the brake pedal assembly during the
installation of the stoplamp switch. Failure to follow these instructions may damage the stoplamp
switch.
1. Without movement to the brake pedal assembly, install the stoplamp switch and rotate 45
degrees counterclockwise. 2. Connect the stoplamp switch electrical connector.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Console Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Console Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
DOOR AJAR SWITCH
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the door latch. 2. Release the locking tab and remove the door ajar switch. 3. To install,
reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear
View 151-39 (LH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11320
View 151-40 (RH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11321
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Door Ajar Switch, Driver Side Rear > Page 11322
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front
C526
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 11325
C602
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 11326
C715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Door Ajar Switch, Left Front > Page 11327
C820
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11331
C2361
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Multifunction Switch > Page 11337
C2065
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Illumination Dimmer Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 11340
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 11341
Headlamp Dimmer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Illumination Dimmer Switch > Page 11342
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-11 (behind Dash Panel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11346
C205
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11347
Headlamp Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11348
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11349
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
HEADLAMP SWITCH
Expedition
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11350
Navigator
Removal and Installation
Expedition
1. Remove the screw and the LH lower instrument panel finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
Navigator
2. Remove the 3 screws and the steering column finish panel.
- Disconnect the electrical connectors.
All vehicles
3. NOTE: The headlamp switch is removed by releasing the tabs and pushing from behind.
Remove the headlamp switch. Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations
View 151-17 (Steering Wheel - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 11354
C217
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11358
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11359
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11360
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11361
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Vehicles with power tilt
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 11362
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Tail Lamp: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11367
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11368
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11369
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11370
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11371
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11372
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11373
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11374
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11375
Tail Lamp: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11376
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11377
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11378
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11379
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11380
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11381
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11382
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11383
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11384
Tail Lamp: Connector Views
C4032
C4035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11385
C4112
C4113
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11386
C4114
C4115
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11387
Tail Lamp: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
92-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11388
92-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11389
92-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Trailer Lamps: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11394
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11395
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11396
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11397
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11398
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11399
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11400
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11401
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11402
Trailer Lamps: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11403
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11404
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11405
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11406
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11407
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11408
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11409
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11410
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11411
Trailer Lamps: Electrical Diagrams
PLEASE NOTE: Some diagrams may appear to be missing because of gaps in the number
sequences. These "gaps" are actually for diagrams that do not apply to the vehicle model selected.
95-1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11412
95-2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 11413
95-3
Diagrams: Other diagrams referred to by number (See Diagram ##-#, etc.) within these diagrams
can be found at Diagrams By Number. See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams/Diagrams By Number
Locations: Location Views (reference numbers starting with 151-) referred to within these diagrams
can be found at Component Location Views. See: Diagrams/Components/Component Location
Views
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Trailer Lamps: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
INSPECTION AND VERIFICATION
1. Verify the customer concern. 2. Verify the exterior lighting system of the vehicle is operating
correctly. If not, refer to the appropriate pinpoint test. 3. Visually inspect the following for obvious
signs of electrical damage.
VISUAL INSPECTION CHART
Electrical Battery junction box (BJB) fuse(s): 5 (40A) (trailer electric brake controller)
- 12 (25A) (trailer tow parking lamps)
- 13 (30A) (trailer tow battery charge relay switch side)
- 34 (25A) (trailer tow turn relays)
- 63 (15A) (trailer tow reversing lamps)
- Smart junction box (SJB) fuse 42 (10A) (trailer tow battery charge relay coil)
- Circuitry
- Trailer tow turn/stop relays
- Trailer tow battery charge relay
- Trailer tow parking lamp relay
- Trailer brake control module
- Trailer
- SJB
4. If the concern is not visually evident, verify the symptom. GO to Symptom Chart. See: Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11416
Symptom Chart
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11417
Trailer Lamps: Pinpoint Tests
Test X: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - All
PINPOINT TEST X: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - ALL
X1
X1 Continued
Normal Operation
The trailer tow connectors receive ground through circuit RAT08 (WH) for all of the trailer lamps.
Possible Causes
- Circuit RAT08 (WH) open
- Trailer
Test Y: The Individual Trailer Lamp Is Inoperative - Trailer Turn/Stoplamp
PINPOINT TEST Y: THE INDIVIDUAL TRAILER LAMP IS INOPERATIVE - TRAILER
TURN/STOPLAMP
Y1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11418
Y1-Y2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11419
Y3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11420
Y4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11421
Y5
Normal Operation
The trailer tow LH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the vehicle
LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 (YE).
The trailer tow RH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the vehicle
RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (OG).
The battery junction box (BJB) fuse 34 (25A) supplies voltage to both trailer tow turn relays. The
trailer tow turn/stop relay coils are grounded through circuit GD123 (BK/GY).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CAT06 (YE) open
- Circuit CAT09 (OG) open
- Circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) open
- Circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) open
- Circuit GD123 (BK/GY) open
- BJB
- Trailer tow turn relay
- Trailer
Test Z: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Parking Lamps
PINPOINT TEST Z: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER PARKING LAMPS
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11422
Z1-Z3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11423
Z3-Z4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11424
Z4 Continued
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11425
Z5
Normal Operation
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil is grounded through
circuit GD123 (BK/GY). The battery junction box (BJB) supplies voltage to the trailer tow parking
lamp relay switch side through circuit SBB12 (GN/RD). When the trailer tow parking lamp relay is
energized, the voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT11 (BN).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CAT11 (BN) open
- Circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) open
- Circuit GD123 (BK/GY) open
- Circuit SBB12 (GN/RD) open
- Trailer tow parking lamp relay
- Trailer
Tests AA: The Trailer Lamps Are Inoperative - Trailer Reversing Lamps
PINPOINT TEST AA: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE INOPERATIVE - TRAILER REVERSING
LAMPS
AA1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11426
AA1-AA2
Normal Operation
The battery junction box (BJB) fuse 63 (15A) receives voltage from circuit CLS10 (GY/BN) when
the vehicle reversing lamps are illuminated. The voltage is then routed to the trailer tow connector
through circuit CAT16 (GY/BN).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CAT16 (GY/BN) open
- Circuit CLS10 (GY/BN) open
- Trailer
Tests AB: The Trailer Lamps Are On Continuously
PINPOINT TEST AB: THE TRAILER LAMPS ARE ON CONTINUOUSLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11427
AB1-AB2
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Turn/Stoplamp
The trailer tow LH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS18 (GY/BN) when the vehicle
LH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow LH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT06 YE).
The trailer tow RH turn relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS19 (VT/OG) when the vehicle
RH rear stoplamp is illuminated. When the trailer tow RH turn relay is energized, the voltage is
routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT09 (OG).
Normal Operation - Trailer Tow Parking
The trailer tow parking lamp relay coil receives voltage through circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) when the
vehicle parking lamps are illuminated. When the trailer tow parking lamp relay is energized, the
voltage is routed to the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT11 (BN).
Possible Causes
- Circuit CAT06 (YE) short to voltage
- Circuit CAT09 (OG) short to voltage
- Circuit CAT11 (BN) short to voltage
- Trailer tow relay
- Trailer
Tests AC: The Trailer Battery Charging Is Inoperative/Does Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST AC: THE TRAILER BATTERY CHARGING IS INOPERATIVE/DOES NOT
OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11428
AC1-AC2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11429
AC3-AC4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11430
AC4-AC5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11431
AC5-AC6
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11432
AC6-AC8
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11433
AC8-AC10
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11434
AC10-AC11
Normal Operation
The trailer battery charge relay coil receives voltage from the smart junction box (SJB) fuse 42
(10A) through circuit CAT23 (GY/YE) when the ignition switch is in the RUN position. Ground for
the trailer battery charge relay coil is supplied through circuit GD123 (BK/GY). The battery junction
box (BJB) fuse 13 (30A) supplies voltage to the trailer battery charge relay switch side through
circuit SSB13 (GY/RD). When the trailer battery charge relay is energized, the voltage is routed to
the trailer tow connector through circuit CAT14 (OG).
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CAT14 (OG) open or short to voltage
- Circuit CAT23 (GY/YE) open or short to voltage
- Circuit GD123 (BK/GY) open
- Circuit SSB13 (GY/RD) open
- Trailer battery charge relay
- Trailer
- SJB
Tests AD: The Trailer Electric Brakes Are Inoperative/Do Not Operate Correctly
PINPOINT TEST AD: THE TRAILER ELECTRIC BRAKES ARE INOPERATIVE/DO NOT
OPERATE CORRECTLY
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11435
AD1-AD2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11436
AD2-AD4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11437
AD5-AD7
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial
Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 11438
AD8-AD9
Normal Operation
The trailer brake control module is provided voltage at all times by the battery junction box (BJB)
fuse 5 (40A) through circuit SBB05 (GY/RD). Ground for the trailer brake control module is
provided through circuit GD138 (BK/WH). The trailer brake control module receives voltage from
the stoplamp switch through circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) when the brake pedal is applied. When
requested, the trailer brake control module sends voltage to the trailer tow connector through circuit
CAT19 (BU). Circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) supplies voltage to the trailer brake control module when the
parking lamps are on.
Possible Causes
- Fuse
- Circuit CAT19 (BU) open, short to ground or voltage
- Circuit CLS17 (YE/GY) open
- Circuit CLS30 (VT/WH) open
- Circuit GD138 (BK/WH) open
- Circuit SBB05 (GY/RD) open
- Trailer brake control module
- Trailer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lamps > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page
11439
Special Tool(s)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11444
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Locations > Trailer Tow
Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11445
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11448
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11449
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11450
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Left/Right Turn
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11451
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11452
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11453
Trailer Lighting Relay: Testing and Inspection Trailer Tow Relay, Parking Lamp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11454
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Trailer Tow Relay, Battery Charge > Page 11455
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information > Application
and ID
Turn Signal Flasher: Application and ID
The flasher function for this vehicle is provided by the Smart Junction Box (SJB).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front
C1023
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11464
C4032
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11465
C1043
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11466
C4035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11467
Turn Signal Lamp: Diagrams
C1023
C4032
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11468
C1043
C4035
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11469
C156
C166
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11470
C4112
C4113
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams >
Park/Turn Lamp, Left Front > Page 11471
C4114
C4115
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11475
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11476
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11477
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11478
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Vehicles with power tilt
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11479
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Vanity Mirror Lamp,
Left
C907
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Vanity Lamp > Component Information > Diagrams > Vanity Mirror Lamp,
Left > Page 11484
C906
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 11490
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 11491
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Element Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 11492
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 11497
Heated Glass Element Relay: Testing and Inspection
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 11498
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 11499
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 11504
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 11507
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 11508
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 11509
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 11510
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Power Window Relay >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 11511
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11517
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11518
View 151-39 (LH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11519
View 151-40 (RH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
C504A
C504B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11522
C535A
C535B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11523
C701
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11524
C801
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11525
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
C624
C648
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11528
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11529
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11530
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11531
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switches - Left Rear and Right Rear
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11532
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11533
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
WINDOW CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LF shown, all others similar.
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. Unlock the tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel. 3. To install,
reverse removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR-FRONT DOOR
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Front Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 11539
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For Navigator, the LF/RF door power window regulator motor must be reinitialized
whenever the LF/RF motor is removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
2. Position the front door weathershield aside.
3. NOTE: Use a flat-blade screwdriver between the window regulator motor and window regulator
assembly to hold the window regulator assembly
drum in place.
Remove the bolts and the front door window regulator motor. 1
Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- For Navigator, reinitialize the LF/RF window regulator motor.
- Cycle the window glass to make sure the gears engage.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Quarter Window Motor > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Quarter Window Motor: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR-REAR QUARTER
Removal
1. Remove the D-pillar trim panel.
2. Disconnect the rear quarter window regulator motor.
- Remove the retaining clip.
3. Remove the bolts and rear quarter window regulator motor.
- To install, tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Motor: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR-REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Rear Door Window Motor >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 11546
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel
2. Position the rear door weathershield aside.
3. NOTE: Use a flat-blade screwdriver between the window regulator motor and the window
regulator assembly to hold the window regulator
assembly drum in place.
Remove the rear door window regulator motor. 1
Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 7 Nm (62 lb-in).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Cycle the door glass to make sure of gear engagement.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Quarter Window Open Relay > Page 11551
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Close Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 11554
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 11555
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 11556
Power Window Relay: Testing and Inspection Quarter Window Open Relay
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 11557
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Relay > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Quarter Window Close Relay > Page 11558
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch
View 151-35 (Driver Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11563
View 151-36 (Passenger Door - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11564
View 151-39 (LH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11565
View 151-40 (RH Rear Door)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Master Window Adjust Switch
C504A
C504B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11568
C535A
C535B
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11569
C701
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11570
C801
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11571
Power Window Switch: Diagrams Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
C624
C648
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Master Window Adjust Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11574
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11575
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Power Window Switch, RH Side Front
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11576
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11577
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection Window Adjust Switches - Left Rear and Right Rear
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Master Window Adjust Switch > Page 11578
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 11579
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
WINDOW CONTROL SWITCH
Removal and Installation
NOTE: LF shown, all others similar.
1. Remove the door trim panel.
2. Unlock the tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel. 3. To install,
reverse removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
DOOR GLASS TOP RUN-FRONT
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > Front Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 11585
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the front door window glass.
2. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
3. Remove the front door glass channel bolt and front door glass top run.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
4. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Liftgate Window Glass: Service and Repair
WINDOW GLASS-LIFTGATE
Material
Material
Removal and Installation
Window glass assembly
1. Remove the rear window wiper motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11589
2. Disconnect the rear window defrost electrical connectors.
3. CAUTION:
- The liftgate glass must be supported when removing and installing the liftgate assist cylinders.
- Do not extend the socket clips more than 2.0 mm (0.08 in) or failure of the socket can occur.
Disconnect the 2 liftgate glass assist cylinders. 1
Insert a screwdriver blade under the socket clip and lift.
2 Gently pull the socket off the ball stud.
Window glass assembly or hinge assembly
4. Remove the liftgate glass hinge-to-body fasteners and remove the glass.
- To install, tighten to 12 Nm (9 lb-ft).
Window hinge assembly
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Liftgate Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11590
5. Remove the liftgate glass to hinge fasteners and remove the glass.
- Apply Threadlock 262 to the liftgate glass to hinge fasteners during installation.
- To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Window glass assembly or window hinge assembly
6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Quarter Window Glass: Service and Repair
WINDOW GLASS-REAR QUARTER
Material
Material
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11594
Part 2
Removal
All vehicles 1. Remove the rear quarter trim panel.
2. CAUTION: To prevent damage to the coat hanger retainer, use a 3/16-inch flat-blade
screwdriver for this step.
Remove the front and rear coat hooks and lower the headliner over the rear quarter window glass.
Open the access cover.
- Insert a screwdriver into the coat hook slot and turn the screwdriver 90 degrees so that it engages
in the plastic component slot. This will spread the steal attachment clip wings to allow the plastic
component to disengage.
Vehicles with power vent window
3. Remove the bolts and rear quarter window regulator motor.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Disconnect the rear quarter window regulator.
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11595
5. Disconnect the audio antenna.
6. If equipped, remove the air duct.
- Remove the pin-type retainer.
7. CAUTION: Have an assistant hold the rear quarter window glass.
Remove the rear quarter window glass. 1
Remove the nuts.
2 Remove the rear quarter window glass.
8. Remove the excess foam core butyl from the window opening.
Installation
All vehicles
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11596
1. Apply 8 mm (0.32 in) Foam Core Butyl or equivalent meeting Ford specification
WSB-M3G143-B1 to the rear quarter window glass frame.
- Start at the bottom middle and work around the frame.
2. Install the rear quarter window glass.
1 Position the rear quarter window glass.
2 Install the rear quarter window glass nuts. Tighten to 2 Nm (18 lb-in).
3. If equipped, install the air duct.
- Install the pin-type retainer.
4. Connect the audios antenna.
Vehicles with power vent windows
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11597
5. Install the rear quarter window regulator.
6. Install the bolts and rear quarter window regulator motor.
- Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb-in).
- Connect the electrical connector.
All vehicles 7. Position the headliner and install the coat hooks. 8. Install the rear quarter trim
panel.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Glass Weatherstrip: Service and Repair
DOOR GLASS TOP RUN-REAR
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Rear Door Window Glass > Rear Door
Window Glass Weatherstrip > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 11602
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Lower the rear door window glass. 2. Remove the rear door trim panel.
3. Remove the inside glass weatherstrip.
4. Remove the rear door glass channel bolts.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
5. Remove the rear door glass top run. 6. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair
Front Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR-FRONT DOOR
Part 1
Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11607
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
NOTE: For Navigator, the LF/RF door power window regulator motor must be reinitialized
whenever the LF/RF window regulator is removed from the vehicle.
1. Remove the front door trim panel.
2. Unlock the tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. Remove the screws and the front door speaker.
- Disconnect the electrical connector.
4. Remove the front door weathershield. 5. Re-connect the electrical connectors to the window
control switch. 6. Lower the window glass to access the 2 window glass clamp bolts.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11608
7. Loosen the window glass clamp bolts.
- To install, raise the window glass until it stalls in the UP position. Tighten the window glass clamp
bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
8. NOTE: Secure the front window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the front window glass with tape to the front door frame.
9. Position the interior door handle aside.
1 Remove the cable conduit fitting from the carrier assembly.
2 Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
3 Remove the cable from the door handle.
10. Release the crash sensor harness pin-type retainers.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Front Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11609
11. Position the front door window regulator harness aside.
1 Disconnect the electrical connectors.
2 Release the pin-type retainers.
12. Remove the front window regulator.
1 Loosen the 2 hanger bolts.
2 Remove the front window regulator bolts and front top run channel bolt. -
To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure. 14. For Navigator, reinitialize the LF/RF window
regulator motor.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair
Rear Door Window Regulator: Service and Repair
WINDOW REGULATOR-REAR DOOR
Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11613
Part 2
Exploded View
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear door trim panel
2. NOTE: LF shown, LR and RR are similar.
Unlock the tabs and remove the window control switch from the door trim panel.
3. Remove the rear door speaker.
1 Remove the screws.
2 Disconnect the electrical connector.
3 Remove the speaker.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11614
4. Remove the rear door weathershield. 5. Connect the window control switch. 6. Lower the
window glass to access the window glass clamp bolts. 7. Disconnect the window control switch. 8.
Loosen the window glass clamp bolts and remove the rear door window glass.
- To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
9. NOTE: Secure the rear window glass in the full UP position.
Secure the rear window glass with tape to the front door frame.
10. Disconnect the rear door window regulator electrical connectors.
11. Position the interior door handle aside.
- Lift upward on the interior door handle retaining bracket and pivot the interior door handle out of
the bracket.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Regulator > Rear Door Window Regulator > System
Information > Service and Repair > Page 11615
12. Remove the rear door window regulator assembly.
- Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
13. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched
Window Seal: Customer Interest Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 11624
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 11625
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 11626
Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass:
One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF,
17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: Both Front Doors (Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 11627
Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched
Window Seal: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Front Door Window Scratched
TSB 07-10-5
05/28/07
FRONT DOOR SIDE GLASS SCRATCHED DUE TO COLLECTION OF DIRT/DEBRIS IN
WARPED OUTER WINDOW MOLDING
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition 2005 Excursion 2005-2008 F-Super Duty
LINCOLN: 2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-18-2 to update the vehicle model years, vehicle application and
parts information.
ISSUE Some 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 2005 Excursion, 2003-2007 Expedition and 2007 Navigator
vehicles may exhibit outer window molding weather strip assembly warping around the lower front
window channel. The condition may be described as a warped or loose outer window molding.
There may be a pucker or gap between the window beltline molding weather strip assembly and
the window glass. This may result in dirt and debris collecting between the molding and the glass,
and therefore scratching the side-window glass.
ACTION Use the Service Procedure to replace the outer window molding and adjust the molding
flange.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Lower the side door window completely.
2. Remove the outside mirror.
3. Remove the outer window molding weather strip assembly by lifting it up away from the flange
(Figure 1).
4. Raise the side door glass completely.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 11633
5. Measure the distance from inboard sur[ace of the door molding flange to outboard surface of the
window glass (Figure 2). Distance from flange to glass should be between 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) for
F-Super Duty and Excursion, and 3/16-7/16" (5-11 mm) for Expedition and Navigator.
6. Lower glass completely.
7. Adjust the door molding flange to meet the 5/8-3/4" (16-19 mm) dimension. Do not adjust flange
more than 3/4" (19 mm) away from the glass.
8. Install a new lower window molding weather strip assembly.
9. Reinstall mirror.
10. If the side door glass has been scratched, replace the glass. Refer to Workshop Manual,
Section 501-11.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 11634
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071005A 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.5 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005B 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.9 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005C 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 0.7 Hr.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 11635
Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass:
One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17628B, 17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF,
17682B)
071005D 2005-2008 F-Super Duty, 1.3 Hrs.
2005 Excursion: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange, And Replace Window Glass Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17628B,
17682C, 23943A, 23943B, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005E 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.6 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
07100SF 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange: Both Front Doors (Do Not Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005G 2003-2007 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding, Includes Time To Measure And Adjust
Door Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: One Front Door (Do Not Use With 17682C,
21452A, 23943A, 23943AB, 23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
071005H 2003-2007 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
2007 Navigator: Replace The Window Beltline Molding Includes Time To Measure And Adjust Door
Molding Flange And Replace Window Glass: Both Front Doors (Do Not
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 07-10-5 > May > 07 > Body - Front Door Window Scratched > Page 11636
Use With 17682C, 21452A, 23943A, 23943AB,
23943A14, 18808AF, 17682B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
2521452 07
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 08-19-11 > Sep > 08 > Suspension - Front/Rear Suspension
Squeak/Rattle
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: All Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Front/Rear
Suspension Squeak/Rattle
TSB 08-19-11
09/29/08
SQUEAK / RATTLE FRONT OR REAR SUSPENSION
FORD: 2007-2008 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2007-2008 Navigator
ISSUE Some 2007-2008 Expedition and Navigator vehicles may exhibit a squeak noise from the
front or rear suspension. The source of the noise may be the lower shock attachment bolt and nut.
ACTION Follow the Service Procedure steps to correct the condition.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Use chassis ears to confirm the noise is coming from the shock to lower control arm attachment
nut and bolt.
2. If confirmed, loosen the nut and bolt and re-torque to the 350 lb-ft (475 N.m) specification in the
Workshop Manual (WSM), Section 204.
3. Retest for the noise. If concern still exists, replace the shock, nut and attaching bolt per WSM,
Section 204.
Parts Block
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
081911A 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.3 Hrs.
Navigator: Diagnosis, Includes Time To Install Chassis Ears, and Torque Fasteners. Includes All
Necessary Road Tests, This Labor Operation Can
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 08-19-11 > Sep > 08 > Suspension - Front/Rear Suspension
Squeak/Rattle > Page 11642
Be Claimed With Any Of the Operations In This Article (Do Not Use With 18124A, 18125A, 5649A)
081911B 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace One Front Shock This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, D
Or E (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911C 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Both Front Shocks This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, D
Or E (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911D 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: Replace One Rear Shock This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, B
Or C (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911E 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Both Rear Shocks This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, B
Or C (Do Not Use With 18124A, 18125A, 5649A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18125 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Seal > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Window Seal: > 08-19-11 > Sep > 08 > Suspension - Front/Rear Suspension
Squeak/Rattle > Page 11648
Be Claimed With Any Of the Operations In This Article (Do Not Use With 18124A, 18125A, 5649A)
081911B 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.7 Hr.
Navigator: Replace One Front Shock This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, D
Or E (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911C 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.1 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Both Front Shocks This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, D
Or E (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911D 2007-2008 Expedition, 0.9 Hr.
Navigator: Replace One Rear Shock This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, B
Or C (Do Not Use With 18124A 18125A, 5649A)
081911E 2007-2008 Expedition, 1.7 Hrs.
Navigator: Replace Both Rear Shocks This Labor Operation Can Be Claimed With Operations A, B
Or C (Do Not Use With 18124A, 18125A, 5649A)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
18125 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
Windshield: Procedures
WINDSHIELD RESEAL
Material
Material
1. Remove the cowl grille.
2. Remove the A-pillar trim panels.
- Remove the bolt covers and bolts.
3. If equipped, remove the overhead console. 4. If equipped, remove the roof opening panel trim. 5.
Remove the interior rear view mirror.
6. Remove the sun visors.
1 Remove the 8 screws.
2 Remove the 2 sun visor and visor arm clips. If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors.
7. Partially lower the front portion of the headliner near the windshield upper opening and block
with a suitable material. 8. Clean the edge formed by the existing urethane and the glass on the
inside at the top and sides, and outside on the bottom of the windshield with
glass cleaner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 11653
9. Cut the urethane applicator tip to specification.
10. NOTE: Use either a high-ratio electric or battery-operated caulk gun that will apply the urethane
with less effort and a continuous bead.
Apply a bead of urethane adhesive to the cleaned area.
11. NOTE: Make sure that all gaps in the urethane adhesive are smoothed into one continuous
bead.
Backfill the urethane application and clean the excess.
12. CAUTION: The urethane adhesive must cure for a minimum of one hour before testing for air or
water leaks.
After the urethane has cured, check the windshield seal for air or water leaks through the urethane
adhesive bead and add urethane adhesive as necessary.
13. Install the headliner.
14. Install the sun visors.
1 Position the sun visors.
2 Install the 8 screws. If equipped, connect the electrical connectors.
15. Install the interior rear view mirror. 16. If equipped, install the roof opening panel trim. 17. If
equipped, install the overhead console. 18. Install the A-pillar trim panels.
- Install the bolts and covers.
19. Install the cowl grille. 20. Clean the interior and exterior of the windshield glass with glass
cleaner.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 11654
Windshield: Removal and Replacement
WINDSHIELD GLASS
Special Tool(s)
Special Tool(s)
Material
Material
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 11655
Removal
WARNING: To prevent glass splinters from entering eyes or cutting hands, wear safety glasses
and heavy gloves when cutting glass from the vehicle.
1. Remove the cowl grille.
2. Remove the A-pillar trim panels.
- Remove the bolt covers and bolts.
3. If equipped, remove the overhead console. 4. Remove the interior rear view mirror
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 11656
5. Remove the sun visors.
1 Remove the 8 screws.
2 Remove the 2 sun visor and visor arm clips. If equipped, disconnect the electrical connectors.
6. Lower the front portion of the headliner.
7. Remove the windshield side mouldings.
- Pull out starting at the top corner.
8. Remove the upper windshield weatherstrip.
- Pull out starting at the corner.
9. Mark the outside of the windshield glass with a wax pencil to avoid damaging the glass stops
when cutting the urethane.
10. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt and foreign material from the pinch weld.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 11657
11. CAUTION: Care must be taken to avoid scratching the pinchweld.
NOTE: Lubricate the urethane adhesive with water to aid the special tool while cutting.
Using the special tool, cut the urethane adhesive from the windshield glass. Insert the blade into the urethane at the top middle of the glass and work toward the top corners.
- Insert the blade at the top corners and work down each side of the glass toward the bottom.
12. CAUTION: Pump special tool 164-R2459 or equivalent slowly as cowl adhesive is cut to avoid
breaking glass.
Using the special tool, distance the windshield from the body.
13. NOTE: Removing the windshield glass requires an assistant.
Using the special tool, cut the remaining urethane adhesive and remove the windshield glass.
14. Using a soft brush or vacuum, remove any dirt and foreign material from the pinch weld.
Installation
CAUTION: Do not drive the vehicle after installing windshield glass until the urethane adhesive has
cured. Inadequate curing of the urethane adhesive adversely affects the strength of the urethane
adhesive bond.
1. Dry-fit the windshield glass by centering it side-to-side and by adjusting the setting blocks (if
equipped) to get the correct position of the part top
to bottom. Make the alignment marks with tape or non-staining grease pencil on both the glass and
the vehicle body.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 11658
2. CAUTION: Care must be taken to avoid scratching the pinch weld.
Trim the remaining urethane adhesive on the pinch weld to within specification. The old urethane surface should be smooth and free of cuts and contamination.
3. If reinstalling the original windshield, remove excess urethane adhesive from the windshield
glass. 4. If installing a new windshield glass, clean the inside of the glass surface with glass cleaner
to make sure the ceramic-coated area is clean.
5. CAUTION: Be sure to use the same brand and cure-rate products for the adhesive and primer.
Do not mix different brands of urethane
and primer. Refer to the Material Chart in this procedure.
NOTE: Sika uses the same black primer for the glass and pinch weld area.
If installing a new windshield glass, apply urethane glass primer according to manufacturer's
instructions. Allow at least 6 minutes to dry.
6. Install the upper windshield weatherstrip.
7. Cut the urethane applicator tip to specification.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 11659
8. CAUTION: Do not drive the vehicle after installing windshield glass until the urethane adhesive
has cured. Inadequate curing of the
urethane adhesive adversely affects the strength of the urethane adhesive bond.
Apply a bead of Urethane Adhesive to the pinch weld just outside the foam butyl dam over the top
of the existing urethane bed.
9. CAUTION: Open the windows to prevent the windshield glass from being pushed out by air
pressure if a door is closed.
Using the alignment marks, install the windshield glass.
10. Install the windshield side mouldings.
NOTE: Be sure the moldings seat completely.
11. Install the headliner. 12. Install the interior rear view mirror. 13. Install the overhead console.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Service and Repair > Procedures
> Page 11660
14. Install the A-pillar trim panels.
- Install the bolts and covers.
15. Install the sun visors.
1 Position the sun visors.
2 Install the 8 screws. If equipped, connect the electrical connectors.
16. Install the cowl grille. 17. Run the blower motor on defrost HIGH to check for glass that may
have fallen into the defroster vents.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer
Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11666
C138
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11670
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 11673
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 11674
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 11675
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 11676
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11677
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Vehicles with power tilt
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11678
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 11682
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 11685
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 11686
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 11687
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 11688
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11689
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Vehicles with power tilt
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 11690
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 11694
C138
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information > Locations
View 151-2 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 2 Of 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Page 11698
C1357
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Pump: Service and Repair
WASHER PUMP
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Windshield washer solution contains methanol, which is poisonous. Observe all
cautions and warnings indicated on the label of the container. Failure to follow these instructions
could result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- When servicing the windshield washer pump be careful not to damage the windshield washer
pump seal.
- Do not operate the windshield washer pump before filling the windshield washer reservoir. Failure
to do so could result in premature pump failure.
1. Remove the RH headlamp assembly. 2. Position aside the shield as necessary to gain access to
the washer pump. 3. Disconnect the windshield washer reservoir hoses. 4. Disconnect the
windshield washer pump electrical connector. 5. Remove the windshield washer pump. 6. To
install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Windshield Washer Reservoir: Service and Repair
WASHER RESERVOIR
Removal and Installation
WARNING: Windshield washer solution contains methanol, which is poisonous. Observe all
cautions and warnings indicated on the label of the container. Failure to follow these instructions
could result in personal injury.
CAUTION:
- When servicing the windshield washer pump, be careful not to damage the windshield washer
pump seal.
- Do not operate the windshield pump before filling the windshield washer reservoir. Failure to do
so could result in premature pump failure.
NOTE: The washer reservoir is integrated with the battery tray and cannot be serviced separately.
1. Remove the vehicle battery. 2. Drain the cooling system.
3. Disconnect the upper radiator hose at the radiator inlet, and position aside.
4. Remove the 3 battery tray bolts.
- To install, tighten to 17 Nm (13 lb-ft).
5. Carefully position the washer reservoir assembly to gain access to the electrical connectors and
washer hoses.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Reservoir > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Page 11705
6. Disconnect the windshield washer solvent level electrical connector, washer pump electrical
connectors and washer hoses.
7. NOTE: If necessary, drain the windshield washer reservoir after removal.
Remove the washer reservoir assembly.
8. Transfer components as necessary. 9. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Refer to Cooling System for coolant filling and bleeding procedures.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Page 11709
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 11712
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 11713
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 11714
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Multifunction Switch > Page 11715
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 11716
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Vehicles with power tilt
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 11717
2. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
^ Disconnect the power tilt electrical connector switch from the lower shroud.
Vehicles with manual tilt
3. If equipped, release the tabs and slide the gear selector cover away from the steering column
shrouds. 4. Remove the 3 screws and the upper and lower steering column shrouds.
All vehicles
5. Disconnect the multi-function switch electrical connector. 6. Remove the 2 screws and the
multi-function switch. 7. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments > Wiper
Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield
Wiper Arm: Adjustments Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield
WIPER BLADE AND PIVOT ARM ADJUSTMENT - WINDSHIELD
1. Cycle and park the windshield wipers.
2. Verify the distance between the outer tip of the (1) RH windshield wiper blade and the (3) bottom
of the windshield glass and between the outer tip
of the (2) LH windshield wiper blade and the (3) bottom of the windshield glass are within
specifications.
3. If the distance is not within specification, remove the windshield wiper pivot arm and reposition to
specification.
1 Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
2 Remove the nut.
4. Tighten the windshield wiper pivot arm nuts to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Adjustments > Wiper
Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Windshield > Page 11722
Wiper Arm: Adjustments Wiper Blade and Pivot Arm Adjustment - Rear
WIPER BLADE AND PIVOT ARM ADJUSTMENT - REAR
1. Cycle and park the rear window wiper pivot arm and blade.
2. Check the rear window wiper park measurement. If not within specification, the rear window
wiper pivot arm will need to be removed.
3. CAUTION: Use a shop towel or similar device to protect the vehicle finish when carrying out the
procedure.
Remove the rear window wiper pivot arm. 1
Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
2 Remove the nut.
4. NOTE: This step makes sure that the wiper motor is in the PARK position.
Turn the rear window wiper switch ON and allow the motor to operate for at least one cycle. Turn
the rear window wiper switch to OFF.
5. Install the rear window wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
1 Position the wiper pivot arm within specification.
2 Tighten the nut to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
3 Install the cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Pivot Arm - Front
WIPER PIVOT ARM - FRONT
Removal and Installation
NOTE: The windshield wiper pivot arms must be in the highest position to remove them.
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position. 2. Turn the windshield wiper on. 3. Stop the
windshield wiper pivot arms at the highest position by turning the ignition switch OFF.
4. Remove the windshield wiper pivot arm.
1 Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
2 Remove the nut. To install, tighten to 35 Nm (26 lb-ft).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
- Adjust the windshield wiper pivot arms.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front > Page 11725
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Pivot Arm - Rear
WIPER PIVOT ARM - REAR
Removal
1. CAUTION: Use a shop towel or similar device to protect the vehicle finish when carrying out the
procedure.
Remove the rear window wiper pivot arm. 1
Lift the pivot arm nut cover.
2 Remove the nut.
Installation
1. NOTE: This step makes sure that the wiper motor is in the PARK position.
Turn the rear window wiper switch ON and allow the motor to operate for at least one cycle. Turn
the rear window wiper switch to OFF.
2. Install the rear window wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
1 Position the wiper pivot arm within specification.
2 Tighten the nut to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
3 Install the cover.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front > Page 11726
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Windshield
WIPER MOUNTING ARM AND PIVOT SHAFT - WINDSHIELD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the cowl grille panel. 2. Disconnect and position the hood light harness aside. 3.
Remove the hood struts.
- Using a suitable tool support the hood.
4. Remove the mounting arm and pivot shaft assembly.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector and position the wiring harness aside.
2 Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
5. To install, reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Arm > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Pivot Arm - Front > Page 11727
Wiper Arm: Service and Repair Wiper Mounting Arm and Pivot Shaft - Rear
WIPER MOUNTING ARM AND PIVOT SHAFT - REAR
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm. 2. Remove the dust boot cover.
3. Remove the nut and the rear window glass handle.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
4. Remove the nuts and the rear window wiper striker and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
5. To install reverse the removal procedure
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Windshield
Wiper Motor
View 151-1 (Engine Compartment - Expedition (Page 1 Of 2))
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Windshield
Wiper Motor > Page 11732
View 151-41 (Liftgate - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Wiper Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
Note
All wiring connections between components are shown exactly as they exist in the vehicles. It is
important to realize, however, that no attempt has been made on the diagrams to represent
components and wiring as they physically appear on the vehicle. For example, a 4-foot length of
wire is treated no differently in a diagram from one that is only a few inches long. Furthermore, to
aid in understanding electrical (electronic) operation, wiring inside complicated components has
been simplified.
Complete Circuit Operation
Each circuit is shown completely and independently in one set. Other components that are
connected to the circuits may not be shown unless they influence the circuit operation.
Current Flow (1)
Each set normally starts with the component that powers the circuit, such as a fuse or the ignition
switch. Current flow is shown from the power source at the top of the diagram to ground at the
bottom of the diagram. A full representation of the power supply of a fuse or the power distribution
from a fuse to various components is given in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Full
representation of the ground connections are shown in Power and Distribution Diagrams.
Switch Positions (2)
Within a diagram, all switches, sensors and relays are shown "at rest" (ignition switch OFF).
Splices (3)
Splices directly connecting to the power distribution are best represented on the power distribution
diagrams in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. Splices connected to grounds can be seen
completely in Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams. For all other splices, a reference is given
to each off diagram where that particular splice can be best viewed.
Component Referencing (4)
Components on a diagram have a reference to a component location view or the diagram where it
is shown completely. The reference is located to the right of each component.
Component Names (5)
Component names are placed on the right hand side of each component when possible.
Descriptions of the internals of the component are also included when available. The diagram
where the component appears in full is listed in the Index. The base part number for a component
is listed in Vehicle/Diagrams.
Internal Name and Function Identification Numbers (6)
Some components on each diagram have internal symbols with an identification number located
within it. You can identify the internal symbol or function by finding the corresponding number
under the component name.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11735
Circuit Numbering and Wire Identification (7)
Ford Motor Company uses three different circuit numbering conventions: Standard Circuit
Numbering System, Global Circuit Numbering System; and New Global Circuit Numbering System
(NGCNS). With each, the circuit number (which identifies a specific circuit function) is followed by
the wire color.
The wire identification consists of a basic color and possibly a stripe, and is determined directly
from the wire's circuit number. In the diagrams, the wire colors are indicated next to the wires. The
colors are abbreviated using the international norm IEC 757. The abbreviations are listed in
Symbols.
Fuse and Relay Information
Fuse and Relay Information contains a view of the fuse/relay box in which fuses and relays are
identified, numbered and named. Fuse and relay numbering and naming follow the indication of the
fuse panel cover. In addition, for all removable relays, pin positions are added to illustrate proper
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11736
orientation.
Power Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams shows the current feed circuits. The current path is
shown from the battery to the ignition switch and to all fuses. It also shows the circuits protected by
each fuse. The circuit is traced from the fuse to the component. All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the fuse and the first component are shown.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11737
Ground Distribution
Power and Ground Distribution Diagrams contains the diagrams that shows the complete details
for each ground connection or main ground splice. This is useful in diagnosing a problem affecting
several components at once (poor ground connection or ground splice). All details (wires, splices,
connectors) between the ground point and the component are shown. These ground connection
details are shown here in order to keep the individual set of diagrams as uncluttered as possible.
C904
Component and Connector Information
Connector Views show the views of the pins and/or cavities of all connectors. The pin and cavity
sides are shown separately as if the connector were disconnected. The color of the connector
housing is indicated next to the connector number when available. The harness causal number is
located above the connector view and below the connector number. The circuit function charts are
located below each connector. The wiring harness designations are listed in set Component
Location Charts.
Component Location Views shows the components and their connecting wires as they can be
found on the vehicle.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11738
Location information that can be found at the vehicle level will helps the user find where the various
items depicted on the diagram can physically be found on the vehicle. A brief written description of
the location is given, along with a reference to the component location views.
WARNINGS
- Always wear safety glasses for eye protection.
- Use safety stands whenever a procedure requires being under a vehicle.
- Be sure that the IGNITION SWITCH is always in the OFF position, unless otherwise required by
the procedure.
- Set the parking brake when working on any vehicle. An automatic transmission should be in
PARK. A manual transmission should be in NEUTRAL.
- Operate the engine only in a well-ventilated area to avoid danger of carbon monoxide.
- Keep away from moving parts, especially the fan and belts, when the engine is running.
- To prevent serious burns, avoid contact with hot metal parts such as the radiator, exhaust
manifold, tail pipe,catalytic converter and muffler.
- Do not allow flame or sparks near the battery. Gases are always present in and around the
battery cell. An explosion could occur.
- Do not smoke when working on a vehicle.
- To avoid injury, always remove rings, watches, loose hanging jewelry and avoid wearing loose
clothing.
Symbols
Symbols Part 1
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11739
Symbols Part 2
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11740
Symbols Part 3
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11741
Symbols Part 4
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11742
Symbols Part 5
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11743
Wiper Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Troubleshooting wiring harness and connector hidden concerns
The illustrations are known examples of wiring harness, splices and connectors that will create
intermittent electrical concerns. The concerns are hidden and can only be discovered by a physical
evaluation as shown in each illustration.
NOTE: Several components, such as the PCM, utilize gold plated terminals in their connections to
the wiring harness. If those terminals need to be replaced, they must be replaced with a gold plated
terminal.
Terminal not properly seated
1 = Locked terminal
2 = Male half
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Unlocked terminal (Hidden by wire seal)
7 = Seal
Check for unlocked terminals by pulling each wire at the end of the connector.
Defective insulation stripping
1 = Proper crimp
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11744
2 = Insulation not removed
3 = Wire strands missing
4 = Intermittent signals through pierced insulation
Partially mated connectors
1 = Seal
2 = Displaced tab
3 = Female half
4 = Seal
5 = Intermittent contact
6 = Male half
7 = Intermittent contact
Lock may be displaced into an unlocked position; pull on the connector to verify the lock.
Deformed (enlarged) female terminals
1 = Enlarged
2 = Normal
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11745
Any probe entering the terminal may enlarge the contact spring opening creating an intermittent
signal. Insert the correct mating terminal (Location A) from the service kit and feel for a loose fit.
Electrical short inside the harness
1 = Solder coated wire to ground
2 = Harness protective tape
3 = Intermittent short
Solder coated wire pierced through the insulation of another circuit
4 = Grounding foil
Electrical short within the harness
Splice tape removed 1
= Intermittent short
Splice covered 2
= Wire strand
3 = Splice tape
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11746
4 = Harness tape
Broken wire strands in harness
1 = Wiring harness tape
2 = Wiring strand
3 = Broken strands intermittent signal
4 = Circuit insulation
Remove the tape and flex/feel each circuit for a reduction in diameter at break.
Recommended splicing method - Solder (For 16 AWG and Smaller Diameter Wire Only)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip wires to appropriate length.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11747
3. Install heat shrink tubing. 4. Twist wires together. 5. Solder wires together.
NOTE: Use rosin core mildly-activated (RMA) solder. Do not use acid core solder.
- Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire splice.
6. Bend wire 1 back in a straight line.
NOTE: Wait for solder to cool before moving wires.
7. Evenly position heat shrink tubing over wire repair.
NOTE: Overlap tubing on both wires.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11748
8. Use shielded heat gun to heat the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of heat
shrink tubing. 9. Reconnect battery ground cable.
Recommended splicing method - Crimp (For 10-22 AWG Diameter Wire to Like Wire Diameter)
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Strip 6.35mm (1/4 in) of insulation from each wire end,
taking care not to nick or cut wire strands. 3. Install heat shrink tubing.
NOTE: Use heat shrinkable tubes marked with ES-1 (16-22 GA) or ES-2 (10-18 GA) to seal wire
splice.
4. Select appropriate wire splice for the wires to be spliced. 5. Identify the appropriate crimping
chamber on the Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper by matching the wire size on the dies with the
wire size
stamped on the butt splice.
NOTE: Rotunda 164-R5901 Pro-Crimper is the only tool that can be used with these splices.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11749
6. Center one end of the wire splice in the appropriate crimping chamber. 7. If visible, be sure to
place the brazed seam toward the indenter. 8. Insert stripped wire into the barrel. 9. Holding the
wire in place, squeeze tool handles until ratchet releases.
10. Repeating steps 5-7, crimp the other half of the splice.
11. Check for acceptable crimp.
a. Crimp should be centered on each end of the butt splice. b. Wire insulation does not enter butt
splice. c. Wire is visible through inspection hole of splices.
12. Evenly position supplied heat shrink tubing over wire repair. 13. Use shielded heat gun to heat
the repaired area until adhesive flows out of both ends of the heat shrink tubing. 14. Reconnect
battery ground cable.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11750
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11751
The given chart is to be used when pigtails or terminals are different wire gauge than the vehicle
harness.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 11752
Wiper Motor: Connector Views
C476
C125
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor - Windshield
WIPER MOTOR - WINDSHIELD
Removal and Installation
1. Remove the mounting arm and pivot shaft.
2. NOTE: Mark the position of the windshield wiper motor crank before it is disconnected.
Disconnect the windshield wiper motor crank. Remove the bolt.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
3. Remove the bolts and the windshield wiper motor.
- To install, tighten to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
4. NOTE: The windshield wiper motor crank must be set to the same location for the windshield
wiper mounting arm and pivot shaft to be installed
properly. Refer to Component test. See: Testing and Inspection/Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Windshield Wiper Motor
To install reverse the removal procedure.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield > Page 11755
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair Wiper Motor - Rear Window
WIPER MOTOR - REAR WINDOW
Removal
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm.
2. Remove the dust boot cover.
3. Remove the rear window wiper pivot shaft nut and handle.
- To install, tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
4. Open the liftgate glass.
5. Remove the nuts and the rear window striker and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
- To install, tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. Remove the liftgate trim panel. 7. Close the liftgate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield > Page 11756
8. If installing a new rear wiper motor, remove the liftgate window glass latch.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
9. Remove the rear window wiper motor.
1 Disconnect the electrical connector.
2 Remove the bolts. To install, tighten to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
Installation
1. If installing a new rear wiper motor, install the liftgate window glass latch.
1 Tighten bolts to 8 Nm (71 lb-in).
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield > Page 11757
2. NOTE: An audible click should be heard as the striker engages the latch.
Push the rear window wiper striker and pivot shaft assembly into the wiper motor. The pivot shaft
pin should be aligned with the hole in the motor disc.
3. Install the rear window wiper motor alignment tool. If installing a new rear wiper motor, one is
provided with the motor assembly.
1 Make sure the alignment tool fits over the motor disc and striker assembly.
2 Make sure the alignment tool clips are securely engaged.
4. Install the rear wiper motor.
1 Tighten the bolts to 11 Nm (8 lb-ft).
2 Connect the electrical connectors.
5. Carefully close the liftgate glass.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Wiper Motor - Windshield > Page 11758
6. Open the liftgate. Install the rear window wiper striker and wiper pivot arm mounting assembly
nuts.
- Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
7. Close the liftgate.
8. Install the rear window wiper pivot shaft nut and handle.
- Tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
9. Install the dust boot cover.
10. Install the rear wiper pivot arm. 11. Open the liftgate.
12. Remove the rear window wiper motor aligning tool. 13. Open the liftgate glass. 14. Install the
liftgate trim panel. 15. Test the liftgate and liftgate glass for normal operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative
Wiper Pivot: Customer Interest Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative
TSB 07-10-13
05/28/07
REAR WIPER INOPERATIVE
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-10 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2003-2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles, the rear wiper may not return to park
position. In this case, the rear wiper system will attempt to park periodically causing a battery
drain.This concern may be caused by corrosion on the wiper pivot shaft assembly.
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to identify and replace the rear window striker/wiper
pivot shaft assembly.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disengage rear wiper mechanism by partially opening the rear liftgate glass. (Figure 1)
2. Access the rear wiper arm attaching nut. (Figure 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative > Page
11767
3. Use a torque wrench to measure the amount of torque necessary to rotate the wiper arm
throughout the entire travel of the wiper arm. (Figure 3)
a. This must be done while the glass is open so that the wiper mechanism is disengaged from the
motor drive plate.
b. The wiper blade should be in full contact with the glass throughout the entire stroke of the arm.
c. The measurement taken must not exceed 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m) of force when rotated in either
direction.
(1) If the force is greater than 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m), then replace the rear window striker / wiper pivot
shaft assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-16 - Wipers and Washers Removal and
Installation. (Figure 4)
(2) If the rear window striker/wiper pivot shaft assembly is within specification, then follow normal
Workshop Manual diagnostics.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative > Page
11768
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071013A 2003-2007 0.7 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Rear Window Striker/Wiper Pivot Shaft, Includes Time To
Verify Concern (Do Not Use With 40860B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17C426 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is
Inoperative
Wiper Pivot: All Technical Service Bulletins Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is Inoperative
TSB 07-10-13
05/28/07
REAR WIPER INOPERATIVE
FORD: 2003-2007 Expedition
LINCOLN: 2003-2007 Navigator
This article supersedes TSB 06-22-10 to update the vehicle model years.
ISSUE Some 2003-2007 Expedition and Navigator vehicles, the rear wiper may not return to park
position. In this case, the rear wiper system will attempt to park periodically causing a battery
drain.This concern may be caused by corrosion on the wiper pivot shaft assembly.
ACTION Use the following Service Procedure to identify and replace the rear window striker/wiper
pivot shaft assembly.
SERVICE PROCEDURE
1. Disengage rear wiper mechanism by partially opening the rear liftgate glass. (Figure 1)
2. Access the rear wiper arm attaching nut. (Figure 2)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is
Inoperative > Page 11774
3. Use a torque wrench to measure the amount of torque necessary to rotate the wiper arm
throughout the entire travel of the wiper arm. (Figure 3)
a. This must be done while the glass is open so that the wiper mechanism is disengaged from the
motor drive plate.
b. The wiper blade should be in full contact with the glass throughout the entire stroke of the arm.
c. The measurement taken must not exceed 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m) of force when rotated in either
direction.
(1) If the force is greater than 49 lb-in (5.5 N.m), then replace the rear window striker / wiper pivot
shaft assembly. Refer to Workshop Manual, Section 501-16 - Wipers and Washers Removal and
Installation. (Figure 4)
(2) If the rear window striker/wiper pivot shaft assembly is within specification, then follow normal
Workshop Manual diagnostics.
WARRANTY STATUS: Eligible Under Provisions Of New Vehicle Limited Warranty Coverage
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiper Pivot: > 07-10-13 > May > 07 > Wipers/Washers - Rear Wiper is
Inoperative > Page 11775
IMPORTANT: Warranty coverage limits/policies are not altered by a TSB. Warranty coverage limits
are determined by the identified causal part.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION TIME
071013A 2003-2007 0.7 Hr.
Expedition/Navigator: Replace The Rear Window Striker/Wiper Pivot Shaft, Includes Time To
Verify Concern (Do Not Use With 40860B)
DEALER CODING
CONDITION
BASIC PART NO. CODE
17C426 42
Disclaimer
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 11776
Wiper Pivot: Service and Repair
STRIKER AND WIPER PIVOT SHAFT ASSEMBLY - REAR
Removal
1. Remove the rear wiper pivot arm.
2. Remove the dust boot cover.
3. Remove the nut and the rear window glass handle.
4. Remove the nuts and the rear window striker and wiper pivot shaft assembly.
Installation
1. Remove the liftgate trim panel.
2. NOTE: An audible click should be heard as the striker engages the latch.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 11777
Push the rear window wiper striker and pivot shaft assembly into the wiper motor. The pivot shaft
pin should be aligned with the hole in the motor disc.
3. Install the rear window wiper motor alignment tool. If installing a new rear wiper motor, one is
provided with the motor assembly.
1 Make sure the alignment tool fits over the motor disc and striker assembly.
2 Make sure the alignment tool clips are securely engaged.
4. Carefully close the liftgate glass.
5. Open the liftgate. Install the rear window wiper striker and wiper pivot arm mounting assembly
nuts. Tighten to 6 Nm (53 lb-in).
6. Remove the rear window wiper motor alignment tool. 7. Close the liftgate.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Pivot > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 11778
8. Install the rear window wiper pivot shaft nut and handle. Tighten to 18 Nm (13 lb-ft).
9. Install the dust boot cover.
10. NOTE: This step makes sure that the wiper motor is in the PARK position.
Turn the rear window wiper switch ON and allow the motor to operate for at least one cycle. Turn
the rear window wiper switch to OFF.
11. Install the rear wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
1 Position the wiper pivot arm onto the rear window wiper motor shaft.
2 Tighten the nut to 15 Nm (11 lb-ft).
3 Install the cover.
12. Open the liftgate. 13. Install the liftgate trim panel. 14. Test the liftgate and liftgate glass for
normal operation.
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations
View 151-15 (Steering Column - Expedition)
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
11782
C202
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 11785
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 11786
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 11787
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection Multifunction Switch
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Multifunction Switch, Wiper/Washer Portion > Page 11788
Ford Expedition 4wd Workshop Manual (V8-5.4L (2007))
Ford Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
> Page 11789
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Steering Column Multifunction Switch
NOTE: Power tilt column shown, manual tilt similar.
Removal and Installation
All vehicles
1. Remove the 3 screws, pull out to release the top retaining clips and remove the lower steering
column opening cover.
Vehicles with power tilt